Thanks to visit codestin.com
Credit goes to www.scribd.com

0% found this document useful (0 votes)
69 views1,864 pages

OS6450 AOS 6.6.2 R02 CLI Reference Guide

The OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide documents the functionality and commands for the OmniSwitch 6450 Series, specifically for release 6.6.2. It includes detailed sections on Ethernet port commands, VLAN management, link aggregation, and various protocols, providing users with essential information for configuration and management. The guide is intended for users seeking to understand and utilize the features of the OmniSwitch 6450 effectively.

Uploaded by

Andrea Couto
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
69 views1,864 pages

OS6450 AOS 6.6.2 R02 CLI Reference Guide

The OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide documents the functionality and commands for the OmniSwitch 6450 Series, specifically for release 6.6.2. It includes detailed sections on Ethernet port commands, VLAN management, link aggregation, and various protocols, providing users with essential information for configuration and management. The guide is intended for users seeking to understand and utilize the features of the OmniSwitch 6450 effectively.

Uploaded by

Andrea Couto
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 1864

Part No. 060354-10, Rev.

A
November 2011

OmniSwitch 6450
CLI Reference Guide

www.alcatel-lucent.com
This user guide documents release 6.6.2 of the OmniSwitch 6450 Series.
The functionality described in this guide is subject to change without notice.

Copyright © 2011 by Alcatel-Lucent. All rights reserved. This document may not be reproduced in whole
or in part without the express written permission of Alcatel-Lucent.
Alcatel-Lucent® and the Alcatel-Lucent logo are registered trademarks of Alcatel-Lucent. Xylan®,
OmniSwitch®, OmniStack®, and Alcatel-Lucent OmniVista® are registered trademarks of Alcatel-Lucent
OmniAccess™, Omni Switch/Router™, PolicyView™, RouterView™, SwitchManager™, VoiceView™,
WebView™, X-Cell™, X-Vision™, and the Xylan logo are trademarks of Alcatel-Lucent
This OmniSwitch product contains components which may be covered by one or more of the following
U.S. Patents:
• U.S. Patent No. 6,339,830
• U.S. Patent No. 6,070,243
• U.S. Patent No. 6,061,368
• U.S. Patent No. 5,394,402
• U.S. Patent No. 6,047,024
• U.S. Patent No. 6,314,106
• U.S. Patent No. 6,542,507
• U.S. Patent No. 6,874,090

26801 West Agoura Road


Calabasas, CA 91301
(818) 880-3500 FAX (818) 880-3505
[email protected]
US Customer Support—(800) 995-2696
International Customer Support—(818) 878-4507
Internet—eservice.ind.alcatel.com

ii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

About This Guide ....................................................................................................... xxv


Supported Platforms ....................................................................................................... xxv
Who Should Read this Manual? .................................................................................... xxvi
When Should I Read this Manual? ................................................................................ xxvi
What is in this Manual? ................................................................................................. xxvi
What is Not in this Manual? ......................................................................................... xxvii
How is the Information Organized? ............................................................................. xxvii
Text Conventions ......................................................................................................... xxvii
Documentation Roadmap .............................................................................................. xxix
Related Documentation .................................................................................................. xxx
User Manual CD ........................................................................................................... xxxi
Technical Support ......................................................................................................... xxxi

Chapter 1 Ethernet Port Commands ......................................................................................... 2-1


trap port link .............................................................................................................2-3
interfaces speed ........................................................................................................2-5
interfaces autoneg .....................................................................................................2-7
interfaces crossover ..................................................................................................2-9
interfaces pause ......................................................................................................2-11
interfaces duplex ....................................................................................................2-13
interfaces admin .....................................................................................................2-15
interfaces alias ........................................................................................................2-16
interfaces ifg ...........................................................................................................2-17
interfaces no l2 statistics ........................................................................................2-18
interfaces max frame ..............................................................................................2-20
interfaces flood multicast .......................................................................................2-21
interfaces flood rate ................................................................................................2-23
interfaces clear-violation-all ...................................................................................2-25
interfaces hybrid autoneg .......................................................................................2-26
interfaces hybrid crossover .....................................................................................2-28
interfaces hybrid duplex .........................................................................................2-30
interfaces hybrid speed ...........................................................................................2-32
interfaces hybrid pause ...........................................................................................2-34
show interfaces .......................................................................................................2-37
show interfaces capability ......................................................................................2-41
show interfaces flow control ..................................................................................2-43
show interfaces pause .............................................................................................2-45
show interfaces accounting ....................................................................................2-47
show interfaces counters ........................................................................................2-50

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 iii


Contents

show interfaces counters errors ..............................................................................2-52


show interfaces collisions .......................................................................................2-54
show interfaces status .............................................................................................2-56
show interfaces port ...............................................................................................2-59
show interfaces ifg .................................................................................................2-61
show interfaces flood rate ......................................................................................2-63
show interfaces traffic ............................................................................................2-65
show interfaces hybrid ...........................................................................................2-67
show interfaces hybrid status .................................................................................2-71
show interfaces hybrid flow control .......................................................................2-73
show interfaces hybrid pause .................................................................................2-75
show interfaces hybrid capability ...........................................................................2-77
show interfaces hybrid accounting .........................................................................2-79
show interfaces hybrid counters .............................................................................2-82
show interfaces hybrid counters errors ...................................................................2-84
show interfaces hybrid collisions ...........................................................................2-86
show interfaces hybrid traffic .................................................................................2-88
show interfaces hybrid port ....................................................................................2-90
show interfaces hybrid flood rate ...........................................................................2-92
show interfaces hybrid ifg ......................................................................................2-94

Chapter 2 Source Learning Commands ................................................................................... 3-1


mac-address-table .....................................................................................................3-2
mac-address-table static-multicast ...........................................................................3-4
mac-address-table aging-time ..................................................................................3-6
source-learning .........................................................................................................3-8
show mac-address-table .........................................................................................3-10
show mac-address-table static-multicast ................................................................3-13
show mac-address-table count ...............................................................................3-16
show mac-address-table aging-time .......................................................................3-18
show source-learning ..............................................................................................3-19

Chapter 3 VLAN Management Commands ............................................................................. 4-1


vlan ...........................................................................................................................4-2
vlan stp .....................................................................................................................4-4
vlan mobile-tag .........................................................................................................4-6
vlan port default .......................................................................................................4-8
vlan source-learning ...............................................................................................4-10
show vlan ................................................................................................................4-12
show vlan port ........................................................................................................4-15
show vlan router mac status ...................................................................................4-18
show vlan gvrp .......................................................................................................4-20
show vlan ipmvlan .................................................................................................4-23

Chapter 4 802.1Q Commands .................................................................................................... 5-1


vlan 802.1q ...............................................................................................................5-2
vlan 802.1q frame type .............................................................................................5-4
show 802.1q .............................................................................................................5-6

Chapter 5 Distributed Spanning Tree Commands ................................................................ 6-1


bridge mode ..............................................................................................................6-4
bridge protocol .........................................................................................................6-6

iv OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

bridge cist protocol ...................................................................................................6-8


bridge 1x1 protocol ................................................................................................6-10
bridge mst region name ..........................................................................................6-12
bridge mst region revision level .............................................................................6-14
bridge mst region max hops ...................................................................................6-15
bridge msti ..............................................................................................................6-17
bridge msti vlan ......................................................................................................6-19
bridge priority .........................................................................................................6-21
bridge cist priority ..................................................................................................6-23
bridge msti priority .................................................................................................6-25
bridge 1x1 priority ..................................................................................................6-27
bridge hello time .....................................................................................................6-29
bridge cist hello time ..............................................................................................6-31
bridge 1x1 hello time ..............................................................................................6-33
bridge max age .......................................................................................................6-35
bridge cist max age .................................................................................................6-37
bridge 1x1 max age ................................................................................................6-39
bridge forward delay ..............................................................................................6-41
bridge cist forward delay ........................................................................................6-43
bridge 1x1 forward delay .......................................................................................6-45
bridge bpdu-switching ............................................................................................6-47
bridge path cost mode ............................................................................................6-49
bridge auto-vlan-containment ................................................................................6-51
bridge slot/port .......................................................................................................6-53
bridge cist slot/port .................................................................................................6-55
bridge 1x1 slot/port ................................................................................................6-57
bridge slot/port priority ..........................................................................................6-59
bridge cist slot/port priority ....................................................................................6-61
bridge msti slot/port priority ..................................................................................6-63
bridge 1x1 slot/port priority ...................................................................................6-65
bridge slot/port path cost ........................................................................................6-67
bridge cist slot/port path cost .................................................................................6-71
bridge msti slot/port path cost ................................................................................6-75
bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost .................................................................................6-78
bridge slot/port mode .............................................................................................6-81
bridge cist slot/port mode .......................................................................................6-83
bridge 1x1 slot/port mode ......................................................................................6-85
bridge slot/port connection .....................................................................................6-87
bridge cist slot/port connection ..............................................................................6-89
bridge 1x1 slot/port connection ..............................................................................6-91
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge .............................................................................6-93
bridge 1x1 slot/port admin-edge ............................................................................6-95
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge ................................................................................6-97
bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge ................................................................................6-99
bridge cist slot/port restricted-role .......................................................................6-101
bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-role .......................................................................6-103
bridge cist slot/port restricted-tcn .........................................................................6-105
bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn ........................................................................6-107
bridge cist txholdcount .........................................................................................6-109
bridge 1x1 txholdcount .........................................................................................6-110
bridge rrstp ...........................................................................................................6-111
bridge rrstp ring ....................................................................................................6-112

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 v


Contents

bridge rrstp ring vlan-tag ......................................................................................6-114


bridge rrstp ring status ..........................................................................................6-116
show spantree .......................................................................................................6-117
show spantree cist .................................................................................................6-123
show spantree msti ...............................................................................................6-127
show spantree 1x1 ................................................................................................6-132
show spantree ports ..............................................................................................6-136
show spantree cist ports ........................................................................................6-145
show spantree msti ports ......................................................................................6-149
show spantree 1x1 ports .......................................................................................6-155
show spantree mst region .....................................................................................6-161
show spantree msti vlan-map ...............................................................................6-163
show spantree cist vlan-map ................................................................................6-165
show spantree map-msti .......................................................................................6-167
show spantree mst port .........................................................................................6-168
show bridge rrstp configuration ...........................................................................6-170
show bridge rrstp ring ..........................................................................................6-171
bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ .........................................................................................6-173
bridge port pvst+ ..................................................................................................6-174

Chapter 6 Link Aggregation Commands ................................................................................. 7-1


static linkagg size .....................................................................................................7-3
static linkagg name ...................................................................................................7-5
static linkagg admin state .........................................................................................7-6
static agg agg num ....................................................................................................7-7
lacp linkagg size .......................................................................................................7-9
lacp linkagg name ...................................................................................................7-11
lacp linkagg admin state .........................................................................................7-12
lacp linkagg actor admin key .................................................................................7-14
lacp linkagg actor system priority ..........................................................................7-15
lacp linkagg actor system id ...................................................................................7-16
lacp linkagg partner system id ................................................................................7-17
lacp linkagg partner system priority .......................................................................7-19
lacp linkagg partner admin key ..............................................................................7-20
lacp agg actor admin key ........................................................................................7-21
lacp agg actor admin state ......................................................................................7-24
lacp agg actor system id .........................................................................................7-26
lacp agg actor system priority ................................................................................7-28
lacp agg partner admin state ...................................................................................7-30
lacp agg partner admin system id ...........................................................................7-32
lacp agg partner admin key ....................................................................................7-34
lacp agg partner admin system priority ..................................................................7-36
lacp agg actor port priority .....................................................................................7-38
lacp agg partner admin port ....................................................................................7-40
lacp agg partner admin port priority .......................................................................7-42
show linkagg ..........................................................................................................7-44
show linkagg port ...................................................................................................7-49

Chapter 7 GVRP Commands ....................................................................................................... 8-1


gvrp ...........................................................................................................................8-2
gvrp port ...................................................................................................................8-3
gvrp transparent switching .......................................................................................8-5

vi OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

gvrp maximum vlan .................................................................................................8-6


gvrp registration .......................................................................................................8-7
gvrp applicant ...........................................................................................................8-9
............................................................................................................... gvrp timer 8-11
gvrp restrict-vlan-registration .................................................................................8-13
gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement ............................................................................8-15
...........................................................................................gvrp static-vlan restrict 8-17
................................................................................................. clear gvrp statistics 8-19
show gvrp statistics ...............................................................................................8-20
show gvrp last-pdu-origin ......................................................................................8-23
show gvrp configuration .........................................................................................8-24
................................................................................. show gvrp configuration port 8-26
show gvrp configuration linkagg/port ....................................................................8-28
show gvrp timer ......................................................................................................8-31

Chapter 8 802.1AB Commands .................................................................................................. 9-1


lldp destination mac-address ....................................................................................9-3
lldp transmit fast-start-count ....................................................................................9-4
lldp transmit interval ................................................................................................9-5
lldp transmit hold-multiplier ....................................................................................9-6
lldp transmit delay ....................................................................................................9-7
lldp reinit delay .........................................................................................................9-8
lldp notification interval ...........................................................................................9-9
lldp lldpdu ..............................................................................................................9-10
lldp notification ......................................................................................................9-12
lldp network-policy ................................................................................................9-14
lldp med network-policy ........................................................................................9-16
lldp tlv management ...............................................................................................9-18
lldp tlv dot1 ............................................................................................................9-20
lldp tlv dot3 ............................................................................................................9-22
lldp tlv med .............................................................................................................9-24
show lldp config .....................................................................................................9-26
show lldp network-policy .......................................................................................9-28
show lldp med network-policy ...............................................................................9-30
show lldp system-statistics .....................................................................................9-32
show lldp statistics .................................................................................................9-34
show lldp local .......................................................................................... -system 9-36
show lldp local ............................................................................................... -port 9-39
show lldp local-management-address ....................................................................9-44
show lldp remote-system ........................................................................................9-45
show lldp remote-system med ................................................................................9-47

Chapter 9 Interswitch Protocol Commands ........................................................................... 10-1


amap .......................................................................................................................10-2
amap discovery time ...............................................................................................10-3
amap common time ................................................................................................10-5
show amap ..............................................................................................................10-7

Chapter 10 IP Commands ............................................................................................................ 11-1


ip interface ..............................................................................................................11-4
ip interface dhcp-client ...........................................................................................11-7
ip router primary-address .......................................................................................11-9

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 vii


Contents

ip router router-id .................................................................................................11-10


ip static-route ........................................................................................................11-11
ip route-pref ..........................................................................................................11-13
ip default-ttl ..........................................................................................................11-15
ping .......................................................................................................................11-16
traceroute ..............................................................................................................11-18
ip directed-broadcast ............................................................................................11-20
ip service ..............................................................................................................11-21
ip redist .................................................................................................................11-23
ip access-list .........................................................................................................11-25
ip access-list address ............................................................................................11-26
ip route-map action ...............................................................................................11-28
ip route-map match ip address .............................................................................11-30
ip route-map match ipv6 address .........................................................................11-32
ip route-map match ip-nexthop ............................................................................11-34
ip route-map match ipv6-nexthop ........................................................................11-36
ip route-map match tag .........................................................................................11-38
ip route-map match ipv4-interface .......................................................................11-40
ip route-map match ipv6-interface .......................................................................11-42
ip route-map match metric ...................................................................................11-44
ip route-map set metric .........................................................................................11-46
ip route-map set tag ..............................................................................................11-48
ip route-map set ip-nexthop ..................................................................................11-50
ip route-map set ipv6-nexthop ..............................................................................11-52
arp .........................................................................................................................11-54
clear arp-cache ......................................................................................................11-56
ip dos arp-poison restricted-address .....................................................................11-57
arp filter ................................................................................................................11-58
clear arp filter .......................................................................................................11-60
icmp type ..............................................................................................................11-61
icmp unreachable ..................................................................................................11-64
icmp echo .............................................................................................................11-66
icmp timestamp ....................................................................................................11-68
icmp addr-mask ....................................................................................................11-70
icmp messages ......................................................................................................11-72
ip dos scan close-port-penalty ..............................................................................11-73
ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty .........................................................................11-74
ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty .......................................................................11-75
ip dos scan threshold ............................................................................................11-76
ip dos trap .............................................................................................................11-78
ip dos scan decay ..................................................................................................11-79
show ip traffic .......................................................................................................11-80
show ip interface ..................................................................................................11-83
show ip route ........................................................................................................11-87
show ip route-pref ................................................................................................11-89
show ip redist .......................................................................................................11-90
show ip access-list ................................................................................................11-92
show ip route-map ................................................................................................11-94
show ip router database ........................................................................................11-96
show ip config ......................................................................................................11-98
show ip protocols .................................................................................................11-99
show ip service ...................................................................................................11-101

viii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

show arp .............................................................................................................11-103


show arp filter .....................................................................................................11-105
show icmp control ..............................................................................................11-107
show icmp statistics ............................................................................................11-109
show tcp statistics ...............................................................................................11-111
show tcp ports .....................................................................................................11-113
show udp statistics ..............................................................................................11-115
show udp ports ...................................................................................................11-116
show ip dos config ..............................................................................................11-117
show ip dos statistics ..........................................................................................11-119
show ip dos arp-poison .......................................................................................11-121

Chapter 11 IPv6 Commands ........................................................................................................ 12-1


ipv6 interface ..........................................................................................................12-3
ipv6 address ............................................................................................................12-6
ipv6 dad-check .......................................................................................................12-8
ipv6 hop-limit .........................................................................................................12-9
ipv6 pmtu-lifetime ................................................................................................12-10
ipv6 host ...............................................................................................................12-11
ipv6 neighbor stale-lifetime .................................................................................12-12
ipv6 neighbor ........................................................................................................12-13
ipv6 prefix ............................................................................................................12-15
ipv6 route ..............................................................................................................12-17
ipv6 static-route ....................................................................................................12-18
ipv6 route-pref ......................................................................................................12-20
ping6 .....................................................................................................................12-21
traceroute6 ............................................................................................................12-23
show ipv6 hosts ....................................................................................................12-25
show ipv6 icmp statistics ......................................................................................12-26
show ipv6 interface ..............................................................................................12-29
show ipv6 pmtu table ...........................................................................................12-33
clear ipv6 pmtu table ............................................................................................12-35
show ipv6 neighbors .............................................................................................12-36
clear ipv6 neighbors .............................................................................................12-38
show ipv6 prefixes ...............................................................................................12-39
show ipv6 routes ...................................................................................................12-41
show ipv6 route-pref ............................................................................................12-43
show ipv6 router database ....................................................................................12-44
show ipv6 tcp ports ..............................................................................................12-46
show ipv6 traffic ...................................................................................................12-48
clear ipv6 traffic ...................................................................................................12-51
show ipv6 udp ports .............................................................................................12-52
show ipv6 information .........................................................................................12-54
ipv6 redist .............................................................................................................12-56
ipv6 access-list .....................................................................................................12-58
ipv6 access-list address ........................................................................................12-59
show ipv6 redist ...................................................................................................12-61
show ipv6 access-list ............................................................................................12-63
ipv6 load rip .........................................................................................................12-65
ipv6 rip status .......................................................................................................12-66
ipv6 rip invalid-timer ...........................................................................................12-67
ipv6 rip garbage-timer ..........................................................................................12-68

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 ix


Contents

ipv6 rip holddown-timer .......................................................................................12-69


ipv6 rip jitter .........................................................................................................12-70
ipv6 rip route-tag ..................................................................................................12-71
ipv6 rip update-interval ........................................................................................12-72
ipv6 rip triggered-sends ........................................................................................12-73
ipv6 rip interface ..................................................................................................12-74
ipv6 rip interface metric .......................................................................................12-76
ipv6 rip interface recv-status ................................................................................12-77
ipv6 rip interface send-status ................................................................................12-78
ipv6 rip interface horizon .....................................................................................12-79
show ipv6 rip ........................................................................................................12-80
show ipv6 rip interface .........................................................................................12-82
show ipv6 rip peer ................................................................................................12-85
show ipv6 rip routes .............................................................................................12-87

Chapter 12 RIP Commands .......................................................................................................... 13-1


ip load rip ...............................................................................................................13-2
ip rip status .............................................................................................................13-3
ip rip interface ........................................................................................................13-4
ip rip interface status ..............................................................................................13-6
ip rip interface metric .............................................................................................13-8
ip rip interface send-version ...................................................................................13-9
ip rip interface recv-version .................................................................................13-11
ip rip force-holddowntimer ..................................................................................13-13
ip rip host-route ....................................................................................................13-15
ip rip route-tag ......................................................................................................13-16
ip rip interface auth-type ......................................................................................13-17
ip rip interface auth-key .......................................................................................13-18
ip rip update-interval ............................................................................................13-19
ip rip invalid-timer ...............................................................................................13-20
ip rip garbage-timer ..............................................................................................13-21
ip rip holddown-timer ...........................................................................................13-22
show ip rip ............................................................................................................13-23
show ip rip routes .................................................................................................13-25
show ip rip interface .............................................................................................13-28
show ip rip peer ....................................................................................................13-30

Chapter 13 RDP Commands ........................................................................................................ 14-1


ip router-discovery .................................................................................................14-2
ip router-discovery interface ..................................................................................14-3
ip router-discovery interface advertisement-address ..............................................14-5
ip router-discovery interface max-advertisement-interval .....................................14-7
ip router-discovery interface min-advertisement-interval ......................................14-9
ip router-discovery interface advertisement-lifetime ...........................................14-11
ip router-discovery interface preference-level .....................................................14-13
show ip router-discovery ......................................................................................14-15
show ip router-discovery interface .......................................................................14-17

Chapter 14 DHCP Relay Commands .......................................................................................... 15-1


ip helper address .....................................................................................................15-3
ip helper address vlan .............................................................................................15-5
ip helper standard ...................................................................................................15-7

x OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

ip helper per-vlan only ...........................................................................................15-8


ip helper forward delay ........................................................................................15-10
ip helper maximum hops ......................................................................................15-12
ip helper agent-information ..................................................................................15-14
ip helper agent-information policy .......................................................................15-16
ip helper pxe-support ............................................................................................15-18
ip helper traffic-suppression .................................................................................15-19
ip helper dhcp-snooping .......................................................................................15-21
ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification ...............................................15-22
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion ...............................................15-23
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format ...........................................................15-24
ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check ................................................15-26
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan ...............................................................................15-27
ip helper dhcp-snooping port ................................................................................15-29
ip helper dhcp-snooping port traffic-suppression .................................................15-31
ip helper dhcp-snooping port ip-source-filtering .................................................15-33
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding ..........................................................................15-35
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding timeout .............................................................15-37
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding action ...............................................................15-38
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency .......................................................15-39
ip helper boot-up ..................................................................................................15-40
ip helper boot-up enable .......................................................................................15-42
ip udp relay ...........................................................................................................15-43
ip udp relay vlan ...................................................................................................15-45
show ip helper ......................................................................................................15-47
show ip helper stats ..............................................................................................15-51
show ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan ......................................................................15-53
show ip helper dhcp-snooping port ......................................................................15-55
show ip helper dhcp-snooping binding ................................................................15-57
show ip udp relay service .....................................................................................15-59
show ip udp relay statistics ...................................................................................15-61
show ip udp relay destination ...............................................................................15-63

Chapter 15 IP Multicast Switching Commands ....................................................................... 16-1


ip multicast status ...................................................................................................16-3
ip multicast querier-forwarding ..............................................................................16-5
ip multicast version ................................................................................................16-7
ip multicast static-neighbor ....................................................................................16-9
ip multicast static-querier .....................................................................................16-11
ip multicast static-group .......................................................................................16-13
ip multicast query-interval ...................................................................................16-15
ip multicast last-member-query-interval ..............................................................16-17
ip multicast query-response-interval ....................................................................16-19
ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval ................................................................16-21
ip multicast router-timeout ...................................................................................16-23
ip multicast source-timeout ..................................................................................16-25
ip multicast querying ............................................................................................16-27
ip multicast robustness .........................................................................................16-29
ip multicast spoofing ............................................................................................16-31
ip multicast zapping .............................................................................................16-33
ip multicast proxying ............................................................................................16-35
ipv6 multicast status .............................................................................................16-37

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xi


Contents

ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding ........................................................................16-39


ipv6 multicast version ..........................................................................................16-41
ipv6 multicast static-neighbor ..............................................................................16-43
ipv6 multicast static-querier .................................................................................16-45
ipv6 multicast static-group ...................................................................................16-47
ipv6 multicast query-interval ...............................................................................16-49
ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval ..........................................................16-51
ipv6 multicast query-response-interval ................................................................16-53
ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval ............................................................16-55
ipv6 multicast router-timeout ...............................................................................16-57
ipv6 multicast source-timeout ..............................................................................16-59
ipv6 multicast querying ........................................................................................16-61
ipv6 multicast robustness .....................................................................................16-63
ipv6 multicast spoofing ........................................................................................16-65
ipv6 multicast zapping .........................................................................................16-67
ipv6 multicast proxying ........................................................................................16-69
show ip multicast ..................................................................................................16-71
show ip multicast forward ....................................................................................16-76
show ip multicast neighbor ..................................................................................16-78
show ip multicast querier .....................................................................................16-80
show ip multicast group .......................................................................................16-82
show ip multicast source ......................................................................................16-84
show ipv6 multicast ..............................................................................................16-86
show ipv6 multicast forward ................................................................................16-91
show ipv6 multicast neighbor ..............................................................................16-93
show ipv6 multicast querier .................................................................................16-95
show ipv6 multicast group ...................................................................................16-97
show ipv6 multicast source ..................................................................................16-99

Chapter 16 IP Multicast VLAN Commands .............................................................................. 17-1


vlan ipmvlan ...........................................................................................................17-2
vlan ipmvlan ctag ...................................................................................................17-4
vlan ipmvlan address ..............................................................................................17-6
vlan ipmvlan sender-port ........................................................................................17-8
vlan ipmvlan receiver-port ...................................................................................17-10
vlan svlan port translate ipmvlan .........................................................................17-12
show vlan ipmvlan c-tag ......................................................................................17-14
show vlan ipmvlan address ..................................................................................17-15
show vlan ipmvlan port-config ............................................................................17-17
show ipmvlan port-config ....................................................................................17-19
show vlan ipmvlan port-binding ..........................................................................17-21

Chapter 17 QoS Commands ........................................................................................................ 18-1


qos ..........................................................................................................................18-3
qos trust ports .........................................................................................................18-5
qos default servicing mode .....................................................................................18-7
qos forward log .......................................................................................................18-9
qos log console .....................................................................................................18-10
qos log lines ..........................................................................................................18-11
qos log level .........................................................................................................18-12
qos default bridged disposition ............................................................................18-14
qos default multicast disposition ..........................................................................18-16

xii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

qos stats interval ...................................................................................................18-17


qos nms priority ....................................................................................................18-18
qos phones ............................................................................................................18-20
qos user-port .........................................................................................................18-22
qos dei ..................................................................................................................18-24
debug qos ..............................................................................................................18-26
debug qos internal ................................................................................................18-28
qos clear log .........................................................................................................18-30
qos apply ..............................................................................................................18-31
qos revert ..............................................................................................................18-32
qos flush ...............................................................................................................18-33
qos reset ................................................................................................................18-35
qos stats reset ........................................................................................................18-36
qos port reset ........................................................................................................18-37
qos port .................................................................................................................18-38
qos port trusted .....................................................................................................18-40
qos port servicing mode .......................................................................................18-42
qos port q maxbw .................................................................................................18-44
qos port maximum egress-bandwidth ..................................................................18-46
qos port maximum ingress-bandwidth .................................................................18-48
qos port default 802.1p .........................................................................................18-50
qos port default dscp ............................................................................................18-52
qos port default classification ...............................................................................18-54
qos port dei ...........................................................................................................18-56
show qos port .......................................................................................................18-58
show qos queue ....................................................................................................18-60
show qos slice .......................................................................................................18-63
show qos log .........................................................................................................18-65
show qos config ....................................................................................................18-67
show qos statistics ................................................................................................18-70

Chapter 18 QoS Policy Commands ............................................................................................ 19-1


policy rule ...............................................................................................................19-5
policy validity period .............................................................................................19-9
policy network group ...........................................................................................19-12
policy service group .............................................................................................19-14
policy mac group ..................................................................................................19-16
policy port group ..................................................................................................19-18
policy vlan group ..................................................................................................19-20
policy map group ..................................................................................................19-22
policy service ........................................................................................................19-24
policy service protocol .........................................................................................19-27
policy service source tcp port ...............................................................................19-29
policy service destination tcp port ........................................................................19-31
policy service source udp port ..............................................................................19-33
policy service destination udp port .......................................................................19-35
policy condition ....................................................................................................19-37
policy condition source ip ....................................................................................19-41
policy condition source ipv6 ................................................................................19-43
policy condition destination ip .............................................................................19-45
policy condition destination ipv6 .........................................................................19-47
policy condition multicast ip ................................................................................19-49

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xiii


Contents

policy condition source network group ................................................................19-51


policy condition destination network group .........................................................19-53
policy condition multicast network group ............................................................19-55
policy condition source ip port .............................................................................19-57
policy condition destination ip port ......................................................................19-59
policy condition source tcp port ...........................................................................19-61
policy condition destination tcp port ....................................................................19-63
policy condition source udp port ..........................................................................19-65
policy condition destination udp port ...................................................................19-67
policy condition ethertype ....................................................................................19-69
policy condition established .................................................................................19-71
policy condition tcpflags ......................................................................................19-73
policy condition service .......................................................................................19-75
policy condition service group .............................................................................19-76
policy condition icmptype ....................................................................................19-78
policy condition icmpcode ...................................................................................19-80
policy condition ip protocol .................................................................................19-82
policy condition ipv6 ............................................................................................19-84
policy condition tos ..............................................................................................19-86
policy condition dscp ...........................................................................................19-88
policy condition source mac .................................................................................19-90
policy condition destination mac ..........................................................................19-92
policy condition source mac group ......................................................................19-94
policy condition destination mac group ...............................................................19-96
policy condition source vlan ................................................................................19-98
policy condition source vlan group ....................................................................19-100
policy condition destination vlan .......................................................................19-102
policy condition 802.1p ......................................................................................19-104
policy condition source port ...............................................................................19-106
policy condition destination port ........................................................................19-108
policy condition source port group .....................................................................19-110
policy condition destination port group .............................................................19-112
policy action .......................................................................................................19-114
policy list ............................................................................................................19-117
policy action disposition .....................................................................................19-120
policy action shared ............................................................................................19-122
policy action priority ..........................................................................................19-124
policy action maximum bandwidth ....................................................................19-126
policy action maximum depth ............................................................................19-128
policy action cir ..................................................................................................19-130
policy action tos .................................................................................................19-132
policy action 802.1p ...........................................................................................19-134
policy action dscp ...............................................................................................19-136
policy action map ...............................................................................................19-138
policy action permanent gateway ip ...................................................................19-140
policy action port-disable ...................................................................................19-142
policy action redirect port ..................................................................................19-144
policy action redirect linkagg .............................................................................19-146
policy action no-cache ........................................................................................19-148
policy action mirror ............................................................................................19-149
policy action cir ..................................................................................................19-151
show policy classify ...........................................................................................19-153

xiv OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

show policy classify source port ........................................................................19-156


show policy classify destination port .................................................................19-158
show policy classify source mac ........................................................................19-160
show policy classify destination mac .................................................................19-162
show policy classify source vlan ........................................................................19-164
show policy classify destination vlan .................................................................19-166
show policy classify source interface type .........................................................19-168
show policy classify destination interface type ..................................................19-170
show policy classify 802.1p ...............................................................................19-172
show policy classify source ip ............................................................................19-174
show policy classify destination ip .....................................................................19-176
show policy classify multicast ip .......................................................................19-178
show policy classify tos ......................................................................................19-180
show policy classify dscp ...................................................................................19-182
show policy classify ip protocol .........................................................................19-184
show policy classify source ip port ....................................................................19-186
show policy classify destination ip port .............................................................19-188
show policy network group ................................................................................19-190
show policy service ............................................................................................19-192
show policy service group ..................................................................................19-194
show policy mac group ......................................................................................19-196
show policy port group .......................................................................................19-198
show policy vlan group ......................................................................................19-200
show policy map group ......................................................................................19-202
show policy action ..............................................................................................19-204
show policy list ...................................................................................................19-207
show policy condition ........................................................................................19-209
show active policy list ........................................................................................19-212
show active policy rule .......................................................................................19-214
show active policy rule meter-statistics .............................................................19-217
show policy rule .................................................................................................19-219
show policy validity period ................................................................................19-222

Chapter 19 Policy Server Commands ........................................................................................ 20-1


policy server load ...................................................................................................20-2
policy server flush ..................................................................................................20-3
policy server ...........................................................................................................20-4
show policy server ..................................................................................................20-6
show policy server long ..........................................................................................20-8
show policy server statistics .................................................................................20-10
show policy server rules .......................................................................................20-12
show policy server events ....................................................................................20-14

Chapter 20 802.1X Commands ................................................................................................... 21-1


802.1x .....................................................................................................................21-2
802.1x initialize ......................................................................................................21-5
802.1x re-authenticate ............................................................................................21-6
802.1x supp-polling retry .......................................................................................21-7
802.1x supplicant policy authentication .................................................................21-9
802.1x non-supplicant policy authentication .......................................................21-12
802.1x non-supplicant policy ...............................................................................21-14
802.1x policy default ............................................................................................21-16

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xv


Contents

802.1x captive-portal policy authentication .........................................................21-18


802.1x captive-portal session-limit ......................................................................21-20
802.1x captive-portal retry-count .........................................................................21-22
802.1x captive-portal address ...............................................................................21-24
802.1x captive-portal proxy-server-url ................................................................21-25
802.1x auth-server-down ......................................................................................21-26
802.1x auth-server-down policy ...........................................................................21-27
802.1x auth-server-down re-authperiod ...............................................................21-28
show 802.1x .........................................................................................................21-29
show 802.1x users ................................................................................................21-32
show 802.1x statistics ...........................................................................................21-34
show 802.1x device classification policies ..........................................................21-36
show 802.1x non-supplicant .................................................................................21-38
show 802.1x auth-server-down ............................................................................21-40
show 802.1x captive-portal configuration ............................................................21-42

Chapter 21 AAA Commands ........................................................................................................ 22-1


aaa radius-server .....................................................................................................22-3
aaa tacacs+-server ..................................................................................................22-5
aaa ldap-server ........................................................................................................22-7
aaa ace-server clear ..............................................................................................22-10
aaa authentication .................................................................................................22-11
aaa authentication default .....................................................................................22-14
aaa authentication 802.1x .....................................................................................22-16
aaa authentication mac .........................................................................................22-18
aaa accounting 802.1x ..........................................................................................22-20
aaa accounting session .........................................................................................22-22
aaa accounting command .....................................................................................22-24
user .......................................................................................................................22-26
password ...............................................................................................................22-30
user password-size min ........................................................................................22-32
user password-expiration ......................................................................................22-33
user password-policy cannot-contain-username ..................................................22-35
user password-policy min-uppercase ...................................................................22-36
user password-policy min-lowercase ...................................................................22-37
user password-policy min-digit ............................................................................22-38
user password-policy min-nonalpha .....................................................................22-39
user password-history ...........................................................................................22-40
user password-min-age .........................................................................................22-41
user lockout-window ............................................................................................22-42
user lockout-threshold ..........................................................................................22-44
user lockout-duration ............................................................................................22-46
user lockout unlock ..............................................................................................22-48
end-user profile ....................................................................................................22-49
end-user profile port-list .......................................................................................22-51
end-user profile vlan-range ..................................................................................22-53
aaa user-network-profile ......................................................................................22-55
show aaa server ....................................................................................................22-56
show aaa authentication .......................................................................................22-59
show aaa authentication 802.1x ...........................................................................22-61
show aaa authentication mac ................................................................................22-63
show aaa accounting 802.1x .................................................................................22-64

xvi OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

show aaa accounting .............................................................................................22-65


show user ..............................................................................................................22-67
show user password-size ......................................................................................22-71
show user password-expiration ............................................................................22-72
show user password-policy ..................................................................................22-73
show user lockout-setting .....................................................................................22-75
debug command-info ............................................................................................22-77
debug end-user profile ..........................................................................................22-79
show end-user profile ...........................................................................................22-81
show aaa user-network-profile .............................................................................22-83
show aaa priv hexa ...............................................................................................22-84

Chapter 22 Port Mobility Commands ........................................................................................ 23-1


vlan dhcp mac .........................................................................................................23-2
vlan dhcp mac range ...............................................................................................23-4
vlan dhcp port .........................................................................................................23-6
vlan dhcp generic ...................................................................................................23-8
vlan mac ...............................................................................................................23-10
vlan mac range .....................................................................................................23-12
vlan ip ...................................................................................................................23-14
vlan protocol .........................................................................................................23-16
vlan port ................................................................................................................23-18
vlan port mobile ...................................................................................................23-20
vlan port default vlan restore ................................................................................23-22
vlan port default vlan ............................................................................................23-24
vlan port authenticate ...........................................................................................23-26
vlan port 802.1x ....................................................................................................23-28
show vlan rules .....................................................................................................23-30
show vlan port mobile ..........................................................................................23-32

Chapter 23 Port Mapping Commands ...................................................................................... 24-1


port mapping user-port network-port .....................................................................24-2
port mapping ..........................................................................................................24-4
port mapping ..........................................................................................................24-6
show port mapping status .......................................................................................24-8
show port mapping ...............................................................................................24-10

Chapter 24 Learned Port Security Commands ....................................................................... 25-1


port-security ...........................................................................................................25-2
port-security shutdown ...........................................................................................25-4
port-security maximum ..........................................................................................25-6
port-security max-filtering .....................................................................................25-8
port-security convert-to-static ................................................................................25-9
port-security mac ..................................................................................................25-11
port-security mac-range ........................................................................................25-13
port-security violation ..........................................................................................25-15
port-security release .............................................................................................25-17
port-security learn-trap-threshold .........................................................................25-19
show port-security ................................................................................................25-20
show port-security shutdown ...............................................................................25-23

Chapter 25 Port Mirroring and

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xvii


Contents

Monitoring Commands 26-1


port mirroring source destination ...........................................................................26-2
port mirroring .........................................................................................................26-5
port monitoring source ...........................................................................................26-7
port monitoring .......................................................................................................26-9
show port mirroring status ....................................................................................26-10
show port monitoring status .................................................................................26-12
show port monitoring file .....................................................................................26-14

Chapter 26 sFlow Commands ...................................................................................................... 27-1


sflow receiver .........................................................................................................27-3
sflow sampler .........................................................................................................27-5
sflow poller .............................................................................................................27-7
show sflow agent ....................................................................................................27-9
show sflow receiver ..............................................................................................27-11
show sflow sampler ..............................................................................................27-13
show sflow poller .................................................................................................27-15

Chapter 27 RMON Commands .................................................................................................... 28-1


rmon probes ............................................................................................................28-2
show rmon probes ..................................................................................................28-4
show rmon events ...................................................................................................28-7

Chapter 28 Switch Logging Commands ................................................................................... 29-1


swlog ......................................................................................................................29-2
swlog appid level ....................................................................................................29-3
swlog output ...........................................................................................................29-6
swlog output flash file-size ....................................................................................29-8
swlog clear ..............................................................................................................29-9
show log swlog .....................................................................................................29-10
show swlog ...........................................................................................................29-13

Chapter 29 Health Monitoring Commands ............................................................................. 30-1


health threshold ......................................................................................................30-2
health interval .........................................................................................................30-4
health statistics reset ...............................................................................................30-5
show health threshold .............................................................................................30-6
show health interval ...............................................................................................30-8
show health .............................................................................................................30-9
show health all ......................................................................................................30-11
show health slice ..................................................................................................30-13
show health fabric ................................................................................................30-15

Chapter 30 CMM Commands ....................................................................................................... 31-1


reload ......................................................................................................................31-2
reload working ........................................................................................................31-4
copy running-config working .................................................................................31-6
write memory .........................................................................................................31-8
copy working certified .........................................................................................31-10
copy flash-synchro ...............................................................................................31-12
takeover ................................................................................................................31-13
show running-directory ........................................................................................31-15

xviii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

show reload ..........................................................................................................31-17


show microcode ....................................................................................................31-18
show microcode history .......................................................................................31-20

Chapter 31 Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands ........................................ 32-1


system contact ........................................................................................................32-3
system name ...........................................................................................................32-4
system location .......................................................................................................32-5
system date .............................................................................................................32-6
system time .............................................................................................................32-7
system time-and-date synchro ................................................................................32-8
system timezone .....................................................................................................32-9
system daylight savings time ................................................................................32-12
update ...................................................................................................................32-14
update lanpower ...................................................................................................32-16
reload ni ................................................................................................................32-17
reload all ...............................................................................................................32-18
reload pass-through ..............................................................................................32-20
power ni ................................................................................................................32-22
temp-threshold ......................................................................................................32-23
stack set slot .........................................................................................................32-24
stack set slot mode ................................................................................................32-26
stack clear slot ......................................................................................................32-28
......................................................................................................... show system 32-30
show hardware info ..............................................................................................32-32
show chassis .........................................................................................................32-34
show cmm ............................................................................................................32-36
show ni .................................................................................................................32-38
show module ........................................................................................................32-41
show module long ................................................................................................32-43
show module status ..............................................................................................32-45
show power ..........................................................................................................32-47
show fan ...............................................................................................................32-49
show temperature .................................................................................................32-51
show stack topology .............................................................................................32-53
show stack status ..................................................................................................32-56
show stack mode ..................................................................................................32-57

Chapter 32 Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands ............................................................... 33-1


mac-range eeprom ..................................................................................................33-2
mac-retention status ................................................................................................33-4
mac-retention dup-mac-trap ...................................................................................33-5
mac release .............................................................................................................33-6
show mac-range ......................................................................................................33-7
show mac-range alloc .............................................................................................33-9
show mac-retention status ....................................................................................33-11

Chapter 33 Network Time Protocol Commands ..................................................................... 34-1


ntp server ................................................................................................................34-2
ntp server synchronized ..........................................................................................34-4
ntp server unsynchronized ......................................................................................34-5
ntp client .................................................................................................................34-6

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xix


Contents

ntp broadcast ..........................................................................................................34-7


ntp broadcast-delay ................................................................................................34-8
ntp key ....................................................................................................................34-9
ntp key load ..........................................................................................................34-11
show ntp client .....................................................................................................34-12
show ntp client server-list ....................................................................................34-14
show ntp server status ..........................................................................................34-16
show ntp keys .......................................................................................................34-19

Chapter 34 Session Management Commands ....................................................................... 35-1


session login-attempt ..............................................................................................35-3
session login-timeout ..............................................................................................35-4
session banner ........................................................................................................35-5
session timeout .......................................................................................................35-7
session prompt ........................................................................................................35-9
session xon-xoff ...................................................................................................35-10
prompt ..................................................................................................................35-11
show prefix ...........................................................................................................35-13
alias .......................................................................................................................35-14
show alias .............................................................................................................35-16
user profile save ...................................................................................................35-17
user profile reset ...................................................................................................35-18
history size ............................................................................................................35-19
show history .........................................................................................................35-20
! .............................................................................................................................35-22
command-log ........................................................................................................35-24
kill .........................................................................................................................35-25
exit ........................................................................................................................35-26
whoami .................................................................................................................35-27
who .......................................................................................................................35-30
show session config ..............................................................................................35-32
show session xon-xoff ..........................................................................................35-34
more size ..............................................................................................................35-35
more ......................................................................................................................35-36
show more ............................................................................................................35-37
telnet .....................................................................................................................35-38
telnet6 ...................................................................................................................35-40
ssh .........................................................................................................................35-42
ssh6 .......................................................................................................................35-44
ssh enforce pubkey-auth .......................................................................................35-46
show ssh config ....................................................................................................35-47
show command-log ..............................................................................................35-49
show command-log status ....................................................................................35-51

Chapter 35 File Management Commands ............................................................................... 36-1


cd ............................................................................................................................36-3
pwd .........................................................................................................................36-5
mkdir ......................................................................................................................36-6
rmdir .......................................................................................................................36-8
ls ...........................................................................................................................36-10
dir .........................................................................................................................36-12
rename ..................................................................................................................36-14

xx OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

rm .........................................................................................................................36-16
delete ....................................................................................................................36-18
cp ..........................................................................................................................36-19
scp .........................................................................................................................36-21
mv .........................................................................................................................36-23
move .....................................................................................................................36-25
chmod ...................................................................................................................36-27
attrib .....................................................................................................................36-28
freespace ...............................................................................................................36-29
fsck .......................................................................................................................36-30
newfs ....................................................................................................................36-32
rcp .........................................................................................................................36-33
rrm ........................................................................................................................36-34
rls ..........................................................................................................................36-35
vi ...........................................................................................................................36-37
view ......................................................................................................................36-38
tty ..........................................................................................................................36-39
show tty ................................................................................................................36-41
more ......................................................................................................................36-42
ftp .........................................................................................................................36-44
ftp6 .......................................................................................................................36-46
scp-sftp .................................................................................................................36-48
show ssh config ....................................................................................................36-49
sftp ........................................................................................................................36-51
sftp6 ......................................................................................................................36-53
tftp ........................................................................................................................36-55
rz ...........................................................................................................................36-57

Chapter 36 Web Management Commands ............................................................................. 37-1


http server ...............................................................................................................37-2
http ssl ....................................................................................................................37-3
http port ..................................................................................................................37-4
https port .................................................................................................................37-5
debug http sessiondb ..............................................................................................37-6
show http ................................................................................................................37-8

Chapter 37 Configuration File Manager Commands ........................................................... 38-1


configuration apply ................................................................................................38-2
configuration error-file limit ..................................................................................38-4
show configuration status .......................................................................................38-6
configuration cancel ...............................................................................................38-8
configuration syntax check .....................................................................................38-9
configuration snapshot .........................................................................................38-11
show configuration snapshot ................................................................................38-14
write terminal .......................................................................................................38-17

Chapter 38 SNMP Commands ..................................................................................................... 39-1


snmp station ............................................................................................................39-3
show snmp station ..................................................................................................39-5
snmp community map ............................................................................................39-7
snmp community map mode ..................................................................................39-9
show snmp community map .................................................................................39-10

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xxi


Contents

snmp security ........................................................................................................39-11


show snmp security ..............................................................................................39-13
show snmp statistics .............................................................................................39-15
show snmp mib family .........................................................................................39-17
snmp trap absorption ............................................................................................39-18
snmp trap to webview ..........................................................................................39-19
snmp trap replay ...................................................................................................39-20
snmp trap filter .....................................................................................................39-22
snmp authentication trap ......................................................................................39-24
show snmp trap replay ..........................................................................................39-25
show snmp trap filter ............................................................................................39-27
show snmp authentication trap .............................................................................39-29
show snmp trap config .........................................................................................39-30

Chapter 39 DNS Commands ........................................................................................................ 40-1


ip domain-lookup ...................................................................................................40-2
ip name-server ........................................................................................................40-3
ipv6 name-server ....................................................................................................40-5
ip domain-name ......................................................................................................40-7
show dns .................................................................................................................40-8

Appendix A Software License and Copyright Statements ................................................... A-11


Alcatel-Lucent License Agreement .............................................................................. A-11
ALCATEL-LUCENT SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT .......................... A-11
Third Party Licenses and Notices ................................................................................ A-14
A. Booting and Debugging Non-Proprietary Software ........................................ A-14
B. The OpenLDAP Public License: Version 2.8, 17 August 2003 ...................... A-14
C. Linux ................................................................................................................ A-15
D. GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE: Version 2, June 1991 ........................ A-15
E. University of California ................................................................................... A-20
F. Carnegie-Mellon University ............................................................................ A-20
G. Random.c ......................................................................................................... A-20
H. Apptitude, Inc. ................................................................................................. A-21
I. Agranat ............................................................................................................. A-21
J. RSA Security Inc. ............................................................................................ A-21
K. Sun Microsystems, Inc. .................................................................................... A-22
L. Wind River Systems, Inc. ................................................................................ A-22
M. Network Time Protocol Version 4 ................................................................... A-22
N. Remote-ni ......................................................................................................... A-23
O. GNU Zip .......................................................................................................... A-23
P. FREESCALE SEMICONDUCTOR SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT .. A-
23
Q. Boost C++ Libraries ........................................................................................ A-24
R. U-Boot ............................................................................................................. A-24
S. Solaris .............................................................................................................. A-24
T. Internet Protocol Version 6 .............................................................................. A-24
U. CURSES .......................................................................................................... A-25
V. ZModem ........................................................................................................... A-25
W. Boost Software License ................................................................................... A-25
X. OpenLDAP ...................................................................................................... A-25
Y. BITMAP.C ....................................................................................................... A-26

xxii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Contents

Z. University of Toronto ...................................................................................... A-26


AA.Free/OpenBSD ............................................................................................... A-26
CLI Quick Reference

Index ...................................................................................................................... Index-1

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 xxiii


Contents

xxiv OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


About This Guide

This OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide is a comprehensive resource to all Command Line Interface
(CLI) commands available on the OmniSwitch 6450 Series.

Supported Platforms
This information in this guide applies to the following products:
• OmniSwitch 6450-Enterprise Models

Note. This OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide covers Release 6.6.2, which is supported on the
OmniSwitch 6450 Series.

Unsupported Platforms
The information in this guide does not apply to the following products:
• OmniSwitch 9000 Series

• OmniSwitch 6400 Series

• OmniSwitch 6600 Family

• OmniSwitch 6800 Family

• OmniSwitch 6850 Series

• OmniSwitch 6855 Series

• OmniSwitch (original version with no numeric model name)

• OmniSwitch 7700/7800

• OmniSwitch 8800

• Omni Switch/Router

• OmniStack

• OmniAccess

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page xxv


Who Should Read this Manual? About This Guide

Who Should Read this Manual?


The audience for this user guide is network administrators and IT support personnel who need to config-
ure, maintain, and monitor switches and routers in a live network. Anyone wishing to gain knowledge on
the details of all CLI commands available on the OmniSwitch will benefit from the material in this refer-
ence guide. However, advanced users who have already familiarized themselves with the OmniSwitch CLI
commands will benefit most from the detailed content in this guide.

When Should I Read this Manual?


Read this guide whenever you want detailed information on individual CLI commands. Although this
guide provides helpful information during any stage of the configuration process, it is a good idea to first
familiarize yourself with the software features available on the switch before investigating the detailed
command information in this guide.
Overview information, procedures, and live network examples on switch software features may be found
in the OmniSwitch 6450 Switch Management Guide and the OmniSwitch 6450 Network Configuration
Guide. Once you are familiar with the procedures and base CLI commands in these configuration guides
you can obtain more detailed information on the individual commands in this guide.

What is in this Manual?


This reference guide includes information on every CLI command available in the switch. The informa-
tion provided for each CLI command includes:
• Command description.

• Syntax.

• Description of all keywords and variables included in the syntax.

• Default values.

• Usage guidelines, which include tips on when and how to use the command.

• Examples of command lines using the command.

• Related commands with descriptions.

• Release history, which indicates the release when the command was introduced.

• SNMP information, such as the MIB files related to a set of CLI commands. In addition each CLI
command includes the corresponding MIB variables that map to all parameters included in a command.

page xxvi OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


About This Guide What is Not in this Manual?

What is Not in this Manual?


Primarily a reference, this guide does not provide step-by-step instructions on how to set up particular
features on the switch. It also does not provide overview or application examples on software features. For
comprehensive information on how to configure particular software features in the switch, consult the
appropriate configuration guide.
This guide also does not provide any information on the network management applications, WebView and
OmniVista. Further information on WebView and OmniVista can be found in the context-sensitive on-line
help available with those applications.

How is the Information Organized?


Each chapter in this guide includes reference material for all commands related to a single software
feature, such as server load balancing or link aggregation. Typically commands in a single chapter will
share a common prefix.

Text Conventions
The following table contains text conventions and usage guidelines for CLI commands as they are
documented in this guide.

bold text Indicates basic command and keyword syntax.


Example: show snmp station
italicized text Indicates user-specific information such as IP addresses, slot numbers,
passwords, names, etc.
Example: no snmp station ip_address

Italicized text that is not enclosed with straight brackets ([ ]) indicates


required information.
[ ] (Straight Brackets) Indicates optional parameters for a given command.
Example: show aaa server [server_name]
Here, you can enter either of the following options:
show aaa server
show aaa server server_name (where server_name is the user-
specified server name, e.g., show aaa server myserver1)

Note that this example includes italicized text. The optional parameter
in this case is a user-specified server name.
{ } (Curly Braces) Indicates that the user must choose between one or more parameters.
Example: port mirroring {enable | disable}
Here, you must choose one of the following:
port mirroring enable or port mirroring disable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page xxvii


Text Conventions About This Guide

| (Vertical Pipes) Used to separate parameter choices within a command string. For
example, the command string
show health threshold [rx | txrx | memory | cpu]
separates the choices rx, txrx, memory, and cpu.
Examples:
show health threshold rx
show health threshold txrx
show health threshold memory
show health threshold cpu
“ ” (Quotation Marks) Used to enclose text strings that contain spaces. The quotation marks
are required input on the command line.
Example: vlan 2 “new test vlan”

page xxviii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


About This Guide Documentation Roadmap

Documentation Roadmap
The OmniSwitch user documentation suite was designed to supply you with information at several critical
junctures of the configuration process. The following section outlines a roadmap of the manuals that will
help you at each stage of the configuration process. Under each stage, we point you to the manual or
manuals that will be most helpful to you.

Stage 1: Using the Switch for the First Time


Pertinent Documentation: Getting Started Guide
Release Notes
A hard-copy Getting Started Guide is included with your switch; this guide provides all the information
you need to get your switch up and running the first time. This guide provides information on unpacking
the switch, rack mounting the switch, installing modules, unlocking access control, setting the switch’s IP
address, and setting up a password. It also includes succinct overview information on fundamental aspects
of the switch, such as hardware LEDs, the software directory structure, CLI conventions, and web-based
management.
At this time you should also familiarize yourself with the Release Notes that accompanied your switch.
This document includes important information on feature limitations that are not included in other user
guides.

Stage 2: Gaining Familiarity with Basic Switch Functions


Pertinent Documentation: Hardware Users Guide
Switch Management Guide
Once you have your switch up and running, you will want to begin investigating basic aspects of its hard
ware and software. Information about switch hardware is provided in the platform-specific Hardware
Users Guide. This guide provide specifications, illustrations, and descriptions of all hardware compo-
nents—chassis, power supplies, Chassis Management Modules (CMMs), Network Interface (NI) modules,
uplink modules, stacking modules, and cooling fans. It also includes steps for common procedures, such
as removing and installing switch components.
The Switch Management Guide for your switch platform is the primary user guide for the basic software
features on a single switch. This guide contains information on the switch directory structure, basic file
and directory utilities, switch access security, SNMP, and web-based management. It is recommended that
you read this guide before connecting your switch to the network.

Stage 3: Integrating the Switch Into a Network


Pertinent Documentation: Network Configuration Guide
When you are ready to connect your switch to the network, you will need to learn how the OmniSwitch
implements fundamental software features, such as 802.1Q, VLANs, Spanning Tree, and network routing
protocols. The Network Configuration Guide for your switch platform contains overview information,
procedures and examples on how standard networking technologies are configured in the OmniSwitch.

Anytime
The OmniSwitch CLI Reference Guide contains comprehensive information on all CLI commands
supported by the switch. This guide includes syntax, default, usage, example, related CLI command, and
CLI-to-MIB variable mapping information for all CLI commands supported by the switch. This guide can
be consulted anytime during the configuration process to find detailed and specific information on each
CLI command.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page xxix


Related Documentation About This Guide

Related Documentation
The following are the titles and descriptions of all the related user manuals:
• OmniSwitch 6450 Series Getting Started Guide

Describes the hardware and software procedures for getting an OmniSwitch 6450 Series switch up and
running. Also provides information on fundamental aspects of OmniSwitch software and stacking
architecture.
• OmniSwitch 6450 Series Hardware Users Guide

Complete technical specifications and procedures for all OmniSwitch 6450 Series chassis, power
supplies, and fans. Also includes comprehensive information on assembling and managing stacked
configurations.
• OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide

Complete reference to all CLI commands supported on the OmniSwitch 6450. Includes syntax defini-
tions, default values, examples, usage guidelines and CLI-to-MIB variable mappings.
• OmniSwitch 6450 Switch Management Guide

Includes procedures for readying an individual switch for integration into a network. Topics include the
software directory architecture, image rollback protections, authenticated switch access, managing
switch files, system configuration, using SNMP, and using web management software (WebView).
• OmniSwitch 6450 Network Configuration Guide

Includes network configuration procedures and descriptive information on all the major software
features and protocols included in the base software package. Chapters cover Layer 2 information
(Ethernet and VLAN configuration), Layer 3 information (routing protocols, such as RIP), security
options (authenticated VLANs), Quality of Service (QoS), and link aggregation.
• OmniSwitch 6450 Transceivers Guide

Includes information on Small Form Factor Pluggable (SFPs) and 10 Gbps Small Form Factor Plugga-
bles (XFPs) transceivers.
• Technical Tips, Field Notices

Includes information published by Alcatel-Lucent’s Customer Support group.


• AOS Release 6.6.2 Release Notes

Includes critical Open Problem Reports, feature exceptions, and other important information on the
features supported in the current release and any limitations to their support.

page xxx OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


About This Guide User Manual CD

User Manual CD
Some products are shipped with documentation included on a User Manual CD that accompanies the
switch. This CD also includes documentation for other Alcatel-Lucent data enterprise products.
All products are shipped with a Product Documentation Card that provides details for downloading docu-
mentation for all OmniSwitch and other Alcatel-Lucent data enterprise products.
All documentation is in PDF format and requires the Adobe Acrobat Reader program for viewing. Acro-
bat Reader freeware is available at www.adobe.com.

Note. In order to take advantage of the documentation CD’s global search feature, it is recommended that
you select the option for searching PDF files before downloading Acrobat Reader freeware.

To verify that you are using Acrobat Reader with the global search option, look for the following button in
the toolbar:

Note. When printing pages from the documentation PDFs, de-select Fit to Page if it is selected in your
print dialog. Otherwise pages may print with slightly smaller margins.

Technical Support
An Alcatel-Lucent service agreement brings your company the assurance of 7x24 no-excuses technical
support. You’ll also receive regular software updates to maintain and maximize your Alcatel-Lucent
product’s features and functionality and on-site hardware replacement through our global network of
highly qualified service delivery partners. Additionally, with 24-hour-a-day access to Alcatel-Lucent’s
Service and Support web page, you’ll be able to view and update any case (open or closed) that you have
reported to Alcatel-Lucent’s technical support, open a new case or access helpful release notes, technical
bulletins, and manuals. For more information on Alcatel-Lucent’s Service Programs, see our web page at
service.esd.alcatel-lucent.com, call us at 1-800-995-2696, or email us at [email protected].

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page xxxi


Technical Support About This Guide

page xxxii OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


1 Ethernet Port Commands

The Ethernet port software is responsible for configuring and monitoring Ethernet ports. This includes:
• Performing hardware diagnostics, loading software, and initializing hardware.

• Notifying other software modules in the system when Ethernet links become active or inactive.

• Configuring basic line parameters for Ethernet ports.

• Gathering basic line statistics for Ethernet ports and passing this information to the user interface and
configuration manager.
MIB information for the Ethernet Port commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Port.mib
Module: alcatelIND1PortMIB
Filename: IETF_ETHERLIKE.mib
Module: EtherLike-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-1


Ethernet Port Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here.

Trap port commands trap port link


Interfaces commands interfaces speed
interfaces autoneg
interfaces crossover
interfaces pause
interfaces duplex
interfaces admin
interfaces alias
interfaces ifg
interfaces no l2 statistics
interfaces max frame
interfaces flood multicast
interfaces flood rate
interfaces clear-violation-all
show interfaces
show interfaces capability
show interfaces flow control
show interfaces pause
show interfaces accounting
show interfaces counters
show interfaces counters errors
show interfaces collisions
show interfaces status
show interfaces port
show interfaces ifg
show interfaces flood rate
show interfaces traffic
Combo port commands interfaces clear-violation-all
interfaces hybrid autoneg
interfaces hybrid crossover
interfaces hybrid duplex
interfaces hybrid speed
interfaces hybrid pause
show interfaces hybrid
show interfaces hybrid status
show interfaces hybrid flow control
show interfaces hybrid pause
show interfaces hybrid capability
show interfaces hybrid accounting
show interfaces hybrid counters
show interfaces hybrid counters errors
show interfaces hybrid collisions
show interfaces hybrid traffic
show interfaces hybrid port
show interfaces hybrid flood rate

page 1-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

trap port link


Enables trap link messages. If enabled, a message is displayed on the Network Management Station
(NMS) whenever the port changes state.
trap slot[/port[-port2]] port link {enable | disable | on | off}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
enable Port link up/down traps are displayed on the NMS.
disable Port link up/down traps are not displayed on the NMS.
on Same as enable.
off Same as disable.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable | on | off disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> trap 3/1 port link enable
-> trap 3 port link enable
-> trap 3/1-6 port link enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-3


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

show interfaces status Displays interface line settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfigTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF

page 1-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces speed
Configures interface line speed.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] speed {auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | 10000 | max {100 | 1000}}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
auto The switch will automatically set the line speed to match the attached
device (auto-sensing).
10 Sets the interface to 10 Mbps.
100 Sets the interface to 100 Mbps.
1000 Sets the interface to 1 Gigabit.
10000 Sets the interface to 10 Gigabit.
max 100 Sets the maximum speed to 100 megabits.
max 1000 Sets the maximum speed to 1000 megabits (1 Gigabit).

Defaults

parameter default
auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | Auto (copper ports);
10000 | max 100 | max 1000 (fiber ports);
1000}

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• The auto option sets the speed to auto-sensing.

• Configuration changes made with the interfaces speed command on combo ports configured as either
forced fiber or preferred fiber will only be made on the SFP fiber ports and not to the copper RJ-45
ports. See the interfaces hybrid speed command for more information.
• Configuration changes made with the interfaces speed command on combo ports configured as either
forced copper or preferred copper will only be made on the copper RJ-45 ports and not to the SFP fiber
port. See the interfaces hybrid speed command for more information.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-5


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 speed auto
-> interfaces 3 speed 100
-> interfaces 3/1-8 speed auto

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces duplex Configures duplex mode.


interfaces autoneg Enables and disables auto negotiation.
show interfaces status Displays interface line settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSpeed

page 1-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces autoneg
Enables or disables auto negotiation on a single port, a range of ports, or an entire Network Interface (NI).
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]]
autoneg {enable | disable | on | off}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
enable Enables auto negotiation.
disable Disables auto negotiation.
on Same as enable.
off Same as disable.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable | on | off enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• If auto negotiation is disabled, auto MDIX, auto speed, and auto duplex are not accepted. See the
interfaces crossover command on page 1-9 for more information.
• Configuration changes made with the interfaces autoneg command on combo ports configured as
either forced fiber or preferred fiber will only be made on the SFP fiber ports and not to the copper RJ-
45 ports. See the interfaces hybrid autoneg command for more information.
• Configuration changes made with the interfaces autoneg command on combo ports configured as
either forced copper or preferred copper will only be made on the copper RJ-45 ports and not to the
SFP fiber port. See the interfaces hybrid autoneg command for more information.
• Disabling auto negotiation is not supported on copper Gigabit ports.

Examples
-> interfaces 3 autoneg disable
-> interfaces 3/1 autoneg disable
-> interfaces 3/1-4 autoneg disable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-7


Ethernet Port Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces speed Configures interface speed.


interfaces crossover Configures crossover port settings.
show interfaces status Displays interface line settings.
show interfaces capability Displays auto negotiation, speed, duplex, and crossover settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgAutoNegotiation

page 1-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces crossover
Configures port crossover settings on a single port, a range of ports, or an entire Network Interface (NI).
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] crossover {auto | mdix | mdi}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
auto The interface will automatically detect crossover settings.
mdix Sets the crossover configuration to Media Dependent Interface with
Crossover (MDIX), which is the standard for hubs and switches.
mdi Sets the crossover configuration to Media Dependent Interface (MDI),
which is the standard for end stations.

Defaults

parameter default
auto | mdix | mdi auto
(all copper ports)

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• If auto negotiation is disabled, then automatic crossover will also be disabled. See the interfaces
autoneg command on page 1-7 for more information.
• You cannot configure crossover settings on fiber ports. These ports use the MDI standard.

• Configuration changes made with the interfaces crossover command on combo ports configured as
either forced copper or preferred copper will only be made on the copper RJ-45 ports and not to the
SFP fiber port. See the interfaces hybrid crossover command for more information.

Examples
-> interfaces 3 crossover mdi
-> interfaces 3/1 crossover mdix
-> interfaces 3/1-4 crossover auto

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-9


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces speed Configures interface speed.


interfaces autoneg Enables and disables auto negotiation.
show interfaces status Displays interface line settings.
show interfaces capability Displays auto negotiation, speed, duplex, and crossover settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgCrossover

page 1-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces pause
Configures whether or not the switch will honor or transmit and honor flow control PAUSE frames on the
specified interface. PAUSE frames are used to temporarily pause the flow of traffic between two
connected devices to help prevent packet loss when traffic congestion occurs between switches.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] pause {rx | tx-and-rx | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
rx Allows interface to honor PAUSE frames from peer switches and
temporarily stop sending traffic to the peer. Does not transmit PAUSE
frames to peer switches.
tx-and-rx Transmits and honors PAUSE frames when traffic congestion occurs
between peer switches.
disable Disables flow control on the interface.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Defaults
By default, flow control is disabled on all switch interfaces.

Usage Guidelines
• Flow control is only supported on a standalone switch. It is not supported in a stackable configuration.

• Flow control is only supported on interfaces configured to run in full-duplex mode; half-duplex mode
is not supported.
• If both autonegotiation and flow control are enabled on the same local interface, autonegotiation calcu-
lates operational flow control settings for that interface. Note that the operational settings, as shown in
the following table, override the configured settings as long as autonegotiation and flow control are
both enabled for the interface:

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-11


Ethernet Port Commands

Configured Configured Configured Configured Operational Operational


Local Tx Local Rx Remote Tx Remote Rx Local Tx Local Rx
No No No No No No
Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Yes No Yes No No No
No Yes No Yes Yes Yes
No No No Yes No No
Yes Yes No No No No
Yes No Yes Yes No No
No Yes Yes No No Yes
No No Yes No No No
Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes
Yes No No No No No
No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
No No Yes Yes No No
Yes Yes Yes No No No
Yes No No Yes Yes No
No Yes No No No No

• If autonegotiation is disabled, the configured flow control settings are applied to the local interface.

Examples
-> interfaces 1 tx-and-rx
-> interfaces 3/1-6 pause rx
-> interfaces 3/1-6 disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid pause Configures flow control settings for combo ports.
show interfaces pause Displays interface flow control settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfigTable
esmPortCfgFlow
dot3PauseTable
dot3PauseAdminMode

page 1-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces duplex
Configures duplex mode. In full duplex mode, the interface transmits and receives data simultaneously. In
half duplex mode, the interface can transmit or receive data at a given time. Auto duplex setting causes the
switch to advertise all available duplex modes (half/full/both) for the port during autonegotiation.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] duplex {full | half | auto}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
full Sets interface to full duplex mode.
half Sets interface to half duplex mode.
auto Switch will automatically set both the duplex mode settings to auto-
negotiation.

Defaults

parameter default
full | half | auto full

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• Half duplex mode is not supported on Gigabit modules if a port is detected as Gigabit (1000 Mbps).

• Configuration changes made with the interfaces duplex command on combo ports configured as either
forced copper or preferred copper will only be made on the copper RJ-45 ports and not to the SFP fiber
port. See the interfaces hybrid duplex command for more information.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-13


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 duplex auto
-> interfaces 3 duplex half
-> interfaces 3/1-4 auto

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces speed Configures interface line speed. Set to auto to set speed and duplex
mode to auto-sensing.
show interfaces status Displays interface line settings (e.g., speed, and mode).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortAutoDuplexMode

page 1-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces admin
Administratively enables or disables interfaces.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] admin {up | down}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
up Enables the interface.
down Disables the interface.

Defaults

parameter default
up | down up

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 admin up
-> interfaces 3 admin down
-> interfaces 3/1-4 admin up

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC


address, input errors, and output errors).
show interfaces port Displays port status (up or down).

MIB Objects
ifTable
ifAdminStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-15


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces alias
Configures a description (alias) for a single port.
interfaces slot/port alias description

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
description A description for the port, which can be up to 40 characters long. Spaces
must be contained within quotes (e.g., “IP Phone”).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one port at time. You cannot configure an alias for multiple ports.

• To remove an alias use a description consisting of two quotes without any spaces (e.g., "").

• On combo ports the configuration changes made with the interfaces alias command apply to both the
fiber SFP port and to the copper RJ-45 port. You cannot configure separate aliases.

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 alias switch_port
-> interfaces 2/2 alias "IP Phone"
-> interfaces 3/1 alias ""

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC


address, input errors, and output errors).
show interfaces port Displays port status (up or down) and any aliases for a port.

MIB Objects
ifXTable
ifAlias

page 1-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces ifg
Configures the inter-frame gap on Gigabit Ethernet interfaces.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] ifg bytes

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
bytes Inter-frame gap value, in bytes. Valid range is 9–12.

Defaults

parameter default
bytes 12

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 ifg 10
-> interfaces 3 ifg 10
-> interfaces 3/1-4 ifg 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces ifg Displays the inter-frame gap value for one or more ports.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgIfg

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-17


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces no l2 statistics
Resets all statistics counters.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] no l2 statistics

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• This command calls for an upper or lower case “L” character in front of the “2” character. Entering the
digit “1” (one) will result in an error message.

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 no l2 statistics
-> interfaces 3 no l2 statistics
-> interfaces 3/1-6 no l2 statistics

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 1-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information, including when statistics


were last cleared.
show interfaces accounting Displays interface accounting information (e.g., packets received/
transmitted and deferred frames received).
show interfaces counters Displays interface counters information (e.g., unicast, broadcast,
and multi-cast packets received/transmitted).
show interfaces counters errors Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit
errors, and receive errors).
show interfaces collisions Displays interface collision information (e.g., number of collisions
and number of retries).

MIB Objects
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherClearStats

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-19


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces max frame


Configures the maximum frame size for Gigabit Ethernet interfaces.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] max frame bytes

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
max frame Maximum frame size, in bytes. Valid range is 1518–9216.

Defaults

parameter default
bytes (Gigabit Ethernet Packets) 9216
bytes (Ethernet Packets) 1553

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 max frame 1518
-> interfaces 3 max frame 1518
-> interfaces 3/1-3 max frame 1518

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC


address, input errors, and output errors).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgMaxFrameSize

page 1-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces flood multicast


Enables flood rate limiting for multicast traffic on the specified interface.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] flood multicast {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot you want to configure (e.g., 3).
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
enable Enables multicast rate limiting.
disable Disables multicast rate limiting.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• When the interfaces flood multicast command is used to enable rate limiting, the peak flood rate
value configured for an interface is also applied to multicast traffic.
• Applying the peak flood rate value to multicast traffic also limits IP Multicast Switching (IPMS) and
non-IPMS multicast traffic.
• The peak flood rate value is configurable through the interfaces flood rate command. The interfaces
flood multicast command is not used to configure this value.
• When multicast rate limiting is disabled, the peak flood rate value for the interface is no longer applied
to multicast traffic. This does not prevent the normal flow of multicast traffic on the specified interface.

Examples
-> interfaces 3 flood multicast
-> interfaces 1/24 flood multicast
-> interfaces 1/23-24 flood multicast

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-21


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

show interfaces flood rate Displays interface peak flood rate settings.
interfaces flood rate Configures the peak flood rate for an interface.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortFloodMcastEnable

page 1-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces flood rate


Configures the peak flood rate value for the specified interface.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] flood rate Mbps

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
Mbps Peak flood rate, in megabits per second (Mbps). Valid ranges:

0–10 for 10 Mbps


0–100 for 100 Mbps
0–1000 for Gigabit Ethernet

Defaults

parameter default
Mbps (10 Ethernet) 4
Mbps (100 Fast Ethernet) 49
Mbps (Gigabit Ethernet) 496

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Although you can configure a flood rate equal to the line speed you should not do so. Alcatel-Lucent
recommends that you always configure the flood rate to be less than the line speed.
• You can only configure one slot at a time. Repeat the command to configure additional slots.

• The interfaces flood rate command configures a maximum ingress flood rate value for an interface.
This peak flood rate value is applied to flooded (unknown destination address, broadcast) and multi-
cast traffic combined. For example, if an interface is configured with a peak flood rate of 50 Mbps, the
50 Mbps limit is shared by all traffic types.
• To specify the type of traffic eligible for rate limiting on an interface, use the interfaces flood rate and
interfaces flood multicast commands. By default, rate limiting applies only to flooded traffic.
• The flood rate can only be accurately configured for 512-byte packets. The flood rate cannot be accu-
rately set for smaller or larger sized packets. The accuracy/resolution is limited because the switch
makes an internal assumption of packet size when it converts bits/seconds to packets/seconds for the
hardware.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-23


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> interfaces 3/1 flood rate 400
-> interfaces 3 flood rate 400
-> interfaces 3/1-4 flood rate 400

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces flood rate Displays interface peak flood rate settings.
interfaces flood multicast Enables/disables flood rate limiting for multicast traffic on an
interface.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortMaxFloodRate

page 1-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces clear-violation-all
Clears all port violations set by various applications on the switch for the given port.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] clear-violation-all

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
All application violations associated with a specific port are cleared when this command is used.

Examples
-> interfaces 1/3 clear-violations-all
-> interfaces 1 clear-violations-all
-> interfaces 1/3-7 clear-violations-all

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces port Displays interface port status.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortViolationClearAll

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-25


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces hybrid autoneg


Enables or disables auto negotiation on a single combo port, a range of combo ports, or all combo ports on
a switch.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid {fiber | copper} autoneg {enable | disable | on | off}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
fiber Specifies that configuration changes will be made to the SFP port(s).
copper Specifies that changes will be made to the copper RJ-45 port(s).
enable Enables auto negotiation.
disable Disables auto negotiation.
on Same as enable.
off Same as disable.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable | on | off enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The MIB table and MIB object listed in the “MIB Objects” section below apply to the inactive configured
media only. See the “MIB Objects” section in the interfaces autoneg section for the MIB table and MIB
object for the active configured media.

Examples
-> interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper autoneg disable
-> interfaces 1/25-26 hybrid copper autoneg disable
-> interfaces 1 hybrid copper autoneg disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 1-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid speed Configures interface speed for combo ports.


interfaces hybrid crossover Configures crossover port settings for combo ports.
interfaces hybrid speed Enables or disables flow (pause).
show interfaces hybrid status Displays interface line settings for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid Displays auto negotiation, speed, duplex, and crossover settings for
capability combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgAutoNegotiation

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-27


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces hybrid crossover


Configures port crossover settings on a single port, a range of ports, or an entire Network Interface (NI).
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid copper crossover {auto | mdix | mdi}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
copper Specifies that changes will be made to the copper RJ-45 port(s).
auto The interface will automatically detect crossover settings.
mdix Sets the crossover configuration to Media Dependent Interface with
Crossover (MDIX), which is the standard for hubs and switches.
mdi Sets the crossover configuration to Media Dependent Interface (MDI),
which is the standard for end stations.

Defaults

parameter default
auto | mdix | mdi auto

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You cannot configure crossover settings on fiber ports. These ports use the MDI standard.

• The MIB table and MIB object listed in the “MIB Objects” section below apply to the inactive config-
ured media only. See the “MIB Objects” section in the interfaces crossover section for the MIB table
and MIB object for the active configured media.

Examples
-> interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper crossover disable
-> interfaces 1/25-26 hybrid copper crossover mdix
-> interfaces hybrid copper crossover auto

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 1-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid speed Configures interface speed for combo ports.


interfaces hybrid autoneg Enables and disables auto negotiation for combo ports.
interfaces hybrid speed Enables or disables flow (pause) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid status Displays interface line settings for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid Displays auto negotiation, speed, duplex, and crossover settings for
capability combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgCrossover

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-29


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces hybrid duplex


Configures duplex mode on combo ports. In full duplex mode, the interface transmits and receives data
simultaneously. In half duplex mode, the interface can transmit or receive data at a given time. Auto
duplex setting causes the switch to advertise all available duplex modes (half/full/both) for the port during
autonegotiation.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid {fiber | copper} duplex {full | half | auto}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
fiber Specifies that configuration changes will be made to the SFP port(s).
copper Specifies that changes will be made to the copper RJ-45 port(s).
full Sets interface to full duplex mode.
half Sets interface to half duplex mode.
auto Switch will automatically set both the duplex mode settings to auto-
negotiation.

Defaults

parameter default
full | half | auto auto

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The MIB table and MIB object listed in the “MIB Objects” section below apply to the inactive configured
media only. See the “MIB Objects” section in the interfaces duplex section for the MIB table and MIB
object for the active configured media.

Examples
-> interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper duplex auto
-> interfaces 1/25-26 hybrid copper duplex half
-> interfaces 1 hybrid copper fiber full

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 1-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid speed Configures interface line speed for combo ports. Set to auto to set
speed and duplex mode to auto-sensing.
show interfaces hybrid status Displays interface line settings (e.g., speed, mode) for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgDuplexMode

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-31


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces hybrid speed


Configures interface line speed on combo ports.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] speed hybrid {fiber | copper} {auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | 10000 | max {100 |
1000}}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
fiber Specifies that configuration changes will be made to the SFP port(s).
copper Specifies that changes will be made to the copper RJ-45 port(s).
auto The switch will automatically set the line speed to match the attached
device (auto-sensing).
10 Sets the interface to 10 Mbps.
100 Sets the interface to 100 Mbps.
1000 Sets the interface to 1 Gigabit.
10000 Sets the interface to 10 Gigabit. This option is currently not supported.
max 100 Sets the maximum speed to 100 megabits.
max 1000 Sets the maximum speed to 1000 megabits (1 Gigabit)

Defaults

parameter default
auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | auto
10000 | max 100 | max
1000

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The MIB table and MIB object listed in the “MIB Objects” section below apply to the inactive configured
media only. See the “MIB Objects” section in the interfaces speed section for the MIB table and MIB
object for the active configured media.

page 1-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper speed auto
-> interfaces 1/25-26 hybrid copper speed 100
-> interfaces 1/25 hybrid fiber speed 1000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid duplex Configures duplex mode for combo ports.


interfaces hybrid autoneg Enables and disables auto negotiation for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid status Displays interface line settings for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgSpeed

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-33


Ethernet Port Commands

interfaces hybrid pause


Configures whether or not the switch will honor or transmit and honor flow control PAUSE frames on the
specified combo port. PAUSE frames are used to temporarily pause the flow of traffic between two
connected devices to help prevent packet loss when traffic congestion occurs between switches.
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid {fiber | copper} pause {rx | tx-and-rx | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
fiber Specifies that configuration changes will be made to the SFP port(s).
copper Specifies that changes will be made to the copper RJ-45 port(s).
rx Allows interface to honor PAUSE frames from peer switches and
temporarily stop sending traffic to the peer. Does not transmit PAUSE
frames to peer switches.
tx-and-rx Transmits and honors PAUSE frames when traffic congestion occurs
between peer switches.
disable Disables flow control on the interface.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Defaults
By default, flow control is disabled on all combo ports.

Usage Guidelines
• Flow control is only supported on interfaces configured to run in full-duplex mode; half-duplex mode
is not supported.

page 1-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

• If both autonegotiation and flow control are enabled on the same local interface, autonegotiation calcu-
lates operational flow control settings for that interface. Note that the operational settings, as shown in
the following table, override the configured settings as long as autonegotiation and flow control are
both enabled for the interface.

Configured Configured Configured Configured Negotiated Negotiated


Local Tx Local Rx Remote Tx Remote Rx Local Tx Local Rx
No No No No No No
Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Yes No Yes No No No
No Yes No Yes Yes Yes
No No No Yes No No
Yes Yes No No No No
Yes No Yes Yes No No
No Yes Yes No No Yes
No No Yes No No No
Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes
Yes No No No No No
No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
No No Yes Yes No No
Yes Yes Yes No No No
Yes No No Yes Yes No
No Yes No No No No

• If autonegotiation is disabled, the configured flow control setting is applied to the local interface.

Examples
-> interfaces 1 hybrid fiber tx-and-rx
-> interfaces 3/21-24 hybrid copper pause rx
-> interfaces 3/21-24 hybrid copper disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-35


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces pause Configures flow control settings for switch interfaces.


show interfaces hybrid pause Displays flow control settings for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmHybridConfigTable
esmHybridPortCfgFlow
dot3PauseTable
dot3PauseAdminMode

page 1-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces
Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC address, input errors, and output errors).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]]

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, information for all slots/ports on the switch is displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-37


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/2
Slot/Port 1/2 :
Operational Status : up,
Last Time Link Changed : FRI DEC 27 15:10:40 ,
Number of Status Change: 1,
Type : Ethernet,
SFP/XFP : Not Present,
MAC address : 00:d0:95:b2:39:85,
BandWidth (Megabits) : 1000, Duplex : Full,
Autonegotiation : 1 [ 1000-F 100-F 100-H 10-F 10-H ],
Long Frame Size(Bytes) : 9216, Runt Size(Bytes) : 64,
Rx :
Bytes Received : 7967624, Unicast Frames : 0,
Broadcast Frames: 124186, M-cast Frames : 290,
UnderSize Frames: 0, OverSize Frames: 0,
Lost Frames : 0, Error Frames : 0,
CRC Error Frames: 0, Alignments Err : 0,
Tx :
Bytes Xmitted : 255804426, Unicast Frames : 24992,
Broadcast Frames: 3178399, M-cast Frames : 465789,
UnderSize Frames: 0, OverSize Frames: 0,
Lost Frames : 0, Collided Frames: 0,
Error Frames : 0

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port.
Operational Status Interface status (up/down).
Type Interface type (Ethernet/Fast Ethernet/Gigabit Ethernet).
MAC address Interface MAC address.
Bandwidth Bandwidth (in megabits).
Duplex Duplex mode (Half/Full/Auto).
Autonegotiation The auto negotiation settings for this interface.
Long Accept Long Frames status (enable/disable).
Runt Accept Runt Frames status (enable/disable).
Long Frame Size Long Frame Size (in Bytes).
Runt Size Runt Frame Size (in Bytes).
Bytes Received Number of Bytes received.
Rx Unicast Frames Number of unicast frames received.
Rx Broadcast Frames Number of broadcast frames received.
Rx M-cast Frames Number of multicast frames received.
Rx Undersize Frames Number of undersized frames received.
Rx Oversize Frames Number of oversized frames received.
Rx Lost Frames Number of Lost Frames received.
Rx Error Frames Number of error frames received.
Rx CRC Error Frames Number of CRC error frames received.

page 1-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Rx Alignments Err Number of Alignments Error frames received.
Bytes Xmitted Number of Bytes transmitted.
Tx Unicast Frames Number of unicast frames transmitted.
Tx Broadcast Frames Number of broadcast frames transmitted.
Tx M-cast Frames Number of multicast frames r transmitted.
Tx Undersize Frames Number of undersized frames transmitted.
Tx Oversize Frames Number of oversized frames transmitted.
Tx Lost Frames Number of Lost Frames transmitted.
Tx Collided Frames Number of collision frames received or transmitted.
Tx Error Frames Number of error frames transmitted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces accounting Displays interface accounting information (e.g., packets received/
transmitted).
show interfaces counters Displays interface counter information (e.g., unicast packets
received/transmitted).
show interfaces counters errors Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit
errors, and receive errors).
show interfaces collisions Displays interface collision information (e.g., number of collisions
and number of retries).
show interfaces status Displays the interface line settings (e.g., speed and mode).
show interfaces traffic Displays interface traffic statistics (input/output bytes and packets).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-39


Ethernet Port Commands

MIB Objects
ifTable
ifOperStatus
ifType
ifPhysAddress
ifSpeed
ifInDiscards
IfOutDiscards
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortCfgLongEnable
esmPortCfgRuntEnable
esmPortCfgMaxFrameSize
esmPortCfgRuntSize
ifXTable
ifHCInOctets
ifHCInUcastPkts
ifHCInBroadcastPkts
ifHCInMulticastPkts
IfHCOutOctets
IfHCOutUcastPkts
IfHCOutBroadcastPkts
IfHCOutMulticastPkts
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatsRxUndersizePkts
alcetherStatsCRCAlignErrors
alcetherStatsTxUndersizePkts
alcetherStatsTxOversizePkts
alcetherStatsTxCollisions
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsFrameTooLong
dot3StatsFCSErrors
dot3StatsLateCollisions

page 1-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces capability


Displays default auto negotiation, speed, duplex, flow, and cross-over settings for a single port, a range of
ports, or all ports on a Network Interface (NI) module.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] capability

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The show interfaces capability command displays defaults settings in two rows of data for each port.
The first row of data, identified by the label CAP, displays the valid user-defined configuration
settings available for the port. The second row, identified by the label DEF, displays the default
settings for the port.

Examples
-> show interfaces 5/1 capability
Slot/Port AutoNeg Flow Crossover Speed Duplex
-----------+---------+--------+-----------+----------+----------
5/1 CAP EN/DIS EN/DIS MDI/X/Auto 10/100/1G Full/Half
5/1 DEF EN EN Auto Auto Auto

output definitions
Slot The slot number.
Port The port number
AutoNeg In the row labeled CAP, the field displays the valid auto negotiation
configurations for the port. In the row label DEF, the field displays the
default auto negotiation settings for the port. The possible values are
EN (enabled) or DIS (disabled).
Flow In the row labeled CAP, the field displays the valid flow configurations
for the port. In the row label DEF, the field displays the default flow
settings for the port. The possible values are EN (enabled) or DIS (dis-
abled).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-41


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Crossover In the row labeled CAP, the field displays the valid cross over configu-
rations for the port. In the row label DEF, the field displays the default
cross over settings for the port. The possible values are Auto,
MDI/X/Auto (MDI/MDIX/Auto), or -- (not configurable and/or not
applicable).
Speed In the row labeled CAP, the field displays the valid line speed configu-
rations for the port. In the row label DEF, the field displays the default
line speed settings for the port. The possible values are 10/100, 100,
1G, 10/100/1G, 10G, or Auto.
Duplex In the row labeled CAP, the field displays the valid duplex configura-
tions for the port. In the row label DEF, the field displays the default
duplex settings for the port. The possible values are Full, Full/Half, or
Auto.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces autoneg Enables and disables auto negotiation.


interfaces crossover Configures crossover port settings.
interfaces speed Configures interface speed.
interfaces duplex Configures duplex settings.
show interfaces status Displays interface line settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgAutoNegotiation
esmPortCfgFlow
esmPortCfgCrossover
esmPortCfgSpeed
esmPortAutoDuplexMode

page 1-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces flow control


Displays interface flow control wait time settings.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] flow [control]

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
control Optional command syntax. It displays the same information as show
interfaces flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, flow control wait time settings for all slots/ports on the switch are
displayed.
• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number, a range of ports by entering a
slot and a range of ports, display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number, or display all inter-
faces as described above.

Examples
-> show interfaces 3/20-24 flow
Slot/Port Active Wait time(usec) Cfg-Flow Cfg-Cross
-----------+--------+----------------+--------+-----------
3/20 - 0 Pause MDIX
3/21 - 0 Pause MDIX
3/22 - 0 Pause MDIX
3/23 - 0 Go MDIX
3/24 - 0 Go MDIX

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number
Active Interface status.
Wait time Flow control wait time, in microseconds.
Cfg-Flow Flow control status (Pause or Go).
Cfg-Cross The user-configured cross-over setting (Auto, MDI, or MDIX).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-43


Ethernet Port Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced..

Related Commands

interfaces crossover Configures crossover settings.


show interfaces hybrid flow control Displays interface flow control wait time settings for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortPauseSlotTime
esmPortCfgCrossover
dot3PauseTable
dot3PauseSlotTime

page 1-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces pause


Displays the flow control pause configuration for the specified interface(s).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] pause

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the flow control pause configura-
tion for all switch interfaces is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number (e.g., 3/21) or a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/21-24) to display informa-
tion for a specific port or a range of ports.
• Enter a slot number (e.g., 1) to display information for all ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces pause
Slot/Port Active Wait time(usec) Cfg-Pause Cfg-Cross Hybrid Type
-----------+--------+---------------+--------+-----------+-----------
1/1 - 0 DIS MDIX -
1/2 - 0 DIS MDIX -
1/3 - 0 DIS MDIX -
1/4 - 0 DIS MDIX -
1/5 - 0 DIS MDIX -
1/6 - 0 DIS MDIX -
1/7 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/8 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/9 - 65535 DIS Auto NA
1/10 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/11 - 65535 DIS Auto NA
1/12 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/13 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/14 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/15 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/16 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/17 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/18 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/19 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/20 - 0 DIS Auto -

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-45


Ethernet Port Commands

1/21 - 0 DIS MDI -


1/21 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/22 - 0 DIS MDI -
1/22 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/23 - 0 DIS MDI -
1/23 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/24 - 0 Tx MDI -
1/24 Active 65535 Tx-N-Rx Auto C

-> show interfaces 1/24 pause


Slot/Port Active Wait time(usec) Cfg-Pause Cfg-Cross Hybrid Type
-----------+--------+---------------+--------+-----------+-----------
1/24 - 0 Tx MDI -
1/24 Active 65535 Tx-N-Rx Auto C

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number
Active Interface status.
Wait time The amount of time, in microseconds, the neighbor interface will wait
after receiving a PAUSE frame from the local interface.
Cfg-Pause The flow control setting (Tx = transmit, Rx = receive, Tx-N-Rx =
transmit and receive). Configured through the interfaces pause com-
mand.
Cfg-Cross The user-configured cross-over setting (Auto, MDI, or MDIX). Con-
figured through the interfaces crossover command.
Hybrid Type The configured active media type for a hybrid port (F = fiber, C = cop-
per, NA = not applicable).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid pause Displays flow control pause settings for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortPauseSlotTime
esmPortCfgCrossover
esmPortActiveHybridType
dot3PauseTable
dot3PauseSlotTime

page 1-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces accounting


Displays interface accounting information (e.g., packets received/transmitted and deferred frames
received).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] accounting

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, accounting information for all slots/ports on the switch is
displayed.
• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

• For combo ports configured as either forced fiber or preferred fiber the accounting information for the
SFP fiber ports and not the copper RJ-45 ports will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid
accounting command for more information.
• For combo ports configured as either forced copper or preferred copper the accounting information for
the copper RJ-45 ports and not the SFP fiber port will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid
accounting command for more information.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-47


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/2 accounting
1/2 ,
Rx undersize packets = 0,
Tx undersize packets = 0,
Rx oversize packets = 0,
Tx oversize packets = 0,
Rx packets 64 Octets = 3073753,
Rx packets 65To127 Octets = 678698,
Rx packets 128To255 Octets = 21616,
Rx packets 256To511 Octets = 21062,
Rx packets 512To1023 Octets = 2,
Rx packets 1024To1518 Octets = 84,
Rx packets 1519to4095 Octets = 0,
Rx packets 4096ToMax Octets = 0,
Rx Jabber frames = 0

output definitions
Rx undersize packets Number of undersized packets received.
Tx undersize packets Number of undersized packets transmitted.
Rx oversize packets Number of oversized packets received.
Tx oversize packets Number of oversized packets transmitted.
Rx packets Octets Number of packets received in each listed octet range.
Rx Jabber frames Number of jabber packets received (longer than 1518 octets).
Tx deferred frames Number of packets for which transmission was delayed (Ethernet
only).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC


address, and input/output errors).
show interfaces counters Displays interface counter information (e.g., unicast packets
received/transmitted).

page 1-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsFrameTooLong
dot3StatsDeferredTransmissions
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatRxsUndersizePkts
alcetherStatTxsUndersizePkts
alcetherStatsTxOversizePkts
alcetherStatsPkts64Octets
alcetherStatsPkts65to127Octets
alcetherStatsPkts128to255Octets
alcetherStatsPkts256to511Octets
alcetherStatsPkts512to1023Octets
alcetherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets
gigaEtherStatsPkts1519to4095Octets
gigaEtherStatsPkts4096to9215Octets
alcetherStatsRxJabber

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-49


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces counters


Displays interface counters information (e.g., unicast, broadcast, and multi-cast packets received/transmit-
ted).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] counters

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, counter information for all slots/ports on the switch is displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

• These counters do not apply to Gigabit Ethernet traffic.

• For combo ports configured as either forced fiber or preferred fiber statistics for the SFP fiber ports and
not the copper RJ-45 ports will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid counters command for
more information.
• For combo ports configured as either forced copper or preferred copper statistics for the copper RJ-45
ports and not the SFP fiber port will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid counters command
for more information.

page 1-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> show interfaces 3/1 counters

InOctets = 54367578586897979, OutOctets = 5.78E19,


InUcastPkts = 55654265276, OutUcastPkts = 5.78E20,
InMcastPkts = 58767867868768777, OutMcastPkts = 5465758756856,
InBcastPkts = 576567567567567576, OutBcastPkts = 786876,
InPauseFrames = 567798768768767, OutPauseFrames= 786876,

output definitions
InOctets Number of octets received.
OutOctets Number of octets transmitted.
InUcastPkts Number of unicast packets received.
OutUcastPkts Number of unicast packets transmitted.
InMcastPkts Number of multicast packets received.
OutMcastPkts Number of unicast packets transmitted.
InBcastPkts Number of broadcast packets received.
OutBcastPkts Number of unicast packets transmitted.
InPauseFrames Number of MAC control frames received.
OutPauseFrames Number of MAC control frames transmitted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces counters errors Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit
errors, and receive errors).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
ifXTable
IfHCInOctets
IfHCOutOctets
IfHCInUcastPkts
IfHCOutUcastPkts
IfHCInMulticastPkts
IfHCOutMulticastPkts
IfHCInBroadcastPkts
IfHCOutBroadcastPkts
dot3PauseTable
dot3InPauseFrame
dot3OutPauseFrame

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-51


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces counters errors


Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit errors, and receive errors).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] counters errors

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, counter error information for all slots/ports on the switch is
displayed.
• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

• These counters do not apply to Gigabit Ethernet traffic.

• For combo ports configured as either forced fiber or preferred fiber, statistics for the SFP fiber ports
and not the copper RJ-45 ports will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid counters errors
command for more information.
• For combo ports configured as either forced copper or preferred copper, statistics for the copper RJ-45
ports and not the SFP fiber port will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid counters errors
command for more information.

page 1-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> show interfaces 2/1 counters errors

02/01,
Alignments Errors = 6.45E13, FCS Errors = 7.65E12
IfInErrors = 6435346, IfOutErrors= 5543,
Undersize pkts = 867568, Oversize pkts = 5.98E8

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number.
Alignments Errors Number of Alignments errors.
FCS Errors Number of Frame Check Sequence errors.
IfInErrors Number of received error frames.
IfOutErrors Number of transmitted error frames.
Undersize pkts Number of undersized packets.
Oversize pkts Number of oversized packets (more than 1518 octets).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces counters Displays interface counters information (e.g., unicast, broadcast,
and multi-cast packets received/transmitted).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
ifTable
ifInErrors
ifOutErrors
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatsRxUndersizePkts
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsAlignmentErrors
dot3StatsFCSErrors
dot3StatsFrameTooLong

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-53


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces collisions


Displays interface collision information (e.g., number of collisions and number of retries).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] collisions

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, collision information for all slots/ports on the switch is displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

• These counters do not apply to Gigabit Ethernet traffic.

• For combo ports configured as either forced fiber or preferred fiber, statistics for the SFP fiber ports
and not the copper RJ-45 ports will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid collisions command
for more information.
• For combo port configured as either forced copper or preferred copper, statistics for the copper RJ-45
ports and not the SFP fiber port will be displayed. See the show interfaces hybrid collisions command
for more information.

Examples
-> show interfaces 2/1 collisions

02/01,
Rx Collisions = 6.56E18, Rx Single Collision = 345464364,
Rx Multiple Collisions = 6325235326, Rx Excessive Collisions = 5.65E19

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number.
Tx Collisions Number of transmit collisions.

page 1-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Tx Single Collision Number of successfully transmitted frames for which transmission was
inhibited by one collision.
Tx Multiple Collisions Number of successfully transmitted frames for which transmission was
inhibited by multiple collisions.
Tx Excessive Retries Number of frames for which transmission fails due to excessive colli-
sions.
Rx Collisions Number of receive collisions.
Rx Single Collision Number of successfully received frames for which reception was
inhibited by one collision.
Rx Multiple Collisions Number of successfully received frames for which reception was
inhibited by multiple collisions.
Rx Excessive Retries Number of frames for which reception fails due to excessive collisions.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC


address, input errors, and output errors).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatsRxCollisions
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsSingleCollisionFrames
dot3StatsMultipleCollisionFrames
dot3StatsExcessiveCollisions

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-55


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces status


Displays interface line settings (e.g., speed and mode).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] status

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, line settings for all slots/ports on the switch are displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

• The show interfaces status command displays the status and configuration of the active port in the
first row and the status and configuration of the other port in the following row. See the show inter-
faces hybrid status command for more information.
• The hybrid mode for combo ports is not configurable; combo ports are set to preferred fiber by default.
As a result, the Hybrid Mode field always displays preferred fiber (PF) for all combo ports. For non-
combo ports, the Hybrid Type and Hybrid Mode fields display NA.

page 1-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
The following is an example for a non-combo port:
-> show interfaces 1/2 status
DETECTED CONFIGURED
Slot/ AutoNego Speed Duplex Hybrid Speed Duplex Hybrid Trap
Port (Mbps) Type (Mbps) Mode LinkUpDown
-----+--------+------+------+------+--------+------+------+------
1/2 Enable 1000 Full NA Auto Auto NA -

The following is an example for a combo port:


-> show interfaces 1/25 status
DETECTED CONFIGURED
Slot/ AutoNego Speed Duplex Hybrid Speed Duplex Hybrid Trap
Port (Mbps) Type (Mbps) Mode LinkUpDown
-----+--------+------+------+------+--------+------+------+------
1/25 Enable - - - 1000 Full PF Enable
1/25 Enable - - - 100 Auto PF Enable

FF - ForcedFiber PF - PreferredFiber F - Fiber


FC - ForcedCopper PC - PreferredCopper C - Copper

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot/port number.
AutoNego Autonegotiation status (Enable/Disable).
Detected Speed Detected line speed (10/100/Auto/1000/10000 Mbps).
Detected Duplex Detected line duplex (Half duplex/Full duplex/Auto).
Detected Hybrid Type The detected combo port type, which can be F (fiber) or C (copper).
Configured Speed Configured line speed (10/100/Auto/1000/10000 Mbps).
Configured Duplex Configured line duplex (Half duplex/Full duplex/Auto).
Configured Hybrid Mode The configured combo port type, which is PF (Preferred Fiber). Con-
figuring the Hybrid Mode is not supported.
Trap Link Up/Down Trap Link status (up/down).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-57


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

trap port link Enables/disables Trap LinkUpDown.


interfaces speed Configures interface line speed, sets speed, and duplex mode to
auto-sensing.
interfaces duplex Configures interface duplex mode.
interfaces clear-violation-all Configures one or more combo ports to use the fiber SFP port(s)
instead of the equivalent copper RJ-45 port(s) when both ports are
enabled and have a valid link.

MIB Objects
ifTable
ifLinkUpDownTrapEnable
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortAutoSpeed
esmPortAutoDuplexMode
esmPortCfgSpeed
esmPortCfgDuplexMode
esmHybridConfTable
esmPortCfgHybridMode
esmPortCfgHybridType

page 1-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces port


Displays interface port status (up or down).
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] port

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
The status for all ports is displayed if a specific slot/port value is not specified with this command.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number.

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

Examples
-> show interfaces port
Slot/ Admin Link Violations Alias
Port Status Status
-----+----------+---------+----------+-----------------------------------------
1/1 enable down none ""
1/2 enable down none ""
1/3 enable down none ""
1/4 enable down none ""

-> show interfaces 1/24 port


Slot/Port Admin Status Link Status Violations Alias
----------+--------------+------------+----------------+-----------------------
1/24 enable down NETSEC ""

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number.
Admin Status Port status (enable/disable).
Link Status Operational status (enable/disable).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-59


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Violations Applications that have blocked the port due to a specific violation.
Alias Interface alias.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces admin Enables/disables an interface.


interfaces clear-violation-all Clears all port violations set by various applications on the switch.
interfaces alias Configures an alias for a port.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
ifXTable
ifAlias
ifTable
ifAdminStatus
ifOperStatus

page 1-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces ifg


Displays interface inter-frame gap values.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] ifg

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, IFG values for all slots/ports on the switch are displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

Examples
-> show interfaces ifg
Slot/Port ifg(Bytes)
-----------+-------------
02/01 12
02/02 12
02/03 12
02/04 12
02/05 12
02/06 12
02/07 12
02/08 12
02/09 12
02/10 12
02/11 12
02/12 12
02/13 12
02/14 12
02/15 12
02/16 12
02/17 12
02/18 12

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-61


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port numbers.
ifg Inter-frame gap value (Gigabit Ethernet interface).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces ifg Configures the inter-frame gap value.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortCfgIFG

page 1-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces flood rate


Displays interface peak flood rate settings.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] flood rate

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, peak rate settings for all slots/ports on the switch are displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number.

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number only.

Examples
-> show interfaces flood rate

Slot/Port peak rate(Mb/second) Enable


-----------+----------------------+---------------
02/01 12 Flood only
02/02 47 Flood only
02/03 16 Flood only
02/04 47 Flood only
02/05 47 Flood only
02/06 47 Flood only
02/07 47 Flood only
02/08 47 Flood only
02/09 47 Flood only
02/10 47 Flood only
02/11 47 Flood only
02/12 47 Flood only
02/13 47 Flood only
02/14 47 Flood only
02/15 47 Flood only
02/16 47 Flood only
02/17 47 Flood only
02/18 47 Flood only

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-63


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port numbers.
peak rate (Mbps) Configured peak flood rate.
Enable Configuration enabled (Flood only/Multicast).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces flood rate Configures the peak flood rate for an interface.
interfaces flood multicast Enables/disables flood rate limiting for multicast traffic on an
interface.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortMaxFloodRate
esmPortFloodMcastEnable

page 1-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces traffic


Displays interface traffic statistics.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] traffic

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, traffic settings for all slots/ports on the switch are displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

Examples
-> show interfaces traffic

Slot/Port Input packets Input bytes Output packets Output bytes


---------+-----------------+-----------------+-----------------+-----------------

02/01 0 0 0 0
02/02 0 0 0 0
02/03 0 0 0 0
03/01 0 0 0 0
03/02 0 0 0 0

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port numbers.
Input packets Input packets detected.
Input bytes Input bytes detected.
Output packets Output packets detected.
Output bytes Output bytes detected.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-65


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

show interfaces Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC


address, and input/output errors).
show interfaces counters Displays interface counter information (e.g., unicast packets
received/transmitted).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
ifXTable
ifHCInOctets
ifHCInUcastPkts
ifHCInMulticastPkts
ifHCInBroadcastPkts
ifHCOutOctets
ifHCOutUcastPkts
ifHCOutMulticastPkts
ifHCOutBroadcastPkts

page 1-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid


Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC address, input errors, output errors) for
combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper}

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the status of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the status of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port numbers are entered, information for all slots/ports on the switch is displayed.

• You can display a specific interface by entering the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).

• You can display a range of port numbers (e.g., 3/1-4).

• You can display all interfaces in a slot by entering the slot number (e.g., 3).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-67


Ethernet Port Commands

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid fiber
Slot/Port 1/25 :
Operational Status : down,
Last Time Link Changed : FRI DEC 27 15:10:23 ,
Number of Status Change: 0,
Type : Ethernet,
MAC address : 00:d0:95:b2:39:b2,
BandWidth (Megabits) : 1000, Duplex : -,
Autonegotiation : 1 [ 1000-F ],
Long Accept : Enable, Runt Accept : Disable,
Long Frame Size(Bytes) : 9216, Runt Size(Bytes) : 64,
Rx :
Bytes Received : 0, Unicast Frames : 0,
Broadcast Frames: 0, M-cast Frames : 0,
UnderSize Frames: 0, OverSize Frames: 0,
Lost Frames : 0, Error Frames : 0,
CRC Error Frames: 0, Alignments Err : 0,
Tx :
Bytes Xmitted : 0, Unicast Frames : 0,
Broadcast Frames: 0, M-cast Frames : 0,
UnderSize Frames: 0, OverSize Frames: 0,
Lost Frames : 0, Collided Frames: 0,
Error Frames : 0

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port.
Operational Status Interface status (up/down).
Last Time Link Changed The last time the configuration for this interface was changed.
Number of Status Change The total number of times that the configuration of this interface has
changed.
Type Interface type (Ethernet/Fast Ethernet/Gigabit Ethernet).
MAC address Interface MAC address.
Bandwidth Bandwidth (in megabits).
Duplex Duplex mode (Half/Full/Auto).
Autonegotiation The auto negotiation settings for this interface.
Long Accept Long Frames status (enable/disable).
Runt Accept Runt Frames status (enable/disable).
Long Frame Size Long Frame Size (in Bytes).
Runt Size Runt Frame Size (in Bytes).
Bytes Received Number of Bytes received.
Rx Unicast Frames Number of unicast frames received.
Rx Broadcast Frames Number of broadcast frames received.
Rx M-cast Frames Number of multicast frames received.
Rx Undersize Frames Number of undersized frames received.
Rx Oversize Frames Number of r oversized frames received.

page 1-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Rx Lost Frames Number of Lost Frames received.
Rx Error Frames Number of error frames received.
Rx CRC Error Frames Number of CRC error frames received.
Rx Alignments Err Number of Alignments Error frames received.
Bytes Xmitted Number of Bytes transmitted.
Tx Unicast Frames Number of unicast frames transmitted.
Tx Broadcast Frames Number of broadcast frames transmitted.
Tx M-cast Frames Number of multicast frames r transmitted.
Tx Undersize Frames Number of undersized frames transmitted.
Tx Oversize Frames Number of oversized frames transmitted.
Tx Lost Frames Number of Lost Frames transmitted.
Tx Collided Frames Number of collision frames received or transmitted.
Tx Error Frames Number of error frames transmitted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid Displays interface accounting information (e.g., packets received/
accounting transmitted) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid counters Displays interface counter information (e.g., unicast packets
received/transmitted) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid counters Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit
errors errors, receive errors) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid Displays interface collision information (e.g., number of collisions,
collisions number of retries) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid status Displays the interface line settings (e.g., speed, mode) for combo
ports.
show interfaces hybrid traffic Displays interface traffic statistics (input/output bytes and packets)
for combo ports.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-69


Ethernet Port Commands

MIB Objects
ifTable
ifOperStatus
ifType
ifPhysAddress
ifSpeed
ifInDiscards
IfOutDiscards
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortCfgLongEnable
esmPortCfgRuntEnable
esmPortCfgMaxFrameSize
esmPortCfgRuntSize
ifXTable
ifHCInOctets
ifHCInUcastPkts
ifHCInBroadcastPkts
ifHCInMulticastPkts
IfHCOutOctets
IfHCOutUcastPkts
IfHCOutBroadcastPkts
IfHCOutMulticastPkts
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatsRxUndersizePkts
alcetherStatsCRCAlignErrors
alcetherStatsTxUndersizePkts
alcetherStatsTxOversizePkts
alcetherStatsTxCollisions
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsFrameTooLong
dot3StatsFCSErrors
dot3StatsLateCollisions

page 1-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid status


Displays interface line settings (e.g., speed, mode) for combo ports only.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} status

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the status of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the status of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the status and configuration
configuration for all switch combo ports is displayed..

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the slot, slot/port, or slot/port-port2 parameters to display the status and configuration for all ports
on a slot, a specific port, or a range of ports.
• The hybrid mode for combo ports is not configurable; combo ports are set to preferred fiber by default.
As a result, the Hybrid Mode field always displays preferred fiber (PF) for all combo ports.

Examples
-> show interfaces hybrid fiber status
DETECTED CONFIGURED
Slot/ AutoNego Speed Duplex Hybrid Speed Duplex Hybrid Trap
Port (Mbps) Type (Mbps) Mode LinkUpDown
-----+--------+------+------+------+--------+------+------+------
1/25 Enable - - - 1000 Full PF -
1/26 Enable - - - 1000 Full PF -

FF - ForcedFiber PF - PreferredFiber F - Fiber


FC - ForcedCopper PC - PreferredCopper C - Copper

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot/port number.
AutoNego Autonegotiation status (Enable/Disable).
Detected Speed Detected line speed (10/100/Auto/1000/10000 Mbps).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-71


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Detected Duplex Detected line duplex (Half duplex/Full duplex/Auto).
Detected Hybrid Type The detected combo port type, which can be F (fiber) or C (copper).
Configured Speed Configured line speed (10/100/Auto/1000/10000 Mbps).
Configured Duplex Configured line duplex (Half duplex/Full duplex/Auto).
Configured Hybrid Mode The configured combo port type, which is PF (Preferred Fiber). Con-
figuring the Hybrid Mode is not supported.
Trap Link Up/Down Trap Link status (up/down).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

trap port link Enables/disables Trap LinkUpDown.


interfaces hybrid speed Configures interface line speed on combo ports.
interfaces hybrid duplex Configures duplex mode on combo ports.
interfaces clear-violation-all Configures one or more combo ports to use the fiber SFP port(s)
instead of the equivalent copper RJ-45 port(s) when both ports are
enabled and have a valid link.

MIB Objects
ifTable
ifLinkUpDownTrapEnable
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortAutoSpeed
esmPortAutoDuplexMode
esmHybridConfTable
esmPortCfgHybridMode
esmPortCfgHybridType
esmHybridPortCfgSpeed
esmHybridPortCfgDuplexMode

page 1-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid flow control


Displays interface flow control wait time settings for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} flow control

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the configuration of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the configuration of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be
displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the flow control wait tme settings
for all switch combo ports is displayed..

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot, slot/port, or slot/port-port2 parameters to display the flow control wait time settings for all
ports on a slot, a specific port, or for a range of ports.

Examples
-> show interfaces hybrid fiber flow control
Slot/Port Active Wait time(usec) Cfg-Flow Cfg-Cross
-----------+--------+---------------+--------+-----------
1/25 - 0 Pause MDI
1/26 - 0 Pause MDI

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number
Active Interface status.
Wait time Flow control wait time, in microseconds.
Cfg-Flow Flow control status, which can be Pause or Go.
Cfg-Cross The user-configured cross-over setting, which can be Auto, MDI, or
MDIX.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-73


Ethernet Port Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid crossover Configures crossover settings for combo ports.


show interfaces flow control Displays interface flow control wait time settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgFlow
esmHybridPortPauseSlotTime
esmHybridPortCfgCrossover

page 1-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid pause


Displays the flow control pause configuration for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} pause

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the configuration of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the configuration of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be
displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the flow control pause configura-
tion for all switch combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces hybrid fiber pause
Slot/Port Active Wait time(usec) Cfg-Pause Cfg-Cross Hybrid Type
-----------+--------+---------------+--------+-----------+-----------
1/25 - 0 DIS MDI -
1/26 - 0 DIS MDI -

-> show interfaces hybrid copper pause


Slot/Port Active Wait time(usec) Cfg-Pause Cfg-Cross Hybrid Type
-----------+--------+---------------+--------+-----------+-----------
1/25 - 0 DIS Auto -
1/26 Active 65535 Tx-N-Rx Auto C

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number
Active Interface status.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-75


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


Wait time The amount of time, in microseconds, the neighbor interface will wait
after receiving a PAUSE frame from the local interface.
Cfg-Pause The flow control setting (Tx = transmit, Rx = receive, Tx-N-Rx =
transmit and receive). Configured through the interfaces hybrid pause
command.
Cfg-Cross The user-configured cross-over setting (Auto, MDI, or MDIX). Con-
figured through the interfaces hybrid crossover command.
Hybrid Type The configured active media type for the hybrid port (F = fiber, C =
copper, NA = not applicable).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces pause Displays the interface flow control pause settings.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIF
esmPortPauseSlotTime
esmPortActiveHybridType
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgFlow
esmHybridPortCfgCrossover
dot3PauseTable
dot3PauseSlotTime

page 1-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid capability


Displays default auto negotiation, speed, duplex, flow, and cross-over settings for a single combo port, a
range of combo ports, or all combo ports on a switch.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} capability

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the configuration of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the configuration of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be
displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the information for all switch
combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

• The show interfaces hybrid capability command displays defaults settings in two rows of data for
each combo port. The first row of data, identified by the label CAP, displays the valid user-defined
configuration settings available for the combo port. The second row, identified by the label DEF,
displays the default settings for the combo port.

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper capability
Slot/Port AutoNeg Flow Crossover Speed Duplex
-----------+---------+--------+-----------+----------+----------
1/25 CAP EN/DIS EN/DIS MDI/X/Auto 10/100/1G Full/Half
1/25 DEF EN EN Auto Auto Auto

output definitions
Slot The slot number.
Port The port number

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-77


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


AutoNeg In the row labeled CAP this field displays the valid auto negotiation
configurations for the port. In the row label DEF this field displays the
default auto negotiation settings for the port. The possible values are
EN (enabled) or DIS (disabled).
Flow In the row labeled CAP this field displays the valid flow configurations
for the port. In the row label DEF this field displays the default flow
settings for the port. The possible values are EN (enabled) or DIS (dis-
abled).
Crossover In the row labeled CAP this field displays the valid cross over configu-
rations for the port. In the row label DEF this field displays the default
cross over settings for the port. The possible values are Auto,
MDI/X/Auto (MDI/MDIX/Auto), or -- (not configurable and/or not
applicable).
Speed In the row labeled CAP this field displays the valid line speed configu-
rations for the port. In the row label DEF this field displays the default
line speed settings for the port. The possible values are 10/100, 100,
1G, 10/100/1G, or Auto.
Duplex In the row labeled CAP this field displays the valid duplex configura-
tions for the port. In the row label DEF this field displays the default
duplex settings for the port. The possible values are Full, Full/Half, or
Auto.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces hybrid autoneg Enables and disables auto negotiation for combo ports.
interfaces hybrid crossover Configures crossover port settings for combo ports.
interfaces hybrid speed Configures interface speed for combo ports.
interfaces hybrid duplex Configures duplex settings for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid status Displays interface line settings for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
esmHybridConfTable
esmHybridPortCfgAutoNegotiation
esmHybridPortCfgFlow
esmHybridPortCfgCrossover
esmHybridPortCfgSpeed
esmHybridPortCfgDuplex

page 1-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid accounting


Displays interface accounting information (e.g., packets received/transmitted, deferred frames received)
for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} accounting

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that statistics for the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that statistics for the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the accounting information for all
switch combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper accounting
1/25 ,
Rx undersize packets = 0,
Tx undersize packets = 0,
Rx oversize packets = 0,
Tx oversize packets = 0,
Rx packets 64 Octets = 3073753,
Rx packets 65To127 Octets = 678698,
Rx packets 128To255 Octets = 21616,
Rx packets 256To511 Octets = 21062,
Rx packets 512To1023 Octets = 2,
Rx packets 1024To1518 Octets = 84,
Rx packets 1519to4095 Octets = 0,
Rx packets 4096ToMax Octets = 0,
Rx Jabber frames = 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-79


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions
Rx undersize packets Number of undersized packets received.
Tx undersize packets Number of undersized packets transmitted.
Rx oversize packets Number of oversized packets received.
Tx oversize packets Number of oversized packets transmitted.
Rx packets Octets Number of packets received in each listed octet range.
Rx Jabber frames Number of jabber packets received (longer than 1518 octets).
Tx deferred frames Number of packets for which transmission was delayed (Ethernet
only).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC
address, input/output errors) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid counters Displays interface counter information (e.g., unicast packets
received/transmitted) for combo ports.

page 1-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatRxsUndersizePkts
alcetherStatTxsUndersizePkts
alcetherStatsTxOversizePkts
alcetherStatsPkts64Octets
alcetherStatsPkts65to127Octets
alcetherStatsPkts128to255Octets
alcetherStatsPkts256to511Octets
alcetherStatsPkts512to1023Octets
alcetherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets
gigaEtherStatsPkts1519to4095Octets
gigaEtherStatsPkts4096to9215Octets
alcetherStatsRxJabber
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsFrameTooLong
dot3StatsDeferredTransmissions

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-81


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid counters


Displays interface counters information (e.g., unicast, broadcast, multi-cast packets received/transmitted)
for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} counters

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that statistics for the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that statistics for the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the interface counters for all switch
combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

• These counters do not apply to Gigabit Ethernet traffic.

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper counters

InOctets = 54367578586897979, OutOctets = 5.78E19,


InUcastPkts = 55654265276, OutUcastPkts = 5.78E20,
InMcastPkts = 58767867868768777, OutMcastPkts = 5465758756856,
InBcastPkts = 576567567567567576, OutBcastPkts = 786876,
InPauseFrames = 567798768768767, OutPauseFrames= 786876,

output definitions
InOctets Number of octets received.
OutOctets Number of octets transmitted.
InUcastPkts Number of unicast packets received.
OutUcastPkts Number of unicast packets transmitted.
InMcastPkts Number of multicast packets received.

page 1-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


OutMcastPkts Number of unicast packets transmitted.
InBcastPkts Number of broadcast packets received.
OutBcastPkts Number of unicast packets transmitted.
InPauseFrames Number of MAC control frames received.
OutPauseFrames Number of MAC control frames transmitted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid counters Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit
errors errors, receive errors).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
ifXTable
IfHCInOctets
IfHCOutOctets
IfHCInUcastPkts
IfHCOutUcastPkts
IfHCInMulticastPkts
IfHCOutMulticastPkts
IfHCInBroadcastPkts
IfHCOutBroadcastPkts
dot3PauseTable
dot3InPauseFrame
dot3OutPauseFrame

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-83


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid counters errors


Displays interface error frame information (e.g., CRC errors, transit errors, receive errors) for combo
ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} counters errors

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that statistics for the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that statistics for the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the error frame information for all
switch combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

• These counters do not apply to Gigabit Ethernet traffic.

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper counters errors

01/25,
Alignments Errors = 6.45E13, FCS Errors = 7.65E12
IfInErrors = 6435346, IfOutErrors= 5543,
Undersize pkts = 867568, Oversize pkts = 5.98E8

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number.
Alignments Errors Number of Alignments errors.
FCS Errors Number of Frame Check Sequence errors.
IfInErrors Number of received error frames.

page 1-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions (continued)


IfOutErrors Number of transmitted error frames.
Undersize pkts Number of undersized packets.
Oversize pkts Number of oversized packets (more than 1518 octets).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid counters Displays interface counters information (e.g., unicast, broadcast,
multi-cast packets received/transmitted).

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
ifTable
ifInErrors
ifOutErrors
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatsRxUndersizePkts
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsAlignmentErrors
dot3StatsFCSErrors
dot3StatsFrameTooLong

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-85


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid collisions


Displays interface collision information (e.g., number of collisions, number of retries) for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} collisions

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that statistics for the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that statistics for the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the information for all switch
combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display collision information for a specific
combo port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

• These counters do not apply to Gigabit Ethernet traffic.

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid copper collisions

01/25,
Rx Collisions = 6.56E18, Rx Single Collision = 345464364,
Rx Multiple Collisions = 6325235326, Rx Excessive Collisions = 5.65E19

page 1-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number.
Tx Collisions Number of transmit collisions.
Tx Single Collision Number of successfully transmitted frames for which transmission was
inhibited by one collision.
Tx Multiple Collisions Number of successfully transmitted frames for which transmission was
inhibited by multiple collisions.
Tx Excessive Retries Number of frames for which transmission fails due to excessive colli-
sions.
Rx Collisions Number of receive collisions.
Rx Single Collision Number of successfully received frames for which reception was
inhibited by one collision.
Rx Multiple Collisions Number of successfully received frames for which reception was
inhibited by multiple collisions.
Rx Excessive Retries Number of frames for which reception fails due to excessive collisions.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC
address, input errors, output errors) for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
alcetherStatsTable
alcetherStatsRxCollisions
dot3StatsTable
dot3StatsSingleCollisionFrames
dot3StatsMultipleCollisionFrames
dot3StatsExcessiveCollisions

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-87


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid traffic


Displays interface traffic statistics for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} traffic

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that statistics for the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that statistics for the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the traffic statistics for all switch
combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces hybrid fiber traffic

Slot/Port Input packets Input bytes Output packets Output bytes


---------+-----------------+-----------------+-----------------+-----------------
01/25 0 0 0
01/26 0 0 0

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port numbers.
Input packets Input packets detected.
Input bytes Input bytes detected.
Output packets Output packets detected.
Output bytes Output bytes detected.

page 1-88 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show interfaces hybrid Displays general interface information (e.g., hardware, MAC
address, input/output errors) for combo ports.
show interfaces hybrid counters Displays interface counter information (e.g., unicast packets
received/transmitted) for combo ports.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
ifXTable
ifHCInOctets
ifHCInUcastPkts
ifHCInMulticastPkts
ifHCInBroadcastPkts
ifHCOutOctets
ifHCOutUcastPkts
ifHCOutMulticastPkts
ifHCOutBroadcastPkts

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-89


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid port


Displays interface port status (up or down) for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} port

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the status of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the status of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the port status for all switch combo
ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces 1/25 hybrid fiber port
Slot/Port Admin Status Link Status Alias
----------+--------------+------------+----------------------------------------
1/25 enable down ""

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port number.
Admin Status Port status (enable/disable).
Link Status Operational status (enable/disable).
Alias Interface alias.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 1-90 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces admin Enables/disables an interface.


interfaces alias Configures an alias for a port.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortCfgSlot
esmPortCfgIfIndex
ifXTable
ifAlias
ifTable
ifAdminStatus
ifOperStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-91


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid flood rate


Displays interface peak flood rate settings for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} flood rate

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that the status of the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that the status of the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the peak rate settings for all switch
combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces flood rate

Slot/Port peak rate(Mb/second) Enable


-----------+----------------------+---------------
02/01 12 Flood only
02/02 47 Flood only
02/03 16 Flood only
02/04 47 Flood only
02/05 47 Flood only
02/06 47 Flood only
02/07 47 Flood only
02/08 47 Flood only
02/09 47 Flood only
02/10 47 Flood only
02/11 47 Flood only
02/12 47 Flood only
02/13 47 Flood only
02/14 47 Flood only
02/15 47 Flood only
02/16 47 Flood only

page 1-92 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

02/17 47 Flood only


02/18 47 Flood only
02/19 47 Flood only

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port numbers.
Peak Rate (Mbps) Configured peak flood rate.
Enable Configuration enabled (Flood only/Flood Multicast/Multicast).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

interfaces flood rate Configures the peak flood rate for an interface.
interfaces flood multicast Enables/disables flood multicasting on an interface.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortMaxFloodRate
esmPortFloodMcastEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-93


Ethernet Port Commands

show interfaces hybrid ifg


Displays interface inter-frame gap values for combo ports.
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} ifg

Syntax Definitions
slot Slot number you want to display.
port Port number of the interface you want to display.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to display.
fiber Specifies that statistics for the SFP port(s) will be displayed.
copper Specifies that statistics for the copper RJ-45 port(s) will be displayed.

Defaults
If a specific slot or slot/port number is not entered with this command, the inter-frame gap values for all
switch combo ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot and port number or a range of port numbers to display information for a specific combo
port or a range of combo ports.
• Enter a slot number to display information for all combo ports on a specific slot.

Examples
-> show interfaces hybrid fiber ifg
Slot/Port ifg(Bytes)
-----------+-------------
1/25 12
1/26 12

output definitions
Slot/Port Interface slot and port numbers.
ifg Inter-frame gap value (Gigabit Ethernet interface).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 1-94 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Ethernet Port Commands

Related Commands

interfaces ifg Configures the inter-frame gap value.

MIB Objects
esmConfTable
esmPortSlot
esmPortIF
esmPortCfgIFG

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1-95


Ethernet Port Commands

page 1-96 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


2 Source Learning
Commands

Source Learning is responsible for creating, updating, and deleting source and destination MAC Address
entries in the MAC Address Table. This chapter includes descriptions of Source Learning commands used
to create or delete static MAC addresses, define the aging time value for static and dynamically learned
MAC addresses, and display MAC Address Table entries and statistics.
MIB information for Source Learning commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelInd1MacAddress.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-MAC-ADDRESS-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

mac-address-table
mac-address-table static-multicast
mac-address-table aging-time
source-learning
show mac-address-table
show mac-address-table static-multicast
show mac-address-table count
show mac-address-table aging-time
show source-learning

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-1


Source Learning Commands

mac-address-table
Configures a destination unicast MAC address. The configured (static) MAC address is assigned to a non-
mobile switch port or link aggregate ID and VLAN. Packets received on ports associated with the speci-
fied VLAN that contain a destination MAC address that matches the static MAC address are forwarded to
the specified port. Static destination MAC addresses are maintained in the Source Learning MAC address
table.
mac-address-table [permanent] mac_address {slot/port | linkagg link_agg} vid [bridging | filtering]
no mac-address-table [permanent | learned] [mac_address {slot/port | linkagg link_agg} vid]

Syntax Definitions
permanent Defines a permanent static MAC Address that is not removed when the
switch reboots.
learned Specifies that the MAC address is a dynamically learned address.
mac_address Enter the destination MAC Address to add to the MAC Address Table
(e.g., 00:00:39:59:f1:0c).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
link_agg Enter a link aggregate ID number (0–31). See Chapter 6, “Link Aggre-
gation Commands.”
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
bridging Specifies that all packets to or from this MAC address are bridged.
filtering Specifies that all packets to or from this MAC address are dropped.

Defaults

parameter default
permanent permanent
bridging | filtering bridging

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a MAC address from the Source Learning MAC Address
Table.
• The specified slot/port or link aggregate ID must already belong to the specified VLAN. Use the vlan
port default command to assign a port or link aggregate ID to a VLAN before you configure the static
MAC address. Only traffic from other ports associated with the same VLAN is directed to the static
MAC address slot/port.

page 2-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

• Select the filtering parameter to set up a denial of service to block potential hostile attacks. Traffic sent
to or from a filtered MAC address is dropped. Select the bridging parameter for regular traffic flow to
or from the MAC address.
• If a packet received on a port associated with the same VLAN contains a source address that matches a
static MAC address, the packet is discarded.
• Static MACs are not supported on mobile ports.

• Only static MAC address entries with a permanent management status are captured when a snapshot
of the switch’s running configuration is taken.
• Use the mac-address-table aging-time command (see page 2-6) to set the aging time value for all
static and dynamically learned MAC addresses. This is the value applied to static MAC addresses
defined using the mac-address-table timeout form of this command.

Examples
-> mac-address-table permanent 00:00:39:59:f1:0c 4/2 355
-> no mac-address-table
-> no mac-address-table 5/1 755
-> no mac-address-table permanent

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

mac-address-table aging-time Configures aging time, in seconds, for static and dynamically learned
MAC addresses.
show mac-address-table Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.
show mac-address-table count Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.
show mac-address-table aging- Displays the current aging time value for the Source Learning MAC
time Address Table.

MIB Objects
slMacAddressTable
slMacAddress
slMacAddressManagement
slMacAddressDisposition

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-3


Source Learning Commands

mac-address-table static-multicast
Configures a static multicast MAC address and assigns the address to one or more egress ports. Packets
received on ports associated with the specified VLAN that contain a destination MAC address that
matches the static multicast address are forwarded to the specified egress ports. Static multicast MAC
addresses are maintained in the Source Learning MAC address table.
mac-address-table static-multicast multicast_address {slot1/port1[-port1a] [slot2/port2[-port2a]...] |
linkagg link_agg} vid
no mac-address-table static-multicast [multicast_address {slot1/port1[-port1a] [slot2/port2[-port2a]...] |
linkagg link_agg} vid]

Syntax Definitions
multicast_address Enter the destination multicast MAC Address to add to the MAC
Address Table (e.g., 01:00:39:59:f1:0c).
slot1/port1[-port1a] The egress slot and port combination that is assigned to the static multi-
cast MAC address. You may enter multiple ports and port ranges.
slot2/port2[-port2a] Additional egress slot and port combinations may be assigned to the
static multicast MAC address. You may enter multiple ports and port
ranges.
link_agg Enter a link aggregate ID number (0–29). See Chapter 6, “Link Aggre-
gation Commands.”
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a static multicast MAC address from the Source Learning
MAC Address Table. Note that if no parameters are specified with this form of the command, then all
static multicast addresses are removed.
• Note that a MAC address is considered a multicast MAC address if the least significant bit of the most
significant octet of the address is enabled. For example, MAC addresses with a prefix of 01, 03, 05, 13,
etc., are multicast MAC addresses.
• If a multicast prefix value is not present, then the address is treated as a regular MAC address and not
allowed when using the mac-address-table static-multicast command. Also note that multicast
addresses within the following ranges are not supported:
01:00:5E:00:00:00 to 01:00:5E:7F:FF:FF
01:80:C2:XX.XX.XX
33:33:XX:XX:XX:XX

page 2-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

• The configured (static) multicast MAC address is assigned to a non-mobile switch port or link aggre-
gate ID and VLAN. Static multicast MACs are not supported on mobile ports.
• In addition to configuring the same static multicast address for multiple ports within a given VLAN, it
is also possible to use the same multicast address across multiple VLANs.
• The specified slot/port or link aggregate ID must already belong to the specified VLAN. Use the
vlan port default command to assign a port or link aggregate ID to a VLAN before you configure the
static MAC address. Only traffic from other ports associated with the same VLAN is directed to the
static multicast MAC address slot/port.
• If the configuration snapshot or write memory command is entered after a static multicast MAC
address is configured, the resulting ASCII file or boot.cfg file will include the following additional
syntax for the mac-address-table static-multicast command:

group num

This syntax indicates the number of the multicast group that the switch has assigned to the multicast
MAC address for the given VLAN association. Each multicast address – VLAN association is treated
as a unique instance and assigned a group number specific to that instance. Up to 1022 such instances
are supported per switch.
• Note that if the port assigned to a multicast MAC address is down or administratively disabled when
the configuration snapshot or write memory command is used, the multicast MAC address is not
saved to the resulting ASCII file or boot.cfg file.

Examples
-> mac-address-table static-multicast 02:00:39:59:f1:0c 4/2 355
-> mac-address-table static-multicast 01:00:00:3a:44:11 1/12-24 255
-> mac-address-table static-multicast 03:00:00:3a:44:12 1/10 2/1-6 3/1-8 1500
-> mac-address-table static-multicast 04:00:00:3a:44:13 linkagg 10 455
-> no mac-address-table static-multicast 03:00:00:3a:44:12 1/10 1500
-> no mac-address-table static-multicast 04:00:00:3a:44:13 linkagg 10 455
-> no mac-address-table static-multicast

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show mac-address-table Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.


show mac-address-table static- Displays a list of static multicast MAC addresses that are configured in
multicast the Source Learning MAC Address Table.
show mac-address-table count Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.

MIB Objects
slMacAddressTable
slMacAddress
slMacAddressManagement
slMacAddressDisposition

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-5


Source Learning Commands

mac-address-table aging-time
Configures aging time, in seconds, for static and dynamically learned MAC addresses. When a MAC
address has aged beyond the aging-time value, the MAC address is discarded.
mac-address-table aging-time seconds
no mac-address-table aging-time

Syntax Definitions
seconds Aging time value (in seconds). Do not use commas in value. The range
is 60—634.

Defaults
By default, the aging time is set to 300 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to set the aging-time back to the default value of 300 seconds.

• The aging time value is a global value that applies to all VLANs. Configuring this value on a per
VLAN basis is not supported on this platform.
• Note that an inactive MAC address may take up to twice as long as the agining time value specified to
age out of the MAC address table. For example, if an aging time of 60 seconds is specified, the MAC
will age out any time between 60 and 120 seconds of inactivity.
• If the timeout parameter is not specified when using the mac-address-table command (see page 2-2)
to configure a static MAC address, then the aging time value is not applied to the static MAC address.
• The MAC address table aging time is also used as the timeout value for the Address Resolution Proto-
col (ARP) table. This timeout value determines how long the switch retains dynamically learned ARP
table entries.

Examples
-> mac-address-table aging-time 1200
-> no mac-address-table aging-time

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 2-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

Related Commands

mac-address-table Configures a static destination Unicast MAC address for a VLAN


bridge.
show mac-address-table Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.
show mac-address-table count Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.
show mac-address-table aging- Displays the current aging time value for the Source Learning MAC
time Address Table.

MIB Objects
slMacAddressAgingTable
slMacAgingValue

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-7


Source Learning Commands

source-learning
Configures the status of source MAC address learning on a single port, a range of ports, or on a link
aggregate of ports.
source-learning {port slot/port1[-port2] | linkagg linkagg_num} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port1 The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports that you want to configure on
the same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1, 2, 3, and 4 on slot 3).
linkagg_num Specifies the link aggregate port ID.
enable Enables source learning.
disable Disables source learning.

Defaults
By default, source learning is enabled on all ports.

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• Configuring source learning is not supported on mobile ports, Learned Port Security ports, individual
ports which are members of a link aggregate, or Access Guardian (802.1x) ports.
• When port-based source learning is configured for a link aggregate ID, it affects all the ports that are
members of the link aggregate.
• When source-learning is disabled on a port or link aggregate, all dynamically learned MAC addresses
are removed from the MAC address table.
• Static MAC addresses associated with a port or link aggregate are not cleared when source learning is
disabled. Also, new static MAC address configurations are allowed on ports or link aggregates even
when source learning is disabled on them.
• Disabling source learning on a port or link aggregate is useful on a ring configuration where switch A
does not have to learn MAC addresses from switch B or for a Transparent LAN Service, where the
service provider does not require the MAC addresses of the customer network.

Examples
-> source-learning port 1/2 disable
-> source-learning port 1/3-9 disable
-> source-learning linkagg 10 disable

page 2-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command introduced.

Related Commands

show source-learning Displays Source Learning status of each port or linkagg ports on a
switch.

Related MIB Objects


slMacAddressTable
slMacLearningControlTable
slMacLearningControlEntry
slMacLearningControlStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-9


Source Learning Commands

show mac-address-table
Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.
show mac-address-table [permanent | learned] [mac_address] [slot slot | slot/port] [linkagg link_agg]
[vid | vid1-vid2]

Syntax Definitions
permanent Display static MAC addresses with a permanent status.
learned Display dynamically learned MAC addresses.
mac_address Enter a MAC Address (e.g., 00:00:39:59:f1:0c).
slot Enter the slot number for a module to specify that the command should
include all ports on that module (e.g., 6 specifies all ports on the module
found in slot 6 of the switch chassis).
slot/port Enter the slot number and the physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
link_agg Enter a link aggregate ID number (0–31). See Chapter 6, “Link Aggre-
gation Commands.”
vid A single VLAN ID number (1–4094).
vid1-vid2 A contiguous range of VLAN ID numbers (e.g., 5-10).

Defaults
By default, information is displayed for all MAC addresses contained in the table.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of VLAN IDs— is allowed with this
command. Multiple entries are not accepted.
• If a static MAC address is configured on a port link that is down or disabled, an asterisk appears to the
right of the MAC address in the show mac-address-table command display. The asterisk indicates that
this is an invalid MAC address. When the port link comes up, however, the MAC address is then
considered valid and the asterisk no longer appears next to the address in the display.

page 2-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

Examples
-> show mac-address-table
Legend: Mac Address: * = address not valid

Vlan Mac Address Type Protocol Operation Interface


------+-------------------+--------------+-----------+------------+-----------
1 00:00:00:00:00:01 learned 0800 bridging 8/ 1
1 00:d0:95:6a:73:9a learned aaaa0003 bridging 10/23
Total number of Valid MAC addresses above = 2

-> show mac-address-table 10-15


Legend: Mac Address: * = address not valid

Vlan Mac Address Type Protocol Operation Interface


------+-------------------+--------------+-----------+------------+-----------
10 00:00:00:00:00:01 learned 0800 bridging 1/2
10 00:d0:95:6a:73:9a learned aaaa0003 bridging 1/2
11 00:d0:95:a3:e0:0d learned --- bridging 1/3
11 00:d0:95:a3:e5:09 learned --- bridging 1/3
11 00:d0:95:a3:e7:75 learned --- bridging 1/4
12 00:d0:95:a3:ed:f7 learned --- bridging 2/1
12 00:d0:95:a8:2a:b6 learned --- bridging 2/1
12 00:d0:95:ad:e3:cc learned --- bridging 2/1
13 00:d0:95:ae:3b:f6 learned --- bridging 2/8
13 00:d0:95:b2:3d:fa learned --- bridging 2/8
Total number of Valid MAC addresses above = 14

output definitions
VLAN Vlan ID number associated with the MAC address and slot/port.
Mac Address MAC address that is currently learned or statically assigned.
Type MAC address management status: learned or permanent. Use the
mac-address-table command on page 2-2 to configure the manage-
ment status for a static MAC address.
Protocol Protocol type for the MAC address entry. Note that if the hardware
source learning mode is active for the port, this field is blank.
Operation The disposition of the MAC address: bridging (default) or filtering.
Use the mac-address-table command on page 2-2 to configure the dis-
position for a static MAC address.
Interface The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module that is associated with the static or dynamically learned MAC
address. If the interface is a link aggregate ID, zero is displayed as the
slot number (e.g., 0/29).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-11


Source Learning Commands

Related Commands

show mac-address-table count Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.
show mac-address-table aging- Displays the current aging time value for the Source Learning MAC
time Address Table.

MIB Objects
slMacAddressTable
slMacAddress
slMacAddressManagement
slMacAddressDisposition
slMacAddressProtocol

page 2-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

show mac-address-table static-multicast


Displays the static multicast MAC address configuration for the switch.
show mac-address-table static-multicast [multicast_address] [slot slot | slot/port] [linkagg link_agg]
[vid | vid1-vid2]

Syntax Definitions
multicast_address Enter a multicast MAC Address (e.g., 01:00:39:59:f1:0c).
slot Enter the slot number for a module to specify that the command should
include all ports on that module (e.g., 6 specifies all ports on the module
found in slot 6 of the switch chassis).
slot/port Enter the slot number and the physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
link_agg Enter a link aggregate ID number (0–29). See Chapter 12, “Link Aggre-
gation Commands.”
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
vid1-vid2 A contiguous range of VLAN ID numbers (e.g., 5-10).

Defaults
By default, information is displayed for all static multicast MAC addresses contained in the MAC address
table.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of VLAN IDs— is allowed with this
command. Multiple entries are not accepted.
• Note that if a static multicast MAC address is configured on a port link that is down or disabled, the
configured multicast address does not appear in the show mac-address-table static-multicast
command display.
• The show mac-address-table command display, however, includes all static multicast addresses
regardless of whether or not the port assigned to the address is up or down. See the second example
below.
• When the show mac-address-table command is used to display MAC addresses known to the switch,
an asterisk appears to the left of all static MAC addresses that are configured on a port link that is
down or disabled. The asterisk indicates that MAC address is invalid. When the port link comes up,
however, the MAC address is then considered valid and the asterisk no longer appears next to the
address in the display.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-13


Source Learning Commands

Examples
In the example below, the static multicast address 01:00:00:00:00:01 is associated with port 1/1, which is
down. As a result, this address does not appear in the show mac-address-table static-multicast display
but is included in the show mac-address-table display with an asterisk.

-> show mac-address-table static-multicast


Legend: Mac Address: * = address not valid

Vlan Mac Address Type Protocol Operation Interface


------+-------------------+--------------+-----------+------------+-----------
1 01:00:00:00:00:02 static-mcast --- bridging 2/6
Total number of Valid MAC addresses above = 1

-> show mac-address-table


Legend: Mac Address: * = address not valid

Vlan Mac Address Type Protocol Operation Interface


------+-------------------+--------------+-----------+------------+-----------
* 1 01:00:00:00:00:01 static-mcast 0 bridging 1/1
24 00:d0:95:e4:cf:5a learned --- bridging 1/2
24 00:d0:95:e5:af:52 learned --- bridging 1/2
24 00:e0:4c:bc:ce:a1 learned --- bridging 1/2
1 01:00:00:00:00:02 static-mcast --- bridging 2/6
1 00:d0:95:e2:77:38 learned --- bridging 3/19
Total number of Valid MAC addresses above = 5

output definitions
VLAN Vlan ID number associated with the static multicast address.
Mac Address The multicast MAC address that is statically assigned to the VLAN and
slot/port.
Type Indicates the MAC address is a static multicast (static-mcast) address.
This type of address is configured through the mac-address-table
static-multicast command.
Protocol Protocol type for the MAC address entry.
Operation The disposition of the MAC address: bridging (default) or filtering.
Note that this value is always set to bridging for static multicast
addresses.
Interface The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module that is associated with the static multicast MAC address. If the
interface is a link aggregate ID, zero is displayed as the slot number
(e.g., 0/29).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show mac-address-table Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.


show mac-address-table count Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.

page 2-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

MIB Objects
slMacAddressTable
slMacAddress
slMacAddressManagement
slMacAddressDisposition
slMacAddressProtocol

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-15


Source Learning Commands

show mac-address-table count


Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.
show mac-address-table count [mac_address] [slot slot | slot/port] [linkagg link_agg] [vid | vid1-vid2]

Syntax Definitions
mac_address MAC Address (e.g., 00:00:39:59:f1:0c).
slot | slot/port Slot number for the module or the slot number and the physical port
number on that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
link_agg Enter a link aggregate ID number (0–31). See Chapter 6, “Link Aggre-
gation Commands.”
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults
By default, the count statistics are displayed for all MAC addresses contained in the MAC address table.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To display statistics for all ports on one slot, specify only the slot number for the slot parameter value.

• Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of VLAN IDs— is allowed with this
command. Multiple entries are not accepted.

Examples
-> show mac-address-table count
Mac Address Table count:
Permanent Address Count = 1
DeleteOnReset Address Count = 0
DeleteOnTimeout Address Count = 0
Dynamic Learned Address Count = 6
Total MAC Address In Use = 7

-> show mac-address-table count 10-20


Mac Address Table count:
Permanent Address Count = 0
DeleteOnReset Address Count = 0
DeleteOnTimeout Address Count = 0
Dynamic Learned Address Count = 28
Total MAC Address In Use = 28

page 2-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

output definitions
Permanent Address Count The number of static MAC addresses configured on the switch with a
permanent management status (MAC address is never aged out).
DeleteOnReset Address Count The number of static MAC addresses configured on the switch with a
reset management status (MAC address is deleted on the next switch
reboot).
DeleteOnTimeout Address The number of static MAC addresses configured on the switch with a
Count timeout management status (MAC address ages out according to the
MAC address table aging timer value).
Dynamic Learned Address The number of MAC addresses learned by the switch. These are MAC
Count addresses that are not statically configured addresses.
Total MAC Address In Use The total number of MAC addresses (learned and static) that are known
to the switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show mac-address-table Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.


show mac-address-table aging- Displays the current aging time value for the Source Learning MAC
time Address Table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-17


Source Learning Commands

show mac-address-table aging-time


Displays the current aging time value.
show mac-address-table aging-time

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The MAC Address Table aging time applies to static MAC addresses that were defined using the time-
out parameter (see page 2-2) and to dynamically learned MAC addresses.
• Note that the aging time is the same for all VLANs because it is not configurable on a per-VLAN basis.
The aging time value on this platform is a global parameter that applies to all VLANs.

Examples
-> show mac-address-table aging-time
Mac Address Aging Time (seconds) = 300

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show mac-address-table Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table information.


show mac-address-table count Displays Source Learning MAC Address Table statistics.

MIB Objects
slMacAddressAgingTable
slMacAgingValue

page 2-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Source Learning Commands

show source-learning
Displays the source learning status of a port or link aggregate of ports.
show source-learning [port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg linkagg_num]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port1 The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports that you want to configure on
the same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1, 2, 3, and 4 on slot 3).
linkagg_num Specifies the link aggregate identifier.

Defaults
By default, the source learning status for all switch ports and link aggregates is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the port slot/port or linkagg linkagg_num parameters to display the source learning status for a
specific port or link aggregate ID.
• When the source learning status is configured for a link aggregate ID, it affects all the ports that are
members of the link aggregate. However, source learning status cannot be configured on individual
ports which are members of the link aggregate.

Example
-> show source-learning
port source-learning
-----+-------------
1/1 disabled
1/2 enabled
1/3 disabled

-> show source-learning port 1/2


port source-learning
-----+-------------
1/2 disabled

-> show source-learning linkagg 10


port source-learning
-----+-------------
0/10 disabled

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2-19


Source Learning Commands

output definitions
port The slot/port number for a switch port or a link aggregate ID number. If
the interface is a link aggregate ID, zero is displayed as the slot number
(e.g., 0/29).
source-learning The source learning status of the port or link aggregate (enabled or
disabled). Configured through the source-learning command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced

Related Commands

source-learning Configures the status of source MAC address learning on a single


port, a range of ports or on a link aggregate of ports.

Related MIB Objects


slMacAddressTable
slMacLearningControlTable
slMacLearningControlEntry
slMacLearningControlStatus

page 2-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


3 VLAN Management
Commands

VLAN management software handles VLAN configuration and the reporting of VLAN configuration
changes to other switch tasks. A VLAN defines a broadcast domain that contains physical ports and can
span across multiple switches. All switches contain a default VLAN 1. Physical switch ports are initially
assigned to VLAN 1 until they are statically or dynamically assigned to other VLANs.
This chapter includes descriptions of VLAN management commands used to create, modify or remove
VLANs. These commands allow you to enable or disable Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) and Authentica-
tion on a VLAN, add or remove virtual router interfaces, statically assign physical switch ports to a default
VLAN, and display VLAN configuration information.
The VLAN management commands comply with RFC 2674.
MIB information is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1VlanManager.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-VLAN-MGR-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

vlan
vlan stp
vlan mobile-tag
vlan port default
vlan source-learning
show vlan
show vlan port
show vlan router mac status
show vlan gvrp
show vlan ipmvlan

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-1


VLAN Management Commands

vlan
Creates a new VLAN with the specified VLAN ID (VID) and an optional description.
vlan vid [enable | disable] [name description]
no vlan vid

Syntax Definitions
vid A numeric value (2–4094) that uniquely identifies an individual VLAN.
This value becomes the VLAN ID for the new VLAN.
description Text string up to 32 characters. Use quotes around string if description
contains multiple words with spaces between them (e.g. “Alcatel-Lucent
Marketing VLAN”).
enable Enable VLAN administrative status.
disable Disable VLAN administrative status.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable
description VLAN ID

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a VLAN from the configuration. All VLAN ports and rout-
ers are detached before the VLAN is removed. Ports return to their default VLANs or VLAN 1, if the
VLAN deleted is the port’s configured default VLAN.
• Note that specifying multiple VLAN IDs and/or a range of VLAN IDs on the same command line is
allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range and a space to separate multiple VLAN ID
entries (e.g., vlan 10-15 500-510 850).
• A VLAN is not operationally active until at least one active port is assigned to the VLAN.

• When a VLAN is administratively disabled, static port and dynamic mobile port assignments are
retained but traffic on these ports is not forwarded. However, VLAN rules remain active and continue
to classify mobile port traffic for VLAN membership.
• Ports are manually configured or dynamically assigned to VLANs.

page 3-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Examples
-> vlan 850 name “Marketing Admin”
-> vlan 200
-> vlan 720 disable
-> no vlan 1020
-> vlan 100-105 355 400-410 “Sales Admin”
-> vlan 10 250-260
-> vlan 250-260 disable
-> no vlan 10-15
-> no vlan 10 20 200-210

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan port default Statically assigns ports to a VLAN.


show vlan Displays a list of existing VLANs.
show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.

MIB Objects
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanDescription
vlanAdmStatus
vlanOperStatus
vlanStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-3


VLAN Management Commands

vlan stp
Enables or disables the Spanning Tree status for a VLAN.
vlan vid [1x1 | flat] stp {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid A VLAN ID number (1–4094).
1x1 Specifies that the Spanning Tree status for the VLAN applies when the
switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning Tree mode.
flat Specifies that the Spanning Tree status for the VLAN applies when the
switch is running in the flat Spanning Tree mode.
enable Enables Spanning Tree for the specified VLAN.
disable Disables Spanning Tree for the specified VLAN.

Defaults
By default, the Spanning Tree status is enabled in both the 1x1 and flat mode when the VLAN is created.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• STP is not active until at least one active port is assigned to the VLAN.

• If the vid specified is that of a VLAN that does not exist, the VLAN is automatically created.

• Note that specifying multiple VLAN ID entries and/or a range of VLAN IDs on the same command
line is allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range and a space to separate multiple VLAN ID
entries (e.g., vlan 10-15 500-510 850 stp enable).
• Use the optional 1x1 or flat parameter with this command to configure the Spanning Tree status only
for the Spanning Tree mode specified by the parameter. For example, if the flat parameter is specified
when disabling STP for VLAN 10, then the Spanning Tree status for VLAN 10 is disabled when the
switch is running in the flat mode. However, the current Spanning Tree status for VLAN 10 in the 1x1
mode remains unchanged.
• If this command is used without specifying the 1x1 or flat parameter, then the Spanning Tree status for
the specified VLAN is changed for both operating modes.
• Up to 252 Spanning Tree instances per switch are supported in the 1x1 Spanning Tree mode. Since
each VLAN with Spanning Tree enabled uses one of these instances, only 252 VLANs can have an
active Spanning Tree instance at any given time.
• To create more than 252 VLANs in the 1x1 Spanning Tree mode, use the vlan stp disable, vlan 1x1
stp disable, or vlan flat stp disable command to create a VLAN with Spanning Tree disabled.

page 3-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

• When STP is disabled on a VLAN, it remains disabled even if the switch Spanning Tree operating
mode is set to 1x1 (one STP instance per VLAN). In addition, all active ports for the disabled VLAN
remain in a forwarding state in both the 1x1 and flat Spanning Tree modes.
• If a switch is running in the flat Spanning Tree mode, disabling Spanning Tree on VLAN 1 disables the
instance across all VLANs. Disabling STP on any other VLAN disables the instance only for that
VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 850 stp enable
-> vlan 720 stp disable
-> vlan 500 1x1 stp disable
-> vlan 500 flat stp enable
-> vlan 100-110 stp disable
-> vlan 500-510 600 720-725 stp enable
-> vlan 250 350 400-410 stp 1x1 enable
-> vlan 10 20 stp flat disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan Creates a VLAN.


bridge mode Selects a flat Spanning Tree or 1x1 Spanning Tree operating mode for a
switch.
show vlan Displays a list of existing VLANs.
show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.

MIB Objects
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanStpStatus
vlan1x1StpStatus
vlanflatStpStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-5


VLAN Management Commands

vlan mobile-tag
Enables or disables classification of tagged packets received on mobile ports. If a mobile port receives a
tagged packet with a VLAN ID that matches the specified VLAN ID, the port and packet are dynamically
assigned to that VLAN. If vlan mobile-tag is disabled, the packets tagged with a VLAN ID that does not
match the mobile port’s default VLAN or a rule VLAN that the traffic qualifies for, the packet is dropped.
vlan vid mobile-tag {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
enable Enables dynamic assignment of tagged mobile port packets to the speci-
fied VLAN.
disable Disables dynamic assignment of tagged mobile port packets to the spec-
ified VLAN.

Defaults
By default, mobile port tagging is disabled when a VLAN is created.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Note that specifying multiple VLAN ID entries and/or a range of VLAN IDs on the same command
line is allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range and a space to separate multiple VLAN ID
entries (e.g., vlan 10-15 500-510 850 mobile-tag enable).
• This command is VLAN based but only applies to tagged packets received on mobile ports.

• Packets received on mobile ports tagged with the VLAN ID are discarded.

Examples
-> vlan 850 mobile-tag enable
-> vlan 720 mobile-tag enable
-> vlan 1020 mobile-tag disable
-> vlan 500 410-420 mobile-tag enable
-> vlan 201-210 301-310 mobile-tag enable
-> vlan 450 550 mobile-tag disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 3-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Related Commands

vlan Creates a VLAN.


show vlan Displays a list of existing VLANs.
show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.

MIB Objects
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanTagMobilePortStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-7


VLAN Management Commands

vlan port default


Configures a new default VLAN for a single port or an aggregate of ports. The VLAN specified with this
command is referred to as the configured default VLAN for the port.
vlan vid port default {slot/port | link_agg}
vlan vid no port default {slot/port | link_agg}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094) of the VLAN to assign as the
port’s configured default VLAN.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots and
ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports (e.g.
3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g. 3/1-16 5/10-20 8/2-9).
link_agg The link aggregate ID number (0–31) to assign to the specified VLAN.
See Chapter 6, “Link Aggregation Commands.”

Defaults
VLAN 1 is the default VLAN for all ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a port or link aggregate from its configured default VLAN
and restore VLAN 1 as the default VLAN.
• Every switch port or link aggregate has only one configured default VLAN. Mobile and 802.1Q tagged
ports, however, may have additional VLAN assignments, which are often referred to as secondary
VLANs.
• Mobile ports that are assigned to a default VLAN other than VLAN 1 are still eligible for dynamic
assignment to other VLANs.

Examples
-> vlan 10 port default 3/1
-> vlan 20 port default 4/1-24
-> vlan 30 port default 5/1-8 6/12-24
-> vlan 200 port default 29
-> vlan 10 no port default 3/1
-> vlan 20 no port default 4/1-24
-> vlan 30 no port default 5/1-8 6/12-24
-> vlan 200 no port default 29

page 3-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan Creates a VLAN.


show vlan Displays list of existing VLANs.
show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.

MIB Objects
vpaTable
vpaVlanNumber
vpaIfIndex
vpaType
vpaState
vpaStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-9


VLAN Management Commands

vlan source-learning
Configures the status of source learning on a VLAN, a range of VLANs, or on an IP Multicast VLAN
(IMPVLAN).
vlan {vid1[-vid2] | impvlan ipmvlan-id} source-learning {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid1 The VLAN ID number (2–4094).
-vid2 The last VLAN ID number in a range of VLANs that you want to
configure (e.g. 10-12 specifies VLANs 10, 11, and 12).
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number. The valid range is 1–4094.
enable Enables source MAC address learning.
disable Disables source MAC address learning.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• The vlan ipmvlan source-learning command does not accept multiple VLAN IDs.

• Disabling source learning on a VLAN or IMPVLAN clears all the dynamically learned MAC addresses
associated with the VLAN or IMPVLAN from the MAC address table. It causes traffic to flood the
VLAN.
• Static MAC addresses associated with a VLAN or IMPVLAN are not cleared when source learning is
disabled for the VLAN or IMPVLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10-15 source-learning disable
-> vlan ipmvlan 10 source-learning disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 3-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Related Commands

show vlan Displays the VLAN configuration for the switch.


show vlan ipmvlan Displays IPMVLAN information for a specific IPMVLAN, a range of
IPMVLANs, or all the IPMVLANs.

MIB Objects
vlanTable
vlanEntry
vlanNumber
vlanStatus
vlanMacLearningControlStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-11


VLAN Management Commands

show vlan
Displays a list of VLANs configured on the switch.
show vlan [vid]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults
By default, a list of all VLANs is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify a VLAN ID with this command to display information about a specific VLAN.

• Note that specifying a range of VLAN IDs is also allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range
(e.g., show vlan 10-15). Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of VLAN
IDs— is allowed with this command. Multiple entries are not accepted.

Examples
-> show vlan
stree mble src
vlan type admin oper 1x1 flat auth ip tag lrn name
-----+-----+------+-----+----+-----+----+-----+ ----+-----+---------
1 std on on on on off off off on VLAN 1
100 vstk on off off on off off off off VLAN 100

-> show vlan 1

Name : VLAN 1,
Administrative State: enabled,
Operational State : enabled,
1x1 Spanning Tree State : enabled,
Flat Spanning Tree State : enabled,
IP Router Port : off,
Mobile Tag : off,
Source Learning : enabled

-> show vlan 100

Name : VLAN 100,


Administrative State: enabled,
Operational State : disabled,
1x1 Spanning Tree State : disabled,
Flat Spanning Tree State : enabled,
IP Router Port : off,
IP MTU : 1500,

page 3-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Mobile Tag : off,


Source Learning : disabled,
Traffic-Type: ethernet-service Customer SVLAN,
Priority-Map: x->0

output definitions
vlan The numerical VLAN ID. Use the vlan command to create or remove
VLANs.
type The type of VLAN (std, vstk, gvrp, or ipmv).
admin VLAN administrative status: on enables VLAN functions to operate;
off disables VLAN functions without deleting the VLAN. Use the vlan
command to change the VLAN administrative status.
oper VLAN operational status: on (enabled) or off (disabled). The opera-
tional status remains disabled until an active port is assigned to the
VLAN. When the operational status is enabled, then VLAN properties
(e.g. router interfaces, Spanning Tree) are applied to ports and traffic
flow. A VLAN must have an enabled administrative status before it can
become operationally enabled.
stree 1x1 VLAN Spanning Tree status for the VLAN in the 1x1 mode: on
(enabled) allows the Spanning Tree algorithm to determine the state of
VLAN ports (forwarding or blocking); off (disabled) prevents Span-
ning Tree algorithm from controlling VLAN ports, leaving active ports
in a forwarding state. Configured through the vlan stp command.
stree flat VLAN Spanning Tree status for the VLAN in the flat mode: on
(enabled) allows the Spanning Tree algorithm to determine the state of
VLAN ports (forwarding or blocking); off (disabled) prevents Span-
ning Tree algorithm from controlling VLAN ports, leaving active ports
in a forwarding state. Configured through the vlan stp command.
auth VLAN Authentication status: on (enabled) or off (disabled). Note that
this status is always off because configuring authenticated VLANs is
not supported.
ip IP router interface status: on (IP interface exists for the VLAN) or off
(no IP router interface exists for the VLAN). Use the ip interface com-
mand to define an IP router interface for a VLAN.
mble tag Mobile tagging status: on (enabled); off (disabled). Configured through
the vlan mobile-tag command.
src lrn Source learning status: on (enabled) ; off (disabled). Configured
through the vlan source-learning command.
name The user-defined text description for the VLAN. By default, the VLAN
ID is specified for the VLAN description.
Traffic-Type Type of traffic passing through the VLAN. For example, customer traf-
fic tunneled through a VLAN Stacking Ethernet Service VLAN
(SVLAN). Note this VLAN Stacking is supported only on Metro
switches.
Priority-Map Priority map value set for the VLAN.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-13


VLAN Management Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.


show vlan router mac status Displays the current MAC router operating mode (single or multiple)
and VLAN router interface statistics.
show vlan gvrp Displays a list of VLANs learned through GVRP and their details.
show vlan ipmvlan Displays IPMVLAN information for a specific IPMVLAN, a range of
IPMVLANs, or all the IPMVLANs.
show ip interface Displays IP router information.

MIB Objects
vlanMgrVlan
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanDescription
vlanAdmStatus
vlanOperStatus
vlanStatus
vlanStpStatus
vlanAuthentStatus
vlanIpAddress
vlanIpMask
vlanIpEnacp
vlanIpForward
vlanIpStatus
vlanTagMobilePortStatus

page 3-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

show vlan port


Displays VLAN port associations (VPAs) for all VLANs, a specific VLAN, or for a specific port. Infor-
mation is also included that shows the VPA type (configured default VLAN, 802.1Q tagged VLAN,
dynamically assigned secondary VLAN, or mirrored port VLAN assignment) and the status of that associ-
ation (inactive, blocking, forwarding, or filtering).
show vlan [vid] port [slot/port | link_agg]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
ling_agg Enter the link aggregate ID number (0–31) to assign to the specified
VLAN.

Defaults
If no parameters are specified with this command, a list of all VLANs and their assigned ports is displayed
by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the vid is specified without a slot/port or link_agg, then all port assignments for that VLAN are
displayed.
• If the slot/port or link_agg is specified without a vid, then all VLAN assignments for that port are
displayed.
• If both the vid and slot/port or link_agg are specified, then information only for that VLAN and slot/
port or link aggregate ID is displayed.
• Note that specifying a range of VLAN IDs is also allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous
range (e.g., show vlan 10-15 port). Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of
VLAN IDs— is allowed with this command. Multiple entries are not accepted.

Examples
-> show vlan port
vlan port type status
+-----+-------+---------+------------+
1 1/1 default inactive
2 1/2 default blocking
1/3 mobile forwarding
11/4 qtagged forwarding
3 1/2 qtagged blocking
11/4 default forwarding
2/5 dynamic forwarding

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-15


VLAN Management Commands

-> show vlan 10 port


port type status
+------+--------+------------+
1/1 default forwarding
1/2 qtagged forwarding
1/3 mobile forwarding

-> show vlan port 3/2


vlan type status
+------+---------+------------+
1 default forwarding
2 qtagged forwarding
5 dynamic blocking
3 qtagged blocking

-> show vlan 500 port 8/16


type :default
status :blocking
vlan admin :on
vlan oper :off
port admin :on
port oper :off

output definitions
vlan Numerical VLAN ID. Identifies the port’s VLAN assignment.
port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
type The type of VPA: default (configured default VLAN assignment for
the port), qtagged (802.1Q tagged secondary VLAN assignment for the
port), mobile (dynamic secondary VLAN assignment for the port),
mirror (port is mirroring the VLAN assignment of another port), or
dynamic (VPAs that are learnt through GVRP).
status The VPA status: inactive (port is not active), forwarding (traffic is for-
warding on this VPA), blocking (traffic is not forwarding on this VPA),
or filtering (a mobile port’s VLAN is administratively off or the port’s
default VLAN status is disabled; does not apply to fixed ports).
vlan admin VLAN administrative status: on enables VLAN functions to operate;
off disables VLAN functions without deleting the VLAN. Use the vlan
command to change the VLAN administrative status.
vlan oper VLAN operational status: on (enabled) or off (disabled). The opera-
tional status remains disabled until an active port is assigned to the
VLAN. When the operational status is enabled, then VLAN properties
(e.g. router interfaces, Spanning Tree) are applied to ports and traffic
flow. A VLAN must have an enabled administrative status before it can
become operationally enabled.

page 3-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

output definitions
port admin Port administrative status: on (enabled) allows the port to send and
receive data when it is active; off (disabled) prevents the port from
sending and receiving traffic even if it has an active connection.
port oper Port operational status: on (enabled) or off (disabled). If a port is cur-
rently in use, then the operational status is enabled. A port must have an
enabled administrative status before it can become operationally
enabled.

Release History

Release 6.6.1; command was introduced..

Related Commands

show vlan Displays list of VLANs configured on the switch.


show vlan router mac status Displays the current MAC router operating mode (single or multiple)
and VLAN router interface statistics.
show vlan gvrp Displays a list of VLANs learned through GVRP and their details.
show vlan ipmvlan Displays IPMVLAN information for a specific IPMVLAN, a range of
IPMVLANs, or all the IPMVLANs.
show ip interface Displays IP router information.

MIB Objects
vlanMgrVpa
vpaTable
vpaVlanNumber
vpaIfIndex
vpaType
vpaState
vpaStatus
vlanMgrVlan
vlanTable
vlanAdmStatus
vlanOperStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-17


VLAN Management Commands

show vlan router mac status


Displays current status of multiple MAC router mode, the number of VLANs configured on the switch, the
number of VLANs with router interfaces and the number of IP router interfaces configured.
show vlan router mac status

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Only single MAC router mode is supported at this tine, so multiple MAC router mode always displays
as disabled.
• In single MAC router mode, a maximum of 4094 VLANs can have IP router interfaces defined. Note
that these limits are subject to the availability of switch resources.

Examples
-> show vlan router mac status
router-mac-multiple total vlans router vlans ip vlans
----------------------+-------------+--------------+----------
disabled 5 1 1

output definitions
router-mac-multiple Multiple MAC router mode status: enabled or disabled. If this mode is
disabled, the switch is running in single MAC router mode.
total vlans The total number of VLANs configured on the switch. Use the vlan
command to create or remove VLANs.
router vlans The total number of VLANs configured on the switch that have at least
one router interface defined (IP). Use the ip interface command to
define an IP router interface for a VLAN.
ip vlans The total number of VLANs configured on the switch that have an IP
router interface defined. Use the ip interface command to define an IP
router for a VLAN.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 3-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Related Commands

show vlan Displays list of VLANs configured on the switch.


show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.
show ip interface Displays VLAN IP router interface information.

MIB Objects
vlanMgrVlanSet
vlanSetMultiRtrMacStatus
vlanSetVlanCount
vlanSetVlanRouterCount
vlanSetIpRouterCount

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-19


VLAN Management Commands

show vlan gvrp


Displays a list of VLANs learned through GVRP and their details.
show vlan gvrp [vlan-id | vlan-range]

Syntax Definitions
vlan-id VLAN ID number you want to display (1–4094).
vlan-range The VLAN ID range (e.g., 1-10).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the vlan-id or vlan-range parameter with this command to display the details for a specific VLAN(s).

Examples
-> show vlan gvrp
stree mble
vlan type admin oper 1x1 flat auth ip tag name
----+-----+-----+----+-----+--------+-------+------+-----+--------------
5 gvrp on on on on off NA off GVRP1
6 gvrp on on off off off NA off GVRP12

output definitions
vlan The numerical VLAN ID. Use the vlan command to create or remove
VLANs.
type The type of VLAN (std, vstk, gvrp, or ipmv)
admin VLAN administrative status: on enables VLAN functions to operate;
off disables VLAN functions without deleting the VLAN. Use the vlan
command to change the VLAN administrative status.
oper VLAN operational status: on (enabled) or off (disabled). The opera-
tional status remains disabled until an active port is assigned to the
VLAN. When the operational status is enabled, then VLAN properties
(e.g. router interfaces, Spanning Tree) are applied to ports and traffic
flow. A VLAN must have an enabled administrative status before it can
become operationally enabled.

page 3-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

output definitions (continued)


stree 1x1 VLAN Spanning Tree status for the VLAN in the 1x1 mode: on
(enabled) allows the Spanning Tree algorithm to determine the state of
VLAN ports (forwarding or blocking); off (disabled) prevents Span-
ning Tree algorithm from controlling VLAN ports, leaving active ports
in a forwarding state. Configured through the vlan stp command.
stree flat VLAN Spanning Tree status for the VLAN in the flat mode: on
(enabled) allows the Spanning Tree algorithm to determine the state of
VLAN ports (forwarding or blocking); off (disabled) prevents Span-
ning Tree algorithm from controlling VLAN ports, leaving active ports
in a forwarding state. Configured through the vlan stp command.
ip IP router interface status: on (IP interface exists for the VLAN) or off
(no IP router interface exists for the VLAN). Use the ip interface com-
mand to define an IP router interface for a VLAN.
mble tag Mobile tagging status: on (enabled); off (disabled). Configured through
the vlan mobile-tag command.
name The user-defined text description for the VLAN. By default, the VLAN
ID is specified for the VLAN description.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan Displays a list of VLANs configured on the switch.


show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-21


VLAN Management Commands

MIB Objects
vlanMgrVlan
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanDescription
vlanAdmStatus
vlanOperStatus
vlanStatus
vlanStpStatus
vlanAuthentStatus
vlanIpAddress
vlanIpMask
vlanIpEnacp
vlanIpForward
vlanIpStatus
vlanTagMobilePortStatus

page 3-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

show vlan ipmvlan


Displays IPMVLAN information for a specific IPMVLAN, a range of IPMVLANs, or all the IPMVLANs.
show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id | ipmvlan-id1-ipmvlan-id2]

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number. The valid range is 2–4094.
ipmvlan-id1-ipmvlan-id2 Specifies the range of the IP Multicast VLAN numbers.

Defaults
By default, the details of all the IPMVLANs will be displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the ipmvlan-id parameter with this command to display details of a specific IPMVLAN.

• Use the ipmvlan-id1-ipmvlan-id2 parameter with this command to display details of a range of
IPMVLANs.

Examples
-> show vlan ipmvlan

stree
vlan type admin oper 1x1 flat name
------+------------+-------+--------+--------------+--------------
1201 Vstk ipmtv on on on on VLAN 1201
1202 Vstk ipmtv on on off off VLAN 1202
1203 Entp ipmtv on on off off VLAN 1203
1204 Vstk ipmtv on on on on VLAN 1204
1205 Entp ipmtv on off on off VLAN 1205

-> show vlan ipmvlan 1201-1203

stree
vlan type admin oper 1x1 flat name
------+------------+-------+--------+--------------+--------------
1201 Vstk ipmtv on on on on VLAN 1201
1202 Vstk ipmtv on on off off VLAN 1202
1203 Entp ipmtv on on off off VLAN 1203

-> show vlan ipmvlan 50

Name : VLAN 50,


IPMV Mode : Enterprise IPMVLAN
Administrative State: enabled,
Operational State : disabled,

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-23


VLAN Management Commands

1x1 Spanning Tree State : disabled,


Flat Spanning Tree State: disabled,

-> show vlan ipmvlan 51

Name : VLAN 51,


IPMV Mode : Vlan Stacking IPMVLAN
Administrative State : enabled,
Operational State : disabled,
1x1 Spanning Tree State : enabled,
Flat Spanning Tree State: enabled,

output definitions
vlan The IPMVLAN ID.
type Indicates if the IPMVLAN is in Enterprise mode (Entp ipmtv) or
VLAN Stacking mode (Vstk ipmtv).
admin Indicates IPMVLAN administrative status: on (enables IPMVLAN
functions to operate) or off (disables IPMVLAN functions without
deleting the IPMVLAN).
oper IPMVLAN operational status: on (enabled) or off (disabled). Opera-
tional status remains disabled until an active port is assigned to the
IPMVLAN. When operational status is enabled, IPMVLAN properties
(e.g. router interfaces, Spanning Tree) are applied to ports and traffic
flow. An IPMVLAN must have an enabled administrative status before
it can become operationally enabled.
Name The user-defined text description for the IPMVLAN. By default, the
IPMVLAN ID is specified for the IPMVLAN description.
IPMV mode Indicates the mode (Enterprise IPMVLAN or Vlan Stacking IPMV-
LAN) of the IPMVLAN.
Administrative State Indicates the administrative status of the IPMVLAN, which can be
enabled or disabled.
Operational State Indicates the operational status of the IPMVLAN, which can be
enabled or disabled.
stree 1x1 VLAN Spanning Tree status for the VLAN in the 1x1 mode: on
(enabled) allows the Spanning Tree algorithm to determine the state of
VLAN ports (forwarding or blocking); off (disabled) prevents Span-
ning Tree algorithm from controlling VLAN ports, leaving active ports
in a forwarding state. Configured through the vlan stp command.
stree flat VLAN Spanning Tree status for the VLAN in the flat mode: on
(enabled) allows the Spanning Tree algorithm to determine the state of
VLAN ports (forwarding or blocking); off (disabled) prevents Span-
ning Tree algorithm from controlling VLAN ports, leaving active ports
in a forwarding state. Configured through the vlan stp command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 3-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


VLAN Management Commands

Related Commands

vlan ipmvlan Creates an IP Multicast VLAN.


show vlan Displays a list of VLANs configured on the switch.
show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments.

MIB Objects
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanDescription
vlanTrafficType
alavlanOperStatus
alavlanAdmStatus
alavlanStpStatus
alavlan1x1StpStatus
alavlanflatStpStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3-25


VLAN Management Commands

page 3-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


4 802.1Q Commands

Alcatel-Lucent’s 802.1Q is an IEEE standard for sending frames through the network tagged with VLAN
identification. This chapter details configuring and monitoring 802.1Q tagging on a single port in a switch
or an aggregate of ports on a switch.
Alcatel-Lucent’s version of 802.1Q complies with the Draft Standard P802.1Q/D11 IEEE Standards for
Local And Metropolitan Area Network: Virtual Bridged Local Area Networks, July 30, 1998.
MIB information for the 802.1Q commands is as follows:
Filename: alcatelIND1Dot1Q.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-DOT1Q-MIB
A summary of available commands is listed here:

vlan 802.1q
vlan 802.1q frame type
show 802.1q

Note. Before using 802.1Q, the VLAN for 802.1Q must be created using the commands described in
Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands.”

Configuration procedures for 802.1Q are explained in “Configuring 802.1Q,” OmniSwitch 6450 Network
Configuration Guide.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 4-1


802.1Q Commands

vlan 802.1q
Creates, deletes, or modifies 802.1Q tagging on a single port or on an aggregate of ports.
vlan vid 802.1q {slot/port | aggregate_id} [description]
vlan vid no 802.1q {slot/port | aggregate_id}

Syntax Definitions
vid The VLAN identification number for a preconfigured VLAN that will
handle the 802.1Q traffic for this port. The valid range is 1 to 4094.
slot The slot number for the 802.1Q tagging.
port The port number for the 802.1Q tagging.
aggregate_id The link aggregation ID, which allows you to configure 802.1Q tagging
on an aggregate of ports. The valid range is 1 to 31.
description An optional textual description (up to 32 characters) for this 802.1Q tag.
Spaces must be unclosed within quotation marks (e.g., “802.1Q tag 2”).

Defaults
The default description for 802.1Q tagging on a port is TAG PORT slot/port VLAN vid (where the slot/
port and vid are as entered when inputting the command) when you configure 802.1Q tagging on a single
port, and TAG AGGREGATE aggregate_id VLAN vid (where the slot/port and vid are as entered when
inputting the command) when you configure 802.1q tagging on an aggregate link.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete 802.1Q tagging on a port or an aggregate of ports.

• The VLAN specified for the port or aggregate link before 802.1Q tagging can be specified. See
Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands” for information on how to create a VLAN.
• You must enable link aggregation before you can tag an aggregate of ports. See Chapter 6, “Link
Aggregation Commands” for more information on link aggregation.
• The port’s default VLAN can never be configured to accepted tagged frames.

Examples
-> vlan 2 802.1q 3/1
-> vlan 10 802.1q 100
-> vlan 5 802.1q 4/2 "802.1q tag 2"
-> vlan 6 no 802.1q 3/1

page 4-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1Q Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan 802.1q frame type Configures a port to accept only VLAN-tagged frames or all frames.
show 802.1q Displays 802.1Q tagging status and configuration.

MIB Objects
QPORTVLANTABLE
qPortVlanSlot
qPortVlanPort
qPortVLanStatus
qPortVlanTagValue
qPortVlanDescription
qAggregateVlanTagValue
qAggregateVlanAggregateId
qAggregateVlanStatus
qAggregateVlanDescription

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 4-3


802.1Q Commands

vlan 802.1q frame type


Configures a port to accept all frames or accept only VLAN-tagged frames.
vlan 802.1q slot/port frame type {all | tagged}

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number to configure 802.1Q tagging.
port The port number to configure 802.1Q tagging.
all Configures this port to accept all frames.
tagged Configures this port to accept only VLAN-tagged frames.

Defaults

parameter default
all | tagged all

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you configure a port to accept only VLAN-tagged frames, then any frames received on this port that do
not carry a VLAN ID (i.e., untagged frames or priority-tagged frames) will be discarded by the ingress
rules for this port. Frames that are not discarded by this ingress rule are classified and processed according
to the ingress rules for this port.

Examples
-> vlan 802.1q 3/1 frame type all

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 4-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1Q Commands

Related Commands

vlan 802.1q Creates, modifies, or deletes 802.1Q tagging on a single port or an


aggregate of ports.
show 802.1q Displays 802.1Q tagging status and configuration.

MIB Objects
DOT1QPORTVLANTABLE
dot1dBasePort
dot1qPortAcceptableFrameTypes

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 4-5


802.1Q Commands

show 802.1q
Displays 802.1Q tagging information for a single port or an aggregate of ports.
show 802.1q {slot/port | aggregate_id}

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number to display 802.1Q tagging.
port The port number to display 802.1Q tagging.
aggregate_id The link aggregation ID to display 802.1Q tagging. See Chapter 6,
“Link Aggregation Commands” for more information on link aggrega-
tion.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show 802.1q 3/4

Acceptable Frame Type : Any Frame Type


Force Tag Internal : off

Tagged VLANS Internal Description


-------------+-------------------------------------------------+
2 TAG PORT 3/4 VLAN 2

-> show 802.1q 2

Tagged VLANS Internal Description


-------------+-------------------------------------------------+
3 TAG AGGREGATE 2 VLAN 3

Output fields are described here:

output definitions
Acceptable Frame Type The acceptable frame type for this port, which can be Any Frame
Type or Tagged Only Frame Type.
Force Tag Internal This field displays if adding the default VLAN ID (VID) to tagged
frames is turned on or off.

page 4-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1Q Commands

output definitions (continued)


Tagged VLANS The 802.1Q tag number for this port.
Internal Description The description of this 802.1Q tag. You can modify this description
with the vlan 802.1q command, which is described on page 4-2.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan 802.1q Creates, modifies, or deletes 802.1Q tagging on a single port or an


aggregate of ports.
vlan 802.1q frame type Configures a port to accept only VLAN-tagged frames or all frames.

MIB Objects
QPORTVLANTABLE
qPortVlanSlot
qPortVlanPort
qPortVLanStatus
qPortVlanTagValue
qPortVlanDescription
qAggregateVlanTagValue
qAggregateVlanAggregateId
qAggregateVlanStatus
qAggregateVlanDescription

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 4-7


802.1Q Commands

page 4-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


5 Distributed Spanning
Tree Commands

The Spanning Tree Algorithm and Protocol (STP) is a self-configuring algorithm that maintains a loop-
free topology while providing data path redundancy and network scalability. Based on the IEEE 802.1D
standard, the Alcatel-Lucent STP implementation distributes the Spanning Tree load between the primary
management module and the network interface modules. In the case of a stack of switches, the STP load is
distributed between the primary management switch and other switches in the stack. This functionality
improves network robustness by providing a Spanning Tree that continues to respond to BPDUs and port
link up and down states in the event of a fail over to a backup management module or switch.
In addition to a distributed architecture, this implementation also provides the following Spanning Tree
features:
• Automatic configuration of a physical topology into a single Spanning Tree to ensure that there is only
one data path between any two switches.
• Fault tolerance within the network topology. The Spanning Tree is reconfigured in the event of a data
path or bridge failure or when a new switch is added to the topology.
• Support for four Spanning Tree protocols: 802.1D (STP), 802.1W (RSTP), 802.1Q 2005 (MSTP), and
RRSTP.
• A flat Spanning Tree operating mode. If STP or RSTP is used, this mode applies a single STP instance
across all VLANs. If MSTP is used, this mode applies a single STP instance to each Multiple Span-
ning Tree Instance (MSTI), which identifies a set of VLANs.
• Support for up to 16 MSTIs per switch. In addition, there is always one Common and Internal Span-
ning Tree (CIST) instance 0 on each switch.
• Ring Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RRSTP) supports up to 128 rings per switch. Note that there can
be no alternate connections for the same instance between any two switches within an RRSTP ring
topology.
• A 1x1 Spanning Tree operating mode, which applies a single STP instance for each defined VLAN on
the switch.
• An STP topology that includes 802.1Q tagged ports and link aggregate logical ports in the calculation
of the physical topology.
MIB information for Distributed Spanning Tree commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1VlanSTP.MIB
Module: STP-MGMT-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 5-1


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here:

Implicit bridge commands bridge mode


bridge protocol
bridge priority
bridge hello time
bridge max age
bridge forward delay
bridge bpdu-switching
bridge path cost mode
bridge auto-vlan-containment
show spantree
Explicit bridge commands bridge cist protocol
bridge 1x1 protocol
bridge cist priority
bridge msti priority
bridge 1x1 priority
bridge cist hello time
bridge 1x1 hello time
bridge cist max age
bridge 1x1 max age
bridge cist forward delay
bridge 1x1 forward delay
show spantree cist
show spantree msti
show spantree 1x1
Implicit port commands bridge slot/port
bridge slot/port priority
bridge slot/port path cost
bridge slot/port mode
bridge slot/port connection
show spantree ports

page 5-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Explicit port commands bridge cist slot/port


bridge 1x1 slot/port
bridge cist slot/port priority
bridge msti slot/port priority
bridge 1x1 slot/port priority
bridge cist slot/port path cost
bridge msti slot/port path cost
bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost
bridge cist slot/port mode
bridge 1x1 slot/port mode
bridge cist slot/port connection
bridge 1x1 slot/port connection
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge
bridge 1x1 slot/port admin-edge
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge
bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge
bridge cist slot/port restricted-role
bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-role
bridge cist slot/port restricted-tcn
bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn
bridge cist txholdcount
bridge 1x1 txholdcount
show spantree cist ports
show spantree msti ports
show spantree 1x1 ports
MST region commands bridge mst region name
bridge mst region revision level
bridge mst region max hops
show spantree mst region
MST instance commands bridge msti
bridge msti vlan
show spantree msti vlan-map
show spantree cist vlan-map
show spantree map-msti
show spantree mst port
RRSTP commands bridge rrstp
bridge rrstp ring
bridge rrstp ring vlan-tag
bridge rrstp ring status
show bridge rrstp configuration
show bridge rrstp ring
PVST+ commands bridge mode 1x1 pvst+
bridge port pvst+

page 5-3 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge mode
Selects a flat Spanning Tree or 1x1 Spanning Tree operating mode for the switch. These modes are exclu-
sive; however, it is not necessary to reboot the switch when changing modes.
bridge mode {flat | 1x1}

Syntax Definitions
flat One Spanning Tree instance per switch.
1x1 One Spanning Tree instance for each VLAN configured on a switch.

Defaults
By default, the bridge mode for the switch is set to 1x1 Spanning Tree.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP), as defined in the IEEE 802.1Q 2005 standard, is only
supported on switches operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode.
• If standard STP or RSTP is used when the switch is running in the flat mode, a single STP instance is
applied across all VLANs. For example, if a port belonging to VLAN 10 and a port belonging to
VLAN 20 both connect to the same switch, then STP will block one of these ports.
• If MSTP is used when the switch is running in the flat mode, a single STP instance is applied to each
Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI). Each MSTI represents a set of VLANs.
• Flat Spanning Tree mode supports fixed (untagged) and 802.1Q tagged ports in each VLAN. However,
Bridge Protocol Data Units (BPDUs) are always untagged.
• If 1x1 mode is selected, a single Spanning Tree instance is enabled for each VLAN configured on the
switch. For example, if there are five VLANs configured on the switch, then there are five separate
Spanning Tree instances. In essence, a VLAN is a virtual bridge in that it will have its own bridge ID
and configurable STP parameters, such as protocol, priority, hello time, max age, and forward delay.
• When operating in 1x1 mode, 802.1Q tagged ports participate in an 802.1Q Spanning Tree instance
that allows the Spanning Tree to extend across tagged VLANs. As a result, a tagged port may partici-
pate in more than one Spanning Tree instance; one for each VLAN that the port carries.
• If a VLAN contains both fixed and tagged ports and the switch is operating in 1x1 Spanning Tree
mode, then a hybrid of the two Spanning Tree instances (single and 802.1Q) is applied. If a VLAN
appears as a tag on a port, then the BPDU for that VLAN are also tagged. However, if a VLAN appears
as the configured default VLAN for the port, then BPDU are not tagged and the single Spanning Tree
instance applies.
• Regardless of which mode the switch is running in, it is possible to administratively disable the Span-
ning Tree status for an individual VLAN (see Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands”). Note that
active ports associated with such a VLAN are excluded from any Spanning Tree calculations and will
remain in a forwarding state.

page 5-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge mode 1x1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge protocol Selects the Spanning Tree protocol for the specified instance.
bridge bpdu-switching Enables the switching of Spanning Tree BPDU on a VLAN that has
Spanning Tree disabled.
show spantree Displays VLAN Spanning Tree parameter values.

MIB Objects
vStpTable
vStpNumber
vStpMode

page 5-5 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge protocol
Configures the Spanning Tree protocol for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance or for an individual VLAN instance if the switch is running in the 1x1 mode.
bridge [instance] protocol {stp | rstp | mstp}

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance (1) or an existing 1x1 mode VLAN ID
instance number (bridge 1–4094).
stp IEEE 802.1D standard Spanning Tree Algorithm and Protocol.
rstp IEEE 802.1W Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol.
mstp IEEE 802.1Q 2005 Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol.

Defaults
RSTP is the default protocol for the flat mode CIST instance and for the 1x1 mode VLAN instance.

parameter default
instance flat mode instance

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the protocol for the associated VLAN instance.
• To configure the protocol for the flat mode CIST instance when the switch is running in either the flat
or 1x1 mode, do not specify an instance number. The CIST is the instance configured by default with
this command.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, entering 1 to specify
the CIST instance is optional. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance
number is not accepted.
• Note that selecting MSTP is only an option for the flat mode CIST instance and is required to config-
ure Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI).
• MSTP is only active when the switch is operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode. STP and RSTP are
active when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 Spanning Tree mode.
• Deleting all existing MSTIs is required before changing the protocol from MSTP to STP or RSTP.

page 5-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• Note that when changing the protocol to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path cost values for
the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values. However, if the path cost mode was set to
32-bit prior to the protocol change, the path cost is not reset to its default value. See the bridge path
cost mode command page for more information.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge protocol mstp
-> bridge protocol rstp
-> bridge protocol stp

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 10 protocol rstp
-> bridge 200 protocol stp
-> bridge protocol mstp
-> bridge protocol rstp
-> bridge protocol stp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist protocol Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree protocol for the flat
mode instance.
bridge 1x1 protocol Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree protocol for a VLAN
instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsProtocolSpecification

page 5-7 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist protocol


Configures the Spanning Tree protocol for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance (bridge 1).
bridge cist protocol {stp | rstp | mstp}

Syntax Definitions
stp IEEE 802.1D standard Spanning Tree Algorithm and Protocol.
rstp IEEE 802.1w Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol.
mstp IEEE 802.1Q 2005 Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol.

Defaults
RSTP is the default protocol for the flat mode CIST instance and for the 1x1 mode VLAN instance.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the flat mode CIST instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• Use this command to select STP, RSTP, or MSTP as the protocol for the flat mode CIST instance.

• Note that selecting MSTP is only an option for the flat mode CIST instance and is required to config-
ure Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI).
• MSTP is only active when the switch is operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode. STP and RSTP are
active when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 Spanning Tree mode.
• Note that when changing the protocol to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path cost values for
the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values. However, if the path cost mode was set to
32-bit prior to the protocol change, the path cost is not reset to its default value. See the bridge path
cost mode command page for more information.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified protocol is not active for
the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge cist protocol rstp
-> bridge cist protocol mstp
-> bridge cist protocol stp

page 5-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge protocol Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree protocol for the flat
mode instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 protocol Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree protocol for a VLAN
instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsProtocolSpecification

page 5-9 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 protocol


Configures the Spanning Tree protocol for an individual VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 vid protocol {stp | rstp}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
stp IEEE 802.1D standard Spanning Tree Algorithm and Protocol.
rstp IEEE 802.1w Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol.

Defaults
RSTP is the default protocol for the flat mode CIST instance and for the 1x1 mode VLAN instance.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in flat mode when this command is used, the specified protocol is not active for
the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to 1x1.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge 1x1 2 protocol stp
-> bridge 1x1 455 protocol rstp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge protocol Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree protocol for the flat
mode instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist protocol Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree protocol for the flat
mode instance.

page 5-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpIns1x1VlanNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsProtocolSpecification

page 5-11 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge mst region name


Defines the name for a Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) region. One of three attributes (name, revision
level, and a VLAN to MST instance association table) that defines an MST region as required by the IEEE
802.1Q 2005 standard. Switches that share the same attribute values are all considered part of the same
MST region. Currently each switch can belong to one MST region at a time.
bridge mst region name name
bridge mst region no name

Syntax Definitions
name An alphanumeric string up to 32 characters. Use quotes around string if
the name contains multiple words with spaces between them (e.g.
“Alcatel-Lucent Marketing”).

Defaults
By default, the MST region name is left blank.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the MST region name. Note that it is not necessary to
specify the region name to remove it.
• To change an existing region name, use this same command but specify a string value that is different
than the existing name. It is not necessary to first remove the old name.
• Specifying an MST region name is allowed regardless of which Spanning Tree operating mode or
protocol is currently active on the switch. However, MST configuration values, such as region name,
only apply when the switch is operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode and using MSTP.

Examples
-> bridge mst region name SalesRegion
-> bridge mst region name “Alcatel-Lucent Marketing”
-> bridge mst region no name

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mst region revision level Defines the revision level for an MST region.
bridge mst region max hops Defines the maximum number of hops for the MST region.
bridge msti Defines a MSTI number that identifies an association between a range
of VLANs and a Spanning Tree instance.
bridge msti vlan Defines an association between a range of VLANs and a single MSTI.

MIB Objects
vStpMstRegionTable
vStpMstRegionNumber
vStpMstRegionConfigName

page 5-13 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge mst region revision level


Defines the revision level for a Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) region. One of three attributes (name, revi-
sion level, and a VLAN to MST instance association table) that defines an MST region as required by the
IEEE 802.1Q 2005 standard. Switches that share the same attribute values are all considered part of the
same MST region. Currently each switch can belong to one MST region at a time.
bridge mst region revision level rev_level

Syntax Definitions
rev_level A numeric value (0–65535) that identifies the MST region revision level
for the switch.

Defaults
By default, the MST revision level is set to zero.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Specifying an MST region revision level is allowed regardless of which Spanning Tree operating mode or
protocol is currently active on the switch. However, MST configuration values, such as revision level, only
apply when the switch is operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode and using the MSTP.

Examples
-> bridge mst region revision level 1000
-> bridge mst region revision level 2000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mst region name Defines the name for an MST region.
bridge mst region max hops Defines the maximum number of hops for the MST region.
bridge msti Defines a MSTI number that identifies an association between a range
of VLANs and a Spanning Tree instance.
bridge msti vlan Defines an association between a range of VLANs and a single MSTI.

MIB Objects
vStpMstRegionTable
vStpMstRegionNumber
vStpMstRegionConfigRevisionLevel

page 5-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge mst region max hops


Configures the maximum number of hops that are authorized to receive Multiple Spanning Tree (MST)
regional information. Use this command to designate how many hops a BPDU is allowed to traverse
before it is discarded and related information is aged.
bridge mst region max hops max_hops

Syntax Definitions
max_hops A numeric value (1–40) that designates the maximum number of hops.

Defaults
By default, the maximum number of hops is set to 20.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The value configured with this command is a regional value that applies to all instances and in essence
is used to determine the size of the region.
• The maximum hop count value is the initial value of the Remaining Hops parameter in the MST BPDU
that originates from the bridge that is serving as the root bridge for the region. Each bridge that in turn
receives the MST BPDU decrements the Remaining Hops count value by one and passes the new value
along to the next bridge. When the count reaches 0, the BPDU is discarded.
• Specifying an MST maximum hop count is allowed regardless of which Spanning Tree operating mode
or protocol is currently active on the switch. However, MST configuration values only apply when the
switch is operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode and using the MSTP.

Examples
-> bridge mst region max hops 40
-> bridge mst region max hops 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-15 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mst region name Defines the name for an MST region.
bridge mst region revision level Defines the revision level for an MST region.
bridge msti Defines a MSTI number that identifies an association between a range
of VLANs and a Spanning Tree instance.
bridge msti vlan Defines an association between a range of VLANs and a single MSTI.

MIB Objects
vStpMstRegionTable
vStpMstRegionNumber
vStpMstRegionMaxHops

page 5-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge msti
Defines a Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) number. This number identifies an association between
a range of VLANs and a single Spanning Tree instance. In addition, it is possible to assign an optional
name to the MSTI for further identification.
bridge msti msti_id [name name]
bridge no msti msti_id
bridge msti msti_id no name

Syntax Definitions
msti_id A numeric value (1–4094) that uniquely identifies an MSTI.
name An alphanumeric string up to 32 characters. Use quotes around string if
the name contains multiple words with spaces between them (e.g.
“Alcatel-Lucent Marketing”).

Defaults
By default, a flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance always exists. The MSTI ID
number for this instance is 0.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no msti form of this command to remove the MSTI from the switch configuration.

• Use the no name form of this command to remove the optional MSTI name from the specified
instance. The instance itself is not removed; only the name.
• Up to 16 MSTIs are allowed per switch; select a number from 1 to 4094 for the MSTI number. In addi-
tion, there is always one Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance 0 per switch. Initially all
VLANs are associated with the CIST instance.
• Creating an MSTI is allowed when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree
mode, as long as MSTP is the selected flat mode protocol. The MSTI configuration, however, is not
active unless the switch is running in the flat mode.

Examples
-> bridge msti 10
-> bridge msti 20 name BldgOneST10
-> bridge msti 20 no name
-> bridge no msti 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-17 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mst region name Defines the name for an MST region.
bridge mst region revision level Defines the revision level for an MST region.
bridge mst region max hops Defines the maximum number of hops for the MST region.
bridge msti vlan Defines an association between a range of VLANs and a single MSTI.

MIB Objects
vStpMstInstanceTable
vStpMstInstanceNumber
vStpMstInstanceName
vStpMstInstanceVlanBitmapAddition
vStpMstInstanceVlanBitmapDeletion
vStpMstInstanceVlanBitmapState

page 5-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge msti vlan


Defines an association between a range of VLANs and a single Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI).
The MSTI-to-VLAN mapping created with this command is one of three attributes (name, revision level,
and a VLAN to MST instance association table) that defines an MST region as required by the IEEE
802.1Q 2005 standard. Switches that share the same attribute values are all considered part of the same
MST region. Currently each switch can belong to one MST region at a time.
bridge msti msti_id vlan vid_range
bridge msti msti_id no vlan vid_range

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0–4094).
vid_range A VLAN ID number (1–4094) To associate multiple VLANS in a single
command, use a hyphen to specify a range of VLAN IDs and a space to
separate multiple VLAN IDs and/or ranges
(e.g. 100-115 122 135 200-210).

Defaults
By default, all VLANs are associated with the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance, which is also known as MSTI 0.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a VLAN or a range of VLANs from the specified MSTI
association.
• Note that the VLAN ID specified with this command does not have to already exist in the switch
configuration. This command maps VLAN IDs to MSTIs, but does not create VLANs.
• A VLAN is associated with only one MSTI at a time, but it is possible to move a VLAN from one
MSTI to another. In addition, it is also possible to assign only one VLAN to an MSTI; a range of
VLANs is not required.
• Configuring an MSTI-to-VLAN mapping is allowed when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or
flat Spanning Tree mode, as long as MSTP is the selected flat mode protocol. The MSTI configura-
tion, however, is not active unless the switch is running in the flat mode.

Examples
-> bridge msti 10 vlan 100-115
-> bridge msti 20 vlan 122 135 200-210
-> bridge msti 10 no vlan 112 200-204

page 5-19 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mst region name Defines the name for an MST region.
bridge mst region revision level Defines the revision level for an MST region.
bridge mst region max hops Defines the maximum number of hops for the MST region.
bridge msti Defines a MSTI number that identifies an association between a range
of VLANs and a Spanning Tree instance.

MIB Objects
vStpMstVlanAssignmentTable
vStpMstVlanAssignmentVlanNumber
vStpMstVlanAssignmentMstiNumber

page 5-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge priority
Configures the bridge priority value for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance. Bridge priority is used to determine which bridge the Span-
ning Tree algorithm designates as the root bridge.
bridge [instance] priority priority

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
priority A bridge priority value within the range of 0–65535. Do not use
commas in the value. If MSTP is the active protocol on the switch, then
a bridge priority value that is a multiple of 4096 is required.

Defaults
By default, the bridge priority value is set to 32768.

parameter default
instance flat mode instance

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The bridge priority specifies the priority value for the first two octets of the Bridge ID (eight octets
long). The remaining six octets of the Bridge ID contain a dedicated bridge MAC address.
• The lower the bridge priority number, the higher the priority that is associated with the bridge.

• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the priority value for the associated VLAN instance.
• To configure the priority value for the flat mode CIST instance when the switch is running in either the
flat or 1x1 mode, do not specify an instance number. The CIST is the instance configured by default
with this command.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, entering 1 to specify
the CIST instance is optional. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance
number is not accepted. In this case, use the bridge cist priority or bridge msti priority commands
instead.
• Note that when the protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority for the flat mode CIST
instance is reset to the default value.

page 5-21 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge priority 8192
-> bridge priority 2500
ERROR: Valid bridge priority values are multiples of 4096: 0, 4096,
8192, 12288, 16384 ... 61440

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 255 priority 16384
-> bridge 355 priority 3500
-> bridge priority 8192

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for the CIST
instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.
bridge msti priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for an MSTI
when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.
bridge 1x1 protocol Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for a VLAN
instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress

page 5-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist priority


Configures the Spanning Tree priority value for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance. Bridge priority is used to determine which bridge the Spanning Tree algorithm designates as the
root bridge.
bridge cist priority priority

Syntax Definitions
priority A bridge priority value within the range of 0–65535. Do not use
commas in the value. If MSTP is the active protocol on the switch, then
a bridge priority value that is a multiple of 4096 is required.

Defaults
By default, the bridge priority value is set to 32768.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The bridge priority specifies the priority value for the first two octets of the Bridge ID (eight octets
long). The remaining six octets of the Bridge ID contain a dedicated bridge MAC address.
• The lower the bridge priority number, the higher the priority that is associated with the bridge.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the CIST instance regardless
of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified priority value is not
active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when the protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority for the flat mode CIST
instance is reset to the default value.
• In regards to the priority for a Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI), only the four most significant
bits are used.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist priority 16384
-> bridge cist priority 53800
ERROR: Valid bridge priority values are multiples of 4096: 0, 4096,
8192, 12288, 16384 ... 61440

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist priority 16384
-> bridge cist priority 12288

page 5-23 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge priority Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for the flat
mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge msti priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for an MSTI
when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.
bridge 1x1 protocol Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for a VLAN
instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress

page 5-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge msti priority


Configures the bridge priority value for an Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI). Bridge priority is
used to determine which bridge the Spanning Tree algorithm designates as the root bridge.
bridge msti msti_id priority priority

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0–4094).
priority A bridge priority value that is a multiple of 4096 and within the range of
0–65535. Do not use commas in the value.

Defaults
By default, the bridge priority value is set to 32768.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The bridge priority specifies the priority value for the first two octets of the Bridge ID (eight octets
long). The remaining six octets of the Bridge ID contain a dedicated bridge MAC address.
• The bridge priority value for an MSTI is calculated by adding the configured priority value to the Span-
ning Tree instance number. For example, if the priority value of MSTI 10 equals 32768 (the default),
then the Spanning Tree priority value advertised for this instance is 32770 (32768 + 10).
• The lower the bridge priority number, the higher the priority that is associated with the bridge.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified MSTI regard-
less of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch. If MSTP is not the selected flat mode
protocol, however, the priority value for any MSTI is not configurable in either mode.
• Note that if zero is entered for the msti_id value, the specified priority value is applied to the CIST
instance. The flat mode CIST instance 0 is also known as MSTI 0.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified priority value is not
active for the specified MSTI until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when the protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority for the flat mode CIST
instance is reset to the default value.
• In regards to the priority for an MSTI, only the four most significant bits are used.

page 5-25 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge msti 2 priority 4096
-> bridge msti 10 priority 53800
ERROR: Valid bridge priority values are multiples of 4096: 0, 4096,
8192, 12288, 16384 ... 61440

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge msti 2 priority 61440
-> bridge msti 10 priority 12288

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects a flat Spanning Tree or 1x1 (per VLAN) Spanning Tree operat-
ing mode for the switch.
bridge priority Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for the flat
mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for the CIST
instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.
bridge 1x1 priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for a VLAN
instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsMstiNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress

page 5-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 priority


Configures the bridge priority value for an individual VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 vid priority priority

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
priority A bridge priority value within the range of 0–65535. Do not use
commas in the value.

Defaults
By default, the bridge priority value is set to 32768.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The bridge priority specifies the priority value for the first two octets of the Bridge ID (eight octets
long). The remaining six octets of the Bridge ID contain a dedicated bridge MAC address.
• The lower the bridge priority number, the higher the priority that is associated with the bridge.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified priority value is not
active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the 1x1
mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 2 priority 16384
-> bridge 1x1 10 priority 53800

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 2 priority 16384
-> bridge 1x1 10 priority 53800

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-27 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects a flat Spanning Tree or 1x1 (per VLAN) Spanning Tree operat-
ing mode for the switch.
bridge priority Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for the flat
mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for the CIST
instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.
bridge msti priority Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree priority for an MSTP
MSTI when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpIns1x1VlanNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress

page 5-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge hello time


Configures the Spanning Tree hello time value for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree
(CIST) instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance. This value specifies the amount of time, in seconds,
between each transmission of a BPDU on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempting to
become the Spanning Tree root.
bridge [instance] hello time seconds

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
seconds Hello Time value, in seconds (1–10).

Defaults
By default, the bridge hello time value for is set to 2 seconds.

parameter default
instance flat mode instance

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Lowering the Hello Time interval improves the robustness of the Spanning Tree Algorithm. Increasing
the Hello Time interval lowers the overhead of the Spanning Tree Algorithm.
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the hello time value for the associated VLAN instance.
• To configure the hello time value for the flat mode CIST instance when the switch is running in either
the flat or 1x1 mode, do not specify an instance number. The CIST is the instance configured by
default with this command.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, entering 1 to specify
the CIST instance is optional. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance
number is not accepted.
• Note that for Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI), the hello time value is inherited from the CIST
instance and is not a configurable parameter.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge hello time 5

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 10 hello time 8
-> bridge hello time 5

page 5-29 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist hello time Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree hello time value for
the CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1
mode.
bridge 1x1 hello time Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree hello time value for a
VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1
mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsBridgeHelloTime

page 5-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist hello time


Configures the bridge hello time value for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance. This value is the amount of time, in seconds, between each transmission of a BPDU on any port
that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempting to become the Spanning Tree root.
bridge cist hello time seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Hello time value in seconds (1–10).

Defaults
By default, the bridge hello time value is set to 2 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Lowering the Hello Time interval improves the robustness of the Spanning Tree Algorithm. Increasing
the Hello Time interval lowers the overhead of the Spanning Tree Algorithm.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the CIST instance regardless
of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified hello time value is not
active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist hello time 5
-> bridge cist hello time 10

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist hello time 5
-> bridge cist hello time 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-31 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge hello time Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree hello time value for
the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 hello time Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree hello time value for a
VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1
mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsBridgeHelloTime

page 5-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 hello time


Configures the bridge hello time value for an individual VLAN instance. This value is the amount of time,
in seconds, between each transmission of a BPDU on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempt-
ing to become the Spanning Tree root.
bridge 1x1 vid hello time seconds

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
seconds Hello time value in seconds (1–10).

Defaults
By default, the bridge Hello Time value is set to 2 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Lowering the Hello Time interval improves the robustness of the Spanning Tree Algorithm. Increasing
the Hello Time interval lowers the overhead of the Spanning Tree Algorithm.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified hello time value is
not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the
1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 2 hello time 5
-> bridge 1x1 10 hello time 10

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 255 hello time 5
-> bridge 1x1 455 hello time 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-33 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge hello time Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree hello time value for
the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist hello time Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree hello time value for
the CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or 1x1
mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpIns1x1VlanNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsBridgeHelloTime

page 5-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge max age


Configures the Spanning Tree bridge max age time for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree
(CIST) instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance. This value is the amount of time, in seconds, that
Spanning Tree information learned from the network on any port is retained. When this information has
aged beyond the max age value, the information is discarded.
bridge [instance] max age seconds

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
seconds Max age time in seconds (6–40).

Defaults
By default, the bridge max age time value is set to 20 seconds.

parameter default
instance flat mode instance

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A low max age time causes the Spanning Tree Algorithm to reconfigure more often.

• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the max age value for the associated VLAN instance.
• To configure the max age value for the flat mode CIST instance when the switch is running in either
the flat or 1x1 mode, do not specify an instance number. The CIST is the instance configured by
default with this command.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, entering 1 to specify
the CIST instance is optional. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance
number is not accepted.
• Note that for Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI), the max age value is inherited from the CIST
instance and is not a configurable parameter.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge max age 40

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 255 max age 40
-> bridge max age 10

page 5-35 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist max age Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree max age time value
for the CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or
1x1 mode.
bridge 1x1 max age Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree max age time value
for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or
1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsBridgeMaxAge

page 5-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist max age


Configures the bridge max age time value for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance. This value is the amount of time, in seconds, that Spanning Tree Protocol information learned
from the network on any port is retained. When this information has aged beyond the max age value, the
information is discarded.
bridge cist max age seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Max age time in seconds (6–40).

Defaults
By default, the bridge max age time value is set to 20 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A low max age time causes the Spanning Tree Algorithm to reconfigure more often.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the CIST instance regardless
of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified max age time value is
not active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist max age 10
-> bridge cist max age 30

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist max age 10
-> bridge cist max age 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-37 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge max age Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree max age time value
for the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 max age Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree max age time value
for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or
1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsBridgeMaxAge

page 5-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 max age


Configures the bridge max age time value for an individual VLAN instance. This value is the amount of
time, in seconds, that Spanning Tree Protocol information learned from the network on any port is
retained. When this information has aged beyond the max age value, the information is discarded.
bridge 1x1 vid max age seconds

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
seconds Max age time in seconds (6–40).

Defaults
By default, the bridge max age time value is set to 20 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A low max age time causes the Spanning Tree Algorithm to reconfigure more often.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified max age time value
is not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the
1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 2 max age 10
-> bridge 1x1 10 max age 40

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 255 max age 30
-> bridge 1x1 455 max age 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-39 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge max age Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree max age time value
for the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist max age Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree max age time value
for the CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the flat or
1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpIns1x1VlanNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsBridgeMaxAge

page 5-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge forward delay


Configures the bridge forward delay time for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance or for 1x1 mode VLAN instance. This value is the amount of time, in seconds, that determines
how fast a port changes its Spanning Tree state until it reaches a forwarding state. The forward delay time
specifies how long a port stays in the listening and learning states, which precede the forwarding state.
bridge [instance] forward delay seconds

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
seconds Forward delay time, in seconds (4–30).

Defaults
By default, the bridge forward delay time value is set to 15 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A low forward delay time can cause temporary loops in the network, because data may get forwarded
before the reconfiguration message has reached all nodes on the network.
• The forward delay time is also used to age out all dynamic MAC address entries in the forwarding table
(MAC address table) when a topology change occurs.
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the forward delay time for the associated VLAN
instance.
• To configure the forward delay time for the flat mode CIST instance when the switch is running in
either the flat or 1x1 mode, do not specify an instance number. The CIST is the instance configured by
default with this command.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, entering 1 to specify
the CIST instance is optional. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance
number is not accepted.
• Note that for Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI), the forward delay time is inherited from the
CIST instance and is not a configurable parameter.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge forward delay 30

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 255 forward delay 10
-> bridge forward delay 30

page 5-41 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist forward delay Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree forward delay time
value for the CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the
flat or 1x1 mode.
bridge 1x1 forward delay Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree forward delay time
value for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the flat
or 1x1 mode.
bridge rrstp ring vlan-tag Displays VLAN Spanning Tree parameter values.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsBridgeForwardDelay

page 5-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist forward delay


Configures the bridge forward delay time value for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree
(CIST) instance. This value is the amount of time, in seconds, that determines how fast a port changes its
Spanning Tree state until it reaches a forwarding state. The forward delay time specifies how long a port
stays in the listening and learning states, which precede the forwarding state.
bridge cist forward delay seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Forward delay time in seconds (4–30).

Defaults
By default, the bridge forward delay time value is set to 15 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A low forward delay time can cause temporary loops in the network, because data may get forwarded
before the reconfiguration message has reached all nodes on the network.
• The forward delay time is also used to age out all dynamic MAC address entries in the forwarding table
(MAC address table) when a topology change occurs.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the flat mode CIST instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified forward delay time
value is not active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat
mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist forward delay 10
-> bridge cist forward delay 30

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist forward delay 25
-> bridge cist forward delay 4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-43 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge forward delay Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree forward delay time
value for the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.
bridge 1x1 forward delay Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree forward delay time
value for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the flat
or 1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsBridgeForwardDelay

page 5-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 forward delay


Configures the bridge forward delay time value for an individual VLAN instance. This value is the amount
of time, in seconds, that determines how fast a port changes its Spanning Tree state until it reaches a
forwarding state. The forward delay time specifies how long a port stays in the listening and learning
states, which precede the forwarding state.
bridge 1x1 vid forward delay seconds

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
seconds Forward delay time in seconds (4–30).

Defaults
By default, the bridge forward delay time value is set to 15 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A low forward delay time can cause temporary loops in the network, because data may get forwarded
before the reconfiguration message has reached all nodes on the network.
• The forward delay time is also used to age out all dynamic MAC address entries in the forwarding table
(MAC address table) when a topology change occurs.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified max age time value
is not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the
1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 2 forward delay 30
-> bridge 1x1 10 forward delay 4

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 255 forward delay 25
-> bridge 1x1 455 forward delay 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-45 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge forward delay Implicit command for changing the Spanning Tree forward delay time
value for the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.
bridge cist forward delay Explicit command for changing the Spanning Tree forward delay time
value for the CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the
flat or 1x1 mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpIns1x1VlanNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsBridgeForwardDelay

page 5-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge bpdu-switching
Enables the switching of Spanning Tree BPDU on the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree
(CIST) instance or for an individual VLAN instance if the switch is running in the 1x1 mode.
bridge [instance] bpdu-switching {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance (bridge 1) or an existing 1x1 mode VLAN
ID instance number (bridge 1–4094).
enable Enables BPDU switching for the specified instance.
disable Disables BPDU switching for the specified instance.

Defaults
By default, BPDU switching is disabled for an instance.

parameter default
instance CIST (flat mode)

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specifying the BPDU switching status for a VLAN does not depend on the current VLAN Spanning
Tree status. For example, setting the BPDU switching status to enabled is allowed on a VLAN that also
has Spanning Tree enabled.
• The bridge bpdu-switching command is an implicit Spanning Tree command. When issued in the 1x1
mode, the instance number specified implies a VLAN ID. When issued in the flat mode, the instance
number specified implies an MSTI number.
• If an instance is not specified with this command, the BPDU switching status is configured for the flat
mode CIST instance by default regardless of which mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• Note that if the switch is running in the flat mode, specifying a value greater than 1 for the instance will
return an error message. BPDU switching is only configured for the flat mode instance (bridge 1),
regardless of which protocol is active (STP, RSTP, or MSTP).

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge bpdu-switching enable
-> bridge 1 bpdu-switching disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 100 bpdu-switching enable
-> bridge 100 bpdu-switching disable

page 5-47 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan stp Enables or disables Spanning Tree instance for the specified VLAN.
show spantree Displays VLAN Spanning Tree parameter values.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsBpduSwitching

page 5-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge path cost mode


Configures the automatic selection of a 16-bit path cost for STP/RSTP ports and a 32-bit path cost for
MSTP ports or sets all path costs to use a 32-bit value.
bridge path cost mode {auto | 32bit}

Syntax Definitions
auto The port path cost value is automatically set depending on which proto-
col is active on the switch (32-bit for MSTP, 16-bit for STP/RSTP).
32bit Specifies that a 32-bit value is used for the port path cost value regard-
less of which protocol is active on the switch.

Defaults
By default, the path cost mode is set to auto.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Note that all path cost values, except those for MSTIs, are reset to the default path cost value when this
mode is changed.
• When connecting a switch running in the 32-bit path cost mode to a switch running in the 16-bit mode,
the 32-bit switch will have a higher path cost value and thus an inferior path cost to the 16-bit switch.
To avoid this, use the bridge path cost mode command to change the 32-bit switch to a 16-bit switch.
• Note that when the protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path cost values for
the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values. The exception to this is if the path cost
mode is set to 32-bit prior to the protocol change, the path cost is not reset to its default value

Examples
-> bridge path cost mode 32bit
-> bridge path cost mode auto

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge slot/port path cost Defines a Spanning Tree path cost for a port.
bridge protocol Configures the protocol for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode
VLAN instance.

page 5-49 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpBridge
vStpPathCostMode

page 5-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge auto-vlan-containment
Enables or disables Auto VLAN Containment (AVC). When enabled, AVC prevents a port that has no
VLANs mapped to an Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) from becoming the root port for that
instance. Such ports are automatically assigned an infinite path cost value to make them an inferior choice
for root port.
bridge [msti msti_id] auto-vlan-containment {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0–4094).
enable Enables automatic VLAN containment.
disable Disables automatic VLAN containment.

Defaults
By default, automatic VLAN containment is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The AVC feature is not active for any MSTI until it is globally enabled. To globally enable this feature,
use the bridge auto-vlan-containment command but do not specify an msti_ id.
• When AVC is globally enabled, it is active for all MSTIs. To disable AVC for a single instance, use the
disable form of this command and specify the msti_id for the instance.
• Use the enable form of this command and specify an msti_id to enable AVC for an instance that was
previously disabled.
• An administratively set port path cost takes precedence and prevents AVC configuration of the path
cost. The exception to this is if the port path cost is administratively set to zero, which resets the path
cost to the default value.
• Note that when AVC is disabled that a port assigned to a VLAN not mapped to a specific instance can
become the root port for that instance and cause a loss of connectivity between other VLANs.
• AVC does not have any effect on root bridges.

Examples
-> bridge auto-vlan-containment enable
-> bridge auto-vlan-containment disable
-> bridge msti 1 auto-vlan-containment disable
-> bridge msti 1 auto-vlan containment enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-51 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge slot/port path cost Defines a Spanning Tree path cost for a port.
show spantree msti ports Displays Spanning Tree port information for a flat mode Multiple Span-
ning Tree Instance (MSTI).

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsAutoVlanContainment
vStpBridge
vStpBridgeAutoVlanContainment

page 5-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge slot/port
Enables or disables the Spanning Tree status on a single port or an aggregate of ports for the specified flat
mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
instance The CIST instance number or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port The Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
enable Enables Spanning Tree on the specified port for the specified instance.
disable Disables Spanning Tree on the specified port for the specified instance.

Defaults
By default, the Spanning Tree status is enabled on eligible ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the port Spanning Tree status for the associated VLAN
instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, enter 1 to specify the
CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance number is not
accepted. In this case, use the bridge cist slot/port command instead.
• Note that for Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI), the port Spanning Tree status is inherited from
the CIST instance and is not a configurable parameter.
• When STP is disabled on a port, the port is set to a forwarding state for the specified STP instance.

• If STP is disabled on a VLAN in the 1x1 mode, the port Spanning Tree status is ignored and all active
ports associated with the VLAN are put in a forwarding state and not included in the Spanning Tree
Algorithm. Note that ports at this point are not switching BPDU, unless the BPDU switching status for
the VLAN is enabled.
• Physical ports that are reserved for link aggregation do not participate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm.
Instead, the algorithm is applied to the aggregate logical link (virtual port) that represents a collection
of physical ports.

page 5-53 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1 4/1 disable
-> bridge 1 1/24 enable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 255 5/10 enable
-> bridge 455 16 enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree status on a port or
an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree status on a port or
an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
vlan stp Enables or disables the Spanning Tree instance for a VLAN.
bridge bpdu-switching Enables or disables BPDU switching for the specified VLAN.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortEnable

page 5-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port


Enables or disables the Spanning Tree status on a single port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode
Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance.
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port The Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
enable Enables Spanning Tree on the specified port for the CIST instance.
disable Disables Spanning Tree on the specified port for the CIST instance.

Defaults
By default, the Spanning Tree status is enabled on eligible ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the port Spanning Tree status
for the flat mode CIST instance regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active
on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the Spanning Tree status configured
for the port is not active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the
flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• When the Spanning Tree status is disabled on a port, the port is set to a forwarding state for the speci-
fied instance.
• If STP is disabled on a VLAN in the 1x1 mode, the port Spanning Tree status is ignored and all active
ports associated with the VLAN are put in a forwarding state and not included in the Spanning Tree
Algorithm. Note that ports at this point are not switching BPDU, unless the BPDU switching status for
the VLAN is enabled.
• Physical ports that are reserved for link aggregation do not participate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm.
Instead, the algorithm is applied to the aggregate logical link (virtual port) that represents a collection
of physical ports.

page 5-55 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 4/1 enable
-> bridge cist 16 enable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 5/10 enable
-> bridge cist 22 enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree status on a port for
the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 slot/port Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree status on a port or
an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
vlan stp Enables or disables the Spanning Tree instance for a VLAN.
bridge bpdu-switching Enables or disables BPDU switching for the specified VLAN.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortEnable

page 5-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port


Enables or disables the Spanning Tree status on a single port or an aggregate of ports for the specified
VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port The Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
enable Enables Spanning Tree on the specified port for the specified instance.
disable Disables Spanning Tree on the specified port for the specified instance.

Defaults
By default, the Spanning Tree status is enabled on eligible ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the Spanning Tree status config-
ured for the port is not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch
is changed to the 1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• When the Spanning Tree status is disabled on a port, the port is set to a forwarding state for the speci-
fied instance.
• If STP is disabled on a VLAN in the 1x1 mode, the port Spanning Tree status is ignored and all active
ports associated with the VLAN are put in a forwarding state and not included in the Spanning Tree
Algorithm. Note that ports at this point are not switching BPDU, unless the BPDU switching status for
the VLAN is enabled.
• Physical ports that are reserved for link aggregation do not participate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm.
Instead, the algorithm is applied to the aggregate logical link (virtual port) that represents a collection
of physical ports.

page 5-57 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 2 4/1 enable
-> bridge 1x1 3 16 disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 2 5/10 enable
-> bridge 1x1 3 22 disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree status on a port for
the flat mode CIST instance or for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist slot/port Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree status on a port or
an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
vlan stp Enables or disables Spanning Tree instance for the specified VLAN.
bridge bpdu-switching Enables or disables BPDU switching for the specified VLAN.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortEnable

page 5-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge slot/port priority


Configures the Spanning Tree priority for a single port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common
and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance. The Spanning Tree Algo-
rithm uses the port priority value to determine the most favorable port when a bridge has multiple ports
with the same path cost to the root bridge.
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
priority Port priority value (0–15). The lower the number, the higher the
priority.

Defaults
By default, the bridge port priority value is set to 7.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The port priority specifies the value of the priority field contained in the first byte of the Port ID. The
second byte contains the physical switch port number.
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the port priority value for the associated VLAN
instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, enter 1 to specify the
CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance number is not
accepted. In this case, use the bridge cist slot/port priority command instead.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1 4/1 priority 0

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 255 1/24 priority 5
-> bridge 455 3/12 priority 15

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-59 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority for a port
or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is operat-
ing in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge msti slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority for a port
or an aggregate of ports for an MSTI when the switch is operating in
either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority for a port
or an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is operat-
ing in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority

page 5-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port priority


Configures the Spanning Tree priority value for a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common
and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance. The Spanning Tree algorithm uses the port priority value to
determine the most favorable port when a bridge has multiple ports with the same path cost to the root
bridge.
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
priority Port priority value (0–15). The lower the number, the higher the
priority.

Defaults
By default, the bridge port priority value is set to 7.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The port priority specifies the value of the priority field contained in the first byte of the Port ID. The
second byte contains the physical switch port number.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the port priority value for the
flat mode CIST instance regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the
switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified port priority value is not
active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 4/1 priority 2
-> bridge cist 10 priority 15

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 5/10 priority 1
-> bridge cist 16 priority 15

page 5-61 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port priority Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the specified CIST or VLAN
instance.
bridge msti slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports for an MSTI when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority

page 5-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge msti slot/port priority


Configures the Spanning Tree priority value for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified flat mode
Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI). The Spanning Tree algorithm uses the port priority value to
determine the most favorable port when a bridge has multiple ports with the same path cost to the root
bridge.
bridge msti msti_id {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
priority Port priority value (0–15). The lower the number, the higher the
priority.

Defaults
By default, the bridge port priority value is set to 7.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The port priority specifies the value of the priority field contained in the first byte of the Port ID. The
second byte contains the physical switch port number.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified MSTI regard-
less of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch. If MSTP is not the selected flat mode
protocol, however, the port priority value for any MSTI is not configurable in either mode.
• Note that if zero is entered for the msti_id value, the specified priority value is applied to the CIST
instance. The flat mode CIST instance 0 is also known as MSTI 0.
• The port priority value configured with this command is only applied to the specified MSTI. As a
result, a single port can have different priority values for each instance. For example, in flat mode, port
1/24 can have a priority value of 7 for MSTI 2 and a priority value of 5 for MSTI 3.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified priority value is not
active for the specified MSTI until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

page 5-63 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge msti 0 1/24 priority 12
-> bridge msti 2 1/24 priority 5

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge msti 0 1/24 priority 12
-> bridge msti 2 1/24 priority 5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port priority Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the specified CIST or VLAN
instance.
bridge cist slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or Tree mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority

page 5-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port priority


Configures the Spanning Tree priority value for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1 mode
VLAN instance. The Spanning Tree algorithm uses the port priority value to determine the most favorable
port when a bridge has multiple ports with the same path cost to the root bridge.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
priority Port priority value (0–15). The lower the number, the higher the
priority.

Defaults
By default, the bridge port priority value is set to 7.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The port priority specifies the value of the priority field contained in the first byte of the Port ID. The
second byte contains the physical switch port number.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified priority value for the
port is not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to
the 1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 100 4/1 priority 2
-> bridge 1x1 200 1/24 priority 4

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 255 5/10 priority 1
-> bridge 1x1 455 1/16 priority 15

page 5-65 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port priority Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the specified CIST or VLAN
instance.
bridge slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge msti slot/port priority Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree priority value for a
port or an aggregate of ports for an MSTI when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority

page 5-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge slot/port path cost


Configures the Spanning Tree path cost value for a single port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the
specified flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
This value is the contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree root bridge that
includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance of the listed port from the root bridge in the
number of hops.
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
path_cost Path cost value (0 - 65535 for 16-bit, 0–200000000 for 32-bit).

Defaults
By default, the path cost is set to zero.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the port path cost for the associated VLAN instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP (802.1D) or RSTP (802.1W) is the active protocol,
enter 1 to specify the CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the
instance number is not accepted. In this case, use the bridge cist slot/port path cost command instead.
• Note that when the Spanning Tree protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path
cost values for the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values.
• Use the bridge path cost mode command to automatically select the path cost value based on the
active Spanning Tree protocol (16-bit for STP and RSTP, 32-bit for MSTP) or to use a 32-bit path cost
value regardless of which protocol is active.
• If a 32-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost is set to zero, the following recommended default
path cost values based on link speed are used.

page 5-67 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
10 MB 2,000,000
100 MB 200,000
1 GB 20,000
10 Gbps 2,000

• Is a 16-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost is set to zero, the following IEEE 802.1D recom-
mended default path cost values based on link speed are used:

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
4 Mbps 250
10 Mbps 100
16 Mbps 62
100 Mbps 19
1 Gbps 4
10 Gbps 2

• If a 32-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following
default values based on link speed and link aggregate size are used:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 MB 2 1,200,000
4 800,000
8 600,000
100 MB 2 120,000
4 80,000
8 60,000
1 GB 2 12,000
4 8,000
8 6,000
10 GB 2 1,200
4 800
8 600

page 5-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• If a 16-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following
default values based on link speed and link aggregate size are used. Note that for Gigabit ports the
aggregate size is not applicable in this case:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 Mbps 2 60
4 40
8 30
100 Mbps 2 12
4 9
8 7
1 Gbps N/A 3
10 Gbps N/A 1

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1 4/1 path cost 19
-> bridge 1 5/1 path cost 0

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 455 1/24 path cost 2000
-> bridge 955 3/12 path cost 500

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-69 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge path cost mode Selects a 32-bit or automatic path cost mode for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost for a port
or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is operat-
ing in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge msti slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost for a port
or an aggregate of ports for an MSTI when the switch is operating in
either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost for a port
or an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is operat-
ing in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPathCost

page 5-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port path cost


Configures the Spanning Tree path cost value for a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode
Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance. This value is the contribution of this port to the path
cost towards the Spanning Tree root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance of
the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops.
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
path_cost Path cost value (0 - 65535 for 16-bit, 0–200000000 for 32-bit).

Defaults
By default, the path cost is set to zero.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the port path cost value for
the CIST instance regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) or protocol is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified path cost value is not
active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when the Spanning Tree protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path
cost values for the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values.
• Use the bridge path cost mode command to automatically select the path cost value based on the
active Spanning Tree protocol (16-bit for STP and RSTP, 32-bit for MSTP) or to use a 32-bit path cost
value regardless of which protocol is active.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• If a 32-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost is set to zero, the following recommended default
path cost values based on link speed are used:

page 5-71 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
10 MB 2,000,000
100 MB 200,000
1 GB 20,000
10 Gbps 2,000

• Is a 16-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost is set to zero, the following IEEE 802.1D recom-
mended default path cost values based on link speed are used:

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
4 Mbps 250
10 Mbps 100
16 Mbps 62
100 Mbps 19
1 Gbps 4
10 Gbps 2

• If a 32-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following
default values based on link speed and link aggregate size are used:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 MB 2 1,200,000
4 800,000
8 600,000
100 MB 2 120,000
4 80,000
8 60,000
1 GB 2 12,000
4 8,000
8 6,000
10 GB 2 1,200
4 800
8 600

page 5-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• If a 16-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following
default values based on link speed and link aggregate size are used. Note that for Gigabit ports the
aggregate size is not applicable in this case:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 Mbps 2 60
4 40
8 30
100 Mbps 2 12
4 9
8 7
1 Gbps N/A 3
10 Gbps N/A 1

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 4/1 path cost 19
-> bridge cist 16 path cost 12000

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 5/10 path cost 19
-> bridge cist 11 path cost 12000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-73 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge path cost mode Selects a 32-bit or automatic path cost mode for the switch.
bridge slot/port path cost Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the specified CIST or
VLAN instance.
bridge msti slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports for an MSTI when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPathCost

page 5-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge msti slot/port path cost


Configures the Spanning Tree path cost value for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified flat mode
Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI). This value is the contribution of this port to the path cost
towards the Spanning Tree root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance of the
listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops.
bridge mist msti_id {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
path_cost Path cost value (0 - 65535 for 16-bit, 0–200000000 for 32-bit).

Defaults
By default, the path cost is set to zero.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified MSTI regard-
less of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch. If MSTP is not the selected flat mode
protocol, however, the path cost value for any MSTI is not configurable.
• Note that if zero is entered for the msti_id value, the specified path cost value is applied to the CIST
instance. The flat mode CIST instance 0 is also known as MSTI 0.
• Note that when the Spanning Tree protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path
cost values for the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values.
• The path cost value configured with this command is only applied to the specified instance. As a result,
a single port can have a different path cost for each instance. For example, in flat mode, port 1/24 can
have a path cost of 20000 for MSTI 2 and a path cost of 200000 for MSTI 3.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified path cost value is not
active for the specified MSTI until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• When MSTP is the active protocol on the switch, only a 32-bit path cost value is used. Using a 16-bit
path cost value is not an option.
• If zero is entered for the path_cost value, then the following recommended default path cost values
based on link speed are used:

page 5-75 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
10 MB 2,000,000
100 MB 200,000
1 GB 20,000
10 Gbps 2,000

• If the path_cost value for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following default values based on link
speed and link aggregate size are used:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 MB 2 1,200,000
4 800,000
8 600,000
100 MB 2 120,000
4 80,000
8 60,000
1 GB 2 12,000
4 8,000
8 6,000
10 GB 2 1,200
4 800
8 600

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge msti 0 4/1 path cost 200000
-> bridge msti 2 4/1 path cost 20000

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge msti 0 1/24 path cost 200000
-> bridge msti 2 1/24 path cost 20000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port path cost Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the specified CIST or
VLAN instance.
bridge cist slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPathCost

page 5-77 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost


Configures the Spanning Tree path cost value for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1
mode VLAN instance. This value is the contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning
Tree root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance of the listed port from the
root bridge in the number of hops.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
path_cost Path cost value (0 - 65535 for 16-bit, 0–200000000 for 32-bit).

Defaults
By default, the path cost is set to zero.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified path cost for the port
is not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the
1x1 mode.
• Note that when the Spanning Tree protocol is changed to/from MSTP, the bridge priority and port path
cost values for the flat mode CIST instance are reset to their default values.
• Use the bridge path cost mode command to automatically select the path cost value based on the
active Spanning Tree protocol (16-bit for STP and RSTP, 32-bit for MSTP) or to use a 32-bit path cost
value regardless of which protocol is active.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• If a 32-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost is set to zero, the following IEEE 892.1S recom-
mended default path cost values based on link speed are used:

page 5-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
10 MB 2,000,000
100 MB 200,000
1 GB 20,000
10 Gbps 2,000

• Is a 16-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost is set to zero, the following IEEE 802.1D recom-
mended default path cost values based on link speed are used:

IEEE 802.1D
Link Speed
Recommended Value
4 Mbps 250
10 Mbps 100
16 Mbps 62
100 Mbps 19
1 Gbps 4
10 Gbps 2

• If a 32-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following
default values based on link speed and link aggregate size are used:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 MB 2 1,200,000
4 800,000
8 600,000
100 MB 2 120,000
4 80,000
8 60,000
1 GB 2 12,000
4 8,000
8 6,000
10 GB 2 1,200
4 800
8 600

page 5-79 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• If a 16-bit path cost value is in use and the path_cost for a link aggregate is set to zero, the following
default values based on link speed and link aggregate size are used. Note that for Gigabit ports the
aggregate size is not applicable in this case:

Aggregate Size Default Path


Link Speed
(number of links) Cost Value
10 Mbps 2 60
4 40
8 30
100 Mbps 2 12
4 9
8 7
1 Gbps N/A 3
10 Gbps N/A 1

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 200 4/1 path cost 4
-> bridge 1x1 300 16 path cost 200000

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 400 5/10 path cost 19
-> bridge 1x1 500 1/24 path cost 20000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port path cost Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports that applies to the specified CIST or
VLAN instance.
bridge cist slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is
operating in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge msti slot/port path cost Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree path cost value for
a port or an aggregate of ports for an MSTI when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPathCost

page 5-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge slot/port mode


Configures Manual mode (forwarding or blocking) or Dynamic mode to manage the state of a port or an
aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance or a 1x1 mode
VLAN instance. Dynamic mode defers the configuration of the port state to the Spanning Tree Protocol.
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} mode {forwarding | blocking | dynamic}

Syntax Definitions
instance The CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
forwarding Set port state to forwarding.
blocking Set port state to blocking.
dynamic Port state is determined by Spanning Tree Protocol.

Defaults
By default, the port Spanning Tree mode is set to dynamic.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running the 1x1 Spanning Tree
operating mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the port Spanning Tree mode (forwarding, block-
ing, or dynamic) for the associated VLAN instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP (802.1D) or RSTP (802.1W) is the active protocol,
enter 1 to specify the CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the
instance number is not accepted. In this case, use the bridge cist slot/port mode command instead.
• Note that for Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI), the port Spanning Tree mode is inherited from
the CIST instance and is not a configurable parameter.
• When port state is manually set to forwarding or blocking, the port remains in that state until it is
changed using this command.
• Ports manually configured to operate in a forwarding or blocking state do not participate in the Span-
ning Tree Algorithm.

page 5-81 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1 4/1 mode forwarding

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 200 4/1 mode dynamic
-> bridge 300 1/24 mode forwarding

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port mode Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree mode on a port or
an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port mode Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree mode on a port or
an aggregate of ports for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortManualMode

page 5-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port mode


Configures Manual mode (forwarding or blocking) or Dynamic mode to manage the state of a port or an
aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance. Dynamic mode
defers the management of the port state to the Spanning Tree algorithm.
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} mode {dynamic | blocking | forwarding}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
dynamic Port state is determined by Spanning Tree algorithm.
blocking Sets port state to blocking.
forwarding Sets port state to forwarding.

Defaults
By default, the port Spanning Tree mode is set to dynamic.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the port Spanning Tree mode
for the CIST instance regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified port mode is not active
for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• Ports manually configured to operate in a forwarding or blocking state do not participate in the Span-
ning Tree algorithm.
• When port state is manually set to forwarding or blocking, the port remains in that state until it is
changed using this command.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 4/1 mode forwarding
-> bridge cist 10 mode blocking

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 2/2 mode blocking
-> bridge cist 11 mode forwarding

page 5-83 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port mode Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree mode for a port or
an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance or a VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 slot/port mode Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree mode for a port or
an aggregate of ports for the specified VLAN instance when the switch
is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortManualMode

page 5-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port mode


Configures Manual mode (forwarding or blocking) or Dynamic mode to manage the state of a port or an
aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1 mode VLAN instance. Dynamic mode defers the management of
the port state to the Spanning Tree algorithm.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} mode {dynamic | blocking | forwarding}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
dynamic Port state is determined by Spanning Tree algorithm.
blocking Sets port state to blocking.
forwarding Sets port state to forwarding.

Defaults
By default, the port Spanning Tree mode is set to dynamic.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified mode for the port is
not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the
1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• Ports manually configured to operate in a forwarding or blocking state do not participate in the Span-
ning Tree algorithm.
• When port state is manually set to forwarding or blocking, the port remains in that state until it is
changed using this command.

page 5-85 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 255 4/1 mode forwarding
-> bridge 1x1 355 1/24 mode dynamic

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 255 2/2 mode blocking
-> bridge 1x1 355 3/12 mode forwarding

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port mode Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree mode for a port or
an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance or for a VLAN instance.
bridge cist slot/port mode Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree mode for a port or
an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the switch is operating
in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortManualMode

page 5-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge slot/port connection


Configures the connection type for a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common and Internal
Spanning Tree (CIST) instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} connection {noptp | ptp | autoptp | edgeport}

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
noptp Defines port connection type as no point to point link.
ptp Defines port connection type as point to point link.
autoptp Specifies that switch software will automatically define connection type
as point to point or no point to point.
edgeport This parameter is currently not supported. Use the bridge cist slot/port
admin-edge or bridge cist slot/port auto-edge command to configure
edge port status.

Defaults
By default the link connection type is set to auto point to point.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running the 1x1 Spanning Tree
operating mode implies a VLAN ID and configures the port connection type for the associated VLAN
instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP or RSTP is the active protocol, enter 1 to specify the
CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the instance number is not
accepted. In this case, use the bridge cist slot/port connection command instead.
• Note that for Multiple Spanning Tree Instances (MSTI), the port connection type is inherited from the
CIST instance and is not a configurable parameter.
• A port is considered connected to a point to point LAN segment if the port belongs to a link aggregate
of ports or if autonegotiation determines if the port should run in full duplex mode or if full duplex
mode was administratively set. Otherwise, the port is considered connected to a no point to point LAN
segment.

page 5-87 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as a point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1 1/24 connection noptp

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 200 8/2 connection ptp
-> bridge 300 10 connection autoptp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port connection Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree connection type
for a port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance when the
switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.
bridge 1x1 slot/port connection Explicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree connection type
for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified VLAN instance
when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree
mode.
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or aggregate
of ports for the CIST instance.
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the
operational edge status of a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat
mode CIST instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType

page 5-88 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port connection


Configures the connection type for a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common and Internal
Spanning Tree (CIST).
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} connection {noptp | ptp | autoptp | edgeport}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
noptp Defines port connection type as no point to point link.
ptp Defines port connection type as point to point link.
autoptp Specifies that switch software will automatically define connection type
as point to point or no point to point.
edgeport This parameter is currently not supported. Use the bridge cist slot/port
admin-edge or bridge cist slot/port auto-edge command to configure
edge port status.

Defaults
By default, the link connection type is set to auto point to point.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the port connection type for
the CIST instance regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified port connection type is
not active for the CIST instance until the operating mode for the switch is changed to the flat mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• A port is considered connected to a point to point LAN segment if the port belongs to a link aggregate
of ports or if autonegotiation determines the port should run in full duplex mode or if full duplex mode
was administratively set. Otherwise, the port is considered connected to a no point to point LAN
segment.
• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as a point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.

page 5-89 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 7/24 connection noptp

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 2/2 connection noptp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge slot/port connection Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree connection type
for a port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance or for a VLAN
instance.
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or aggregate
of ports for the CIST instance.
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the
operational edge status of a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat
mode CIST instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType

page 5-90 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port connection


Configures the connection type for a port or an aggregate of ports for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} connection {noptp | ptp | autoptp | edgeport}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
noptp Defines port connection type as no point to point link.
ptp Defines port connection type as point to point link.
autoptp Specifies that switch software will automatically define connection type
as point to point or no point to point and whether or not the port is an
edge port.
edgeport This parameter is currently not supported. Use the bridge 1x1 slot/port
admin-edge or bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge command to configure
edge port status.

Defaults
By default, the link connection type is set to auto point to point.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified connection type for
the port is not active for the specified VLAN instance until the operating mode for the switch is
changed to the 1x1 mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• A port is considered connected to a point to point LAN segment if the port belongs to a link aggregate
of ports or if autonegotiation determines the port should run in full duplex mode or if full duplex mode
was administratively set. Otherwise, the port is considered connected to a no point to point LAN
segment.
• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as a point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.

page 5-91 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 255 7/24 connection noptp

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 200 2/2 connection noptp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch
bridge slot/port connection Implicit command for configuring the Spanning Tree connection type
for a port or an aggregate of ports for the CIST instance or for a VLAN
instance.
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or aggregate
of ports for the CIST instance.
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the
operational edge status of a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat
mode CIST instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType

page 5-92 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port admin-edge


Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode
Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST).
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} admin-edge {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
on Turns on the administrative edge port status for the specified
port-CIST instance.
off Turns off the administrative edge port status for the specified
port-CIST instance.
enable Enables the administrative edge port status for the specified port-CIST
instance.
disable Disables the administrative edge port status for the specified port-CIST
instance.

Defaults
By default, the administrative edge port status is disabled (off).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the port connection type for
the CIST instance regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified edge port status is
not active for the CIST instance until the switch is configured to run in the flat Spanning Tree mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• The administrative edge port status is used to determine if a port is an edge or non-edge port when
automatic edge port configuration (auto-edge) is disabled for the port. However, if auto-edge is
enabled for the port, then the administrative status is overridden.
• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as a point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.

page 5-93 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• Configure ports that will connect to a host (PC, workstation, server, etc.) as edge ports to avoid unnec-
essary topology changes when these ports go active. This will also prevent the flushing of learned
MAC addresses on these ports if a topology change occurs as a result of another non-edge port going
active. If an edge port receives a BPDU, it will operationally revert back to a no point to point connec-
tion type.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 15 admin-edge on
-> bridge cist 8/23 admin-edge disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 2/2 admin-edge enable
-> bridge cist 8/23 admin-edge off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch
bridge 1x1 slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or an aggre-
gate of ports for a specific VLAN instance.
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the
operational edge status of a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat
mode CIST instance.
bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree determines the operational
edge port status for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1
mode VLAN instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminEdge

page 5-94 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port admin-edge


Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or an aggregate of ports for a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} admin-edge {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
on Turns on the administrative edge port status for the specified
port-VLAN instance.
off Turns off the administrative edge port status for the specified
port-VLAN instance.
enable Enables the administrative edge port status for the specified port-VLAN
instance.
disable Disables the administrative edge port status for the specified port-VLAN
instance.

Defaults
By default, the administrative edge port status is disabled (off).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified edge port status for
the port is not active for the VLAN instance until the switch is configured to run in the 1x1 Spanning
Tree mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• The administrative edge port status is used to determine if a port is an edge or non-edge port when
automatic edge port configuration (auto-edge) is disabled for the port. However, if auto-edge is
enabled for the port, then the administrative status is overridden.
• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.

page 5-95 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

• Configure ports that will connect to a host (PC, workstation, server, etc.) as edge ports to avoid unnec-
essary topology changes when these ports go active. This will also prevent the flushing of learned
MAC addresses on these ports if a topology change occurs as a result of another non-edge port going
active. If an edge port receives a BPDU, it will operationally revert back to a no point to point connec-
tion type.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 4 15 admin-edge on
-> bridge 1x1 255 8/23 admin-edge disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 3 2/2 admin-edge enable
-> bridge 1x1 255 10 admin-edge off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or aggregate
of ports for the CIST instance.
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the
operational edge status of a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat
mode CIST instance.
bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree determines the operational
edge port status for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1
mode VLAN instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminEdge

page 5-96 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port auto-edge


Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the operational edge port status of a
port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST).
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} auto-edge {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
on Spanning Tree automatically determines edge port status.
off Spanning Tree does not automatically determine edge port status.
enable Spanning Tree automatically determines edge port status.
disable Spanning Tree does not automatically determine edge port status.

Defaults
By default, automatic edge port status configuration is enabled (on).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the CIST instance regardless
of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified edge port status for
the port is not active for the CIST instance until the switch is running in the flat Spanning Tree mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• The administrative edge port status is used to determine if a port is an edge or non-edge port when
automatic edge port configuration (auto-edge) is disabled for the port. However, if auto-edge is
enabled for the port, then the administrative status is overridden.
• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.
• Configure ports that will connect to a host (PC, workstation, server, etc.) as edge ports to avoid unnec-
essary topology changes when these ports go active. This will also prevent the flushing of learned
MAC addresses on these ports if a topology change occurs as a result of another non-edge port going
active. If an edge port receives a BPDU, it will operationally revert back to a no point to point connec-
tion type.

page 5-97 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 15 auto-edge on
-> bridge cist 8/23 auto-edge disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 2/2 auto-edge enable
-> bridge cist 10 auto-edge off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch
bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree determines the operational
edge port status for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1
mode VLAN instance.
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or aggregate
of ports for the CIST instance.
bridge 1x1 slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or an aggre-
gate of ports for a specific VLAN instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAutoEdge

page 5-98 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port auto-edge


Configures whether or not Spanning Tree determines the operational edge port status for a port or an
aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} auto-edge {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
on Spanning Tree automatically determines edge port status.
off Spanning Tree does not automatically determine edge port status.
enable Spanning Tree automatically determines edge port status.
disable Spanning Tree does not automatically determine edge port status.

Defaults
By default, automatic edge port status configuration is enabled (on).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified edge port status for
the port is not active for the VLAN instance until the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning Tree mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.
• The administrative edge port status is used to determine if a port is an edge or non-edge port when
automatic edge port configuration (auto-edge) is disabled for the port. However, if auto-edge is
enabled for the port, then the administrative status is overridden.
• Rapid transition of a designated port to forwarding can only occur if the port’s connection type is
defined as point to point or an edge port. Rapid transition of an alternate port role to a root port role is
not affected by the port connection type definition.
• Configure ports that will connect to a host (PC, workstation, server, etc.) as edge ports to avoid unnec-
essary topology changes when these ports go active. This will also prevent the flushing of learned
MAC addresses on these ports if a topology change occurs as a result of another non-edge port going
active. If an edge port receives a BPDU, it will operationally revert back to a no point to point connec-
tion type.

page 5-99 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 3 15 auto-edge on
-> bridge 1x1 255 8/23 auto-edge disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 4 2/2 auto-edge enable
-> bridge 1x1 255 10 auto-edge off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port auto-edge Configures whether or not Spanning Tree automatically determines the
operational edge status of a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat
mode CIST instance.
bridge cist slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or aggregate
of ports for the CIST instance.
bridge 1x1 slot/port admin-edge Configures the administrative edge port status for a port or an aggre-
gate of ports for a specific VLAN instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortAutoEdge

page 5-100 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port restricted-role


Configures whether or not to prevent a port (or an aggregate of ports) from becoming the root port. When
this parameter is enabled, the port will not become the root even if the port is the most likely candidate for
the root. Once another port is selected as the root port, the restricted port becomes the Alternate Port.
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} {restricted-role | root-guard} {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
root-guard Optional command syntax. Enter root-guard instead of restricted-role;
both parameters specify the same functionality for this command.
on Turns on (enables) the restricted role status for the specified port.
off Turns off (disables) the restricted role status for the specified port.
enable Enables the restricted role status for the specified port.
disable Disables the restricted role status for the specified port.

Defaults
By default, the port is not restricted from becoming the root port.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When running in flat mode, this is a per-port setting and is applicable to any CIST or MSTI instances
configured on that port.
• Note that preventing an eligible root port from becoming the root may impact connectivity within the
network.
• Network administrators exclude certain ports from becoming the root to prevent bridges external to the
core region of the network from influencing the Spanning Tree topology.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

page 5-101 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 15 restricted-role on
-> bridge cist 8/23 root-guard disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 2/2 root-guard enable
-> bridge cist 10 restricted-role off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted- Configures the restricted role status for a port or an aggregate of ports
role for the 1x1 mode VLAN instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortRestrictedRole

page 5-102 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-role


Configures whether or not to prevent a port (or an aggregate of ports) for the specified 1x1 mode VLAN
instance from becoming the root port. When this parameter is enabled, the port will not become the root
even if the port is the most likely candidate for the root. Once another port is selected as the root port, the
restricted port becomes the Alternate Port.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} {restricted-role | root-guard} {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
root-guard Optional command syntax. Enter root-guard instead of restricted-role;
both parameters specify the same functionality for this command.
on Turns on (enables) the restricted role status for the specified
port-VLAN instance.
off Turns off (disables) the restricted role status for the specified
port-VLAN instance.
enable Enables the restricted role status for the specified port-VLAN instance.
disable Disables the restricted role status for the specified port-VLAN instance.

Defaults
By default, the port is not restricted from becoming the root port.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Note that preventing an eligible port from becoming the root may impact connectivity within the
network.
• Network administrators exclude certain ports from becoming the root to prevent bridges external to the
core region of the network from influencing the Spanning Tree topology.
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the VLAN instance regard-
less of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the restricted status of the port is
not active for the VLAN instance until the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning Tree mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

page 5-103 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 3 15 restricted-role on
-> bridge 1x1 255 8/23 root-guard disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 4 2/2 root-guard enable
-> bridge 1x1 255 10 restricted-role off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port restricted- Configures the restricted role status for a port or an aggregate of ports
role for the flat mode CIST instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortRestrictedRole

page 5-104 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist slot/port restricted-tcn


Configures the restricted TCN status for a port or an aggregate of ports for the flat mode Common and
Internal Spanning Tree (CIST). When this parameter is enabled, the port will not propagate topology
changes and notifications to/from other ports.
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} restricted-tcn {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
on Turns on (enables) the restricted TCN status for the specified
port-CIST instance.
off Turns off (disables) the restricted TCN status for the specified
port-CIST instance.
enable Enables the restricted TCN status for the specified port-CIST instance.
disable Disables the restricted TCN status for the specified port-CIST instance.

Defaults
By default, the restricted TCN status for the port is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enabling the restricted TCN status is used by network administrators to prevent bridges external to the
core region of the network from causing unnecessary MAC address flushing in that region.
• Note that enabling the restricted TCN status for a port may impact Spanning Tree connectivity.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the CIST instance regardless
of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified restricted TCN
status for the port is not active for the CIST instance until the switch is running in the flat Spanning
Tree mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

page 5-105 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge cist 15 restricted-tcn on
-> bridge cist 8/23 restricted-tcn disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge cist 2/2 restricted-tcn enable
-> bridge cist 10 restricted-tcn off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted- Configures the restricted TCN status for a port or an aggregate of ports
tcn for the specified 1x1 mode VLAN instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortRestrictedTcn

page 5-106 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn


Configures the restricted TCN status for a port or an aggregate of ports for the specified 1x1 mode VLAN
instance. When this parameter is enabled, the port will not propagate topology changes and notifications
to/from other ports.
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} restricted-tcn {on | off | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port Link aggregate ID number (0–31).
on Turns on (enables) the restricted TCN status for the specified
port-VLAN instance.
off Turns off (disables) the restricted TCN status for the specified
port-VLAN instance.
enable Enables the restricted TCN status for the specified port-VLAN instance.
disable Disables the restricted TCN status for the specified port-VLAN
instance.

Defaults
By default, the restricted TCN is set to disable.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enabling the restricted TCN status is used by network administrators to prevent bridges external to the
core region of the network from causing unnecessary MAC address flushing in that region.
• Note that enabling the restricted TCN status for a port may impact Spanning Tree connectivity.

• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified restricted TCN status
for the port is not active for the VLAN instance until the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning Tree
mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

page 5-107 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge 1x1 2 15 restricted-tcn on
-> bridge 1x1 255 8/23 restricted-tcn disable

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> bridge 1x1 5 2/2 restricted-tcn enable
-> bridge 1x1 255 10 restricted-tcn off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist slot/port restricted- Configures the restricted TCN status for a port or an aggregate of ports
tcn for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST).

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortRestrictedTcn

page 5-108 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge cist txholdcount


This command is used to rate limit the transmission of BPDU through a given port for the flat mode
Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance.
bridge cist txholdcount value

Syntax Definitions
value A numeric value (1–10) that controls the transmission of BPDU through
the port.

Defaults
By default, the txholdcount value is set to 3.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the CIST instance regardless
of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the 1x1 mode when this command is used, the specified txholdcount status
for the port is not active for the CIST instance until the switch is running in the flat Spanning Tree
mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge cist txholdcount 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge 1x1 txholdcount Explicit command used to rate limit the transmission of BPDU for the
specified VLAN instance when the switch is operating in either the 1x1
or flat Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsBridgeTxHoldCount

page 5-109 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge 1x1 txholdcount


This command is used to rate limit the transmission of BPDU through a given port for the 1x1 mode
VLAN instance.
bridge 1x1 vid txholdcount {value}

Syntax Definitions
value A numeric value (1–10) that controls the transmission of BPDU through
the port.

Defaults
By default, the txholdcount value is set to 3.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is an explicit Spanning Tree command that only applies to the specified VLAN instance
regardless of which operating mode (flat or 1x1) is active on the switch.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode when this command is used, the specified txholdcount status
for the port is not active for the VLAN instance until the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning Tree
mode.
• Note that when a configuration snapshot is taken of the switch, all Spanning Tree commands are saved
in their explicit format.

Examples
-> bridge 1x1 3 txholdcount 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge mode Selects the Spanning Tree operating mode (flat or 1x1) for the switch.
bridge cist txholdcount Explicit command used to rate limit the transmission of BPDU for the
CIST instance when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat
Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsBridgeTxHoldCount

page 5-110 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge rrstp
Enables or disables RRSTP on a switch.
bridge rrstp
no bridge rrstp

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, RRSTP is disabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to disable RRSTP on the switch.

Examples
-> bridge rrstp
-> no bridge rrstp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge rrstp ring Creates a RRSTP ring comprising of two ports.


show bridge rrstp Displays the current RRSTP status for the switch.
configuration

MIB Objects
vStpInfo
VStpRrstpGlobalState

page 5-111 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge rrstp ring


Creates a RRSTP ring comprising of two ports.
bridge rrstp ring ring_id port1 {slot/port | linkagg agg_num} port2
{slot/port | linkagg agg_num} vlan-tag vlan_id [status {enable | disable}]
no bridge rrstp ring [ring_id]

Syntax Definitions
ring_id A numeric value (1–128) that identifies the RRSTP ring.
slot/port The slot number of the module and the physical port number on that
module (For example, 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
agg_num The number corresponding to the static aggregate group. Must be a
unique integer in the range 0–31.
vlan_id VLAN identifier with which ring ports should be 802.1q tagged before
ring creation.
enable Enables the RRSTP ring.
disable Disables the RRSTP ring.

Defaults

Parameters Defaults
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a specific RRSTP ring.

• This command is used to create a ring or modify ports in an existing ring or modify the ring status.

• The ring ports must be 802.1q tagged with the VLAN before using this command.

• Note that there can be no alternate connections for the same instance between any two switches within
an RRSTP ring topology.
• If RRSTP ring consists of NNI ports then they must be tagged with SVLAN (VLAN stacking) and not
with standard VLAN before ring creation. For tagged RRSTP frame generation same SVLAN must be
specified as ring vlan-tag. Also RRSTP ring ports must be of same type i.e. either both ring ports
should be NNI ports or both should be conventional ports.
• RRSTP ring cannot be created on UNI ports.

page 5-112 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge rrstp ring 1 port1 1/1 port2 1/3 vlan-tag 10 status enable
-> no bridge rrstp ring 1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge rrstp Enables RRSTP on a switch.


show bridge rrstp ring Displays information for all the rings or a specific ring present in the
system.

MIB Objects
vStpRrstpRingConfigTable
vStpRrstpRingId
vStpRrstpRingPort1
vStpRrstpRingPort2
vStpRrstpRingVlanTag
vStpRrstpRingState
vStpRrstpRingRowStatus

page 5-113 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge rrstp ring vlan-tag


Modifies the unique vlan-tag associated with the ring. The previous ring vlan-tag will be over-written.
bridge rrstp ring ring_id vlan-tag vid

Syntax Definitions
ring_id A numeric value (1–128) that identifies the RRSTP ring.
vid The VLAN identification number of preconfigured VLAN with which
ring ports are 802.1q tagged. The RRSTP ring frames shall be 802.1q
tagged with this VLAN.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The RRSTP ring can have only one VLAN tag associated with it.

• Untagged RRSTP frames shall be generated if the specified vlan-tag is the default VLAN of the ports.

• The ring ports must be 802.1q tagged with the new vlan-tag before modifying the ring vlan-tag.

• RRSTP frames has 802.1q priority similar to STP BPDUs. In order to retain this priority, use the qos
trust ports command.

Examples
-> bridge rrstp ring 1 vlan-tag 10
-> bridge rrstp ring 5 vlan-tag 20
-> bridge rrstp ring 11 vlan-tag 11

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge rrstp ring Creates a RRSTP ring comprising of two ports.


show bridge rrstp ring Displays information for all the rings or a specific ring present in the
system.

page 5-114 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpRrstpRingConfigTable
vStpRrstpRingId
vStpRrstpRingVlanTag

page 5-115 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge rrstp ring status


Modifies the RRSTP status of an existing ring.
bridge rrstp ring ring_id status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
ring_id A numeric value (1–128) that identifies the RRSTP ring.
enable Enables the RRSTP ring.
disable Disables the RRSTP ring.

Defaults

Parameters Defaults
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The RRSTP status can also be modified by using bridge rrstp ring command.

Examples
-> bridge rrstp ring 1 status enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge rrstp ring Creates a RRSTP ring comprising of two ports.


show bridge rrstp ring Displays information for all the rings or a specific ring present in the
system.

MIB Objects
vStpRrstpRingConfigTable
vStpRrstpRingId
vStpRrstpRingState
vStpRrstpRingRowStatus

page 5-116 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree
Displays Spanning Tree bridge information for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree [instance]

Syntax Definitions
instance The flat mode CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults

parameter default
instance all instances

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an instance number is not specified, this command displays the Spanning Tree status, protocol, and
priority values for all instances.
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running the 1x1 Spanning Tree
operating mode implies a VLAN ID and displays Spanning Tree bridge information for the associated
VLAN instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP (802.1D) or RSTP (802.1W) is the active protocol,
enter 1 to specify the CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the
instance number is not accepted. In this case, use the show spantree cist or show spantree msti
commands instead.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge protocol rstp
-> show spantree
Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
Bridge STP Status Protocol Priority(Prio:SysID)
------+----------+--------+--------------------
1 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000:0x0000

page 5-117 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> show spantree 1


Spanning Tree Parameters
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Rapid STP,
mode : FLAT (Single STP),
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
Bridge ID : 8000-00:d0:95:57:3a:9e,
Designated Root : 8000-00:00:e8:00:00:00,
Cost to Root Bridge : 71,
Root Port : Slot 1 Interface 1,
Next Best Root Cost : 0,
Next Best Root Port : None,
Tx Hold Count : 6,
Topology Changes : 8,
Topology age : 00:00:02,
Current Parameters (seconds)
Max Age = 20,
Forward Delay = 15,
Hello Time = 2
Parameters system uses when attempting to become root
System Max Age = 20,
System Forward Delay = 15,
System Hello Time = 2

output definitions
Spanning Tree Path Cost The Spanning Tree path cost mode for the switch (32 BIT or AUTO)
Mode Configured through the bridge path cost mode command.
Bridge The CIST instance, referred to as bridge 1 when either STP (802.1D) or
RSTP (802.1W) is the active protocol in the flat mode.
Spanning Tree Status The Spanning Tree state for the CIST instance (ON or OFF).
Protocol The Spanning Tree protocol applied to the instance (STP or RSTP).
Configured through the bridge protocol command.
Mode The Spanning Tree operating mode for the switch (1x1 or flat). Config-
ured through the bridge mode command.
Priority The Spanning Tree bridge priority for the instance. The lower the num-
ber, the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge priority
command.
Bridge ID The bridge identifier for this Spanning Tree instance. Consists of the
bridge priority value (in hex) concatenated with the dedicated bridge
MAC address.
Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the Spanning Tree for this instance.
Cost to Root Bridge The cost of the path to the root for this Spanning Tree instance.
Root Port The port that offers the lowest cost path from this bridge to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Cost The cost of the next best root port for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Port The port that offers the next best (second lowest) cost path to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Tx Hold Count The count to limit the transmission of BPDU through the port.

page 5-118 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Topology Changes The number of topology changes detected by this Spanning Tree
instance since the management entity was last reset or initialized.
Topology age The amount of time (in hundredths of seconds) since the last topology
change was detected by this Spanning Tree instance (hh:mm:ss or dd
days and hh:mm:ss).
Max Age The amount of time (in seconds) that Spanning Tree Protocol informa-
tion is retained before it is discarded. Configured through the bridge
max age command.
Forward Delay The amount of time (in seconds) that a port will remain in the Listening
state and then the Learning state until it reaches the forwarding state.
This is also the amount of time used to age out all dynamic entries in
the Forwarding Database when a topology change occurs. Configured
through the bridge forward delay command.
Hello Time The amount of time (in seconds) between the transmission of Configu-
ration BPDUs on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempt-
ing to become the Spanning Tree root. Configured through the bridge
hello time command.
System Max Age The Max Age value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.
System Hello Time The Hello Time value for the root bridge.

-> bridge mode flat


-> bridge protocol mstp
-> show spantree
Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
Msti STP Status Protocol Priority (Prio:SysID)
-----+----------+--------+---------------------
0 ON MSTP 32768 (0x8000:0x0000)
2 ON MSTP 32770 (0x8000:0x0002)
3 ON MSTP 32771 (0x8000:0x0003)

output definitions
Spanning Tree Path Cost The Spanning Tree path cost mode for the switch (32 BIT or AUTO)
Mode Configured through the bridge path cost mode command.
Msti The Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) instance number. Config-
ured through the bridge msti command. Note that MSTI 0 also repre-
sents the CIST instance that is always present on the switch.
Spanning Tree Status The Spanning Tree state for the MSTI (ON or OFF).
Protocol The Spanning Tree protocol applied to this instance. Configured
through the bridge protocol command.
Priority The Spanning Tree bridge priority for the instance. The lower the num-
ber, the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge priority
command.

page 5-119 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> show spantree
Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
Spanning Tree PVST+ Mode : Enable
Vlan STP Status Protocol Priority
-----+----------+--------+--------------
1 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
2 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
3 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
4 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
5 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
6 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
7 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)

-> show spantree 2


Spanning Tree Parameters for Vlan 2
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE STP,
mode : PVST+ (1 STP per Vlan),
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
Bridge ID : 8000-00:d0:95:6a:f4:58,
Designated Root : 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00,
Cost to Root Bridge : 0,
Root Port : Slot 1 Interface 1,
Next Best Root Cost : 0,
Next Best Root Port : Slot 1 Interface 1,
Tx Hold Count : 6,
Topology Changes : 0,
Topology age : 00:00:00,
Current Parameters (seconds)
Max Age = 20,
Forward Delay = 15,
Hello Time = 2
Parameters system uses when attempting to become root
System Max Age = 20,
System Forward Delay = 15,
System Hello Time = 2

output definitions
Spanning Tree Path Cost The Spanning Tree path cost mode for the switch (32 BIT or AUTO)
Mode Configured through the bridge path cost mode command.
Spanning Tree PVST+ Mode Indicates whether the PVST + status is enabled or disabled. Configured
through the bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ command.
Vlan The VLAN ID associated with the VLAN Spanning Tree instance.
Configured through the vlan commands
STP Status The Spanning Tree state for the instance (ON or OFF). Configured
through the vlan stp command.
Protocol The Spanning Tree protocol applied to this instance (STP or RSTP).
Configured through the bridge protocol command.
Mode The Spanning Tree operating mode for the switch (PVST+, 1x1 or
flat). Configured through bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ or bridge mode
command.

page 5-120 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Priority The Spanning Tree bridge priority for the instance. The lower the num-
ber, the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge priority
command.
Bridge ID The bridge identifier for this Spanning Tree instance. Consists of the
bridge priority value (in hex) concatenated with the dedicated bridge
MAC address.
Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the Spanning Tree for this instance.
Cost to Root Bridge The cost of the path to the root for this Spanning Tree instance.
Root Port The port that offers the lowest cost path from this bridge to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Cost The cost of the next best root port for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Port The port that offers the next best (second lowest) cost path to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Tx Hold Count The count to limit the transmission of BPDU through the port.
Topology Changes The number of topology changes detected by this Spanning Tree
instance since the management entity was last reset or initialized.
Topology age The amount of time (in hundredths of seconds) since the last topology
change was detected by this Spanning Tree instance (hh:mm:ss or dd
days and hh:mm:ss).
Max Age The amount of time (in seconds) that Spanning Tree Protocol informa-
tion is retained before it is discarded. Configured through the bridge
max age command.
Forward Delay The amount of time (in seconds) that a port will remain in the Listening
state and then the Learning state until it reaches the forwarding state.
This is also the amount of time used to age out all dynamic entries in
the Forwarding Database when a topology change occurs. Configured
through the bridge forward delay command.
Hello Time The amount of time (in seconds) between the transmission of Configu-
ration BPDUs on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempt-
ing to become the Spanning Tree root. Configured through the bridge
hello time command.
System Max Age The Max Age value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.
System Hello Time The Hello Time value for the root bridge.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-121 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

show spantree cist Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for the CIST instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat)
is active on the switch.
show spantree msti Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for an MSTI regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active
on the switch.
show spantree 1x1 Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for a VLAN instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat)
is active on the switch.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsProtocolSpecification
vStpInsMode
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress
vStpInsDesignatedRoot
vStpInsRootCost
vStpInsRootPortNumber
vStpInsNextBestRootCost
vStpInsNextBestRootPortNumber
vStpInsBridgeTxHoldCount
vStpInsTopChanges
vStpInsTimeSinceTopologyChange
vStpInsMaxAge
vStpInsForwardDelay
vStpInsHelloTime

page 5-122 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree cist


Displays the Spanning Tree bridge configuration for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree
(CIST) instance.
show spantree cist

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guideline
This is an explicit Spanning Tree command that displays Spanning Tree bridge information for the flat
mode CIST instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active on the switch. Note that minimal
information is displayed when this command is used in the 1x1 mode, as the CIST is not active in this
mode. See second example below.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> show spantree cist
Spanning Tree Parameters for Cist
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Multiple STP,
mode : FLAT (Single STP),
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
Bridge ID : 8000-00:d0:95:6a:f4:58,
CST Designated Root : 0001-00:d0:95:6a:79:50,
Cost to CST Root : 19,
Next CST Best Cost : 0,
Designated Root : 8000-00:d0:95:6a:f4:58,
Cost to Root Bridge : 0,
Root Port : Slot 1 Interface 12,
Next Best Root Cost : 0,
Next Best Root Port : None,
Tx Hold Count : 6,
Topology Changes : 7,
Topology age : 00:00:07,
Current Parameters (seconds)
Max Age = 20,
Forward Delay = 15,
Hello Time = 2
Parameters system uses when attempting to become root
System Max Age = 20,
System Forward Delay = 15,
System Hello Time = 2

page 5-123 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> show spantree cist
Per Vlan Spanning Tree is enforced !! (1x1 mode)
INACTIVE Spanning Tree Parameters for Cist
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Multiple STP,
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
System Max Age (seconds) = 20,
System Forward Delay (seconds) = 15,
System Hello Time (seconds) = 2

output definitions
STP Status The Spanning Tree state for the instance (on or off).
Protocol The Spanning Tree protocol applied to the CIST (STP, RSTP, or
MSTP). Configured through the bridge protocol command.
Mode The Spanning Tree operating mode for the switch (1x1 or flat). Config-
ured through the bridge mode command.
Priority The Spanning Tree bridge priority for the instance. The lower the num-
ber, the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge priority
command.
Bridge ID The bridge identifier for this Spanning Tree instance. Consists of the
bridge priority value (in hex) concatenated with the dedicated bridge
MAC address.
CST Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the flat mode CIST instance. This
field only appears when MSTP is active on the switch.
Cost to CST Root The cost of the path to the root of the flat mode CIST instance. This
field only appears when MSTP is active on the switch.
Next CST Best Cost The cost of the next best root port for the flat mode CIST instance. This
field only appears when MSTP is active on the switch.
Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the Spanning Tree for this instance.
Cost to Root Bridge The cost of the path to the root for this Spanning Tree instance.
Root Port The port that offers the lowest cost path from this bridge to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Cost The cost of the next best root port for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Port The port that offers the next best (second lowest) cost path to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Tx Hold Count The count to limit the transmission of BPDU through the port.
Topology Changes The number of topology changes detected by this Spanning Tree
instance since the management entity was last reset or initialized.
Topology age The amount of time (in hundredths of seconds) since the last topology
change was detected by this Spanning Tree instance (hh:mm:ss or dd
days and hh:mm:ss).
Max Age The amount of time (in seconds) that Spanning Tree Protocol informa-
tion is retained before it is discarded. Configured through the bridge
max age command.

page 5-124 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Forward Delay The amount of time (in seconds) that a port will remain in the Listening
state and then the Learning state until it reaches the forwarding state.
This is also the amount of time used to age out all dynamic entries in
the Forwarding Database when a topology change occurs. Configured
through the bridge forward delay command.
Hello Time The amount of time (in seconds) between the transmission of Configu-
ration BPDUs on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempt-
ing to become the Spanning Tree root. Configured through the bridge
hello time command.
System Max Age The Max Age value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree Implicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.
show spantree msti Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for an MSTI regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active
on the switch.
show spantree 1x1 Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for a VLAN instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat)
is active on the switch.

page 5-125 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsProtocolSpecification
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress
vStpInsTimeSinceTopologyChange
vStpInsTopChanges
vStpInsDesignatedRoot
vStpInsRootCost
vStpInsRootPortNumber
vStpInsNextBestRootCost
vStpInsNextBestRootPortNumber
vStpInsMaxAge
vStpInsHelloTime
vStpInsBridgeTxHoldCount
vStpInsForwardDelay
vStpInsBridgeMaxAge
vStpInsBridgeHelloTime
vStpInsBridgeForwardDelay
vStpInsCistRegionalRootId
vStpInsCistPathCost

page 5-126 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree msti


Displays Spanning Tree bridge information for a Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI).
show spantree msti [msti_id]

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0-4094).

Defaults

parameter default
instance all MSTIs

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an msti_id number is not specified, this command displays the Spanning Tree status, protocol, and
priority values for all MSTIs.
• This is an explicit Spanning Tree command that displays Spanning Tree bridge information for an
MSTI regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active on the switch.
• Note that minimal information is displayed when this command is used in the 1x1 mode, as MSTIs are
not active in this mode. In addition, this command will fail if MSTP is not the selected flat mode proto-
col.
• Note that MSTI 0 also represents the CIST instance that is always present on the switch. To view the
CIST instance using this command, specify zero (0) for the msti_id number.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> bridge protocol mstp
-> show spantree msti
Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
Msti STP Status Protocol Priority (Prio:SysID)
-----+----------+--------+---------------------
0 ON MSTP 32768 (0x8000:0x0000)
2 ON MSTP 32770 (0x8000:0x0002)
3 ON MSTP 32771 (0x8000:0x0003)

-> show spantree msti 0


Spanning Tree Parameters for Cist
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Multiple STP,
mode : FLAT (Single STP),
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
Bridge ID : 8000-00:d0:95:6b:08:40,

page 5-127 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

CST Designated Root : 0001-00:10:b5:58:9d:39,


Cost to CST Root : 39,
Next CST Best Cost : 0,
Designated Root : 8000-00:d0:95:6b:08:40,
Cost to Root Bridge : 0,
Root Port : Slot 9 Interface 2,
Next Best Root Cost : 0,
Next Best Root Port : None,
TxHoldCount : 6,
Topology Changes : 1,
Topology age : 0:30:46
Current Parameters (seconds)
Max Age = 6,
Forward Delay = 4,
Hello Time = 2
Parameters system uses when attempting to become root
System Max Age = 20,
System Forward Delay = 15,
System Hello Time = 2

-> show spantree msti 1


Spanning Tree Parameters for Msti 1
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Multiple STP,
mode : FLAT (Single STP),
Priority : 32769 (0x8001),
Bridge ID : 8001-00:d0:95:6b:08:40,
Designated Root : 8001-00:d0:95:6b:08:40,
Cost to Root Bridge : 0,
Root Port : None,
Next Best Root Cost : 0,
Next Best Root Port : None,
TxHoldCount : 6,
Topology Changes : 0,
Topology age : 0:0:0
Current Parameters (seconds)
Max Age = 20,
Forward Delay = 15,
Hello Time = 2
Parameters system uses when attempting to become root
System Max Age = 20,
System Forward Delay = 15,
System Hello Time = 2

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> show spantree msti
Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
** Inactive flat mode instances: **
Msti STP Status Protocol Priority (Prio:SysID)
-----+----------+--------+---------------------
0 ON MSTP 32768 (0x8000:0x0000)
2 ON MSTP 32770 (0x8000:0x0002)
3 ON MSTP 32771 (0x8000:0x0003)

page 5-128 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> show spantree msti 0


Per Vlan Spanning Tree is enforced !! (1x1 mode)
INACTIVE Spanning Tree Parameters for Cist
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Multiple STP,
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
System Max Age (seconds) = 20,
System Forward Delay (seconds) = 15,
System Hello Time (seconds) = 2

-> show spantree msti 2


Per Vlan Spanning Tree is enforced !! (1x1 mode)
INACTIVE Spanning Tree Parameters for Msti 2
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE Multiple STP,
Priority : 32770 (0x8002),
System Max Age (seconds) = 20,
System Forward Delay (seconds) = 15,
System Hello Time (seconds) = 2

output definitions
Spanning Tree Path Cost The Spanning Tree path cost mode for the switch (32 BIT or AUTO)
Mode Configured through the bridge path cost mode command.
Msti The Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) number. MSTI 0 repre-
sents the CIST. Configured through the bridge msti command.
STP Status The Spanning Tree state for the instance (ON or OFF).
Protocol The Spanning Tree protocol applied to the instance (STP, RSTP, or
MSTP). This value is not configurable for an MSTI. Configured
through the bridge protocol command.
Mode The Spanning Tree operating mode for the switch (1x1 or flat). Config-
ured through the bridge mode command.
Priority The Spanning Tree bridge priority for the instance. The lower the num-
ber, the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge msti prior-
ity command.
Bridge ID The bridge identifier for this Spanning Tree instance. Consists of the
bridge priority value (in hex) concatenated with the dedicated bridge
MAC address.
CST Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the flat mode CIST instance. This
field only appears when MSTP is active on the switch.
Cost to CST Root The cost of the path to the root for the flat mode CIST instance. This
field only appears when MSTP is active on the switch.
Next CST Best Cost The cost of the next best root port for the flat mode CIST instance. This
field only appears when MSTP is active on the switch.
Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the Spanning Tree for this instance.
Cost to Root Bridge The cost of the path to the root for this Spanning Tree instance.
Root Port The port that offers the lowest cost path from this bridge to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Cost The cost of the next best root port for this Spanning Tree instance.

page 5-129 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Next Best Root Port The port that offers the next best (second lowest) cost path to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
TxHoldCount The count to limit the transmission of BPDU through the port.
Topology Changes The number of topology changes detected by this Spanning Tree
instance since the management entity was last reset or initialized.
Topology age The amount of time (in hundredths of seconds) since the last topology
change was detected by this Spanning Tree instance (hh:mm:ss or dd
days and hh:mm:ss).
Max Age The amount of time (in seconds) that Spanning Tree Protocol informa-
tion is retained before it is discarded. MSTIs inherit this value from the
CIST instance.
Forward Delay The amount of time (in seconds) that a port will remain in the Listening
state and then the Learning state until it reaches the forwarding state.
This is also the amount of time used to age out all dynamic entries in
the Forwarding Database when a topology change occurs. MSTIs
inherit this value from the CIST instance.
Hello Time The amount of time (in seconds) between the transmission of Configu-
ration BPDUs on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempt-
ing to become the Spanning Tree root. MSTIs inherit this value from
the CIST instance.
System Max Age The Max Age value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree Implicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.
show spantree cist Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for the CIST instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat)
is active on the switch.
show spantree 1x1 Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for a VLAN instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat)
is active on the switch.

page 5-130 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsProtocolSpecification
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress
vStpInsTimeSinceTopologyChange
vStpInsTopChanges
vStpInsDesignatedRoot
vStpInsRootCost
vStpInsRootPortNumber
vStpInsNextBestRootCost
vStpInsNextBestRootPortNumber
vStpInsMaxAge
vStpInsHelloTime
vStpInsBridgeTxHoldCount
vStpInsForwardDelay
vStpInsBridgeMaxAge
vStpInsBridgeHelloTime
vStpInsBridgeForwardDelay
vStpInsCistRegionalRootId
vStpInsCistPathCost
vStpInsMstiNumber

page 5-131 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree 1x1


Displays Spanning Tree bridge information for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree 1x1 [vid]

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1-4094).

Defaults

parameter default
vid all VLAN instances

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a vid number is not specified, this command displays the Spanning Tree status, protocol, and priority
values for all VLAN instances.
• Specify a vid number with this command to display Spanning Tree bridge information for a specific
VLAN instance.
• Specifying a range of VLAN IDs is also allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range (e.g.,
show spantree 1x1 10-15). Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of VLAN
IDs— is allowed with this command. Multiple entries are not accepted.
• This is an explicit Spanning Tree command that displays Spanning Tree bridge information for a
VLAN instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active on the switch. Note that minimal infor-
mation is displayed when this command is used in the flat mode, as VLAN instances are not active in
this mode.

Examples
-> show spantree 1x1
Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
Vlan STP Status Protocol Priority
-----+----------+--------+--------------
1 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
2 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
3 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
4 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
5 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)
6 ON STP 32768 (0x8000)

page 5-132 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> show spantree 1x1 7


Spanning Tree Parameters for Vlan 7
Spanning Tree Status : ON,
Protocol : IEEE STP,
mode : 1X1 (1 STP per Vlan),
Priority : 32768 (0x8000),
Bridge ID : 8000-00:d0:95:6a:f4:58,
Designated Root : 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00,
Cost to Root Bridge : 0,
Root Port : Slot 1 Interface 1,
Next Best Root Cost : 0,
Next Best Root Port : Slot 1 Interface 1,
Tx Hold Count : 6,
Topology Changes : 0,
Topology age : 00:00:00,
Current Parameters (seconds)
Max Age = 20,
Forward Delay = 15,
Hello Time = 2
Parameters system uses when attempting to become root
System Max Age = 20,
System Forward Delay = 15,
System Hello Time = 2

-> show spantree 1x1 10-15


Spanning Tree Path Cost Mode : AUTO
Vlan STP Status Protocol Priority
-----+----------+--------+--------------
10 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000)
11 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000)
12 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000)
13 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000)
14 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000)
15 ON RSTP 32768 (0x8000)

output definitions
Spanning Tree Path Cost The Spanning Tree path cost mode for the switch (32 BIT or AUTO)
Mode Configured through the bridge path cost mode command.
Vlan The VLAN ID associated with the VLAN Spanning Tree instance.
Configured through the vlan commands
STP Status The Spanning Tree state for the instance (ON or OFF).
Protocol The Spanning Tree protocol applied to the VLAN instance (STP or
RSTP). Note that MSTP is not supported for a VLAN instance. Con-
figured through the bridge protocol command.
Mode The Spanning Tree operating mode for the switch (1x1 or flat). Config-
ured through the bridge mode command.
Priority The Spanning Tree bridge priority for the instance. The lower the num-
ber, the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge priority
command.
Bridge ID The bridge identifier for this Spanning Tree instance. Consists of the
bridge priority value (in hex) concatenated with the dedicated bridge
MAC address.

page 5-133 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Designated Root The bridge identifier for the root of the Spanning Tree for this instance.
Cost to Root Bridge The cost of the path to the root for this Spanning Tree instance.
Root Port The port that offers the lowest cost path from this bridge to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Cost The cost of the next best root port for this Spanning Tree instance.
Next Best Root Port The port that offers the next best (second lowest) cost path to the root
bridge for this Spanning Tree instance.
Tx Hold Count The count to limit the transmission of BPDU through the port.
Topology Changes The number of topology changes detected by this Spanning Tree
instance since the management entity was last reset or initialized.
Topology age The amount of time (in hundredths of seconds) since the last topology
change was detected by this Spanning Tree instance (hh:mm:ss or dd
days and hh:mm:ss).
Max Age The amount of time (in seconds) that Spanning Tree Protocol informa-
tion is retained before it is discarded. Configured through the bridge
max age command.
Forward Delay The amount of time (in seconds) that a port will remain in the Listening
state and then the Learning state until it reaches the forwarding state.
This is also the amount of time used to age out all dynamic entries in
the Forwarding Database when a topology change occurs. Configured
through the bridge forward delay command.
Hello Time The amount of time (in seconds) between the transmission of Configu-
ration BPDUs on any port that is the Spanning Tree root or is attempt-
ing to become the Spanning Tree root. Configured through the bridge
hello time command.
System Max Age The Max Age value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.
System Forward Delay The Forward Delay value for the root bridge.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-134 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

show spantree Implicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.
show spantree cist Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge configu-
ration for the CIST instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat)
is active on the switch.
show spantree msti Explicit command for displaying the Spanning Tree bridge informa-
tion for an MSTI when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat
Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsTable
vStpInsNumber
vStpInsMode
vStpInsProtocolSpecification
vStpInsPriority
vStpInsBridgeAddress
vStpInsTimeSinceTopologyChange
vStpInsTopChanges
vStpInsDesignatedRoot
vStpInsRootCost
vStpInsRootPortNumber
vStpInsNextBestRootCost
vStpInsNextBestRootPortNumber
vStpInsMaxAge
vStpInsHelloTime
vStpInsBridgeTxHoldCount
vStpInsForwardDelay
vStpInsBridgeMaxAge
vStpInsBridgeHelloTime
vStpInsBridgeForwardDelay
vStpIns1x1VlanNumber

page 5-135 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree ports


Displays Spanning Tree port information for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree [instance] ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]

Syntax Definitions
instance The CIST instance or an existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
forwarding Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
forwarding for the specified instance.
blocking Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
blocked for the specified instance.
active Displays a list of active ports associated with the specified instance.
configured Displays Spanning Tree administrative port parameters for all ports
associated with the specified instance. Note that this parameter is only
available if an instance value is specified with this command.

Defaults

parameter default
instance all instances
forwarding | blocking | active | all ports
configured

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an instance number is not specified, this command displays the Spanning Tree operational status,
path cost, and role for all ports and their associated instances.
• Specifying an instance number with this command when the switch is running the 1x1 Spanning Tree
operating mode implies a VLAN ID and displays Spanning Tree port information for the associated
VLAN instance.
• If the switch is running in the flat mode and STP (802.1D) or RSTP (802.1W) is the active protocol,
enter 1 to specify the CIST instance. If MSTP is the active protocol, however, entering 1 for the
instance number is not accepted. In this case, use the show spantree cist ports or show spantree msti
ports commands instead.
• The configured keyword is only available when an instance number is specified with this command. In
addition, this keyword cannot be used in combination with either the forwarding or blocking
keywords.

page 5-136 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> show spantree ports
Bridge Port Oper Status Path Cost Role
------+-----+------------+---------+-----
1 1/1 FORW 19 ROOT
1 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/12 DIS 0 DIS

-> show spantree 1 ports


Spanning Tree Port Summary
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+----------------------
1/1 FORW 19 52 ROOT 1/1 PTP EDG 8000-00:30:f1:5b:37:73
1/2 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/2 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/3 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/3 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/4 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/4 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/5 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/5 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/6 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/6 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/7 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/7 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/8 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/8 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/9 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/9 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/10 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/10 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/11 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/11 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/12 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/12 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00

-> show spantree 1 ports active


Spanning Tree Port Summary
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+----------------------
1/1 FORW 19 52 ROOT 1/1 PTP EDG 8000-00:30:f1:5b:37:73

output definitions
Bridge The CIST instance, referred to as bridge 1 when either STP (802.1D) or
RSTP (802.1W) is the active protocol in the flat mode.
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Oper St The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, learning, and forwarding.

page 5-137 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Path Cost The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops. Config-
ured through the bridge slot/port path cost command.
Desig Cost The path cost of the Designated Port of the segment connected to this
port. If this is the root bridge or the Spanning Tree status of the port is
administratively disabled, this value is 0.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, and backup.
Prim. Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module for the primary port associated with this Spanning Tree
instance. This information is only available if the port role is backup.
Op Cnx Operational connection type: PTP, NPT, or NS (nonsignificant).
Shows the current operational state of the port’s connection type. See
the bridge slot/port connection command on page 5-87 for more
information.
Op Edg Operational connection type: EDG. Shows the current operational state
of the port’s connection type. See the bridge slot/port connection
command on page 5-87 for more information.
Desig Bridge ID The bridge identifier for the designated bridge for this port’s segment.

-> show spantree msti 1 ports configured


Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr OS8800
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Role 10G Opt.
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+----+----+----+--------
1/1 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/2 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/3 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/4 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/5 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/6 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/7 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/8 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/9 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/10 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/11 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/12 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS

output definitions
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Port Pri The Spanning Tree priority for the port (0–15). The lower the number,
the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge slot/port prior-
ity command.
Adm St The Spanning Tree administrative status of the port: enabled or dis-
abled. Configured through the bridge slot/port command to enable or
disable Spanning Tree on a port.

page 5-138 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions
Man. Mode The manual mode setting for the port: yes indicates that the blocking or
forwarding state of the port was manually set and the port does not par-
ticipate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm; no indicates that the Spanning
Tree Algorithm is managing the port state. Configured through the
bridge slot/port mode command.
Config Cost The configured path cost value for this port. Configured through the
bridge slot/port path cost command.
Adm Cnx The administrative connection type: PTP, NPT, or AUT. Configured
through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Adm Edg The edge port administrative status: yes indicates that the port is an
admin edge port; no indicates that the port is not an admin edge port.
Configured through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Aut Edg The edge port automatic status: yes indicates that the port is an auto-
matic edge port; no indicates that the port is not an automatic edge port.
Configured through the bridge cist slot/port auto-edge or bridge 1x1
slot/port auto-edge command.
Rstr Tcn The restricted TCN capability: yes indicates that the port supports the
restricted TCN capability; no indicates that the port does not support
the restricted TCN capability. Configured through the bridge cist slot/
port restricted-tcn or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn command.
Rstr Role The restricted role port status: yes indicates that the port is a restricted
role port; no indicates that the port is not a restricted role port. Config-
ured through the bridge cist slot/port restricted-role or bridge 1x1
slot/port restricted-role command.
OS8800 10G Opt. N/A

-> bridge mode flat


-> bridge protocol mstp
-> show spantree ports
Msti Port Oper Status Path Cost Role
-----+-----+------------+---------+-----
0 1/1 FORW 200000 ROOT
0 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/12 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/13 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/14 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/15 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/16 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/17 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/18 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/19 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/20 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/21 DIS 0 DIS

page 5-139 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

0 1/22 DIS 0 DIS


0 1/23 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/24 DIS 0 DIS
0 5/1 DIS 0 DIS
0 5/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/1 FORW 200000 MSTR
1 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/12 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/13 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/14 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/15 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/16 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/17 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/18 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/19 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/20 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/21 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/22 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/23 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/24 DIS 0 DIS

-> show spantree ports active


Msti Port Oper Status Path Cost Role
-----+-----+------------+---------+-----
0 1/1 FORW 200000 ROOT
1 1/1 FORW 200000 MSTR
2 1/1 FORW 200000 MSTR

output definitions
Msti The Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) instance number. Config-
ured through the bridge msti command. Note that MSTI 0 also repre-
sents the CIST instance that is always present on the switch.
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Oper St The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, learning, and forwarding.
Path Cost The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops. Config-
ured through the bridge slot/port path cost command.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, and backup.

page 5-140 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> bridge mode 1x1


-> show spantree ports
Vlan Port Oper Status Path Cost Role
-----+-----+------------+---------+-----
1 1/1 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/12 FORW 19 ROOT
-> show spantree 1 ports
Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 1
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+----+---+----+----------------------
1/1 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/1 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/2 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/2 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/3 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/3 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/4 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/4 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/5 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/5 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/6 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/6 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/7 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/7 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/8 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/8 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/9 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/9 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/10 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/10 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/11 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/11 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/12 FORW 19 0 ROOT 1/12 PTP NO 0001-00:d0:95:6a:79:50

-> show spantree 1 ports active


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 1
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+----+----+---+----------------------
1/12 FORW 19 0 ROOT 1/12 PTP EDG 0001-00:d0:95:6a:79:50

output definitions
Vlan The VLAN ID associated with the VLAN Spanning Tree instance.
Configured through the vlan commands
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Oper St The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, listening, learning, and forwarding.
Path Cost The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops. Config-
ured through the bridge slot/port path cost command.

page 5-141 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Desig Cost The path cost of the Designated Port of the segment connected to this
port. If this is the root bridge or the Spanning Tree status of the port is
administratively disabled, this value is 0.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, and backup.
Prim. Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module for the primary port associated with this Spanning Tree
instance. This information is only available if the port role is backup.
Op Cnx Operational connection type: PTP, NPT, or NS (nonsignificant).
Shows the current operational state of the port’s connection type. See
the bridge slot/port connection command on page 5-87 for more
information.
Op Edg Operational connection type: EDG. Shows the current operational state
of the port’s connection type. See the bridge slot/port connection
command on page 5-87 for more information.
Desig Bridge ID The bridge identifier for the designated bridge for this port’s segment.

-> show spantree 2 ports configured


Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 2
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Role 10G Opt. Cfg Stst
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+----+----+----+---------+---------
3/1 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT/ON
3/3 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT/OFF
0/9 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT/ON

output definitions
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Port Pri The Spanning Tree priority for the port (0–15). The lower the number,
the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge slot/port prior-
ity command.
Adm St The Spanning Tree administrative status of the port: enabled or dis-
abled. Configured through the bridge slot/port command to enable or
disable Spanning Tree on a port.
Man. Mode The manual mode setting for the port: yes indicates that the blocking or
forwarding state of the port was manually set and the port does not par-
ticipate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm; no indicates that the Spanning
Tree Algorithm is managing the port state. Configured through the
bridge slot/port mode command.
Config Cost The configured path cost value for this port. Configured through the
bridge slot/port path cost command.
Adm Cnx The administrative connection type: PTP, NPT, or AUT. Configured
through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Adm Edg The edge port administrative status: yes indicates that the port is an
admin edge port; no indicates that the port is not an admin edge port.
Configured through the bridge slot/port connection command.

page 5-142 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Aut Edg The edge port automatic status: yes indicates that the port is an auto-
matic edge port; no indicates that the port is not an automatic edge port.
Configured through the bridge cist slot/port auto-edge or bridge 1x1
slot/port auto-edge command.
Rstr Tcn The restricted TCN capability: yes indicates that the port supports the
restricted TCN capability; no indicates that the port does not support
the restricted TCN capability. Configured through the bridge cist slot/
port restricted-tcn or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn command.
Rstr Role The restricted role port status: yes indicates that the port is a restricted
role port; no indicates that the port is not a restricted role port. Config-
ured through the bridge cist slot/port restricted-role or bridge 1x1
slot/port restricted-role command.
OS8800 10G Opt. N/A
PVST+ Cfg Indicates the current PVST+ port configuration (auto, enable or dis-
able).
PVST+ Stat Indicates the current status of the PVST+ port (On or Off).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree cist ports Implicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for the flat mode CIST when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or
flat Spanning Tree mode.
show spantree msti ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for an MSTI when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat Span-
ning Tree mode.
show spantree 1x1 ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat
Spanning Tree mode.

page 5-143 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority
vStpInsPortEnable
vStpInsPortState
vStpInsPortManualMode
vStpInsPortPathCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedCost
vStpInsPortRole
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType
vStpInsPortAdminEdge
vStpInsPortAutoEdge
vStpInsPortRestrictedRole
vStpInsPortRestrictedTcn
vStpInsPortPrimaryPortNumber
vStpInsPortDesignatedRoot
vStpInsPortDesignatedBridge

page 5-144 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree cist ports


Displays Spanning Tree port information for the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance.
show spantree cist ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]

Syntax Definitions
forwarding Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
forwarding for the CIST instance.
blocking Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
blocked for the CIST instance.
active Displays a list of active ports associated with the specified instance.
configured Displays Spanning Tree administrative port parameters for the CIST
instance.

Defaults

parameter default
forwarding | blocking | active | all ports
configured

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This is an explicit Spanning Tree command that displays Spanning Tree port information for the flat
mode CIST instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active on the switch.
• Note that minimal information is displayed when this command is used in the 1x1 mode, as the CIST is
not active in this mode.

Examples
-> show spantree cist ports
Spanning Tree Port Summary for Cist
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+----+---+----+----------------------
1/1 FORW 200000 52 ROOT 1/1 PTP EDG 8000-00:30:f1:5b:37:73
1/2 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/2 NS No 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/3 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/3 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/4 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/4 NS No 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/5 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/5 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/6 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/6 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/7 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/7 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/8 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/8 NS No 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00

page 5-145 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> show spantree cist ports active


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Cist
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+----+----+----+----------------------
1/1 FORW 200000 52 ROOT 1/1 PTP EDG 8000-00:30:f1:5b:37:73

output definitions
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Oper St The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, listening, learning, and forwarding.
Path Cost The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops. Config-
ured through the bridge slot/port path cost command.
Desig Cost The path cost of the Designated Port of the segment connected to this
port. If this is the root bridge or the Spanning Tree status of the port is
administratively disabled, this value is 0.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, and backup.
Prim. Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module for the primary port associated with this Spanning Tree
instance. This information is only available if the port role is backup.
Op Cnx Operational connection type: PTP, NPT, or NS (nonsignificant).
Shows the current operational state of the port’s connection type. See
the bridge slot/port connection command on page 5-87 for more
information.
Op Edg Operational connection type: EDG. Shows the current operational state
of the port’s connection type. See the bridge slot/port connection
command on page 5-87 for more information.
Desig Bridge ID The bridge identifier for the designated bridge for this port’s segment.

-> show spantree cist ports configured


Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 1
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr Role/ OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Root Guard 10G Opt Cfg Stat
-----+----+----+-----+-------+----+----+----+----+-----------+--------+--------
1/1 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT Off
1/2 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT Off
1/3 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT Off
1/4 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT Off

page 5-146 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Port Pri The Spanning Tree priority for the port (0–15). The lower the number,
the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge slot/port prior-
ity command.
Adm St The Spanning Tree administrative status of the port: enabled or dis-
abled. Configured through the bridge slot/port command to enable or
disable Spanning Tree on a port.
Man. Mode The manual mode setting for the port: yes indicates that the blocking or
forwarding state of the port was manually set and the port does not par-
ticipate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm; no indicates that the Spanning
Tree Algorithm is managing the port state. Configured through the
bridge slot/port mode command.
Config Cost The configured path cost value for this port. Configured through the
bridge slot/port path cost command.
Adm Cnx The administrative connection type: PTP, NPT, or AUT. Configured
through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Adm Edg The edge port administrative status: yes indicates that the port is an
admin edge port; no indicates that the port is not an admin edge port.
Configured through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Aut Edg The edge port automatic status: yes indicates that the port is an auto-
matic edge port; no indicates that the port is not an automatic edge port.
Configured through the bridge cist slot/port auto-edge or bridge 1x1
slot/port auto-edge command.
Rstr Tcn The restricted TCN capability: yes indicates that the port supports the
restricted TCN capability; no indicates that the port does not support
the restricted TCN capability. Configured through the bridge cist slot/
port restricted-tcn or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn command.
Rstr Role/Root Guard The restricted status of the port: Yes indicates that the port is restricted
from becoming the root; No indicates that the port is not restricted from
becoming the root. Configured through the bridge cist slot/port
restricted-role or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-role command.
OS8800 10G Opt. N/A
PVST+ Cfg Stat The PVST+ status on the switch: enabled or disabled. Configured
through the bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ command to enable or disable
PVST+ mode on the switch.
PVST+ Stat Indicates whether or not the PVST+ interoperability status is enabled
(ENA) or disabled (DIS) for the port. Configured throught the bridge
mode 1x1 pvst+ command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-147 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

show spantree ports Implicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree msti ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for an MSTI when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat Span-
ning Tree mode.
show spantree 1x1 ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for a VLAN instance when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat
Spanning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority
vStpInsPortState
vStpInsPortEnable
vStpInsPortPathCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedBridge
vStpInsPortAdminEdge
vStpInsPortAutoEdge
vStpInsPortRestrictedRole
vStpInsPortRestrictedTcn
vStpInsPortManualMode
vStpInsPortRole
vStpInsPrimaryPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType

page 5-148 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree msti ports


Displays Spanning Tree port information for a flat mode Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI).
show spantree msti [msti_id] ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0-4094).
forwarding Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
forwarding for the CIST instance.
blocking Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
blocked for the CIST instance.
active Displays a list of active ports associated with the specified instance.
configured Displays Spanning Tree administrative port parameters for the CIST
instance.

Defaults

parameter default
msti_id all MSTIs
forwarding | blocking | active | all ports
configured

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an msti_id number is not specified, this command displays the Spanning Tree port operational status,
path cost, and role values for all associated MSTIs.
• This is an explicit Spanning Tree command that displays Spanning Tree port information for an MSTI
regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active on the switch.
• Note that minimal information is displayed when this command is used in the 1x1 mode, as MSTIs are
not active in this mode. In addition, if MSTP is not the selected flat mode protocol, this command will
fail.
• The configured keyword is only available when an instance number is specified with this command. In
addition, this keyword cannot be used in combination with either the forwarding or blocking
keywords.
• Note that MSTI 0 also represents the CIST instance that is always present on the switch. To view the
CIST instance using this command, specify zero (0) for the msti_id number.

page 5-149 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> show spantree msti ports
Msti Port Oper Status Path Cost Role
-----+-----+------------+---------+-----
0 1/1 FORW 200000 ROOT
0 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/12 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/13 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/14 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/15 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/16 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/17 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/18 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/19 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/20 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/21 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/22 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/23 DIS 0 DIS
0 1/24 DIS 0 DIS
0 5/1 DIS 0 DIS
0 5/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/1 FORW 200000 MSTR
1 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/12 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/13 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/14 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/15 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/16 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/17 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/18 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/19 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/20 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/21 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/22 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/23 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/24 DIS 0 DIS
1 5/1 DIS 0 DIS
1 5/2 DIS 0 DIS

page 5-150 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> show spantree msti 2 ports


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Msti 2
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+----------------------
1/1 FORW 200000 0 MSTR 1/1 PTP EDG 8002-00:d0:95:57:3a:9e
1/2 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/2 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/3 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/3 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/4 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/4 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/5 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/5 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/6 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/6 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/7 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/7 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/8 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/8 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/9 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/9 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/10 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/10 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/11 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/11 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/12 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/12 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/13 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/13 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/14 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/14 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/15 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/15 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/16 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/16 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/17 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/17 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/18 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/18 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/19 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/19 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/20 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/20 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/21 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/21 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/22 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/22 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/23 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/23 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/24 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/24 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
5/1 DIS 0 0 DIS 5/1 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
5/2 DIS 0 0 DIS 5/2 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00

-> show spantree msti 2 ports active


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Msti 2
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+-----------------------
1/1 FORW 200000 0 MSTR 1/1 PTP EDG 8002-00:d0:95:57:3a:9e

output definitions
Msti The Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) number. MSTI 0 repre-
sents the CIST. Configured through the bridge msti command.
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Oper St The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, listening, learning, and forwarding.
Path Cost The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops. Config-
ured through the bridge msti slot/port path cost command.

page 5-151 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Desig Cost The path cost of the Designated Port of the segment connected to this
port. If this is the root bridge or the Spanning Tree status of the port is
administratively disabled, this value is 0.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, master, and backup.
Prim. Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module for the primary port associated with this Spanning Tree
instance. This information is only available if the port role is backup.
Op Cnx Operational connection type: PTP, NPT, or NS (nonsignificant).
Shows the current operational state of the port’s connection type. See
the bridge slot/port connection command on page 5-87 for more
information.
Op Edg Operational connection type: EDG. Shows the current operational state
of the port’s connection type. See the bridge slot/port connection
command on page 5-87 for more information.
Desig Bridge ID The bridge identifier for the designated bridge for this port’s segment.

-> show spantree msti 2 ports configured


Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Msti 2
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr OS8800
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Role 10G Opt.
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+----+----+----+--------
1/1 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/2 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/3 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/4 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/5 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/6 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/7 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/8 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/9 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/10 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/11 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS
1/12 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS

output definitions
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Port Pri The Spanning Tree priority for the port (0–15). The lower the number,
the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge msti slot/port
priority command.
Adm St The Spanning Tree administrative status of the port: enabled or dis-
abled. Configured through the bridge slot/port command to enable or
disable Spanning Tree on a port.

page 5-152 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Man. Mode The manual mode setting for the port: yes indicates that the blocking or
forwarding state of the port was manually set and the port does not par-
ticipate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm; no indicates that the Spanning
Tree Algorithm is managing the port state. Configured through the
bridge slot/port mode command.
Config Cost The configured path cost value for this port. Configured through the
bridge msti slot/port path cost command.
Adm Cnx The administrative connection type: PTP, NPT, or AUT. Configured
through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Adm Edg The edge port administrative status: yes indicates that the port is an
admin edge port; no indicates that the port is not an admin edge port.
Configured through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Aut Edg The edge port automatic status: yes indicates that the port is an auto-
matic edge port; no indicates that the port is not an automatic edge port.
Configured through the bridge cist slot/port auto-edge or bridge 1x1
slot/port auto-edge command.
Rstr Tcn The restricted TCN capability: yes indicates that the port supports the
restricted TCN capability; no indicates that the port does not support
the restricted TCN capability. Configured through the bridge cist slot/
port restricted-tcn or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn command.
Rstr Role The restricted role port status: yes indicates that the port is a restricted
role port; no indicates that the port is not a restricted role port. Config-
ured through the bridge cist slot/port restricted-role or bridge 1x1
slot/port restricted-role command.
OS8800 10G Opt. N/A

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree ports Implicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree cist ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for a CIST instance when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat
Spanning Tree mode.
show spantree 1x1 ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for a VLAN when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat Span-
ning Tree mode.

page 5-153 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority
vStpInsPortState
vStpInsPortEnable
vStpInsPortPathCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedBridge
vStpInsPortAdminEdge
vStpInsPortAutoEdge
vStpInsPortRestrictedRole
vStpInsPortRestrictedTcn
vStpInsPortManualMode
vStpInsPortRole
vStpInsPrimaryPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType

page 5-154 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree 1x1 ports


Displays Spanning Tree port information for a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree 1x1 [vid] ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1-4094).
forwarding Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
forwarding for the CIST instance.
blocking Displays Spanning Tree operational port parameters for ports that are
blocked for the CIST instance.
active Displays a list of active ports associated with the specified instance.
configured Displays Spanning Tree administrative port parameters for the CIST
instance.

Defaults

parameter default
vid all VLAN instances
forwarding | blocking | active | all ports
configured

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a vid number is not specified, this command displays the Spanning Tree port operational status, path
cost, and role values for all VLAN instances.
• Specifying a range of VLAN IDs is also allowed. Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range (e.g.,
show spantree 1x1 10-15 ports). Note that only one VLAN entry—a single VLAN ID or a range of
VLAN IDs— is allowed with this command. Multiple entries are not accepted.
• This is an explicit Spanning Tree command that displays Spanning Tree port information for a VLAN
instance regardless of which mode (1x1 or flat) is active on the switch.
• Note that minimal information is displayed when this command is used in the flat mode, as VLAN
instances are not active in this mode.
• The configured keyword is only available when an instance number is specified with this command. In
addition, this keyword cannot be used in combination with either the forwarding or blocking
keywords.

page 5-155 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Examples
-> show spantree 1x1 ports
Vlan Port Oper Status Path Cost Role
-----+-----+------------+---------+-----
1 1/1 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/2 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/3 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/4 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/5 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/6 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/7 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/8 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/9 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/10 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/11 DIS 0 DIS
1 1/12 FORW 19 DIS

-> show spantree 1x1 1 ports


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 1
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+----------------------
1/1 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/1 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/2 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/2 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/3 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/3 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/4 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/4 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/5 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/5 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/6 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/6 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/7 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/7 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/8 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/8 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/9 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/9 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/10 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/10 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/11 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/11 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/12 FORW 19 0 DIS 1/12 PTP NO 0001-00:d0:95:6a:79:50

-> show spantree 1x1 1 ports active


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 1
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+----+---+---+-----------------------
1/12 FORW 19 0 DIS 1/12 PTP EDG 0001-00:d0:95:6a:79:50

-> show spantree 1x1 10-13 ports


Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 10
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Egd Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+----+----+---+----------------------
1/46 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/46 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vl 11
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+---------------------
1/36 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/36 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/37 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/37 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00

page 5-156 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 12


Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+----------------------
1/42 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/42 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
1/43 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/43 NS NO 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00
Spanning Tree Port Summary for Vlan 13
Oper Path Desig Prim. Op Op
Port St Cost Cost Role Port Cnx Edg Desig Bridge ID
-----+----+-------+-------+----+-----+---+---+----------------------
1/38 DIS 0 0 DIS 1/38 NS EDG 0000-00:00:00:00:00:00

output definitions
Vlan The VLAN ID associated with the VLAN Spanning Tree instance.
Configured through the vlan commands
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Oper St The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, listening, learning, and forwarding.
Path Cost The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops. Config-
ured through the bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost command.
Desig Cost The path cost of the Designated Port of the segment connected to this
port. If this is the root bridge or the Spanning Tree status of the port is
administratively disabled, this value is 0.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, master, and backup.
Prim. Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module for the primary port associated with this Spanning Tree
instance. This information is only available if the port role is backup.
Op Cnx Operational connection type: PTP, NPT, or NS (nonsignificant).
Shows the current operational state of the port’s connection type. See
the bridge slot/port connection command on page 5-87 for more
information.
Op Edg Operational connection type: EDG. Shows the current operational state
of the port’s connection type. See the bridge slot/port connection
command on page 5-87 for more information.
Desig Bridge ID The bridge identifier for the designated bridge for this port’s segment.

page 5-157 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

-> show spantree 1x1 1 ports configured


Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 1
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr Role/ OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Root Guard 10G Opt Cfg Stat
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+-----+----+---------+--------+---------
1/1 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/2 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/3 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/4 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/5 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/6 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/7 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/8 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/9 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/10 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/11 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/12 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF

-> show spantree 1x1 10-13 ports configured


Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 10
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr Role/ OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Root Guard 10G Opt Cfg Stat
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+-----+----+---------+--------+---------
1/46 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 11
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr Role/ OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Root Guard 10G Opt Cfg Stat
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+-----+----+---------+--------+---------
1/36 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/37 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 12
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr Role/ OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Root Guard 10G Opt Cfg Stat
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+----+----+----------+--------+---------
1/42 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
1/43 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF
Spanning Tree Port Admin Configuration for Vlan 13
Port Adm Man. Config Adm Adm Aut Rstr Rstr Role/ OS8800 PVST+
Port Pri St. Mode Cost Cnx Edg Edg Tcn Root Guard 10G Opt Cfg Stat
-----+----+----+----+-------+----+----+----+----+----------+--------+---------
1/38 7 ENA No 0 AUT No Yes No No DIS AUT OFF

output definitions
Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number or a logi-
cal port. If the slot number is 0, then the port number refers to a link
aggregate logical port number (e.g., 0/31).
Port Pri The Spanning Tree priority for the port (0–15). The lower the number,
the higher the priority. Configured through the bridge 1x1 slot/port
priority command.
Adm St The Spanning Tree administrative status of the port: enabled or dis-
abled. Configured through the bridge slot/port command to enable or
disable Spanning Tree on a port.

page 5-158 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Man. Mode The manual mode setting for the port: yes indicates that the blocking or
forwarding state of the port was manually set and the port does not par-
ticipate in the Spanning Tree Algorithm; no indicates that the Spanning
Tree Algorithm is managing the port state. Configured through the
bridge slot/port mode command.
Config Cost The configured path cost value for this port. Configured through the
bridge 1x1 slot/port path cost command.
Adm Cnx The administrative connection type: PTP, NPT, or AUT. Configured
through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Adm Edg The edge port administrative status: yes indicates that the port is an
admin edge port; no indicates that the port is not an admin edge port.
Configured through the bridge slot/port connection command.
Aut Edg The edge port automatic status: yes indicates that the port is an auto-
matic edge port; no indicates that the port is not an automatic edge port.
Configured through the bridge cist slot/port auto-edge or bridge 1x1
slot/port auto-edge command.
Rstr Tcn The restricted TCN capability: yes indicates that the port supports the
restricted TCN capability; no indicates that the port does not support
the restricted TCN capability. Configured through the bridge cist slot/
port restricted-tcn or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-tcn command.
Rstr Role/Root Guard The restricted status of the port: Yes indicates that the port is restricted
from becoming the root; No indicates that the port is not restricted from
becoming the root. Configured through the bridge cist slot/port
restricted-role or bridge 1x1 slot/port restricted-role command.
OS8800 10G Opt. N/A
PVST+ Cfg The type of BPDU used on the port: AUTO indicates that IEEE
BPDUs are used until a PVST+ BPDU is detected; ENA indicates
that PVST+ BPDUs are used; DIS indicates that IEEE BPDUs are
used. Configured through the bridge port pvst+ command.
PVST+ Stat Indicates whether or not the PVST+ interoperability status is enabled
(ENA) or disabled (DIS) for the port. Configured throught the bridge
mode 1x1 pvst+ command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-159 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

show spantree ports Implicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for the flat mode CIST instance or a 1x1 mode VLAN instance.
show spantree cist ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for a CIST instance when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat
Spanning Tree mode.
show spantree msti ports Explicit command for displaying Spanning Tree port information
for an MSTI when the switch is operating in the 1x1 or flat Span-
ning Tree mode.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortNumber
vStpInsPortPriority
vStpInsPortState
vStpInsPortEnable
vStpInsPortPathCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedCost
vStpInsPortDesignatedBridge
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType
vStpInsPortAdminEdge
vStpInsPortAutoEdge
vStpInsPortRestrictedRole
vStpInsPortRestrictedTcn
vStpInsPortManualMode
vStpInsPortRole
vStpInsPrimaryPortNumber
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortOperConnectionType

page 5-160 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree mst region


Displays the Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) region information for the switch.
show spantree mst region

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Three MST region attributes (configuration name, revision level, and configuration digest) define an
MST region as required by the IEEE 802.1Q 2005 standard. Switches that share the same values for
these attributes are all considered part of the same region. Currently each switch can belong to one
MST region at a time.
• This command is available when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

Examples
-> show spantree mst region
Configuration Name : Region 1
Revision Level : 0
Configuration Digest : 0xac36177f 50283cd4 b83821d8 ab26de62
Revision Max hops : 20
Cist Instance Number : 0

output definitions
Configuration Name An alphanumeric string up to 32 characters that identifies the name of
the MST region. Use the bridge mst region name command to define
this value.
Revision Level A numeric value (0–65535) that identifies the MST region revision
level for the switch.
Configuration Digest An MST region identifier consisting of a 16 octet hex value (as per the
IEEE 802.1Q 2005 standard) that represents all defined MSTIs and
their associated VLAN ranges. Use the bridge msti and bridge msti
vlan commands to define VLAN to MSTI associations.

page 5-161 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions (continued)


Revision Max hops The number of maximum hops authorized for region information. Con-
figured through the bridge mst region max hops command.
Cist Instance Number The number of the CIST instance, which is currently zero as there is
only one region per switch. Therefore, only one CIST exists per switch
Note that this instance is also known as the flat mode instance and is
known as bridge 1 when using STP or RSTP.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree msti vlan-map Displays the range of VLANs associated to the specified MSTI.
show spantree cist vlan-map Displays the range of VLANs associated to the CIST instance.
show spantree map-msti Displays the MSTI that is associated to the specified VLAN

MIB Objects
vStpMstRegionTable
vStpMstRegionNumber
vStpMstRegionConfigDigest
vStpMstRegionConfigName
vStpMstRegionConfigRevisionLevel
vStpMstRegionCistInstanceNumber
vStpMstRegionMaxHops

page 5-162 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree msti vlan-map


Displays the range of VLANs associated with the specified Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI).
show spantree mst [msti_id] vlan-map

Syntax Definitions
msti_id An existing MSTI ID number (0–4094).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an msti_id is not specified, then the VLAN to MSTI mapping for all defined MSTIs is displayed.

• This command is available when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

• Initially all VLANs are associated with the flat mode CIST instance (also known as MSTI 0).

Examples
-> show spantree msti vlan-map
Spanning Tree Msti/Cist Vlan map
-----------------------------------

Cist
Name :
VLAN list : 1-9,14-4094

Msti 1
Name :
VLAN list : 10-11

Msti 2
Name :
VLAN list : 12-13

-> show spantree msti 2 vlan-map


Spanning Tree Msti Vlan map
-----------------------------

Msti 2
Name :
VLAN list : 12-13

page 5-163 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions
Cist Instance Identifies MSTI VLAN mapping information for the CIST instance.
Msti The MSTI ID number that identifies an association between a Spanning
Tree instance and a range of VLANs.
Name An alphanumeric value that identifies an MSTI name. Use the bridge
msti command to define an MSTI name.
VLAN list The range of VLAN IDs that are associated with this MSTI.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree mst region Displays the MST region information for the switch.
show spantree cist vlan-map Displays the range of VLANs associated to the CIST instance.
show spantree map-msti Displays the MSTI that is associated to the specified VLAN

MIB Objects
vStpMstInstanceTable
vStpMstInstanceNumber
vStpMstInstanceName
vStpMstInstanceVlanBitmapState

page 5-164 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree cist vlan-map


Displays the range of VLANs associated with the flat mode Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST)
instance.
show spantree cist vlan-map

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is available when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

• Initially all VLANs are associated with the flat mode CIST instance 0 (also known as MSTI 0).

Examples
-> show spantree cist vlan-map
Spanning Tree Cist Vlan map
-----------------------------

Cist
Name :
VLAN list : 1-9,14-4094

output definitions
Name An alphanumeric value that identifies the name of the CIST. Use the
bridge msti command to define a name for this instance.
VLAN list The range of VLAN IDs that are associated with the CIST instance.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree mst region Displays the MST region information for the switch.
show spantree msti vlan-map Displays the range of VLANs associated to the specified MSTI.
show spantree map-msti Displays the MSTI that is associated to the specified VLAN

page 5-165 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

MIB Objects
vStpMstInstanceTable
vStpMstInstanceNumber
vStpMstInstanceName
vStpMstInstanceVlanBitmapState

page 5-166 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree map-msti


Displays the Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) that is associated to the specified VLAN.
show spantree mst vid vlan-map

Syntax Definitions
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is available when the switch is operating in either the 1x1 or flat Spanning Tree mode.

• Initially all VLANs are associated with the flat mode CIST instance (also known as MSTI 0).

Examples
-> show spantree 200 map-msti
Vlan Msti/Cist(0)
------+--------------------------
200 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree mst region Displays the MST region information for the switch.
show spantree msti vlan-map Displays the range of VLANs associated to the specified MSTI.
show spantree cist vlan-map Displays the range of VLANs associated to the CIST instance.

MIB Objects
vStpMstVlanAssignmentTable
vStpMstVlanAssignmentVlanNumber
vStpMstVlanAssignmentMstiNumber

page 5-167 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show spantree mst port


Displays a summary of Spanning Tree connection information and instance associations for the specified
port or a link aggregate of ports.
show spantree mst port {slot/port | logical_port}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
logical_port The Link aggregate ID number (0–31).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is only available when the switch is running in the flat Spanning Tree mode.

• Note that MST 0 also represents the flat mode CIST instance, which all ports are associated with when
the switch is running in the flat Spanning Tree mode.

Examples
-> bridge mode flat
-> show spantree mst port 1/10
MST parameters for interface 1/10:
Conection Type: NS
Edge Port: YES
Boundary Port: YES

MST | Role | State | Pth Cst | Vlans


--------------------------------------------------------
0 DIS DIS 0 200
2 DIS DIS 0

-> show spantree mst port 1/1


MST parameters for interface 1/1 :
Conection Type: PTP
Edge Port: NO
Boundary Port: YES

MST | Role | State | Pth Cst | Vlans


--------------------------------------------------------
0 ROOT FORW 19 1
-> bridge mode 1x1
-> show spantree mst port 1/10
Current STP mode is 1x1, MSTI instances are inactive

page 5-168 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

output definitions
Connection Type Operational connection type: PTP, NPT, NS (nonsignificant) or EDG.
Shows the current operational state of the port’s connection type. See
the bridge slot/port connection command on page 5-87 for more
information.
Edge Port Indicates whether or not the port is an edge port (YES or NO).
Boundary Port Indicates whether or not the port is a boundary port (YES or NO). A
boundary port connects an MST bridge to a LAN that belongs to a dif-
ferent MST region.
MST The Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI) number that is associated
with this port.
Role The role of the port for this Spanning Tree instance. Possible port roles
are: root, designated, alternate, master, and backup.
State The port operational state as defined by application of the Spanning
Tree Protocol. Possible port operational states include: disabled, block-
ing, listening, learning, and forwarding.
Pth Cst The contribution of this port to the path cost towards the Spanning Tree
root bridge that includes this port. Path cost is a measure of the distance
of the listed port from the root bridge in the number of hops.
Vlans The VLAN ID of the default VLAN for the port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show spantree cist ports Displays Spanning Tree port information for the flat mode Common
and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) instance.
show spantree msti ports Displays Spanning Tree port information for a flat mode Multiple
Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI).
show spantree 1x1 ports Displays Spanning Tree port information for a 1x1 mode VLAN
instance.

MIB Objects
vStpInsPortTable
vStpInsPortAdminConnectionType
vStpInsPortAdminEdge
vStpInsPortAutoEdge
vStpMstInstanceNumber
vStpInsPortRole
vStpInsPortState
vStpInsPortPathCost
vStpMstVlanAssignmentTable
vStpMstVlanAssignmentVlanNumber

page 5-169 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show bridge rrstp configuration


Displays the current RRSTP status for the switch.
show bridge rrstp configuration

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show bridge rrstp configuration
RRSTP Global state is Enabled

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge rrstp Enables RRSTP on a switch.


show bridge rrstp ring Displays information for all the rings or a specific ring present in the
system.

MIB Objects
vStpInfo
VStpRrstpGlobalState

page 5-170 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

show bridge rrstp ring


Displays information for all the rings or for a specific ring present in the system.
show bridge rrstp ring [ring_id]

Syntax Definitions
ring_id An existing ring ID number (1–128).

Defaults
By default displays information for all rings.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the ring_id parameter with this command to display information for a specific ring.

Examples
-> show bridge rrstp ring
RingId Vlan-Tag Ring-Port1 Ring-Port2 Ring Status
-----------+------------+---------------+--------------+---------------
2 1000 1/19 1/10 enabled
6 20 1/1 1/8 disabled
128 1 0/1 0/31 enabled

output definitions
RingId The numeric ID of the RRSTP ring.
Vlan-Tag The VLAN to which the RRSTP ring frames are tagged.
Ring-Port-1 The first port in the RRSTP ring.
Ring-Port-2 The second port in the RRSTP ring.
Ring Status The current state of the RRSTP ring (Enabled or Disabled).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-171 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge rrstp ring Creates a RRSTP ring comprising of two ports.


show bridge rrstp Displays the current RRSTP status for the switch.
configuration

MIB Objects
vStpRrstpRingConfigTable
vStpRrstpRingId
vStpRrstpRingPort1
vStpRrstpRingPort2
vStpRrstpRingVlanTag
vStpRrstpRingState
vStpRrstpRingRowStatus

page 5-172 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge mode 1x1 pvst+


Enables or disables PVST+ mode on the switch, enabling it to operate with Cisco switches.
bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the pvst+ mode.
disable Disables the pvst+ mode.

Defaults
PVST+ is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• In order to handle PVST+ mode, the ports must be configured in 1x1 mode.

• This command enables the ports to handle PVST+ BPDUs.

• In this mode, the bridge priority field of the bridge ID can only be changed by a multiple of 4096.

Examples
-> bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ enable
-> bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

bridge port pvst+ Configures the type of BPDU to be used on a port when PVST+ mode is
enabled.

MIB Objects
vStpTable
vStpMode
vStpModePVST

page 5-173 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

bridge port pvst+


Configures the type of BPDU to be used on a port when PVST+ mode is enabled.
bridge port {slot/port | agg_num} pvst+ {auto | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
agg_num Specifies the aggregate group.
auto IEEE BPDUs are used until a PVST+ BPDU is detected.
enable Specifies that PVST+ BPDUs will be used.
disable Specifies that IEEE BPDUs will be used.

Defaults

parameters default
auto | enable | disable auto

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• In order to handle PVST+ mode, the ports must be configured in 1x1 mode.

• Initially, a port sends or receive IEEE BPDUs. Once a PVST+ BPDU is received, the port will send
and receive only PVST+ BPDUs for tagged VLANs and IEEE BPDUs for default VLANs.

Examples
-> bridge port 1/3 pvst+ enable
-> bridge port 2/2 pvst+ auto

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 5-174 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

Related Commands

bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ Enables or disables PVST+ mode on the switch.

MIB Objects
vStpPortConfigTable
vStpPortConfigIfInedx
vStpPortConfigPVST

page 5-175 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Distributed Spanning Tree Commands

page 5-176 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


6 Link Aggregation
Commands

Link aggregation is a way of combining multiple physical links between two switches into one logical
link. The aggregate group operates within Spanning Tree as one virtual port and can provide more band-
width than a single link. It also provides redundancy. If one physical link in the aggregate group goes
down, link integrity is maintained.
There are two types of aggregate groups: static and dynamic. Static aggregate groups are manually config-
ured on the switch with static links. Dynamic groups are set up on the switch but they aggregate links as
necessary according to the Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP).
The dynamic aggregation software is compatible only with the following IEEE standard:
802.3ad — Aggregation of Multiple Link Segments
MIB information for the link aggregation commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1LAG.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-LAG-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-1


Link Aggregation Commands

A summary of available commands is listed here:

Static link aggregates static linkagg size


static linkagg name
static linkagg admin state
static agg agg num
Dynamic link aggregates lacp linkagg size
lacp linkagg name
lacp linkagg admin state
lacp linkagg actor admin key
lacp linkagg actor system priority
lacp linkagg actor system id
lacp linkagg partner system id
lacp linkagg partner system priority
lacp linkagg partner admin key
lacp agg actor admin key
lacp agg actor admin state
lacp agg actor system id
lacp agg actor system priority
lacp agg partner admin state
lacp agg partner admin system id
lacp agg partner admin key
lacp agg partner admin system priority
lacp agg actor port priority
lacp agg partner admin port
lacp agg partner admin port priority
Static and dynamic show linkagg
show linkagg port

page 6-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

static linkagg size


Creates a static aggregate group between two switches. A static aggregate group contains static links.
static linkagg agg_num size size [name name] [admin state {enable | disable}]
no static linkagg agg_num

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the static aggregate group. Must be a
unique integer in the range 0–31.
size The maximum number of links allowed in the aggregate group. Values
may be 2, 4, or 8.
name The name of the static aggregate group. May be any alphanumeric string
up to 255 characters long. Spaces must be contained within quotes (e.g.,
“Static Group 1”).
enable Specifies that the static aggregate group is active and is able to aggre-
gate links.
disable Specifies that the static aggregate group is inactive and not able to
aggregate links.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a static aggregate group from the configuration.

• The maximum number of link aggregate groups allowed on the switch (static and dynamic combined)
is 32.
• If the static aggregate has any attached ports you must delete them with the static agg agg num
command before you can delete it.
• Use the lacp linkagg size command to create a dynamic aggregation (i.e., LACP) group. See page 6-9
for more information about this command.

Examples
-> static linkagg 3 size 8
-> static linkagg 4 size 2 admin state disable
-> no static linkagg 3

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-3


Link Aggregation Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) link aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggSize
alclnkaggAggLacpType
alclnkaggAggName
alclnkaggAggAdminState

page 6-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

static linkagg name


Configures a name for an existing static aggregate group.
static linkagg agg_num name name
static linkagg agg_num no name

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the static aggregate group.
name The name of the static aggregation group, an alphanumeric string up to
255 characters. Spaces must be contained within quotes (e.g., “Static
Group 1”).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove a name from a static aggregate.

Examples
-> static linkagg 2 name accounting
-> static linkagg 2 no name

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

static linkagg size Creates a static aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-5


Link Aggregation Commands

static linkagg admin state


Configures the administrative state (whether the static aggregate group is active or inactive) of a static
aggregate group.
static linkagg agg_num admin state {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the static aggregate group.
enable Specifies that the static aggregate group is active and is able to aggre-
gate links.
disable Specifies that the static aggregate group is inactive and not able to
aggregate links.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When the administrative state is set to disable, the static aggregate group is disabled.

Examples
-> static linkagg 2 admin state disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

static linkagg size Creates a static aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggAdminState

page 6-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

static agg agg num


Configures a slot and port for a static aggregate group.
static agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port agg num agg_num
static agg no [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
agg_num The number corresponding to the static aggregate group.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove one or more ports from a static aggregate group.

• Mobile ports cannot be aggregated.

• A port may belong to only one aggregate group.

• Ports in a static aggregate must all be the same speed (e.g., all 10 Mbps, all 100 Mbps, all 1 Gigabit, or
all 10 Gigabit).
• Ports that belong to the same static aggregate group do not have to be configured sequentially and can
be on any Network Interface (NI) or unit within a stack.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> static agg 2/1 agg num 4
-> static agg no 2/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-7


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

static linkagg size Creates a static aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about link aggregation ports.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortLacpType
alclnkaggAggPortSelectedAggNumber

page 6-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg size


Creates a dynamic aggregate group that uses the Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) to establish
and maintain link aggregation. The size parameter is required to create the link aggregate group.
lacp linkagg agg_num size size
[name name]
[admin state {enable | disable}]
[actor admin key actor_admin_key]
[actor system priority actor_system_priority]
[actor system id actor_system_id]
[partner system id partner_system_id]
[partner system priority partner_system_priority]
[partner admin key partner_admin_key]
no lacp linkagg agg_num

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group. Must be a
unique integer in the range 0–31.
size The maximum number of links that may belong to the aggregate. Values
may be 2, 4, or 8.
name The name of the dynamic aggregate group. May be any alphanumeric
string up to 255 characters long. Spaces must be contained within
quotes (e.g., “Dynamic Group 1”).
enable Specifies that the dynamic aggregate group is active and is able to
aggregate links.
disable Specifies that the dynamic aggregate group is inactive and not able to
aggregate links.
actor_admin_key The administrative key value associated with the dynamic aggregate
group. Possible values are 0–65535.
actor_system_priority The priority of the dynamic aggregate group. Possible values are
0–65535.
actor_system_id The MAC address of the dynamic aggregate group on the switch.
partner_system_id The MAC address of the remote system’s aggregate group to which the
switch’s aggregate group is attached.
partner_system_priority The priority of the remote system to which the aggregation group is
attached. Possible values are 0–65535.
partner_admin_key The administrative key for the aggregation group’s remote partner.
Possible values are 0–65535.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-9


Link Aggregation Commands

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a dynamic aggregate group from the configuration.

• The maximum number of link aggregate groups allowed on the switch (static and dynamic combined)
is 32.
• If the dynamic group has any attached ports, you must disable the group with the lacp linkagg admin
state command before you can delete it.
• Optional parameters for the dynamic aggregate group may be configured when the aggregate is created
or the dynamic aggregate group may be modified later.
• Use the static linkagg size command to create static aggregate groups. See page 6-3 for more informa-
tion about this command.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 2 size 4
-> lacp linkagg 3 size 2 admin state disable actor system priority 65535

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggSize
alclnkaggAggLacpType
alclnkaggAggName
alclnkaggAggAdminState
alclnkaggAggActorAdminKey
alclnkaggAggActorSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggActorSystemID
alclnkaggAggPartnerSystemID
alclnkaggAggPartnerSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPartnerAdminKey

page 6-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg name


Configures a name for a dynamic aggregate group.
lacp linkagg agg_num name name
lacp linkagg agg_num no name

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group.
name The name of the dynamic aggregate group. May be any alphanumeric
string up to 255 characters long. Spaces must be contained within
quotes (e.g., “Dynamic Group 1”).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove a name from a dynamic aggregate group.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 2 name finance
-> lacp linkagg 2 no name

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-11


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg admin state


Configures the administrative state of the dynamic aggregate (whether it is up and active, or down and
inactive) group.
lacp linkagg agg_num admin state {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group.
enable Specifies that the dynamic aggregate group is active and is able to
aggregate links.
disable Specifies that the operation of a dynamic aggregate group cannot be
performed.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When the administrative state is set to disable, the operation of a dynamic aggregation (LACP) group
cannot be performed.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 2 admin state disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.
show linkagg port Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggAdminState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-13


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg actor admin key


Configures the administrative key associated with a dynamic aggregate group.
lacp linkagg agg_num actor admin key actor_admin_key
lacp linkagg agg_num no actor admin key

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group.
actor_admin_key The administrative key value associated with the dynamic aggregate
group. The valid range is 0–65535.

Defaults

parameter default
actor_admin_key 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove an actor admin key from a dynamic aggregate group.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 3 actor admin key 2
-> lacp linkagg 3 no actor admin key

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggActorAdminKey

page 6-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg actor system priority


Configures the priority of the dynamic aggregate group.
lacp linkagg agg_num actor system priority actor_system_priority
lacp linkagg agg_num no actor system priority

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the link aggregate group.
actor_system_priority The priority of the switch’s dynamic aggregate group in relation to other
aggregate groups. Possible values are 0–65535.

Defaults

parameter default
actor_system_priority 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to return the value to its default.

• Ports with the same system priority value can join the same dynamic aggregate group.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 3 actor system priority 100
-> lacp linkagg 3 no actor system priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggActorSystemPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-15


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg actor system id


Configures the MAC address of a dynamic aggregate group on the switch.
lacp linkagg agg_num actor system id actor_system_id
lacp linkagg agg_num no actor system id

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group.
actor_system_id The MAC address of the dynamic aggregate group on the switch in the
hexadecimal format xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.

Defaults

parameter default
actor_system_id 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove an actor system ID from a dynamic aggregate group.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 3 actor system id 00:20:da:81:d5:b0
-> lacp linkagg 3 no actor system id

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggActorSystemID

page 6-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg partner system id


Configures the MAC address of the remote system’s dynamic aggregate group to which the local switch’s
dynamic aggregate group is attached.
lacp linkagg agg_num partner system id partner_system_id
lacp linkagg agg_num no partner system id

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group on the
switch.
partner_system_id The MAC address of the remote switch’s dynamic aggregate group in
the hexadecimal format xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_system_id 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a partner system ID from a dynamic aggregate group.

• The partner_system_id and the partner_system_priority specify the remote system’s priority.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 2 partner system id 00:20:da4:32:81
-> lacp linkagg 2 no partner system id

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-17


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggPartnerSystemID

page 6-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg partner system priority


Configures the priority of the remote switch’s dynamic aggregate group to which the local switch’s aggre-
gate group is attached.
lacp linkagg agg_num partner system priority partner_system_priority
lacp linkagg agg_num no partner system priority

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group.
partner_system_priority The priority of the remote switch’s dynamic aggregate group to which
the local switch’s aggregate group is attached. Possible values are
0–65535.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_system_priority 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to return to the priority value to its default.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 3 partner system priority 65535
-> lacp linkagg 3 no partner system priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggPartnerSystemPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-19


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp linkagg partner admin key


Configures the administrative key for the dynamic aggregation group’s remote partner.
lacp linkagg agg_num partner admin key partner_admin_key
lacp linkagg agg_num no partner admin key

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the dynamic aggregate group.
partner_admin_key The administrative key for the dynamic aggregation group’s remote
partner. Possible values are 0–65535.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_admin_key 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove a partner admin key from a dynamic aggregate group.

Examples
-> lacp linkagg 3 partner admin key 1
-> lacp linkagg 3 no partner admin key

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggPartnerAdminKey

page 6-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg actor admin key


Configures an actor administrative key for a port, which allows the port to join a dynamic aggregate
group.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor admin key actor_admin_key
[actor admin state {[[no] active] [[no] timeout] [[no] aggregate] [[no] synchronize] [[no] collect]
[[no] distribute] [[no] default] [[no] expire] | none}]
[actor system id actor_system_id]
[actor system priority actor_system_priority]
[partner admin system id partner_admin_system_id]
[partner admin key partner_admin_key]
[partner admin system priority partner_admin_system_priority]
[partner admin state {[[no] active] [[no] timeout] [[no] aggregate] [[no] synchronize] [[no] collect]
[[no] distribute] [[no] default] [[no] expire] | none}]
[actor port priority actor_port_priority]
[partner admin port partner_admin_port]
[partner admin port priority partner_admin_port_priority]
lacp agg no [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
actor_admin_key The administrative key associated with this dynamic aggregate group.
Possible values are 0–65535.
actor admin state See the lacp agg actor admin state command on page 6-24.
actor_system_id The MAC address of this dynamic aggregate group on the switch.
actor_system_priority The priority of the dynamic aggregate group. Possible values are
0–255.
partner_admin_system_id The MAC address of the remote switch’s dynamic aggregate group.
partner_admin_key The administrative key for the dynamic aggregation group’s remote
partner. Possible values are 0–65535.
partner_admin_system_priority The priority of the remote system to which the dynamic aggregation
group is attached. Possible values are 0–255.
partner admin state See the lacp agg partner admin state command on page 6-30.
actor_port_priority The priority of the actor port. Possible values are 0–255.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-21


Link Aggregation Commands

partner_admin_port The administrative state of the partner port. Possible values are
0–65535.
partner_admin_port_priority The priority of the partner port. Possible values are 0–255.

Defaults

parameter default
[active] [timeout] .... active, timeout, aggregate

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a slot and port from a dynamic aggregate group.

• Mobile ports cannot be aggregated.

• A port may belong to only one aggregate group.

• Ports in a dynamic aggregate must all be in the same speed (e.g., all 100 Mbps. 1 Gigabit. or all 10
Gigabit).
• Ports that belong to the same dynamic aggregate group do not have to be configured sequentially and
can be on any Network Interface (NI).
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 3/1 actor admin key 0
-> lacp agg no 3/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregates.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggActorAdminKey
alclnkaggAggPortLacpType
alclnkaggAggPortActorAdminState
alclnkaggAggPortActorSystemID

page 6-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

alclnkaggAggPortActorSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminSystemID
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminKey
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminState
alclnkaggAggPortActorPortPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminPort
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminPortPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-23


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg actor admin state


Configures the system administrative state of the slot and port for the dynamic aggregate group on the
local switch. The state values correspond to bits in the actor state octet in the LACPDU frame.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor admin state {[active] [timeout]
[aggregate] [synchronize] [collect] [distribute] [default] [expire] | none}
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
actor admin state {[[no] active] [[no] timeout] [[no] aggregate] [[no] synchronize]
[[no] collect] [[no] distribute] [[no] default] [[no] expire] | none}

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
active Specifies that bit 0 in the actor state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, the dynamic aggregate group is able to exchange LACPDU frames.
By default, this value is set.
timeout Specifies that bit 1 in the actor state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, a short timeout is used for LACPDU frames. When this bit is
disabled, a long timeout is used for LACPDU frames. By default, this
value is set.
aggregate Specifies that bit 2 in the actor state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, the system considers this port to be a potential candidate for aggre-
gation. If this bit is not enabled, the system considers the port to be indi-
vidual (it can only operate as a single link). By default, this value is set.
synchronize Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 3) is set by the system, the port is
allocated to the correct dynamic aggregation group. If this bit is not set
by the system, the port is not allocated to the correct dynamic aggrega-
tion group.
collect Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 4) is set by the system, incom-
ing LACPDU frames are collected from the individual ports that make
up the dynamic aggregate group.
distribute Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 5) is set by the system, distribut-
ing outgoing frames on the port is disabled.
default Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 6) is set by the system, it indi-

page 6-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

cates that the actor is using the defaulted partner information adminis-
tratively configured for the partner.
expire Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 7) is set by the system, the actor
cannot receive LACPDU frames.
none Resets all administrative states to their default configurations.

Defaults

parameter default
[active] [timeout] .... active, timeout, aggregate

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to restore the LACPDU bit settings to their default configuration.

• When the actor admin state is set to none, all bit values are restored to their default configurations.

• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 4/2 actor admin state synchronize no collect distribute
-> lacp agg 4/2 actor admin state no synchronize collect
-> lacp agg 4/2 actor admin state none

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortActorAdminState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-25


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg actor system id


Configures the system ID (i.e., MAC address) for the local port associated with a dynamic aggregate
group.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor system id actor_system_id
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port no actor system id

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
actor_system_id The MAC address of the dynamic aggregate group on the switch in the
hexadecimal format xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.

Defaults

parameter default
actor_system_id 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an actor system ID from a slot and port associated with a
dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp 3/1 actor system id 00:20:da:06:ba:d3
-> lacp 3/1 no actor system id

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortActorSystemID

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-27


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg actor system priority


Configures the system priority of the port on the switch that belongs to the dynamic aggregate group.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor system priority actor_system_priority
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
no actor system priority

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
actor_system_priority The priority of the dynamic aggregate group. Possible values are
0–255.

Defaults

parameter default
actor_system_priority 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an actor system priority value from a slot and port associ-
ated with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg ethernet 3/2 actor system priority 65
-> lacp agg ethernet 3/2 no actor system priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregates.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortActorSystemPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-29


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg partner admin state


Configures the system administrative state of the slot and port for the dynamic aggregate group on the
remote switch. The state values correspond to bits in the actor state octet in the LACPDU frame.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin state
{[active] [timeout] [aggregate] [synchronize] [collect] [distribute] [default] [expire] | none}
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin state
{[[no] active] [[no] timeout] [[no] aggregate] [[no] synchronize] [[no] collect] [[no] distribute]
[[no] default] [[no] expire] | none}

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
active Specifies that bit 0 in the partner state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, the dynamic aggregate group is able to exchange LACPDU frames.
By default, this value is set.
timeout Specifies that bit 1 in the partner state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, a short timeout is used for LACPDU frames. When this bit is
disabled, a long timeout is used for LACPDU frames. By default, this
value is set.
aggregate Specifies that bit 2 in the partner state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, the system considers this port to be a potential candidate for aggre-
gation. If this bit is not enabled, the system considers the port to be indi-
vidual (it can only operate as a single link). By default, this value is set.
synchronize Specifies that bit 3 in the partner state octet is enabled. When this bit is
set, the port is allocated to the correct dynamic aggregation group. If this
bit is not enabled, the port is not allocated to the correct aggregation
group. By default, this value is disabled.
collect Specifying this keyword has no effect because the system always deter-
mines its value. When this bit (bit 4) is set by the system, incoming
LACPDU frames are collected from the individual ports that make up
the dynamic aggregate group.
distribute Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 5) is set by the system, distribut-
ing outgoing frames on the port is disabled.
default Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 6) is set by the system, it indi-

page 6-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

cates that the partner is using the defaulted actor information adminis-
tratively configured for the actor.
expire Specifying that this keyword has no effect because the system always
determines its value. When this bit (bit 7) is set by the system, the part-
ner cannot receive LACPDU frames.
none Resets all administrative states to their default configurations.

Defaults

parameter default
[active] [timeout] .... active, timeout, aggregate

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to restore the LACPDU bit settings to their default configuration.

• When the partner admin state is set to none, all bit values are restored to their default configurations.

• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 4/2 partner admin state synchronize collect distribute
-> lacp agg 4/2 partner admin state no synchronize no collect

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-31


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg partner admin system id


Configures the partner administrative system ID for a dynamic aggregate group port.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin system id
partner_admin_system_id
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
no partner admin system id

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
partner_admin_system_id The MAC address of the remote dynamic aggregate group in the hexa-
decimal format xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_admin_system_id 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a partner administrative system ID from a slot and port
associated with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 3/1 partner admin system id 00:20:da:05:f6:23

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminSystemID

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-33


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg partner admin key


Configures the partner administrative key for a dynamic aggregate group port.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin key partner_admin_key
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port no partner admin key

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
parnter_admin_key The administrative key for the dynamic aggregation group’s remote
partner. Possible values are 0–65535.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_admin_key 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a partner admin key value from a slot and port associated
with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 2/1 partner admin key 0
-> lacp agg 2/1 no partner admin key

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays detailed information about ports associated with a particular
aggregate group or all aggregate groups.
show linkagg port Displays information about slots and ports associated with all aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminKey

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-35


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg partner admin system priority


Configures the partner system priority for a dynamic aggregate group port.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin system priority
partner_admin_system_priority
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
no partner admin system priority

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
partner_admin_system_priority The priority of the remote switch’s dynamic aggregate group to which
the aggregation group is attached. Possible values are 0–255.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_admin_system_priority 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a partner_system_priority value from a slot and port asso-
ciated with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 2/1 partner admin system priority 65
-> lacp agg 2/1 no partner admin system priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortAdminSystemPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-37


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg actor port priority


Configures the priority for an actor port.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor port priority actor_port_priority
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port no actor port priority

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
actor_port_priority The priority of the actor port. Possible values are 0–255.

Defaults

parameter default
actor_port_priority 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an actor_port_priority value from a slot and port associ-
ated with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 2/1 actor port priority 100
-> lacp agg 2/1 no actor port priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortActorPortPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-39


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg partner admin port


Configures the administrative status of a partner port.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin port partner_admin_port
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
no partner admin port

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
partner_admin_port The administrative state of the partner port. Possible values are
0–65535.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_admin_port 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a partner_admin_port value from a slot and port associ-
ated with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 2/1 partner admin port 255
-> lacp agg 2/1 no partner admin port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-41


Link Aggregation Commands

lacp agg partner admin port priority


Configures the priority for a partner port.
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin port priority
partner_admin_port_priority
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
no partner admin port priority

Syntax Definitions
ethernet Documents that the port is 10 Mbps Ethernet.
fastethernet Documents that the port is 100 Mbps Fast Ethernet.
gigaethernet Documents that the port is Gigabit Ethernet.
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port that the switch will initially use as the Spanning Tree virtual
port for this aggregate.
partner_admin_port_priority The priority of the partner port. Possible values are 0–255.

Defaults

parameter default
partner_admin_port_priority 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a partner_admin_port_priority value from a slot and port
associated with a dynamic aggregate group.
• The ethernet, fastethernet, and gigaethernet keywords do not modify a port’s configuration. See
Chapter 1, “Ethernet Port Commands,” for information on CLI commands to configure Ethernet ports.

Examples
-> lacp agg 2/1 partner admin port priority 100
-> lacp agg 2/1 no partner admin port priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 6-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

Related Commands

lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.


show linkagg port Displays information about ports associated with a particular aggregate
group or all aggregate groups.

MIB Objects
AlcLnkAggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortGlobalPortNumber
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminPortPriority

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-43


Link Aggregation Commands

show linkagg
Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate groups.
show linkagg [agg_num]

Syntax Definitions
agg_num Specifies the aggregate group. Configured through the static linkagg
size or lacp linkagg size command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no aggregation number is specified, information for all aggregate groups is displayed. If an aggre-
gate number is specified, information about that aggregate group is displayed only. The fields included
in the display depend on whether the aggregate group is a static or dynamic.
• Use the show linkagg port command to display information about aggregate group ports.

Examples
No aggregate group is specified:
-> show linkagg
Number Aggregate SNMP Id Size Admin State Oper State Att/Sel Ports
-------+----------+--------+----+-------------+-------------+-------------
1 Static 40000001 8 ENABLED UP 2 2
2 Dynamic 40000002 4 ENABLED DOWN 0 0
3 Dynamic 40000003 8 ENABLED DOWN 0 2
4 Dynamic 40000004 8 ENABLED UP 3 3
5 Static 40000005 2 DISABLED DOWN 0 0

Output fields are defined here:

output definitions
Number The aggregate group number.
Aggregate The type of aggregate group, which can be Static or Dynamic.
SNMP Id The SNMP ID associated with the aggregate group.
Size The number of links in this aggregate group.

page 6-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

output definitions (continued)


Admin State The current administrative state of the aggregate group, which can be
ENABLED or DISABLED. You can modify this parameter with the
static linkagg admin state command (see page 6-6) for static aggre-
gate groups and with the lacp linkagg admin state command (see page
6-12) for dynamic aggregate groups.
Oper State The current operational state of the aggregate group, which can be UP
or DOWN.
Att Ports The number of ports actually attached to this aggregate group.
Sel Ports The number of ports that could possibly attach to the aggregate group.

A static aggregate is specified:


-> show linkagg 5
Static Aggregate
SNMP Id : 40000005,
Aggregate Number : 5,
SNMP Descriptor : Omnichannel Aggregate Number 5 ref 40000005 size 2,
Name : AGG5,
Admin State : ENABLED,
Operational State : DOWN,
Aggregate Size : 2,
Number of Selected Ports : 0,
Number of Reserved Ports : 0,
Number of Attached Ports : 0,
Primary Port : NONE

Output fields are defined here:

output definitions
SNMP Id The SNMP ID associated with this static aggregate group.
Aggregate Number The group number.
SNMP Descriptor The standard MIB name for this static aggregate group.
Name The name of this static aggregate group. You can modify this parameter
with the static linkagg name command (see page 6-5).
Admin State The administrative state of this static aggregate group, which can be
ENABLED or DISABLED. You can modify this parameter with the
static linkagg admin state command (see page 6-6).
Operational State The operational state of this static aggregate group, which can be UP or
DOWN.
Aggregate Size The number of links configured for this static aggregate group.
Number of Selected Ports The number of ports that could possibly attach to this static aggregate
group.
Number of Reserved Ports The total number of ports reserved for use in link aggregation by this
static aggregate group. (Note: This field is not relevant for static aggre-
gate groups.)

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-45


Link Aggregation Commands

output definitions (continued)


Number of Attached Ports The number of ports actually attached to this static aggregate group.
Primary Port The port number of the first port to join this static aggregate group. If
the first port to join the aggregate is no longer part of the aggregate
group, the switch automatically assigns another port in the aggregate
group to be the primary port.

A dynamic aggregate group is specified:


-> show linkagg 2
Dynamic Aggregate
SNMP Id : 40000002,
Aggregate Number : 2,
SNMP Descriptor : Dynamic Aggregate Number 2 ref 40000002 size 4,
Name : AGG 2,
Admin State : ENABLED,
Operational State : DOWN,
Aggregate Size : 4,
Number of Selected Ports : 0,
Number of Reserved Ports : 0,
Number of Attached Ports : 0,
Primary Port : NONE,
LACP
MACAddress : [00:1f:cc:00:00:00],
Actor System Id : [00:20:da:81:d5:b0],
Actor System Priority : 50,
Actor Admin Key : 120,
Actor Oper Key : 0,
Partner System Id : [00:20:da:81:d5:b1],
Partner System Priority : 70,
Partner Admin Key : 220,
Partner Oper Key : 0

Output fields are defined here:

output definitions
SNMP Id The SNMP ID associated with this dynamic aggregate group.
Aggregate Number The group number of this dynamic aggregate group.
SNMP Descriptor The standard MIB name for this dynamic aggregate group.
Name The name of this dynamic aggregate group. You can modify this param-
eter with the lacp linkagg name command (see page 6-11).
Admin State The administrative state of this dynamic aggregate group, which can be
ENABLED or DISABLED. You can modify this parameter with the
lacp linkagg admin state command (see page 6-12).
Operational State The operational state of this dynamic aggregate group, which can be
UP or DOWN.
Aggregate Size The number of links configured for this dynamic aggregate group.
Number of Selected Ports The number of ports available to this dynamic aggregate group.
Number of Reserved Ports The total number of ports reserved for use in link aggregation by this
dynamic aggregate group.
Number of Attached Ports The number of ports actually attached to this dynamic aggregate group.

page 6-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

output definitions (continued)


Primary Port The port number of the first port to join this dynamic aggregate group.
If the first port to join the aggregate group is no longer part of the
aggregate group, the switch automatically assigns another port in the
aggregate group to be the primary port.
MACAddress The MAC address associated with the primary port.
Actor System Id The MAC address of this dynamic aggregate group. You can modify
this parameter with the lacp linkagg actor system id command (see
page 6-16).
Actor System Priority The priority of this dynamic aggregate group. You can modify this
parameter with the lacp linkagg actor system priority command (see
page 6-15).
Actor Admin Key The administrative key associated with this dynamic aggregate group.
You can modify this parameter with the lacp linkagg actor admin key
command (see page 6-14).
Actor Oper Key The operational key associated with this dynamic aggregate group.
Partner System Id The MAC address of the remote dynamic aggregate group. You can
modify this parameter with the lacp linkagg partner system id com-
mand (see page 6-17).
Partner System Priority The priority of the remote system to which this dynamic aggregation
group is attached. You can modify this parameter with the lacp linkagg
partner system priority command (see page 6-19).
Partner Admin Key The administrative key for this dynamic aggregation group’s remote
partner. You can modify this parameter with the lacp linkagg partner
admin key command (see page 6-20).
Partner Oper Key The operational key of the remote system to which the dynamic aggre-
gation group is attached.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

static linkagg size Creates a static aggregate group.


lacp linkagg size Creates a dynamic aggregate group.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-47


Link Aggregation Commands

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggTable
alclnkAggSize
alclnkaggAggNumber
alclnkaggAggDescr
alclnkaggAggName
alclnkaggAggLacpType
alclnkaggAggAdminState
alclnkaggAggOperState
alclnkaggAggNbrSelectedPorts
alclnkaggAggNbrAttachedPorts
alclnkaggPrimaryPortIndex
alclnkaggAggMACAddress
alclnkaggAggActorSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggActorSystemID
alclnkaggAggPartnerAdminKey
alclnkaggAggActorAdminKey
alclnkaggAggActorOperKey
alclnkaggAggPartnerSystemID
alclnkaggAggPartnerSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPartnerOperKey

page 6-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

show linkagg port


Displays the aggregate group information about a particular slot and port.
show linkagg port [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number for this aggregate.
port The port number for this aggregate.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If no slot/port is specified, the information for all slots/ports is displayed. If a particular slot or port is
specified, the fields displayed depend upon whether or not the port belongs to a static aggregate group or
dynamic (LACP) aggregate group.

Examples
-> show linkagg port
Slot/Port Aggregate SNMP Id Status Agg
---------+-----------+--------+--------------+-------
2/16 Dynamic 2016 CONFIGURED NONE
2/17 Dynamic 2017 CONFIGURED NONE
3/ 1 Static 3001 CONFIGURED 2

Output fields are defined here:

output definitions
Slot/Port The slot/port associated with the aggregate group.
Aggregate The type of aggregate group associated with the port, either Static or
Dynamic.
SNMP Id The SNMP ID associated with the aggregate group.
Status The current status of the port, which can be
CONFIGURED, PENDING, SELECTED, or RESERVED.
Agg The number of the aggregate groups associated with this port.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-49


Link Aggregation Commands

A port that belongs to a static aggregate is specified:


-> show linkagg port 4/1
Static Aggregable Port
SNMP Id : 4001,
Slot/Port : 4/1,
Administrative State : ENABLED,
Operational State : DOWN,
Port State : CONFIGURED,
Link State : DOWN,
Selected Agg Number : 2,
Port position in the aggregate: 0,
Primary port : NONE

Output fields are defined here:

output definitions
SNMP Id The SNMP ID associated with this port.
Slot/Port The slot and port number.
Administrative State The current administrative state of this port, which can be ENABLED
or DISABLED.
Operational State The current operational state of the port, which can be UP or DOWN.
Port State The current operational state of the port, which can be
CONFIGURED, PENDING, SELECTED, or RESERVED.
Link State The current operational state of the link from this port to its remote
partner, which can be UP or DOWN.
Selected Agg Number The number associated with the static aggregate group to which the
port is attached.
Port position in the aggregate The rank of this port within the static aggregate group. Possible values
are 0–15.
Primary Port The port number of the first port to join this static aggregate group. If
the first port to join the aggregate is no longer part of the aggregate
group, the switch automatically assigns another port in the aggregate
group to be the primary port.

page 6-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

A port that belongs to a dynamic aggregate is specified:


-> show linkagg port 2/1
Dynamic Aggregable Port
SNMP Id : 2001,
Slot/Port : 2/1,
Administrative State : ENABLED,
Operational State : DOWN,
Port State : CONFIGURED,
Link State : DOWN,
Selected Agg Number : NONE,
Primary port : UNKNOWN,
LACP
Actor System Priority : 10,
Actor System Id : [00:d0:95:6a:78:3a],
Actor Admin Key : 8,
Actor Oper Key : 8,
Partner Admin System Priority : 20,
Partner Oper System Priority : 20,
Partner Admin System Id : [00:00:00:00:00:00],
Partner Oper System Id : [00:00:00:00:00:00],
Partner Admin Key : 8,
Partner Oper Key : 0,
Attached Agg Id : 0,
Actor Port : 7,
Actor Port Priority : 15,
Partner Admin Port : 0,
Partner Oper Port : 0,
Partner Admin Port Priority : 0,
Partner Oper Port Priority : 0,
Actor Admin State : act1.tim1.agg1.syn0.col0.dis0.def1.exp0
Actor Oper State : act1.tim1.agg1.syn0.col0.dis0.def1.exp0,
Partner Admin State : act0.tim0.agg1.syn1.col1.dis1.def1.exp0,
Partner Oper State : act0.tim0.agg1.syn0.col1.dis1.def1.exp0

Output fields are defined here:

output definitions
SNMP Id The SNMP ID associated with this port.
Slot/Port The slot and port number.
Administrative State The current administrative state of this port, which can be ENABLED
or DISABLED.
Operational State The current operational state of the port, which can be UP or DOWN.
Port State The current operational state of the port, which can be
CONFIGURED, PENDING, SELECTED, or AGGREGATED.
Link State The current operational state of the link from this port to its remote
partner, which can be UP or DOWN.
Selected Agg Number The number associated with the dynamic aggregate group to which the
port is attached.
Primary Port The port number of the first port to join this dynamic aggregate group.
If the first port to join the aggregate is no longer part of the aggregate
group, the switch automatically assigns another port in the aggregate
group to be the primary port.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-51


Link Aggregation Commands

output definitions (continued)


Actor System Priority The actor system priority of this port. You can modify this parameter
with the lacp agg actor system priority command (see page 6-28).
Actor System Id The actor system ID (i.e., MAC address) of this port. You can modify
this parameter with the lacp agg actor system id command (see page
6-26).
Actor Admin Key The actor administrative key value for this port. You can modify this
parameter with the lacp agg actor admin key command (see page
6-21).
Actor Oper Key The actor operational key associated with this port.
Partner Admin System The administrative priority of the remote system to which this port is
Priority attached. You can modify this parameter with the lacp agg partner
admin system priority command (see page 6-36).
Partner Oper System Priority The operational priority of the remote system to which this port is
attached.
Partner Admin System Id The administrative MAC address associated with the remote partner’s
system ID. This value is used along with Partner Admin System Prior-
ity, Partner Admin Key, and Partner Admin Port Priority to manually
configure aggregation. You can modify this parameter with the lacp
agg partner admin system id command (see page 6-32).
Partner Oper System id The MAC address that corresponds to the remote partner’s system ID.
Partner Admin Key The administrative value of the key for the remote partner. This value is
used along with Partner Admin System Priority, Partner Admin System,
Partner Admin Port, and Partner Admin Port Priority to manually con-
figure aggregation. You can modify this parameter with the lacp agg
partner admin key command (see page 6-34).
Partner Oper Key The current operational value of the key for the protocol partner.
Attached Agg ID The ID of the aggregate group that the port has attached itself to. A
value of zero indicates that the port is not attached to an aggregate
group.
Actor Port The port number locally assigned to this port.
Actor Port Priority The actor priority value assigned to the port. You can modify this
parameter with the lacp agg actor port priority command (see page
6-38).
Partner Admin Port The administrative value of the port number for the protocol partner.
This value is used along with Partner Admin System Priority, Partner
Admin System ID, Partner Admin Key, and Partner Admin Port Prior-
ity to manually configure aggregation. You can modify this parameter
with the lacp agg partner admin port command (see page 6-40).
Partner Oper Port The operational port number assigned to the port by the port’s protocol
partner.
Partner Admin Port Priority The administrative port priority of the protocol partner. This value is
used along with Partner Admin System Priority, Partner Admin System
ID, and Partner Admin Key to manually configure aggregation.
You can modify this parameter with the lacp agg partner admin port
priority command (see page 6-42).
Partner Oper Port Priority The priority value assigned to the this port by the partner.

page 6-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Link Aggregation Commands

output definitions (continued)


Actor Admin State The administrative state of the port. You can modify this parameter
with the lacp agg actor admin state command (see page 6-24).
Actor Oper State The current operational state of the port.
Partner Admin State The administrative state of the partner’s port. You can modify this
parameter with the lacp agg partner admin state command (see page
6-30).
Partner Oper State The current operational state of the partner’s port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

static agg agg num Configures a slot and port for a static aggregate group.
lacp agg actor admin key Configures a slot and port for a dynamic aggregate group.
show linkagg Displays information about static and dynamic (LACP) aggregate
groups.

MIB Objects
alclnkaggAggPortTable
alclnkaggAggPortActorSystem
alclnkaggAggPortActorSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPortActorSystemID
alclnkaggAggPortActorAdminKey
alclnkaggAggPortActorOperKey
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerOperSystemPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminSystemID
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerOperSystemID
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminKey
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerOperKey
alclnkaggAggPortSelectedAggID
alclnkaggAggPortAttachedAggID
alclnkaggAggPortActorPort
alclnkaggAggPortActorPortPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminPort
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerOperPort
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminPortPriority
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerOperPortPriority
alclnkaggAggPortActorAdminState
alclnkaggAggPortActorOperState
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerAdminState
alclnkaggAggPortPartnerOperState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6-53


Link Aggregation Commands

page 6-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


7 GVRP Commands

The GARP VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) facilitates control of virtual local area networks
(VLANs) within a larger network. It is an application of General Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP)
that provides the VLAN registration service. The GARP provides a generic framework whereby devices in
a bridged LAN can register and de-register attribute values, such as VLAN identifiers.
GVRP is compliant with 802.1q and dynamically learns and further propagates VLAN membership infor-
mation across a bridged network. It dynamically maintains and updates the registration and de-registration
of VLANs and prunes unnecessary broadcast and unicast traffic. Through propagation of GVRP informa-
tion, a switch can continuously update its knowledge on the set of VLANs that currently have active nodes
and on ports through which those nodes can be reached.
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

gvrp
gvrp port
gvrp transparent switching
gvrp maximum vlan
gvrp registration
gvrp applicant
gvrp timer
gvrp restrict-vlan-registration
gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement
gvrp static-vlan restrict
clear gvrp statistics
show gvrp statistics
show gvrp last-pdu-origin
show gvrp configuration
show gvrp configuration port
show gvrp configuration linkagg/port
show gvrp timer

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-1


GVRP Commands

gvrp
Enables GVRP on the switch globally.
gvrp
no gvrp

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, GVRP is disabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable GVRP globally on the switch.

• Disabling GVRP globally will delete all the learned VLANs.

• GVRP is supported only when the switch is operating in the flat Spanning Tree mode; it is not
supported in the 1x1 mode.

Examples
-> gvrp
-> no gvrp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration Displays the global configuration for GVRP.

MIB Objects
dot1qGvrpStatus

page 7-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp port
Enables GVRP on a specific port or an aggregate of ports on the switch.
gvrp {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
no gvrp {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.

Defaults
By default, GVRP is disabled on the ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable GVRP on the specified ports.

• GVRP can be enabled on ports regardless of whether it is globally enabled or not. However, for the
port to become an active participant, you should enable GVRP globally on the switch.
• When GVRP is globally enabled on the switch and is not enabled on the port, that port is excluded
from the GVRP process.
• GVRP can be enabled only on fixed ports, 802.1 Q ports, and aggregate ports. Other ports (mirror
ports, aggregable ports, mobile ports, and MSTI Trunking ports) do not support GVRP.
• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

Examples
-> gvrp port 3/2
-> no gvrp port 3/2
-> gvrp linkagg 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-3


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration port Displays the GVRP configuration for all the ports.
show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
dot1qPortVlanTable
dot1qPortGvrpStatus

page 7-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp transparent switching


Enables transparent switching on the switch. When transparent switching is enabled, the switch propa-
gates GVRP information to other switches but does not register itself in the GVRP process.
gvrp transparent switching
no gvrp transparent switching

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, transparent switching is disabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable transparent switching on the device.

• If GVRP is globally disabled and transparent switching is enabled, the router will flood the GVRP
messages.
• If GVRP is globally disabled and transparent switching is disabled, the router will discard the GVRP
messages.
• If GVRP is globally enabled transparent switching will not have any effect on the functional behavior
of the device.

Examples
-> gvrp transparent switching
-> no gvrp transparent switching

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration Displays the global configuration for GVRP.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpTransparentSwitching

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-5


GVRP Commands

gvrp maximum vlan


Configures the maximum number of dynamic VLANs that can be created by GVRP.
gvrp maximum vlan vlanlimit

Syntax Definitions
vlanlimit The maximum number of VLANs to be created by GVRP. The valid
range is 32–4094.

Defaults

parameter default
vlanlimit 256

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command can be used even when GVRP is not enabled on the switch. However, GVRP should be
enabled on the switch for creating dynamic VLANs.
• If the VLAN limit to be set is less than the current number of dynamically learnt VLANs, then the new
configuration will take effect only after the GVRP is disabled and enabled again on the switch. If this
operation is not done, the VLANs learnt earlier will be maintained.

Examples
-> gvrp maximum vlan 100

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration Displays the global configuration for GVRP.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpMaxVlanLimit

page 7-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp registration
Configures the GVRP registration mode for a specific port or an aggregate of ports.
gvrp registration {normal | fixed | forbidden} {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
no gvrp registration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

Syntax Definitions
normal Specifies that both registration and de-registration of VLANs are
allowed. VLANs can be mapped either dynamically (through GVRP) or
statically (through management application) on such a port.
fixed Specifies that only static mapping of VLANs is allowed on the port but
de-registration of previously created dynamic or static VLANs is not
allowed.
forbidden Specifies that dynamic VLAN registration or de-registration is not
allowed on the port. Any dynamic VLAN created earlier will be de-
registered.
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults

parameter default
normal | fixed | forbidden normal

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to set the registration mode to the default value.

• GVRP should be enabled on the port before configuring the GVRP registration mode.

• The registration mode for the default VLANs of all the ports in the switch will be set to fixed.

• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

Examples
-> gvrp registration forbidden port 3/2
-> no gvrp registration port 3/2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-7


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigtable
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrarMode

page 7-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp applicant
Configures the applicant mode of a specific port or an aggregate of ports on the switch. The applicant
mode determines whether or not GVRP PDU exchanges are allowed on a port depending on the Spanning
Tree state of the port.
gvrp applicant {participant | non-participant | active} {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
no gvrp applicant {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

Syntax Definitions
participant Specifies that GVRP PDU exchanges are only allowed when the port is
in the STP forwarding state.
non-participant Specifies that no GVRP PDU exchanges are allowed on the port,
regardless of the STP status of the port.
active Specifies that GVRP PDU exchanges are allowed when the port is
either in the STP forwarding or STP blocking state.
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults

parameter default
participant | non-participant | participant
active

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to set the applicant mode to the default value.

• GVRP should be enabled on the port before configuring the GVRP applicant mode.

• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

Examples
-> gvrp applicant active port 2/2
-> no gvrp applicant port 2/2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-9


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigtable
alaGvrpPortConfigApplicantMode

page 7-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp timer
Configures the Join, Leave, or LeaveAll timer values for the switch ports.
gvrp timer {join | leave | leaveall} timer-value {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
no gvrp timer {join | leave | leaveall} {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

Syntax Definitions
join Specifies the value of the Join timer in milliseconds.
leave Specifies the value of the Leave timer in milliseconds.
leaveall Specifies the value of the LeaveAll timer in milliseconds.
timer-value The value of the specified timer in milliseconds. The valid range is
1–2,147,483,647 for Join timer, 3–2,147,483,647 for Leave timer, and
3–2,147,483,647 for LeaveAll timer.
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults

parameter default
timer-value (join) 600 ms
timer-value (leave) 1800 ms
timer-value (leaveall) 30000 ms

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to set the timer for a particular slot or port to the default value.

• GVRP should be enabled on the port before configuring the timer value for that port.

• Leave timer value should be greater than or equal to three times the Join timer value.

• Leaveall timer value should be greater than or equal to the Leave timer value.

• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-11


GVRP Commands

Examples
-> gvrp timer join 300 port 3/2
-> no gvrp timer join 3/2
-> gvrp timer leave 900 port 3/2
-> no gvrp timer leave port 3/2
-> gvrp timer leaveall 950 port 3/2
-> no gvrp timer leaveall port 3/2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show gvrp timer Displays the timer values configured for all the ports or a specific port.
show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigTable
alaGvrpPortConfigJoinTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigLeaveTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigLeaveAllTimer

page 7-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp restrict-vlan-registration
Restricts GVRP processing from dynamically registering the specified VLAN(s) on the switch.
gvrp restrict-vlan-registration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list
no gvrp restrict-vlan-registration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
vlan-list The VLAN ID or the VLAN ID range (e.g., 1-10).

Defaults
By default, GVRP dynamic VLAN registration is not restricted.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to allow registration of dynamic VLAN IDs through GVRP process-
ing.
• GVRP should be enabled on the port before restricting dynamic VLAN registrations on that port.

• This command can be used only if the GVRP registration mode is set to normal.

• If the specified VLAN already exists on the switch, the VLAN is mapped to the receiving port.

• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

Examples
-> gvrp restrict-vlan-registration port 3/1 5
-> no gvrp restrict-vlan-registration port 3/1 5
-> gvrp restrict-vlan-registration port 3/1 6-10
-> no gvrp restrict-vlan-registration port 3/1 6-10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-13


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

gvrp registration Configures the GVRP registration mode for the switch ports.
show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigTable
alaGvrpPortConfigRestrictedRegistrationBitmap
alaGvrpPortConfigAllowRegistrationBitmap
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrationBitmap

page 7-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement
Restricts the advertisement of VLANs on a specific port or an aggregate of ports.
gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list
no gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
vlan-list The VLAN ID or the VLAN ID range (e.g., 1-10).

Defaults
By default, VLAN advertisement is not restricted.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to allow the propagation of VLANs.

• GVRP should be enabled on the port before restricting VLAN advertisements on that port.

• This command affects the GVRP processing only if the applicant mode is set to participant or active.

• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

Examples
-> gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement port 3/1 4
-> no gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement port 3/1 4
-> gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement port 3/1 6-9
-> no gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement port 3/1 6-9
-> gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement linkagg 3 10
-> no gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement linkagg 3 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-15


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

gvrp applicant Configures the applicant mode for the switch port.
show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigTable
alaGvrpPortConfigRestrictedApplicantBitmap
alaGvrpPortConfigAllowApplicantBitmap
alaGvrpPortConfigApplicantBitmap

page 7-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

gvrp static-vlan restrict


Restricts a port from becoming a member of a statically created VLAN or a range of VLANs.
gvrp static-vlan restrict {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list
no gvrp static-vlan restrict {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
vlan-list The VLAN ID or the VLAN ID range (e.g., 1-10).

Defaults
By default, ports are assigned to the static VLAN based on GVRP PDU processing.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to set the specified port and VLAN to the default value.

• GVRP should be enabled on the port before restricting static VLAN registrations on that port.

• This command does not apply to dynamic VLANs.

• To use the agg_num parameter, the link aggregate group should be created and enabled.

Examples
-> gvrp static-vlan restrict port 3/2 5
-> no gvrp static-vlan restrict port 3/2 5
-> gvrp static-vlan restrict port 3/2 6-9
-> no gvrp static-vlan restrict port 3/2 6-9
-> gvrp static-vlan restrict linkagg 3 4-5
-> no gvrp static-vlan aggregate linkagg 3 4-5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-17


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigTable
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrationToStaticVlan
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrationToStaticVlanLearn
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrationToStaticVlanRestrict

page 7-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

clear gvrp statistics


Clears GVRP statistics for all the ports, an aggregate of ports, or a specific port.
clear gvrp statistics [linkagg agg_num | port slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults
By default, the GVRP statistics are deleted for all the ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the agg_num or slot/port parameter with this command to clear GVRP statistics for a specific port.

Examples
-> clear gvrp statistics port 3/2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show gvrp statistics Displays the GVRP statistics or all the ports, an aggregate of ports, or a
specific port.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpGlobalClearStats
alaGvrpPortStatsTable
alaGvrpPortStatsClearStats

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-19


GVRP Commands

show gvrp statistics


Displays the GVRP statistics for all the ports, an aggregate of ports, or a specific port.
show gvrp statistics [linkagg agg_num | port slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults
By default, the GVRP statistics are displayed for all ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the agg_num or slot/port parameter with this command to display GVRP statistics for a specific port.

Examples
-> show gvrp statistics port 1/21
Port 1/21:
Join Empty Received : 8290,
Join In Received : 1526,
Empty Received : 0,
Leave Empty Received : 1,
Leave In Received : 0,
Leave All Received : 283,
Join Empty Transmitted : 826,
Join In Transmitted : 1532,
Empty Transmitted : 39,
Leave Empty Transmitted : 0,
Leave In Transmitted : 0,
Leave All Transmitted : 296,
Failed Registrations : 0,
Garp PDU Received : 1160,
Garp PDU Transmitted : 957,
Garp Msgs Received : 10100,
Garp Msgs Transmitted : 2693,
Invalid Msgs Received : 0

-> show gvrp statistics


Port 1/1:
Join Empty Received : 0,
Join In Received : 0,
Empty Received : 0,
Leave Empty Received : 0,

page 7-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

Leave In Received : 0,
Leave All Received : 0,
Join Empty Transmitted : 0,
Join In Transmitted : 0,
Empty Transmitted : 0,
Leave Empty Transmitted : 0,
Leave In Transmitted : 0,
Leave All Transmitted : 0,
Failed Registrations : 0,
Garp PDU Received : 0,
Garp PDU Transmitted : 0,
Garp Msgs Received : 0,
Garp Msgs Transmitted : 0,
Invalid Msgs Received : 0

Port 1/2:
Join Empty Received : 8330,
Join In Received : 1526,
Empty Received : 0,
Leave Empty Received : 1,
Leave In Received : 0,
Leave All Received : 284,
Join Empty Transmitted : 830,
Join In Transmitted : 1532,
Empty Transmitted : 39,
Leave Empty Transmitted : 0,
Leave In Transmitted : 0,
Leave All Transmitted : 297,
Failed Registrations : 0,
Garp PDU Received : 1165,
Garp PDU Transmitted : 962,
Garp Msgs Received : 10141,
Garp Msgs Transmitted : 2698,
Invalid Msgs Received : 0

Port 1/3:
Join Empty Received : 0,
Join In Received : 0,
Empty Received : 0,

output definitions
Join Empty Received The number of Join Empty messages received.
Join In Received The number of Join In messages received.
Empty Received The number of Empty messages received.
Leave Empty Received The number of Leave Empty messages received.
Leave In Received The number of Leave In messages received.
Leave All Received The number of Leave All messages received.
Join Empty Transmitted The number of Join Empty messages transmitted.
Join In Transmitted The number of Join In messages transmitted.
Empty Transmitted The number of Empty messages transmitted.
Leave Empty Transmitted The number of Leave Empty messages transmitted.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-21


GVRP Commands

output definitions
Join Empty Received The number of Join Empty messages received.
Leave In Transmitted The number of Leave In messages transmitted.
Leave All Transmitted The number of Leave All messages transmitted.
Failed Registrations The number of failed registrations.
Total PDU Received The number of total PDUs received.
Total PDU Transmitted The number of total PDUs transmitted.
Invalid Msgs Received The number of invalid messages received.
Total Msgs Received The number of total messages received.
Total Msgs Transmitted The number of total messages transmitted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

clear gvrp statistics Clears GVRP statistics for all the ports, an aggregate of ports, or a spe-
cific port.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortStatsTable
alaGvrpPortStatsJoinEmptyReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsJoinInReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsEmptyReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsLeaveInReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsLeaveEmptyReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsLeaveAllReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsJoinEmptyTransmitted
alaGvrpPortStatsJoinInTransmitted
alaGvrpPortStatsEmptyTransmitted
alaGvrpPortStatsLeaveInTransmitted
alaGvrpPortStatsLeaveEmptyTransmitted
alaGvrpPortStatsLeaveAllTransmitted
dot1qPortGvrpFailedRegistrations
alaGvrpPortStatsTotalPDUReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsTotalPDUTransmitted
alaGvrpPortStatsInvalidMsgsReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsTotalMsgsReceived
alaGvrpPortStatsTotalMsgsTransmitted

page 7-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

show gvrp last-pdu-origin


Displays the source MAC address of the last GVRP message received on a specific port or an aggregate of
ports.
show gvrp last-pdu-origin {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show gvrp last-pdu-origin port 1/21
Last-PDU Origin : 00:d0:95:ee:f4:64

output definitions
Last-PDU Origin The source MAC address of the last PDU message received on the spe-
cific port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
Dot1qPortvlantable
dot1qPortGvrpLastPduOrigin

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-23


GVRP Commands

show gvrp configuration


Displays the global configuration for GVRP.
show gvrp configuration

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show gvrp configuration
GVRP Enabled : yes,
Transparent Switching Enabled : no,
Maximum VLAN Limit : 256

output definitions
GVRP Enabled Indicates whether or not GVRP is globally enabled.
Transparent Switching Indicates whether transparent switching is enabled (Yes) or disabled
Enabled (No). When enabled, GVRP messages are flooded even if GVRP is dis-
abled for the switch.
Maximum VLAN Limit The maximum number of VLANs that can be learned by GVRP in the
system.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 7-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

gvrp Enables GVRP on the device globally.


gvrp transparent switching Enables transparent switching on the device.
gvrp maximum vlan Configures the maximum number of dynamic VLANs that can be
learned by GVRP.

MIB Objects
dot1qGvrpStatus
alaGvrpTransparentSwitching
alaGvrpMaxVlanLimit

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-25


GVRP Commands

show gvrp configuration port


Displays the GVRP configuration status for all the ports.
show gvrp configuration port

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show gvrp configuration port
Port GVRP Status
--------+---------------
1/1 Disabled
1/2 Disabled
1/3 Disabled
1/4 Disabled
1/5 Disabled
1/6 Disabled
1/7 Disabled
1/8 Disabled
1/9 Enabled
1/10 Disabled
1/11 Disabled
1/12 Disabled
1/13 Disabled
1/14 Disabled
1/15 Disabled
1/16 Disabled
1/17 Disabled
1/18 Disabled
1/19 Disabled
1/20 Disabled
1/21 Enabled
1/22 Disabled
1/23 Disabled
1/24 Disabled
1/25 Disabled
1/26 Disabled
1/27 Disabled
1/28 Disabled

page 7-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

1/29 Disabled
1/30 Disabled
1/31 Enabled
1/32 Disabled
1/33 Disabled
1/34 Disabled
1/35 Disabled
1/36 Disabled
1/37 Disabled
1/38 Disabled
1/39 Disabled
1/40 Disabled
1/41 Disabled
1/42 Disabled
1/43 Disabled
1/44 Disabled
1/45 Disabled
1/46 Disabled
1/47 Disabled
1/48 Disabled
1/49 Disabled
1/50 Disabled

output definitions
Port Displays the slot/port number.
GVRP Status Indicates if GVRP is Enabled or Disabled on the port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

gvrp port Enables GVRP on a specific port or an aggregate of ports on the switch.
show gvrp configuration Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of
linkagg/port ports.

MIB Objects
Dot1qportvlantable
dot1qPortGvrpStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-27


GVRP Commands

show gvrp configuration linkagg/port


Displays the GVRP configuration for a specific port or an aggregate of ports.
show gvrp configuration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

Syntax Definitions
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show gvrp configuration port 1/21
Port 1/21:
GVRP Enabled : yes,
Registrar Mode : normal,
Applicant Mode : participant,
Join Timer (msec) : 600,
Leave Timer (msec) : 1800,
LeaveAll Timer (msec) : 30000,
Legacy Bpdu : disabled

VLAN Memberships:
VLAN Id Static Restricted Restricted
Registration Registration Applicant
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----------
1 LEARN FALSE FALSE
2 LEARN FALSE FALSE
11 LEARN FALSE FALSE
12 LEARN FALSE FALSE
13 LEARN FALSE FALSE
14 LEARN FALSE FALSE
15 LEARN FALSE FALSE
16 LEARN FALSE FALSE
17 LEARN FALSE FALSE
18 LEARN FALSE FALSE
19 LEARN FALSE FALSE
20 LEARN FALSE FALSE
51 RESTRICT FALSE FALSE
52 RESTRICT FALSE FALSE

page 7-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

53 LEARN TRUE FALSE


54 LEARN TRUE FALSE
55 LEARN FALSE TRUE
56 LEARN FALSE TRUE
57 LEARN FALSE FALSE
58 LEARN FALSE FALSE
59 LEARN FALSE FALSE
60 LEARN FALSE FALSE

output definitions
GVRP Enabled Indicates whether or not GVRP is globally enabled (Yes or No).
Registrar Mode Indicates the registrar mode (NORMAL, FIXED, or FORBIDDEN)
of the port.
Applicant Mode Indicates the applicant mode (PARTICIPANT, NON-PARTICI-
PANT, or ACTIVE) of the port.
Join Timer Displays the Join timer value.
Leave Timer Displays the Leave timer value.
LeaveAll Timer Displays the LeaveAll timer value.
Legacy Bpdu Indicates the status of conventional/customer BPDU processing on net-
work ports (ENABLED or DISABLED).
VLAN Id The numerical VLAN ID.
Static Registration Indicates if the port is restricted (RESTRICT) or not restricted
(LEARN) from becoming a member of the static VLAN.
Restricted Registration Indicates if the VLAN is restricted (TRUE) or not restricted (FALSE)
from dynamic registration on the port.
Restricted Applicant Indicates if the restricted applicant mode is enabled (TRUE) or not
(FALSE).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-29


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

gvrp port Enables GVRP on a specific port or an aggregate of ports on the switch.
gvrp registration Configures the GVRP registration mode for a specific port or an aggre-
gate of ports.
gvrp applicant Configures the applicant mode of a specific port or an aggregate of ports
on the switch.
gvrp timer Configures the Join, Leave, or LeaveAll timer values for the switch
ports.
gvrp restrict-vlan-registration Restricts GVRP processing from dynamically registering the specified
VLAN(s) on the switch.
gvrp restrict-vlan- Restricts the advertisement of VLANs on a specific port or an aggregate
advertisement of ports.
gvrp static-vlan restrict Restricts a port from becoming a member of a statically created VLAN
or a range of VLANs.
show gvrp configuration port Displays the GVRP configuration status for all the ports.

MIB Objects
Dot1qportvlantable
dot1qPortGvrpLastPduOrigin
dot1qPortGvrpStatus
alaGvrpPortConfigTable
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrarMode
alaGvrpPortConfigApplicantMode
alaGvrpPortConfigJoinTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigLeaveTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigLeaveAllTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigRestrictedRegistrationBitmap
alaGvrpPortConfigRegistrationToStaticVlan
alaGvrpPortConfigPropagateDynamicNonGvrpVlan

page 7-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

show gvrp timer


Displays the timer values configured for all the ports or a specific port.
show gvrp timer [[join | leave | leaveall] {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}]

Syntax Definitions
join Displays the Join timer value.
leave Displays the Leave timer value.
leaveall Displays the LeaveAll timer value.
agg_num The number corresponding to the aggregate group.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults
By default the timer values configured on all the ports are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the join, leave, or leaveall parameter with this command to view the specific timer values config-
ured on all the ports.
• Use the agg_num or slot/port parameter with this command to display the timer values configured for a
specific port.

Examples
-> show gvrp timer
Legend : All timer values are in milliseconds
Port Join Timer Leave Timer LeaveAll Timer
--------+--------------+--------------+---------------
1/1 600 1800 30000
1/2 600 1800 30000
1/3 600 1800 30000
1/4 600 1800 30000
1/5 600 1800 30000
1/6 600 1800 30000
1/7 600 1800 30000
1/8 600 1800 30000
1/9 600 1800 30000
1/10 600 1800 30000
1/11 600 1800 30000
1/12 600 1800 30000
1/13 600 1800 30000
1/14 600 1800 30000
1/15 600 1800 30000

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-31


GVRP Commands

1/16 600 1800 30000


1/17 600 1800 30000
1/18 600 1800 30000
1/19 600 1800 30000
1/20 600 1800 30000
1/21 600 1800 30000
1/22 600 1800 30000
1/23 600 1800 30000
1/24 600 1800 30000
1/25 600 1800 30000
1/26 600 1800 30000
1/27 600 1800 30000
1/28 600 1800 30000
1/29 600 1800 30000
1/30 600 1800 30000
1/31 600 1800 30000
1/32 600 1800 30000
1/33 600 1800 30000
1/34 600 1800 30000
1/35 600 1800 30000
1/36 600 1800 30000
1/37 600 1800 30000
1/38 600 1800 30000
1/39 600 1800 30000
1/40 600 1800 30000
1/41 600 1800 30000
1/42 600 1800 30000
1/43 600 1800 30000
1/44 600 1800 30000
1/45 600 1800 30000
1/46 600 1800 30000
1/47 600 1800 30000
1/48 600 1800 30000
1/49 600 1800 30000
1/50 600 1800 30000

-> show gvrp timer port 1/21


Join Timer (msec) : 600,
Leave Timer (msec) : 1800,
LeaveAll Timer (msec) : 30000

-> show gvrp timer join port 1/21


Join Timer (msec) : 600

-> show gvrp timer leave port 1/21


Leave Timer (msec) : 1800

-> show gvrp timer leaveall port 1/21


LeaveAll Timer (msec) : 30000

-> show gvrp timer join


Legend : All timer values are in milliseconds
Port Join Timer
--------+----------------
1/1 600
1/2 600
1/3 600

page 7-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

1/4 600
1/5 600
1/6 600
1/7 600
1/8 600
1/9 600
1/10 600
1/11 600
1/12 600
1/13 600
1/14 600
1/15 600
1/16 600
1/17 600
1/18 600
1/19 600
1/20 600
1/21 600
1/22 600
1/23 600
1/24 600
1/25 600
1/26 600
1/27 600
1/28 600
1/29 600
1/30 600
1/31 600
1/32 600
1/33 600
1/34 600
1/35 600
1/36 600
1/37 600
1/38 600
1/39 600
1/40 600
1/41 600
1/42 600
1/43 600
1/44 600
1/45 600
1/46 600
1/47 600
1/48 600
1/49 600
1/50 600

-> show gvrp timer leave


Legend : All timer values are in milliseconds
Port Leave Timer
--------+----------------
1/1 1800
1/2 1800
1/3 1800
1/4 1800
1/5 1800
1/6 1800

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-33


GVRP Commands

1/7 1800
1/8 1800
1/9 1800
1/10 1800
1/11 1800
1/12 1800
1/13 1800
1/14 1800
1/15 1800
1/16 1800
1/17 1800
1/18 1800
1/19 1800
1/20 1800
1/21 1800
1/22 1800
1/23 1800
1/24 1800
1/25 1800
1/26 1800
1/27 1800
1/28 1800
1/29 1800
1/30 1800
1/31 1800
1/32 1800
1/33 1800
1/34 1800
1/35 1800
1/36 1800
1/37 1800
1/38 1800
1/39 1800
1/40 1800
1/41 1800
1/42 1800
1/43 1800
1/44 1800
1/45 1800
1/46 1800
1/47 1800
1/48 1800
1/49 1800
1/50 1800

-> show gvrp timer leaveall


Legend : All timer values are in milliseconds
Port LeaveAll Timer
--------+----------------
1/1 30000
1/2 30000
1/3 30000
1/4 30000
1/5 30000
1/6 30000
1/7 30000
1/8 30000
1/9 30000

page 7-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


GVRP Commands

1/10 30000
1/11 30000
1/12 30000
1/13 30000
1/14 30000
1/15 30000
1/16 30000
1/17 30000
1/18 30000
1/19 30000
1/20 30000
1/21 30000
1/22 30000
1/23 30000
1/24 30000
1/25 30000
1/26 30000
1/27 30000
1/28 30000
1/29 30000
1/30 30000
1/31 30000
1/32 30000
1/33 30000
1/34 30000
1/35 30000
1/36 30000
1/37 30000
1/38 30000
1/39 30000
1/40 30000
1/41 30000
1/42 30000
1/43 30000
1/44 30000
1/45 30000
1/46 30000
1/47 30000
1/48 30000
1/49 30000
1/50 30000

output definitions
Port Displays the slot/port number.
Join Timer Displays the Join timer value in milliseconds.
Leave Timer Displays the Leave timer value in milliseconds.
LeaveAll Timer Displays the LeaveAll timer value in milliseconds.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7-35


GVRP Commands

Related Commands

gvrp timer Configures the Join, Leave, or LeaveAll timer values for the switch
ports.

MIB Objects
alaGvrpPortConfigTable
alaGvrpPortConfigJoinTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigLeaveTimer
alaGvrpPortConfigLeaveAllTimer

page 7-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


8 802.1AB Commands

Alcatel-Lucent’s 802.1AB is an IEEE standard for exchanging information with neighboring devices and
maintaining a database of the information. The information is exchanged using the LLDPDU (Link Layer
Discovery Protocol Data Unit) in TLV (Time, Length, Value) format. This chapter details configuring and
monitoring 802.1AB on a switch.
Alcatel-Lucent’s version of 802.1AB complies with the IEEE 802.1AB-2005 Station and Media Access
Control Discovery and ANSI-TIA 1057-2006 Link Layer Discovery Protocol for Media End Point
Devices.
MIB information for the 802.1AB commands is as follows:
Filename: IEEE_LLDP_Base.mib
Module: LLDP-MIB
Filename: IEEE_LLDP_Dot1.mib
Module: LLDP-EXT-DOT1-MIB
Filename: IEEE_LLDP_Dot3.mib
Module: LLDP-EXT-DOT3-MIB
A summary of available commands is listed here:

lldp destination mac-address


lldp transmit fast-start-count
lldp transmit hold-multiplier
lldp transmit delay
lldp reinit delay
lldp network-policy
lldp med network-policy
lldp notification interval
lldp lldpdu
lldp notification
lldp tlv management
lldp tlv dot1
lldp tlv dot3
lldp tlv med
show lldp config
show lldp network-policy
show lldp med network-policy
show lldp system-statistics
show lldp config
show lldp statistics
show lldp local -system
show lldp local -port
show lldp local-management-address
show lldp remote-system

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-1


802.1AB Commands

Configuration procedures for 802.1AB are explained in the “Configuring 802.1AB” chapter of the
OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide.

page 8-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

lldp destination mac-address


Sets the lldp destination mac-address sent in LLPDUs.
lldp destination mac-address {nearest-bridge | nearest-edge}

Syntax Definitions
nearest-bridge Specifies the destination mac-address as 01:80:C2:00:00:0E.
nearest-edge Specifies the destination mac-address as 01:20: DA: 02:01:73.

Defaults

parameter default
mac-address nearest-bridge

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The nearest-edge MAC address is used in conjunction with the Auto Download Configuration feature to
advertise the management VLAN.

Examples
-> lldp destination mac-address nearest-edge

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command introduced.

Related Commands

show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpDestMac

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-3


802.1AB Commands

lldp transmit fast-start-count


Configures the fast start count for an LLDP Media Endpoint Device (MED).The fast start count specifes
the number of LLDPDUs to be sent as soon as a MED is detected by the switch. The LLDPDUs contain
the LLDP MED Network Policy TLVs.
lldp transmit fast-start-count num

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the number of LLDPDUs to send when a MED is detected.
The valid range is 1–10.

Defaults

parameter default
num 3

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The LLDP MED fast start is only applicable when the MED is detected by the switch.

Examples
-> lldp transmit fast-start-count 4

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command introduced.

Related Commands

lldp network-policy Configures a MED Network Policy on the switch for a specific applica-
tion type.
lldp med network-policy Associates an existing MED Network Policy with one or more LLDP
ports.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpXMedFastStartRepeatCount

page 8-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

lldp transmit interval


Sets the transmit time interval for LLDPDUs.
lldp transmit interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The transmit interval between LLDPDUs, in seconds. The valid range is
5 - 32768.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 30

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The LLDP protocol must be enabled before using this command.

Examples
-> lldp transmit interval 40

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp transmit hold-multiplier Sets the transmit hold multiplier value. This value is used to calculate
the Time To Live (TLL) value that is advertised in an LLDPDU.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpConfiguration
lldpMessageTxInterval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-5


802.1AB Commands

lldp transmit hold-multiplier


Sets the transmit hold multiplier value. This value is used to calculate the Time To Live (TTL) value that
is advertised in an LLDPDU.
lldp transmit hold-multiplier num

Syntax Definitions
num The transmit hold multiplier value. The valid range is 2-10.

Defaults

parameter default
num 4

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDP protocol must be enabled before using this command.

• The Time To Live is a multiple of transmit interval and transmit hold multiplier.

Examples
-> lldp transmit hold-multiplier 6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp destination mac-address Sets the transmit time interval for LLDPDUs. This is the amount of
time the switch waits between each transmission of an LLDPDU.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpConfiguration
lldpMessageTxHoldMultiplier

page 8-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

lldp transmit delay


Sets the minimum amount of time that must elapse between successive LLDPDUs that are transmitted as
the result of a value or status change in the LLDP local systems MIB.
lldp transmit delay seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The time interval between successive LLDPDUs transmitted, in
seconds. The valid range is 1-8192.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDP protocol must be enabled before using this command.

• The transmit delay is less than or equal to the multiplication of transmit interval and 0.25 (transmit
interval * 0.25).

Examples
-> lldp transmit delay 20

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp destination mac-address Sets the transmit time interval for LLDPDUs. This is the amount of
time the switch waits between each transmission of an LLDPDU.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpConfiguration
lldpTxDelay

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-7


802.1AB Commands

lldp reinit delay


Sets the time interval that must elapse before the current status of a port is reinitialized after a status
change.
lldp reinit delay seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The number of seconds to reinitialize the ports status after a status
change. The valid range is 1-10.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450 .

Usage Guidelines
The LLDP protocol must be enabled before using this command.

Examples
-> lldp reinit delay 4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp transmit delay Sets the minimum time interval between successive LLDPDUs trans-
mitted.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpConfiguration
lldpReinitDelay

page 8-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

lldp notification interval


Sets the time interval that must elapse before a notification about the local system MIB change is
generated.
lldp notification interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The minimum number of seconds for generating a notification-event.
The valid range is 5-3600.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 5

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDP protocol and notification must be enabled before using this command.

• In a specified interval, generating more than one notification-event is not possible.

Examples
-> lldp notification interval 25

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp notification Enables or disables the LLDP notification status for one or more switch
ports. LLDP notifications are sent when there is a change to the remote
systems MIB.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpConfiguration
lldpNotificationInterval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-9


802.1AB Commands

lldp lldpdu
Specifies the switch to control the transmission and the reception of LLDPDUs for a particular chassis, a
slot, or a port.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} lldpdu {tx | rx | tx-and-rx | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
chassis All ports on the switch.
tx Transmits LLDPDUs.
rx Receives LLDPDUs.
tx-and-rx Transmits and receives LLDPDUs.
disable Disables LLDPDUs transmission and reception.

Defaults

parameter default
tx | rx | tx-and-rx | disable tx-and-rx

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The port can be set to receive, transmit, or transmit and receive LLDPDUs using this command.

• If this command is applied to a slot or chassis, then the existing configuration related to this command
will be lost.

Examples
-> lldp 1/2 lldpdu tx-and-rx
-> lldp chassis lldpdu disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 8-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Related Commands

lldp notification Enables or disables the LLDP notification status for one or more switch
ports. LLDP notifications are sent when there is a change to the remote
systems MIB.
show lldp local -port Displays information about local system ports.
show lldp config Displays the general LLDP configuration information for LLDP ports.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpPortConfigPortNum
lldpPortConfigAdminStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-11


802.1AB Commands

lldp notification
Enables or disables the LLDP notification status for one or more switch ports. LLDP notifications are sent
when there is a change to the remote systems MIB.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} notification {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
chassis All switch ports.
enable Enables the notification of local system MIB changes.
disable Disables the notification.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDPDU administrative status must be in the receive state before using this command.

• If this command is applied to a slot or chassis, then the existing configuration related to this command
will be lost.

Examples
-> lldp 1/2 notification enable
-> lldp 1 notification disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 8-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Related Commands

lldp notification interval Sets the time interval that must elapse before a notification about the
local system MIB change is generated.
lldp lldpdu Configures the LLDPDU status for one or more switch ports. The status
determines if the specified switch ports will transmit, receive, transmit
and receive, or drop LLDPDUs.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpPortConfigPortNum
lldpPortConfigNotificationEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-13


802.1AB Commands

lldp network-policy
Configures a local Network Policy on the switch for a specific application type.
lldp network-policy policy_id - [ policy_id2] application { voice | voice-signaling | guest-voice |
guest-voice-signaling | softphone-voice | video-conferencing | streaming-video | video-signaling }
vlan { untagged | priority-tag | vlan-id } [ l2-priority 802.1p_value ] [ dscp dscp_value ]
no lldp network-policy policy_id - [ policy_id2]

Syntax Definitions
policy_id - [policy_id2] A network policy identifier (0-31) which is associated to a port.
voice Specifies a voice application type.
voice-signaling Specifies a voice-signaling application type.
guest-voice Specifies a guest-voice application type.
guest-voice-signaling Specifies a guest-voice-signaling application type.
softphone-voice Specifies a softphone-voice application type.
video-conferencing Specifies a video-conferencing application type.
streaming-video Specifies a streaming-video application type.
video-signaling Specifies a video-signaling application type.
untagged Specifies that a VLAN port is untagged.
priority-tag Specifies the internal priority that would be assigned to the VLAN.
vlan_id VLAN identifier. Valid range is 1–4094.
802.1p_value The Layer-2 priority value assigned to the VLAN. Valid range is 0–7.
dscp_value Priority value assigned to the DSCP (Differentiated Service Code Point)
header. Valid range is 0–63.

Defaults

parameter default
802.1p_value 0
dscp_value 0

• By default the VLAN ID is configured in the voice network profile.

• By default the 802.1p_value is 5 for voice application.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

page 8-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the configured network policy from the system.

• When a network policy is deleted, all the associated values and port bindings are also deleted.

• A maximum of 32 network policies can be configured on a single VLAN.

• Once a policy is created, the application type, VLAN ID, 802.1p, and DSCP values can be modified.

• If a network policy ID is bound to a port, it cannot be modified.

• Use a hyphen to specify a range of Policy IDs and a space to separate multiple Policy IDs in the
command.
• The range for Policy IDs is supported only with the no form of this command.

Examples
-> lldp network-policy 10 application voice vlan 20
-> lldp network-policy 11 application guest-voice-signaling vlan untagged
l2-priority 3
-> lldp network-policy 20 application voice vlan priority-tag dscp 39
-> lldp network-policy 20 application voice-signaling vlan 23 l2-priority 2 dscp 43
-> no lldp network-policy 10
-> no lldp network-policy 10-20

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command introduced.

Related Commands

lldp tlv med Configures whether or not LLDP-MED TLVs are included in
transmitted LLDPDUs.
show lldp network-policy Displays the network policy details for a given policy ID.
show lldp med network-policy Displays the network policy configured on a slot or port. If no option is
specified, network policies configured on all ports of the chassis are
displayed.

MIB Objects
aLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyTable
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyId
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyAppType
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyVlanType
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyVlanID
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPriority
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyDscp
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyUnknown
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyTagged
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-15


802.1AB Commands

lldp med network-policy


Associates an existing network policy to a port, slot, or chassis.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} med network-policy policy_id - [policy_id2]
no lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} med network-policy policy_id - [policy_id2]

Syntax Definition
slot/port The slot number for the module and physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
chassis All switch ports.
policy_id - [policy_id2] A network policy identifier (0–31).

Defaults
NA

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disassociate a network policy from a port.

• The network policy should already be configured in the system before associating it with a port.

• A maximum of 8 network policies can be associated to a port.

• Two or more network policy IDs with the same application type cannot be associated to a port.

Examples
-> lldp chassis med network-policy 22
-> lldp 1 med network-policy 1-4 5 6
-> lldp 2/3 med network-policy 12
-> no lldp 2/3 med network-policy 12

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command introduced.

page 8-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Related Commands

lldp tlv med Configures whether or not LLDP-MED TLVs are included in
transmitted LLDPDUs.
show lldp network-policy Displays the MED Network Policy details for a given policy ID.
show lldp med network-policy Displays the network policy configured on a slot or port. If no option is
specified, network policies configured on all ports of the chassis are
displayed.

MIB Objects
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPortTable
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPortIfIndex
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyId
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPortRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-17


802.1AB Commands

lldp tlv management


Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be incorporated in the LLDPDUs.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv management {port-description | system-name | system-description |
system-capabilities | management-address} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
port-description Enables or disables the transmission of port description TLV in
LLDPDU.
system-name Enables or disables the transmission of system name TLV in LLDPDU.
system-description Enables or disables transmission of system description TLV in
LLDPDU.
system-capabilities Enables or disables transmission of system capabilities TLV in
LLDPDU.
management-address Enables or disables transmission of management address on per port.
enable Enables management TLV LLDPDU transmission.
disable Disables management TLV LLDPDU transmission.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDPDU must be enabled and set to transmit before using this command.

• If this command is applied to a slot or chassis, then the existing configuration related to this command
will be lost.

Examples
-> lldp 1/2 tlv management port-description enable
-> lldp 2 tlv management management-address enable
-> lldp 3 tlv management system-name disable

page 8-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp lldpdu Specifies the switch to control the transmission and the reception of
LLDPDUs for a particular chassis, a slot, or a port.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.
show lldp local -port Displays per port information.
show lldp remote-system Displays per local port and information of remote system.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpLocPortPortNum
lldpPortConfigTLVsTxEnable
lldpConfigManAddrTable
lldpConfigManAddrPortsTxEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-19


802.1AB Commands

lldp tlv dot1


Specifies the switch to control per port 802.1 TLVs to be incorporated in the LLDPDUs.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv dot1 {port-vlan | vlan-name} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
port-vlan Enables or disables transmission of port VLAN TLV in LLDPDU.
vlan-name Enables or disables transmission of VLAN name TLV in LLDPDU.
enable Enables 802.1 TLV LLDPDU transmission.
disable Disables 802.1 TLV LLDPDU transmission.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDPDU must be enabled and set to transmit before using this command.

• If this command is applied to a slot or chassis, then the existing configuration related to this command
will be lost.
• If one TLV is included then the other TLV is automatically included when you use this command.

Examples
-> lldp 5/1 tlv dot1 port-vlan enable
-> lldp 3 tlv dot1 vlan-name enable
-> lldp 3 tlv dot1 vlan-name disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 8-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Related Commands

lldp tlv management Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be incor-
porated in the LLDPDUs.
show lldp statistics Displays per port statistics.
show lldp local -port Displays per port information.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpPortConfigPortNum
lldpXdot1ConfigPortVlanTable
lldpXdot1ConfigPortVlanTxEnable
lldpXdot1ConfigVlanNameTable
lldpXdot1ConfigVlanNameTxEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-21


802.1AB Commands

lldp tlv dot3


Specifies the switch to control per port 802.3 TLVs to be incorporated in the LLDPDUs.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv dot3 mac-phy {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
enable Enables 802.3 TLV LLDPDU transmission.
disable Disables 802.3 TLV LLDPDU transmission.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDPDU must be enabled and set to transmit before using this command.

• If this command is applied to a slot or chassis, then the existing configuration related to this command
will be lost.

Examples
-> lldp 2/4 tlv dot3 mac-phy enable
-> lldp 2 tlv dot3 mac-phy disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 8-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Related Commands

lldp lldpdu Configures the LLDPDU status for one or more switch ports. The status
determines if the specified switch ports will transmit, receive, transmit
and receive, or drop LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv management Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be incor-
porated in the LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv dot1 Specifies the switch to control per port 802.1 TLVs to be incorporated
in the LLDPDUs.
show lldp statistics Displays per port statistics.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpPortConfigPortNum
lldpXdot3PortConfigTable
lldpXdot3PortConfigTLVsTxEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-23


802.1AB Commands

lldp tlv med


Specifies the switch to control per port LLDP-MED (Media Endpoint Device) TLVs to be incorporated in
the LLDPDUs.
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv med {power | capability | network policy} {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
chassis All ports on the switch.
power Includes the extended POE TLV in transmitted LLDPDUs.
capability Enables or disables transmission of LLDP-MED capabilities TLV in
LLDPDU.
network policy Includes the Network Policy TLV in transmitted LLDPDUs.
enable Enables LLDP-MED TLV LLDPDU transmission.
disable Disables LLDP-MED TLV LLDPDU transmission.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LLDPDU must be enabled and set to transmit before using this command.

• If this command is applied to a slot or chassis, then the existing configuration related to this command
will be lost.
• The lldp tlv med power version of this command applies only to PoE units.

• Before enabling the Power MED TLV, use the lanpower start command to activate PoE on a port or
on all ports in a specific slot.

Examples
-> lldp 4/4 tlv med power enable
-> lldp 4/3 tlv med capability enable
-> lldp 4 tlv med power disable
-> lldp 4 tlv med network-policy enable
-> lldp chassis tlv med network-policy enable

page 8-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; network policy option added.

Related Commands

lldp lldpdu Configures the LLDPDU status for one or more switch ports. The status
determines if the specified switch ports will transmit, receive, transmit
and receive, or drop LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv management Configures whether or not management TLVs are included in transmit-
ted LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv dot1 Configures whether or not 802.1 TLVs are included in transmitted
LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv dot3 Configures whether or not 802.3 TLVs are included in transmitted
LLDPDUs.
show lldp med network-policy Displays the MED Network Policy configuration.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpPortConfigPortNum
lldpXMedPortConfigTable
lldpXMedPortConfigTLVsTxEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-25


802.1AB Commands

show lldp config


Displays the general LLDP configuration information for LLDP ports.
show lldp {slot | slot/port} config

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number for a specific module.
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).

Defaults
By default, a list of all LLDP ports with their configuration parameters is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot/port or slot parameter to display information for a specific port or for all ports on a specific
module.

Examples
-> show lldp config
----------+-------------------------------------------+-----------------+-------
| Admin | Notify | Std TLV | Mgmt | 802.1 | 802.3 | MED
Slot/Port| Status | Trap | Mask | Address | TLV | Mask | Mask
----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+------+------
2/1 Rx + Tx Disabled 0x00 Disabled Disabled 0x00 0x00
2/2 Rx + Tx Disabled 0x00 Disabled Disabled 0x00 0x00
2/3 Rx + Tx Disabled 0x00 Disabled Disabled 0x00 0x00
2/4 Rx + Tx Disabled 0x00 Disabled Disabled 0x00 0x00
2/5 Rx + Tx Disabled 0x00 Disabled Disabled 0x00 0x00

output definitions
Slot/Port The LLDP slot and port number.
Admin Status Indicates the Administrative status of the LLDP port.The options
are - Disabled, Rx, Tx, and Rx+Tx.
Notify Trap Indicates if the Notify Trap feature is disabled or enabled on a
particular port
Std TLV Mask The standard TLV mask set for the port.
Mgmt Address Indicates whether transmission of the per port IPv4 management
address is enabled or disabled.
802.1 TLV Indicates whether 802.1 TLV status is enabled or disabled on the LLDP
port.

page 8-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

output definitions
802.3 Mask The standard 802.3 mask set for the port.
MED Mask The standard MED mask set for the port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp lldpdu Configures the LLDPDU status for one or more switch ports. The status
determines if the specified switch ports will transmit, receive, transmit
and receive, or drop LLDPDUs.
lldp notification Enables or disables the LLDP notification status for one or more switch
ports. LLDP notifications are sent when there is a change to the remote
systems MIB.
lldp tlv management Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be
incorporated in the LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv dot3 Configures whether or not 802.3 TLVs are included in transmitted
LLDPDUs.

MIB Objects
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpPortConfigPortNum
lldpPortConfigAdminStatus
lldpPortConfigNotificationEnable
lldpLocPortPortNum
lldpPortConfigTLVsTxEnable
lldpConfigManAddrTable
lldpConfigManAddrPortsTxEnable
lldpXdot3PortConfigTable
lldpXdot3PortConfigTLVsTxEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-27


802.1AB Commands

show lldp network-policy


Displays the MED Network Policy details for a given policy ID.
show lldp network-policy [policy_id]

Syntax Definitions
policy_id Policy identifier for a network policy definition. Valid range is between
0 and 31.

Defaults
By default, all configured policies are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Network policy should be configured on the system before using this command.

• Enter a policy ID with this command to display information for a specific policy.

Examples
-> show lldp network-policy
Legend: 0 Priority Tagged Vlan
- Untagged Vlan

Network Application Vlan Layer2 DSCP


Policy ID Type Id Priority Value
-----------+----------------------+------+--------+-------
1 voice 4000 7 33
12 guest-voice - - 44
21 streaming-voice 0 4 11
31 guest-voice-signaling 23 2 1

-> show lldp network-policy 1


Legend: 0 Priority Tagged Vlan
- Untagged Vlan

Network Application Vlan Layer2 DSCP


Policy ID Type Id Priority Value
-----------+----------------------+------+--------+-------
1 voice 4000 7 33

page 8-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

output definitions

Network Policy ID Policy identifier for a network policy definition.


Application Type Indicates the type of application configured on the port or VLAN.
VLAN ID The VLAN ID assigned to the port on which the network policy is
configured.
Layer2 Priority Layer 2 priority to be used for the specified application type.
DSCP Value DSCP value to be used to provide Diffserv node behavior for the
specified application type.

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command introduced.

Related Commands

lldp network-policy Configures a local network policy on a switch for an application type.

MIB Objects
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyTable
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyId
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyAppType
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyVlanType
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyVlanId
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPriority
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyDscp
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyUnknown
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyTagged

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-29


802.1AB Commands

show lldp med network-policy


Displays the network policy configured on a slot or port. If no option is specified, network policies
configured on all ports of the chassis are displayed.
show lldp [slot | slot/port] med network-policy

Syntax Definitions
slot Specifies the slot number on a specific module or chassis.
slot/port Specifies the slot number for the module and physical port number on
that module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 of slot 3).

Defaults
By default, all ports with associated policies are displayed.

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• Network policy should be configured on the system before using this command.

• Enter a slot or slot/port number with this command to display information for a specific slot or port.

Examples
-> show lldp med network-policy

slot/port Network Policy ID


--------------+-------------------------
1/1 1 3 5 7 21 23 30 31
1/2 1 2 3 4 7 8 9 10
.
.
.
2/1 1 3 5
.
.

-> show lldp 1/1 med network-policy

Legend: 0 Priority Tagged Vlan


- Untagged Vlan

Slot/ Network Application Vlan Layer2 DSCP


Port Policy ID Type Id Priority Value
-------+-----------+----------------------+------+--------+-------
1/1 1 guest-voice-signaling - - 0

page 8-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

output definitions
Slot / Port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module.
Network Policy ID Policy identifier for a network policy definition.
Application Type Indicates the type of application configured on the port or VLAN.
VLAN ID The VLAN ID assigned to the port on which the network policy is
configured.
Layer2 Priority Layer 2 priority to be used for the specified application type.

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command introduced.

Related Commands

lldp tlv med Configures whether or not LLDP-MED TLVs are included in
transmitted LLDPDUs.
lldp network-policy Configures a local network policy on a switch for an application type.

MIB Objects
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPortTable
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyPortIfIndex
alaLldpXMedLocMediaPolicyId

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-31


802.1AB Commands

show lldp system-statistics


Displays system-wide statistics.
show lldp system-statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show lldp system-statistics
Local LLDP Agent System Statistics:
Remote Systems Last Change = 0 days 0 hours 3 minutes and 10 seconds,
Remote Systems MIB Inserts = 2,
Remote Systems MIB Deletes = 0,
Remote Systems MIB Drops = 0,
Remote Systems MIB Age Outs = 0

output definitions
Remote Systems Last Change The last change recorded in the tables associated with the remote sys-
tem.
Remote Systems MIB Inserts The total number of complete inserts in the tables associated with the
remote system.
Remote Systems MIB Deletes The total number of complete deletes in tables associated with the
remote system.
Remote Systems MIB Drops The total number of LLDPDUs dropped because of insufficient
resources.
Remote Systems MIB Age The total number of complete age-outs in the tables associated with the
Outs remote system.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 8-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Related Commands

lldp notification Enables or disables the LLDP notification status for one or more switch
ports. LLDP notifications are sent when there is a change to the remote
systems MIB.
lldp notification interval Sets the amount of time that must elapse before an LLDP notification
about a remote systems MIB change is generated.

MIB Objects
lldpStatistics
lldpStatsRemTablesLastChangeTime
lldpStatsRemTablesInserts
lldpStatsRemTablesDeletes
lldpStatsRemTablesDrops
lldpStatsRemTablesAgeouts

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-33


802.1AB Commands

show lldp statistics


Displays per port statistics.
show lldp [slot|slot/port] statistics

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.

Defaults
By default, statistics are displayed for all LLDP ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a slot or slot/port number to display statistics for a specific slot or port.

• If the statistics are zero they are not displayed.

Examples
-> show lldp statistics
----------+--------------------------------------+---------------------+----------
| LLDPDU | TLV | Device
Slot/Port| Tx Rx Errors Discards | Unknown Discards | Ageouts
----------+--------+----------+----------+----------+----------+----------+-----
1/23 52 0 0 0 0 0 0
2/47 50 50 0 0 0 0 0
2/48 50 50 0 0 0 0 0

output definitions
Slot/Port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module.
LLDPDU Tx The total number of LLDPDUs transmitted on the port.
LLDPDU Rx The total number of valid LLDPDUs received on the port.
LLDPDU Errors The total number of invalid LLDPDUs discarded on the port.
LLDPDU Discards The total number of LLDPDUs discarded on the port.
TLV Unknown The total number of unrecognized LLDP TLVs on the port.
TLV Discards The total number of LLDP TLVs discarded on the port.
Device Ageouts The total number of complete age-outs on the port.

page 8-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp lldpdu Configures the LLDPDU status for one or more switch ports. The status
determines if the specified switch ports will transmit, receive, transmit
and receive, or drop LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv management Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be incor-
porated in the LLDPDUs.

MIB Objects
lldpStatsTxPortTable
lldpStatsTxPortNum
lldpStatsTxPortFramesTotal
lldpStatsRxPortTable
lldpStatsRxPortNum
lldpStatsRxPortFramesDiscardedTotal
lldpStatsRxPortFramesErrors
lldpStatsRxPortFramesTotal
lldpStatsRxPortTLVsDiscardedTotal
lldpStatsRxPortTLVsUnrecognizedTotal
lldpStatsRxPortAgeoutsTotal

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-35


802.1AB Commands

show lldp local-system


Displays local system information.
show lldp local-system

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show lldp local-system
Local LLDP Agent System Data:
Chassis ID Subtype = 4 (MAC Address),
Chassis ID = 00:d0:95:e9:c9:2e,
System Name = Kite2_Stack_of_2,
System Description = 6.3.1.636.R01 Development, September 07, 2007.,
Capabilites Supported = Bridge, Router,
Capabilites Enabled = Bridge, Router,
LLDPDU Transmit Interval = 30 seconds,
TTL Hold Multiplier = 4,
LLDPDU Transmit Delay = 2 seconds,
Reintialization Delay = 2 seconds,
MIB Notification Interval = 5 seconds
Fast Start Count = 4,
Management Address Type = 1 (IPv4),
Management IP Address = 10.255.11.100,

output definitions
Chassis ID Subtype The subtype that describe chassis ID.
Chassis ID The chassis ID (MAC address).
System Name The name of the system.
System Description The description of the system.
Capabilites Supported The capabilities of the system.
Capabilites Enabled The enabled capabilities of the system.
LLDPDU Transmit Interval The LLDPDU transmit interval.
TTL Hold Multiplier The hold multiplier used to calculate TTL.

page 8-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

output definitions (continued)


LLDPDU Transmit Delay The minimum transmit time between successive LLDPDUs.
Reintialization Delay The minimum time interval before the reinitialization of local port
objects between port status changes.
MIB Notification Interval The minimum time interval between consecutive notifications of local
system MIB change.
Fast Start Count Specifes the number of LLDPDUs to be sent as soon as a MED is
detected by system.
Management Address Type The type of management address used in LLDPDU.
Management IP Address The management IP address. This will be the Loopback0 IP address if
configured, otherwise it is the first IP interface configured on the
switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; Fast Start Count field added to output.

Related Commands

lldp destination mac-address Configures the fast start count for an LLDP Media Endpoint Device
(MED).The fast start count specifes the number of LLDPDUs to be sent
as soon as a MED is detected by the switch. The LLDPDUs contain the
LLDP MED Network Policy TLVs.
lldp reinit delay Sets the amount of time that must elapse before an LLDP port is re-ini-
tialized after the status for the port was disabled.
lldp transmit hold-multiplier Sets the transmit hold multiplier value. This value is used to calculate
the Time To Live (TTL) value that is advertised in an LLDPDU.
lldp transmit delay Sets the minimum amount of time that must elapse between successive
LLDPDUs that are transmitted as the result of a value or status change
in the LLDP local systems MIB.

MIB Objects
lldpLocalSystemData
lldpLocChassisIdSubtype
lldpLocChassisId
lldpLocSysName
lldpLocSysDesc
lldpLocSysCapSupported
lldpLocSysEnabled
lldpPortConfigTable
lldpMessageTxInterval
lldpMessageTXHoldMultiplier
lldpTxDelay
lldpReinitDelay
lldpNotificationInterval
lldpLocManAddrTable
lldpLocManAddrSubtype
lldpLocManAddr

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-37


802.1AB Commands

lldpXMedFastStartRepeatCount

page 8-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

show lldp local-port


Displays per port information.
show lldp [slot/port | slot] local-port

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.

Defaults
By default, a list of all lldp ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show lldp local-port
Local Slot 1/Port 1 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1001 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/1 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 2 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1002 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/2 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 3 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1003 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/3 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 4 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1004 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/4 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 5 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1005 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/5 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 6 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1006 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/6 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 7 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1007 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/7 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 8 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1008 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/8 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 9 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1009 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/9 6.3.1.636.R01,

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-39


802.1AB Commands

Local Slot 1/Port 10 LLDP Info:


Port ID = 1010 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/10 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 11 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1011 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/11 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 12 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1012 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/12 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 13 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1013 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/13 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 14 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1014 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/14 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 15 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1015 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/15 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 16 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1016 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/16 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 17 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1017 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/17 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 18 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1018 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/18 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 19 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1019 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/19 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 20 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1020 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/20 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 21 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1021 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/21 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 22 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1022 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/22 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 23 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1023 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/23 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 24 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1024 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 1/24 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 1/Port 25 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1025 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = ,
Local Slot 1/Port 26 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 1026 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = ,
Local Slot 2/Port 1 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2001 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/1 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 2 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2002 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/2 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 3 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2003 (Locally assigned),

page 8-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Port Description = Alcatel 2/3 6.3.1.636.R01,


Local Slot 2/Port 4 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2004 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/4 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 5 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2005 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/5 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 6 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2006 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/6 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 7 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2007 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/7 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 8 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2008 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/8 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 9 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2009 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/9 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 10 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2010 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/10 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 11 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2011 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/11 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 12 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2012 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/12 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 13 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2013 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/13 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 14 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2014 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/14 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 15 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2015 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/15 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 16 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2016 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/16 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 17 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2017 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/17 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 18 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2018 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/18 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 19 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2019 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/19 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 20 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2020 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/20 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 21 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2021 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/21 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 22 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2022 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/22 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 23 LLDP Info:

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-41


802.1AB Commands

Port ID = 2023 (Locally assigned),


Port Description = Alcatel 2/23 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 24 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2024 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/24 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 25 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2025 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/25 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 26 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2026 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/26 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 27 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2027 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/27 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 28 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2028 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/28 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 29 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2029 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/29 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 30 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2030 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/30 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 31 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2031 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/31 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 32 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2032 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/32 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 33 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2033 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/33 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 34 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2034 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/34 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 35 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2035 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/35 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 36 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2036 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/36 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 37 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2037 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/37 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 38 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2038 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/38 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 39 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2039 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/39 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 40 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2040 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/40 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 41 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2041 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/41 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 42 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2042 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/42 6.3.1.636.R01,

page 8-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

Local Slot 2/Port 43 LLDP Info:


Port ID = 2043 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/43 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 44 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2044 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/44 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 45 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2045 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/45 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 46 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2046 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/46 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 47 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2047 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/47 6.3.1.636.R01,
Local Slot 2/Port 48 LLDP Info:
Port ID = 2048 (Locally assigned),
Port Description = Alcatel 2/48 6.3.1.636.R01,

output definitions
Port ID The port ID (Port MAC).
Port Description The description of the port (which includes the port number and the
AOS version).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp tlv management Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be incor-
porated in the LLDPDUs.
lldp tlv dot1 Specifies the switch to control per port 802.1 TLVs to be incorporated
in the LLDPDUs.

MIB Objects
lldpLocPortTable
lldpLocPortNum
lldpLocPortIdsubtype
lldpLocPortId
lldpLocPortDesc

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-43


802.1AB Commands

show lldp local-management-address


Displays the local management address information.
show lldp local-management-address

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show lldp local-management-address
Local LLDP Agent Management Address:
Management Address Type = 1 (IPv4),
Management IP Address = 10.255.11.100

output definitions
Management Address Type The address type used to define the interface number (IPv4 or IPv6).
Management IP Address The management IP address. The loopback0 IP address is configured
for the management IP address to be transmitted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

lldp tlv management Specifies the switch to control per port management TLVs to be incor-
porated in the LLDPDUs.
show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpLocManAddrTable
lldpLocManAddrLen
lldpLocManAddrIfSubtype
lldpLocManAddrIfId

page 8-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

show lldp remote-system


Displays per local port and information of remote system.
show lldp [slot/port | slot] remote-system

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.

Defaults
By default, a list of all lldp ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show lldp remote-system
Remote LLDP Agents on Local Slot/Port: 2/47,
Chassis ID Subtype = 4 (MAC Address),
Chassis ID = 00:d0:95:e9:c9:2e,
Port ID Subtype = 7 (Locally assigned),
Port ID = 2048,
Port Description = (null),
System Name = (null),
System Description = (null),
Capabilites Supported = none supported,
Capabilites Enabled = none enabled,

Remote LLDP Agents on Local Slot/Port: 2/48,


Chassis ID Subtype = 4 (MAC Address),
Chassis ID = 00:d0:95:e9:c9:2e,
Port ID Subtype = 7 (Locally assigned),
Port ID = 2047,
Port Description = (null),
System Name = (null),
System Description = (null),
Capabilites Supported = none supported,
Capabilites Enabled = none enabled,

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-45


802.1AB Commands

output definitions
Remote LLDP Agents on Local The Slot number to which the remote system entry is associated and the
Slot/Port physical port number on that module.
Chassis ID Subtype The sub type that describes chassis ID.
Chassis ID The chassis ID (MAC address).
Port ID Subtype The sub type that describes port ID
Port ID The port ID (Port MAC).
Port Description The description of the port (which includes the port number and the
AOS version).
System Name The name of the system.
System Description The description of the system.
Capabilites Supported The capabilities of the system.
Capabilites Enabled The enabled capabilities of the system.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show lldp local -port Displays per port information.


show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

MIB Objects
lldpRemTable
lldpRemLocalPortNum
lldpRemChassisIdSubtype
lldpRemChassisId
lldpRemPortIdSubtype
lldpRemPortId
lldpRemPortDesc
lldpRemSysName
lldpRemSysDesc
lldpRemSysCapSupported
lldpRemSysCapEnabled
lldpRemManAddrIfSubtype
lldpRemManAddrIfId

page 8-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

show lldp remote-system med


Displays remote system MED information for a single port or all ports on a slot.
show lldp [slot/port | slot] remote-system [med {network-policy | inventory}]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
slot The slot number for a specific module.
network-policy Display network-policy TLVs from remote Endpoint Devices
inventory Display inventory management TLVs from remote Endpoint Devices

Defaults
By default, a list of all LLDP ports is displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot/port or slot parameter to display information for a specific port or for all ports on a specific
module.

Examples
-> show lldp 2/47 remote-system med network-policy
Slot/ Remote Application Unknown Tagged Vlan Layer2 DSCP
Port ID Type Policy Flag Flag Id Priority Value
------+------+---------------+-----------+---------+------+----------+------
1/22 1 Voice(01) Defined Untagged 345 4 34
1/22 2 Guest Voice(4) Defined Untagged 50 3 46

output definitions
Slot/Port The Slot number to which the remote system entry is associated and the
physical port number on that module.
Remote ID The Index of the Remote Device.
Application Type The Application type of the peer entity.
1. Voice
2. Voice Signaling
3. Guest Voice
4. Guest Voice Signaling
5. Softphone Voice
6. Video Conferencing
7. Streaming Video
8. Video Signaling

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-47


802.1AB Commands

output definitions (continued)


Unknown Policy Flag Whether the network policy for the specified application type is cur-
rently defined or unknown.
Tagged Flag Whether the specified application type is using a tagged or an
untagged VLAN.
VLAN ID The VLAN identifier (VID) for the port.
Layer 2 Priority Layer 2 priority to be used for the specified application type.
DSCP Value DSCP value to be used to provide Diffserv node behavior for the spec-
ified application type.

-> show lldp 2/47 remote-system med inventory


Remote LLDP Agents on Local Slot/Port 1/22:
Remote ID 1:
MED Hardware Revision = "1.2.12.3",
MED Firmware Revision = "6.3.4.1",
MED Software Revision = "4.2.1.11",
MED Serial Number = "32421",
MED Manufacturer Name = "Manufacturer1",
MED Model Name = "Alc32d21",
MED Asset ID = "124421",
Remote ID 2:
MED Hardware Revision = "1.2.12.4",
MED Firmware Revision = "6.3.4.2",
MED Software Revision = "4.2.1.13",
MED Serial Number = "32424",
MED Manufacturer Name = "Manufacturer2",
MED Model Name = "Alc32d41",
MED Asset ID = "124424",

output definitions
Remote ID The Index of the Remote Device.
MED Hardware Revision The Hardware Revision of the endpoint
MED Firmware Revision The Firmware Revision of the endpoint.
MED Software Revision The Software Revision of the endpoint.
MED Manufacturer Name The Manufacturer Name of the endpoint.
MED Model Name The Model Name of the endpoint.
MED Asset ID The Asset ID of the endpoint.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show lldp local -port Displays per port information.


show lldp local -system Displays local system information.

page 8-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1AB Commands

MIB Objects
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyTable
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyAppType
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyDscp
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyPriority
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyTagged
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyUnknown
lldpXMedRemMediaPolicyVlanID
lldpXMedRemInventoryTable
lldpXMedRemAssetID
lldpXMedRemFirmwareRev
lldpXMedRemHardwareRev
lldpXMedRemMfgName
lldpXMedRemModelName
lldpXMedRemSerialNum
lldpXMedRemSoftwareRev

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8-49


802.1AB Commands

page 8-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


9 Interswitch Protocol
Commands

Alcatel-Lucent Interswitch Protocols (AIP) are used to discover and advertise adjacent switch
information. Only one protocol is supported:
• Alcatel-Lucent Mapping Adjacency Protocol (AMAP), used to discover the topology of
OmniSwitches.
This chapter includes descriptions of AMAP commands.
MIB information for AMAP commands is as follows:
Filename: alcatelIND1InterswitchProtocol.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-INTERSWITCH-PROTOCOL-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

Mapping Adjacency Protocol amap


amap discovery time
amap common time
show amap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 9-1


Interswitch Protocol Commands

amap
Enables or disables the Alcatel-Lucent Mapping Adjacency Protocol (AMAP) on the switch. AMAP
discovers adjacent switches by sending and responding to Hello update packets on active Spanning Tree
ports.
amap {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables AMAP.
disable Disables AMAP.

Defaults
By default, AMAP is enabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Adjacent switches are defined as those having a Spanning Tree path between them and no other switch
between them on the same Spanning Tree path that has AMAP enabled.

Examples
-> amap disable
-> amap enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

amap discovery time Sets the discovery transmission time interval used by active Span-
ning Tree ports in the discovery transmission state.
amap common time Sets the common transmission time interval used by active Span-
ning Tree ports in the common transmission state.
show amap Displays adjacent switches and associated MAC addresses, ports,
VLANs, and IP addresses.

MIB Objects
aipAMAPstate

page 9-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Interswitch Protocol Commands

amap discovery time


Sets the discovery transmission time interval. In the discovery transmission state, an active port sends
AMAP Hello packets to detect adjacent switches. The discovery transmission time specifies the number of
seconds to wait between each Hello packet transmission.
amap discovery [time] seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Discovery transmission time value, in seconds (1–65535). Do not use
commas in the value.

Defaults
By default, the discovery transmission time is set to 30 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use of the time command keyword is optional.

• When AMAP is enabled, all active Spanning Tree ports start out in the discovery transmission state.

• Ports that receive Hello packets before three discovery transmission times expire, send a Hello reply
and transition to the common transmission state.
• Ports that do not receive Hello packets before three discovery transmission times expire, revert to the
passive reception state.
• Ports in the passive reception state do not send Hello packets and do not use any timer to determine
how long to wait for Hello packets.
• The discovery transmission time value is also used by ports in the common transmission state to deter-
mine how long to wait for Hello packets (see page 9-5).

Examples
-> amap discovery 1200
-> amap discovery time 600

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 9-3


Interswitch Protocol Commands

Related Commands

amap Enables (default) or disables AMAP on a switch.


amap common time Sets the common transmission time interval used by active Span-
ning Tree ports in the common transmission state.
show amap Displays adjacent switches and associated MAC addresses, ports,
VLANs, and IP addresses.

MIB Objects
aipAMAPdisctime

page 9-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Interswitch Protocol Commands

amap common time


Sets the common phase transmission time interval. In the common transmission state, an active port sends
AMAP Hello packets to determine adjacent switch failures and disconnects. The common transmission
time specifies the number of seconds to wait between each Hello packet transmission.
amap common [time] seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Common transmission time value in seconds (1–65535). Do not use
commas in the value.

Defaults
By default, the common transmission time is set to 300 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use of the time command keyword is optional.

• To avoid synchronization with adjacent switches, the common transmission time is jittered randomly
by plus or minus ten percent. For example, if the default time is used (300 seconds), the jitter is plus or
minus 30 seconds.
• The common transmission time value is only used by ports in the common transmission state.

• If a Hello packet is received from an adjacent switch before the common transmission time has
expired, the switch sends a Hello reply and restarts the common transmission timer.
• A port reverts to the discovery transmission state if a Hello response is not received after the discovery
time interval (see page 9-3) has expired.

Examples
-> amap common 1200
-> amap common time 600

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 9-5


Interswitch Protocol Commands

Related Commands

amap Enables (default) or disables AMAP on a switch.


amap discovery time Sets the discovery transmission time interval used by the active
Spanning Tree ports in the discovery transmission state.
show amap Displays adjacent switches and associated MAC addresses, ports,
VLANs, and IP addresses.

MIB Objects
aipAMAPcommontime

page 9-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Interswitch Protocol Commands

show amap
Displays adjacent switches and associated MAC addresses, ports, VLANs, IP addresses, and system
names.
show amap

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Remote switches that stop sending Hello packets and are connected to an AMAP switch via a hub may
take up to two times the common transmission time to age out of the AMAP database, and no longer
appear in this show command display.

Examples
-> show amap
AMAP is currently enabled,
AMAP Common Phase Timeout Interval (seconds) = 300,
AMAP Discovery Phase Timeout Interval (seconds) = 30

Remote Host Description = falconCmm


Remote Host Base MAC = 00:00:00:00:00:00
Local Interface = 1/2, VLAN = 200
Remote Interface = 3/1, VLAN = 200
Remote IP Address Configured = 1
2.0.0.10

Remote Host Description = falconCmm


Remote Host Base MAC = 00:d0:95:6b:09:40
Local Interface = 3/1, VLAN = 1
Remote Interface = 6/1, VLAN = 1
Remote IP Address Configured = 1
2.0.0.11

output definitions
AMAP is currently The AMAP status: enabled (default) or disabled. Use the amap com-
mand to change the AMAP status for the switch.
AMAP Common Phase Time- The number of seconds to wait between each Hello packet transmission
out Interval (seconds) during the common phase. Use the amap common time command to
change this value.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 9-7


Interswitch Protocol Commands

output definitions (continued)


AMAP Discovery Phase Time- The number of seconds to wait between each Hello packet transmission
out Interval (seconds) during the discovery phase. Use the amap discovery time command to
change this value.
Remote Host Description The system name for the adjacent switch.
Remote Host Base MAC The chassis base MAC address for the adjacent switch.
Local Interface The local switch port/VLAN that received the AMAP packet.
Remote Interface The adjacent switch port/VLAN that sent the AMAP packet.
Remote IP Address The number of IP addresses configured on the adjacent switch. The
Configured actual IP address values are listed below this field.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

amap Enables (default) or disables AMAP on a switch.


amap discovery time Sets the discovery transmission time interval used by active Span-
ning Tree ports in the discovery transmission state.
amap common time Sets the common transmission time interval used by the active
Spanning Tree ports in the common transmission state.

page 9-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


10 IP Commands

This chapter details Internet Protocol (IP) commands for the switch. IP is a network-layer (Layer 3) proto-
col that contains addressing information and some control information that enables packets to be
forwarded. IP is documented in RFC 791 and is the primary network-layer protocol in the Internet proto-
col suite. Along with the Transmission Control Protocol (TCP), IP represents the heart of the Internet
protocols.
IP is enabled on the switch by default and there are few options that can, or need to be, configured. This
chapter provides instructions for basic IP configuration commands. It also includes commands for several
Layer 3 and Layer 4 protocols that are associated with IP:
• Address Resolution Protocol (ARP)—Used to match the IP address of a device with its physical
(MAC) address.
• Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP)—Specifies the generation of error messages, test packets,
and informational messages related to IP. ICMP supports the ping command used to determine if hosts
are online.
• Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)—A major data transport mechanism that provides reliable,
connection-oriented, full-duplex data streams. While the role of TCP is to add reliability to IP, TCP
relies upon IP to do the actual delivering of datagrams.
• User Datagram Protocol (UDP)—A secondary transport-layer protocol that uses IP for delivery. UDP
is not connection-oriented and does not provide reliable end-to-end delivery of datagrams. But some
applications can safely use UDP to send datagrams that do not require the extra overhead added by
TCP.
The IP commands also include protection from Denial of Service (DoS) attacks. The goal of this feature is
to protect a switch from well-known DoS attacks and to notify the administrator or manager when an
attack is underway. Also, notifications can be sent when port scans are being performed.

Note. Packets can be forwarded using IP if all devices are on the same VLAN, or if IP interfaces are
created on multiple VLANs to enable routing of packets. However, IP routing requires the Routing Infor-
mation Protocol (RIP). See Chapter 12, “RIP Commands,” for the appropriate CLI commands. For more
information on VLANs and RIP, see the applicable chapter(s) in the OmniSwitch Network Configuration
Guide.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-1


IP Commands

MIB information for the IP commands is as follows:


Filename: IpForward.mib
Module: IpForward
Filename: Ip.mib
Module: Ip
Filename: AlcatelIND1Ip.mib
Module: alcatelIND1IPMIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1Iprm.mib
Module: alcatelIND1IPRMMIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

IP ip interface
ip interface dhcp-client
ip router primary-address
ip router router-id
ip static-route
ip route-pref
ip default-ttl
ping
traceroute
ip directed-broadcast
ip service
show ip traffic
show ip interface
show ip route
show ip route-pref
show ip redist
show ip access-list
show ip route-map
show ip router database
show ip config
show ip protocols
show ip service
IP Route Map Redistribution ip redist
ip access-list
ip access-list address
ip route-map action
ip route-map match ip address
ip route-map match ipv6 address
ip route-map match ip-nexthop
ip route-map match ipv6-nexthop
ip route-map match tag
ip route-map match ipv4-interface
ip route-map match ipv6-interface
ip route-map match metric
ip route-map set metric
ip route-map set tag
ip route-map set ip-nexthop
ip route-map set ipv6-nexthop
show ip redist
show ip access-list
show ip route-map

page 10-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ARP arp
clear arp-cache
ip dos arp-poison restricted-address
arp filter
clear arp filter
show arp
show arp filter
show ip dos arp-poison
ICMP icmp type
icmp unreachable
icmp echo
icmp timestamp
icmp addr-mask
icmp messages
show icmp control
show icmp statistics
TCP show tcp statistics
show tcp ports
UDP show udp statistics
show udp ports
Denial of Service (DoS) ip dos scan close-port-penalty
ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty
ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty
ip dos scan threshold
ip dos trap
ip dos scan decay
show ip dos config
show ip dos statistics

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-3


IP Commands

ip interface
Configures an IP interface to enable IP routing on a VLAN. Without an IP interface, traffic is bridged
within the VLAN or across connections to the same VLAN on other switches.
ip interface name [address ip_address] [mask subnet_mask] [admin [enable | disable]] [vlan vid]
[forward | no forward] [local-proxy-arp | no local-proxy-arp] [eth2 | snap] [primary | no primary]
no ip interface name

Syntax Definitions
name Text string up to 20 characters. Use quotes around string if description
contains multiple words with spaces between them (e.g. “Alcatel-Lucent
Marketing”). Note that this value is case sensitive.
ip_address An IP host address (e.g. 10.0.0.1, 171.15.0.20) to specify the IP router
network.
subnet_mask A valid IP address mask (e.g., 255.0.0.0, 255.255.0.0) to identify the IP
subnet for the interface.
enable Enables the administrative status for the IP interface.
disable Disables the administrative status for the IP interface.
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
forward Enables forwarding of IP frames to other subnets.
no forward Disables forwarding of IP frames. The router interface still receives
frames from other hosts on the same subnet.
local-proxy-arp Enables Local Proxy ARP on the specified interface.
no local-proxy-arp Disables Local Proxy ARP on the specified interface.
eth2 Specifies Ethernet-II encapsulation.
snap SNAP encapsulation.
primary Designates the specified IP interface as the primary interface for the
VLAN.
no primary Removes the configured primary IP interface designation for the VLAN.
The first interface bound to the VLAN becomes the primary by default.

page 10-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Defaults

parameter default
ip_address 0.0.0.0
subnet_mask IP address class
enable | disable enable
vid none (unbound)
forward | no forward forward
local-proxy-arp | no local-proxy-arp no local-proxy-arp
eth2 | snap eth2
primary | no primary First interface bound
to a VLAN.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IP interface.

• IP multinetting is supported. As a result, it is possible to configure up to eight IP interfaces per VLAN.


Each interface is configured with a different subnet, thus allowing traffic from each configured subnet
to coexist on the same VLAN.
• Note that when Local Proxy ARP is enabled for any one IP router interface associated with a VLAN,
the feature is applied to the entire VLAN. It is not necessary to enable it for each interface. However, if
the IP interface that has this feature enabled is moved to another VLAN, Local Proxy ARP is enabled
for the new VLAN and must be enabled on another interface for the old VLAN.
• When Local Proxy ARP is enabled, all traffic is routed instead of bridged within the VLAN. ARP
requests return the MAC address of the IP router interface. Note that the same MAC address is
assigned to each interface configured for a VLAN.
• Local Proxy ARP takes precedence over any switch-wide ARP or Proxy ARP function. It is not neces-
sary to have Proxy ARP configured in order to use Local Proxy ARP. The two features are indepen-
dent of each other.
• By default, the first interface bound to a VLAN becomes the primary interface for that VLAN. Use the
primary keyword with this command to configure a different IP interface as the primary.
• To create an IP interface for network management purposes, specify Loopback0 (case sensitive) as the
name of the interface. The Loopback0 interface is not bound to any VLAN, so it will always remain
operationally active.

Examples
-> ip interface “Marketing”
-> ip interface “Payroll address” 18.12.6.3 vlan 255
-> ip interface “Human Resources” 10.200.12.101 vlan 500 no forward snap
-> ip interface “Distribution” 11.255.14.102 vlan 500 local-proxy-arp primary

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-5


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip interface Displays the status and configuration of IP interfaces.

MIB Objects
alaIpInterfaceTable
alaIpInterfaceName
alaIpInterfaceAddress
alaIpInterfaceMask
alaIpInterfaceAdminState
alaIpInterfaceDeviceType
alaIpInterfaceVlanID
alaIpInterfaceIpForward
alaIpInterfaceEncap
alaIpInterfaceLocalProxyArp
alaIpInterfacePrimCfg
alaIpInterfaceOperState
alaIpInterfaceOperReason
alaIpInterfaceRouterMac
alaIpInterfaceBcastAddr
alaIpInterfacePrimAct

page 10-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip interface dhcp-client
Configures a DHCP client IP interface that is to be assigned an IP address from a DHCP server.
ip interface dhcp-client [vlan vid] [release | renew] [option-60 opt60_string] [admin {enable |
disable}]
no ip interface dhcp-client

Syntax Definitions
dhcp-client Reserved IP interface name indicating this interface should use DHCP
to obtain an IP address from a DHCP server.
vid An existing VLAN ID number (1–4094).
release Releases the DHCP server assigned IP address.
renew Renews the DHCP server assigned IP address.
opt60_string The option-60 field value to be included in DHCP discover/request
packets.
enable Enables the administrative status for the IP interface.
disable Disables the administrative status for the IP interface.

Defaults

parameter default
opt60_string OmniSwitch-6450
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the dhcp-client IP interface.

• Only one DHCP client IP interface can be assigned per switch but it can belong to any VLAN and any
VRF instance.
• If the system name has not been configured, it will be updated using the option-12 field. If the option-
12 string is greater than 19 characters the remaining characters will be truncated.
• The minimum lease time accecpted on the dhcp-client interface is 5 minutes.

Examples
-> ip interface dhcp-client vlan 100
-> ip interface dhcp-client admin enable
-> ip interface dhcp-client release

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-7


IP Commands

-> ip interface dhcp-client renew


-> ip interface dhcp-client option-60 OmniSwitch
-> no ip interface dhcp-client

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip interface Displays the status and configuration of IP interfaces.

MIB Objects
alaIpInterfaceTable
alaIpInterfaceDhcpStatus
alaIpInterfaceDhcpIpRelease
alaIpInterfaceDhcpIpRenew
alaIpInterfaceDhcpOption60String

page 10-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip router primary-address
Configures the router primary IP address. By default, the router primary address is derived from the first
IP interface that becomes operational on the router.
ip router primary-address ip_address

Syntax Definitions
ip_address 32-bit IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The router primary address should be a valid IP unicast host address.

• The router primary IP address is used by BGP to derive its unique BGP Identifier, if the router
router-id is not a valid IP unicast address.
• It is recommended that the primary address be explicitly configured on dual CMM chassis or stacked
routers.

Examples
-> ip router primary-address 172.22.2.115

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip router router-id Configures the router ID for the router.

MIB Objects
alaDcrTmConfig
alaDrcTmIpRouterPrimaryAddress

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-9


IP Commands

ip router router-id
Configures the router ID for the router. By default, the router primary address of the router is used as the
router ID. However, if a primary address has not been explicitly configured, the router ID defaults to the
address of the first IP interface that becomes operational.
ip router router-id ip_address

Syntax Definitions
ip_address 32-bit IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The router ID can be any 32-bit number.

• If the router ID is not a valid IP unicast host address, the BGP identifier is derived from the router
primary address.
• It is recommended that the router ID be explicitly configured on dual CMM chassis or stacked routers.

Examples
-> ip router router-id 172.22.2.115

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip router primary-address Configures the router primary IP address.

MIB Objects
alaDcrTmConfig
alaDrcTmIpRouterId

page 10-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip static-route
Creates/deletes an IP static route. Static routes are user-defined; they carry a higher priority than routes
created by dynamic routing protocols. That is, static routes always have priority over dynamic routes,
regardless of the metric value.
ip static-route ip_address [mask mask] gateway gateway [metric metric]
no ip static-route ip_address [mask mask] gateway ip_address [metric metric]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address Destination IP address of the static route.
mask Subnet mask corresponding to the destination IP address.
gateway ip_address IP address of the next hop used to reach the destination IP address.
metric Metric or cost (hop count) for the static route. You can set a priority for
the static route by assigning a metric value. The lower the metric value,
the higher the priority. Valid range is 1–15.

Defaults

parameter default
metric 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Static routes do not age out of the routing tables; however, they can be deleted. Use the no form of this
command to delete a static route.
• A static route is not active unless the gateway it is using is active.

• The subnet mask is not required if you want to use the natural subnet mask. By default, the switch
imposes a natural mask on the IP address.
• Use the ip static-route command to configure default route. For example, to create a default route
through gateway 171.11.2.1, you would enter: ip static-route 0.0.0.0 mask 0.0.0.0 gateway
171.11.2.1.

Examples
-> ip static-route 171.11.1.1 gateway 171.11.2.1
-> ip static-route 0.0.0.0 mask 0.0.0.0 gateway 171.11.2.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-11


IP Commands

Related Commands

show ip route Displays the IP Forwarding table.


show ip router database Displays the IP router database contents.

MIB Objects
alaIprmStaticRoute
alaIprmStaticRouteDest
alaIprmStaticRouteMask
alaIprmStaticRouteNextHop
alaIprmStaticRouteMetric
alaIprmStaticRouteStatus

page 10-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip route-pref
Configures the route preference of a router.
ip route-pref {static | rip | ebgp | ibgp} value

Syntax Definitions
static Configures the route preference of static routes.
rip Configures the route preference of RIP routes.
ebgp Configures the route preference of external BGP routes.
ibgp Configures the route preference of internal BGP routes.
value Route preference value.

Defaults

parameter default
static value 2
rip value 120
ebgp value 190
ibgp value 200

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Route preference of local routes cannot be changed.

Examples
-> ip route-pref ebgp 20
-> ip route-pref rip 60

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-13


IP Commands

Related Commands

show ip route-pref Displays the configured route-preference of a router.

MIB Objects
alaIprmRtPrefTable
alaIprmRtPrefLocal
alaIprmRtPrefStatic
alaIprmRtPrefRip
alaIprmRtPrefEbgp
alaIprmRtPrefIbgp

page 10-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip default-ttl
Configures the Time To Live value (TTL) for IP packets. The TTL value is the maximum number of hops
an IP packet will travel before being discarded.
ip default-ttl hops

Syntax Definitions
hops TTL value, in hops. Valid range is 1–255.

Defaults

parameter default
hops 64

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This value represents the default value inserted into the TTL field of the IP header for datagrams originat-
ing from this switch whenever a TTL value is not supplied by the transport layer protocol.

Examples
-> ip default-ttl 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip config Displays IP configuration parameters.

MIB Objects
IpDefaultTTL

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-15


IP Commands

ping
Tests whether an IP destination can be reached from the local switch. This command sends an ICMP echo
request to a destination and then waits for a reply. To ping a destination, enter the ping command and
enter either the destination’s IP address or hostname. The switch will ping the destination using the default
frame count, packet size, interval, and timeout parameters (6 frames, 64 bytes, 1 second, and 5 seconds
respectively). You can also customize any or all of these parameters as described below.
ping {ip_address | hostname} [count count] [size packet_size] [interval seconds] [timeout seconds]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP address of the system to ping.
hostname DNS name of the system to ping.
count Number of frames to be transmitted.
packet_size Size of the data portion of the packet sent for this ping, in bytes. Valid
range is 1–60000.
interval seconds Polling interval. The switch will poll the host at time intervals specified
in seconds.
timeout seconds Number of seconds the program will wait for a response before timing
out.

Defaults

parameter default
count 6
packet_size 64
interval seconds 1
timeout seconds 5

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you change the default values they will only apply to the current ping. The next time you use the ping
command, the default values will be used unless you again enter different values.

page 10-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Examples
-> ping 10.255.11.242

PING 10.255.11.242: 56 data bytes


64 bytes from 10.255.11.242: icmp_seq=0. time=0. ms
64 bytes from 10.255.11.242: icmp_seq=1. time=0. ms
64 bytes from 10.255.11.242: icmp_seq=2. time=0. ms
64 bytes from 10.255.11.242: icmp_seq=3. time=0. ms
64 bytes from 10.255.11.242: icmp_seq=4. time=0. ms
64 bytes from 10.255.11.242: icmp_seq=5. time=0. ms
----10.255.11.242 PING Statistics----
6 packets transmitted, 6 packets received, 0% packet loss
round-trip (ms) min/avg/max = 0/0/0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
traceroute Finds the path taken by an IP packet from the local switch to a
specified destination.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-17


IP Commands

traceroute
Finds the path taken by an IP packet from the local switch to a specified destination. This command
displays the individual hops to the destination as well as some timing information.
traceroute {ip_address | hostname} [max-hop max_hop_count]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP address of the host whose route you want to trace.
hostname DNS name of the host whose route you want to trace.
max_hop_value Maximum hop count for the trace.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When using this command, you must enter the name of the destination as part of the command line
(either the IP address or host name).
• Use the optional max-hop parameter to set a maximum hop count to the destination. If the trace
reaches this maximum hop count without reaching the destination, the trace stops.

Examples
-> traceroute 128.251.17.224

traceroute to 128.251.17.224, 30 hops max, 40 byte packets


1 10.255.11.254 0 ms 0 ms 0 ms
2 172.23.0.251 0 ms 16.6667 ms 0 ms
3 128.251.14.253 0 ms 0 ms 0 ms
4 128.251.17.224 0 ms 0 ms 0 ms

-> traceroute 128.251.17.224 max-hop 3


traceroute to 128.251.17.224, 3 hops max, 40 byte packets
1 10.255.11.254 0 ms 0 ms 0 ms
2 172.23.0.251 16.6667 ms 0 ms 0 ms
3 128.251.14.253 0 ms 0 ms 0 ms

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands
show ip route Displays the IP Forwarding table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-19


IP Commands

ip directed-broadcast
Enables or disables IP directed broadcasts routed through the switch. An IP directed broadcast is an IP
datagram that has all zeros or all 1’s in the host portion of the destination address. The packet is sent to the
broadcast address of a subnet to which the sender is not directly attached.
ip directed-broadcast {on | off}

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
The default value is off.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Directed broadcasts are used in denial-of-service “smurf” attacks. In a smurf attack, a continuous stream of
ping requests are sent from a falsified source address to a directed broadcast address, resulting in a large
stream of replies, which can overload the host of the source address. By default, the switch drops directed
broadcasts. Typically, directed broadcasts should not be enabled.

Examples
-> ip directed-broadcast off

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip interface Displays the status and configuration of IP interfaces.
show ip route Displays the IP Forwarding table.
show ip config Displays IP configuration parameters.

MIB Objects
alaIpDirectedBroadcast

page 10-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip service
Enables (opens) or disables (closes) well-known TCP/UDP service ports (i.e., SSH, telnet, FTP, etc.).
Selectively enabling or disabling these types of ports provides an additional method for protecting against
denial of service (DoS) attacks.
ip service {all | service_name | port service_port}
no ip service {all | service_name | port service_port}

Syntax Definitions
all Configures access to all TCP/UDP ports.
service_name The name of the TCP/UDP service to enable or disable. (Refer to the
table in the “Usage Guidelines” section below for a list of supported
service names.)
service_port A TCP/UDP service port number. Configures access by port number
rather than by service name. (Refer to the table in the “Usage Guide-
lines” section below for a list of supported service names.)

Defaults
All TCP/UDP ports are open by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command only applies to TCP/UDP service ports opened by default. It does not affect ports that
are opened by applications, such as RIP, BGP, etc.
• Use the all option with this command to configure access to all well-known TCP/UDP service ports.

• To designate which port to enable or disable, specify either the name of a service or the well-known
port number associated with that service. Note that specifying a name and a port number in a single
command line is not supported.
• When using service names, it is possible to specify more than one service in a single command line by
entering each service name separated by a space. See the examples below.
• When specifying a service port number, note that the port keyword is required and that only one port
number is allowed in a single command.
• The following table lists the ip service command options for specifying TCP/UDP services and also
includes the well-known port number associated with each service:

service name port Status


ftp 21 enabled
ssh 22 enabled

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-21


IP Commands

service name port Status


telnet 23 enabled
udp-relay 67 enabled
http 80 enabled
network-time 123 enabled
snmp 161 enabled
secure-http 443 enabled

Examples
-> ip service all
-> ip service ftp telnet snmp
-> ip service port 1024
-> no ip service ftp snmp
-> no ip service all

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip service Displays a list of all well-known TCP/UDP ports and their current
status (enabled or disabled).

MIB Objects
alaIpServiceTable
alaIpServiceType
alaIpServicePort
alaIpServiceStatus
alaIpPortServiceTable
alaIpPortServicePort
alaIpPortServiceStatus

page 10-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip redist
Controls the conditions for redistributing IPv4 routes between different protocols.
ip redist {local | static | rip} into {rip} route-map route-map-name [status {enable | disable}]
no ip redist {local | static | rip} into {rip} [route-map route-map-name]

Syntax Definitions
local Redistributes local routes.
static Redistributes static routes.
rip Specifies RIP as the source or destination (into) protocol.
route-map-name Name of an existing route map that will control the redistribution of
routes between the source and destination protocol.
enable Enables the administrative status of the redistribution configuration.
disable Disables the administrative status of the redistribution configuration.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a route map redistribution configuration. Note that if a
route map name is not specified, all route maps associated with the redistribution configuration are
removed.
• The source and destination protocols must be loaded and enabled before redistribution occurs.

• If the metric calculated for the redistributed route, as described above, is greater than 15
(RIP_UNREACHABLE) or greater than the metric of an existing pure RIP route, the new route is not
redistributed.
• Use the ip route-map commands described in this chapter to create a route map. Refer to the “Config-
uring IP” chapter in the OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide for more information about how to
create a route map.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-23


IP Commands

Examples
-> ip redist rip into static route-map rip-to-static1
-> ip redist rip into static route-map rip-to-static2
-> no ip redist rip into static route-map rip-to-static2
-> ip redist static into rip route-map static-to-rip
-> ip redist static into rip route-map static-to-rip disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip redist Displays the route map redistribution configuration.


ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapRedistProtoTable
alaRouteMapRedistSrcProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistDestProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapRedistStatus
alaRouteMapRedistAddressType
alaRouteMapRedistRowStatus

page 10-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip access-list
Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv4 addresses to route maps.
ip access-list access-list-name
no ip access-list access-list-name

Syntax Definitions
access-list-name Name of the access list (up to 20 characters).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to delete the access list.

Examples
-> ip access-list access1
-> no ip access-list access1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip access-list address Adds IPv4 addresses to the specified IPv4 access list.
show ip access-list Displays the details of the access list.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapAccessListNameTable
alaRouteMapAccessListName
alaRouteMapAccessListNameIndex
alaRouteMapAccessListNameAddressType
alaRouteMapAccessListNameRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-25


IP Commands

ip access-list address
Adds multiple IPv4 addresses to the specified IPv4 access list.
ip access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen [action {permit | deny}]
[redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}]
no ip access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen

Syntax Definitions
access-list-name Name of the access list.
address/prefixLen IP address/prefix length to be added to the access list.
permit Permits the IP address for redistribution.
deny Denies the IP address for redistribution.
all-subnets Redistributes or denies all the subnet routes that match the network
portion of the IP address as specified by the mask length
no-subnets Redistributes or denies only those routes that exactly match the IP
address and the mask length.
aggregate Redistributes an aggregate route if there are one or more routes that
match or are subnets of this address.

Defaults

parameter default
permit | deny permit
all-subnets | no-subnets | all-subnets
aggregate

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the address from the access list.

• The access-list-name should exist before you add multiple addresses to it.

• The action parameters (permit and deny) determine if a route that matches the redist-control configu-
ration for the IP address is allowed or denied redistribution.
• The redist-control parameters (all-subnets, no-subnets, and aggregate) defines the criteria used to
determine if a route matches an address in the access list.
• Note that configuring the combination of redist-control aggregate with action deny is not allowed.

• Use this command multiple times with the same access list name to add multiple addresses to the exist-
ing access list.

page 10-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Examples
-> ip access-list access1 address 10.0.0.0/8 action permit
-> ip access-list access1 address 11.1.0.0/16 action permit
-> ip access-list access1 address 10.1.1.0/24 redist-control aggregate
-> no ip access-list access1 address 10.0.0.0/8

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip access-list Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv4 addresses to route maps.
show ip access-list Displays the contents of an IPv4 access list.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapAccessListTable
alaRouteMapAccessListIndex
alaRouteMapAccessListAddress
alaRouteMapAccessListAddressType
alaRouteMapAccessListPrefixLength
alaRouteMapAccessListAction
alaRouteMapAccessListRedistControl
alaRouteMapAccessListRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-27


IP Commands

ip route-map action
Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route map to permit or deny.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] action {permit | deny}
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number]

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
permit Permits route redistribution.
deny Denies route redistribution.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50
permit | deny permit

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the entire route map by specifying only the route-map-
name.
• Use the no form of this command to delete a specific sequence in the route map by specifying the
sequence-number.
• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• Use this command to change the status of an existing route map to permit or deny.

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 action permit
-> no ip route-map route1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands

show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapSequenceTable
alaRouteMapSequenceIndex
alaRouteMapSequenceNumber
alaRouteMapSequenceAction
alaRouteMapSequenceRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-29


IP Commands

ip route-map match ip address


Matches the route with the specified IPv4 address or an address defined in the specified IPv4 access list.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ip-address {access-list-name |
ip_address/prefixLen [redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}] [permit | deny]
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ip-address {access-list-name |
ip_address/prefixLen [redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}] [permit | deny]

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
access-list-name The name of an IPv4 access list that contains IPv4 addresses to match.
ip_address/prefixLen The destination IP address along with the prefix length of the routes to
be redistributed.
all-subnets Redistributes all the subnet routes that match the network portion of the
IP address as specified by the mask length.
no-subnets Redistributes only those routes that exactly match the IP address and the
mask length.
aggregate Redistributes an aggregate route if there are one or more routes that
match the IP address.
permit Permits a route based on the IP address or prefix constrained by redist-
control.
deny Denies a route based on the IP address or prefix constrained by redist-
control.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50
permit | deny permit

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match ip-address redist-control parameter in the route
map.
• Specify either the name of an existing IPv4 access list or an IPv4 address/prefix length with this
command.

page 10-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

• Note that configuring the combination of redist-control aggregate with deny is not allowed.

• Multiple addresses in the same route map sequence are matched using the longest prefix match.

• If the best matching address is type deny, then the route is not redistributed. If the best matching
address is type permit and the route map action is deny, the route is not redistributed.
• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name, sequence-number, and access-list-name (if used) should exist before you
configure this match criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map 3 match ip-address 10.1.1.1/8 redist-control no-subnets deny
-> no ip route-map 3 match ip-address 10.1.1.1 redist-control no-subnets deny
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ip-address list1
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ip-address list1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
ip access-list Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv4 addresses to route maps.
ip access-list address Adds IPv4 addresses to the specified IPv4 access list.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-31


IP Commands

ip route-map match ipv6 address


Matches the route with the specified IPv6 address or an address defined in the specified IPv6 access list.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-address {access-list-name |
ipv6_address/prefixLen [redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}] [permit | deny]
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-address ipv6_address/prefix-
Len [redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}] [permit | deny]

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
access-list-name The name of an IPv4 access list that contains IPv4 addresses to match.
ipv6_address/prefixLen The destination IPv6 address along with the prefix length of the routes
to be redistributed.
all-subnets Redistributes all the subnet routes that match the network portion of the
IP address as specified by the mask length.
no-subnets Redistributes only those routes that exactly match the IP address and the
mask length.
aggregate Redistributes an aggregate route if there are one or more routes that
match the IPv6 address.
permit Permits a route based on the IPv6 address or prefix constrained by
redist-control.
deny Denies a route based on the IPv6 address or prefix constrained by redist-
control.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50
permit | deny permit

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match ipv6-address redist-control parameter in the
route map.
• Specify either the name of an existing IPv6 access list or an IPv6 address/prefix length with this
command.

page 10-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

• Note that configuring the combination of redist-control aggregate with deny is not allowed.

• Multiple addresses in the same route map sequence are matched using the longest prefix match.

• If the best matching address is type deny, then the route is not redistributed. If the best matching
address is type permit and the route map action is deny, the route is not redistributed.
• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this match criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map 3 match ipv6-address 2001::1/64 redist-control no-subnets deny
-> no ip route-map 3 match ipv6-address 2001::1/64 redist-control no-subnets deny
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-address list1
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-address list1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
ipv6 access-list Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv6 addresses to route maps.
ipv6 access-list address Adds IPv6 addresses to the specified IPv6 access list.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-33


IP Commands

ip route-map match ip-nexthop


Matches any routes that have a next-hop router address permitted by the specified access list name or the
IP address specified in the route map.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ip-nexthop
{access-list-name | ip_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]}
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ip-nexthop
{access-list-name | ip_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]}

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
access-list-name The access list that matches the route nexthop IP address.
ip_address/prefixLen The IP address along with the prefix length that matches any nexthop IP
address within the specified subnet.
permit Permits a route based on the IP nexthop.
deny Denies a route based on the IP nexthop.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50
permit | deny permit

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match ip-nexthop parameter in the route map.

• If the best matching nexthop is type deny, then the route is not redistributed. If the best matching
nexthop is type permit and the route map action is deny, the route is not redistributed.
• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name, sequence-number, and access-list-name should exist before you configure this
match criteria.

page 10-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ip-nexthop list1
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ip-nexthop list1
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ip-nexthop 10.0.0.0/8
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ip-nexthop 10.0.0.0/8

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip access-list Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv4 addresses to route maps.
ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-35


IP Commands

ip route-map match ipv6-nexthop


Matches any routes that have an IPv6 next-hop router address permitted by the specified access list name
or the IPv6 address specified in the route map.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-nexthop
{access-list-name | ipv6_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]}
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-nexthop
{access-list-name | ipv6_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]}

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
access-list-name The access list that matches the route nexthop IPv6 address.
ipv6_address/prefixLen The IPv6 address along with the prefix length that matches any nexthop
IPv6 address within the specified subnet.
permit Permits a route based on the IPv6 nexthop.
deny Denies a route based on the IPv6 nexthop.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50
permit | deny permit

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match ipv6-nexthop parameter in the route map.

• If the best matching nexthop is type deny, then the route is not redistributed. If the best matching
nexthop is type permit but the route map action is deny, the route is not redistributed.
• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name, sequence-number, and access-list-name should exist before you configure this
match criteria.

page 10-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-nexthop list1
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-nexthop list1
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-nexthop 2001::/64
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-nexthop 2001::/64

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 access-list Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv6 addresses to route maps.
ipv6 access-list address Adds IPv6 addresses to the specified IPv6 access list.
ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-37


IP Commands

ip route-map match tag


Matches the tag value specified in the route map with the one that the routing protocol learned the route
on.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match tag tag-number
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match tag tag-number

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
tag-number The tag number.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match tag parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this match criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match tag 4
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match tag 4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

page 10-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-39


IP Commands

ip route-map match ipv4-interface


Matches the IPv4 interface name specified in the route map with the one that the routing protocol learned
the route on.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv4-interface interface-name
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv4-interface interface-name

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
interface-name Specifies the interface name of the route’s outgoing interface.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match ipv4-interface parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this match criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv4-interface int4
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv4-interface int4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

page 10-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-41


IP Commands

ip route-map match ipv6-interface


Matches the IPv6 interface name specified in the route map with the one that the routing protocol learned
the route on.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-interface interface-name
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-interface interface-name

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
interface-name Specifies the interface name of the route’s outgoing interface.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match ipv6-interface parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this match criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-interface int6
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match ipv6-interface int6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

page 10-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-43


IP Commands

ip route-map match metric


Matches the metric value specified in the route map with the actual metric value of the route.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match metric metric [deviation deviation]
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match metric metric
[deviation deviation]

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
metric The metric value that matches a specified metric.
deviation The deviation value. If deviation is included, the route metric can have
any value within the range (metric-deviation to metric+deviation).

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the match metric parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this match criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match metric 4
-> no ip route-map route1 sequence-number 10 match metric 4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-45


IP Commands

ip route-map set metric


Configures the metric value of the route being distributed.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set metric metric
[effect {add | subtract | replace | none}]
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set metric metric
[effect {add | subtract | replace | none}]

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
metric Configures the metric value of the route being distributed. A value of 0
is not allowed.
add Adds the configured metric value to the actual metric value.
subtract Subtracts the configured metric value from the actual metric value.
replace Replaces the actual metric value with the configured metric value.
none Redistributes the actual metric value. The configured metric value is
ignored. Use any value except 0.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the set metric parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this set criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map 111 sequence-number 50 set metric 30 effect add
-> no ip route-map 111 sequence-number 50 set metric 30 effect add

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-47


IP Commands

ip route-map set tag


Configures the tag value of the route being distributed.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set tag tag-number
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set tag tag-number

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
tag-number Configures the tag number.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the set tag parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this set criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map 111 sequence-number 50 set tag 23
-> no ip route-map 111 sequence-number 50 set tag 23

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

page 10-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-49


IP Commands

ip route-map set ip-nexthop


Configures the IP address of the next hop in a route map.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ip-nexthop ip_address
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ip-nexthop ip_address

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
ip_address IP address of the next hop.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the set ip-nexthop parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this set criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map 222 sequence-number 50 set ip-nexthop 128.251.17.224
-> no ip route-map 222 sequence-number 50 set ip-nexthop 128.251.17.224

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaIPRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-51


IP Commands

ip route-map set ipv6-nexthop


Configures the IPv6 address of the next hop in a route map.
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ipv6-nexthop ipv6_address
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ipv6-nexthop ipv6_address

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the route map (up to 20 characters).
number A number that links together the route maps. The range is 1–100.
ipv6_address IPv6 address of the next hop.

Defaults

parameter default
number 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the set ipv6-nexthop parameter in the route map.

• All route maps having the same name but different sequence numbers are linked together and
processed in order of increasing sequence number.
• The route-map-name and sequence-number should exist before you configure this set criteria.

Examples
-> ip route-map 222 sequence-number 50 set ipv6-nexthop 2001::1
-> no ip route-map 222 sequence-number 50 set ipv6-nexthop 2001::1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands

ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of the route
map to permit or deny.
show ip route-map Displays the configured IP route maps.

MIB Objects
alaIPRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-53


IP Commands

arp
Adds a permanent entry to the ARP table. To forward packets, the switch dynamically builds an ARP
Table to match the IP address of a device with its physical (MAC) address. These entries age out of the
table when the timeout value is exceeded. This command is used to add a permanent entry to the table.
Permanent entries do not age out of the table.
arp ip_address hardware_address [alias]
no arp ip_address [alias]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP address of the device you are adding to the ARP table.
hardware_address MAC address of the device in hexadecimal format (e.g.,
00.00.39.59.f1.0c).
alias Specifies that the switch will act as an alias (or proxy) for this IP
address. When the alias option is used, the switch responds to all ARP
requests for the specified IP address with its own MAC address.
You can also enable the proxy feature for an IP interface using the ip
interface command. When enabled, ARP requests return the MAC
address of the IP router interface and all traffic within the VLAN is
routed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a permanent ARP entry.

• Note that using the arp alias command is not related to proxy ARP as defined in RFC 925. Instead,
arp alias is similar to the Local Proxy ARP feature, except that it is used to configure the switch as a
proxy for only one IP address.
• Because most hosts support the use of address resolution protocols to determine cache address informa-
tion (called dynamic address resolution), you generally do not need to specify permanent ARP cache
entries.
• Only the IP address is required when deleting an ARP entry from the table.

Examples
-> arp 171.11.1.1 00:05:02:c0:7f:11

page 10-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
clear arp-cache Deletes all dynamic entries from the ARP table.
ip interface Enables or disables the Local Proxy ARP feature for an IP inter-
face. When enabled, all traffic within the VLAN is routed. ARP
requests return the MAC address of the IP router interface.
show arp Displays the ARP table.

MIB Objects
ipNetToMediaTable
ipNetToMediaIfIndex
ipNetToMediaNetAddress
ipNetToMediaPhyAddress
ipNetToMediaType
alaIpNetToMediaTable
alaIpNetToMediaPhyAddress
alaIpNetToMediaProxy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-55


IP Commands

clear arp-cache
Deletes all dynamic entries from the ARP table.
clear arp-cache

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This commands only clears dynamic entries. If permanent entries have been added to the table, they
must be removed using the no form of the ip service command.
• Dynamic entries remain in the ARP table until they time out. The switch uses the MAC Address table
timeout value as the ARP timeout value. Use the mac-address-table aging-time command to set the
timeout value.

Examples
-> clear arp-cache

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip service Adds a permanent entry to the ARP table.
show arp Displays the ARP table.

MIB Objects
alaIpClearArpCache

page 10-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip dos arp-poison restricted-address


Adds or deletes an ARP Poison restricted address.
ip dos arp-poison restricted-address ip_address
no ip dos arp-poison restricted-address ip_address

Syntax Definitions
ip_address 32-bit IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of the command to remove an already configured ARP Poison restricted address.

Examples
-> ip dos arp-poison restricted-address 192.168.1.1
-> no ip dos arp-poison restricted-address 192.168.1.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip dos arp-poison Displays the number of attacks detected for configured ARP poison
restricted-addresses.

MIB Objects
alaDoSArpPoisonTable
alaDoSArpPoisonIpAddr
alaDosArpPoisonRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-57


IP Commands

arp filter
Configures an ARP filter that will determine if ARP Request packets containing a specific IP address are
processed by the switch or discarded.
arp filter ip_address [mask ip_mask] [vid] [sender | target] [allow | block]
no arp filter ip_address

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address to use for filtering ARP packet IP addresses.
ip_mask An IP mask that identifies which part of the ARP packet IP address is
examined for filtering (e.g. mask 255.0.0.0 filters on the first octet of the
ARP packet IP address).
vid A VLAN ID that specifies that only ARP packets for a specific VLAN
are filtered.
sender The sender IP address in the ARP packet is used for ARP filtering.
target The target IP address in the ARP packet is used for ARP filtering.
allow ARP packets that meet filter criteria are processed.
block ARP packets that meet filter criteria are discarded.

Defaults

parameter default
vid 0 (no VLAN)
ip_mask 255.255.255.255
sender | target target
allow | block block

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete an ARP filter.

• If there are no filters configured for the switch, all ARP Request packets received are processed.

• Up to 200 filters are allowed on each switch.

• If sender or target IP address in an ARP Request packet does not match any filter criteria, the packet is
processed by the switch.
• ARP filtering is generally used in conjunction with the Local Proxy ARP application; however, ARP
filtering is available for use on its own and/or with other applications.

page 10-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Examples
-> arp filter 171.11.1.1
-> arp filter 172.0.0.0 mask 255.0.0.0
-> arp filter 198.0.0.0 mask 255.0.0.0 sender
-> arp filter 198.172.16.1 vlan 200 allow
-> no arp filter 171.11.1.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
clear arp filter Clears all ARP filters from the filter database.
ip interface Enables or disables the Local Proxy ARP feature on an IP inter-
face. When enabled, all traffic within the VLAN is routed. ARP
requests return the MAC address of the IP router interface.
show arp filter Displays the ARP filter configuration.

MIB Objects
alaIpArpFilterTable
alaIpArpFilterIpAddr
alaIpArpFilterIpMask
alaIpArpFilterVlan
alaIpArpFilterMode
alaIpArpFilterType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-59


IP Commands

clear arp filter


Clears the ARP filter database of all entries.
clear arp-cache

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This commands clears all ARP filters configured on the switch. To remove an individual filter entry, use
the no form of the arp filter command.

Examples
-> clear arp filter

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
arp filter Configures an ARP filter to allow or block the processing of speci-
fied ARP Request packets.
show arp filter Displays the ARP filter configuration.

MIB Objects
alaIpClearArpFilter

page 10-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

icmp type
Enables or disables a specific type of ICMP message, and sets the minimum packet gap. The minimum
packet gap is the number of microseconds that must pass between ICMP messages of the same type.
icmp type type code code {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap}

Syntax Definitions
type The ICMP packet type. This is conjunction with the ICMP code deter-
mines the type of ICMP message being specified.
code The ICMP code type. This is conjunction with the ICMP type deter-
mines the type of ICMP message being specified.
enable Enables the specified ICMP message.
disable Disables the specified ICMP message.
gap The number of microseconds required between ICMP messages of this
type.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disabled
gap 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-61


IP Commands

Usage Guidelines
• This command allows the use to enable or disable all types of ICMP messages, and set the minimum
packet gap between messages of the specified type. The ICMP message types are specified in RFC
792, and are listed below:

ICMP Message Type Code


echo reply 0 0
network unreachable 0 3
host unreachable 3 1
protocal unreachable 3 2
port unreachable 3 3
frag needed but DF bit set 3 4
source route failed 3 5
destination network unknown 3 6
destination host unknown 3 7
source host isolated 3 8
dest network admin prohibited 3 9
host admin prohibited by filter 3 10
network unreachable for TOS 3 11
host unreachable for TOS 3 12
source quench 4 0
redirect for network 5 0
redirect for host 5 1
redirect for TOS and network 5 2
redirect for TOS and host 5 3
echo request 8 0
router advertisement 9 0
router solicitation 10 0
time exceeded during transmit 11 0
time exceeded during reassembly 11 1
ip header bad 12 0
required option missing 12 1
timestamp request 13 0
timestamp reply 14 0
information request (obsolete) 15 0
information reply (obsolete) 16 0
address mask request 17 0
address mask reply 18 0

page 10-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

• While this command can be used to enable or disable all ICMP message, some of the more common
ICMP messages have their own CLI commands, as described in the pages below. The following ICMP
message have specific commands to enable and disable:

ICMP Message Command


Network unreachable (type 0, code 3) icmp unreachable
Host unreachable (type 3, code 1) icmp unreachable
Protocol unreachable (type 3, code 2) icmp unreachable
Port unreachable (type 3, code 3) icmp unreachable
Echo reply (type 0, code 0) icmp echo
Echo request (type 8, code 0) icmp echo
Timestamp request (type 13, code 0) icmp timestamp
Timestamp reply (type 14, code 0) icmp timestamp
Address Mask request (type 17, code 0) icmp addr-mask
Address Mask reply (type 18, code 0) icmp addr-mask

• Enabling Host unreachable and Network unreachable messages are not recommended as it can
cause the switch instability due to high-CPU conditions depending upon the volume of traffic required
by these messages.

Examples
-> icmp type 4 code 0 enabled
-> icmp type 4 code 0 min-pkt-gap 40
-> icmp type 4 code 0 disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
icmp messages Enables or disables all ICMP messages.
show icmp control Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.

MIB Objects
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlType
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlCode
alaIcmpCtrlStatus
alaIcmpCtrlPktGap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-63


IP Commands

icmp unreachable
Enables or disables ICMP messages pertaining to unreachable destinations, and sets the minimum packet
gap. The minimum packet gap is the number of microseconds that must pass between ICMP messages of
the same type.
icmp unreachable [net-unreachable | host-unreachable | protocol-unreachable |
port-unreachable] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap}

Syntax Definitions
net-unreachable Sets the unreachable network ICMP message.
host-unreachable Sets the unreachable host ICMP message.
protocol-unreachable Sets the unreachable protocol ICMP message.
port-unreachable Sets the unreachable port ICMP message.
enable Enables the specified ICMP message.
disable Disables the specified ICMP message.
gap The number of microseconds required between ICMP messages of this
type.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disabled
gap 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command enables ICMP messages relating to unreachable destinations. Unreachable networks,
hosts, protocols, and ports can all be specified.
• Enabling host-unreachable and net-unreachable messages are not recommended as it can cause the
switch instability due to high-CPU conditions depending upon the volume of traffic required by these
messages.
• The unreachable ICMP messages can also be enabled, disabled, and modified using the icmp type
command. See the icmp type command information on the type and code for the unreachable ICMP
messages.

Examples
-> icmp unreachable net-unreachable enable
-> icmp unreachable host-unreachable enable

page 10-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

-> icmp unreachable protocol-unreachable enable


-> icmp unreachable port-unreachable enable
-> icmp unreachable port-unreachable min-pkt-gap 50

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show icmp control Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.

MIB Objects
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlType
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlCode
alaIcmpCtrlStatus
alaIcmpCtrlPktGap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-65


IP Commands

icmp echo
Enables or disables ICMP echo messages, and sets the minimum packet gap. The minimum packet gap is
the number of microseconds that must pass between ICMP messages of the same type.
icmp echo [request | reply] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap}

Syntax Definitions
request Specifies the echo request ICMP message.
reply Specifies the echo reply ICMP message.
enable Enables the specified ICMP message.
disable Disables the specified ICMP message.
gap The number of microseconds required between ICMP messages of this
type.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable
gap 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command sets the ICMP echo messages. An echo request is sent to a destination, and must be
responded to with an echo reply message that contains the original echo request.
• Using this command without specifying a request or reply will enable, disable, or set the minimum
packet gap for both types.
• The echo ICMP messages can also be enabled, disabled, and modified using the icmp type command.
See the icmp type command information on the type and code for the echo ICMP messages.

Examples
-> icmp echo reply enable
-> icmp echo enable
-> icmp echo request enable
-> icmp echo request min-pkt-gap 50

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands
show icmp control Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.

MIB Objects
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlType
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlCode
alaIcmpCtrlStatus
alaIcmpCtrlPktGap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-67


IP Commands

icmp timestamp
Enables or disables ICMP timestamp messages, and sets the minimum packet gap. The minimum packet
gap is the number of microseconds that must pass between ICMP messages of the same type.
icmp timestamp [request | reply] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap}

Syntax Definitions
request Specifies timestamp request messages.
reply Specifies timestamp reply messages.
enable Enables the specified ICMP message.
disable Disables the specified ICMP message.
gap The number of microseconds required between ICMP messages of this
type.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable
gap 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The data received (a timestamp) in the message is returned in the reply together with an additional
timestamp. The timestamp is 32 bits of milliseconds since midnight UT. The Originate timestamp is the
time the sender last touched the message before sending it, the Receive timestamp is the time the
echoer first touched it on receipt, and the Transmit timestamp is the time the echoer last touched the
message on sending it.
• Using this command without specifying a request or reply will enable, disable, or set the minimum
packet gap for both types.
• The timestamp ICMP messages can also be enabled, disabled, and modified using the icmp type
command. See the icmp type command information on the type and code for the timestamp ICMP
messages.

Examples
-> icmp timestamp reply enable
-> icmp timestamp enable
-> icmp timestamp request enable
-> icmp timestamp request min-pkt-gap 50

page 10-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show icmp control Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.

MIB Objects
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlType
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlCode
alaIcmpCtrlStatus
alaIcmpCtrlPktGap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-69


IP Commands

icmp addr-mask
Enables or disables ICMP address mask messages, and sets the minimum packet gap. The minimum
packet gap is the number of microseconds that must pass between ICMP messages of the same type.
icmp add-mask [request | reply] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap}

Syntax Definitions
request Specifies request address mask messages.
reply Specifies reply address mask messages.
enable Enables the specified ICMP message.
disable Disables the specified ICMP message.
gap The number of microseconds required between ICMP messages of this
type.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable
gap 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A gateway receiving an address mask request should return it with the address mask field set to the 32-
bit mask of the bits identifying the subnet and network, for the subnet on which the request was
received.
• Using this command without specifying a request or reply will enable, disable, or set the minimum
packet gap for both types.
• The address mask ICMP messages can also be enabled, disabled, and modified using the icmp type
command. See the icmp type command information on the type and code for the address mask ICMP
messages.

Examples
-> icmp addr-mask reply enable
-> icmp addr-mask enable
-> icmp addr-mask request enable
-> icmp addr-mask request min-pkt-gap 50

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands
show icmp control Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.

MIB Objects
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlType
alaIcmpCtrlTable
alaIcmpCtrlCode
alaIcmpCtrlStatus
alaIcmpCtrlPktGap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-71


IP Commands

icmp messages
Enables or disables all Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) messages.
icmp messages {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables ICMP messages.
disable Disables ICMP messages.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> icmp messages enable
-> icmp messages disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
icmp type Enables or disables a specific type of ICMP message, and sets the
minimum packet gap.
show icmp control Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.

MIB Objects
alaIcmpCtrl
alaIcmpAllMsgStatus

page 10-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip dos scan close-port-penalty


Assigns a penalty value to be added to the Denial of Service penalty scan value when a TCP or UDP
packet is received on a closed port.
ip dos scan close-port-penalty penalty_value

Syntax Definitions
penalty_value A penalty value added to the penalty scan value. This value can be any
non-negative integer.

Defaults

parameter default
penalty_value 10

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command creates a point value that is added to the total port scan penalty value when a TCP or UDP
packet is received that is destined for a closed port.

Examples
-> ip dos scan close-port-penalty 25

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip dos scan threshold Sets the threshold for the port scan value, at which a DoS attack is
recorded.
ip dos trap Sets whether the switch generates SNMP DoS traps when an attack
is detected.

MIB Objects
alaDoSConfig
alaDoSPortScanClosePortPenalty

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-73


IP Commands

ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty


Assigns a penalty value to be added to the Denial of Service penalty scan value when a TCP packet is
received on an open port.
ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty penalty_value

Syntax Definitions
penalty_value A penalty value added to the penalty scan value. This value can be any
non-negative integer.

Defaults

parameter default
penalty_value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command creates a point value that is added to the total port scan penalty value when a TCP
packet is received that is destined for an open port.
• The switch does not distinguished between a legal TCP packet and a port scan packet.

Examples
-> ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip dos scan threshold Sets the threshold for the port scan value, at which a DoS attack is
recorded.
ip dos trap Sets whether the switch generates SNMP DoS traps when an attack
is detected.

MIB Objects
alaDoSConfig
alaDoSPortScanTcpOpenPortPenalty

page 10-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty


Assigns a penalty value to be added to the Denial of Service penalty scan value when a UDP packet is
received on an open port.
ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty penalty_value

Syntax Definitions
penalty_value A penalty value added to the penalty scan value. This value can be any
non-negative integer.

Defaults

parameter default
penalty_value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command creates a point value that is added to the total port scan penalty value when a UDP
packet is received that is destined for an open port.
• The switch does not distinguished between a legal UDP packet and a port scan packet.

Examples
-> ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty 15

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip dos scan threshold Sets the threshold for the port scan value, at which a DoS attack is
recorded.
ip dos trap Sets whether the switch generates SNMP DoS traps when an attack
is detected.

MIB Objects
alaDoSConfig
alaDoSPortScanUdpOpenPortPenalty

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-75


IP Commands

ip dos scan threshold


Sets the threshold for the port scan value, at which a DoS attack is recorded.
ip dos scan threshold threshold_value

Syntax Definitions
threshold_value A numerical value representing the total acceptable penalty before a
DoS attack is noted. This value can be any non-negative integer.

Defaults

parameter default
threshold_value 1000

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the total port scan penalty value exceeds this value, a port scan attack is recorded.

• The penalty value is incremented by recording TCP or UDP packets that are bound for open or closed
ports. Such packets are given a penalty value, which are added together. The commands for setting the
packet penalty value are the ip dos scan close-port-penalty, ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty, and
ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty commands.

Examples
-> ip dos scan threshold 1200

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands
ip dos scan close-port-penalty Assigns a penalty value to be added to the Denial of Service pen-
alty scan value when a TCP or UDP packet is received on a closed
port.
ip dos scan tcp open-port- Assigns a penalty value to be added to the Denial of Service pen-
penalty alty scan value when a TCP packet is received on an open port.
ip dos scan udp open-port- Assigns a penalty value to be added to the Denial of Service pen-
penalty alty scan value when a UDP packet is received on an open port.
show ip dos config Displays the configuration parameters of the DoS scan for the
switch.

MIB Objects
alaDoSConfig
alaDoSPortScanThreshold

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-77


IP Commands

ip dos trap
Sets whether the switch generates SNMP DoS traps when an attack is detected.
ip dos trap {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the generation of DoS traps.
disable Disables the generation of DoS traps.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command controls whether the switch generates an SNMP trap when a DoS attack is detected. It is
assumed a DoS attack has occurred when the port scan penalty threshold is exceeded. This value is set
using the ip dos scan threshold command.

Examples
-> ip dos trap enable
-> ip dos trap disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip dos scan threshold Sets the threshold for the port scan value, at which a DoS attack is
recorded.
show ip dos config Displays the configuration parameters of the DoS scan for the
switch.

MIB Objects
alaDoSConfig
alaDoSTrapCnt1

page 10-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

ip dos scan decay


Sets the decay speed of the port scan penalty value for the switch when calculating DoS attacks.
ip dos scan decay decay_value

Syntax Definitions
decay_value The decay value amount for reducing the port scan penalty. This value
can be any non-negative integer.

Defaults

parameter default
decay_value 2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The port scan penalty value is reduced every minute by dividing by the amount set in using this command.
For example, if the decay value is set to 10, every minute the total port scan penalty value is divided by
10.

Examples
-> ip dos scan decay 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip dos scan threshold Sets the threshold for the port scan value, at which a DoS attack is
recorded.
show ip dos config Displays the configuration parameters of the DoS scan for the
switch.

MIB Objects
alaDoSConfig
alaDoSPortScanDecay

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-79


IP Commands

show ip traffic
Displays IP datagram traffic and errors.
show ip traffic

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The statistics show the cumulative totals since the last time the switch was powered on or since the last
reset of the switch was executed.
• Packets received on a port that is a member of the UserPorts group are dropped if they contain a source
IP network address that does not match the IP subnet for the port. This is done to block spoofed IP traf-
fic. If the UserPorts group function is active and spoofed traffic was detected and blocked, the output
display of this command will include statistics regarding the spoofed traffic.
• Note that the presence of spoofing event statistics in the output display of this command indicates that
an attack was prevented, not that the switch is currently under attack.
• If statistics for spoofed traffic are not displayed, then a spoofing attempt has not occurred since the last
time this command was issued.

Examples
-> show ip traffic

IP statistics
Datagrams received
Total = 621883,
IP header error = 0,
Destination IP error = 51752,
Unknown protocol = 0,
Local discards = 0,
Delivered to users = 567330,
Reassemble needed = 0,
Reassembled = 0,

page 10-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Reassemble failed = 0

Datagrams sent
Fowarded = 2801,
Generated = 578108,
Local discards = 0,
No route discards = 9,
Fragmented = 2801,
Fragment failed = 0,
Fragments generated = 0

Event Source Total Last 33 seconds


-------------+-------+------------+------------------------
spoof 5/26 18 2 last mac 00:08:02:e2:17:70

output definitions
Total Total number of input datagrams received including those received in
error.
IP header error Number of IP datagrams discarded due to errors in the IP header (e.g.,
bad checksums, version number mismatch, other format errors, time-to-
live exceeded, errors discarded in processing IP options).
Destination IP error Number of IP datagrams discarded because the IP header destination
field contained an invalid address. This count includes invalid
addresses (e.g., 0.0.0.0) and addresses of unsupported classes (e.g.,
Class E).
Unknown protocol Number of locally-addressed datagrams received successfully but dis-
carded because of an unknown or unsupported protocol.
Local discards Number of IP datagrams received that were discarded, even though
they had no errors to prevent transmission (e.g., lack of buffer space).
This does not include any datagrams discarded while awaiting reassem-
bly. Typically, this value should be zero.
Delivered to users Total number of datagrams received that were successfully delivered to
IP user protocols (including ICMP).
Reassemble needed Number of IP fragments received that needed to be reassembled.
Reassembled Number of IP datagrams received that were successfully reassembled.
Reassemble failed Number of IP failures detected by the IP reassembly algorithm for all
reasons (e.g., timed out, error). This is not necessarily a count of dis-
carded IP fragments since some algorithms (notably the algorithm in
RFC 815) can lose track of the number of fragments by combining
them as they are received.
Fragmented Number of successfully fragmented IP datagrams.
Fragment failed Number of packets received and discarded by IP because they needed
to be fragmented but could not be. This situation could happen if a large
packet has the “Don’t Fragment” flag set.
Forwarded Number of IP datagrams forwarded by the switch.
Generated Total number of IP datagrams that local IP user protocols (including
ICMP) generated in response to requests for transmission. This does
not include any datagrams counted as “Forwarded.”

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-81


IP Commands

output definitions (continued)


Local discards Number of output IP datagrams that were discarded, even though they
had no errors to prevent transmission (e.g., lack of buffer space). This
number includes datagrams counted as “Forwarded” if the packets are
discarded for these reasons.
No route discards Number of IP datagrams received and discarded by IP because no route
could be found to transmit them to their destination. This includes any
packets counted as “Forwarded” if the packets are discarded for these
reasons. It also includes any datagrams that a host cannot route because
all of its default routers are down.
Fragments generated The of IP datagram fragments generated as a result of fragmentation.
Routing entry discards Number of packets received and discarded by IP even though no prob-
lems were encountered to prevent their transmission to their destination
(e.g., discarded because of lack of buffer space).
Event The type of event (spoof).
Source The slot and port number of the port that has received spoofed packets
and is also a member of the UserPorts group. Ports are configured as
members of the UserPorts group through the policy port group com-
mand.
Total The total number of spoofed packets received on the source port.
Last xx seconds The number of spoofed packets blocked in the last number of seconds
indicated. Also includes the source MAC address of the last spoofed
packet received.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show icmp statistics Displays ICMP statistics and errors.

page 10-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip interface
Displays the configuration and status of IP interfaces.
show ip interface [name | vlan vlan id | dhcp-client]

Syntax Definitions
name The name associated with the IP interface.
vlan_id VLAN ID (displays a list of IP interfaces associated with a VLAN).
dhcp-client Displays the configuration and status of the DHCP-Client interface.

Defaults
By default, all IP interfaces are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The basic show ip interface command displays information about all configured IP interfaces on the
switch.
• Use the optional vlan parameter to display a list of interfaces configured for the specified VLAN.

• Specify an optional interface name to display detailed information about an individual interface.

Examples
-> show ip interface
Total 13 interfaces
Name IP Address Subnet Mask Status Forward Device
--------------------+---------------+---------------+------+-------+--------
EMP 172.22.16.115 255.255.255.0 UP NO EMP
GMRULE 40.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 DOWN NO vlan 40
Loopback 127.0.0.1 255.0.0.0 UP NO Loopback
dhcp-client 172.16.105.10 255.255.255.0 UP NO vlan 60
client 60.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 DOWN NO vlan 65
gbps 5.5.5.5 255.255.255.0 DOWN NO vlan 7
if222 30.1.5.1 255.0.0.0 UP YES vlan 222
ldap_client1 173.22.16.115 255.255.255.0 UP YES vlan 173
ldap_server1 174.22.16.115 255.255.255.0 UP YES vlan 174
radius_client3 110.1.1.101 255.255.255.0 UP YES vlan 30
vlan-2 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 DOWN NO unbound
vlan-23 23.23.23.1 255.255.255.0 UP YES vlan 23

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-83


IP Commands

output definitions
Name Interface name. Generally, this is the name configured for the interface
(e.g., Accounting). Loopback refers to a loopback interface configured
for testing.
IP Address IP address of the interface. Configured through the ip interface com-
mand.
Subnet Mask IP subnet mask for the interface IP address. Configured through the ip
interface command.
Status Interface status:
• UP—Interface is ready to pass packets.
• DOWN—Interface is down.
Forward Indicates whether or not the interface is actively forwarding packets
(YES or NO).
Device The type of device bound to the interface:
• unbound—No device is bound to the interface.
• vlan—The VLAN ID that is bound to the interface.
• Loopback—A loopback interface is configured for testing.
Configured through the ip interface command.

-> show ip interface Marketing


Interface Name = Marketing
SNMP Interface Index = 13600007,
IP Address = 172.16.105.10,
Subnet Mask = 255.255.0.0,
Broadcast Address = 172.16.255.255,
Device = vlan 200,
Encapsulation = eth2,
Forwarding = disabled,
Administrative State = enabled,
Operational State = down,
Operational State Reason = device-down,
Router MAC = 00:d0:95:6a:f4:5c,
Local Proxy ARP = disabled,
Maximum Transfer Unit = 1500,
Primary (config/actual) = no/yes
-> show ip interface dhcp-client
Interface Name = Marketing
SNMP Interface Index = 13600012,
IP Address = 172.16.105.10,
Subnet Mask = 255.255.0.0,
Broadcast Address = 172.16.255.255,
Device = vlan 60,
Forwarding = disabled,
Administrative State = enabled,
Operational State = up,
Router MAC = 00:d0:95:6a:f4:55,
Maximum Transfer Unit = 1500,
DHCP-CLIENT Parameter Details
Client Status = Active,
Server IP = 198.206.181.55,
Lease Time Remaining = 2 Days 10 Hours 20 Min,
Option-60 = Option60_example,
HostName = TechPubs

page 10-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

output definitions
SNMP Interface Index Interface index.
IP Address IP address associated with the interface. Configured through the
ip interface command.
Subnet Mask IP subnet mask for the interface. Configured through the ip interface
command.
Broadcast Address Broadcast address for the interface.
Device The type of device bound to the interface:
• unbound—No device is bound to the interface.
• vlan—The VLAN ID that is bound to the interface.
• Loopback—A loopback interface is configured for testing.
Configured through the ip interface command.
Encapsulation Displays the IP router encapsulation (eth2 or snap) that the interface
will use when routing packets. Configured through the ip interface
command.
Forwarding Indicates whether or not IP forwarding is active for the interface
(enabled or disabled). Configured through the ip interface command.
Administrative State Administrative state of the IP interface (enabled or disabled), which is
independent of the state of the underlying device. Configured through
the ip interface command.
Operational State Indicates whether or not the interface is active (up or down).
Operation State Reason Indicates why the operational state of the interface is down:
• unbound—No device is bound to the interface.
• device-down—Device bound to the interface is down.
• admin-down—The admin state of the interface is down.
• no-such-device—Device does not exist.
• no-router-mac—No MAC address available for the interface.
Note that Operational State Reason field is only included in the dis-
play output when the operational state of the interface is down.
Router MAC Switch MAC address assigned to the interface. Note that each interface
assigned to the same VLAN will share the same switch MAC address.
Local Proxy ARP Indicates whether or not Local Proxy ARP is active for the interface
(enabled or disabled). Configured through the ip interface command.
Maximum Transfer Unit The Maximum Transmission Unit size set for the interface. Configured
through the ip interface command.
Primary (config/actual) Indicates if the interface is the configured and/or actual primary inter-
face for the device (VLAN, EMP, Loopback). If the actual status is set
to yes and the config status is set to no, the interface is the default inter-
face for the VLAN. Configured through the ip interface command.
DHCP-CLIENT Parameter (Parameters below are only applicable to the ‘dhcp-client’ interface)
Details
Client Status DHCP Client Status (In-active, Inactive)
Server IP The IP address of the DHCP server.
Lease Time Remaining The lease time remaining for the DHCP client IP address.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-85


IP Commands

output definitions (continued)


Option-60 The option-60 string that shall be included in DHCP discover/request
packets.
HostName The system name of the OmniSwitch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; DHCP Client options added.

Related Commands
ip interface Configures an IP interface to enable IP routing on a VLAN. With-
out an IP interface, traffic is bridged within the VLAN or across
connections to the same VLAN on other switches.
ip interface dhcp-client Configures a DHCP client IP interface that is to be assigned an IP
address from a DHCP server.
show icmp statistics Displays ICMP statistics and errors.

MIB Objects
alaIpInterfaceTable
alaIpInterfaceName
alaIpInterfaceAddress
alaIpInterfaceMask
alaIpInterfaceAdminState
alaIpInterfaceDeviceType
alaIpInterfaceVlanID
alaIpInterfaceIpForward
alaIpInterfaceEncap
alaIpInterfaceLocalProxyArp
alaIpInterfacePrimCfg
alaIpInterfaceOperState
alaIpInterfaceOperReason
alaIpInterfaceRouterMac
alaIpInterfaceBcastAddr
alaIpInterfacePrimAct
alaIpInterfaceMtu

page 10-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip route
Displays the IP Forwarding table.
show ip route [summary]

Syntax Definitions
summary Displays a summary of routing protocols that appear in the IP Forward-
ing table.

Defaults
By default, all routes are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The IP Forwarding table includes static routes as well as all routes learned through routing protocols
(e.g., RIP).
• Use the optional summary keyword to display a list of routing protocols and the number of routes for
each protocol that appear in the IP Forwarding table.

Examples
-> show ip route

+ = Equal cost multipath routes


Total 4 routes

Dest Address Subnet Mask Gateway Addr Age Protocol


------------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------+-----------
0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 10.255.11.254 01:50:33 NETMGMT
10.255.11.0 255.255.255.0 10.255.11.225 01:50:33 LOCAL
127.0.0.1 255.255.255.255 127.0.0.1 01:51:47 LOCAL
212.109.138.0 255.255.255.0 212.109.138.138 00:33:07 LOCAL

-> show ip route summary

Protocol Route Count


----------------+--------------
All 4
Local 3
Netmgmt 1
RIP 0
Other 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-87


IP Commands

output definitions
Dest Addr Destination IP address.
Subnet Mask Destination IP address IP subnet mask.
Gateway Addr IP address of the gateway from which this address was learned.
Age Age of the entry. If the entry is less than a day old, it is displayed in
hh/mm/ss format. If it is more than a day old, it is displayed in dd/hh
format (e.g., a route that is 2 days and 12 hours old is displayed as
2d12h).
Protocol Protocol by which this IP address was learned (e.g., RIP). NETMGT
indicates a static route. LOCAL indicates a local interface.
Route Count The number of routes that appear in the IP Foredoing table for each
protocol type listed.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ping Used to test whether an IP destination can be reached from the
local switch.
traceroute Used to find the path taken by an IP packet from the local switch to
a specified destination.
show ip route Displays a list of all routes (static and dynamic) that exist in the IP
router database.

page 10-88 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip route-pref
Displays the IPv4 routing preferences of a router.
show ip route-pref

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip route-pref
Protocol Route Preference Value
------------+------------------------
Local 1
Static 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip route-pref Configures the route preference of a router.

MIB Objects
alaIprmRtPrefTable
alaIprmRtPrefLocal
alaIprmRtPrefStatic
alaIprmRtPrefRip

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-89


IP Commands

show ip redist
Displays the IPv4 route map redistribution configuration.
show ipv6 redist [rip]

Syntax Definitions
rip Displays route map redistribution configurations that use RIP as the
destination (into) protocol.

Defaults
By default all route map redistribution configurations are shown.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Specify a destination protocol with this command to display only those configurations that redistribute
routes into the specified protocol.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Examples
-> show ip redist

Source Destination
Protocol Protocol Status Route Map
------------+------------+---------+--------------------
RIP Static Enabled ipv4rm

-> show ip redist rip

Source Destination
Protocol Protocol Status Route Map
------------+------------+---------+--------------------
Static RIP Enabled ipv4rm

output definitions
Source Protocol The protocol from which the routes are learned.
Destination Protocol The protocol into which the source protocol routes are redistributed.
Status The administrative status (Enabled or Disabled) of the route map
redistribution configuration.
Route Map The name of the route map that is applied with this redistribution
configuration.

page 10-90 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands

ip redist Controls the conditions for redistributing different IPv6 routes


between protocols.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapRedistProtoTable
alaRouteMapRedistSrcProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistDestProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapRedistStatus
alaRouteMapRedistAddressType
alaRouteMapRedistRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-91


IP Commands

show ip access-list
Displays the details of the access list.
show ip access-list [access-list-name]

Syntax Definitions
access-list-name Name of the access list.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If the access-list-name is not specified in this command, all the access lists will be displayed.

Examples
-> show ip access-list
Address / Redistribution
Name Prefix Length Effect Control
--------------------+------------------+-------+--------------
al_3 10.0.0.0/8 permit all-subnets
al_3 11.0.0.0/8 permit all-subnets
al_4 1.0.0.0/8 permit no-subnets
al_4 10.0.0.0/8 permit all-subnets

-> show ip access-list al_4

Address / Redistribution
Name Prefix Length Effect Control
--------------------+------------------+-------+--------------
al_4 1.0.0.0/8 permit no-subnets
al_4 10.0.0.0/8 permit all-subnets

output definitions
Name Name of the access list.
Address/Prefix Length IP address that belongs to the access list.
Effect Indicates whether the IP address is permitted or denied for redistribu-
tion.
Redistribution Control Indicates the conditions specified for redistributing the matched routes.

page 10-92 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced

Related Commands

ip access-list Creates an access list for adding multiple IPv4 addresses to route maps.
ip access-list address Adds multiple IPv4 addresses to the access list.

MIB objects
alaRouteMapAccessListIndex
alaRouteMapAccessListAddressType
alaRouteMapAccessListAddress
alaRouteMapAccessListPrefixLength
alaRouteMapAccessListAction
alaRouteMapAccessListRedistControl

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-93


IP Commands

show ip route-map
Displays the IP route maps configured on the switch.
show ip route-map [route-map-name]

Syntax Definitions
route-map-name The name of the specific route map.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If the route-map-name is not specified in this command, all the route maps are displayed.

Examples
-> show ip route-map
Route Maps: configured: 1 max: 200
Route Map: Route_map1 Sequence Number: 50 Action permit
match ip address 10.0.0.0/8 redist-control all-subnets permit
set metric 100 effect replace

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 10-94 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Related Commands
ip route-map action Creates a route map for redistribution and sets the status of route
map to permit or deny.
ip route-map match ip address Matches the route with the specified IPv4 address or with addresses
contained in an IPv4 access list specified by the access list name.
ip route-map match ipv6 Matches the route with the specified IPv6 address or with addresses
address contained in an IPv6 access list specified by the access list name
ip route-map match ip- Matches the routes that have a next-hop router address permitted
nexthop by the specified access list.
ip route-map match ipv6- Matches the routes that have an IPv6 next-hop router address per-
nexthop mitted by the specified access list
ip route-map match tag Permits or denies a route based on the specified next-hop IP
address.
ip route-map match tag Matches the tag value specified in the route map with the one that
the routing protocol learned the route on.
ip route-map match metric Matches the metric value specified in the route map with the one
that the routing protocol learned the route on.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapRedistProtoTable
alaRouteMapRedistRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapTable
alaRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapSequence
alaRouteMapType
alaRouteMapValue
alaRouteMapRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-95


IP Commands

show ip router database


Displays a list of all routes (static and dynamic) that exist in the IP router database. This database serves as
a central repository where routes are first processed for redistribution and where duplicate routes are
compared to determine the best route to use. If a route does not appear in the IP router database list, then
the switch does not know about it. In the case of dynamically learned routes, this could indicate that the
route was never received by the switch.
show ip router database [protocol type | gateway ip_address | dest {ip_address/prefixLen | ip_address}]

Syntax Definitions
type Routing protocol type (local, static, or RIP).
ip_address Destination IP address.
ip_address/prefixLen The destination IP address along with the prefix length of the routes
processed for redistribution.

Defaults
By default, all routes are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Command options are not mutually exclusive. You can use them on the same command line to narrow
and/or customize the output display of this command. For example, use the protocol and dest options
to display only those routes that are of a specific protocol type and have the specified destination
network.
• The IP forwarding table is derived from IP router database processing performed by the switch and
contains only unique routes that the switch currently uses. Use the show ip route command to view the
forwarding table.
• If an expected route does not appear in the IP forwarding table, use the show ip router database
command to see if the switch knows about the route and/or if a duplicate route with a higher prece-
dence was selected instead.
• The switch compares the protocol of duplicate routes to determine which one to use. Regardless of
whether or not a route has a higher priority metric value, protocol determines precedence. Local routes
are given the highest level of precedence followed by static, then RIP routes. As a result, a route that is
known to the switch may not appear in the IP forwarding table if a duplicate route with a higher proto-
col precedence exists.
• A list of inactive static routes is also included in the show ip router database output display. A route
becomes inactive if the interface for its gateway goes down. Inactive routes are unable to get to their
destination and further investigation is warranted to determine why their gateway is unavailable.
• Static routes that appear as inactive are not included in the main IP router database listing. If an inac-
tive route becomes active, however, it is removed from the inactive list and added to the active route
list.

page 10-96 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

Examples

-> show ip router database


Destination Gateway Protocol Metric VLAN
-------------------+----------------+--------+------+-----
10.212.59.0/24 10.212.59.17 LOCAL 1 45
10.212.60.0/24 10.212.60.17 LOCAL 1 44
10.212.61.0/24 10.212.61.17 LOCAL 1 43
10.212.66.0/24 10.212.66.17 LOCAL 1 46
143.209.92.0/24 172.28.6.254 STATIC 1 N/A
172.28.6.0/24 172.28.6.2 LOCAL 1 6

Inactive Static Routes

Destination Gateway Metric


-----------------+--------------+------
1.0.0.0/8 8.4.5.3 1

output definitions
Destination Destination IP address. Also includes the mask prefix length notation
after the address to indicate the subnet mask value. For example, /24
indicates the destination IP address has a 24-bit mask (255.255.255.0).
Gateway IP address of the gateway from which this route was learned.
Protocol Protocol by which this IP address was learned: LOCAL, STATIC, RIP).
Metric RIP metric or cost (hop count) for the route. Indicates a priority for the
route. The lower the metric value, the higher the priority.
VLAN The VLAN on which the route was learned, not forwarded. Note that
N/A appears in this field for static routes as they are not learned on a
VLAN.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip route Displays the IP Forwarding table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-97


IP Commands

show ip config
Displays IP configuration parameters.
show ip config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip config
IP directed-broadcast = OFF,
IP default TTL = 64

output definitions
IP directed-broadcast Indicates whether the IP directed-broadcast feature is on or off.
IP default TTL IP default TTL interval.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip directed-broadcast Enables or disables IP directed broadcasts routed through the
switch.
ip default-ttl Sets TTL value for IP packets.

page 10-98 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip protocols
Displays switch routing protocol information and status.
show ip protocols

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command also displays the switch’s primary IP address and router ID, if configured, and debug infor-
mation.

Examples
-> show ip protocols
Router ID = 10.255.11.243,
Primary addr = 10.255.11.243,

RIP status = Not Loaded,

Debug level = 1,
Debug sections = error,

output definitions
Router ID The set routing ID. The router ID is how the router is identified in IP.
Primary addr The primary interface address the route uses.
RIP status Whether RIP is loaded or not.
Debug level What the current router debug level is.
Debug sections What types of debugging information are being tracked.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-99


IP Commands

Related Commands
ip router primary-address Configures the router primary IP address.
ip router router-id Configures the router ID for the router.

MIB Objects
alaIpRouteSumTable
alaIpRouteProtocol

page 10-100 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip service
Displays the current status of TCP/UDP service ports.
show ip service

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The display output from this command also includes the service port number.

Examples
-> show ip service
Name Port Status
----------------------+-------+---------
ftp 21 enabled
ssh 22 disabled
telnet 23 disabled
udp-relay 67 disabled
http 80 disabled
network-time 123 disabled
snmp 161 disabled
secure_http 443 enabled

output definitions
Name Name of the TCP/UDP service.
Port The TCP/UDP well-known port number associated with the service.
Status The status of the well-known service port: enabled (port is closed) or
disabled (port is open).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-101


IP Commands

Related Commands
ip service Enables (opens) or disables (closes) well-known TCP/UDP service
ports.

MIB Objects
alaIpServiceTable
alaIpServiceType
alaIpServicePort
alaIpServiceStatus
alaIpPortServiceTable
alaIpPortServicePort
alaIpPortServiceStatus

page 10-102 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show arp
Displays the ARP table. The ARP table contains a listing of IP addresses and their corresponding transla-
tions to physical MAC addresses.
show arp [ip_address | hardware_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP address of the entry you want to view.
hardware_address MAC address of the entry you want to view.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the basic command (show arp) to view all of the entries in the table. Enter a specific IP address or
MAC address to view a specific entry.

Examples
-> show arp
Total 8 arp entries
Flags (P=Proxy)

IP Addr Hardware Addr Type Flags Port Interface Name


-----------------+-------------------+----------+-------+--------+----------+------
10.255.11.59 00:50:04:b2:c9:ee DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.48 00:50:04:b2:ca:11 DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.201 00:10:83:03:e7:e4 DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.14 00:10:5a:04:19:a7 DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.64 00:b0:d0:62:fa:f1 DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.25 00:b0:d0:42:80:24 DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.26 00:b0:d0:42:82:59 DYNAMIC 3/20 vlan 1
10.255.11.254 11:50:04:11:11:11 STATIC 3/20 vlan 1 demoarp

output definitions
IP Address Device IP address.
Hardware Addr MAC address of the device that corresponds to the IP address.
Type Indicates whether the ARP cache entries are dynamic or static.
Flags Indicates the type of entry:
• P = Proxy
Port The port on the switch attached to the device identified by the IP
address.
Interface The interface to which the entry belongs (e.g., VLAN, EMP).
Name User configured name of static arp entry.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-103


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip service Adds a permanent entry to the ARP table.
clear arp-cache Deletes all dynamic entries from the ARP table.

MIB Objects
ipNetToMediaTable
ipNetToMediaIfIndex
ipNetToMediaNetAddress
ipNetToMediaPhyAddress
ipNetToMediaType
ipNetToMediaAugTable
ipNetToMediaSlot
ipNetToMediaPort
alaIpNetToMediaTable
alaIpNetToMediaPhyAddress
alaIpNetToMediaProxy
alaIpNetToMediaAuth

page 10-104 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show arp filter


Displays a list of ARP filters configured for the switch.
show arp filter [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP address of the filter entry you want to view.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an IP address is not specified with this command, a list of all ARP filters is displayed.

• Enter a specific IP address to view the configuration for an individual filter.

Examples
-> show arp filter
IP Addr IP Mask Vlan Type Mode
-----------------+-------------------+------+----------+-------
171.11.1.1 255.255.255.255 0 target block
172.0.0.0 255.0.0.0 0 target block
198.0.0.0 255.0.0.0 0 sender block
198.172.16.1 255.255.255.255 200 target allow

-> show arp filter 198.172.16.1


IP Addr IP Mask Vlan Type Mode
-----------------+-------------------+------+----------+-------
198.0.0.0 255.0.0.0 0 sender block
198.172.16.1 255.255.255.255 200 target allow

output definitions
IP Addr The ARP packet IP address to which the filter is applied.
IP Mask The IP mask that specifies which part of the IP address to which the fil-
ter is applied.
Vlan A VLAN ID. The filter is applied only to ARP packets received on
ports associated with this VLAN.
Type Indicates which IP address in the ARP packet (sender or target) is
used to identify if a filter exists for that address.
Mode Indicates whether or not to block or allow a switch response to an ARP
packet that matches the filter.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-105


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
arp filter Adds a permanent entry to the ARP table.
clear arp filter Deletes all dynamic entries from the ARP table.

MIB Objects
alaIpArpFilterTable
alaIpArpFilterIpAddr
alaIpArpFilterIpMask
alaIpArpFilterVlan
alaIpArpFilterMode
alaIpArpFilterType

page 10-106 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show icmp control


Allows the viewing of the ICMP control settings.
show icmp control

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to view the status of the various ICMP messages. It is also useful to determine the type
and code of the less common ICMP messages.

Examples
-> show icmp control
Name Type Code Status min-pkt-gap(us)
-------------------------------------+------+------+---------+------------------
echo reply 0 0 enabled 0
network unreachable 3 0 enabled 0
host unreachable 3 1 enabled 0
protocal unreachable 3 2 enabled 0
port unreachable 3 3 enabled 0
frag needed but DF bit set 3 4 enabled 0
source route failed 3 5 enabled 0
destination network unknown 3 6 enabled 0
destination host unknown 3 7 enabled 0
source host isolated 3 8 enabled 0
dest network admin prohibited 3 9 enabled 0
host admin prohibited by filter 3 10 enabled 0
network unreachable for TOS 3 11 enabled 0
host unreachable for TOS 3 12 enabled 0
source quench 4 0 enabled 0
redirect for network 5 0 enabled 0
redirect for host 5 1 enabled 0
redirect for TOS and network 5 2 enabled 0
redirect for TOS and host 5 3 enabled 0
echo request 8 0 enabled 0
router advertisement 9 0 enabled 0
router solicitation 10 0 enabled 0
time exceeded during transmit 11 0 enabled 0
time exceeded during reassembly 11 1 enabled 0
ip header bad 12 0 enabled 0
required option missing 12 1 enabled 0
timestamp request 13 0 enabled 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-107


IP Commands

timestamp reply 14 0 enabled 0


information request(obsolete) 15 0 enabled 0
information reply(obsolete) 16 0 enabled 0
address mask request 17 0 enabled 0
address mask reply 18 0 enabled 0

output definitions
Name The name of the ICMP message.
Type The ICMP message type. This along with the ICMP code specify the
kind of ICMP message.
Code The ICMP message code. This along with the ICMP type specify the
kind of ICMP message.
Status Whether this message is Enabled or Disabled.
min-pkt-gap The minimum packet gap, in microseconds, for this ICMP message.
The minimum packet gap is the amount of time that must pass between
ICMP messages of like types.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
icmp type Enables or disables a specific type of ICMP message, and sets the
minimum packet gap.
icmp unreachable Enables or disables ICMP messages pertaining to unreachable des-
tinations, and sets the minimum packet gap.
icmp echo Enables or disables ICMP echo messages, and sets the minimum
packet gap.
icmp timestamp Enables or disables ICMP timestamp messages, and sets the mini-
mum packet gap.
icmp addr-mask Enables or disables ICMP address mask messages, and sets the
minimum packet gap.
icmp messages Enables or disables all ICMP messages.

page 10-108 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show icmp statistics


Displays Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) statistics and errors. ICMP is a network layer proto-
col within the IP protocol suite that provides message packets to report errors and other IP packet process-
ing information back to the source. ICMP generates several kinds of useful messages, including
Destination Unreachable, Echo Request and Reply, Redirect, Time Exceeded, and Router Advertisement
and Solicitation. If an ICMP message cannot be delivered, no second one is generated. This is to avoid an
endless flood of ICMP messages.
show icmp [statistics]

Syntax Definitions
statistics Optional syntax.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the ICMP Table to monitor and troubleshoot the switch.

Examples
-> show icmp
Messages Received Sent
-------------------------+-----------+------------
Total 2105 2105
Error 0 0
Destination unreachable 0 0
Time exceeded 0 0
Parameter problem 0 0
Source quench 0 0
Redirect 0 0
Echo request 2105 0
Echo reply 0 2105
Time stamp request 0 0
Time stamp reply 0 0
Address mask request 0 0
Address mask reply 0 0

output definitions
Total Total number of ICMP messages the switch received or attempted to
send. This counter includes all those counted as errors.
Error Number of ICMP messages the switch sent/received but was unable to
process because of ICMP-specific errors (e.g., bad ICMP checksums,
bad length).
Destination unreachable Number of “destination unreachable” messages that were sent/received
by the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-109


IP Commands

output definitions (continued)


Time exceeded Number of “time exceeded” messages that were sent/received by the
switch. These occur when a packet is dropped because the TTL counter
reaches zero. When a large number of these occur, it is a symptom that
packets are looping, that congestion is severe, or that the TTL counter
value is set too low. These messages also occur when all the fragments
trying to be reassembled do not arrive before the reassembly timer
expires.
Parameter problem Number of messages sent/received which indicate that an illegal value
has been detected in a header field. These messages can indicate a prob-
lem in the sending host’s IP software or possibly the gateway’s soft-
ware.
Source quench Number of messages sent/received that tell a host that it is sending too
many packets. A host should attempt to reduce its transmissions upon
receiving these messages.
Redirect Number of ICMP redirect messages sent/received by the switch.
Echo request Number of ICMP echo messages sent/received by the switch to see if a
destination is active and unreachable.
Echo reply Number of echo reply messages received by the switch.
Time stamp request Number of time stamp request messages sent/received by the switch.
Time stamp reply Number of time stamp reply messages sent/received by the switch.
Address mask request Number of address mask request messages that were sent/received by
the switch in an attempt to determine the subnet mask for the network.
Address mask reply Number of address mask reply messages that were sent/received by the
switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show udp statistics Displays UDP errors and statistics.

page 10-110 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show tcp statistics


Displays TCP statistics.
show tcp statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show tcp statistics
Total segments received = 235080,
Error segments received = 0,
Total segments sent = 363218,
Segments retransmitted = 38,
Reset segments sent = 97,
Connections initiated = 57185,
Connections accepted = 412,
Connections established = 1,
Attempt fails = 24393,
Established resets = 221

output definitions
Total segments received Total number of segments received, including those received in error.
This count includes segments received on currently established connec-
tions.
Error segments received Total number of segments received in error (e.g., bad TCP checksums).
Total segments sent Total number of segments sent, including those on current connections
but excluding those containing only retransmitted octets.
Segments retransmitted Number of TCP segments transmitted containing one or more
previously transmitted octets.
Reset segments sent Number of TCP segments containing the reset flag.
Connections initiated Number of connections attempted.
Connections accepted Number of connections allowed.
Connections established Number of successful connections.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-111


IP Commands

output definitions (continued)


Attempt fails Number of times attempted TCP connections have failed.
Established resets Number of times TCP connections have been reset from the "Estab-
lished" or "Close Wait" state to the “Closed” state.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show icmp statistics Displays ICMP statistics and errors.
show tcp ports Displays the TCP connection table.

page 10-112 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show tcp ports


Displays the TCP connection table.
show tcp ports

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this table to check the current available TCP connections.

Examples
-> show tcp ports
Local Address Local Port Remote Address Remote Port State
------------------+------------+-----------------+--------------+-------------
0.0.0.0 21 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
0.0.0.0 23 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
0.0.0.0 80 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
0.0.0.0 260 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
0.0.0.0 261 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
0.0.0.0 443 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
0.0.0.0 6778 0.0.0.0 0 LISTEN
10.255.11.223 23 128.251.16.224 1867 ESTABLISHED
10.255.11.223 2509 10.255.11.33 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2510 10.255.11.25 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2513 10.255.11.33 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2514 10.255.11.25 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2517 10.255.11.33 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2518 10.255.11.25 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2521 10.255.11.33 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2522 10.255.11.25 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2525 10.255.11.33 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2526 10.255.11.25 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2529 10.255.11.33 389 TIME-WAIT
10.255.11.223 2530 10.255.11.25 389 TIME-WAIT

output definitions
Local Address Local IP address for this TCP connection. If a connection is in the LIS-
TEN state and will accept connections for any IP interface associated
with the node, IP address 0.0.0.0 is used.
Local Port Local port number for this TCP connection. The range is 0–65535.
Remote Address Remote IP address for this TCP connection.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-113


IP Commands

output definitions (continued)


Remote Port Remote port number for this TCP connection. The range is 0–65535.
State State of the TCP connection, as defined in RFC 793. A connection
progresses through a series of states during its lifetime:
• Listen—Waiting for a connection request from any remote TCP
and port.
• Syn Sent—Waiting for a matching connection request after having
sent a connection request.
• Syn Received—Waiting for a confirming connection request
acknowledgment after having both received and sent a connection
request.
• Established—Open connection. Data received can be delivered to
the user. This is the normal state for the data transfer phase of the
connection.
• Fin Wait 1—Waiting for a connection termination request from the
remote TCP, or an acknowledgment of the connection termination
request previously sent.
• Fin Wait 2—Waiting for a connection termination request from the
remote TCP.
• Close Wait—Waiting for a connection termination request from the
local user.
• Closing—Waiting for a connection termination request acknowl-
edgment from the remote TCP.
• Last Ack—Waiting for an acknowledgment of the connection
termination request previously sent to the remote TCP (which
includes an acknowledgment of its connection termination request).
• Time Wait—Waiting for enough time to pass to be sure the remote
TCP received the acknowledgment of its connection termination
request.
• Closed—No connection state.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip interface Displays the status and configuration of IP interfaces.
show tcp statistics Displays TCP statistics.

page 10-114 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show udp statistics


Displays UDP errors and statistics.
show udp statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays cumulative statistics since the last time the switch was powered on or since the
last reset of the switch.

Examples
-> show udp statistics
Total datagrams received = 214937,
Error datagrams received = 0,
No port datagrams received = 32891,
Total datagrams sent = 211884

output definitions
Total datagrams received Total number of UDP datagrams delivered to UDP applications.
Error datagrams received Number of UDP datagrams that could not be delivered for any reason.
No port datagrams received Number of UDP datagrams that could not be delivered for reasons
other than lack of application at the destination.
Total datagrams sent Total number of UDP datagrams sent from this switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show udp ports Displays the UDP Listener table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-115


IP Commands

show udp ports


Displays the UDP Listener table. The table shows the local IP addresses and the local port number for each
UDP listener.
show udp ports

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• An IP address of zero (0.0.0.0) indicates that it is listening on all interfaces.
• This table contains information about the UDP end-points on which a local application is currently
accepting datagrams.

Examples
-> show udp port
Local Address Local Port
------------------+--------------
0.0.0.0 67
0.0.0.0 161
0.0.0.0 520

output definitions
Local Address Local IP address for this UDP connection.
Local Port Local port number for this UDP connection.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show udp statistics Displays UDP errors and statistics.

page 10-116 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip dos config


Displays the configuration parameters of the DoS scan for the switch.
show ip dos config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command allows the user to view the configuration parameters of the DoS scan. The scan keeps a
record of the penalties incurred by certain types of packets on TCP and UDP ports. When the set penalty
threshold is reached, it is assumed a DoS attack is in progress, and a trap is generated to inform the system
administrator.

Examples
-> show ip dos config

Dos type Status


-------------------------------------------+-----------------
port scan ENABLED
tcp sync flood ENABLED
ping of death ENABLED
smurf ENABLED
pepsi ENABLED
land ENABLED
teardrop/bonk/boink ENABLED
loopback-src ENABLED
invalid-ip ENABLED
invalid-multicast ENABLED
unicast dest-ip/multicast-mac ENABLED
ping overload DISABLED
arp flood ENABLED
arp poison ENABLED
DoS trap generation = ENABLED,
DoS port scan threshold = 1000,
DoS port scan decay = 2,
DoS port scan close port penalty = 10,
DoS port scan TCP open port penalty = 0,
DoS port scan UDP open port penalty = 0,
Dos MAximum Ping Rate = 100
Dos Maximum ARP Request Rate = 500

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-117


IP Commands

output definitions
DoS trap generation Displays the status of DoS trap generation. It is either ENABLED or
DISABLED. This is set using the ip dos trap command.
DoS port scan threshold The penalty threshold setting. When enough packets have increased the
penalty number to this setting, a trap is generated to warn the adminis-
trator that a DoS attack is in progress. This is set using the ip dos scan
threshold command.
DoS port scan decay The decay value for the switch. The penalty value of the switch is
decreased by this number every minute. This is set using the ip dos
scan decay command.
DoS port scan close port pen- The penalty value for packets received on closed UDP and TCP ports.
alty The penalty number for the switch is increased by this amount every
time a packet is received on a closed UDP or TCP port. This is set using
the ip dos scan close-port-penalty command.
DoS port scan TCP open port The penalty value for packets received on open TCP ports. The penalty
penalty number for the switch is increased by this amount every time a packet
is received on an open TCP port. This is set using the ip dos scan tcp
open-port-penalty command.
DoS port scan UDP open port The penalty value for packets received on open UDP ports. The penalty
penalty number for the switch is increased by this amount every time a packet
is received on an open UDP port. This is set using the ip dos scan udp
open-port-penalty command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip dos statistics Displays the statistics on detected DoS attacks for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaDosTable
alaDoSType

page 10-118 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip dos statistics


Displays the statistics on detected DoS attacks for the switch.
show ip dos statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command displays the number of attacks the switch has detected for several types of DoS attacks.

• Just because an attack is detected and reported, doesn’t necessarily mean an attack occurred. The
switch assumes a DoS attack is underway anytime the penalty threshold is exceeded. It is possible for
this threshold to be exceeded when no attack is in progress.

Examples
-> show ip dos statistics
DoS type Attacks detected
---------------------+--------------------
port scan 0
tcp sync flood 0
ping of death 0
smurf 0
pepsi 0
land 0
teardrop/bonk/boink 0
loopback-src 0
invalid-ip 0
invalid-multicast 0
unicast dest-ip/multicast-mac 0
ping overload 0
arp flood 0
arp poison 0

output definitions
DoS type The type of DoS attack. The most common seven are displayed.
Attacks detected The number of attacks noted for each DoS type.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-119


IP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip dos config Displays the configuration parameters of the DoS scan for the
switch.

MIB Objects
alaDoSTable
alaDoSType

page 10-120 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Commands

show ip dos arp-poison


Displays the number of attacks detected for configured ARP poison restricted-addresses.
show ip dos arp-poison

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip dos arp-poison
IP Address Attacks
-----------------------------------+------------
192.168.1.1 0
192.168.1.2 0
192.168.1.3 0

output definitions
IP Address The configured ARP Poison restricted-addresses.
Attacks detected The number of ARP Poison attacks detected for each address.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ip dos arp-poison restricted- Adds or deletes an ARP Poison restricted address.
address

MIB Objects
alaDoSArpPoisonTable
alaDoSArpPoisonIpAddr
alaDoSArpPoisonDetected

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10-121


IP Commands

page 10-122 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


11 IPv6 Commands

This chapter details Internet Protocol Version 6 (IPv6) commands for the switch (including RIPng
commands). IPv6 (documented in RFC 2460) is designed as a successor to IPv4. The changes from IPv4
to IPv6 fall primarily into the following categories:
Expanded Routing and Addressing Capabilities - IPv6 increases the IP address size from 32 bits to 128
bits, to support more levels of addressing hierarchy and a much greater number of addressable nodes, and
simpler auto-configuration of addresses. The scalability of multicast routing is improved by adding a
"scope" field to multicast addresses.
Header Format Simplification - Some IPv4 header fields were dropped or made optional, to reduce the
common-case processing cost of packet handling and to keep the bandwidth cost of the IPv6 header as low
as possible despite the increased size of the addresses. Even though the IPv6 addresses are four times
longer than the IPv4 addresses, the IPv6 header is only twice the size of the IPv4 header.
Anycast Addressing - A new type of address called a "anycast address" is defined, to identify sets of
nodes where a packet sent to an anycast address is delivered to one of the nodes. The use of anycast
addresses in the IPv6 source route allows nodes to control the path on which their traffic flows.
Improved Support for Options - Changes in the way IP header options are encoded allows for more effi-
cient forwarding, less stringent limits on the length of options, and greater flexibility for introducing new
options in the future.
Authentication and Privacy Capabilities - IPv6 includes the definition of extensions which provide
support for authentication, data integrity, and confidentiality. This is included as a basic element of IPv6
and will be included in all implementations.
MIB information for the IPv6 and RIPng commands is as follows:
Filename: Ipv6.mib
Module: Ipv6-MIB, Ipv6-TCP-MIB, Ipv6-UDP-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1Ipv6.mib
Module: alcatelIND1IPv6MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1Iprmv6.mib
Module: alcatelIND1IprmV6MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1Ripng.mib
Module: alcatelIND1RipngMIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-1


IPv6 Commands

A summary of the IPv6 commands is listed here:

IPv6 ipv6 interface


ipv6 address
ipv6 dad-check
ipv6 hop-limit
ipv6 pmtu-lifetime
ipv6 host
ipv6 neighbor stale-lifetime
ipv6 neighbor
ipv6 prefix
ipv6 route
ipv6 static-route
ipv6 route-pref
ping6
traceroute6
show ipv6 hosts
show ipv6 icmp statistics
show ipv6 interface
show ipv6 pmtu table
clear ipv6 pmtu table
show ipv6 neighbors
clear ipv6 neighbors
show ipv6 prefixes
show ipv6 routes
show ipv6 route-pref
show ipv6 router database
show ipv6 tcp ports
show ipv6 traffic
clear ipv6 traffic
show ipv6 udp ports
show ipv6 information
IPv6 Route Map ipv6 redist
Redistribution ipv6 access-list
ipv6 access-list address
show ipv6 redist
show ipv6 access-list
IPv6 RIP ipv6 load rip
ipv6 rip status
ipv6 rip invalid-timer
ipv6 rip garbage-timer
ipv6 rip holddown-timer
ipv6 rip jitter
ipv6 rip route-tag
ipv6 rip update-interval
ipv6 rip triggered-sends
ipv6 rip interface
ipv6 rip interface metric
ipv6 rip interface recv-status
ipv6 rip interface send-status
ipv6 rip interface horizon
show ipv6 rip
show ipv6 rip interface
show ipv6 rip peer
show ipv6 rip routes

page 11-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 interface
Configures an IPv6 interface on a VLAN.
ipv6 interface if_name vlan vid [enable | disable]
[base-reachable-time time]
[ra-send {yes | no}]
[ra-max-interval interval]
[ra-managed-config-flag {true | false}]
[ra-other-config-flag {true | false}]
[ra-reachable-time time]
[ra-retrans-timer time]
[ra-default-lifetime time | no ra-default-lifetime]
[ra-send-mtu] {yes | no}
no ipv6 interface if_name

Syntax Definitions
if_name IPv6 interface name.
vlan Creates a VLAN interface.
vid VLAN ID number.
base-reachable-time time Base value used to compute the reachable time for neighbors reached
via this interface.
ra-send Specifies whether the router advertisements are sent on this interface.
ra-max-interval interval Maximum time, in seconds, allowed between the transmission of unso-
licited multicast router advertisements in this interface. The range is 4 -
1,800.

ra-managed-config-flag Value to be placed in the managed address configuration flag field in


router advertisements sent on this interface.
ra-other-config-flag Value to be placed in the other stateful configuration flag in router
advertisements sent on this interface.
ra-reachable-time time Value, in milliseconds, to be placed in the reachable time field in router
advertisements sent on this interface. The range is 0 - 3,600,000. The
special value of zero indicates that this time is unspecified by the router.
ra-retrans-timer time Value, in milliseconds, to be placed in the retransmit timer field in
router advertisements sent on this interface. The value zero indicates
that the time is unspecified by the router.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-3


IPv6 Commands

ra-default-lifetime time Value, in seconds, to be placed in the router lifetime field in router
advertisements sent on this interface. The time must be zero or between
the value of “ra-max-interval” and 9,000 seconds. A value of zero indi-
cates that the router is not to be used as a default router. The “no ra-
default-lifetime” option will calculate the value using the formula (3 *
ra-max-interval).
enable | disable Administratively enable or disable the interface.
ra-send-mtu Specifies whether the MTU option is included in the router advertise-
ments sent on the interface.

Defaults

parameter default
ra-send yes
ra-max-interval 600
ra-managed-config-flag false
ra-reachable-time 0
ra-retrans-timer 0
ra-default-lifetime no
ra-send-mtu no

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete an interface.

• When you create an IPv6 interface, it is enabled by default.

• All IPv6 interfaces must have a name.

• When creating an IPv6 interface you must specify a VLAN ID. When modifying or deleting an inter-
face, you do not need to specify one of these options unless the name assigned to the interface is being
changed. If it is present with a different value from when the interface was created, the command will
be in error.
• To enable IPv6 routing you must first create a VLAN, then create an IPv6 interface on the VLAN. See
Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands,” for information on creating VLANs.

page 11-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Examples
-> ipv6 interface Test vlan 1
-> no ipv6 interface Test

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 interface Displays IPv6 Interface Table.

MIB Objects
IPv6IfIndex
alaIPv6InterfaceTable
alaIPv6InterfaceName
alaIPv6InterfaceMtu
alaIPv6InterfaceSendRouterAdvertisements
alaIPv6InterfaceMaxRtrAdvInterval
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvManagedFlag
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvOtherConfigFlag
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvRetransTimer
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvDefaultLifetime
alaIPv6InterfaceAdminStatus
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvReachableTime
alaIPv6InterfaceBaseReachableTime
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvSendMtu
alaIPv6InterfaceRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-5


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 address
Configures an IPv6 address for an IPv6 interface on a VLAN. There are different formats for this
command depending on the address type.
ipv6 address ipv6_address /prefix_length [anycast] {if_name | loopback}
no ipv6 address ipv6_address [anycast] {if_name | loopback}
ipv6 address ipv6_prefix eui-64 {if_name | loopback}
no ipv6 address ipv6_prefix eui-64 {if_name | loopback}

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address IPv6 address.
/prefix_length The number of bits that are significant in the IPv6 address (mask).
(3..128).
anycast Indicates the address is an anycast address.
eui-64 Append an EUI-64 identifier to the prefix.
if_name Name assigned to the interface.
loopback Configures the loopback interface.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete an address.

• You can assign multiple IPv6 addresses to an IPv6 interface.

• No default value for prefix length.

• The “eui” form of the command is used to add or remove an IPv6 address for a VLAN using an EUI-64
interface ID in the low order 64 bits of the address.
• To enable IPv6 routing you must first create a VLAN, then create an IPv6 interface on the VLAN. See
Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands,” for information on creating VLANs.

Examples
-> ipv6 address 4132:86::19A/64 Test_Lab
-> ipv6 address 2002:d423:2323::35/64 Test_Engr

page 11-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 interface Displays IPv6 Interface Table.

MIB Objects
IPv6IfIndex
alaIPv6InterfaceAddressTable
alaIPv6InterfaceAddress
alaIPv6InterfaceAddressAnycastFlag
alaIPv6InterfaceEUI64AddressPrefixLength
alaIPv6InterfaceEUI64AddressrowStatus

For EUI-64 Addresses:


alaIPv6InterfaceEUI64AddresssTable
alaIPv6InterfaceEUI64Address
alaIPv6InterfaceEUI64AddressPrefixLength
alaIPv6InterfaceEUI64AddressRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-7


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 dad-check
Runs a Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) check on an address that was marked as duplicated.
ipv6 dad-check ipv6_address if_name

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address IPv6 address.
ip_name Name assigned to the interface.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The switch performs DAD check when an interface is attached to the stack and its VLAN first enters the
active state. Use this command to rerun a DAD check on an address that was marked as duplicated.

Examples
-> ipv6 dad-check fe80::2d0:95ff:fe6a:f458/64 Test_Lab

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
alaIPv6InterfaceAddressTable
alaIPv6InterfaceAddressDADStatus

page 11-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 hop-limit
Configures the value placed in the hop limit field in the header of all IPv6 packets that are originated by
the switch. It also configures the value placed in the hop limit field in router advertisements.
ipv6 hop-limit value
no ipv6 hop-limit

Syntax Definitions
value Hop limit value. The range is 0 - 255.

Defaults

parameter default
value 64

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to return the hop limit to its default value.

• Inputting the value 0 (zero) will result in the default (64) hop-limit.

Examples
-> ipv6 hop-limit 64

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 information Displays IPv6 information.

MIB Objects
ipv6MibObjects
Ipv6DefaultHopLimit

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-9


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 pmtu-lifetime
Configures the minimum lifetime for entries in the path MTU Table.
ipv6 pmtu-lifetime time

Syntax Definitions
time Minimum path MTU entry lifetime, in minutes. Valid range is 10–1440.

Defaults

parameter default
time 60

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> ipv6 pmtu-lifetime 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 pmtu table Displays the IPv6 path MTU Table.
show ipv6 information Displays IPv6 information.
clear ipv6 pmtu table Removes all the entries from the IPv6 path MTU Table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6ConfigTable
alaIPv6PMTUMinLifetime

page 11-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 host
Configures a static host name to IPv6 address mapping to the local host table.
ipv6 host name ipv6_address
no ipv6 host name ipv6_address

Syntax Definitions
name Host name associated with the IPv6 address (1 - 255 characters).
ipv6_address IPv6 address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove the mapping from the host table.

Examples
-> ipv6 host Lab 4235::1200:0010

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 hosts Displays IPv6 Local Hosts Table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6HostTable
alaIPv6HostName
alaIPv6HostAddress
alaIPv6HostRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-11


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 neighbor stale-lifetime


Configures the minimum lifetime for all neighbor entries.
ipv6 neighbor stale-lifetime stale-lifetime

Syntax Definitions
stale-lifetime Minimum lifetime for neighbor entries in the stale state (5–2800).

Defaults

parameter default
stale-lifetime 1440

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> ipv6 neighbor stale-lifetime 1400

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 neighbors Displays IPv6 Neighbor Table.
show ipv6 information Displays IPv6 information.

MIB Objects
IPv6IfIndex
alaIPv6NeighborTable
alaIPv6NeighborStaleLifetime

page 11-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 neighbor
Configures a static entry in IPv6 Neighbor Table.
ipv6 neighbor ipv6_address hardware_address {if_name} slot/port
no ipv6 neighbor ipv6_address {if_name}

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address IPv6 address that corresponds to the hardware address.
hardware_address MAC address in hex format (e.g., 00:00:39:59:F1:0C).
if_name Name assigned to the interface on which the neighbor resides.
slot/port Slot/port used to reach the neighbor.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove an entry from IPv6 Neighbor Table.

Examples
-> ipv6 neighbor 4132:86::203 00:d0:c0:86:12:07 Test 1/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 neighbors Displays IPv6 Neighbor Table.
show ipv6 information Displays IPv6 information.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-13


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
IPv6IfIndex
alaIPv6NeighborTable
alaIPv6NeighborNetAddress
alaIPv6NeighborPhysAddress
alaIPv6NeighborSlot
alaIPv6NeighborPort
alaIPv6NeighborRowStatus
alaIPv6NeighborStaleLifetime

page 11-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 prefix
Configures an IPv6 prefix on an interface. Used for configuring prefixes for router advertisements.
ipv6 prefix ipv6_address /prefix_length if_name
[valid-lifetime time]
[preferred-lifetime time]
[on-link-flag {true | false}
[autonomous-flag {true | false}] if_name
no ipv6 prefix ipv6_address /prefix_length if_name

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address IPv6 address of the interface.
/prefix_length The number of bits that are significant in the IPv6 address (mask).
(1...127).
valid-lifetime time Length of time, in seconds, that this prefix will remain valid, i.e. time
until deprecation. A value of 4,294,967,295 represents infinity.
preferred-lifetime time Length of time, in seconds, that this prefix will remain preferred, i.e.
time until deprecation. A value of 4,294,967,295 represents infinity.
on-link-flag On-link configuration flag. When “true” this prefix can be used for on-
link determination.
autonomous-flag Autonomous address configuration flag. When “true”, indicates that this
prefix can be used for autonomous address configuration (i.e., can be
used to form a local interface address).
if_name Name assigned to the interface.

Defaults

parameter default
valid-lifetime time 2,592,000
preferred-lifetime time 604,800
on-link-flag true
autonomous-flag true

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to delete a prefix.

Examples
-> ipv6 prefix 4132:86::/64 Test

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-15


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 prefixes Displays IPv6 prefixes used in router advertisements.

MIB Objects
IPv6IfIndex
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixTable
alaIP6vInterfacePrefix
alaIP6vInterfacePrefixLength
alaIP6vInterfacePrefixValidLifetime
alaIP6vInterfacePrefixPreferredLifetime
alaIP6vInterfacePrefixonLinkFlag
alaIP6vInterfacePrefixAutonomousFlag
alaIP6vInterfacePrefixRowStatus

page 11-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 route
Configures a static entry in the IPv6 route. This command is currently not supported. Please use the new
ipv6 static-route command.
ipv6 route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length ipv6_address [if_name]
no ipv6 route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length ipv6_address [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_prefix IPv6 network that is the destination of this static route.
/prefix_length The number of bits that are significant in the iPv6 address (mask).
(0...128).
ipv6_address IPv6 address of the next hop used to reach the specified network.
if_name If the next hop is a link-local address, the name of the interface used to
reach it.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported

OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove a static route.

Examples
-> ipv6 route 212:95:5::/64 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe6a:f458 v6if-137

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 routes Displays IPv6 Forwarding Table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6StaticRouteTable
alaIPv6StaticRouteNextHop
alaIPv6StaticRouteIfIndex
alaIPv6StaticRouteDest
alaIPv6StaticRoutePrefixLength
alaIPv6StaticRouteRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-17


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 static-route
Creates/deletes an IPv6 static route. Static routes are user-defined; they carry a higher priority than routes
created by dynamic routing protocols. That is, static routes always have priority over dynamic routes,
regardless of the metric value.
ipv6 static-route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length gateway ipv6_address [if_name] [metric metric]
no ipv6 static-route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length gateway ipv6_address [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_prefix IPv6 network that is the destination of this static route.
/prefix_length The number of bits (0...128) that are significant in the iPv6 address
(mask).
gateway ipv6_address IPv6 address of the next hop used to reach the destination IPv6 address.
if_name If the next hop is a link-local address, the name of the interface used to
reach it.
metric Metric or cost (hop count) for the static route. You can set a priority for
the static route by assigning a metric value. The lower the metric value,
the higher the priority. Valid range is 1–15.

Defaults

parameter default
metric 1

Platforms Supported

OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to remove a static route.

Examples
-> ipv6 static-route 212:95:5::/64 gateway fe80::2d0:95ff:fe6a:f458 v6if-137 metric 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 11-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands
show ipv6 routes Displays IPv6 Forwarding Table.
show ipv6 router database Displays a list of all routes (static and dynamic) that exist in the
IPv6 router database.

MIB Objects
alaIprmv6StaticRouteTable
alaIprmv6StaticRouteDest
alaIprmv6StaticRoutePrefixLength
alaIprmv6StaticRouteNextHop
alaIprmv6StaticRouteIfIndex
alaIprmv6StaticRouteMetric
alaIprmv6StaticRouteRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-19


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 route-pref
Configures the route preference of a router.
ipv6 route-pref {static | rip} value

Syntax Definitions
static Configures the route preference of static routes.
rip Configures the route preference of RIPng routes.
value Route preference value.

Defaults

parameter default
static value 2
rip value 120

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Route preference of local routes cannot be changed.

• The valid route preference range is 1–255.

• The IPv6 version of BGP is not supported currently.

Examples
-> ipv6 route-pref static 2
-> ipv6 route-pref rip 60

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 route-pref Displays the configured route preference of a router.

MIB Objects
alaIprmRtPrefTable
alaIprmRtPrefLocal
alaIprmRtPrefStatic
alaIprmRtPrefRip

page 11-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ping6
Tests whether an IPv6 destination can be reached from the local switch. This command sends an ICMPv6
echo request to a destination and then waits for a reply. To ping a destination, enter the ping6 command
and enter either the destination’s IPv6 address or hostname. The switch will ping the destination using the
default frame count, packet size, and interval (6 frames, 64 bytes, and 1 second respectively). You can also
customize any or all of these parameters as described below.
ping6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name] [count count] [size data_size] [interval seconds]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address IP address of the system to ping.
hostname DNS name of the system to ping.
if_name If the target is a link-local address, the name of the interface used to
reach it.
count Number of packets to be transmitted.
size Size of the data portion of the packet sent for this ping, in bytes.
seconds Interval, in seconds, at which ping packets are transmitted.

Defaults

parameter default
count 6
size 56
interval seconds 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If you change the default values, they will only apply to the current ping. The next time you use the
ping command, the default values will be used unless you again enter different values.
• When the next hop address is a local link address, the name of the interface used to reach the destina-
tion must be specified.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-21


IPv6 Commands

Examples
-> ping6 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe6a:f458/64

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
traceroute6 Finds the path taken by an IPv6 packet from the local switch to a
specified destination.

page 11-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

traceroute6
Finds the path taken by an IPv6 packet from the local switch to a specified destination. This command
displays the individual hops to the destination as well as some timing information.
traceroute6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name] [max-hop hop_count] [wait-time time] [port
port_number] [probe-count probe]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address Destination IPv6 address. IPv6 address of the host whose route you
want to trace.
hostname DNS name of the host whose route you want to trace.
if_name If the target is a link-local address, the name of the interface used to
reach it.
hop_count Maximum hop count for the trace.
time Delay time, in seconds between probes
port Specific UDP port destination. By default, the destination port is chosen
by traceroute6.
probe Number of probes to be sent to a single hop.

Defaults

parameter default
hop_count 30
time 5
probe 3

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When using this command, you must enter the name of the destination as part of the command line
(either the IPv6 address or hostname).
• Use the optional max-hop parameter to set a maximum hop count to the destination. If the trace
reaches this maximum hop count without reaching the destination, the trace stops.

Examples
-> traceroute6 41EA:103::65C3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-23


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands
ping6 Tests whether an IPv6 destination can be reached from the local
switch.

page 11-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 hosts


Displays IPv6 Local Hosts Table.
show ipv6 hosts [substring]

Syntax Definitions
substring Limits the display to host names starting with the specified substring.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify a substring, all IPv6 hosts are displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 hosts

Name IPv6 Address


-------------------------------------------+--------------------------------------
ipv6-test1.alcatel-lucent.com 4235::1200:0010
ipv6-test2.alcatel-lucent.com 4235::1200:0020
otheripv6hostname 4143:1295:9490:9303:00d0:6a63:5430:9031

output definitions
Name Name associated with the IPv6 address.
IPv6 Address IPv6 address associated with the host name.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 host Configures a static host name to the IPv6 address mapping to the
local host table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6HostTable
alaIPv6HostName
alaIPv6HostAddress

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-25


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 icmp statistics


Displays IPv6 ICMP statistics.
show ipv6 icmp statistics [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
if_name Display statistics only for this interface.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the ICMP table to monitor and troubleshoot the switch.

Examples
-> show ipv6 icmp statistics

Message Received Sent


------------------------------+----------+----------
Total 0 0
Errors 0 0
Destination Unreachable 0 0
Administratively Prohibited 0 0
Time Exceeded 0 0
Parameter Problems 0 0
Packet Too Big 0 0
Echo Requests 0 0
Echo Replies 0 0
Router Solicitations 0 0
Router Advertisements 0 0
Neighbor Solicitations 0 0
Neighbor Advertisements 0 0
Redirects 0 0
Group Membership Queries 0 0
Group Membership Responses 0 0
Group Membership Reductions 0 0

output definitions
Total Total number of ICMPv6 messages the switch received or attempted
to send.
Errors Number of ICMPv6 messages the switch sent or received but was
unable to process because of ICMPv6-specific errors (bad checksums,
bad length, etc.).
Destination Unreachable Number of Destination Unreachable messages that were sent or
received by the switch.

page 11-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

output definitions (continued)


Administratively Prohibited Number of Destination Unreachable/Communication Administra-
tively Prohibited messages sent or received by the switch.
Time Exceeded Number of Time Exceeded messages sent or received by the switch.
Parameter Problems Number of Parameter Problem messages sent or received by the
switch.
Packet Too Big Number of Packet Too Big messages sent or received by the switch.
Echo Requests Number of Echo Request messages sent or received by the switch.
Echo Replies Number of Echo Reply messages sent or received by the switch.
Router Solicitations Number of Router Solicitations sent or received by the switch.
Router Advertisements Number of Router Advertisements sent or received by the switch.
Neighbor Solicitations Number of Neighbor Solicitations sent or received by the switch.
Neighbor Advertisements Number of Neighbor Advertisements sent or received by the switch.
Redirects Number of Redirect messages sent or received by the switch.
Group Membership Queries Number of Group Membership Queries sent or received by the switch.
Group Membership Responses Number of Group Membership Responses sent or received by the
switch.
Group Membership Reductions Number of Group Membership Reductions sent or received by the
switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 traffic Displays IPv6 traffic statistics.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-27


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
ipv6IfIcmpTable
ipv6IfIcmpInMsgs
ipv6IfIcmpInErrors
ipv6IfIcmpInDestUnreachs
ipv6IfIcmpInAdminProhibs
ipv6IfIcmpInTimeExcds
ipv6IfIcmpInParmProblems
ipv6IfIcmpInPktTooBigs
ipv6IfIcmpInEchos
ipv6IfIcmpInEchoReplies
ipv6IfIcmpInRouterSolicits
ipv6IfIcmpInRouterAdvertisements
ipv6IfIcmpInNeighborSolicits
ipv6IfIcmpInNeighborAdvertisements
ipv6IfIcmpInRedirects
ipv6IfIcmpInGroupMembQueries
ipv6IfIcmpInGroupMembResponses
ipv6IfIcmpInGroupMembReductions
ipv6IfIcmpOutMsgs
ipv6IfIcmpOutErrors
ipv6IfIcmpOutDestUnreachs
ipv6IfIcmpOutAdminProhibs
ipv6IfIcmpOutTimeExcds
ipv6IfIcmpOutParmProblems
ipv6IfIcmpOutPktTooBigs
ipv6IfIcmpOutEchos
ipv6IfIcmpOutEchoReplies
ipv6IfIcmpOutRouterSolicits
ipv6IfIcmpOutRouterAdvertisements
ipv6IfIcmpOutNeighborSolicits
ipv6IfIcmpOutNeighborAdvertisements
ipv6IfIcmpOutRedirects
ipv6IfIcmpOutGroupMembQueries
ipv6IfIcmpOutGroupMembResponses
ipv6IfIcmpOutGroupMembReductions

page 11-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 interface


Displays IPv6 Interface Table.
show ipv6 interface [if_name | loopback]

Syntax Definitions
if_name Interface name. Limits the display to a specific interface.
loopback Limits display to loopback interfaces.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If you do not specify an interface name, all IPv6 interfaces are displayed.

• Specify an interface name (e.g., VLAN 12) to obtain a more detailed information about a specific inter-
face.

Examples
-> show ipv6 interface

Name IPv6 Address/Prefix Length Status Device


--------------------+----------------------------------------+---------+--------
smbif-5 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470/64 Active VLAN 955
212:95:5::35/64
212:95:5::/64
v6if-to-eagle fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470/64 Disabled VLAN 1002
195:35::35/64
195:35::/64
loopback ::1/128 Active loopback

output definitions
Name Interface name. This is usually the VLAN on which the interface is
configured.
IPv6 Address/Prefix Length IPv6 address and prefix length assigned to the interface. If an interface
has more than one IPv6 address assigned to it, each address is shown on
a separate line.
Status Interface status (e.g., Active/Inactive).
Device The device on which the interface is configured (e.g., VLAN 955).

-> show ipv6 interface smbif-5

smbif-5
IPv6 interface index = 16777216(0x01000000)

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-29


IPv6 Commands

Administrative status = Enabled


Operational status = Active
Hardware address = 00:E0:B1:C2:EE:87
Link-local address(es):
fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470/64
Global unicast address(es):
212:95:5::35/64
Anycast address(es):
212:95:5::/64
Joined group addresses:
ff02::1:ff00:0
ff02::2:93da:68lb
ff02::1
ff02::1:ff00:35
Maximum Transfer Unit (MTU) = 1500
Neighbor reachable time (sec) = 538
Base reachable time (sec) = 360
Retransmit timer (ms) = 1000
DAD transmits = 1
Send Router Advertisements = No
Maximum RA interval (sec) = 600
Minimum RA interval (sec) = 198
RA managed config flag = False
RA other config flag = False
RA reachable time (ms) = 30000
RA retransmit timer (ms) = 1000
RA default lifetime (sec) = 1800
RA hop limit = 64
RA send MTU option = No
RA clock skew (sec) = 600
Packets received = 215686
Packets sent = 2019
Bytes received = 14108208
Bytes sent = 178746
Input errors = 0
Output errors = 0
Collisions = 0
Dropped = 0

output definitions
IPv6 interface index IPv6IfIndex value that should be used in SNMP requests pertaining to
this interface.
Administrative status Administrative status of this interface (Enabled/Disabled).
Operational status Indicates whether the physical interface is connected to a device
(Active/Inactive).
Hardware address Interface’s MAC address.
Link-local address Link-local address assigned to the interface.
Global unicast address(es) Global unicast address(es) assigned to the interface.
Joined group address(es) Addresses of the multicast groups that this interface has joined.
Maximum Transfer Unit Interface MTU value.
Send Router Advertisements Indicates if the router sends periodic router advertisements and
responds to router solicitations on the interface.
Maximum RA interval (sec) Maximum time between the transmission of unsolicited router adver-
tisements over the interface.

page 11-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

output definitions (continued)


Minimum RA interval (sec) Minimum time between the transmission of unsolicited router adver-
tisements over the interface (0.33 * Maximum RA Interval).
RA managed config flag True/False value in the managed address configuration flag field in
router advertisements.
RA other config flag The True/False value in the other stateful configuration flag field in
router advertisements sent over this interface.
RA reachable time (ms) Value placed in the reachable time field in the router advertisements
sent over this interface.
RA retransmit timer (ms) Value placed in the retransmit timer field in router advertisements sent
over this interface.
RA default lifetime (ms) The value placed in the router lifetime field in the router advertisements
sent over this interface.
Packets received Number of IPv6 packets received since the last time the counters were
reset.
Packets sent Number of IPv6 packets sent since the last time the counters were reset.
Bytes received Number of bytes of data received since the last time the counters were
reset.
Bytes sent Number of bytes of data sent since the last time the counters were reset.
Input errors Number of input errors received since the last time the counters were
reset.
Output errors Number of output errors received since the last time the counters were
reset.
Collisions Number of collisions since the last time the counters were reset.
Dropped Number of packets dropped since the last time the counters were reset.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 address Configures an IPv6 address on a VLAN.
ipv6 interface Configures an IPv6 interface on a VLAN.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-31


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
ipv6InterfaceTable
ipv6AdminStatus
ipv6PhysicalAddress
ipv6InterfaceAddress
ipv6Address
ipv6AddressPrefix
ipv6IfEffectiveMtu
ipv6IfStatsInReceives
ipv6IfStatsOutRequests
ipv6IfStatsOutForwDatagrams

alaIPv6InterfaceTable
alaIPv6InterfaceName
alaIPv6InterfaceAddress
alaIPv6InterfaceAdminStatus
alaIPv6InterfaceRowStatus
alaIPv6InterfaceDescription
alaIPv6InterfaceMtu
alaIPv6InterfaceType
alaIPv6InterfaceAdminStatus
alaIPv6InterfaceSendRouterAdvertisements
alaIPv6InterfaceMaxRtrAdvInterval
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvManagedFlag
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvOtherConfigFlag
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvReachableTime
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvRetransTimer
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvDefaultLifetime
alaIPv6InterfaceName
alaIPv6InterfaceAdvSendMtu

page 11-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 pmtu table


Displays the IPv6 Path MTU Table.
show ipv6 pmtu table

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 pmtu table

1-PMTU Entry
PMTU entry minimum lifetime = 10m
Destination Address MTU Expires
--------------------------------------------------------+--------+-------
fe80::02d0:c0ff:fe86:1207 1280 1h 0m

output definitions
Destination Address IPv6 address of the path's destination.
MTU Path’s MTU.
Expires Minimum remaining lifetime for the entry.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-33


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 pmtu-lifetime Configures the minimum lifetime for entries in the path MTU
Table.
clear ipv6 pmtu table Removes all the entries from the IPv6 path MTU Table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6ConfigTable
alaIPv6PMTUDest
alaIPv6PMTUexpire

page 11-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

clear ipv6 pmtu table


Removes all the entries from the IPv6 path MTU Table.
clear ipv6 pmtu table

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> clear ipv6 pmtu table

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 pmtu-lifetime Configures the configure the minimum lifetime for entries in the
path MTU Table.
show ipv6 pmtu table Displays the IPv6 path MTU Table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6ConfigTable
alaIpv6ClearPMTUTable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-35


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 neighbors


Displays IPv6 Neighbor Table.
show ipv6 neighbors [ipv6_prefix/prefix_length | if_name | hw hardware_address | static]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_prefix/prefix_length IPv6 prefix. Restricts the display to those neighbors starting with the
specified prefix.
if_name Interface name. Restricts the display to those neighbors reached via the
specified interface.
hardware_address MAC address. Restricts the display to the specified MAC address.
static Restricts display to statically configured neighbors.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify an option (e.g., if_name), all IPv6 neighbors are displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 neighbors

IPv6 Address Hardware Address State Type Port Interface


----------------------------+-------------------+----------+-------+-----+---------
fe80::02d0:c0ff:fe86:1207 00:d0:c0:86:12:07 Probe Dynamic 1/15 vlan_4
fe80::020a:03ff:fe71:fe8d 00:0a:03:71:fe:8d Reachable Dynamic 1/ 5 vlan_17

output definitions
IPv6 Address The neighbor’s IPv6 address.
Hardware Address The MAC address corresponding to the IPv6 address.
State The neighbor’s state:
- Unknown
- Incomplete
- Reachable
- Stale
- Delay
- Probe.
Type Indicates whether the neighbor entry is a Static or Dynamic entry.
Port The port used to reach the neighbor.
Interface The neighbor’s interface name (e.g., vlan_1)

page 11-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 neighbor Configures a static entry in the IPv6 Neighbor Table.

MIB Objects
ipv6IfIndex
alaIPv6NeighborTable
alaIPv6NeighborNetAddress
alaIPv6NeighborPhysAddress
alaIPv6NeighborSlot
alaIPv6NeighborPort
alaIPv6NeighborType
alaIPv6NeighborState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-37


IPv6 Commands

clear ipv6 neighbors


Removes all entries, except static entries, from IPv6 Neighbor Table.
clear ipv6 neighbors

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This commands only clears dynamic entries. If static entries have been added to the table, they must be
removed using the no form of the ipv6 neighbor command.

Examples
-> clear ipv6 neighbors

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 neighbor Configures a static entry in IPv6 Neighbor Table.
show ipv6 neighbors Displays IPv6 Neighbor Table.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6NeighborTable
alaIPv6ClearNeighbors

page 11-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 prefixes


Displays IPv6 prefixes used in router advertisements.
show ipv6 prefixes

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 prefixes

Legend: Flags: A = Autonomous Address Configuration, L = OnLink

Valid Preferred
Name IPv6 Address/Prefix Length Lifetime Lifetime Flags Source
--------------+----------------------------+----------+----------+-------+---------
vlan 955 212:95:5::/64 2592000 604800 LA dynamic
vlan 1002 195:35::/64 2592000 604800 LA dynamic

output definitions
Name The interface name. This is usually the VLAN on which the interface is
configured.
IPv6 Address/Prefix Length The IPv6 prefix and prefix length for a Router Advertisement Prefix
Option.
Valid Lifetime Length of time, in seconds, that this prefix will remain valid (i.e., time
until deprecation). A value of 4,294,967,295 represents infinity.
Preferred Lifetime Length of time, in seconds, that this prefix will remain preferred (i.e.
time until deprecation). A value of 4,294,967,295 represents infinity.
Flags L - Prefix can be used for onlink determination.
A - Prefix can be used for autonomous address configuration (i.e., can
be used to form a local interface address).
Source config - Prefix has been configured by management.
dynamic - Router Advertisements are using interface prefixes.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-39


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 prefix Configures an IPv6 prefix on an interface. Used for configuring
prefixes for router advertisements.

MIB Objects
IPv6AddrPrefixTable
IPv6AddressPrefixEntry
IPv6AddressPrefixLength
IPv6AddressPrefixLinkFlag
IPv6AddressPrefixAdvvalidLifetime
IPv6AddressPrefixAdvPreferredLifetime
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixTable
alaIPv6InterfacePrefix
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixLength
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixValidLifetime
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixPreferredLifetime
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixOnLinkFlag
alaIPv6InterfacePrefixsource

page 11-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 routes


Displays IPv6 Forwarding Table.
show ipv6 routes [ipv6_prefix/prefix_length | static]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_prefix/prefix_length IPv6 prefix. Restricts the display to those routes starting with the speci-
fied prefix.
static Restricts display to statically configured routes.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify an option (e.g., “static”), all IPv6 interfaces are displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 routes

Legend:Flags:U = Up, G = Gateway, H = Host, S = Static, C = Cloneable, D = Dynamic,


M = Modified, R = Unreachable, X = Externally resolved, B = Discard,
L = Link-layer, 1 = Protocol specific, 2 = Protocol specific

Destination Prefix Gateway Address Interface Age Protocol Flags


-------------------+----------------+--------+-----------------+------------+---------+-----
195:35::/64 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470 v6if-to-eagle 18h 51m 55s Local UC
212:95:5::/64 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470 smbif-5 18h 51m 55s Local UC

output definitions
Destination Prefix IPv6 destination address and prefix.
Gateway Address IPv6 address of the gateway used to reach the destination network.
Interface The IPv6 interface name or loopback.
Age Age of the entry. Entries less than 1 day old are displayed in hh:mm:ss
format. Entries more than 1 day old are displayed in dd:hh format.
Protocol Protocol by which the route was learned.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-41


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 route Configures a static entry in the IPv6 route.

MIB Objects
IPv6RouteTable
IPv6Routes
IPv6RoutesPrefix
IPV6RoutesStatic
alaIPv6StaticRouteTable
alaIPv6StaticRouteEntry

page 11-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 route-pref


Displays the IPv6 routing preference of the router.
show ipv6 route-pref

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 route-pref
Protocol Route Preference Value
------------+------------------------
Local 1
Static 2
RIP 120

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 route-pref Configures the IPv6 route preference of a router.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-43


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 router database


Displays a list of all routes (static and dynamic) that exist in the IPv6 router database. This database serves
as a central repository where routes are first processed for redistribution and where duplicate routes are
compared to determine the best route to use. If a route does not appear in the IPv6 router database list, then
the switch does not know about it. In the case of dynamically learned routes, this could indicate that the
route was never received by the switch.
show iv6p router database [protocol type | gateway ipv6_address | dest ipv6_prefix/prefix_length]

Syntax Definitions
type Routing protocol type (local, static, or RIP).
gateway ipv6_address IPv6 address of the next hop used to reach the destination IPv6 address.
ipv6_prefix IPv6 network that is the destination of this static route.
/prefix_length The number of bits that are significant in the iPv6 address (mask).
(0...128).

Defaults
By default, all routes are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The IPv6 forwarding table is derived from IPv6 router database processing performed by the switch
and contains only unique routes that the switch currently uses. Use the show ipv6 routes command to
view the forwarding table.
• If an expected route does not appear in the IPv6 forwarding table, use the show ipv6 router database
command to see if the switch knows about the route and/or if a duplicate route with a higher prece-
dence was selected instead.
• The switch compares the protocol of duplicate routes to determine which one to use. Regardless of
whether or not a route has a higher priority metric value, protocol determines precedence. Local routes
are given the highest level of precedence followed by static, then RIP routes. As a result, a route that is
known to the switch may not appear in the IP forwarding table if a duplicate route with a higher proto-
col precedence exists.
• A list of inactive static routes is also included in the show ipv6 router database output display. A
route becomes inactive if the interface for its gateway goes down. Inactive routes are unable to get to
their destination and further investigation is warranted to determine why their gateway is unavailable.
• Routes that appear as inactive are not included in the main IP router database listing. If an inactive
route becomes active, however, it is removed from the inactive list and added to the active route list.

page 11-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Examples

-> show ipv6 router database


Legend: + indicates routes in use

Total IPRM IPv6 routes: 5

Destination/Prefix Gateway Address Interface Protocol Metric


-------------------+-------------------------+-----------------+---------+-------
195:35::/64 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470 v6if-to-eagle RIP 2
212:95:5::/64 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:f470 smbif-5 Local 1

Inactive Static Routes:

VLAN Destination/Prefix Gateway Address Metric


-----+-------------------+-------------------------+-------
1510 212:95:5::/64 fe80::2d0:95ff:fe6a:f458 1

output definitions
Destination/Prefix IPv6 destination address and prefix.
Gateway Address IPv6 address of the gateway used to reach the destination network.
Interface The IPv6 interface name or loopback.
Protocol Protocol by which this IPv6 address was learned (LOCAL, STATIC,
RIP).
Metric RIP metric or cost (hop count) for the route. Indicates a priority for the
route. The lower the metric value, the higher the priority.
VLAN The VLAN on which the route was learned, not forwarded. Note that
N/A appears in this field for static routes as they are not learned on a
VLAN.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 routes Displays the IPv6 Forwarding Table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-45


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 tcp ports


Displays TCP Over IPv6 Connection Table. This table contains information about existing TCP connec-
tions between IPv6 endpoints.
show ipv6 tcp ports

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Only connections between IPv6 addresses are contained in this table.

Examples
-> show ipv6 tcp ports

Local Address Port Remote Address Port Interface State


--------------------+-------------------------------------+------+--------------+--------
:: 21 :: 0 listen
:: 23 :: 0 listen
2002:d423:2323::35 21 212:61:61:0:2b0:doff:fe43:d4f8 34144 v6if-6to4-137 established
2002:d423:2323::35 49153 212:61:61:0:2b0:d0ff:fe43:d4f8 34144 v6if-6to4-137 established

output definitions
Local Address Local address for this TCP connection. For ports in the “Listen” state,
which accepts connections on any IPv6 interface, the address is ::0.
Port Local port number for the TCP connection.
Remote Address Remote IPv6 address for the connection. If the connection is in the
“Listen” state, the address is ::0.
Port Remote port number for the TCP connection. If the connection is in the
“Listen” state, the port number is 0.
Interface Name of the interface (or “unknown”) over which the connection is
established.
State State of the TCP connection as defined in RFC 793.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 11-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands
show ipv6 udp ports Displays the UDP Over IPv6 Listener Table.

MIB Objects
IPv6TcpConnTable
IPv6TcpConnEntry
IPv6TcpConnLocalAddress
IPv6TcpConnLocalPort
IPv6TcpConnRemAddress
IPv6TcpConnRemPort
IPv6TcpConnIfIndex
IPv6TcpConnState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-47


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 traffic


Displays IPv6 traffic statistics.
show ipv6 traffic [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
if_name Interface name. Restricts the display to the specified interface instead of
global statistics.

Defaults
N/A.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The statistics show the cumulative totals since the last time the switch was powered on, the last reset of the
switch was executed or the traffic statistics were cleared using the command.

Examples
-> show ipv6 traffic

Global IPv6 Statistics


Packets received
Total = 598174
Header errors = 0
Too big = 12718
No route = 4
Address errors = 0
Unknown protocol = 0
Truncated packets = 0
Local discards = 0
Delivered to users = 582306
Reassembly needed = 0
Reassembled = 0
Reassembly failed = 0
Multicast Packets = 118
Packets sent
Forwarded = 3146
Generated = 432819
Local discards = 0
Fragmented = 0
Fragmentation failed = 0
Fragments generated = 0
Multicast packets = 265

page 11-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

output definitions
Total Total number of input packets received, including those received in
error.
Header errors Number of input packets discarded due to errors in their IPv6
headers (e.g., version number mismatch, other format errors, hop
count exceeded, and errors discovered in processing their IPv6
options).
Too big Number of input packets that could not be forwarded because their
size exceeded the link MTU of the outgoing interface.
No route Number of input packets discarded because no route could be
found to transmit them to their destination.
Address errors Number of input packets discarded because the IPv6 address in
their IPv6 header's destination field was not a valid address to be
received at this entity. This count includes invalid addresses (e.g., ::0)
and unsupported addresses (e.g., addresses with unallocated prefixes).
Unknown protocol Number of locally-addressed packets received successfully but dis-
carded because of an unknown or unsupported protocol.
Truncated packets Number of input packets discarded because the packet frame
did not carry enough data.
Local discards Number of input IPv6 packets for which no problems were encountered
to prevent their continued processing, but which were discarded (e.g.,
for lack of buffer space). Note that this counter does not include any
packets discarded while awaiting re-assembly.
Delivered to users Total number of packets successfully delivered to IPv6 user protocols
(including ICMP).
Reassembly needed Number of IPv6 fragments received that needed to be reassembled.
Reassembled Number of IPv6 packets successfully reassembled.
Reassembly failed Number of failures detected by the IPv6 reassembly algorithm (for
whatever reason: timed out, errors, etc.).
Multicast packets Number of multicast packets received.
Forwarded Number of output packets that this entity received and forwarded to
their final destinations.
Generated Total number of IPv6 packets that local IPv6 user-protocols (including
ICMP) supplied to IPv6 in requests for transmission. Note that
this counter does not include any packets counted by the Forwarded
statistic.
Local discards Number of output IPv6 packets for which no problem was encountered
to prevent their transmission to their destination, but were discarded
(e.g., for lack of buffer space). Note that this counter would include
packets counted by the Forwarded statistic if any such packets met this
(discretionary) discard criterion.
Fragmented Number of IPv6 packets successfully fragmented.
Fragmentation failed Number of IPv6 packets discarded because they needed to be frag-
mented but could not be.
Fragments generated Number of output packet fragments generated as a result of fragmenta-
tion.
Multicast packets Number of multicast packets transmitted.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-49


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 icmp statistics Displays IPv6 ICMP statistics.

MIB Objects
ipv6IfStatsTable
ipv6IfStatsInReceives
ipv6IfStatsInHdrErrors
ipv6IfStatsInTooBigErrors
ipv6IfStatsInNoRoutes
ipv6IfStatsInAddrErrors
ipv6IfStatsInUnknownProtos
ipv6IfStatsInTruncatedPkts
ipv6IfStatsInDiscards
ipv6IfStatsInDelivers
ipv6IfStatsOutForwDatagrams
ipv6IfStatsOutRequests
ipv6IfStatsOutDiscards
ipv6IfStatsOutFragOKs
ipv6IfStatsOutFragFails
ipv6IfStatsOutFragCreates
ipv6IfStatsReasmReqds
ipv6IfStatsReasmOKs
ipv6IfStatsReasmFails
ipv6IfStatsInMcastPkts
ipv6IfStatsOutMcastPkts

page 11-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

clear ipv6 traffic


Resets all IPv6 traffic counters.
clear ipv6 traffic

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the show ipv6 traffic command to view current IPv6 traffic statistics.

Examples
-> clear ipv6 traffic

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 traffic Displays IPv6 traffic statistics.

MIB Objects
alaIPv6ConfigTable
alaIPv6ClearTraffic

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-51


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 udp ports


Displays UDP Over IPv6 Listener Table. This table contains information about UDP/IPv6 endpoints.
show ipv6 udp ports

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Only endpoints utilizing IPv6 addresses are displayed in this table.

Examples
-> show ipv6 udp ports

Local Address Port Interface


---------------------------------------------+-----+--------------------
:: 521

output definitions
Local Address Local IPv6 address for this UDP listener. If a UDP listener accepts
packets for any IPv6 address associated with the switch, the value is ::0.
Port Local Port number for the UDP connection.
Interface Name of the interface the listener is using or “unknown.”

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ipv6 tcp ports Displays TCP Over IPv6 Connection Table.

page 11-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
IPv6UdpTable
IPv6UdpEntry
IPv6UdpLocalAddress
IPv6UdpLocalPort
IPv6UdpIfIndex

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-53


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 information


Displays IPv6 information.
show ipv6 information

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 information

Default hop limit = 64


Path MTU entry minimum lifetime (min) = 60
Neighbor stale lifetime (min) = 1440

output definitions
Default hop limit The value placed in the hop limit field in router advertisements
Path MTU entry minimum Minimum lifetime for entries in the path MTU.
lifetime
Neighbor stale lifetime Minimum lifetime for neighbor entries in the stale state.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ipv6 neighbor Configures a static entry in the IPv6 Neighbor Table.
ipv6 pmtu-lifetime Configures the minimum lifetime for entries in the path MTU
Table.
ipv6 hop-limit Configures the value placed in the hop limit field in the header of
all IPv6 packet.

page 11-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
ipv6MibObjects
Ipv6DefaultHopLimit
alaIPv6ConfigTable
alaIPv6PMTUMinLifetime
alaIPv6NeighborTable
alaIPv6NeighborStaleLifetime

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-55


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 redist
Controls the conditions for redistributing IPv6 routes between different protocols.
ipv6 redist {local | static | rip} into {rip} route-map route-map-name
[status {enable | disable}]
no ipv6 redist {local | static} into {rip} [route-map route-map-name]

Syntax Definitions
local Redistributes local IPv6 routes.
static Redistributes static IPv6 routes.
route-map-name Name of an existing route map that will control the redistribution of
routes between the source and destination protocol.
enable Enables the administrative status of the redistribution configuration.
disable Disables the administrative status of the redistribution configuration.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a route map redistribution configuration. Note that if a
route map name is not specified, all route maps associated with the redistribution configuration are
removed.
• The source and destination protocols must be loaded and enabled before redistribution occurs.

• Use the ip route-map commands described in the “IP Commands” chapter of this guide to create a
route map. Refer to the “Configuring IP” chapter in the OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide for
more information about how to create a route map.

Examples
-> ipv6 redist rip into static route-map rip-to-static1
-> ipv6 redist rip into static route-map rip-to-static2
-> no ipv6 redist rip into static route-map rip-to-ospf2
-> ipv6 redist local into rip route-map local-to-rip
-> ipv6 redist local into rip route-map local-to-rip disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 11-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 redist Displays the route map redistribution configuration.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapRedistProtoTable
alaRouteMapRedistSrcProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistDestProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapRedistStatus
alaRouteMapRedistAddressType
alaRouteMapRedistRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-57


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 access-list
Creates an IPv6 access list that is used to specify multiple IPv6 addresses for a route map configuration.
ipv6 access-list access-list-name
no ipv6 access-list access-list-name

Syntax Definitions
access-list-name Name of the IPv6 access list (up to 20 characters).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to delete the access list.

Examples
-> ipv6 access-list access1
-> no ipv6 access-list access1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 access-list address Adds IPv6 addresses to an existing IPv6 access list.
show ipv6 access-list Displays the contents of an IPv6 access list.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapAccessListNameTable
alaRouteMapAccessListName
alaRouteMapAccessListNameIndex
alaRouteMapAccessListNameAddressType
alaRouteMapAccessListNameRowStatus

page 11-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 access-list address


Adds IPv6 addresses to the specified IPv6 access list.
ipv6 access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen [action {permit | deny}]
[redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}]
no ipv6 access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen

Syntax Definitions
access-list-name Name of the IPv6 access list (up to 20 characters).
address/prefixLen IPv6 address along with the prefix length to be added to the access list.
permit Permits the IPv6 address for redistribution.
deny Denies the IPv6 address for redistribution.
all-subnets Redistributes or denies all the subnet routes that match the network
portion of the IP address as specified by the mask length.
no-subnets Redistributes or denies only those routes that exactly match the IP
address and the mask length.
aggregate Redistributes an aggregate route if there are one or more routes that
match or are subnets of this address.

Defaults

parameter default
permit | deny permit
all-subnets | no-subnets | all-subnets
aggregate

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the address from the access list.

• The access-list-name should exist before you add multiple IPv6 addresses to the IPv6 access list.

• The action parameters (permit and deny) determine if a route that matches the redist-control configu-
ration for the IP address is allowed or denied redistribution.
• The redist-control parameters (all-subnets, no-subnets, and aggregate) defines the criteria used to
determine if a route matches an address in the access list.
• Note that configuring the combination of redist-control aggregate with action deny is not allowed.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-59


IPv6 Commands

• Use this command multiple times with the same access list name to add multiple addresses to the exist-
ing IPv6 access list.

Examples
-> ipv6 access-list access1 address 2001::1/64 action permit
-> ipv6 access-list access1 address 2001::1/64 redist-control aggregate
-> no ipv6 access-list access1 address 2001::1/64

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 access-list Creates an IPv6 access list that is used to specify multiple IPv6
addresses for a route map configuration.
show ipv6 access-list Displays the contents of an IPv6 access list.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapAccessListTable
alaRouteMapAccessListIndex
alaRouteMapAccessListAddress
alaRouteMapAccessListAddressType
alaRouteMapAccessListPrefixLength
alaRouteMapAccessListAction
alaRouteMapAccessListRedistControl
alaRouteMapAccessListRowStatus

page 11-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 redist


Displays the IPv6 route map redistribution configuration.
show ipv6 redist [rip]

Syntax Definitions
rip Displays the route map redistribution configurations that specify RIP as
the destination (into) protocol.

Defaults
By default all route map redistribution configurations are shown.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify a destination protocol with this command to display only those configurations that redistribute
routes into the specified protocol.
• The IPv6 version of BGP is not supported currently.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Examples
-> show ipv6 redist

Source Destination
Protocol Protocol Status Route Map
------------+------------+---------+--------------------
localIPv6 RIPng Enabled ipv6rm

output definitions
Source Protocol The protocol from which the routes are learned.
Destination Protocol The protocol into which the source protocol routes are redistributed..
Status The administrative status (Enabled or Disabled) of the route map
redistribution configuration.
Route Map The name of the route map that is applied with this redistribution
configuration.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-61


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 redist Controls the conditions for redistributing IPv6 routes between
different protocols.

MIB Objects
alaRouteMapRedistProtoTable
alaRouteMapRedistSrcProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistDestProtoId
alaRouteMapRedistRouteMapIndex
alaRouteMapRedistStatus
alaRouteMapRedistAddressType
alaRouteMapRedistRowStatus

page 11-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 access-list


Displays the contents of the specified IPv6 access list.
show ip access-list [access-list-name]

Syntax Definitions
access-list-name Name of the IPv6 access list.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If the access-list-name is not specified in this command, all the access lists will be displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 access-list
Address / Redistribution
Name Prefix Length Effect Control
--------------------+------------------+-------+--------------
al_3 128::/64 permit all-subnets
al_4 124::/64 permit no-subnets

-> show ipv6 access-list 4

Address / Redistribution
Name Prefix Length Effect Control
--------------------+------------------+-------+--------------
al_4 124::/64 permit no-subnets

output definitions
Name Name of the IPv6 access list.
Address/Prefix Length IPv6 address that belongs to the access list.
Effect Indicates whether the IPv6 address is permitted or denied for redistribu-
tion.
Redistribution Control Indicates the conditions specified for redistributing the matched routes.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-63


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 access-list Creates an IPv6 access list for adding multiple IPv6 addresses to route
maps.
ipv6 access-list address Adds multiple IPv6 addresses to the IPv6 access list.

MIB objects
alaRouteMapAccessListIndex
alaRouteMapAccessListAddressType
alaRouteMapAccessListAddress
alaRouteMapAccessListPrefixLength
alaRouteMapAccessListAction
alaRouteMapAccessListRedistControl

page 11-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 load rip


Loads RIPng into memory. When the switch is initially configured, you must load RIPng into memory to
enable RIPng routing.
ipv6 load rip

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• RIPng will support a maximum of 1,000 routes.

• RIPng will support a maximum of 20 interfaces.

• Use the ipv6 rip status command to enable RIPng on the switch.

Examples
-> ipv6 load rip

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip status Enables/disables RIPng routing on the switch.


show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration parameters.

MIB Objects
alaDrcTmConfig
alaDrcTmIPRipngStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-65


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip status


Enables or disables RIPng on the switch.
ipv6 rip status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
RIPng must be loaded on the switch (ipv6 load rip) to enable RIP on the switch.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip status enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 load rip Loads RIPng into memory.


show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration parameters.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngProtoStatus

page 11-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip invalid-timer


Configures the amount of time a route remains active in RIB before being moved to the "Garbage" state.
ipv6 rip invalid-timer seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Time, in seconds, that a route will remain in an “Active” state. Valid
range is 1 - 300.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 180

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This timer is reset each time a routing update is received.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip invalid-timer 300

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip garbage-timer Configures the RIPng garbage timer value.


ipv6 rip holddown-timer Configures the amount of time a route is placed in a holddown state.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngInvalidTimer

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-67


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip garbage-timer


Configures the RIPng garbage timer value. When a route in the RIB exceeds the configured Invalid Timer
Value, the route is moved to a “Garbage” state in the the RIB. The garbage timer is the length of time a
route will stay in this state before it is flushed from the RIB.
ipv6 rip garbage-timer seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Time, in seconds, that a route will remain in the RIPng Routing Table
before it is flushed from the RIB. Valid range is 0 - 180.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 120

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the ipv6 rip invalid-timer command to set the Invalid Timer Value.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip garbage-timer 180

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip invalid-timer Configures the amount of time a route remains active in RIB before
being moved to the "Garbage" state.
ipv6 rip holddown-timer Configures the amount of time a route is placed in a holddown state.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngGarbageTimer

page 11-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip holddown-timer


Configures the amount of time a route is placed in a holddown state. Whenever a route is seen from the
same gateway with a higher metric than the route in RIB, the route goes into holddown. This excludes
route updates with an INFINITY metric.
ipv6 rip holddown-timer seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Time, in seconds, that a route will remain in a holddown state. Valid
range is 0 - 120.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
While in holddown, the route continues being announced as usual and used in RIB. This interval is used to
control route flap dampening.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip holddown-timer 60

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip invalid-timer Configures the amount of time a route remains active in RIB before
being moved to the "Garbage" state.
ipv6 rip garbage-timer Configures the RIPng garbage timer value.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngHolddownTimer

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-69


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip jitter


Configures an offset value for RIPng updates. This is the maximum (positive or negative) value that can
be used to offset the update interval. For example, with an update interval of 30 seconds, and a jitter value
of 5 seconds, the RIPng update packet would be sent somewhere (random) between 25 and 35 seconds
from the previous update.
ipv6 rip jitter value

Syntax Definitions
value Time, in seconds, that a routing update is offset. Valid range is 0 to one-
half the updated interval value (e.g., if the updated interval is 30, the
range would be 0 - 300).

Defaults

parameter default
value 5

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
As you increase the number of RIPng interfaces/peers, it is recommended that you increase the Jitter value
to reduce the number of RIPng updates being sent over the network.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip jitter 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip update-interval Configures the RIPng update interval.


show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngJitter

page 11-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip route-tag


Configures the route tag value for RIP routes generated by the switch.
ipv6 rip route-tag value

Syntax Definitions
value Route tag value. Valid range is 0 – 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This value does not apply to routes learned from other routers. For these routes, the route tag propagates
with the route.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip route-tag 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngRouteTag

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-71


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip update-interval


Configures the RIPng update interval. This is the interval, in seconds, that RIPng routing updates will be
sent out.
ipv6 rip update-interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Interval, in seconds, that RIPng routing updates are sent out. Valid range
is 0–120.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 30

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command, along with the ipv6 rip jitter command to configure RIPng updates.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip update-interval 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip jitter Configures an offset value for RIPng updates.


show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaRipng
alaRipngUpdateInterval

page 11-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip triggered-sends


Configures the behavior of triggered updates.
ipv6 rip triggered-sends {all | updated-only | none}

Syntax Definitions
all All RIPng routes are added to any triggered updates.
updated-only Only route changes that are causing the triggered update are included in
the update packets.
none RIPng routes are not added to triggered updates.

Defaults

parameter default
all | updated-only | none updated-only

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If set to all, all routes are sent in the update, not just route changes, which increases RIPng traffic on
the network.
• If set to none, no triggered updates are sent, which can cause delays in network convergence.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip triggered-sends none

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolripng
alaRipngTriggeredSends

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-73


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip interface


Creates or deletes a RIPng interface.
ipv6 rip interface if_name
[no] ipv6 rip interface if_name

Syntax Definitions
if_name IPv6 interface name.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• By default, a RIPng interface is created in the enabled state.

• Routing is enabled on a VLAN when you create a router port. However, to enable RIPng routing, you
must also configure and enable a RIPng routing interface on the VLAN’s IP router port. For more
information on VLANs and router ports, see Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands”.
• RIPng will support a maximum of 20 interfaces.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip interface Test_Lab

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 11-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 redist Loads RIPng into memory.


ipv6 rip status Enables or disables RIPng on the switch.
ipv6 rip interface recv-status Configures IPv6 RIPng interface “Receive” status. When this status
is set to "enable", packets can be received on this interface.
ipv6 rip interface send-status Configures IPv6 RIPng interface “Send” status. When this status is
set to "enable", packets can be sent on this interface.
show ipv6 rip interface Displays information for all or specified RIPng interfaces.

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-75


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip interface metric


Configures the RIPng metric or cost for a specified interface. You can set priorities for routes generated by
a switch by assigning a metric value to routes generated by that switch’s RIPng interface. For example,
routes generated by a neighboring switch may have a hop count of 1. However, you can lower the priority
of routes generated by that switch by increasing the metric value for routes generated by the RIPng inter-
face.
ipv6 rip interface if_name metric value

Syntax Definitions
if_name IPv6 interface name.
value Metric value. Valid range is 1 - 15.

Defaults

parameter default
value 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When you configure a metric for a RIPng interface, this metric cost is added to the metric of the incoming
route.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip Test_Lab metric 1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip interface Creates or deletes a RIPng interface.


show ipv6 rip interface Displays information for all or specified RIPng interfaces.

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceMetric

page 11-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip interface recv-status


Configures IPv6 RIPng interface “Receive” status. When this status is set to "enable", packets can be
received on this interface. When it is set to "disable", packets will not be received on this interface.
ipv6 rip interface if_name recv-status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
if_name IPv6 interface name.
enable | disable Interface “Receive” status.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
RIPng must be loaded (ipv6 load rip) and enabled (ipv6 rip status)on the switch to send or receive pack-
ets on the interface.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip interface Test_Lab recv-status disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 redist Loads RIPng into memory.


ipv6 rip status Enables/disables RIPng on the switch.
ipv6 rip interface send-status Configures IPv6 RIPng interface “Send” status.

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceRecvStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-77


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip interface send-status


Configures IPv6 RIPng interface “Send” status. When this status is set to "enable", packets can be sent
from this interface. When it is set to "disable", packets will not be sent from this interface.
ipv6 rip interface if_name send-status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
if name IPv6 interface name.
enable | disable Interface “Send” status.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
RIPng must be loaded (ipv6 load rip) and enabled (ipv6 rip status)on the switch to send or receive pack-
ets on the interface.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip interface Test_Lab send-status enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 redist Loads RIPng into memory.


ipv6 rip status Enables/disables RIPng on the switch.
ipv6 rip interface recv-status Configures IPv6 RIPng interface “Receive” status.

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceSendStatus

page 11-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

ipv6 rip interface horizon


Configures the routing loop prevention mechanisms.
ipv6 rip interface if_name horizon {none | split-only | poison}

Syntax Definitions
if_name IPv6 interface name.
none | split-only | poison none - Disables loop prevention mechanisms.
split-only - Enables split-horizon, without poison-reverse.
poison - Enables split-horizon with poison-reverse.

Defaults

parameter default
none | split-only | poison poison

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If set to none the route is not sent back to the peer.

• If set to split-only, the route received from the peer is sent back with an increased metric.

• If set to poison the route received from the peer is sent back with an “infinity” metric.

Examples
-> ipv6 rip interface Test_Lab none

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 rip interface Displays information for all or specified RIPng interfaces.
show ipv6 rip routes Displays all or a specific set of routes in the RIPng Routing Table.

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceHorizon

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-79


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 rip


Displays the RIPng status and general configuration parameters.
show ipv6 rip

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 rip

Status = Enabled,
Number of routes = 10,
Route tag = 0,
Update interval = 30,
Invalid interval = 180,
Garbage interval = 120,
Holddown interval = 0,
Jitter interval = 5,
Triggered Updates = All Routes,

output definitions
Status RIPng protocol status (enabled or disabled).
Number of routes Number of RIPng routes in Forwarding Information Base (FIB).
Route tag Route tag value for RIP routes generated by the switch. Valid range is
0-65535. Default is 0.
Invalid interval Invalid Timer setting, in seconds.
Garbage interval Garbage Timer setting, in seconds.
Holddown interval Holddown Timer setting, in seconds.
Jitter interval Jitter setting.
Triggered updates Triggered Updates setting (All Routes, Updated Routes, and None).

page 11-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip status Enables or disables RIPng routing on the switch.


ipv6 rip route-tag Configures the route tag value for RIP routes generated by the
switch.
ipv6 rip update-interval Configures the Interval, in seconds, so that RIPng routing updates
are sent out.
ipv6 rip invalid-timer Configures the amount of time a route remains active in RIB before
being moved to the "garbage" state.
ipv6 rip invalid-timer Configures the RIPng garbage timer value. Routes move into the
garbage collection state because the timer expired or a route update
with an INFINITY metric was received.
ipv6 rip holddown-timer Configures the amount of time a route is placed in a holddown state.
ipv6 rip jitter Configures an offset value for RIPng updates. This is the maximum
(positive or negative) value that can be used to offset the update
interval.
ipv6 rip triggered-sends Configures the behavior of triggered updates.

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceStatus
alaRipngRouteTag
laRipngInvalidTimer
alaRipngGarbageTimer
alaRipngHolddownTimer
alaRipngJitter
alaRipngTriggeredSends

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-81


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 rip interface


Displays information for all or specified RIPng interfaces.
show ipv6 rip interface [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
if_name IPv6 interface name.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify an interface, all IPv6 RIP interfaces are displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 rip interface

Interface Packets
Name Status Recvd Sent Metric
--------------------+----------+---------+--------+---------
Test_Lab Active 12986 12544 1
Test_Lab_2 Active 12556 12552 1

-> show ipv6 rip interface if3

Name = Test_Lab,
IPv6 interface index = 3,
Interface status = Active,
Next Update = 27 secs,
Horizon Mode = Split and Poison-reverse,
MTU size = 1500,
Metric = 1,
Send status = Enabled,
Receive status = Enabled,
Packets received = 12986,
Packets sent = 12544,

output definitions
Interface name Interface name.
IPv6 interface index IPv6 index of this interface.
Status Interface status (Active/Inactive).
Packets Recvd Number of packets received by the interface.

page 11-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

output definitions (continued)


Packets Sent Number of packets sent by the interface.
Metric RIPng metric (cost) configured for the interface.
IPv6 interface index IPv6 interface index number.
Interface status Interface status (Active/Inactive).
Next update Seconds remaining until the next update on this interface.
Horizon mode Interface Horizon Mode (routing loop prevention mechanisms). Dis-
played modes are none/split-only/poison-reverse.
MTU size Maximum transmission size for RIPng packets on the interface.
Send status Interface “Send” status. When this status is set to "enable", packets can
be sent from this interface. When it is set to "disable", packets will not
be sent from this interface.
Receive status Interface “Receive” status. When this status is set to "enable", packets
can be received by this interface. When it is set to "disable", packets
cannot be received by this interface.
Packets received Number of packets received by the interface.
Packets sent Number of packets sent by the interface.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip interface IPv6 interface name.


ipv6 rip status Enables or disables RIPng routing on the switch.
ipv6 rip interface recv-status Configures the interface “Receive” status. When this status is set to
"enable", packets can be received by this interface. When it is set to
"disable", packets cannot be received by this interface.
ipv6 rip interface send-status Configures the interface “Send” status. When this status is set to
"enable", packets can be sent from this interface. When it is set to
"disable", packets will not be sent from this interface.
ipv6 rip interface metric Configures the RIPng metric (cost) for the interface.
ipv6 rip interface horizon Configures the interface Horizon Mode (routing loop prevention
mechanisms).
show ipv6 rip Displays RIPng status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
force holddown timer).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-83


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
alaRipngInterfaceTable
alaRipngInterfaceEntry
alaRipngInterfaceStatus
alaRipngInterfacePacketsRcvd
alaRipngInterfacePacketsSent
alaRipngInterfaceMetric
alaRipngInterfaceIndex
alaRipngInterfaceNextUpdate
alaRipngInterfaceHorizon
alaRipngInterfaceMTU
alaRipngInterfaceSendStatus
alaRipngInterfaceRecvStatus

page 11-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 rip peer


Displays a summary of the observed RIPng peers, or specific information about a peer when a peer
address is provided.
show ipv6 rip peer [ipv6_addresss]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_addresss IPv6 address of the peer.

Defaults
N/A.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify a peer, all IPv6 RIP peers are displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 peer
Seen on Packets Last
Address Interface Recv Update
-----------------------------+-------------+--------+----------
fe80::200:39ff:fe1f:710c vlan172 23 20
fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40 bkbone20 33 2
fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40 vlan150 26 25
fe80::2d0:95ff:fe6a:5d41 nssa23 20 25

-> show ipv6 rip peer fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40

Peer#1 address = fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40,


Seen on interface = bkbone20,
Last Update = 8 secs,
Received packets = 33,
Received bad packets = 0
Received routes = 5,
Received bad routes = 0

Peer#2 address = fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40,


Seen on interface = vlan150,
Last Update = 1 secs,
Received packets = 27,
Received bad packets = 0
Received routes = 2,
Received bad routes = 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-85


IPv6 Commands

output definitions
Address IPv6 address of the peer.
Seen on Interface Interface used to reach the peer.
Packets Recvd Number of packets received from the peer.
Last Update Number of seconds since the last update was received from the peer.
Peer address Peer IPv6 address.
Received packets Number of packets received from the peer.
Received bad packets Number of bad packets received from the peer.
Received routes Number of RIPng routes received from the peer.
Received bad routes Number of bad RIPng routes received from the peer.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 rip interface Displays all or specified RIPng interface status.
show ipv6 rip routes Displays all or a specific set of routes in RIPng Routing Table.

MIB Objects
alaRipngPeerTable
alaRipngPeerEntry
alaRipngPeerAddress
alaRipngPeerIndex
alaRipngPeerLastUpdate
alaRipngPeerNumUpdates
alaRipngPeerBadPackets
alaRipngPeerNumRoutes
alaRipngPeerBadRoutes

page 11-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

show ipv6 rip routes


Displays all or a specific set of routes in RIPng Routing Table.
show ipv6 rip routes [dest <ipv6_prefix/prefix_length>] | [gateway <ipv6_addr>] | [detail <ipv6
prefix/prefix_length>]

Syntax Definitions
dest Displays all routes whose destination matches the IPv6 prefix/prefix
length.
gateway Displays all routes whose gateway matches the specified IPv6 address.
detail Displays detailed information about a single route matching the speci-
fied destination.
ipv6_addr IPv6 address.
ipv6_prefix/prefix length IPv6 address and prefix/prefix length.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not enter one of the optional parameters, all IPv6 RIP routes are displayed.

Examples
-> show ipv6 rip routes

Legends: State: A = Active, H = Holddown, G = Garbage


Destination Gateway State Metric Proto
---------------+----------------------------+-------+------+------
100::1/128 +fe80::200:39ff:fe1f:710c A 2 Rip
100::100:1/128 +fe80::200:39ff:fe1f:710c A 2 Rip
400::/100 +fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:e050 A 1 Local
900::/100 +fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:e050 A 1 Local
8900::/100 +fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40 A 2 Rip
9800::/100 +fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40 A 2 Rip
9900::/100 +fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:e050 A 1 Local

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-87


IPv6 Commands

-> show ipv6 rip routes detail 9900::/100

Destination = 9900::,
Mask length = 100,
Gateway(1) = fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:e050,
Protocol = Local,
Out Interface = nssa23,
Metric = 1,
Status = Installed,
State = Active,
Age = 10544s,
Tag = 0,
Gateway(2) = fe80::2d0:95ff:fe12:da40,
Protocol = Rip,
Out Interface = bkbone20,
Metric = 2,
Status = Not Installed,
State = Active,
Age = 15s,
Tag = 0,

output definitions
Destination IPv6 address/address length of the destination.
Gateway IPv6 gateway used to reach the destination.
State Route status (Active/Inactive).
Metric Routing metric for this route.
Protocol Protocol used to learn the route.
Mask Length Prefix Length.
Out Interface The interface used to reach the destination.
Status Route status (Active/Inactive).
Age The number of seconds since the route was last updated.
Tag The route tag value for the route.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 rip interface Creates/deletes a RIPng interface.


ipv6 rip interface metric Configures the RIPng metric or cost for a specified interface.
show ipv6 rip interface Displays all or specified RIPng interface status.

page 11-88 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IPv6 Commands

MIB Objects
alaRipngRouteTable
alaRipngRouteEntry
alaRipngRoutePrefixLen
alaRipngRouteNextHop
alaRipngRouteType
alaRipngRouteAge
alaRipngRouteTag
alaRipngRouteStatus
alaRipngRouteMetric

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11-89


IPv6 Commands

page 11-90 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


12 RIP Commands

Routing Information Protocol (RIP) is an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) that uses hop count as its rout-
ing metric. RIP-enabled switches update neighboring switches by transmitting a copy of their own routing
table. The RIP routing table always uses the most efficient route to a destination, that is, the route with the
fewest hops and longest matching prefix.
The switch supports RIP version 1 (RIPv1), RIP version 2 (RIPv2), and RIPv2 that is compatible with
RIPv1. It also supports simple and MD5 authentication, on an interface basis, for RIPv2.
The RIP commands comply with the following RFCs: RFC1058, RFC2453, RFC1722, RFC1723, and
RFC1724.
MIB information for the RIP commands is as follows:
Filename: RIPv2.mib
Module: rip2
Filename: AlcatelIND1Rip.mib
Module: alaRipMIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

ip load rip
ip rip status
ip rip interface
ip rip interface status
ip rip interface metric
ip rip interface send-version
ip rip interface recv-version
ip rip force-holddowntimer
ip rip host-route
ip rip route-tag
ip rip interface auth-type
ip rip interface auth-key
ip rip update-interval
ip rip invalid-timer
ip rip garbage-timer
ip rip holddown-timer
show ip rip
show ip rip routes
show ip rip interface
show ip rip peer

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-1


RIP Commands

ip load rip
Loads RIP into memory. When the switch is initially configured, you must load RIP into memory before it
can be enabled.
ip load rip

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• In simple networks where only IP forwarding is required, you may not want to use RIP. If you are not
using RIP, it is best not to load it to save switch resources.
• To remove RIP from switch memory, you must manually edit the boot.cfg file. The boot.cfg file is an
ASCII text-based file that controls many of the switch parameters. Open the file and delete all refer-
ences to RIP. You must reboot the switch when this is complete.
• Use the ip rip status command to enable RIP on the switch.

Examples
-> ip load rip

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip status Enables/disables RIP routing on the switch.


show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaDrcTmConfig
alaDrcTmIPRipStatus

page 12-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip status
Enables/disables RIP on the switch. RIP performs well in small networks. By default, RIP packets are
broadcast every 30 seconds, even if no change has occurred anywhere in a route or service. Depending on
the size and speed of the network, these periodic broadcasts can consume a significant amount of band-
width.
ip rip status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables RIP routing on the switch.
disable Disables RIP routing on the switch.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• RIP must be loaded on the switch (ip load rip) to enable RIP on the switch.

• A RIP network can be no more than 15 hops (end-to-end). If there is a 16th hop, that network is identi-
fied as infinity and the packet is discarded.

Examples
-> ip rip status enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip load rip Loads RIP into the switch memory.


show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipProtoStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-3


RIP Commands

ip rip interface
Creates/deletes a RIP interface. Routing is enabled on a VLAN when you create a router interface.
However, to enable RIP routing, you must also configure and enable a RIP routing interface on the
VLAN’s IP router interface.
ip rip interface {interface_name}
no ip rip interface {interface_name}

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• By default, a RIP interface is created in the disabled state. To enable RIP routing on the interface, you
must enable the interface by using the ip rip interface status command.
• You can create a RIP interface even if an IP router interface has not been configured. However, RIP
will not function unless an IP router interface is configured with the RIP interface.
• For more information on VLANs and router ports, see Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands”.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 12-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

Related Commands

ip interface Creates a VLAN router interface.


ip load rip Loads RIP into memory. When the switch is initially configured,
you must load RIP into memory before it can be enabled.
ip rip status Enables/disables RIP routing on the switch.
ip rip interface status Enables/disables a RIP interface.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-5


RIP Commands

ip rip interface status


Enables/disables a RIP interface. By default, a RIP interface is created in the disabled state. After creating
a RIP interface, you must use this command to enable the interface.
ip rip interface {interface_name} status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must first create a RIP interface by using the ip rip interface command before enabling the inter-
face.
• You can create a RIP interface even if an IP router interface has not been configured. However, RIP
will not function unless an IP router interface is configured with the RIP interface.
• For more information on VLANs and router ports, see Chapter 3, “VLAN Management Commands”.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1 status enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 12-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

Related Commands

ip interface Creates a VLAN router interface.


ip load rip Loads RIP into memory. When the switch is initially configured,
you must load RIP into memory before it can be enabled.
ip rip status Enables/disables RIP routing on the switch.
ip rip interface Creates/deletes a RIP interface.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-7


RIP Commands

ip rip interface metric


Configures the RIP metric or cost for a specified interface. You can set priorities for routes generated by a
switch by assigning a metric value to routes generated by that switch’s RIP interface. For example, routes
generated by a neighboring switch may have a hop count of 1. However, you can lower the priority of
routes generated by that switch by increasing the metric value for routes generated by the RIP interface.
ip rip interface {interface_name} metric value

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.
value Metric value. Valid range is 1–15.

Defaults

parameter default
value 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When you configure a metric for a RIP interface, this metric cost is added to the metric of the incoming
route.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1 metric 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip interface Enables/disables RIP on a specific interface.


show ip rip peer Displays active RIP neighbors (peers). An active peer is a switch
that has sent a RIP packet within the last 180 seconds.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfDefaultMetric

page 12-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip interface send-version


Configures the send option for a RIP interface. This defines the type(s) of RIP packets that the interface
will send.
ip rip interface {interface_name} send-version {none | v1 | v1compatible | v2}

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.
none RIP packets will not be sent by the interface.
v1 Only RIPv1 packets will be sent by the interface.
v1compatible Only RIPv2 broadcast packets (not multicast) will be sent by the inter-
face.
v2 Only RIPv2 packets will be sent by the interface.

Defaults

parameter default
none | v1 | v2 | v1compatible v2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Using this command will override RIP default behavior.

• Other devices must be able to interpret the information provided by this command or there will not be
proper routing information exchanged between the switch and other devices on the network.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1 send-version v1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-9


RIP Commands

Related Commands

ip rip interface recv-version Configures the receive option for a RIP interface.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfSend

page 12-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip interface recv-version


Configures the receive option for a RIP interface. This defines the type(s) of RIP packets that the inter-
face will accept.
ip rip interface {interface_name} recv-version {v1 | v2 | both | none}

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.
v1 Only RIPv1 packets will be received by the interface.
v2 Only RIPv2 packets will be received by the interface.
both Both RIPv1 and RIPv2 packets will be received by the interface.
none Interface ignores any RIP packets received.

Defaults

parameter default
v1 | v2 | both | none both

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Using this command will override RIP default behavior.

• Other devices must be able to interpret the information provided by this command or there will not be
proper routing information exchanged between the switch and other devices on the network.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1 recv-version both

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-11


RIP Commands

Related Commands

ip rip interface send-version Configures the send option for a RIP interface.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfReceive

page 12-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip force-holddowntimer
Configures the forced hold-down timer value, in seconds, that defines an amount of time during which
routing information regarding better paths is suppressed. A route enters into a forced hold-down state
when an update packet is received that indicates the route is unreachable and when this timer is set to a
non-zero value. After this timer has expired and if the value is less than 120 seconds, the route enters a
hold-down state for the rest of the period until the remainder of the 120 seconds has also expired. During
this time the switch will accept any advertisements for better paths that are received.
ip rip force-holddowntimer seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The forced hold-down time interval, in seconds. The valid range is
0–120.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The forced hold-down timer is not the same as the RIP hold-down timer. The forced hold-down timer
defines a separate interval that overlaps the hold-down state. During the forced hold-down timer inter-
val, the switch will not accept better routes from other gateways.
• The forced hold-down time interval can become a subset of the hold-down timer (120 seconds) by
using this command to set a value less than 120.
• To allow the routing switch to use better routes advertised during the entire hold-down time period,
leave the forced hold-down timer set to the default value of 0.

Examples
-> ip rip force-holddowntimer 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-13


RIP Commands

Related Commands

show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipForceHolddownTimer

page 12-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip host-route
Specifies whether or not RIP can add host routes (routes with a 32-bit mask) to the RIP table.
ip rip host-route
no ip rip host-route

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
The default is to enable a default host route.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to prevent RIP from adding host routes to the RIP table.

• When enabled, RIPv1 will interpret an incoming route announcement that contains any 1 bit in the host
portion of the IP address as a host route, implying a mask of 255.255.255.255.

Examples
-> ip rip host-route

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip rip routes Displays the RIP Routing Database.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipHostRouteSupport

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-15


RIP Commands

ip rip route-tag
Configures the route tag value for RIP routes generated by the switch.
ip rip route-tag value

Syntax Definitions
value Route tag value. Valid range is 0–2147483647.

Defaults

parameter default
value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Only RIPv2 supports route tags.

Examples
-> ip rip route-tag 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaRipRedistRouteTag

page 12-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip interface auth-type


Configures the type of authentication that will be used for the RIP interface. By default, there is no authen-
tication used for RIP. However, you can configure a password for a RIP interface. To configure a pass-
word, you must first select the authentication type (simple or MD5), then configure a password.
ip rip interface {interface_name} auth-type {none | simple | md5}

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.
none No authentication will be used.
simple Simple authentication will be used.
md5 MD5 authentication will be used.

Defaults

parameter default
none | simple none

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Regardless of which authentication type is used (simple or MD5), both switches on either end of a link
must share the same password.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1 auth-type none

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip interface auth-key Configures the text string that will be used as the password for the
RIP interface.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfAuthType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-17


RIP Commands

ip rip interface auth-key


Configures the text string that will be used as the password for the RIP interface. If you configure simple
or MD5 authentication, you must configure a text string that will be used as the password for the RIP
interface.
ip rip interface {interface_name} auth-key string

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The name of the interface.
string 16-byte text string.

Defaults
The default authentication string is a null string.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Regardless of which authentication type is used (simple or MD5), both switches on either end of a link
must share the same password.

Examples
-> ip rip interface rip-1 auth-key nms

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip interface auth-type Configures the type of authentication that will be used for the RIP
interface.

MIB Objects
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfAuthKey

page 12-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip update-interval
Configures the time interval during which RIP routing updates are sent out.
ip rip update-interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The RIP routing update interval, in seconds. The valid range is 1–120.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 30

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The update interval value must be less than or equal to one-third the invalid interval value.

Examples
-> ip rip update-interval 45

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipUpdateInterval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-19


RIP Commands

ip rip invalid-timer
Configures the RIP invalid timer value that defines the time interval during which a route will remain
active in Routing Information Base (RIB) before moving to the invalid state.
ip rip invalid-timer seconds

Syntax Definition
seconds The RIP invalid timer value, in seconds. The valid range is 3–360.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 180

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The invalid time interval value must be three times the update interval value.

Examples
-> ip rip invalid-timer 270

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipInvalidTimer

page 12-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

ip rip garbage-timer
Configures the RIP garbage timer value that defines the time interval, which must elapse before an expired
route is removed from the RIB.

ip rip garbage-timer seconds

Syntax Definition
seconds The RIP garbage timer value, in seconds. The valid range is 0–180.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 120

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
During the RIP garbage interval, the router advertises the route with a metric of INFINITY (i.e., 16 hops).

Examples
-> ip rip garbage-timer 180

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipGarbageTimer

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-21


RIP Commands

ip rip holddown-timer
Configures the RIP hold-down timer value that defines the time interval during which a route remains in
the hold-down state.
ip rip holddown-timer seconds

Syntax Definition
seconds The hold-down time interval, in seconds. The valid range is 0–120.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When RIP detects a route with higher metric than the route in the RIB, the route with the higher metric
goes into the hold-down state. The route updates with a metric of INFINITY are rejected.

Examples
-> ip rip holddown-timer 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip rip Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g.,
forced hold-down timer).

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipHolddownTimer

page 12-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

show ip rip
Displays the RIP status and general configuration parameters (e.g., forced hold-down timer).
show ip rip

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip rip

Status = Enabled
Number of routes = 9
Host Route Support = Enabled
Route Tag = 42
Update interval = 30
Invalid interval = 180
Garbage interval = 120
Holddown interval = 0
Forced Hold-Down Timer = 0

output definitions
Status RIP status (Enabled or Disabled).
Number of routes Number of network routes in the RIP routing table.
Host Route Support Host route status (Enabled or Disabled). Indicates whether or not RIP
can add host routes (routes with a 32-bit mask) to the RIP table.
Route Tag Route tag value for RIP routes generated by the switch. Valid values are
0–2147483647.
Update interval The RIP routing update interval, in seconds. Valid range is 1–120.
Default is 30.
Invalid interval The RIP invalid timer value, in seconds. Valid range is 3–360. Default
is 180.
Garbage interval The RIP garbage timer value, in seconds. Valid range is 0–180. Default
is 120.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-23


RIP Commands

output definitions
Holddown interval The hold-down time interval, in seconds. Valid range is 0–120. Default
is 0.
Forced Hold-Down Timer The forced hold-down time interval, in seconds. The valid range is
0–120. Default is 0.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip status Enables/disables RIP routing on the switch.


ip rip force-holddowntimer Configures the interval during which a RIP route remains in the
forced hold-down state.
ip rip update-interval Configures the time interval during which RIP routing updates are
sent out.
ip rip invalid-timer Configures the RIP invalid timer value that defines the time interval
during which a route will remain active in Routing Information
Base (RIB) before moving to the invalid state.
ip rip garbage-timer Configures the RIP garbage timer value that defines the time inter-
val, which must elapse before an expired route is removed from the
RIB.
ip rip holddown-timer Configures the RIP hold-down timer value that defines the time
interval during which a route remains in the hold down state.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipProtoStatus
alaRipRouteNumber
alaRipHostRouteSupport
alaRipRedistRouteTag
alaRipUpdateInterval
alaRipInvalidTimer
alaRipGarbageTimer
alaRipHolddownTimer
alaRipForceHolddownTimer

page 12-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

show ip rip routes


Displays the RIP routing database. The routing database contains all of the routes learned through RIP.
show ip rip routes [ip_address ip_mask]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address 32-bit IP address.
ip_mask The mask corresponding to the IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
To view all RIP routes, enter the basic command syntax (show ip rip routes). To view a specific route,
enter the destination IP address and mask.

Examples
-> show ip rip routes

Legends: State: A = Active, H = Holddown, G = Garbage


Destination Gateway State Metric Proto
------------------+-----------------+----+------+------
2.0.0.0/8 +5.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
4.0.0.7 A 3 Rip
4.0.0.0/8 +5.0.0.14 A 3 Rip
2.0.0.14 A 3 Rip
5.0.0.0/8 +2.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
4.0.0.7 A 3 Rip
10.0.0.0/8 +4.0.0.7 A 2 Rip
5.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
2.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
22.0.0.0/8 +5.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
2.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
4.0.0.7 A 3 Rip
128.251.40.0/24 +4.0.0.7 A 2 Rip
5.0.0.14 A 3 Rip
2.0.0.14 A 3 Rip
150.0.0.0/24 +4.0.0.7 A 2 Rip
5.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
2.0.0.14 A 2 Rip
152.0.0.0/24 +4.0.0.7 A 2 Rip
5.0.0.14 A 3 Rip

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-25


RIP Commands

output definitions
Destination Destination network IP address.
Gateway The Gateway IP address (switch from which the destination address
was learned).
State The associated state of the route, which can be A (Active), H
(Holddown), or G (Garbage).
Metric Metric associated with this network. Generally, this is the RIP hop
count (the number of hops from this switch to the destination switch).
Proto The type of route (Local, Rip, or Redist).

-> show ip rip routes 2.0.0.0 255.0.0.0

Destination = 2.0.0.0,
Mask length = 8,
Gateway(1) = 5.0.0.14,
Protocol = Rip,
Out Interface = intf5,
Metric = 2,
Status = Installed,
State = Active,
Age = 19s,
Tag = 0,
Gateway(2) = 4.0.0.7,
Protocol = Rip,
Out Interface = intf4,
Metric = 3,
Status = Not Installed,
State = Active,
Age = 12s,
Tag = 0,

output definitions
Destination Destination network IP address.
Mask length Length of the destination network IP subnet mask.
Gateway The Gateway IP address (switch from which the destination address
was learned).
Protocol The type of the route (Local, Rip, or Redist).
Out Interface The RIP interface through which the next hop is reached.
Metric Metric associated with this network. Generally, this is the RIP hop
count (the number of hops from this switch to the destination switch).
Status The RIP interface status (Installed or Not Installed).
State The associated state of the route (Active, Holddown, or Garbage).
Age The age of the route in seconds (the number of seconds since this route
was last updated or otherwise determined to be correct).
Tag The associated route tag.

page 12-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip host-route Enables/disables a host route to an individual host on a network.

MIB Objects
alaRipEcmpRouteTable
alaRipEcmpRouteDest
alaRipEcmpRouteMask
alaRipEcmpRouteNextHop
alaRipEcmpRouteType
alaRipEcmpMetric
alaRipEcmpStatus
alaRipEcmpAge
alaRipEcmpTag
alaRipEcmpRouteState
alaRipEcmpRouteStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-27


RIP Commands

show ip rip interface


Displays RIP interface status and configuration.
show ip rip interface [interface_name]

Syntax Definitions
interface_name The interface name.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Enter an IP address to view a specific interface. Enter the basic show ip rip interface command to show
status for all interfaces.

Examples
-> show ip rip interface rip-1

Interface IP Name = rip-1,


Interface IP Address = 11.11.11.1
IP Interface Number (VLANId) = 4,
Interface Admin status = enabled,
IP Interface Status = enabled,
Interface Config AuthType = None,
Interface Config AuthKey Length = 0,
Interface Config Send-Version = v2,
Interface Config Receive-Version = both,
Interface Config Default Metric = 1,
Received Packets = 154,
Received Bad Packets = 0,
Received Bad Routes = 0,
Sent Updates = 8

output definitions
Interface IP Name The IP Interface name.
Interface IP Address Interface IP address.
IP Interface Number Interface VLAN ID number.
Interface Admin Status The RIP administrative status (enabled/disabled).
IP Interface Status Interface status (enabled /disabled).
Interface Config AuthType The type of authentication that will be used for the RIP interface (None
or Simple).

page 12-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

output definitions (continued)


Interface Config AuthKey The authentication key length used for the RIP interface.
Length
Interface Config Send-Version Interface send option (none, v1, v2, and v1 compatible). Default is v2.
Interface Config Receive-Ver- Interface receive option (none, v1, v2, and both). Default is both.
sion
Interface Config Default Met- Default redistribution metric. Default is 1.
ric
Received Packets Number of packets received on the interface.
Received Bad Packets Number of bad packets received and discarded. Normally this value is
zero (0).
Received Bad Routes Number of bad routes received and discarded. Normally this value is
zero (0).
Sent Updates Number of RIP routing table updates sent.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip rip interface Enables/disables RIP for a specific interface.

MIB Objects
alaProtocolRip
alaRipProtoStatus
alaRip2IfConfAugTable
alaRip2IfConfName
alaRip2IfRecvPkts
alaRip2IfIpConfStatus
rip2IfConfTable
rip2IfConfAddress
rip2IfConfAuthType
rip2IfConfAuthKey
rip2IfConfSend
rip2IfConfReceive
rip2IfConfDefaultMetric
rip2IfStatTable
rip2IfStatRcvBadPackets
rip2IfStatRcvBadRoutes
rip2IfStatSentUpdates

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-29


RIP Commands

show ip rip peer


Displays active RIP neighbors (peers). An active peer is a switch that has sent a RIP packet within the last
180 seconds. If a peer does not send a RIP packet (request or response) within 180 seconds, it is aged out
and will not be displayed.
show ip rip peer [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address 32-bit IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip rip peer

Total Bad Bad xxxxxxxxxxxxSecs since


IP Address Recvd Packets Routes Version last update
----------------+------+-------+------+-------+-----------
100.10.10.1 1 0 0 2 3

output definitions
IP Address Peer IP address.
Total recvd Total number of RIP packets received from the peer.
Bad Packets Number of bad packets received from peer.
Bad Routes Number of bad routes received from peer.
Version Peer's RIP version as seen on the last packet received.
Secs since last update Number of seconds since the last packet was received from the peer.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 12-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RIP Commands

Related Commands

show ip rip interface Displays the RIP interface status and configuration.

MIB Objects
rip2PeerTable
rip2PeerAddress
rip2PeerDomain
rip2PeerLastUpdate
rip2PeerVersion
rip2PeerRcvBadPackets
rip2PeerRcvBadRoutes

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12-31


RIP Commands

page 12-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


13 RDP Commands

This chapter details Router Discovery Protocol (RDP) commands for the switch. RDP is an extension of
the Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) that provides a mechanism for end hosts to discover at least
one router in the same network.
This implementation of RDP is based on the router requirements specified in RFC 1256. Switches that
serve as a router can enable RDP to advertise themselves to clients on the same network at random inter-
vals between a configurable range of time and in response to client solicitations.
MIB information for the RDP commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Rdp.mib
Module: alcatelIND1RDPMIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

ip router-discovery
ip router-discovery interface
ip router-discovery interface advertisement-address
ip router-discovery interface max-advertisement-interval
ip router-discovery interface min-advertisement-interval
ip router-discovery interface advertisement-lifetime
ip router-discovery interface preference-level
show ip router-discovery
show ip router-discovery interface

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-1


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery
Enables or disables the Router Discovery Protocol (RDP) for the switch.
ip router-discovery {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables RDP on the switch.
disable Disables RDP on the switch.

Defaults
By default, RDP is disabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The ip router-discovery command only activates RDP for the switch. No advertisements occur until
an IP interface is configured with RDP.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery enable
-> ip router-discovery disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip router-discovery interface Enables or disables an RDP interface.

MIB Objects
alaRDPConfig
alaRDPStatus

page 13-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery interface
Enables or disables RDP for the specified IP interface. An RDP interface is created for the specified IP
interface name, which is then advertised by RDP as an active router on the local network.
ip router-discovery interface name [enable | disable]
no router-discovery interface name

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.
enable Enables an RDP interface for the specified IP interface.
disable Disables an RDP interface for the specified IP interface.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the RDP interface from the switch configuration.

• Do not use the enable option the first time this command is used to create an RDP interface, as it is not
necessary and will return an error message. Once RDP is enabled and then is subsequently disabled,
however, the enable option is then required the next time this command is used to enable the RDP
interface.
• The RDP interface is not active unless RDP is also enabled for the switch.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing disable
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing enable
-> no ip router-discovery interface Marketing

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-3


RDP Commands

Related Commands

ip router-discovery Enables or disables RDP for the switch.


ip interface Configures an IP router interface.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfStatus

page 13-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery interface advertisement-address


Configures the destination address to which RDP will send router advertisement packets from the speci-
fied interface. Advertisement packets are sent at configurable intervals by routers to announce their IP
addresses on the network.
ip router-discovery interface name advertisement-address {all-systems-multicast | broadcast}

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.
all-systems-multicast Specifies 224.0.0.1 as the destination address for RDP advertisement
packets.
Broadcast Specifies 255.255.255.255 as the destination address for RDP advertise-
ment packets. Use this address if IP multicast links are not available.

Defaults

parameter default
all-systems-multicast | broadcast all-systems-multicast

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The RDP interface advertisement address is not active unless RDP is enabled on the switch and the
specified interface is also enabled.
• RFC 1256 recommends the use of all-system-multicast on all links with “listening hosts” that support
IP multicast.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing advertisement-address all-systems-multi-
cast
-> ip router-discovery interface Accounting advertisement-address broadcast

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-5


RDP Commands

Related Commands

ip router-discovery Enables or disables RDP on the switch.


ip router-discovery interface Enables or disables an RDP interface.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfAdvtAddress

page 13-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery interface max-advertisement-interval


Configures the maximum time, in seconds, RDP allows between each advertisement packet the router
transmits on the specified interface.
ip router-discovery interface name max-advertisement-interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.
seconds The maximum amount of time allowed before the next advertisement
occurs. The range is 4 to1800 seconds.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 600

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The RDP interface maximum advertisement time is not active unless RDP is enabled on the switch and
the specified interface is also enabled.
• Do not specify a value for the maximum advertisement interval that is less than the value specified for
the minimum advertisement interval. To set the minimum advertisement interval value, use the
ip router-discovery interface min-advertisement-interval command.
• Note that the minimum and maximum advertisement values define an interval of time in which RDP
transmits advertisement packets. RDP transmits packets at random times within this interval, waiting
no longer than the maximum time specified and no sooner than the minimum time specified before the
next transmission.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing max-advertisement-interval 350
-> ip router-discovery interface Accounting max-advertisement-interval 20

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-7


RDP Commands

Related Commands
ip router-discovery Enables or disables RDP on the switch.
ip router-discovery interface Enables or disables an RDP interface.
ip router-discovery interface Configures the minimum time, in seconds, RDP allows between
min-advertisement-interval each advertisement packet the router transmits on the specified
interface.
ip router-discovery interface Configures the maximum amount of time, in seconds, that router IP
advertisement-lifetime addresses received in advertisement packets are considered valid.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfMaxAdvtInterval

page 13-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery interface min-advertisement-interval


Configures the minimum time, in seconds, RDP allows between each advertisement packet the router
transmits on the specified interface.
ip router-discovery interface name min-advertisement-interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.
seconds The minimum amount of time allowed before the next advertisement
occurs. The range is 3 seconds to the value set for the maximum adver-
tisement interval.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 0.75 * maximum advertisement interval

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The RDP interface minimum advertisement time is not active unless RDP is enabled on the switch and
the specified interface is also enabled.
• Do not specify a value for the minimum advertisement interval that is greater than the value specified
for the maximum advertisement interval. To set the maximum advertisement interval value, use the ip
router-discovery interface max-advertisement-interval command.
• Note that the minimum and maximum advertisement values define an interval of time in which RDP
transmits advertisement packets. RDP transmits packets at random times within this interval, waiting
no longer than the maximum time specified and no sooner than the minimum time specified before the
next transmission.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing min-advertisement-interval 20
-> ip router-discovery interface Accounting min-advertisement-interval 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-9


RDP Commands

Related Commands
ip router-discovery Enables or disables RDP on the switch.
ip router-discovery interface Enables or disables an RDP interface.
ip router-discovery interface Configures the maximum time, in seconds, RDP allows between
max-advertisement-interval each advertisement packet the router transmits on the specified
interface.
ip router-discovery interface Configures the maximum amount of time, in seconds, that router IP
advertisement-lifetime addresses received in advertisement packets are considered valid.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfMinAdvtInterval

page 13-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery interface advertisement-lifetime


Configures the maximum amount of time, in seconds, that router IP addresses advertised from the speci-
fied interface are considered valid. This value is set in the lifetime field of the advertisement packets trans-
mitted on the specified RDP interface.
ip router-discovery interface name advertisement-lifetime seconds

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.
seconds The length of time, in seconds, that advertised IP addresses are consid-
ered valid by the receiving host. The range is the value set for the maxi-
mum advertisement interval to 9000.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 3 * maximum advertisement interval

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The RDP interface advertisement lifetime value is not active unless RDP is enabled on the switch, and
the specified interface is also enabled.
• Do not specify an advertisement lifetime value that is less than the value specified for the maximum
advertisement interval. To set the maximum advertisement interval value, use the
ip router-discovery interface max-advertisement-interval command.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing advertisement-lifetime 2000
-> ip router-discovery interface Accounting advertisement-lifetime 750

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-11


RDP Commands

Related Commands
ip router-discovery Enables or disables RDP on the switch.
ip router-discovery interface Enables or disables an RDP interface.
ip router-discovery interface Configures the minimum time, in seconds, RDP allows between
min-advertisement-interval each advertisement packet the router transmits on the specified
interface.
ip router-discovery interface Configures the maximum time, in seconds, RDP allows between
max-advertisement-interval each advertisement packet the router transmits on the specified
interface.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfAdvLifeTime

page 13-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

ip router-discovery interface preference-level


Configures the preference level for each IP address advertised on the specified RDP interface. The end
host selects the address with the highest preference level to use as its default router, if the host is not
already redirected or configured to use another default router for a particular destination.
ip router-discovery interface name preference-level level

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.
level Any positive, integer value.The higher the value, the higher the prece-
dence.

Defaults

parameter default
level 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The RDP interface preference level value is not active unless RDP is enabled on the switch and the
specified interface is also enabled.
• Set the preference level higher to encourage the use of an advertised router IP address.

• Set the preference level lower to discourage the use of an advertised router IP address.

• The preference level of an advertised router IP address is compared only to the preference levels of
other addresses on the same subnet.

Examples
-> ip router-discovery interface Marketing preference-level 10
-> ip router-discovery interface Accounting preference-level 50

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-13


RDP Commands

Related Commands
ip router-discovery Enables or disables RDP on the switch.
ip router-discovery interface Enables or disables an RDP interface.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfPrefLevel

page 13-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

show ip router-discovery
Displays the current RDP status and related statistics for the entire switch.
show ip router-discovery

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Each time RDP is enabled on the switch, all statistic parameter values are reset to zero for the new
session. For example, if the RDP uptime was 160000 seconds when RDP was last disabled, the uptime
starts out at zero the next time RDP is enabled.
• Use the show ip router-discovery interface command to display information about a specific RDP
interface.

Examples
-> show ip router-discovery
Status = Enabled,
RDP uptime = 161636 secs
#Packets Tx = 4,
#Packets Rx = 0,
#Send Errors = 0,
#Recv Errors = 0,

output definitions
Status The status of RDP. Enabled allows RDP interfaces to advertise router
IP addresses; Disabled stops RDP traffic on all switch interfaces. Use
the ip router-discovery command to enable or disable RDP on the
switch.
RDP uptime Indicates the amount of time, in seconds, that RDP has remained active
on the switch.
#Packets Tx The number of RDP packets transmitted from all active RDP interfaces
on the switch.
#Packets Rx The number of RDP packets received on all active RDP interfaces on
the switch.
#Send Errors The number of RDP packet transmission errors that have occurred.
#Recv Errors The number of errors that occurred when receiving RDP packets.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-15


RDP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip router- Displays the current RDP status and related statistics for one or
discovery interface more switch router port interfaces.

MIB Objects
alaRDPConfig
alaRDPStatus

page 13-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

show ip router-discovery interface


Displays the current RDP status, related parameter values, and RDP traffic statistics for one or more
switch router interfaces.
show ip router-discovery interface [name]

Syntax Definitions
name The IP interface name that was defined at the time the IP interface was
configured.

Defaults
By default, the information for all RDP interfaces is displayed with this command.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When an optional IP interface name is specified with this command, additional information about the
RDP interface is displayed.
• Use the show ip router-discovery command to display global RDP status and statistics for the entire
switch.

Examples
-> show ip router-discovery interface
IP i/f RDP i/f Next #Pkts
Name status status Advt sent/recvd
---------------------+--------+--------+------+---------
Marketing Disabled Enabled 9 0 0
Accounting Disabled Enabled 3 0 0

output definitions
Name The user-defined IP interface name defined at the time the IP interface
was configured.
IP i/f status The IP status for this interface (Enabled or Disabled).
RDP i/f status The RDP status for this interface (Enabled or Disabled).
Next Advt Time remaining until the next advertisement is sent.
#Pkts sent/recvd Number of advertisement packets sent from this interface; the number
of solicitation packets received on this interface.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-17


RDP Commands

-> show ip router-discovery interface Marketing


Name = Marketing,
IP Address = 11.255.4.1,
IP Mask = 255.0.0.0,
IP Interface status = Enabled,
RDP Interface status = Enabled,
Advertisement address = 224.0.0.1,
Max Advertisement interval = 600 secs,
Min Advertisement interval = 450 secs,
Advertisement lifetime = 1800 secs,
Preference Level = 0x0,
#Packets sent = 3,
#Packets received = 0,

output definitions
Name The user-defined IP interface name defined at the time the IP interface
was configured.
IP Address The IP address associated with the IP interface name.
IP Mask The subnet mask associated with the interface IP address.
IP Interface status The IP status for this interface (Enabled or Disabled).
RDP Interface status The RDP status for this interface (Enabled or Disabled).
Advertisement address The destination address for RDP advertisement packets: 224.0.0.1 (all-
systems-multicast) or 255.255.255.255 (broadcast). Configured using
the ip router-discovery interface advertisement-address command.
Max Advertisement interval The maximum time, in seconds, RDP allows between each advertise-
ment packet the router transmits from this interface. Configured using
the ip router-discovery interface max-advertisement-interval com-
mand.
Min Advertisement interval The minimum time, in seconds, RDP allows between each advertise-
ment packet the router transmits from this interface. Configured using
the ip router-discovery interface min-advertisement-interval com-
mand.
Advertisement lifetime The maximum amount of time, in seconds, that router IP addresses
advertised from this interface are considered valid. Configured using
the ip router-discovery interface advertisement-lifetime command.
Preference Level The preference level, displayed in hex, for each IP address advertised
on this interface. Configured using the ip router-discovery interface
preference-level command.
#Packets sent The number of advertisement packets transmitted from this interface.
#Packets received The number of solicitation packets received on this interface.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 13-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RDP Commands

Related Commands

show ip router-discovery Displays the current RDP status and related statistics for the entire
switch.

MIB Objects
alaRDPIfTable
alaRDPIfAdvtAdress
alaRDPIfMaxAdvtInterval
alaRDPIfMinAdvtInterval
alaRDPIfAdvLifeTime
alaRDPIfPrefLevel

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13-19


RDP Commands

page 13-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


14 DHCP Relay Commands

Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP) and Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) packets contain configu-
ration information for network hosts. DHCP Relay enables forwarding of BOOTP/DHCP packets between
networks. This allows routing of DHCP traffic between clients and servers. It is not necessary to enable
DHCP Relay if DHCP traffic is bridged through one network (i.e. clients and servers are on the same
physical network).
This chapter includes a description of DHCP Relay commands that are used to define the IP address of
DHCP servers, maximum number of hops, and forward delay time. Configure DHCP Relay on the switch
where routing of BOOTP/DHCP packets occur.
MIB information for DHCP Relay commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1UDPRelay.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-UDP-RELAY-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-1


DHCP Relay Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here.

ip helper address
ip helper address vlan
ip helper standard
ip helper per-vlan only
ip helper forward delay
ip helper maximum hops
ip helper agent-information
ip helper agent-information policy
ip helper pxe-support
ip helper dhcp-snooping
ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format
ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan
ip helper dhcp-snooping port
ip helper dhcp-snooping port traffic-suppression
ip helper dhcp-snooping port ip-source-filtering
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding timeout
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding action
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency
ip helper boot-up
ip helper boot-up enable
ip udp relay
ip udp relay vlan
show ip helper
show ip helper stats
show ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan
show ip helper dhcp-snooping port
show ip helper dhcp-snooping binding
show ip udp relay service
show ip udp relay statistics
show ip udp relay destination

page 14-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper address
Adds or deletes a DHCP server IP address. DHCP Relay forwards BOOTP/DHCP broadcasts to and from
the specified address. If multiple DHCP servers are used, configure one IP address for each server.
ip helper address ip_address
ip helper no address [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address DHCP server IP address (e.g. 21.0.0.10).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Using this command enables a Global DHCP Relay service on the switch. When the DHCP Relay is
specified by the DHCP server IP address, the service is called Global DHCP.
• When the DHCP Relay is specified by the VLAN number of the DHCP request, the service is referred
to as Per-VLAN DHCP.
• Global DHCP and Per-VLAN DHCP are mutually exclusive. You may only configure one or the other.

• Use the no form of this command to delete an IP address from the DHCP Relay service. If an address
is not specified, then all addresses are deleted.
• UPD Relay is automatically enabled on a switch when a DHCP server IP address is defined. There is
no separate command for enabling or disabling the relay service.
• Configure DHCP Relay on switches where packets are routed between IP networks.

• You can configure up to 256 server IP addresses for one relay service.

Examples
-> ip helper address 75.0.0.10
-> ip helper no address 31.0.0.20

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-3


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper address vlan Specifies or deletes DHCP Relay based on the VLAN of the DHCP
request.
ip helper forward delay Sets the forward delay time value. DHCP Relay will not process a client
packet unless the packet contains an elapsed boot time value that is
equal to or greater than the configured value of the forward delay time.
ip helper maximum hops Sets the maximum number of hops value to specify how many relays a
BOOTP/DHCP packet can traverse.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

MIB Objects
iphelperTable
iphelperService
iphelperForwAddr

page 14-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper address vlan


Configures a DHCP Relay service for the specified VLAN. This command is used when a per-VLAN only
relay service is active on the switch. It does not apply when using a standard relay service.
ip helper address ip_address vlan vlan_id
ip helper no address ip_address vlan vlan_id

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP address (e.g. 21.0.0.10) of the DHCP server VLAN.
vlan_id VLAN identification number (e.g. 3) of the DHCP server VLAN.

Defaults
If no VLAN identification number is entered, VLAN ID 0 is used by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the DHCP server VLAN from the DHCP Relay.

• Specifying multiple VLAN IDs and/or a range of VLAN IDs on the same command line is allowed.
Use a hyphen to indicate a contiguous range and a space to separate multiple VLAN ID entries (e.g.,
10-15 500-510 850).
• The ip helper address vlan command does not work if the per-vlan only forwarding option is not
active. Use the ip helper per-vlan only command to enable this option.
• Configure DHCP Relay on switches where packets are routed between IP networks.

• The per-VLAN only relay service supports a maximum of 256 VLANs.

Examples
-> ip helper address 75.0.0.10 3
-> ip helper no address 31.0.0.20 4
-> ip helper address 198.206.15.2 250-255
-> ip helper address 10.11.4.1 550-555 1500 1601-1620
-> ip helper no address 198.206.15.2 1601-1620

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-5


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper per-vlan only Sets the DHCP Relay forwarding option to process only DHCP packets
received from a specific, identified VLAN.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

MIB Objects
iphelperTable
iphelperService
iphelperVlan

page 14-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper standard
Sets DHCP Relay forwarding option to standard. All DHCP packets are processed by a global relay
service.
ip helper standard

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, the DHCP Relay forwarding option is set to standard.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
To process DHCP packets on a per VLAN basis, use the ip helper per-vlan only command.

Examples
-> ip helper standard

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.


show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperForwOption

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-7


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper per-vlan only


Sets the DHCP Relay forwarding option to process only DHCP packets received from a specific, identi-
fied VLAN. This option allows each VLAN to have its own relay.
ip helper per-vlan only

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, the UDP forwarding option is set to standard.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the forwarding option is set to per-vlan only, the standard (global) DHCP relay service is not
available. These two types of services are mutually exclusive.
• Using the per-vlan only forwarding option requires you to specify a DHCP server IP address for each
VLAN that will provide a relay service. The ip helper address vlan command performs this function
and at the same time enables relay for the specified VLAN.

Examples
-> ip helper per-vlan only

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper address vlan Configures a DHCP Relay service for the specified VLAN.
ip helper standard Sets DHCP Relay forwarding option to standard. All DHCP packets are
processed.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

page 14-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperForwOption

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-9


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper forward delay


Sets the forward delay time value for the DHCP Relay configuration. The BOOTP/DHCP packet the client
sends contains the elapsed boot time. This is the amount of time, in seconds, since the client last booted.
DHCP Relay will not process the packet unless the client’s elapsed boot time value is equal to or greater
than the configured value of the forward delay time.
ip helper forward delay seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Forward delay time value in seconds (1–65535). Do not use commas in
the value.

Defaults
By default, the forward delay time is set to three seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The time specified applies to all defined IP helper addresses.

• If a packet contains an elapsed boot time value that is less than the specified forward delay time value,
DHCP Relay discards the packet.

Examples
-> ip helper forward delay 300
-> ip helper forward delay 120

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper address Adds or deletes one or more DHCP server IP addresses to the DHCP
Relay configuration.
ip helper maximum hops Sets the maximum number of hops value to specify how many relays a
BOOTP/DHCP packet can traverse.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

page 14-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperForwDelay

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-11


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper maximum hops


Sets the maximum number of hops value for the DHCP Relay configuration. This value specifies the
maximum number of relays a BOOTP/DHCP packet is allowed to traverse until it reaches its server desti-
nation. Limiting the number of hops that can forward a packet prevents packets from looping through the
network.
ip helper maximum hops hops

Syntax Definitions
hops The maximum number of relays (1–16).

Defaults
By default, the maximum hops value is set to four hops.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a packet contains a hop count equal to or greater than the hops value, DHCP Relay discards the
packet.
• The maximum hops value only applies to DHCP Relay and is ignored by other services.

Examples
-> ip helper maximum hops 1
-> ip helper maximum hops 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper address Adds or deletes one or more DHCP server IP addresses to the DHCP
Relay configuration.
ip helper forward delay Sets the forward delay time value. DHCP Relay will not process a client
packet unless the packet contains an elapsed boot time value that is
equal to or greater than the configured value of the forward delay time.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

page 14-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperMaxHops

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-13


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper agent-information
Enables or disables the DHCP relay agent information option (Option-82) feature. When this feature is
enabled, local relay agent information is inserted into client DHCP packets when the agent forwards these
packets to a DHCP server.
ip helper agent-information {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the relay agent Option-82 feature for the switch.
disable Disables the relay agent Option-82 feature for the switch.

Defaults
By default, this feature is disabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command enables the DHCP Option-82 feature for the entire switch; it is not configurable on a
per-VLAN basis.
• When the DHCP Option-82 feature is enabled, DHCP Snooping is not available. These two features are
mutually exclusive.
• When the relay agent receives a DHCP packet that already contains the Option-82 field, it will process
the packet based on the agent information policy configured for the switch. This policy is configured
using the ip help agent-information policy command.

Examples
-> ip helper agent-information enable
-> ip helper agent-information disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper agent-information Configures a policy to determine how the relay agent handles DHCP
policy packets that already contain the Option-82 field.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

page 14-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

MIB Objects
iphelperAgentInformation

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-15


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper agent-information policy


Configures a policy that determines how the DHCP relay agent will handle DHCP packets that already
contain an Option-82 field.
ip helper agent-information policy {drop | keep | replace}

Syntax Definitions
drop Drop DHCP packets that already contain an Option-82 field.
keep Keep the existing Option-82 field information and continue to relay the
DHCP packet.
replace Replace the existing Option-82 field information with local relay agent
information and continue to relay the DHCP packet.

Defaults
By default, DHCP packets that already contain an Option-82 field are dropped.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The policy configured with this command is only applied if the DHCP Option-82 feature is enabled for
the switch.
• The agent information policy is not applied if the DHCP relay agent receives a DHCP packet from a
client that contains a non-zero value for the gateway IP address (giaddr). In this case, the agent will not
insert the relay agent information option into the DHCP packet and will forward the packet to the
DHCP server.
• Note that if a DHCP packet contains a gateway IP address (giaddr) value that matches a local subnet
and also contains the Option-82 field, the packet is dropped by the relay agent.

Examples
-> ip helper agent-information policy drop
-> ip helper agent-information policy keep
-> ip helper agent-information policy replace

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 14-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper agent-information Enables the insertion of relay agent information Option-82 into DHCP
packets.
show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.
show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

MIB Objects
iphelperAgentInformationPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-17


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper pxe-support
Enables or disables relay agent support for Preboot Execution Environment (PXE) devices.
ip helper pxe-support {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables PXE support.
disable Disables PXE support.

Defaults
By default, PXE support is disabled for the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
PXE support was enabled by default in previous releases. Note that PXE is currently disabled by default
and is now a user-configurable option using the ip helper pxe-support command.

Examples
-> ip helper pxe-support enable
-> ip helper pxe-support disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.

MIB Objects
iphelperPXESupport

page 14-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper traffic-suppression
Globally enables or disables the suppression of DHCP broadcast traffic on the switch. When this feature is
enabled, all DHCP broadcast packets are forwarded to the relay agent for processing even if the client and
server reside in the same VLAN.
This command is currently not supported. Traffic suppression is automatically enabled when DHCP
Snooping is enabled for the switch or for specific VLANs.
ip helper traffic-suppression {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables traffic suppression for the switch.
disable Disables traffic suppression for the switch.

Defaults
By default, traffic suppression is disabled for the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When traffic suppression is enabled, any active relay agent features (e.g., Option-82 data insertion,
DHCP Snooping) are also effected on all DHCP broadcast traffic, regardless of the VLAN in which the
traffic originated.
• Enabling traffic suppression requires the configuration of IP helper addresses for all DHCP servers,
even if the server resides in the same VLAN as the DHCP clients.
• Note that enabling DHCP traffic suppression for the switch overrides any traffic suppression status
configured for an individual DHCP Snooping port.
• If the per-VLAN UDP Relay mode is active for the switch, DHCP broadcast traffic originating in a
VLAN that does not have an IP helper address configured is still broadcast whether or not traffic
suppression is enabled for the switch.
• When traffic suppression is disabled, DHCP packets are flooded on the default VLAN for the port.
Any DHCP server in the same VLAN domain as the client will receive and respond to such packets
without the involvement of the relay agent.

Examples
-> ip helper traffic-suppression enable
-> ip helper traffic-suppression disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-19


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.


ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan Enables or disables DHCP Snooping on a per VLAN basis.
show ip helper Displays the current DHCP configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperTrafficSuppressionStatus

page 14-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping
Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch. When this feature is enabled, all DHCP
packets received on all switch ports are filtered.
ip helper dhcp-snooping {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
disable Disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.

Defaults
By default, this feature is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the DHCP relay agent Option-82 feature is enabled, DHCP Snooping is not available. These two
features are mutually exclusive.
• If the DHCP Snooping feature is globally enabled for the switch, then configuring snooping on a per-
VLAN basis is not allowed. The opposite is also true; invoking VLAN based snooping prevents the use
of switch level snooping.
• When DHCP Snooping is enabled at the switch level, MAC address verification and Option-82 data
insertion are enabled by default. In addition, the trust mode for all ports is set to the DHCP client only
mode.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan .Enables or disables DHCP Snooping on a per VLAN basis.
show ip helper Displays the current DHCP configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnooping

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-21


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification


Globally enables or disables MAC address verification for incoming DHCP traffic. When this feature is
enabled, the source MAC address is compared to the client hardware MAC address in the DHCP packet. If
these two addresses do not match, the DHCP packet is dropped.
ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables DHCP MAC address verification for the switch.
disable Disables DHCP MAC address verification for the switch.

Defaults
By default, this feature is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When DHCP Snooping is enabled at the switch level, MAC address verification and Option-82 data
insertion are enabled by default. In addition, the trust mode for all ports is set to the DHCP client only
mode.
• Changing the enabled or disabled status for MAC address verification is only allowed when DHCP
Snooping is globally enabled for the switch.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping .Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Option-82 data insertion for DHCP
option-82 data-insertion packets.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingMacAddressVerificationStatus

page 14-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion


Globally enables or disables DHCP Option-82 data insertion for DHCP packets. When this feature is
enabled, the relay agent inserts the Option-82 field into DHCP packets before forwarding them to the
DHCP server.
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables inserting the DHCP Option-82 field into DHCP packets.
disable Disables inserting the DHCP Option-82 field into DHCP packets.

Defaults
By default, this feature is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When DHCP Snooping is enabled at the switch level, Option-82 data insertion and MAC address verifica-
tion are enabled by default. In addition, the trust mode for all ports is set to the DHCP client only mode.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Configures the type of information that is inserted in both the Circuit ID
option-82 format and Remote ID suboption of the Option-82 field.
ip helper dhcp-snooping .Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping Enables or disables the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality
binding
show ip helper Displays the current DHCP configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingOpt82DataInsertionStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-23


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format


Configures the type of information that is inserted in both the Circuit ID and Remote ID suboption fields
of the Option-82 field.
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion format [base-mac | system-name | user-string
string]

Syntax Definitions
base-mac The base MAC address of the switch.
system-name The system name of the switch.
string A user-defined text string up to 64 characters.

Defaults

parameter value
base-mac | system-name | base-mac
user-string string

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The string parameter specifies user-defined information to insert into the Circuit ID and Remote ID
fields.
• When entering a string for user-defined Option-82 information, quotes are required around ambiguous
characters, such as hex characters, spaces, etc, so they are interpreted as text. For example, the string
“Building B Server” requires quotes because of the spaces between the words.
• The data specified with this command is added to the Circuit ID and Remote ID fields only when
DHCP Option-82 data insertion is enabled for the switch.
• When DHCP Snooping is enabled at the switch level, Option-82 data insertion is enabled by default.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format user-string “Building B Server”
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format system-name
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format base-mac

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 14-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Option-82 data insertion for DHCP
option-82 data-insertion packets.
ip helper dhcp-snooping .Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
show ip helper Displays the current DHCP configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingOption82FormatType
iphelperDhcpSnoopingOption82StringValeu

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-25


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check


Enables or disables checking for an Option-82 field in DHCP packets ingressing on untrusted ports.
ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Bypasses the Option-82 field check.
disable Checks DHCP packets for the Option-82 field.

Defaults
By default, this feature is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When this feature is disabled (the default), DHCP packets ingressing on untrusted ports are checked to
see if they contain the Option-82 field. If this field is present, the DHCP packet is discarded.
• When this feature is enabled, DHCP packets ingressing on untrusted ports are not checked to see if
they contain the Option-82 field. In this case, the Option-82 field is ignored and all DHCP packets are
processed.
• Using this command is only allowed when DHCP Snooping is enabled globally for the switch or at the
VLAN level.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
show ip helper Displays the current DHCP configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDHCPSnoopingBypassOpt82CheckStatus

page 14-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan


Enables or disables DHCP Snooping on a per VLAN basis. When this feature is enabled, all DHCP pack-
ets received on ports associated with the DHCP Snooping VLAN are filtered.
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan vlan_id [mac-address verification {enable | disable}] [option-82 data-
insertion {enable | disable}]
no ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan vlan_id

Syntax Definitions
vlan_id The VLAN identification number (1–4094).
mac-address verification Enables or disables verifying the source MAC address of DHCP pack-
ets with the client MAC address contained in the same packet.
option-82 data-insertion Enables or disables inserting Option-82 information into DHCP packets.

Defaults
By default, DHCP Snooping is disabled. When this feature is enabled for the specified VLAN, the follow-
ing default parameter values apply:

parameter default
mac-address verification Enabled
option-82 data-insertion Enabled

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable DHCP Snooping for the specified VLAN.

• The MAC address verification and Option-82 data insertion are applied to packets received on ports
associated with the DHCP Snooping VLAN.
• If the DHCP relay agent Option-82 feature is enabled, DHCP Snooping is not available. These two
features are mutually exclusive.
• If the DHCP Snooping feature is globally enabled for the switch, then configuring snooping on a per-
VLAN basis is not allowed. The opposite is also true; invoking VLAN based snooping prevents the use
of switch level snooping.
• Note that disabling the Option-82 data insertion operation for a VLAN is not allowed when the bind-
ing table functionality is enabled.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan 100 enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan 100 disable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-27


DHCP Relay Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping Enables or disables the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality
binding

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanNumber
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanMacVerificationStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanOpt82DataInsertionStatus

page 14-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping port


Configures the DHCP Snooping trust mode for the port. The trust mode determines if the port will accept
all DHCP traffic, block all DHCP traffic, or accept only client DHCP traffic.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port slot1/port1[-port1a] {block | client-only | trust}

Syntax Definitions
slot1/port1[-port1a] Specifies the slot number for the module and the physical port number
on that module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). Use a hyphen to
specify a range of ports (e.g. 3/1-16).
block Blocks all DHCP traffic on the port.
client-only Allows only DHCP client traffic on the port.
trust Allows all DHCP traffic on the port. The port behaves as if DHCP
Snooping was not enabled.

Defaults
By default, the trust mode for a port is set to client-only when the DHCP Snooping feature is enabled for
the switch or for a VLAN.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The DHCP trust mode only applies when the DHCP Snooping feature is enabled for the switch or for a
VLAN.
• If DHCP Snooping is enabled at the switch level, the trust mode applies to all switch ports.

• If DHCP Snooping is enabled for a specific VLAN, then the trust mode applies to only those ports that
are associated with that VLAN.
• Use the show ip helper dhcp-snooping port command to display the current trust mode for a port and
statistics regarding the number of packets dropped due to DHCP Snooping violations.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 1/24 trust
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 2/1-10 block
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 4/8 client-only

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-29


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan Enables or disables DHCP Snooping on a per-VLAN basis.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIfIndex
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortTrustMode

page 14-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping port traffic-suppression


Configures the traffic suppression status for the port. When this function is enabled, DHCP packets are not
flooded on the default VLAN for the specified port. This will prevent DHCP communications between a
DHCP server and a client when both devices belong to the same VLAN domain.
This command is currently not supported. Traffic suppression is automatically enabled when DHCP
Snooping is enabled for the switch or for specific VLANs.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port slot1/port1[-port1a] traffic-suppression {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot1/port1[-port1a] Specifies the slot number for the module and the physical port number
on that module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). Use a hyphen to
specify a range of ports (e.g. 3/1-16).
enable Enables traffic suppression for the specified port.
disable Disables traffic suppression for the specified port.

Defaults
By default, traffic suppression is disabled for the port.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Traffic suppression applies only to ports that are associated with a VLAN that has DHCP Snooping
enabled or to all ports when DHCP Snooping is globally enabled for the switch.
• When traffic suppression is disabled, then DHCP packets are flooded on the default VLAN for the
port. Any DHCP server in the same VLAN domain as the client will receive and respond to such pack-
ets; DHCP Snooping is not invoked in this scenario.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 1/24 traffic-suppression enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 2/1-10 traffic-suppression enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 4/8 traffic-suppression disable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 3/1-5 traffic-suppression disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-31


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan Enables or disables DHCP Snooping on a per-VLAN basis.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port Configures the DHCP Snooping trust mode for a port.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port Configures the IP source filtering status for a DHCP Snooping port.
ip-source-filtering

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIfIndex
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIpTrafficSuppression

page 14-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping port ip-source-filtering


Configures the IP source filtering status for the port. When this function is enabled, traffic on the port is
restricted to packets received on the port that contain the client MAC address and IP address. All other
packets are dropped.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port slot1/port1[-port1a] ip-source-filtering {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot1/port1[-port1a] Specifies the slot number for the module and the physical port number
on that module (e.g. 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). Use a hyphen to
specify a range of ports (e.g. 3/1-16).
enable Enables IP source filtering for the specified port.
disable Disables IP source filtering for the specified port.

Defaults
By default, IP source filtering is disabled for the port.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP source filtering applies only to ports that are associated with a VLAN that has DHCP Snooping
enabled or to all ports when DHCP Snooping is globally enabled for the switch.
• The DHCP Snooping binding table is used to verify client information.

• If a device connected to a DHCP Snooping port with IP source filtering enabled does not have a valid
IP address lease from the trusted DHCP server, then all IP traffic for that device is blocked on the port.
• Disable IP source filtering for the DHCP Snooping port to allow a device to obtain a valid IP address
lease.
• Once a device obtains a valid lease or if a device already has a valid lease, then only source bound traf-
fic is allowed.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 1/24 ip-source-filtering enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 2/1-10 ip-source-filtering enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 4/8 ip-source-filtering disable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping port 3/1-5 ip-source-filtering disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-33


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Globally enables or disables DHCP Snooping for the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan Enables or disables DHCP Snooping on a per-VLAN basis.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port Configures the DHCP Snooping trust mode for a port.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port Configures the traffic suppression status for a DHCP Snooping port.
traffic-suppression

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIfIndex
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIpSourceFiltering

page 14-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping binding


Enables or disables the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality. The binding table contains the MAC
address, IP address, lease time, binding type (dynamic or static), VLAN number, and the interface infor-
mation that corresponds to a local untrusted port on the switch. In addition, this command is also used to
configure a static entry in the binding table.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding {[enable | disable] | [mac_address port slot/port address
ip_address lease-time time vlan vlan_id]}
no ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding mac_address port slot/port address ip_address lease-time
time vlan vlan_id

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the creation of binding table entries.
disable Disables the creation of binding table entries.
mac_address The client MAC address.
slot/port The slot and port number that received the DHCP request.
ip_address The IP address that the DHCP server offered to the client.
time The IP address lease time assigned by the DHCP server.
vlan_id The VLAN identification number (1–4094) of the VLAN to which the
client belongs.

Defaults
By default, the binding table functionality is enabled when the DHCP Snooping feature is enabled for the
switch or for a VLAN.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a static entry from the DHCP Snooping binding table.

• The enable and disable parameters are independent of the other parameters, in that they are only used
to turn the binding table functionality on and off. Enabling or disabling binding table functionality and
creating a static binding table entry is not allowed on the same command line.
• Note that enabling the binding table functionality is not allowed if Option-82 data insertion is not
enabled at either the switch or VLAN level.
• Static binding table entries are created using this command. If DHCP Snooping binding table function-
ality is not enabled, creating a static entry is not allowed.
• Dynamic binding table entries are created when the relay agent receives a DHCPACK packet.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-35


DHCP Relay Commands

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding disable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding 00:2a:95:51:6c:10 port 1/15 address 17.15.3.10
lease-time 3 vlan 200
-> no ip helper dhcp-snooping binding 00:2a:95:51:6c:10 port 1/15 address
17.15.3.10 lease-time 3 vlan 200

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Configures the amount of time between each automatic save of the bind-
binding timeout ing table contents to a file on the switch.
ip helper dhcp-snooping Synchronizes the contents of the DHCP Snooping binding table with the
binding action contents of the dhcpBinding.db file saved on the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingMacAddress
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingIfIndex
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingIpAddress
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingLeaseTime
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingVlan
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingType

page 14-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping binding timeout


Configures the amount of time between each automatic save of the DHCP Snooping binding table
contents maintained in memory to a file on the switch. This functionality preserves binding table contents
across switch reboots.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding timeout seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The number of seconds (180 to 600) to wait before the next save.

Defaults
By default, the timeout value is set to 300 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The timeout value is only valid if the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality is enabled.

• The contents of the binding table is saved to the dhcpBinding.db file in the /flash/switch directory.

• The dhcpBinding.db file is time stamped when a save of the binding table contents is successfully
completed.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding timeout 600
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding timeout 250

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping .Enables or disables the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality.
binding
ip helper dhcp-snooping Synchronizes the contents of the DHCP Snooping binding table with the
binding action contents of the dhcpBinding.db file saved on the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingDatabaseSyncTimeout
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingDatabaseLastSyncTime

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-37


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping binding action


Triggers a purge or renew action against the DHCP Snooping binding table. A purge action clears the
contents of the table. A renew action populates the table with entries saved in the dhcpBinding.db file.
ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding action {purge | renew}

Syntax Definitions
purge Clears all binding table entries that are maintained in switch memory.
renew Populates the binding table with entries saved in the dhcpBinding.db
file located in the /flash/switch directory on the switch.

Defaults
By default, the timeout value is set to 300 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The DHCP Snooping binding table is maintained in the switch memory. Binding table entries are saved on
a periodic basis to the dhcpBinding.db file on the switch. Use the purge and renew options available
with this command to sync the binding table contents with the contents of the dhcpBinding.db file.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding action purge
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding action renew

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping .Enables or disables the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality.
binding
ip helper dhcp-snooping Configures the amount of time between each automatic save of the bind-
binding timeout ing table contents to a file on the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingDatabaseAction

page 14-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency


Retains the entries in the DHCP Snooping binding table for the duration of the lease regardless of the
existence of the MAC address in the MAC address table.
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables DHCP Snooping binding persistency.
disable Disables DHCP Snooping binding persistency.

Defaults
By default, DHCP Snooping binding persistency is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• With this option disabled, the entry will be removed if the MAC address is missing from the MAC
address table when the database is synchronized.
• Use the show ip helper command to display the current status.

Examples
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency enable
-> ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip helper dhcp-snooping Enables or disables the DHCP Snooping binding table functionality.
binding
ip helper dhcp-snooping Configures the amount of time between each automatic save of the bind-
binding timeout ing table contents to a file on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-39


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper boot-up
Enables or disables automatic IP address configuration for default VLAN 1 when an unconfigured switch
boots up. If enabled, the switch broadcasts a BootP or a DHCP request packet at boot time. When the
switch receives an IP address from a BootP/DHCP server, the address is assigned to default VLAN 1.

Note. Automatic IP address configuration only supports the assignment of a permanent IP address to the
switch. Make sure that the DHCP server is configured with such an address before using this feature.

ip helper boot-up {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables automatic IP address configuration for default VLAN 1.
disable Disables automatic IP address configuration for default VLAN 1.

Defaults
By default, this feature is disabled on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the ip helper boot-up enable command to specify BootP or DHCP for the request packet type.

• If an IP router port already exists for VLAN 1, a request packet is not broadcast even if automatic IP
address configuration is enabled for the switch.

Examples
-> ip helper boot-up enable
-> ip helper boot-up disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; command deprecated; use ip interface dhcp-client.

page 14-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

ip helper boot-up enable Specifies BootP or DHCP as the type of request packet the switch will
broadcast at boot time.

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperBootupOption

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-41


DHCP Relay Commands

ip helper boot-up enable


Specifies the type of packet to broadcast (BootP or DHCP) when automatic IP address configuration is
enabled for the switch.

Note. Automatic IP address configuration only supports the assignment of a permanent IP address to the
switch. Make sure that the DHCP server is configured with such an address before using this feature.

ip helper boot-up enable {BOOTP | DHCP}

Syntax Definitions
BOOTP Broadcasts a BOOTP formatted request packet.
DHCP Broadcasts a DHCP formatted request packet.

Defaults

parameter default
BOOTP | DHCP BOOTP

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command is only valid if automatic IP address configuration is already enabled for the switch.

Examples
-> ip helper boot-up enable DHCP
-> ip helper boot-up enable BOOTP

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; command deprecated; use ip interface dhcp-client.

Related Commands

ip helper boot-up Enables or disables automatic IP configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperBootupPacketOption

page 14-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip udp relay
Enables or disables UDP port relay for BOOTP/DHCP and generic UDP service ports (i.e., NBNS/NBDD,
other well-known UDP ports, and user-defined service ports that are not well-known).
ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port [name]}
no ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port}

Syntax Definitions
BOOTP BOOTP/DHCP well-known ports 67/68.
NBDD NBDD well-known port 138.
NBNSNBDD NBNS/NBDD well-known ports 137/138.
DNS DNS well-known port 53.
TACACS TACACS well-known port 65.
TFTP TFTP well-known port 69.
NTP NTP well-known port 123.
port Any number that is not a well-known port number.
name Text string description up to 30 characters.

Defaults
By default, relay is enabled on the BOOTP/DHCP well-known ports.

parameter default
name User Service Other#

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable UDP Relay for the specified service port.

• Only use the port parameter to specify service port numbers that are not well known. For example, do
not specify port 53 as it is the well-known port number for DNS. Instead, use the DNS parameter to
enable relay for port 53.
• The name parameter is only used with the port parameter and provides a user-defined description to
identify the not well-known port service.
• When entering a name for a user-defined service, quotes are required around ambiguous characters,
such as hex characters, spaces, etc, so they are interpreted as text. For example, the name “A UDP
Protocol” requires quotes because of the spaces between the words.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-43


DHCP Relay Commands

• When UDP Relay is disabled for BOOTP/DHCP, the ip helper configuration is not retained and all
dependant functionality (i.e., automatic IP configuration for VLAN 1, Telnet and HTTP client authenti-
cation, etc.) is disrupted.
• Up to three types of UDP Relay services are supported at any one time and in any combination.

Note. If the relay service for BOOTP/DHCP is disabled when the switch reboots, the service is automati-
cally enabled when the switch comes back up. If there were three non-BOOTP/DHCP relay services
already enabled before the reboot, the most recent service enabled is disabled and replaced with the
BOOTP/DHCP relay service.

• If port relay is enabled for the NBDD well-known port, NBNS is not automatically enabled by default.
Specify NBNS/NBDD to enable relay for both well-known ports.
• Note that when UDP port relay is enabled for NTP, relay cannot forward NTP packets that contain a
destination IP address that matches a VLAN router IP address on the switch.

Examples
-> ip udp relay DNS
-> ip udp 3047 “Generic Service”
-> no ip udp relay BOOTP
-> no ip udp relay 3047

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip udp relay vlan Specifies the VLAN to which traffic from the specified UDP service
port is forwarded.

MIB Objects
iphelperxServicePortAssociationTable
iphelperxServicePortAssociationService
iphelperxServicePortAssociationPort
iphelperxServicePortAssociationName
iphelperxPortServiceAssociationTable
iphelperxPortServiceAssociationService
iphelperxPortServiceAssociationPort
iphelperxPortServiceAssociationName

page 14-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

ip udp relay vlan


Specifies a VLAN on which traffic destined for a UDP port is forwarded.
ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port} vlan vlan_id
no ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port} vlan vlan_id

Syntax Definitions
BOOTP BOOTP/DHCP well-known ports 67/68.
NBDD NBDD well-known port 138.
NBNSNBDD NBNS/NBDD well-known ports 137/138.
DNS DNS well-known port 53.
TACACS TACACS well-known port 65.
TFTP TFTP well-known port 69.
NTP NTP well-known port 123.
port A user-specified port that is not a well-known port.
vlan_id A numeric value (1–4094) that uniquely identifies an individual VLAN.
Use a hyphen to specify a range of VLANs (e.g., 1-5).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the VLAN association with the UDP service port.

• The maximum number of VLANs that can receive forwarded UDP service port traffic is 256.

• Only specify service port numbers that are not well known when using the port parameter with this
command. For example, do not specify port 53 as it is the well-known port number for the DNS UDP
service. Instead, use the DNS parameter to enable relay for port 53.
• Specifying a VLAN for the BOOTP/DHCP service does not work if the per-vlan only forwarding
option is not active. Use the ip helper per-vlan only command to enable this option.

Examples
-> ip udp relay DNS vlan 10
-> ip udp 3047 vlan 500
-> no ip udp relay DNS vlan 10

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-45


DHCP Relay Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip udp relay Enables or disables relay for UDP service ports.

MIB Objects
iphelperxPortServiceAssociationTable
iphelperxPortServiceAssociationService

page 14-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip helper
Displays the current DHCP Relay, Relay Agent Information, and DHCP Snooping configuration.
show ip helper

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Displays information for all IP addresses configured.

Examples
The following example shows what the display output looks like when the DHCP Snooping feature is
enabled and the DHCP relay agent information (Option 82) feature is disabled:

-> show ip helper


Ip helper :
Forward Delay(seconds) = 3,
Max number of hops = 4,
Relay Agent Information = Disabled,
DHCP Snooping Status = Switch-Level Enabled,
Option 82 Data Insertion Per Switch = Enabled,
MAC Address Verification Per Switch = Enabled,
DHCP Snooping Bypass Opt82-Check = Disabled,
DHCP Snooping Opt82 Format = Base MAC,
DHCP Snooping Opt82 String = 00:d0:95:ae:3b:f6,
DHCP Snooping Binding DB Status = Enabled,
Database Sync Timeout = 300,
Database Last Sync Time = Mar 19 2007 14:32,
Binding Persistency Status = Enabled
PXE Support = Disabled,
Forward option = standard
Vlan Number NA
Bootup Option Disable
Forwarding Address :
1.1.1.1
21.2.2.10
172.19.4.1

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-47


DHCP Relay Commands

The following example shows what the display output looks like when the DHCP relay agent information
(Option 82) feature is enabled and the DHCP Snooping feature is disabled:

-> show ip helper


Ip helper :
Forward Delay(seconds) = 3,
Max number of hops = 4,
Relay Agent Information = Enabled,
Relay Agent Information Policy = Drop
DHCP Snooping Status = Disabled
DHCP Snooping Bypass Opt82-Check = Disabled,
DHCP Snooping Opt82 Format = Base MAC,
DHCP Snooping Opt82 String = 00:d0:95:ae:3b:f6,
DHCP Snooping Binding DB Status = Disabled,
Forward option = standard
Vlan Number NA
Bootup Option Disable
Forwarding Address :
5.5.5.5
21.2.2.10
172.19.4.1

output definitions
Forward Delay The current forward delay time (default is three seconds). Use the
ip helper forward delay command to change this value.
Max number of hops The current maximum number of hops allowed (default is four
hops). Use the ip helper maximum hops command to change this
value.
Forward option The current forwarding option setting: standard. Configured
through the ip helper standard command.
Relay Agent Information Indicates the status (Enabled or Disabled) of the DHCP relay
agent information option (Option 82) feature. Configured through
the ip helper agent-information command. This feature is dis-
abled if the DHCP snooping feature is enabled.
Relay Agent Information Policy The current policy action (Drop, Keep, Replace) applied to DHCP
packets that contain an Option-82 field. Configured through the ip
helper agent-information policy command. Note that this field
only appears when the DHCP relay agent information Option-82
feature is enabled.
DHCP Snooping Status Indicates the status (Disabled, Switch-Level Enabled, or VLAN-
Level Enabled) of the DHCP snooping feature. Configured
through the ip helper dhcp-snooping or ip helper dhcp-snooping
vlan command. This feature is disabled if the DHCP relay agent
information option is enabled.
Option 82 Data Insertion Per Indicates whether or not the DHCP Option 82 field is added to
Switch DHCP packets (Enabled or Disabled). Configured through the ip
helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion command. Note
that this field only appears when DHCP snooping is enabled at the
switch level.

page 14-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

output definitions
MAC Address Verification Per Indicates whether or not MAC address verification is performed on
Switch the DHCP packets (Enabled or Disabled). Configured through the
ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification command.
Note that this field only appears when DHCP snooping is enabled
at the switch level.
DHCP Snooping Bypass Opt82- Indicates whether or not an Option-82 check is performed for
Check DHCP packets ingressing on untrusted ports (Enabled or Dis-
abled). Configured through the ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass
option-82-check command.
DHCP Snooping Opt 82 Format The type of information (base MAC address for the switch, system
name for the switch, or user-defined text) that is inserted into the
Option-82 field when Option-82 data insertion is enabled for the
switch. Configured through the ip helper dhcp-snooping option-
82 format command.
DHCP Snooping Opt 82 String The user-defined text inserted into the Option-82 field when data
insertion is enabled and a string format for the data is specified.
Configure through the ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 format
command.
DHCP Binding DB Status Indicates if the DHCP snooping binding table (database) function-
ality is Enabled or Disabled.
Database Sync Timeout The amount of time, in seconds, that the switch waits between each
synchronization of the DHCP snooping binding table with the
dhcpBinding.db file (default is 300 seconds). Configured through
the ip helper dhcp-snooping binding timeout command. Note
that this field does not appear if the binding table functionality is
disabled.
Database Last Sync Time The last time and day the DHCP snooping binding table was syn-
chronized with the dhcpBinding.db file. Note that this field does
not appear if the binding table functionality is disabled.
Binding Persistency Status Indicates whether or not the DHCP snooping binding table retains
entries with MAC addresses that were cleared from the MAC
address table (Enabled or Disabled). Configured through the ip
helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency command.
Bootup Option Indicates whether or not automatic IP address configuration for
default VLAN 1 is done when the switch boots up (Enabled or
Disabled). Configured through the ip helper boot-up command.
Bootup Packet Option Indicates if the Bootup Option broadcasts a DHCP or BOOTP
packet to obtain an IP address for default VLAN 1. Configured
through the ip helper boot-up enable command. Note that this
field does not appear if the Bootup Option is disabled.
Forwarding Addresses IP addresses for DHCP servers that will receive BOOTP/DHCP
packets forwarded by this DHCP Relay service. Use the ip helper
address command to add or remove DHCP server IP addresses
from the DHCP Relay configuration.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-49


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

show ip helper stats Displays DHCP Relay statistics, including the number of client packets
received and transmitted to the DHCP server and packets dropped due to
forward delay time and maximum hops violations.

MIB Objects
iphelperTable
iphelperService
iphelperForwAddr
iphelperForwDelay
iphelperMaxHops
iphelperAgentInformation
iphelperAgentInformationPolicy
iphelperDhcpSnooping
iphelperDhcpSnoopingOpt82DataInsertionStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingMacAddressVerificationStatus
iphelperDHCPSnoopingBypassOpt82CheckStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingOption82FormatType
iphelperDhcpSnoopingOption82StringValue
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingDatabaseSyncTimeout
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingDatabaseLastSyncTime
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanNumber
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanMacVerificationStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanOpt82DataInsertionStatus
iphelperStatTable
iphelperBootupOption
iphelperBootupPacketOption

page 14-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip helper stats


Displays the number of packets DHCP Relay has received, the number of packets dropped due to forward
delay and maximum hops violations, and the number of packets processed since the last time these statis-
tics were displayed. Also includes statistics that apply to a specific DHCP server, such as the number of
packets transmitted to the server and the difference between the number of packets received from a client
and the number transmitted to the server.
show ip helper stats
ip helper no stats

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to clear all DHCP Relay statistics.

Examples
-> show ip helper stats

Global Statistics :
Reception From Client :
Total Count = 12, Delta = 12,
Forw Delay Violation :
Total Count = 3, Delta = 3,
Max Hops Violation :
Total Count = 0, Delta = 0,
Agent Info Violation :
Total Count = 0, Delta = 0,
Invalid Gateway IP :
Total Count = 0, Delta = 0,
Invalid Agent Info From Server :
Total Count = 0, Delta = 0,
Server Specific Statistics :
Server 5.5.5.5
Tx Server :
Total Count = 9, Delta = 9

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-51


DHCP Relay Commands

output definitions
Reception From Client Number of packets DHCP Relay has received from the DHCP client.
Forw Delay Violation Number of packets dropped as a result of forward delay violations. A
violation occurs if a client packet contains an elapsed boot time value
that is less than the configured DHCP Relay forward delay time value.
Max Hops Violation Number of packets dropped as a result of maximum hop violations. A
violation occurs if a packet contains a hop count equal to or greater than
the configured DHCP Relay maximum hops value.
Agent Info Violation Number of packets dropped as a result of a relay agent information
(Option-82) violation. A violation occurs if an Option-82 DHCP packet
contains a zero gateway IP address (giaddr) and the relay agent infor-
mation policy is set to Drop or a DHCP packet has no Option-82 field
and contains a non-zero giaddr.
Invalid Gateway IP Number of packets dropped as a result of a gateway IP violation. A vio-
lation occurs if an Option-82 DHCP packet contains a gateway IP
address (giaddr) that matches a local subnet address.
Invalid Agent Info From Number of invalid Option-82 DHCP server packets dropped by the
Server relay agent.
Delta Total number of packets processed since the last time the ip helper sta-
tistics were checked during any user session.
Server DHCP server IP address that receives BOOTP/DHCP packets for-
warded by this DHCP Relay service. Use the ip helper address com-
mand to add or remove DHCP server IP addresses from DHCP Relay
configuration.
Tx Server Number of packets DHCP Relay has transmitted to the DHCP server.
Delta The difference between the number of packets received from the client
and the number of packets transmitted to the DHCP server since the last
time DHCP Relay statistics were checked during any user session.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.

MIB Objects
iphelperStatTable
iphelperServerAddress
iphelperRxFromClient
iphelperTxToServer
iphelperMaxHopsViolation
iphelperForwDelayViolation
iphelperResetAll

page 14-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan


Displays a list of VLANs that have DHCP Snooping enabled and whether or not MAC address verifica-
tion and Option-82 data insertion is enabled for each VLAN.
show ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command only applies if DHCP Snooping is enabled at the VLAN level.

• Use the show ip helper command to determine the status of DHCP Snooping at the switch level.

Examples
-> show ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan
VLAN Opt82 MAC Addr
ID Insertion Verification
------+----------+--------------
50 Enabled Enabled
60 Enabled Enabled
100 Disabled Enabled
200 Enabled Disabled
1500 Disabled Disabled

output definitions
VLAN ID The VLAN identification number for the DHCP Snooping VLAN.
MAC Address Verification Indicates whether or not MAC address verification is enabled for the
VLAN (Enabled or Disabled). Configured through the ip helper
dhcp-snooping vlan command.
Opt-82 Data Insertion Indicates whether or not Option-82 data insertion is enabled for the
VLAN (Enabled or Disabled). Configured through the ip helper
dhcp-snooping vlan command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-53


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.


show ip helper dhcp-snooping Displays the trust mode and DHCP violation statistics for all switch
port ports that are filtered by DHCP Snooping.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanNumber
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanMacVerificationStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingVlanOpt82DataInsertionStatus

page 14-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip helper dhcp-snooping port


Displays the trust mode and DHCP Snooping violation statistics for all switch ports that are filtered by
DHCP Snooping.
show ip helper dhcp-snooping port

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If DHCP Snooping is operating at the switch level, then information for all switch ports is displayed.

• If DHCP Snooping is operating at the VLAN level, then information for only those ports that are asso-
ciated with a DHCP Snooping VLAN is displayed.
• The violation statistics displayed only apply to ports that are in the client only trust mode. When the
trust mode for a port is changed from client-only to trusted or blocked, the violation counters are set
to zero (0).

Examples
-> show ip helper dhcp-snooping port
Slot Trust IP Src Opt82 MAC Server Relay Binding
Port Mode Filtering Violation Violation Violation Violation Violation
-----+-------------+----------+----------+----------+----------+---------|---------
1/1 Blocked Disabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/2 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/3 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/4 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/5 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/6 Blocked Disabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/7 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/8 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/9 Client-Only Enabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/10 Trusted Disabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/11 Trusted Disabled 0 0 0 0 0
1/12 Trusted Disabled 0 0 0 0 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-55


DHCP Relay Commands

output definitions
Slot/Port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
Trust Mode The DHCP Snooping trust mode for the port (Blocked, Client-Only, or
Trusted). Configured through the ip helper dhcp-snooping port com-
mand.
IP Src Filtering Indicates whether or not IP source filtering is enabled for the port
(Enabled or Disabled). Configured through the ip helper dhcp-snoop-
ing port ip-source-filtering command.
Opt82 Violation The number of DHCP packets dropped due to a DHCP Snooping
Option-82 violation.
MAC Violation The number of DHCP packets dropped due to a mismatch between the
packet source MAC address and the client hardware address contained
within the packet.
Server Violation The number of DHCP server packets dropped because they originated
from outside the network or firewall.
Relay Violation The number of DHCP packets dropped because the packet included a
relay agent IP address that was not 0.0.0.0.
Binding Violation The number of DHCP packets dropped due to a mismatch between
packets received and binding table information.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.


show ip helper dhcp-snooping Displays a list of DHCP Snooping VLANs.
vlan

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIfIndex
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortTrustMode
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortIpSourceFiltering
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortOption82Violation
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortMacAddrViolation
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortDhcpServerViolation
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortRelayAgentViolation
iphelperDhcpSnoopingPortBindingViolation

page 14-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip helper dhcp-snooping binding


Displays the contents of the DHCP Snooping binding table (database).
show ip helper dhcp-snooping binding

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the ip helper dhcp-snooping binding command to create a static entry in the binding table.

• Dynamic binding table entries are created when the relay agent receives a DHCPACK packet.

Examples
-> show ip helper dhcp-snooping binding
MAC Slot IP Lease VLAN Binding
Address Port Address Time ID Type
-------------------+------+---------------+---------+-------+-----------
00:ae:22:e4:00:08 1/4 10.255.11.23 2000 5 Dynamic
10:fe:a2:e4:32:08 2/15 10.255.91.53 2000 2 Dynamic

output definitions
MAC Address The MAC address of the client.
Slot/Port The slot/port designation for the switch port that received the DHCP
request
IP Address The IP address offered by the DHCP server.
Lease Time The IP address lease time assigned by the DHCP server.
VLAN ID The VLAN ID of the VLAN to which the client belongs.
Binding Type Indicates whether the binding table entry is dynamic or static. Static
entries are created using the ip helper dhcp-snooping binding com-
mand.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-57


DHCP Relay Commands

Related Commands

show ip helper Displays current DHCP Relay configuration information.


show ip helper dhcp-snooping Displays a list of DHCP Snooping VLANs.
vlan
show ip helper dhcp-snooping Displays the trust mode and DHCP violation statistics for all switch
port ports that are filtered by DHCP Snooping.

MIB Objects
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingStatus
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingTable
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingMacAddress
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingIfIndex
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingIpAddress
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingLeaseTime
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingVlan
iphelperDhcpSnoopingBindingType

page 14-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip udp relay service


Displays current configuration for UDP services by service name or by service port number.
show ip udp relay service [BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port]

Syntax Definitions
BOOTP BOOTP/DHCP well-known ports 67/68.
NBDD NBDD well-known port 138.
NBNSNBDD NBNS/NBDD well-known ports 137/138.
DNS DNS well-known port 53.
TACACS TACACS well-known port 65.
TFTP TFTP well-known port 69.
NTP NTP well-known port 123.
port A user-specified port that is not a well-known port.

Defaults
By default, the configuration for all UDP services is shown.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a service name or port number with this command to display information about an individual
service.
• When specifying a port number, do not specify a well-known port number. Instead, use the service
name for the well-known port (i.e., NBNS/NBDD, DNS, etc.).

Examples
-> show ip udp relay service

Service Port(s) Description


---------+--------+------------------
1 67 68 BOOTP/DHCP
4 53 DNS
5 65 TACACS

-> show ip udp relay service dns

Service Port(s) Description


---------+--------+------------------
4 53 DNS

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-59


DHCP Relay Commands

-> show ip udp relay service 1776

Service Port(s) Description


---------+--------+------------------
9 1776 A UDP protocol

output definitions
Service The UDP service number. (1 through 7 for well-known service ports
and 8 and above for user-defined service ports).
Port(s) The UDP service port number.
Description A description of the UDP service.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip udp relay statistics Displays the current statistics for each UDP port relay service.
show ip udp relay destination Displays the VLAN assignments to which the traffic received on the
specified UDP service port is forwarded.

MIB Objects
iphelperxPropertiesTable
iphelperxPropertiesService
iphelperxPropertiesPort
iphelperxPropertiesName

page 14-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip udp relay statistics


Displays the current statistics for each UDP port relay service. These statistics include the name of the
service, the forwarding VLAN(s) configured for that service, and the number of packets the service has
sent and received.
show ip udp relay [BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port]

Syntax Definitions
BOOTP BOOTP/DHCP well-known ports 67/68.
NBDD NBDD well-known port 138.
NBNSNBDD NBNS/NBDD well-known ports 137/138.
DNS DNS well-known port 53.
TACACS TACACS well-known port 65.
TFTP TFTP well-known port 69.
NTP NTP well-known port 123.
port A user-specified port that is not a well-known port.

Defaults
By default, the statistics for all UDP services is shown.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a service name or port number with this command to display information about an individual
service.
• When specifying a port number, do not specify a well-known port number. Instead, use the service
name for the well-known port (i.e., NBNS/NBDD, DNS, etc.).

Examples
-> show ip udp relay statistics

Service Vlan Pkts Sent Pkts Recvd


---------------+--------+------------+----------
BOOTP 0 0
DNS 2 10 10
4 15 15
TACACS 3 0 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-61


DHCP Relay Commands

-> show ip udp relay statistics tacacs

Service Vlan Pkts Sent Pkts Recvd


---------------+--------+------------+-----------
TACACS 3 0 0

-> show ip udp relay statistics 1776

Service Vlan Pkts Sent Pkts Recvd


-------------------+--------+-----------+-----------
A UDP Protocol 18 2 2

output definitions
Service The active UDP service name.
VLAN The VLAN assigned to the UDP service port that will forward traffic
destined for that port. Use the ip udp relay vlan command to configure
this value.
Pkts Sent The number of packets sent from this service port to the server.
Pkts Recvd The number of packets received by this service port from a client.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip udp relay service Displays current configuration for UDP services by service name or by
service port number.
show ip udp relay destination Displays the VLAN assignments to which the traffic received on the
specified UDP service port is forwarded.

MIB Objects
iphelperxStatTable
iphelperxStatService
iphelperxStatVlan
iphelperxStatTxToServer
iphelperxStatRxFromClient

page 14-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DHCP Relay Commands

show ip udp relay destination


Displays the VLAN assignments to which the traffic received on the specified UDP service port is
forwarded.
show ip udp relay destination [BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port]

Syntax Definitions
BOOTP BOOTP/DHCP well-known ports 67/68.
NBDD NBDD well-known port 138.
NBNSNBDD NBNS/NBDD well-known ports 137/138.
DNS DNS well-known port 53.
TACACS TACACS well-known port 65.
TFTP TFTP well-known port 69.
NTP NTP well-known port 123.
port A user-specified port that is not a well-known port.

Defaults
By default, the forwarding VLAN assignments for all UDP services is shown.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Enter a service name or port number with this command to display information about an individual
service.
• When specifying a port number, do not specify a well-known port number. Instead, use the service
name for the well-known port (i.e., NBNS/NBDD, DNS, etc.).

Examples
-> show ip udp relay destination

Service Port VLANs


---------------+--------+----------------
BOOTP 67
DNS 53 2 4
TACACS 65 3

-> show ip udp relay destination dns

Service Port VLANs


---------------+--------+----------------
DNS 53 2 4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14-63


DHCP Relay Commands

-> show ip udp relay destination 1776

Service Port VLANs


-----------------+--------+----------------
A UDP Protocol 1776 18

output definitions
Service The active UDP service name.
Port The UDP service port number.
VLANs The VLAN assigned to the UDP service port that will forward traffic
destined for that port. Use the ip udp relay vlan command to configure
this value.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip udp relay service Displays current configuration for UDP services by service name or by
service port number.
show ip udp relay statistics Displays the current statistics for each UDP port relay service.

MIB Objects
iphelperTable
iphelperService
iphelperVlan
iphelperxPropertiesTable
iphelperxPropertiesName
iphelperxPropertiesPort

page 14-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


15 IP Multicast Switching
Commands

IP Multicast Switching (IPMS) is a one-to-many communication technique employed by emerging appli-


cations such as video distribution, news feeds, conferencing, netcasting, and resource discovery). Unlike
unicast, which sends one packet per destination, multicast sends one packet to all devices in any subnet-
work that has at least one device requesting the multicast traffic.
Alcatel-Lucent’s IPMS software is compatible with the following RFCs:
RFC 1112 — Host Extensions for IP Multicasting
RFC 2236 — Internet Group Management Protocol, Version 2
RFC 2933 — Internet Group Management Protocol MIB
RFC 3376 — Internet Group Management Protocol, Version 3
Alcatel-Lucent’s IPv6MS software is compatible with the following RFCs:
RFC 2710 — Multicast Listener Discovery for IPv6
RFC 3019 — IPv6 MIB for Multicast Listener Discovery Protocol
RFC 3810 — Multicast Listener Discovery Version 2 for IPv6
MIB information for the IPMS commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Igmp.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IGMP-IND1-MIB
MIB information for the IPv6MS commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Mld.mib
Module: ALCATEL-MLD-IND1-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-1


IP Multicast Switching Commands

The following table summarizes the available IP and IPv6 multicast commands:

ip multicast status
ip multicast querier-forwarding
ip multicast version
ip multicast static-neighbor
ip multicast static-querier
ip multicast static-group
ip multicast query-interval
ip multicast last-member-query-interval
ip multicast query-response-interval
ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval
ip multicast router-timeout
ip multicast source-timeout
ip multicast querying
ip multicast robustness
ip multicast spoofing
ip multicast zapping
ip multicast proxying
ipv6 multicast status
ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding
ipv6 multicast version
ipv6 multicast static-neighbor
ipv6 multicast static-querier
ipv6 multicast static-group
ipv6 multicast query-interval
ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval
ipv6 multicast query-response-interval
ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval
ipv6 multicast router-timeout
ipv6 multicast source-timeout
ipv6 multicast querying
ipv6 multicast robustness
ipv6 multicast spoofing
ipv6 multicast zapping
ipv6 multicast proxying
show ip multicast
show ip multicast forward
show ip multicast neighbor
show ip multicast querier
show ip multicast group
show ip multicast source
show ipv6 multicast
show ipv6 multicast forward
show ipv6 multicast neighbor
show ipv6 multicast querier
show ipv6 multicast group
show ipv6 multicast source

page 15-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast status
Enables or disables IP Multicast Switching and Routing on the specified VLAN, or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] status [{enable | disable}]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable IP Multicast Switching and Routing.
disable Disable IP Multicast Switching and Routing.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an IP Multicast Routing protocol is already running on the system, the ip multicast status command
will override the existing configuration and always enable IP Multicast Switching and Routing.
• If the IP Multicast Switching and Routing is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• You can also restore the IP Multicast Switching and Routing to its default (i.e., disabled) status on the
system if no VLAN is specified, by using only ip multicast status (e.g., ip multicast status).
• You can also restore the IP Multicast Switching and Routing to its default (i.e., disabled) status on the
specified VLAN, by using only ip multicast vlan vid status (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 status).

Examples
-> ip multicast status enable
-> ip multicast status disable
-> ip multicast status
-> ip multicast vlan 2 status enable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 status disable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 status

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-3


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpStatus
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanStatus

page 15-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast querier-forwarding
Enables or disables IGMP querier forwarding on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding [{enable | disable}]
no ip multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding

Syntax Definitions
vid The VLAN on which configuration is applied.
enable Enable IGMP querier forwarding.
disable Disable IGMP querier forwarding.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IGMP querier forwarding entry on the specified VLAN
or on the system and return to its default behavior.
• If the IGMP querier forwarding is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• IGMP querier forwarding refers to promoting detected IGMP queriers to receive all IP multicast data
traffic.

Examples
-> ip multicast querier-forwarding enable
-> ip multicast querier-forwarding disable
-> ip multicast querier-forwarding
-> ip multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding enable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding disable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding
-> no ip multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-5


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpQuerierForwarding
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanQuerierForwarding

page 15-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast version
Sets the default version of the IGMP protocol on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] version [version]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
version Default IGMP protocol version to run. Valid range is 1 to 3.
Defaults

parameter default
version 2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the default IGMP protocol version on the
system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the default IGMP protocol version is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• Due to protocol inter-operation requirements, this command specifies only a default version of the
IGMP protocol to run.
• To restore the IGMP multicast version to the default (i.e., 2) version on the system if no VLAN is spec-
ified, use ip multicast version followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast version 0) or use
only ip multicast version (e.g., ip multicast version).
• To restore the IGMP multicast version to the default (i.e., 2) version on the specified VLAN, use
ip multicast vlan vid version, followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 version 0) or use
only ip multicast vlan vid version (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 version).

Examples
-> ip multicast version 3
-> ip multicast version 0
-> ip multicast version
-> ip multicast vlan 2 version 3
-> ip multicast vlan 2 version 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 version

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-7


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpVersion
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanVersion

page 15-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast static-neighbor
Creates a static IGMP neighbor entry on a specified port on a specified VLAN.
ip multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port
no ip multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN to include as a static IGMP neighbor.
slot/port The slot/port number you want to configure as a static IGMP neighbor.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IGMP static neighbor entry on a specified port on a
specified VLAN.
• The ip multicast static-neighbor command allows you to create an IGMP static neighbor entry on a
specified port on a specified VLAN. This, in turn, enables that network segment to receive all the
IGMP traffic.
• You can also create an IGMP static neighbor entry on a link aggregate port by entering
ip multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port, followed by the link aggregation group number
(e.g., ip multicast static-neighbor vlan 2 port 7).

Examples
-> ip multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 1/1
-> no ip multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 1/1
-> ip multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 7
-> no ip multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-9


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast neighbor Displays the IGMP neighbor table entries of IP Multicast Switching and
Routing.

MIB Objects
alaIgmpStaticNeighborTable
alaIgmpStaticNeighborVlan
alaIgmpStaticNeighborIfIndex
alaIgmpStaticNeighborRowStatus

page 15-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast static-querier
Creates a static IGMP querier entry on a specified port on a specified VLAN.
ip multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port
no ip multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN to include as a static IGMP querier.
slot/port The slot/port number you want to configure as a static IGMP querier.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IGMP static querier entry on a specified port on a spec-
ified VLAN.
• The ip multicast static-querier command allows you to create an IGMP static querier entry on a spec-
ified port on a specified VLAN. This, in-turn, enables that network segment to receive all the IGMP
traffic.
• You can also create an IGMP static querier entry on a link aggregate port by entering
ip multicast static-querier vlan vid port, followed by the link aggregation group number
(e.g., ip multicast static-querier vlan 2 port 7).

Examples
-> ip multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 1/1
-> no ip multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 1/1
-> ip multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 7
-> no ip multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-11


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast querier Displays the IGMP querier table entries of IP Multicast Switching and
Routing.

MIB Objects
alaIgmpStaticQuerierTable
alaIgmpStaticQuerierVlan
alaIgmpStaticQuerierIfIndex
alaIgmpStaticQuerierRowStatus

page 15-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast static-group
Creates a static IGMP group entry on a specified port on a specified VLAN.
ip multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port
no ip multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address of the multicast group.
vid VLAN to include as a static IGMP group.
slot/port The slot/port number you want to configure as a static IGMP group.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IGMP static group entry on a specified port on a speci-
fied VLAN.
• The ip multicast static-group command allows you to create an IGMP static group entry on a speci-
fied port on a specified VLAN. This, in-turn, enables that network segment to receive IGMP traffic
addressed to the specified IP multicast group address.
• You can also create an IGMP static group entry on a link aggregate port by entering
ip multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port, followed by the link aggregation group number
(e.g., ip multicast static-group 11.0.0.1 vlan 2 port 7).

Examples
-> ip multicast static-group 229.10.10.10 vlan 4 port 1/1
-> no ip multicast static-group 229.10.10.10 vlan 4 port 1/1
-> ip multicast static-group 225.11.11.11 vlan 4 port 7
-> no ip multicast static-group 225.11.11.11 vlan 4 port 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-13


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast group Displays the IGMP group membership table entries of IP Multicast
Switching and Routing for the specified IP multicast group address or
all entries if no IP multicast group address is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmpStaticMemberTable
alaIgmpStaticMemberVlan
alaIgmpStaticMemberIfIndex
alaIgmpStaticMemberGroupAddress
alaIgmpStaticMemberRowStatus

page 15-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast query-interval
Sets the IGMP query interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] query-interval [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds IGMP query interval in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 125

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP query interval on the system and/
or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP query interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• The IGMP query interval refers to the time period between IGMP query messages.

• To restore the IGMP query interval to its default (i.e., 125 seconds) value on the system if no VLAN is
specified, use ip multicast query-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast query-interval 0)
or use only ip multicast query-interval (e.g., ip multicast query-interval).
• To restore the IGMP query interval to its default (i.e., 125 seconds) value on the specified VLAN, use
ip multicast vlan vid query-interval, followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 query-interval
0) or use only ip multicast vlan vid query-interval (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 query-interval).

Examples
-> ip multicast query-interval 100
-> ip multicast query-interval 0
-> ip multicast query-interval
-> ip multicast vlan 2 query-interval 100
-> ip multicast vlan 2 query-interval 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 query-interval

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-15


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpQueryInterval
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanQueryInterval

page 15-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast last-member-query-interval
Sets the IGMP last member query interval value on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] last-member-query-interval [tenths-of-seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
tenths-of-seconds IGMP last member query interval in tenths of seconds. Valid range is 1
to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
tenths-of-seconds 10

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP last member query interval on
the system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP last member query interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configu-
ration will override the system's configuration.
• The IGMP last member query interval refers to the time period to reply to an IGMP query message
sent in response to a leave group message.
• To restore the IGMP last member query interval to its default (i.e., 10 tenths-of-seconds) value on the
system if no VLAN is specified, use ip multicast last-member-query-interval followed by the value
0 (e.g., ip multicast last-member-query-interval 0) or use only
ip multicast last-member-query-interval (e.g., ip multicast last-member-query-interval).
• To restore the IGMP last member query interval to its default (i.e., 10 tenths-of-seconds) value on the
specified VLAN, use ip multicast vlan vid last-member-query interval followed by the value 0 (e.g.,
ip multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-interval 0) or use only
ip multicast vlan vid last-member-query-interval (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-inter-
val).

Examples
-> ip multicast last-member-query-interval 22
-> ip multicast last-member-query-interval 0
-> ip multicast last-member-query-interval
-> ip multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-interval 22
-> ip multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-interval 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-interval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-17


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpLastMemberQueryInterval
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanLastMemberQueryInterval

page 15-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast query-response-interval
Sets the IGMP query response interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] query-response-interval [tenths-of-seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
tenths-of-seconds IGMP query response interval in tenths of seconds. Valid range is 1 to
65535.

Defaults

parameter default
tenths-of-seconds 100

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP query response interval on the
system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP query response interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• The query response interval refers to the time period to reply to an IGMP query message.

• To restore the IGMP query response interval to its default (i.e., 100 tenths-of-seconds) value on the
system if no VLAN is specified, use ip multicast query-response-interval followed by the value 0
(e.g., ip multicast query-response-interval 0) or use only ip multicast query-response-interval (e.g.,
ip multicast query-response-interval).
• To restore the IGMP last member query interval to its default (i.e., 100 tenths-of-seconds) value on the
specified VLAN, use ip multicast vlan vid query-response-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip
multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval 0) or use only ip multicast vlan vid query-response-inter-
val (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval).

Examples
-> ip multicast query-response-interval 200
-> ip multicast query-response-interval 0
-> ip multicast query-response-interval
-> ip multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval 300
-> ip multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-19


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpQueryResponseInterval
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanQueryResponseInterval

page 15-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval
Sets the value of the IGMP unsolicited report interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] unsolicited-report-interval [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds IGMP query response interval in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535,
where 0 represents the default setting.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP unsolicited report interval on the
system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP query response interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• The unsolicited report interval refers to the time period to proxy any changed IGMP membership state.

• To restore the IGMP unsolicited report interval to its default (i.e., 1 second) value on the system if no
VLAN is specified, use ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip
multicast unsolicited-report-interval 0) or use only ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval (e.g., ip
multicast unsolicited-report-interval).
• To restore the IGMP unsolicited report interval to its default (i.e., 1 second) value on the specified
VLAN, use ip multicast vlan vid unsolicited-report-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multi-
cast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval 0) or use only ip multicast vlan vid unsolicited-report-inter-
val (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval).

Examples
-> ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval 200
-> ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval 0
-> ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval
-> ip multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval 300
-> ip multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-21


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpUnsolicitedReportInterval
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanUnsolicitedReportInterval

page 15-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast router-timeout
Configures the expiry time of IP multicast routers on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] router-timeout [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds IGMP router timeout in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 90

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP router timeout on the system and/
or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP router timeout is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• To restore the IGMP router timeout to its default (i.e., 90 seconds) value on the system if no VLAN is
specified, use ip multicast router-timeout followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast router-timeout 0)
or use only ip multicast router-timeout (e.g., ip multicast router-timeout).
• To restore the IGMP router timeout to its default (i.e., 90 seconds) value on the specified VLAN, use
ip multicast vlan vid router-timeout followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 router-timeout
0) or use only ip multicast vlan vid router-timeout (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 router-timeout).

Examples
-> ip multicast router-timeout 100
-> ip multicast router-timeout 0
-> ip multicast router-timeout
-> ip multicast vlan 2 router-timeout 100
-> ip multicast vlan 2 router-timeout 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 router-timeout

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-23


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpRouterTimeout
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanRouterTimeout

page 15-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast source-timeout
Configures the expiry time of IP multicast sources on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] source-timeout [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds IGMP source timeout in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 30

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP source timeout on the system
and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP source timeout is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• To restore the IGMP source timeout to its default (i.e., 30 seconds) value on the system if no VLAN is
specified, use ip multicast source-timeout followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast source-timeout
0) or use only ip multicast source-timeout (e.g., ip multicast source-timeout).
• To restore the IGMP source timeout to its default (i.e., 30 seconds) value on the specified VLAN, use
ip multicast vlan vid source-timeout followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 source-timeout
0) or use only ip multicast vlan vid source-timeout (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 source-timeout).

Examples
-> ip multicast source-timeout 100
-> ip multicast source-timeout 0
-> ip multicast source-timeout
-> ip multicast vlan 2 source-timeout 100
-> ip multicast vlan 2 source-timeout 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 source-timeout

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-25


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpSourceTimeout
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanSourceTimeout

page 15-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast querying
Enables or disables IGMP querying on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] querying [{enable | disable}]
no ip multicast [vlan vid] querying

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which configuration is applied.
enable Enable IGMP querying.
disable Disable IGMP querying.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IGMP querying entry on the specified VLAN or on the
system and return to its default behavior.
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to enable IGMP querying on the system and/or
specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP querying is already enabled/disabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• IGMP querying refers to requesting the network's IGMP group membership information by sending
out IGMP queries. IGMP querying also involves participating in IGMP querier election.
• You can also restore the IGMP querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ip multicast querying (e.g., ip multicast querying).
• You can also restore the IGMP querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN,
by using only ip multicast vlan vid querying (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 querying).

Examples
-> ip multicast querying enable
-> ip multicast querying disable
-> ip multicast querying
-> ip multicast vlan 2 querying enable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 querying disable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 querying
-> no ip multicast vlan 2 querying

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-27


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpQuerying
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanQuerying

page 15-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast robustness
Sets the IGMP robustness variable on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] robustness [robustness]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
robustness IGMP robustness variable. Valid range is 1 to 7.

Defaults

parameter default
robustness 2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IP Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the IGMP robustness variable on the system
and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the IGMP robustness variable is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• Robustness variable allows fine-tuning on the network, where the expected packet loss would be
greater.
• To restore the IGMP robustness variable to its default (i.e., 2) value on the system if no VLAN is spec-
ified, use ip multicast robustness followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast robustness 0) or use only
ip multicast robustness (e.g., ip multicast robustness).
• To restore the IGMP robustness variable to its default (i.e., 2) value on the specified VLAN, use
ip multicast vlan vid robustness followed by the value 0 (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 robustness 0) or use
only ip multicast vlan vid robustness (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 robustness).

Examples
-> ip multicast robustness 3
-> ip multicast robustness 0
-> ip multicast robustness
-> ip multicast vlan 2 robustness 3
-> ip multicast vlan 2 robustness 0
-> ip multicast vlan 2 robustness

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-29


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpRobustness
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanRobustness

page 15-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast spoofing
Enables or disables IGMP spoofing on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] spoofing [{enable | disable}]
no ip multicast [vlan vid] spoofing

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable IGMP spoofing.
disable Disable IGMP spoofing.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an IGMP spoofing entry on the specified VLAN or on the
system and return to its default behavior.
• If the IGMP spoofing is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will override the
system's configuration.
• IGMP spoofing refers to replacing a client's MAC and IP address with the system's MAC and IP
address when proxying aggregated IGMP group membership information.
• You can also restore the IGMP spoofing to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ip multicast spoofing (e.g., ip multicast spoofing).
• You can also restore the IGMP spoofing to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN, by
using only ip multicast vlan vid spoofing (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 spoofing).

Examples
-> ip multicast spoofing enable
-> ip multicast spoofing disable
-> ip multicast spoofing
-> ip multicast vlan 2 spoofing enable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 spoofing disable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 spoofing
-> no ip multicast vlan 2 spoofing

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-31


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpSpoofing
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanSpoofing

page 15-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast zapping
Enables or disables IGMP zapping on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] zapping [{enable | disable}]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable IGMP zapping.
disable Disable IGMP zapping.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the IGMP zapping is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will override the
system's configuration.
• IGMP zapping refers to processing membership, immediate source filter removals and will not wait for
the protocol's specified time period. This mode facilitates IP TV applications looking for quick changes
between IP multicast groups.
• You can also restore the IGMP querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ip multicast zapping (e.g., ip multicast zapping).
• You can also restore the IGMP querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN,
by using only ip multicast vlan vid zapping (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 zapping).

Examples
-> ip multicast zapping enable
-> ip multicast zapping disable
-> ip multicast zapping
-> ip multicast vlan 2 zapping enable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 zapping disable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 zapping

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-33


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpZapping
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanZapping

page 15-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ip multicast proxying
Enables or disables IGMP proxying on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast [vlan vid] proxying [enable | disable]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable IGMP proxying.
disable Disable IGMP proxying.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the IGMP proxying is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will override the
system's configuration.
• IGMP proxying refers to processing membership information on behalf of client systems and reporting
membership on their behalf.
• You can also restore the IGMP querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ip multicast proxying (e.g., ip multicast proxying).
• You can also restore the IGMP querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN,
by using only ip multicast vlan vid proxying (e.g., ip multicast vlan 2 proxying).

Examples
-> ip multicast proxying enable
-> ip multicast proxying disable
-> ip multicast proxying
-> ip multicast vlan 2 proxying enable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 proxying disable
-> ip multicast vlan 2 proxying

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-35


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ip multicast Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general
configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpProxying
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanProxying

page 15-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast status


Enables or disables IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing on the specified VLAN or on the system if no
VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] status [{enable | disable}]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing.
disable Disable IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If an IPv6 multicast routing protocol is already running on the system, the ipv6 multicast status
command will override this configuration and always enable IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing.
• If the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configu-
ration will override the system's configuration.
• You can also restore the MLD querying to its default (i.e., disabled) status on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ipv6 multicast status (e.g., ipv6 multicast status).
• You can also restore the MLD querying to its default (i.e., disabled) status on the specified VLAN, by
using only ipv6 multicast vlan vid status (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 status).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast status enable
-> ipv6 multicast status disable
-> ipv6 multicast status
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 status enable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 status disable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 status

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-37


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldStatus
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanStatus

page 15-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding


Enables or disables MLD querier forwarding on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding [{enable | disable}]
no ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding

Syntax Definitions
vid The VLAN on which configuration is applied.
enable Enable MLD querier forwarding.
disable Disable MLD querier forwarding.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an MLD querier forwarding entry on the specified VLAN
or on the system and return to its default behavior.
• If the MLD querier forwarding is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• MLD querier forwarding refers to promoting detected MLD queriers to receive all IP multicast data
traffic.

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding enable
-> ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding disable
-> ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding enable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding disable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding
-> no ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querier-forwarding

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-39


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldQuerierForwarding
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanQuerierForwarding

page 15-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast version


Sets the default version of the MLD protocol on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is
specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] version [version]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
version Default MLD protocol version to run. Valid range is 1 to 2.
Defaults

parameter default
version 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the default MLD protocol version on the
system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the default MLD protocol version is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• Due to protocol inter-operation requirements, this command specifies only a default version of the
MLD protocol to run.
• To restore the MLD multicast version to the default (i.e., 1) version on the system if no VLAN is speci-
fied, use ipv6 multicast version followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast version 0) or use
only ipv6 multicast version (e.g., ipv6 multicast version).
• To restore the MLD multicast version to the default (i.e., 1) version on the specified VLAN, use
ipv6 multicast vlan vid version followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 version 0) or use
only ipv6 multicast vlan vid version (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 version).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast version 2
-> ipv6 multicast version 0
-> ipv6 multicast version
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 version 2
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 version 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 version

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-41


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldVersion
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanVersion

page 15-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast static-neighbor


Creates a static MLD neighbor entry on a specified port on a specified VLAN.
ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port
no ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN to include as a static MLD neighbor.
slot/port The slot/port number you want to configure as a static MLD neighbor.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an MLD static neighbor entry on a specified port on a
specified VLAN.
• The ipv6 multicast static-neighbor command allows you to create an MLD static neighbor entry on a
specified port on a specified VLAN. This, in turn, enables that network segment to receive all MLD
traffic.
• You can also create an MLD static neighbor entry on a link aggregate port by entering
ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port, followed by the link aggregation group number
(e.g., ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan 2 port 7).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 1/1
-> no ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 1/1
-> ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 7
-> no ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan 4 port 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-43


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast neighbor Displays the MLD neighbor table entries of IPv6 Multicast Switching
and Routing.

MIB Objects
alaMldStaticNeighborTable
alaMldStaticNeighborVlan
alaMldStaticNeighborIfIndex
alaMldStaticNeighborRowStatus

page 15-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast static-querier


Creates a static MLD querier entry on a specified port on a specified VLAN.
ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port
no ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN to include as a static MLD querier.
slot/port The slot/port number you want to configure as a static MLD querier.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an MLD static querier entry on a specified port on a speci-
fied VLAN.
• The ipv6 multicast static-querier command allows you to create an MLD static querier entry on a
specified port on a specified VLAN. This, in turn, enables that network segment to receive all MLD
traffic.
• You can also create an MLD static querier entry on a link aggregate port by entering
ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan vid port, followed by the link aggregation group number
(e.g., ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan 2 port 7).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 1/1
-> no ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 1/1
-> ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 7
-> no ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan 4 port 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-45


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast querier Displays the MLD querier table entries of IPv6 Multicast Switching and
Routing.

MIB Objects
alaMldStaticQuerierTable
alaMldStaticQuerierVlan
alaMldStaticQuerierIfIndex
alaMldStaticQuerierRowStatus

page 15-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast static-group


Creates a static MLD group entry on a specified port on a specified VLAN.
ipv6 multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port
no ipv6 multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IPv6 multicast group address.
vid VLAN to include as a static MLD group.
slot/port The slot/port number you want to configure as a static MLD group.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an MLD static group entry on a specified port on the spec-
ified VLAN.
• The ipv6 multicast static-group command allows you to create an MLD static group entry on a speci-
fied port on a specified VLAN. This, in turn, enables that network segment to receive MLD traffic
addressed to the specified IPv6 multicast group address.
• You can also create an MLD static group entry on a link aggregate port by entering
ipv6 multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port, followed by the link aggregation group number
(e.g., ipv6 multicast static-group ff05::5 vlan 2 port 7).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast static-group ff05::4681 vlan 4 port 1/1
-> no ipv6 multicast static-group ff05::4681 vlan 4 port 1/1
-> ipv6 multicast static-group ff05::4681 vlan 4 port 7
-> no ipv6 multicast static-group ff05::4681 vlan 4 port 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-47


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast group Displays the MLD group membership table entries of IPv6 Multicast
Switching and Routing for the specified IPv6 multicast group address or
all entries if no IPv6 multicast group address is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMldStaticMemberTable
alaMldStaticMemberVlan
alaMldStaticMemberIfIndex
alaMldStaticMemberGroupAddress
alaMldStaticMemberRowStatus

page 15-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast query-interval


Sets the MLD query interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] query-interval [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds MLD query interval in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 125

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD query interval on the system
and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the MLD query interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will over-
ride the system's configuration.
• The MLD query interval refers to the time period between MLD query messages.

• To restore the MLD query interval to its default (i.e., 125 seconds) value on the system if no VLAN is
specified, use ipv6 multicast query-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast query-inter-
val 0) or use only ipv6 multicast query-interval (e.g., ipv6 multicast query-interval).
• To restore the MLD query interval to its default (i.e., 125 seconds) value on the specified VLAN, use
ipv6 multicast vlan vid query-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-
interval 0) or use only ipv6 multicast vlan vid query-interval (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-inter-
val).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast query-interval 100
-> ipv6 multicast query-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast query-interval
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-interval 100
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-interval

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-49


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldQueryInterval
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanQueryInterval

page 15-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval


Sets the MLD last member query interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is speci-
fied.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] last-member-query-interval [milliseconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
milliseconds MLD last member query interval in milliseconds. Valid range is 1 to
65535.
Defaults

parameter default
milliseconds 1000

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD last member query interval to
use on the system and/or the specified VLANs. apply this configuration.
• If the MLD last member query interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• The MLD last member query interval refers to the time period to reply to an MLD query message sent
in response to a leave group message.
• To restore the MLD last member query interval to its default (i.e., 1000 milliseconds) value on the
system if no VLAN is specified, use ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval followed by the
value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval 0) or use only
ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval (e.g., ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval).
• To restore the MLD last member query interval to its default (i.e., 1000 milliseconds) value on the
specified VLAN, use ipv6 multicast vlan vid last-member-query interval followed by the value 0
(e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-interval 0) or use only
ipv6 multicast vlan vid last-member-query-interval (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 last-member-query-
interval).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval 2200
-> ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 4 last-member-query-interval 2200
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 4 last-member-query-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 4 last-member-query-interval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-51


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldLastMemberQueryInterval
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanLastMemberQueryInterval

page 15-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast query-response-interval


Sets the MLD query response interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] query-response-interval [milliseconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
milliseconds MLD query response interval in milliseconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
milliseconds 10000

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD query response interval to use
on the system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the MLD query response interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration
will override the system's configuration.
• The MLD query response interval refers to the time period to reply to an MLD query message.

• To restore the MLD query response interval to its default (i.e., 10000 milliseconds) value on the
system if no VLAN is specified, use ipv6 multicast query-response-interval followed by the value 0
(e.g., ipv6 multicast query-response-interval 0) or use only ipv6 multicast query-response-interval
(e.g., ipv6 multicast query-response-interval).
• To restore the MLD last member query interval to its default (i.e., 10000 milliseconds) value on the
specified VLAN, use ipv6 multicast vlan vid query-response-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g.,
ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval 0) or use only
ipv6 multicast vlan vid query-response-interval (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast query-response-interval 20000
-> ipv6 multicast query-response-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast query-response-interval
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval 20000
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 query-response-interval

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-53


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldQueryResponseInterval
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanQueryReponseInterval

page 15-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval


Sets the MLD unsolicited report interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is speci-
fied.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] unsolicited-report-interval [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds MLD unsolicited report interval in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535,
where 0 represents the default setting.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD unsolicited report interval to
use on the system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the MLD unsolicited report interval is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configura-
tion will override the system's configuration.
• The unsolicited report interval refers to the time period to proxy any changed MLD membership state.

• To restore the MLD unsolicited interval to its default (i.e., 1 second) value on the system if no VLAN
is specified, use ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multi-
cast unsolicited-report-interval 0) or use only ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval (e.g., ipv6
multicast unsolicited-report-interval).
• To restore the MLD unsolicited report interval to its default (i.e., 1 second) value on the specified
VLAN, use ipv6 multicast vlan vid unsolicited-report-interval followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6
multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval 0) or use only
ipv6 multicast vlan vid unsolicited-report-interval (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-
interval).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval 20000
-> ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval 20000
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 unsolicited-report-interval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-55


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldUnsolicitedReportInterval
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanUnsolicitedReportInterval

page 15-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast router-timeout


Configures the expiry time of IPv6 multicast routers on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN
is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] router-timeout [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds MLD router timeout in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 90

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD router timeout on the system
and/or the specified VLANs. apply this configuration.
• If the MLD router timeout is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• To restore the MLD router timeout to its default (i.e., 90 seconds) value on the system if no VLAN is
specified, use ipv6 multicast router-timeout followed by the value 0
(e.g., ipv6 multicast router-timeout 0) or use only ipv6 multicast router-timeout (e.g., ipv6 multicast
router-timeout).
• To restore the MLD router timeout to its default (i.e., 90 seconds) value on the specified VLAN, use
ipv6 multicast vlan vid router-timeout followed by the value 0
(e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 router-timeout 0) or use only ipv6 multicast vlan vid router-timeout (e.g.,
ipv6 multicast vlan 2 router-timeout).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast router-timeout 100
-> ipv6 multicast router-timeout 0
-> ipv6 multicast router-timeout
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 router-timeout 100
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 router-timeout 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 router-timeout

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-57


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldRouterTimeout
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanRouterTimeout

page 15-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast source-timeout


Configures the expiry time of IPv6 multicast sources on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN
is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] source-timeout [seconds]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
seconds MLD source timeout in seconds. Valid range is 1 to 65535.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 30

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD source timeout on the system
and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the MLD source timeout is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• To restore the MLD router timeout to its default (i.e., 30 seconds) value on the system if no VLAN is
specified, use ipv6 multicast source-timeout followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast source-
timeout 0) or use only ipv6 multicast source-timeout (e.g., ipv6 multicast source-timeout).
• To restore the MLD router timeout to its default (i.e., 30 seconds) value on the specified VLAN, use
ipv6 multicast vlan vid source-timeout followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 source-
timeout 0) or use only ipv6 multicast vlan vid source-timeout (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 source-
timeout).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast source-timeout 100
-> ipv6 multicast source-timeout 0
-> ipv6 multicast source-timeout
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 source-timeout 100
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 source-timeout 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 source-timeout

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-59


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldSourceTimeout
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanSourceTimeout

page 15-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast querying


Enables or disables MLD querying on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querying [{enable | disable}]
no ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querying

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable MLD querying.
disable Disable MLD querying.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an MLD querying entry on the specified VLAN or on the
system and return to its default behavior.
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to enable MLD querying on the system and/or
specified VLANs.
• If the MLD querying is already enabled/disabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• MLD querying refers to requesting the network's MLD group membership information by sending out
MLD queries. MLD querying also involves participating in MLD querier election.
• You can also restore the MLD querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ipv6 multicast querying (e.g., ipv6 multicast querying).
• You can also restore the MLD querying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN, by
using only ipv6 multicast vlan vid querying (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querying).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast querying enable
-> ipv6 multicast querying disable
-> ipv6 multicast querying
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querying enable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querying disable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querying
-> no ipv6 multicast vlan 2 querying

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-61


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldQuerying
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanQuerying

page 15-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast robustness


Sets the MLD robustness variable on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] robustness [robustness]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
robustness MLD robustness variable. Valid range is 1 to 7.

Defaults

parameter default
robustness 2

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing must be enabled to set the MLD robustness variable on the
system and/or the specified VLANs.
• If the MLD robustness variable is already configured on the system, then the VLAN configuration will
override the system's configuration.
• Robustness variable allows fine-tuning on the network, where the expected packet loss would be
greater.
• To restore the MLD robustness variable to its default (i.e., 2) value on the system if no VLAN is speci-
fied, use ipv6 multicast robustness followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast robustness 0) or use
only ipv6 multicast robustness (e.g., ipv6 multicast robustness).
• To restore the MLD robustness variable to its default (i.e., 2) value on the specified VLAN, use
ipv6 multicast vlan vid robustness followed by the value 0 (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 robustness 0)
or use only ipv6 multicast vlan vid robustness (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 robustness).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast robustness 3
-> ipv6 multicast robustness 0
-> ipv6 multicast robustness
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 robustness 3
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 robustness 0
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 robustness

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-63


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldRobustness
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanRobustness

page 15-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast spoofing


Enables or disables MLD spoofing on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] spoofing [{enable | disable}]
no ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] spoofing

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable MLD spoofing.
disable Disable MLD spoofing.

Defaults

parameter defaults
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an MLD spoofing entry on the specified VLAN or on the
system and return to its default behavior.
• If the MLD spoofing is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will override the
system's configuration.
• MLD spoofing refers to replacing a client's MAC and IP address with the system's MAC and IP
address when proxying aggregated MLD group membership information.
• You can also restore the MLD spoofing to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ipv6 multicast spoofing (i.e., ipv6 multicast spoofing).
• You can also restore the MLD spoofing to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN, by
using only ipv6 multicast vlan vid spoofing (i.e., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 spoofing).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast spoofing enable
-> ipv6 multicast spoofing disable
-> ipv6 multicast spoofing
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 spoofing enable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 spoofing disable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 spoofing
-> no ipv6 multicast vlan 2 spoofing

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-65


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldSpoofing
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanSpoofing

page 15-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast zapping


Enables or disables MLD zapping on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] zapping [{enable | disable}]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable MLD zapping.
disable Disable MLD zapping.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the MLD zapping is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will override the
system's configuration.
• MLD zapping refers to processing membership and source filter removals immediately and not wait-
ing for the protocol's specified time period. This mode facilitates IP TV applications looking for quick
changes between IP multicast groups.
• You can also restore the MLD zapping to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ipv6 multicast zapping (e.g., ipv6 multicast zapping).
• You can also restore the MLD zapping to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN, by
using only ipv6 multicast vlan vid zapping (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 zapping).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast zapping enable
-> ipv6 multicast zapping disable
-> ipv6 multicast zapping
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 zapping enable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 zapping disable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 zapping

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-67


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldZapping
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanZapping

page 15-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

ipv6 multicast proxying


Enables or disables MLD proxying on the specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] proxying [enable | disable]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN on which to apply the configuration.
enable Enable MLD proxying.
disable Disable MLD proxying.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the MLD proxying is already enabled on the system, then the VLAN configuration will override the
system's configuration.
• MLD proxying refers to processing membership information on behalf of client systems and reporting
membership on their behalf.
• You can also restore the MLD proxying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the system if no VLAN
is specified, by using only ipv6 multicast proxying (e.g., ipv6 multicast proxying).
• You can also restore the MLD proxying to its default (i.e., disabled) setting on the specified VLAN, by
using only ipv6 multicast vlan vid proxying (e.g., ipv6 multicast vlan 2 proxying).

Examples
-> ipv6 multicast proxying enable
-> ipv6 multicast proxying disable
-> ipv6 multicast proxying
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 proxying enable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 proxying disable
-> ipv6 multicast vlan 2 proxying

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-69


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

show ipv6 multicast Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the gen-
eral configuration parameters on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldProxying
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanProxying

page 15-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ip multicast
Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general configuration parameters on the
specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
show ip multicast [vlan vid]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults
By default the status and general configuration parameters for the system.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Specify a VLAN ID to display the configuration information for an individual VLAN.

Examples
-> show ip multicast

Status: Enabled
Querying: Disabled
Proxying Disabled
Spoofing: Disabled
Zapping: Disabled
Querier Forwarding: Disabled
Version: 2
Robustness: 2
Query Interval (seconds): 125
Query Response Interval (tenths of seconds): 100
Last Member Query Interval(tenths of seconds):10
Unsolicited Report Interval(seconds): 1
Router Timeout (seconds): 90
Source Timeout (seconds): 30

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-71


IP Multicast Switching Commands

-> show ip multicast vlan 1

Status: Enabled
Querying: Disabled
Proxying Disabled
Spoofing: Disabled
Zapping: Disabled
Querier Forwarding: Disabled
Version: 2
Robustness: 2
Query Interval (seconds): 125
Query Response Interval (tenths of seconds): 100
Last Member Query Interval(tenths of seconds):10
Unsolicited Report Interval(seconds): 1
Router Timeout (seconds): 90
Source Timeout (seconds): 30

Output fields are described here:

output definitions
Status Whether the IP Multicast Switching and Routing is Enabled or Dis-
abled (the default status).You can enable or disable IP Multicast
Switching and Routing with the ip multicast status command, which is
described on page 15-3.
Querying The current state of IGMP querying, which can be Enabled or Dis-
abled (the default status). You can enable or disable IGMP querying
with the ip multicast querying command, which is described on page
15-27.
Proxying The current state of IGMP proxying on the system, which can be
Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
IGMP spoofing with the ip multicast proxying command, which is
described on page 15-35.
Spoofing The current state of IGMP spoofing on the system, which can be
Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
IGMP spoofing with the ip multicast spoofing command, which is
described on page 15-31.
Zapping The current state of IGMP zapping on the system, which can be
Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
IGMP zapping with the ip multicast zapping command, which is
described on page 15-33.
Querier Forwarding The current state of IGMP querier forwarding on the system, which can
be Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
IGMP Querier forwarding with the ip multicast querier-forwarding
command, which is described on page 15-5.
Version Displays the default IGMP version, which can be 1, 2 or 3. Use the ip
multicast version command to modify this parameter.
Robustness Displays the IGMP robustness value, ranging from 1 to 7. (The default
value is 2). Use the ip multicast robustness command to modify this
parameter.

page 15-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

output definitions
Query Interval (seconds) Displays the time (in seconds) between IGMP queries. (The default
value is 125 seconds). You can modify this parameter with the
ip multicast query-interval command, which is described on page
15-15.
Query Response Interval Displays the time (in tenths of seconds) taken to reply to an IGMP
(tenths of seconds) query message. (The default value is 100 tenths-of-seconds). You can
modify this parameter with the ip multicast query-response-interval
command, which is described on page 15-19.
Last Member Query Interval Displays the time (in tenths of seconds) taken to reply to an IGMP
(tenths of seconds) query message sent in response to a leave group message. (The default
value is 10 tenths-of-seconds.) You can modify this parameter with the
ip multicast last-member-query-interval command, which is
described on page 15-17.
Unsolicited Report Interval Displays the time period (in seconds) to proxy any changed IGMP
(seconds) membership state. (The default value is 1 second). You can modify this
parameter with the ip multicast unsolicited-report-interval com-
mand, which is described on page 15-21.
Router Timeout (seconds) Displays the IGMP router timeout in seconds. (The default value is 90
seconds.) You can modify this parameter with the
ip multicast router-timeout command, which is described on page
15-23.
Source Timeout (seconds) Displays the IGMP source timeout in seconds. (The default value is 30
seconds.) You can modify this parameter with the
ip multicast source-timeout command, which is described on page
15-25.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-73


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

ip multicast status Enables or disables IP Multicast Switching and Routing on the specified
VLAN, or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast version Sets the default version of the IGMP protocol on the specified VLAN or
on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast querying Enables or disables IGMP querying on the specified VLAN or on the
system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast robustness Sets the IGMP robustness variable on the specified VLAN or on the sys-
tem if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast spoofing Enables or disables IGMP spoofing on the specified VLAN or on the
system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast zapping Enables or disables IGMP zapping on the specified VLAN or on the sys-
tem if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast proxying Enables or disables IGMP proxying on the specified VLAN or on the
system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast query-interval Sets the IGMP query interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast last-member- Sets the IGMP last member query interval value on the specified VLAN
query-interval or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast query-response- Sets the IGMP query response interval on the specified VLAN or on the
interval system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast unsolicited- Sets the value of the IGMP unsolicited report interval on the specified
report-interval VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast router-timeout Configures the expiry time of IP multicast routers on the specified
VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ip multicast source-timeout Configures the expiry time of IP multicast sources on the specified
VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaIgmp
alaIgmpStatus
alaIgmpQuerying
alaIgmpProxying
alaIgmpSpoofing
alaIgmpZapping
alaIgmpQuerierForwarding
alaIgmpVersion
alaIgmpRobustness
alaIgmpQueryInterval
alaIgmpQueryResponseInterval
alaIgmpLastMemberQueryInterval
alaIgmpUnsolicitedReportInterval
alaIgmpRouterTimeout
alaIgmpSourceTimeout
alaIgmpVlan
alaIgmpVlanStatus
alaIgmpVlanQuerying
alaIgmpVlanProxying

page 15-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

alaIgmpVlanSpoofing
alaIgmpVlanZapping
alaIgmpVlanQuerierForwarding
alaIgmpVlanVersion
alaIgmpVlanRobustness
alaIgmpVlanQueryInterval
alaIgmpVlanQueryResponseInterval
alaIgmpVlanLastMemberQueryInterval
alaIgmpVlanUnsolicitedReportInterval
alaIgmpVlanRouterTimeout
alaIgmpVlanSourceTimeout

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-75


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ip multicast forward


Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing forwarding table entries for the specified IP multicast
group address or all the entries if no IP multicast group address is specified.
show ip multicast forward [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP multicast group address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip multicast forward

Total 1 Forwards
Ingress Egress
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port VLAN Port
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----+-----+-----+------
228.0.0.1 1.0.0.2 0.0.0.0 1 2/1 1 2/23

-> show ip multicast forward 228.0.0.1

Ingress Egress
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port VLAN Port
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----+-----+-----+------
228.0.0.1 1.0.0.2 0.0.0.0 1 2/1 1 2/23

Output fields are described here:

output definitions
Group Address IP group address of the IP multicast forward.
Host Address IP host address of the IP multicast forward.
Tunnel Address IP source tunnel address of the IP multicast forward.
VLAN VLAN associated with the IP multicast forward.
Port The slot and port number of the IP multicast forward.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 15-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

ip multicast static-group Creates a static IGMP group entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaIgmpForwardTable
alaIgmpForwardVlan
alaIgmpForwardIfIndex
alaIgmpForwardGroupAddress
alaIgmpForwardHostAddress
alaIgmpForwardDestAddress
alaIgmpForwardOrigAddress
alaIgmpForwardType
alaIgmpForwardNextVlan
alaIgmpForwardNextIfIndex
alaIgmpForwardNextTunnelAddress
alaIgmpForwardNextType
alaIgmpForwardTtl

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-77


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ip multicast neighbor


Displays the IGMP neighbor table entries of IP Multicast Switching and Routing.
show ip multicast neighbor

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip multicast neighbor

Total 2 Neighbors
Host Address VLAN Port Static Count Life
---------------+-----+-----+-------+------+-----
1.0.0.2 1 2/1 no 1 86
0.0.0.0 1 2/13 yes 0 0

Output fields are described here:

output definitions
Host Address The IP address of the IP multicast neighbor.
VLAN The VLAN associated with the IP multicast neighbor.
Port The slot and port number of the IP multicast neighbor.
Static Whether it is a static IP multicast neighbor or not.
Count Displays the count of IP multicast neighbor.
Life The life time of the IP multicast neighbor.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip multicast static-neighbor Creates a static IGMP neighbor entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

page 15-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

MIB Objects
alaIgmpNeighborTable
alaIgmpNeighborVlan
alaIgmpNeighborIfIndex
alaIgmpNeighborHostAddress
alaIgmpNeighborCount
alaIgmpNeighborTimeout
alaIgmpNeighborUpTime
alaIgmpStaticNeighborTable
alaIgmpStaticNeighborVlan
alaIgmpStaticNeighborIfIndex
alaIgmpStaticNeighborRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-79


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ip multicast querier


Displays the IGMP querier table entries of IP Multicast Switching and Routing.
show ip multicast querier

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip multicast querier

Total 2 Queriers
Host Address VLAN Port Static Count Life
---------------+-----+-----+-------+------+-----
1.0.0.2 1 2/1 no 1 250
0.0.0.0 1 2/13 yes 0 0

Output fields are described here:

output definitions
Host Address The IP address of the IP multicast querier.
VLAN The VLAN associated with the IP multicast querier.
Port The slot and port number of the IP multicast querier.
Static Whether it is a static multicast neighbor or not.
Count Displays the count of the IP multicast querier.
Life The life time of the IP multicast querier.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Related Commands

ip multicast static-querier Creates a static IGMP querier entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

page 15-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

MIB Objects
alaIgmpQuerierTable
alaIgmpQuerierVlan
alaIgmpQuerierIfIndex
alaIgmpQuerierHostAddress
alaIgmpQuerierCount
alaIgmpQuerierTimeout
alaIgmpQuerierUpTime
alaIgmpStaticQuerierTable
alaIgmpStaticQuerierVlan
alaIgmpStaticQuerierIfIndex
alaIgmpStaticQuerierRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-81


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ip multicast group


Displays the IGMP group membership table entries of IP Multicast Switching and Routing for the speci-
fied IP multicast group address or all entries if no IP multicast group address is specified.
show ip multicast group [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP multicast group address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip multicast group

Total 3 Groups
Group Address Source Address VLAN Port Mode Static Count Life
---------------+---------------+-----+-----+--------+-------+------+-----
231.0.0.3 1.0.0.5 1 2/1 exclude no 1 257
234.0.0.4 0.0.0.0 1 2/1 exclude no 1 218
229.0.0.1 0.0.0.0 1 2/13 exclude yes 0 0

-> show ip multicast group 234.0.0.4

Group Address Source Address VLAN Port Mode Static Count Life
---------------+---------------+-----+-----+--------+-------+------+-----
234.0.0.4 0.0.0.0 1 2/1 exclude no 1 218

Output fields are described here:

output definitions
Group Address IP address of the IP multicast group.
Source Address IP address of the IP multicast source.
VLAN The VLAN associated with the IP multicast group.
Port The slot and port number of the IP multicast group.
Mode IGMP source filter mode.
Static Whether it is a static multicast group or not.
Count Number of IGMP membership requests made.
Life Life time of the IGMP group membership.

page 15-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced

Related Commands.

ip multicast static-group Creates a static IGMP group entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaIgmpMemberTable
alaIgmpMemberVlan
alaIgmpMemberIfIndex
alaIgmpMemberGroupAddress
alaIgmpMemberSourceAddress
alaIgmpMemberMode
alaIgmpMemberCount
alaIgmpMemberTimeout
alaIgmpStaticMemberTable
alaIgmpStaticMemberVlan
alaIgmpStaticMemberIfIndex
alaIgmpStaticMemberGroupAddress
alaIgmpStaticMemberRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-83


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ip multicast source


Displays the IP Multicast Switching and Routing source table entries matching the specified IP multicast
group address or all entries if no IP multicast group address is specified.
show ip multicast source [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IP multicast group address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ip multicast source

Total 1 Sources
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----+-----
228.0.0.1 1.0.0.2 0.0.0.0 1 2/1

-> show ip multicast source 228.0.0.1

Total 1 Sources
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----+-----
228.0.0.1 1.0.0.2 0.0.0.0 1 2/1

output definitions
Group Address IP group address of the IP multicast source.
Host Address IP host address of the IP multicast source.
Tunnel Address IP destination tunnel address of the IP multicast source.
VLAN VLAN associated with the IP multicast source.
Port The slot and port number of the IP multicast source.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 15-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

ip multicast static-group Creates a static IGMP group entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaIgmpSourceTable
alaIgmpSourceVlan
alaIgmpSourceIfIndex
alaIgmpSourceGroupAddress
alaIgmpSourceHostAddress
alaIgmpSourceDestAddress
alaIgmpSourceOrigAddress
alaIgmpSourceType
alaIgmpSourceUpTime

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-85


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ipv6 multicast


Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing status and the general configuration parameters on the
specified VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
show ipv6 multicast [vlan vid]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN for which to display the configuration.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 multicast

Status: = Enabled
Querying: = Disabled
Proxying: = Disabled
Spoofing: = Disabled
Zapping: = Disabled
Querier Forwarding: = Disabled
Version: = 1
Robustness: = 2
Query Interval (seconds): = 125
Query Response Interval (milliseconds): = 10000
Last Member Query Interval (milliseconds): = 1000
Unsolicited Report Interval (seconds) = 1,
Router Timeout (seconds): = 90
Source Timeout (seconds): = 30

page 15-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

-> show ipv6 multicast vlan 1

Status: = Enabled
Querying: = Disabled
Proxying: = Disabled
Spoofing: = Disabled
Zapping: = Disabled
Querier Forwarding: = Disabled
Version: = 1
Robustness: = 2
Query Interval (seconds): = 125
Query Response Interval (milliseconds): = 10000
Last Member Query Interval (milliseconds): = 1000
Unsolicited Report Interval (seconds) = 1,
Router Timeout (seconds): = 90
Source Timeout (seconds): = 30:

output definitions
Status Whether the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing is Enabled or Dis-
abled (the default status).You can enable or disable IPv6 Multicast
Switching and Routing with the ipv6 multicast status command,
which is described on page 15-37
Querying The current state of MLD querying, which can be Enabled or Disabled
(the default status). You can enable or disable MLD querying with the
ipv6 multicast querying command, which is described on page 15-61
Proxying The current state of MLD proxying on the system, which can be
Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
MLD spoofing with the ipv6 multicast proxying command, which is
described on page 15-69
Spoofing The current state of MLD spoofing on the system, which can be
Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
MLD spoofing with the ipv6 multicast spoofing command, which is
described on page 15-31
Zapping The current state of MLD zapping on the system, which can be
Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
MLD zapping with the ipv6 multicast zapping command, which is
described on page 15-67
Querier Forwarding The current state of MLD querier forwarding on the system, which can
be Enabled or Disabled (the default status). You can enable or disable
MLD Querier forwarding with the ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding
command, which is described on page 15-39.
Version Displays the default MLD version, which can be 1, 2 or 3. Use the ipv6
multicast version command to modify this parameter.
Robustness Displays the MLD robustness value, ranging from 1 to 7. Use the ipv6
multicast robustness command to modify this parameter.
Query Interval (seconds) Displays the time (in seconds) between MLD queries. (The default
value is 125 seconds). You can modify this parameter with the
ipv6 multicast query-interval command, which is described on page
15-49.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-87


IP Multicast Switching Commands

output definitions
Query Response Interval Displays the time (in milliseconds) to reply to an MLD query message.
(milliseconds) (The default value is 10000 milliseconds.) You can modify this parame-
ter with the ipv6 multicast query-response-interval command, which
is described on page 15-53.
Last Member Query Interval Displays the time (in milliseconds) to reply to an MLD query message
(milliseconds) sent in response to a leave group message. (The default value is 1000
milliseconds.) You can modify this parameter with the
ipv6 multicast last-member-query-interval command, which is
described on page 15-51.
Unsolicited Report Interval Displays the time period (in seconds) to proxy any changed MLD
(seconds) membership state. (The default value is 1 second). You can modify this
parameter with the ipv6 multicast unsolicited-report-interval com-
mand, which is described on page 15-55.
Router Timeout (seconds) Displays the MLD router timeout in seconds (The default value is 90
seconds.) You can modify this parameter with the
ipv6 multicast router-timeout command, which is described on page
15-57
Source Timeout (seconds) Displays the IGMP source timeout in seconds (The default is 30 sec-
onds.) You can modify this parameter with the
ipv6 multicast source-timeout command, which is described on page
15-59

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 15-88 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 multicast status Enables or disables IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing on the speci-
fied VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast version Sets the default version of the MLD protocol on the specified VLAN or
on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast query-interval Sets the MLD query interval on the specified VLAN or on the system if
no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast last-member- Sets the MLD last member query interval on the specified VLAN or on
query-interval the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast query-response- Sets the MLD query response interval on the specified VLAN or on the
interval system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast unsolicited- Sets the MLD unsolicited report interval on the specified VLAN or on
report-interval the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast router-timeout Configures the expiry time of IPv6 multicast routers on the specified
VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast source-timeout Configures the expiry time of IPv6 multicast sources on the specified
VLAN or on the system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast querying Enables or disables MLD querying on the specified VLAN or on the
system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast robustness Sets the MLD robustness variable on the specified VLAN or on the sys-
tem if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast spoofing Enables or disables MLD spoofing on the specified VLAN or on the
system if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast zapping Enables or disables MLD zapping on the specified VLAN or on the sys-
tem if no VLAN is specified.
ipv6 multicast proxying Enables or disables MLD proxying on the specified VLAN or on the
system if no VLAN is specified.

MIB Objects
alaMld
alaMldStatus
alaMldQuerying
alaMldProxying
alaMldSpoofing
alaMldZapping
alaMldQuerierForwarding
alaMldVersion
alaMldRobustness
alaMldQueryInterval
alaMldQueryResponseInterval
alaMldLastMemberQueryInterval
alaMldUnsolicitedReportInterval
alaMldRouterTimeout
alaMldSourceTimeout
alaMldVlan
alaMldVlanStatus
alaMldVlanQuerying
alaMldVlanProxying

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-89


IP Multicast Switching Commands

alaMldVlanSpoofing
alaMldVlanZapping
alaMldVlanQuerierForwarding
alaMldVlanVersion
alaMldVlanRobustness
alaMldVlanQueryInterval
alaMldVlanQueryResponseInterval
alaMldVlanLastMemberQueryInterval
alaMldVlanUnsolicitedReportInterval
alaMldVlanRouterTimeout
alaMldVlanSourceTimeout

page 15-90 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ipv6 multicast forward


Display the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing forwarding table entries for the specified IPv6 multi-
cast group address or all entries if no IPv6 multicast address is specified.
show ipv6 multicast forward [ipv6_ddress]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_ddress IPv6 multicast group address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 multicast forward

Total 1 Forwards
Ingress Egress
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port VLAN Port
-------------- +---------------+---------------+-----+-----+-----+------
ff05::6 4444::2 :: 1 2/1 1 2/23

-> show ipv6 multicast forward ff05::6

Ingress Egress
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port VLAN Port
-------------- +---------------+---------------+-----+-----+-----+------
ff05::6 4444::2 :: 1 2/1 1 2/23

output definitions
Group Address IPv6 group address of the IPv6 multicast forward.
Host Address IPv6 host address of the IPv6 multicast forward.
Tunnel Address IPv6 source tunnel address of the IPv6 multicast forward.
VLAN VLAN associated with the IPv6 multicast forward.
Port The slot and port number of the IPv6 multicast forward.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-91


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 multicast static-group Creates a static MLD group entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaMldForwardTable
alaMldForwardVlan
alaMldForwardIfIndex
alaMldForwardGroupAddress
alaMldForwardHostAddress
alaMldForwardDestAddress
alaMldForwardOrigAddress
alaMldForwardType
alaMldForwardNextVlan
alaMldForwardNextIfIndex
alaMldForwardNextDestAddress
alaMldForwardNextType
alaMldForwardTtl

page 15-92 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ipv6 multicast neighbor


Displays the MLD neighbor table entries of IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing.
show ipv6 multicast neighbor

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 multicast neighbor

Total 2 Neighbors
Host Address VLAN Port Static Count Life
-------------------------+-----+-----+-------+------+-----
fe80::2a0:ccff:fed3:2853 1 2/1 no 1 6
:: 1 2/13 yes 0 0

output definitions
Host Address The IPv6 address of the IPv6 multicast neighbor.
VLAN The VLAN associated with the IPv6 multicast neighbor.
Port The slot and port number of the IPv6 multicast neighbor.
Static Whether it is a static MLD neighbor or not.
Count Displays the count of the IPv6 multicast neighbor.
Life The life time of the IPv6 multicast neighbor.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ipv6 multicast static-neighbor Creates a static MLD neighbor entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-93


IP Multicast Switching Commands

MIB Objects
alaMldNeighborTable
alaMldNeighborVlan
alaMldNeighborIfIndex
alaMldNeighborHostAddress
alaMldNeighborCount
alaMldNeighborTimeout
alaMldNeighborUpTime
alaMldStaticNeighborTable
alaMldStaticNeighborVlan
alaMldStaticNeighborIfIndex
alaMldStaticNeighborRowStatus

page 15-94 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ipv6 multicast querier


Displays the MLD querier table entries of IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing.
show ipv6 multicast querier

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 multicast querier

Total 2 Queriers
Host Address VLAN Port Static Count Life
-------------------------+-----+-----+-------+------+-----
fe80::2a0:ccff:fed3:2853 1 2/1 no 1 6
:: 1 2/13 yes 0 0

output definitions
Host Address The IPv6 address of the IPv6 multicast querier.
VLAN The VLAN associated with the IPv6 multicast querier.
Port The slot and port number of the IPv6 multicast querier.
Static Whether it is a static MLD neighbor or not.
Count Displays the count of the IPv6 multicast querier.
Life The life time of the IPv6 multicast querier.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced

Related Commands

ipv6 multicast static-querier Creates a static MLD querier entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-95


IP Multicast Switching Commands

MIB Objects
alaMldQuerierTable
alaMldQuerierVlan
alaMldQuerierIfIndex
alaMldQuerierHostAddress
alaMldQuerierCount
alaMldQuerierTimeout
alaMldQuerierUpTime
alaMldStaticQuerierTable
alaMldStaticQuerierVlan
alaMldStaticQuerierIfIndex
alaMldStaticQuerierRowStatus

page 15-96 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ipv6 multicast group


Displays the MLD group membership table entries of IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing for the speci-
fied IPv6 multicast group address or all entries if no IPv6 multicast group address is specified.
show ipv6 multicast group [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IPv6 multicast group address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 multicast group

Total 3 Groups
Group Address Source Address VLAN Port Mode Static Count Life
----------------+---------------+-----+-----+--------+-------+------+-----
ff05::5 :: 1 2/1 exclude no 1 145
ff05::6 3333::1 1 2/1 exclude no 1 242
ff05::9 :: 1 2/13 exclude yes 0 0

-> show ipv6 multicast group ff05::5

Group Address Source Address VLAN Port Mode Static Count Life
----------------+---------------+-----+-----+--------+-------+------+-----
ff05::5 :: 1 2/1 exclude no 1 145

output definitions
Group Address IPv6 address of the IPv6 multicast group.
Source Address IPv6 address of the IPv6 multicast source.
VLAN The VLAN associated with the IPv6 multicast group.
Port The slot and port number of the IPv6 multicast group.
Mode MLD source filter mode.
Static Whether it is a static MLD group or not.
Count Number of MLD membership requests made.
Life Life time of the MLD group membership.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-97


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced

Related Commands

ipv6 multicast static-group Creates a static MLD group entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaMldMemberTable
alaMldMemberVlan
alaMldMemberIfIndex
alaMldMemberGroupAddress
alaMldMemberSourceAddress
alaMldMemberMode
alaMldMemberCount
alaMldMemberTimeout
alaMldMemberUpTime
alaMldStaticMemberTable
alaMldStaticMemberVlan
alaMldStaticMemberIfIndex
alaMldStaticMemberGroupAddress
alaMldStaticMemberRowStatus

page 15-98 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast Switching Commands

show ipv6 multicast source


Displays the IPv6 Multicast Switching and Routing source table entries matching the specified IPv6 multi-
cast group address or all entries if no IPv6 multicast group address is specified.
show ipv6 multicast source [ip_address]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address IPv6 multicast group address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ipv6 multicast source

Total 1 Sources
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----+-----
ff05::6 4444::2 :: 1 2/1

-> show ipv6 multicast source ff05::6

Total 1 Sources
Group Address Host Address Tunnel Address VLAN Port
---------------+---------------+---------------+-----+-----
ff05::6 4444::2 :: 1 2/1

output definitions
Group Address IPv6 group address of the IPv6 multicast source.
Host Address IPv6 host address of the IPv6 multicast source.
Tunnel Address IPv6 source tunnel address of the IPv6 multicast source.
VLAN VLAN associated with the IPv6 multicast source.
Port The slot and port number of the IPv6 multicast source.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15-99


IP Multicast Switching Commands

Related Commands

ipv6 multicast static-group Creates a static MLD group entry on a specified port on a specified
VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaMldSourceTable
alaMldSourceVlan
alaMldSourceIfIndex
alaMldSourceGroupAddress
alaMldSourceHostAddress
alaMldSourceDestAddress
alaMldSourceOrigAddress
alaMldSourceType
alaMldSourceUpTime

page 15-100 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


16 IP Multicast VLAN
Commands

The IP Multicast VLAN (IPMV) is a distribution Multicast VLAN that flows into the customer ports.
These distribution VLANs connect to the nearest multicast router and support multicast traffic only. Multi-
cast traffic flows from the distribution VLAN to the customer VLAN and not vice-versa. Customer-gener-
ated multicast traffic should flow via the customer VLANs so that the Multicast router can control
distribution of this traffic. IPMV feature is invisible to the customer. The customer VLANs can be tagged
or untagged.
IPMV works in both the Enterprise environment as well as the VLAN Stacking environment. The ports are
separately classified as VLAN Stacking ports or as legacy ports (fixed ports/tagged ports). VLAN Stack-
ing VLAN contains only VLAN Stacking ports as its members, while Normal data VLAN contains normal
legacy ports. This ensures that data flow is confined to a single broadcast domain.
MIB information for the IP Multicast VLAN commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1IPMV.MIB
Module: Alcatel-IND1-IPM-VLAN-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1VlanStacking.MIB
Module: Alcatel-IND1-VLAN-STACKING-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1VlanManager.MIB
Module: Alcatel-IND1-VLAN-MGR-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

VLAN Manager Commands vlan ipmvlan


VLAN Stacking Commands vlan ipmvlan ctag
vlan ipmvlan address
vlan ipmvlan sender-port
vlan ipmvlan receiver-port
vlan svlan port translate ipmvlan
show vlan ipmvlan c-tag
show vlan ipmvlan address
show vlan ipmvlan port-config
show ipmvlan port-config
show vlan ipmvlan port-binding

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-1


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

vlan ipmvlan
Creates an IP Multicast VLAN.
vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id [{enable | disable} | [{1x1 | flat} stp {enable | disable}]] [name name-string]
[svlan]
no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id [-ipmvlan-id2]

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number. The valid range is 2–4094.
enable Enables IPMVLAN.
disable Disables IPMVLAN.
1x1 Specifies that the switch is running in the 1x1 Spanning Tree mode.
flat Specifies that the switch is running in the Flat Spanning Tree mode.
stp enable Enables Spanning Tree for the specified IPMVLAN.
stp disable Disables Spanning Tree for the specified IPMVLAN.
name-string Alphanumeric string up to 32 characters. Use quotes around the string if
the name contains multiple words with spaces between them (for exam-
ple, “Alcatel-Lucent VLAN”).
svlan Tags the IPMVLAN to be used in VLAN Stacking environment.
ipmvlan-id2 Th last IPMVLAN number in a range of IPMVLANs that you want to
configure.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a single or multiple IPMVLANs. If the specified IPMV-
LAN(s) does not exist, an error message will be displayed.
• If ipmvlan-id does not exist or if ipmvlan-id exists as VLAN Stacking VLAN or Standard VLAN, an
error message will be displayed.
• Use the svlan parameter to specify that the IPMVLAN should be used in the VLAN Stacking environ-
ment.
• The default mode of the IPMVLAN is the Enterprise mode.

page 16-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

• If an IPMVLAN is disabled, all the ports bound to an IPMVLAN will be blocked for that VLAN
instance.
• A maximum of 256 IPMVLANs can be configured.

Examples
-> vlan ipmvlan 1003 name "multicast vlan"
-> vlan ipmvlan 1033 name "multicast vlan" svlan
-> vlan ipmvlan 1333 1x1 stp enable name "multicast vlan" svlan
-> no vlan ipmvlan 1003

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan ipmvlan Displays IPMVLAN information for a specific IPMVLAN or all IPMV-
LANs.
show vlan Displays a list of VLANs and their types configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
vlanTable
vlanNumber
vlanDescription
vlanTraffictype
vlanAdmStatus
vlanStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-3


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

vlan ipmvlan ctag


Defines the mapping between an IPMVLAN and a customer VLAN ID (c-tag) to be used in the c-tag
translation rule.
vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id ctag {ctag | ctag1-ctag2}
no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id ctag {ctag | ctag1-ctag2}

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number for which the c-tag is to be
assigned.The valid range is 2–4094.
ctag The customer VLAN ID number used in the translation rule. The valid
range is 1–4094.
ctag1-ctag2 Specifies the range of the customer VLAN ID numbers.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the mapping between the IPMVLAN and the customer
VLAN ID.
• If the c-tag is already assigned to another IPMVLAN, the configuration request will fail.

• If you assign a range of c-tags to an IPMVLAN, an error message will be displayed for the c-tags
already assigned to the IPMVLAN.
• The command will not work in Enterprise Mode.

Examples
-> vlan ipmvlan 1003 ctag 10
-> no vlan ipmvlan 1003 ctag 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 16-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

Related Commands

show vlan ipmvlan c-tag Displays the customer VLAN IDs associated with a single IP Multicast
VLAN or all the configured IP Multicast VLANs.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanCtagTable
alaipmvVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanCtag
alaipmvVlanCtagRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-5


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

vlan ipmvlan address


Assigns an IPv4 address, IPv6 address, or a range of addresses to an existing IPMVLAN.
vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id address {ip_address | ipv6_address | ipaddress1-ipaddress2 | ipv6address1-
ipv6address2}
no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id address {ip_address | ipv6_address | ipaddress1-ipaddress2 | ipv6address1-
ipv6address2}

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number to which the IP address will
be assigned. The valid range is 2–4094.
ip_address Specifies a 32-bit IP Multicast address that will be assigned to the
IPMVLAN.
ipv6_address Specifies a 128-bit IPv6 Multicast address that will be assigned to the
IPMVLAN.
ipaddress1-ipaddress2 Specifies the IP Multicast address range.
ipv6address1-ipv6address2 Specifies the IPv6 Multicast address range.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disassociate the already assigned IP or IPv6 address from the
IPMV.
• If the address is already assigned to another IPMVLAN, the configuration request will fail.

• If you assign a range of addresses to an IPMVLAN, an error message will be displayed for the
addresses already assigned to the IPMVLAN.
• A maximum of 128 addresses can be specified in a range. If the range is exceeded, configuration for all
the addresses in that range will fail.

Examples
-> vlan ipmvlan 1003 address 225.0.0.1
-> vlan ipmvlan 1033 address ff08::3
-> no vlan ipmvlan 1003 address 225.0.0.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 16-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

Related Commands

show vlan ipmvlan address Displays the IPv4 and IPv6 addresses assigned to single IP Multicast
VLAN or all the configured IP Multicast VLANs.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanIpAddrTable
alaipmvVlanIpAddrVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanIpAddrType
alaipmvVlanIpAddress
alaipmvVlanIpAddrRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-7


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

vlan ipmvlan sender-port


Configures a port, a range of ports, an aggregate of ports, or a range of aggregates as sender port for the IP
Multicast VLAN. This sender port can receive multicast data for the configured multicast groups.
vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id sender-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-agg_num2]}
no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id sender-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-agg_num2]}

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number to which the port will be
attached as a sender port. The valid range is 2–4094.
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
port2 The last port number in a range of ports that you want to configure on
the same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
agg_num The link aggregate ID number (0–31) to be assigned as a sender port to
the IPMVLAN.
agg_num2 The last link aggregate ID number in a range of aggregates that you
want to configure.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a single port, a range of ports, an aggregate of ports, or a
range of aggregates assigned as the sender port(s) for the IPMVLAN.
• Multiple sender ports can be assigned to an IPMVLAN and a port can be configured as a sender port
for multiple IPMVLANs.
• In the Enterprise mode, the configuration fails if the port configured as a sender port is not a tagged
port, or if the port is an aggregated port ( member port of a logical aggregate) or a VLAN Stacking
port.
• In the VLAN Stacking mode, the configuration fails if the port configured as a sender port is not a
VLAN Stacking port (network port).

Examples
The following command configures the sender port in an Enterprise mode:
-> vlan ipmvlan 1003 sender-port port 1/45-50

The following commands configure the sender port in the VLAN Stacking mode:

page 16-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

-> vlan svlan 1/49 network-port


-> vlan ipmvlan 1033 sender-port port 1/49

The following command removes the port configured as sender port:


-> no vlan ipmvlan 1003 sender-port port 1/50

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan ipmvlan port-config Displays the sender and receiver ports for a specific IP Multicast VLAN
or all the IP Multicast VLANs.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanPortTable
alaipmvVlanPortIPMVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortType
alaipmvVlanPortRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-9


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

vlan ipmvlan receiver-port


Configures a port, a range of ports, or an aggregate of ports as receiver ports for the IP Multicast VLAN.
vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id receiver-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-agg_num2]}
no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id receiver-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-agg_num2]}

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number to which the port will be
attached as a receiver port. The valid range is 2–4094.
slot/port The slot number for the module and physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the same
slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
agg_num The link aggregate ID number to be assigned as a receiver port to the
specified IPMVLAN. The valid range is 0–31.
agg_num2 Last link aggregate ID number in a range of aggregates you want to
configure.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the port assigned as a receiver port for the IPMVLAN.

• A single port can be configured as a receiver port for multiple IPMVLANs. An IPMVLAN can contain
multiple receiver ports.
• In the Enterprise mode, the configuration fails if the port configured as a receiver port is an aggregated
port (member port of a logical aggregate) or a VLAN Stacking port.
• In the VLAN Stacking mode, the configuration fails if the port configured as a receiver port is not a
VLAN Stacking port (user port).

Examples
The following commands configure the receiver port in the Enterprise mode:
-> vlan ipmvlan 1003 receiver-port port 1/51-60
-> vlan ipmvlan 1033 receiver-port port 1/62

page 16-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

The following commands configure the receiver port in the VLAN Stacking mode:
-> vlan svlan port 1/1 user-customer-port default-svlan 10
-> vlan ipmvlan 1002 receiver-port port 1/1
-> no vlan ipmvlan 1002 receiver-port port 1/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan ipmvlan port-config Displays the sender and receiver ports for a specific IP Multicast VLAN
or all the configured IP Multicast VLANs.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanPortTable
alaipmvVlanPortIPMVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortType
alaipmvVlanPortRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-11


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

vlan svlan port translate ipmvlan


Creates an association between IP Multicast VLAN and customer VLAN (c-tag) on the receiver ports.
vlan svlan port {slot/port | agg_num} translate cvlan customer-vlan-id {ipmvlan ipmvlan-id | svlan
svlan-id}
vlan svlan port {slot/port | agg_num} cvlan customer-vlan-id no ipmvlan ipmvlan-id

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Slot number for the module and physical port number on that module
(e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
agg_num The link aggregate ID number to associate SVLAN / IPMVLAN to a
customer VLAN on the receiver port. The valid range is 0–31.
customer-vlan-id Customer VLAN ID associated with the SVLAN / IPMVLAN.
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number. The valid range is 2–4094.
svlan-id Specifies the SVLAN number identifying the instance.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the association between SVLAN / IPMVLAN and customer
VLAN.
• If the SVLAN / IPMVLAN does not exist, the port is not a VLAN Stacking port, the port is a member
of an aggregate, or the aggregate does not exist, then an error message will be displayed.

Examples
-> vlan svlan port 1/1 user-customer-port default-svlan 10
-> vlan ipmvlan 1002 receiver-port port 1/1
-> vlan svlan port 1/1 translate cvlan 10 ipmvlan 1002
-> vlan svlan port 1/1 cvlan 10 no ipmvlan 1002

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 16-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

Related Commands

show vlan ipmvlan port- Displays the translation bindings of an IP Multicast VLAN on a port, an
binding aggregate of ports, or all the ports.

MIB Objects
alaVstkSvlanPortTable
alaVstkSvlanPortNumber
alaVstkSvlanPortSvlanNumber
alaVstkSvlanPortCvlanNumber
alaVstkSvlanPortMode
alaVstkSvlanPortRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-13


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

show vlan ipmvlan c-tag


Displays the customer VLAN IDs associated with a single IP Multicast VLAN or all the configured IP
Multicast VLANs.
show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id] c-tag

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number. The valid range is 2–4094.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show vlan ipmvlan c-tag

ipmvlan ctag
+----------+-------+
100 10
100 20
200 30

output definitions
ipmvlan The numerical IPMVLAN ID.
ctag The customer VLAN-ID associated with the IPMVLAN.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan ipmvlan ctag Defines the mapping between a IPMVLAN and a customer VLAN ID
(c-tag) to be used in the c-tag translation rule.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanCtagTable
alaipmvVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanCtag

page 16-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

show vlan ipmvlan address


Displays the IPv4 and IPv6 addresses assigned to a single IP Multicast VLAN or all the configured IP
Multicast VLANs.
show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id] address

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number. The valid range is 2–4094.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show vlan ipmvlan 10 address
IpAddress ipAddressType
----------+---------------
224.1.1.1 Ipv4
224.1.1.2 Ipv4
224.1.1.3 Ipv4
ffae::1 Ipv6
ffae::2 Ipv6
ffae::3 Ipv6

output definitions
IPv4 Addresses Assigned to The 32-bit IPv4 address assigned to IPMVLAN 10.
IPMVLAN 10
IPv6 Addresses Assigned to The 128-bit IPv4 address assigned to IPMVLAN 10.
IPMVLAN 10

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-15


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

-> show vlan ipmvlan address

ipmvlan ipAddress ipAddressType


+----------+-------------+-------------------+
100 224.1.2.3 Ipv4
100 225.1.1.1 Ipv4
100 ff08::3 Ipv6
200 224.1.1.2 Ipv4
200 ff09::1 Ipv6

output definitions
ipmvlan The numerical IPMVLAN ID.
ipAddress The IPv4 or IPv6 address.
ipAddressType The IP address type (IPv4 or IPv6).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan ipmvlan address Assigns an IPv4 address, IPv6 address, or a range of addresses to an
existing IPMVLAN.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanIpAddrTable
alaipmvVlanIpAddrVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanIpAddrType
alaipmvVlanIpAddress

page 16-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

show vlan ipmvlan port-config


Displays the sender and receiver ports for a specific IP Multicast VLAN or all the IP Multicast VLANs.
show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id] port-config

Syntax Definitions
ipmvlan-id Specifies the IP Multicast VLAN number for which the sender and
receiver ports will be displayed. The valid range is 2–4094.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show vlan ipmvlan port-config
ipmvlan port type
+---------+--------+-----------+
50 2/1 receiver
50 2/10 sender
51 2/2 receiver
51 0/2 receiver
100 2/2 receiver
101 0/1 sender

-> show vlan ipmvlan 50 port-config


port type
+--------+-----------+
2/1 receiver
2/10 sender

-> show vlan ipmvlan 51 port-config


port type
+--------+-----------+
2/2 receiver
0/2 receiver

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-17


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

-> show vlan ipmvlan 100 port-config


port type
+--------+-----------+
2/2 receiver

-> show vlan ipmvlan 101 port-config


port type
+--------+-----------+
0/1 sender

output definitions
ipmvlan The numerical IPMVLAN ID.
port Displays the slot number of the module and the physical port number
on that module for which the IPMVLAN is configured.
type The type (sender or receiver) of the IPMVLAN port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan ipmvlan sender-port Configures a port or an aggregate of ports as the sender port for the IP
Multicast VLAN.
vlan ipmvlan receiver-port Configures a port (or a range of ports) or an aggregate of ports as the
receiver port for the IP Multicast VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanPortTable
alaipmvVlanPortIPMVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortType

page 16-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

show ipmvlan port-config


Displays the sender and receiver IPMVLANs for a specific slot or port.
show vlan ipmvlan port-config [slot/port | agg_num]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
agg_num The Link aggregate ID number. The valid range is 0–31.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show vlan ipmvlan port-config 2/1
ipmvlan type
+---------+------------+
50 receiver

-> show vlan ipmvlan port-config 2/2


ipmvlan type
+---------+------------+
51 receiver
100 receiver

-> show vlan ipmvlan port-config 1


ipmvlan type
+---------+------------+
101 sender

output definitions
ipmvlan The numerical IPMVLAN ID.
type The type (sender or receiver) of the IPMVLAN port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-19


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

Related Commands

vlan ipmvlan sender-port Configures a port or an aggregate of ports as the sender port for the IP
Multicast VLAN.
vlan ipmvlan receiver-port Configures a port (or a range of ports) or an aggregate of ports as the
receiver port for the IP Multicast VLAN.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanPortTable
alaipmvVlanPortIPMVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortType

page 16-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

show vlan ipmvlan port-binding


Displays the translation bindings of an IP Multicast VLAN on a port, an aggregate of ports, or all the
ports.
show vlan ipmvlan port-binding [slot/port | agg_num]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
agg_num The Link aggregate ID number. The valid range is 0–31.

Defaults
By default all the IPMVLANs will be displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot/port or agg_num parameter with this command to view the IPMVLANs associated with a
specific port or an aggregate of ports.

Examples
-> show vlan ipmvlan port-binding
port ipmvlan cvlan type
+---------+-----------+----------+-------------+
2/2 100 10 receiver
2/2 100 11 receiver
0/2 51 151 receiver

-> show vlan ipmvlan port-binding 2/2


ipmvlan cvlan type
+---------+-----------+------------+
100 10 receiver
100 11 receiver

-> show vlan ipmvlan port-binding 2


ipmvlan cvlan type
+---------+-----------+------------+
51 151 receiver

output definitions
port The slot number/physical port number on that module.
ipmvlan The numerical IPMVLAN ID.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16-21


IP Multicast VLAN Commands

output definitions (continued)


cvlan The numerical CVLAN ID associated with the IPMV.
type The type (sender or receiver) of the IPMVLAN port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan svlan port translate Creates an association between IP Multicast VLAN and customer
ipmvlan VLAN (c-tag) on the receiver ports.

MIB Objects
alaipmvVlanPortTable
alaipmvVlanPortIPMVlanNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortNumber
alaipmvVlanPortPortType

page 16-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


17 QoS Commands

Alcatel-Lucent’s QoS software provides a way to manipulate flows coming through the switch based on
user-configured policies. The flow manipulation (generally referred to as Quality of Service or QoS) may
be as simple as allowing/denying traffic, or as complicated as remapping 802.1p bits from a Layer 2
network to ToS values in a Layer 3 network.
This chapter provides information about configuring QoS global and port parameters through the
Command Line Interface (CLI). Refer to Chapter 18, “QoS Policy Commands,” for information about
commands used to configure QoS policy rules.
MIB information for the QoS commands is as follows:
Filename: alcatelIND1Qos.mib
Module ALCATEL-IND1-QoS-MIB

Important Note. Some of the commands listed here are not currently supported on one or more plat-
forms. See command descriptions in this chapter and check release notes for information about commands
that are not supported.

The QoS commands are listed here:

Global commands qos


qos trust ports
qos default servicing mode
qos forward log
qos log console
qos log lines
qos log level
qos default bridged disposition
qos default multicast disposition
qos stats interval
qos nms priority
qos phones
qos user-port
qos dei
debug qos
debug qos internal
qos clear log
qos apply
qos revert
qos flush
qos reset
qos stats reset
show qos queue
show qos slice
show qos log
show qos config
show qos statistics

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-1


QoS Commands

Port and Slice commands qos port


qos port reset
qos port trusted
qos port servicing mode
qos port q maxbw
qos port maximum egress-bandwidth
qos port maximum ingress-bandwidth
qos port default 802.1p
qos port default dscp
qos port default classification
qos port dei
show qos port

page 17-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos
Enables or disables QoS. This section describes the base command with a single required option (enable
or disable).
In lieu of these options, the base command (qos) may be used with other keywords to set up global QoS
configuration. These keywords are listed here and described as separate commands later in this chapter. In
addition, some keywords have a no form to remove the parameter or return it to its default.
qos {enable | disable}
[trust ports]
[default servicing mode]
[forward log]
[log console]
[log lines lines]
[log level level]
[default bridged disposition {accept | deny | drop}]
[default multicast disposition {accept | deny | drop}]
[stats interval seconds]
[user-port {filter | shutdown} {spoof | bpdu | rip}]
[dei]

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables QoS. The QoS software in the switch classifies flows coming
into the switch to attempt to match them to QoS policies. If a match is
found, the policy parameters are applied to the flow. The enable setting
may be used alone or in conjunction with optional command keywords.
disable Disables QoS. Flows coming into the switch are not matched to poli-
cies. The disable setting cannot be used with any other command
keyword.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When QoS is disabled, flows coming into the switch are classified but not matched to a policy. Traffic
is treated as best effort and assigned to default queues.
• The command keywords may be used with or without enable; these keywords cannot be used with
disable.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-3


QoS Commands

Examples
-> qos enable default disposition deny
-> qos disable
-> qos enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configu-
ration.
policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch.
show policy rule Displays information for policy rules configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigEnable
alaQoSConfigTrustedPorts
alaQoSConfigDefaultQueues
alaQoSConfigAppliedDefaultQueues
alaQoSConfigLogLines
alaQoSConfigLogLevel
alaQoSConfigLogConsole
alaQoSConfigFlowTimeout
alaQoSConfigApliedFlowTimeout
alaQoSConfigFragmentTimeout
alaQoSConfigAppliedFragmentTimeout
alaQoSConfigReflexiveTimeout
alaQoSConfigAppliedReflexiveTimeout
alaQoSConfigNatTimeout
alaQoSConfigAppliedNatTimeout
alaQoSConfigClassifyFragments
alaQoSConfigAppliedClassifyFragments
alaQoSConfigDefaultMulticastDisposition
alaQoSConfigAppliedDefaultMulticastDisposition
alaQoSConfigDefaultDisposition
alaQoSConfigAppliedDefaultDisposition
alaQoSConfigDEIMarking

page 17-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos trust ports


Configures the global trust mode for QoS ports. Trusted ports can accept 802.1p and ToS/DSCP values in
incoming packets; untrusted ports will set any 802.1p or ToS/DSCP values to zero in incoming packets,
unless a default 802.1p or ToS/DSCP value is configured.
Any port configured through the qos port command will automatically be added in the trust mode speci-
fied by this command. See page 17-38 for more information about this command.
qos trust ports
qos no trust ports

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, 802.1Q-tagged ports and mobile ports are trusted; any other port is untrusted by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the qos ports trusted command to override the default for a particular port.

• The setting only applies to ports with incoming traffic.

• Any port configured for 802.1Q tagging is always trusted regardless of the global setting.

• Mobile ports are always trusted regardless of the global setting.

• Use the qos port default 802.1p or qos port default dscp commands to specify that a value other than
zero should be applied to the incoming packets. Note that this value is overridden if a policy exists that
specifies a different value for such packets.

Examples
-> qos trust ports
-> qos no trust ports

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-5


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.


qos port trusted Configures whether or not a particular port is trusted or untrusted.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigTrustedPorts

page 17-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos default servicing mode


Configures the default queuing scheme for destination (egress) ports.
qos default servicing mode {strict-priority | wrr [w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7] | drr] [w0 w1 w2 w3 w4
w5 w6 w7]}

Syntax Definitions
strict-priority Selects the strict priority queuing scheme as the default servicing mode.
All eight available queues on a port are serviced strictly by priority.
wrr Selects the weighted round robin (WRR) queuing scheme as the default
servicing mode. Traffic is serviced based on the weight of each queue.
drr Selects the deficit round robin (DRR) queuing scheme as the default
servicing mode. Traffic is serviced based on the weight of each queue.
w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7 The value of the desired weight for each of the queues when WRR,
priority-WRR, or DRR is the active queuing scheme. The range is 0 to
15.

Defaults

parameter default
strict-priority | priority-wrr | strict-priority
wrr | drr
w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7 1 (best effort)

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Each queue can have a different weight value and configuring these values in ascending or descending
order is not required. When a queue is given a weight of 0, it is configured as a Strict-Priority queue.
• Use the wrr parameter to configure a Priority-WRR queuing scheme, which consists of a combination
of Strict-Priority queues (zero weight) and WRR queues (non-zero weight).
• Using the qos default servicing mode command does not override configuration values that were set
on a per port basis with the qos port servicing mode command.
• The servicing mode only applies to destination (egress) ports because this is where traffic shaping
occurs. Even though the qos port servicing mode and qos default servicing mode commands are
allowed on source (ingress) ports, they do not affect traffic on these ports.

Examples
-> qos default servicing mode strict-priority
-> qos default servicing mode wrr 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-> qos default servicing mode drr 10 0 12 14 0 0 8 1

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-7


QoS Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port servicing mode Configures the servicing mode (SPQ or priority WRR) for a port.
show qos queue Displays information for all QoS queues.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfig
alaQoSConfigServicingMode
alaQoSConfigLowPriorityWeight
alaQoSConfigMediumPriorityWeight
alaQoSConfigHighPriorityWeight
alaQoSConfigUrgentPriorityWeight

page 17-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos forward log


Enables the QoS software in the switch to send events to the policy server software in the switch in real
time. The policy server software may then be polled by an NMS application for logged events.
qos forward log
qos no forward log

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, logged events are not sent to the policy server software in the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
An NMS application may query the Policy Manager in the switch for logged events. Use the qos forward
log command to forward each event as it happens.

Examples
-> qos forward log

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos log lines Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.
show qos log Displays the log of QoS events.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigForwardLog

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-9


QoS Commands

qos log console


Sends QoS log messages to the switch logging utility, which is an event logging application available on
the OmniSwitch. The configuration of the switch logging utility determines if QoS messages are sent to a
log file in the switch’s flash file system, displayed on the switch console, or sent to a remote syslog server.
qos log console
qos no log console

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
QoS log messages are not sent to the switch logging utility by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To display QoS log events as they happen on an output console attached to the switch, configure the
switch logging utility to output events to the console. This is done using the swlog output command.
• The entire log may be viewed at any time using the show qos log command.

Examples
-> qos log console
-> qos no log console

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos log lines Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.
swlog output Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data
socket (remote session).
show qos log Displays the log of QoS events.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigLogConsole

page 17-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos log lines


Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.
qos log lines lines

Syntax Definitions
lines The number of lines included in the QoS log. A value of zero turns off
logging to the console. The range is 0–512.

Defaults

parameter default
lines 256

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To turn off logging, enter 0 for the number of log lines. (Note that error messages will still be logged.)

• If you change the number of log lines, you may clear all messages in the QoS log. To avoid clearing all
messages in the log, enter the qos log lines command in the boot.cfg file. The log length will be
changed at the next reboot.

Examples
-> qos log lines 5
-> qos log lines 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show qos log Displays the log of QoS events.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigLogLines

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-11


QoS Commands

qos log level


Configures the level of log detail.
qos log level level
qos no log level

Syntax Definitions
level The level of log detail, in the range from 2 (least detail) to 9 (most
detail).

Defaults

parameter default
level 6

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the qos debug command to change the type of debugging messages that are logged. The qos log
level command configures the level of detail for these messages.
• If the qos debug command is not configured to log any kind of information (this is the default), the qos
log level command has no effect.
• To log fatal errors only, set the log level to 0.

• Note that a high log level value will impact the performance of the switch.

Examples
-> qos log level 4
-> qos log level 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos log lines Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.
debug qos Configures the type of QoS events that will be displayed in the QoS log.
show qos log Displays the log of QoS events.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigLogLevel

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-13


QoS Commands

qos default bridged disposition


Configures the default disposition for bridged traffic (Layer 2) that comes into the switch and does not
match any policies.
qos default bridged disposition {accept | deny | drop}

Syntax Definitions
accept Specifies that the switch should accept the flow.
drop Specifies that the switch should silently drop the flow.
deny Specifies that the switch should drop the flow and issue an ICMP
message indicating the flow was dropped for administrative reasons.
Currently this option will provide the same result as drop; that is, the
flow is silently dropped.

Defaults
By default, the disposition for flows that do match any policies is accept.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The disposition for particular flows may be configured through the policy action disposition
command. The disposition for a particular flow will override the global setting.
• Typically, when configuring IP filtering rules, the global default disposition should be set to deny.
Filtering rules may then be configured to allow particular types of traffic through the switch.
• If you set the bridged disposition to deny or drop, and you configure rules to allow bridged traffic, each
type of allowed traffic must have two rules, one for source and one for destination.

Examples
-> qos default bridged disposition deny

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

policy action disposition Configures a disposition for a policy action.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigDefaultBridgedDisposition
alaQoSConfigAppliedDefaultBridgedDisposition

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-15


QoS Commands

qos default multicast disposition


Configures the default disposition for multicast flows coming into the switch that do not match any poli-
cies.
qos default multicast disposition {accept | deny | drop}

Syntax Definitions
accept Specifies that the switch should accept the flow.
drop Specifies that the switch should silently drop the flow.
deny Specifies that the switch should drop the flow and issue an ICMP
message indicating the flow was dropped for administrative reasons.
Currently this option will provide the same result as drop; that is, the
flow is silently dropped.

Defaults
By default, multicast flows that do not match policies are accepted on the switch.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the policy action multicast command to specify the disposition for a particular action associated with
a multicast condition. The disposition for a particular action will override the global setting.

Examples
-> qos default multicast disposition deny

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy action disposition Configures a disposition for a policy action.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigDefaultMulticastDisposition
alaQoSConfigAppliedDefaultMulticastDisposition

page 17-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos stats interval


Configures how often the switch polls network interfaces for statistics about QoS events.
qos stats interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The number of seconds before the switch polls network interfaces for
statistics. The range is 10–3600.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 60

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Change the statistics interval to a smaller interval if you want to monitor QoS events.

• Change the statistics interval to a larger interval if you want to free some switch memory.

Examples
-> qos stats interval 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
show qos statistics Displays statistics about the QoS configuration.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigStatsInterval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-17


QoS Commands

qos nms priority


Enables or disables the automatic prioritization of NMS traffic—SSH (TCP Port 22), Telnet (TCP Port
23), WebView (HTTP Port 80) and SNMP (UDP port 161)—that is destined for the switch. Prioritization
maximizes access for NMS traffic and helps to reduce the potential for DoS attacks.
qos nms priority
qos no nms priority

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, NMS traffic prioritization is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable automatic prioritization of NMS traffic.

• The NMS traffic from the first eight active IP interfaces is prioritized; any such traffic from additional
interfaces is not prioritized.
• The precedence of an active IP interface is determined by the value of the SNMP interface index (ifin-
dex), which was assigned to the interface when it was created. The lower the ifindex value the higher
the precedence; the higher the ifindex value the lower the precedence. Note that the precedence is only
determined for active IP interfaces.
• To change the precedence of an IP interface, use the ip interface ifindex command and specify a
higher (lower precedence) or lower (higher precedence) ifindex value.
• When automatic NMS prioritization is enabled, QoS policies that specify priority are not applied to the
NMS traffic. Other QoS policies, however, are applied to this type of traffic as usual. If a policy speci-
fies rate limiting, then the policy with the lowest rate limiting value is applied.

Examples
-> qos nms priority
-> qos no nms priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands
show qos config Displays the QoS configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigAutoNms

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-19


QoS Commands

qos phones
Enables or disables the automatic prioritization of IP phone traffic.
qos phones priority priority_value
qos no phones

Syntax Definitions
priority_value The priority given to scheduling traffic on the output port. Values range
from 0 (lowest) to 7 (highest).

Defaults
By default, the priority value is set to 5.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable automatic prioritization of IP phone traffic.

• IP phone traffic is identified by examining the source MAC address of the packet received on the port.
If the source MAC falls within one of the following ranges, the QoS IP phone priority is automatically
assigned to the MAC:
00-80-9F-54-xx-xx to 00-80-9F-64-xx-xx
00-80-9F-66-xx-xx to 00-80-9F-6F-xx-xx.
• To automatically apply the QoS IP phone priority to other, non-IP phone traffic, add the source MAC
addresses of such traffic to the QoS “alaPhone” group.
• When automatic prioritization of IP phone traffic is enabled, QoS policies that specify priority are not
applied to the IP phone traffic. Other QoS policies, however, are applied to this type of traffic as usual.

Examples
-> qos phones priority 7
-> qos no phones

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands
show qos config Displays the QoS configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigAutoPhones

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-21


QoS Commands

qos user-port
Configures the option to filter packets or administratively disable a port when the specified type of traffic
is received on a port that is a member of the pre-defined UserPorts group.
qos user-port {filter | shutdown} {spoof | bpdu | rip | dhcp-server | dns-reply}
qos no user-port {filter | shutdown}

Syntax Definitions
filter Filters the specified type of traffic when it is received on UserPort ports.
shutdown Administratively disables UserPort ports that receive the specified type
of traffic.
spoof Detects IP spoofing. The source IP address of a packet ingressing on a
user port is compared to the subnet of the VLAN for the user port; the
packet is dropped if these two items do not match. Also applies to ARP
packets.
bpdu Filters conventional Spanning Tree BPDU (destination MAC address
0x0180c2:000000) packets and GVRP (destination MAC address
0x0180c2:000021) packets.
rip Filters RIP protocol packets.
dhcp-server Filters response packets originating from a DHCP or BOOTP server that
is configured on the known UDP port 67.
dns-reply Filters all packets (both TCP and UDP) that originate from the known
DNS port 53.

Defaults

parameter default
filter spoof
shutdown none

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable the filter or shutdown function. This form of the command
effects the overall operation of the feature.
• To specify more than one traffic type in the same command line, enter each type separated by a space
(e.g., spoof bpdu rip).
• Note that existing traffic types to filter or shutdown are removed each time the filter or shutdown
option is configured. Specify all desired traffic types each time the qos user-port command is
performed to retain previously configured traffic types.

page 17-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

• No changes to the filtering and shutdown options are applied to the switch until the qos apply
command is performed.
• This command only applies to ports that are members of the UserPorts group. Use the policy port
group command to create and assign members to the UserPorts group.
• An SNMP trap is sent when a port is administratively disabled through a UserPorts shutdown function
or a port disable action.
• To enable a port disabled by a user port shutdown operation, use the interfaces admin command to
administratively enable the port or disconnect and reconnect the port cable.
• Up to 126 IP interfaces are supported with spoof detection on user ports. If the number of interfaces
exceeds this amount, user port packets ingressing on those interfaces that exceed the 126 limit are
dropped.

Examples
-> qos user-port filter spoof bpdu
-> qos user-port shutdown spoof bdpu rip
-> qos no user-port shutdown

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
policy port group Configures a port group and its associated slot and port numbers.
show qos config Displays QoS configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigUserportFilter
alaQoSConfigAppliedUserportFilter
alaQoSConfigUserportShutdown
alaQoSConfigAppliedUserportShutdown

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-23


QoS Commands

qos dei
Configures the global Drop Eligible Indicator (DEI) bit marking setting for all QoS ports.The DEI setting
applies to packets marked yellow (non-conforming) as the result of Tri-Color Marking (TCM) rate limit-
ing.
qos dei egress
qos no dei egress

Syntax Definitions
egress Marks the DEI/CFI bit for egress packets if TCM marked the packets
yellow.

Defaults
By default, no DEI/CFI bit marking is done.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable the global DEI bit marking (egress) configuration for the
switch.
• Use the qos port dei command to set the DEI bit marking configuration for a specific port. Note that
the port setting takes precedence over the global DEI setting.
• Packets marked yellow by TCM rate limiting are still transmitted when there is no congestion on the
egress port queues. Setting the DEI/CFI bit for yellow egress packets (qos dei egress) ensures that an
upstream switch is made aware that the packet was marked yellow.
• DEI mapping of ingress traffic (qos port dei ingress) is not supported.

Examples
-> qos dei egress
-> qos no dei egress

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.


qos port dei Configures the Drop Eligible Indicator (DEI) bit marking setting for the
specified QoS port.
policy action cir Configures a Tri-Color Marking policy action.
show qos config Displays global information about the QoS configuration.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigDEIMarking

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-25


QoS Commands

debug qos
Configures the type of QoS events that will be displayed in the QoS log.
debug qos [info] [config] [rule] [main] [route] [hre] [port] [msg] [sl] [ioctl] [mem] [cam] [mapper]
[flows] [queue] [slot] [l2] [l3] [classifier] [nat] [sem] [pm] [ingress] [egress] [rsvp] [balance] [nimsg]
debug no qos
debug no qos [info] [config] [rule] [main] [route] [hre] [port] [msg] [sl] [ioctl] [mem] [cam] [mapper]
[flows] [queue] [slot] [l2] [l3] [classifier] [nat] [sem] [pm] [ingress] [egress] [rsvp] [balance] [nimsg]

Syntax Definitions
flows Logs events for flows on the switch.
queue Logs events for queues created and destroyed on the switch.
rule Logs events for rules configured on the switch.
l2 Logs Layer 2 QoS events on the switch.
l3 Logs Layer 3 QoS events on the switch.
nat Logs events for Network Address Translation policies. Not supported
for the OmniSwitch 6624/6648.
port Logs events related to QoS ports.
msg Logs QoS messages.
classifier Logs information whenever the switch classifies a flow; more details are
provided if the log level is higher.
info Logs basic information about the switch
config Logs information about the global configuration.
main Logs information about basic program interfaces.
route Logs information about routing.
hre Logs information about hardware route programming.
sl Logs information about source learning.
mem Logs information about memory.
cam Logs information about CAM operations.
mapper Logs information about mapping queues.
slot Logs events related to slots.
sem Logs information about semaphore, process locking.
pm Logs events related to the Policy Manager.
ingress Logs information about packets arriving on the switch.

page 17-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

egress Logs information about packets leaving the switch.


rsvp Logs information about RSVP flows. Currently not supported.
balance Logs information about flows that are part of a load balancing cluster.
Not supported for the OmniSwitch 6624/6648.
nimsg Logs information about QoS interfaces.

Defaults
By default basic information messages are logged (info). Error messages are always logged.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to change the type of messages that will be logged or to return
debugging to its default state.
• Use this command to troubleshoot QoS events on the switch.

Examples
-> debug qos flows queue
-> qos debug no flows no queue
-> debug no qos

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos forward log Enables the switch to send events to the PolicyView application in real
time.
qos log lines Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.
show qos log Displays the log of QoS events.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigDebug

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-27


QoS Commands

debug qos internal


Displays debugging information for QoS internal to the switch.
debug qos internal [slice slot/slice] [flow] [queue] [port] [l2tree] [l3tree] [vector] [pending] [verbose]
[mapper] [pool] [log] [pingonly | nopingonly]

Syntax Definitions
slot/slice The slot number and slice for which you want to view debugging infor-
mation. A slice is a logical section of hardware that corresponds to
particular ports on a network interface module.
flow Displays information about QoS flows.
queue Displays information about QoS queues.
port Displays information about QoS ports.
l2tree Displays information about Layer 2 flows.
l3tree Displays information about Layer 3 flows.
vector Displays information about vectors.
pending Displays information about pending QoS objects.
verbose Sets the output to verbose mode for more detailed information.
mapper Displays information about QoS mapping flows to queues.
pool Displays information about the buffer pool.
log Displays information about QoS information that is logged.
pingonly On an OmniSwitch 6624/6648, specifies that any policies configured
with an ICMP protocol condition apply only to ICMP echo-requests.
nopingonly Configures the switch so that any policies configured with an ICMP
protocol condition apply to any ICMP packets.

Defaults
Debugging is disabled by default.

parameter default
pingonly | nopingonly nopingonly

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the debug qos command to set the level of log detail in the QoS log.

page 17-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Examples
-> debug qos internal "verbose log"

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

debug qos Configures the type of QoS events that will be displayed in the QoS log.
policy condition ip protocol Configures an IP protocol for a policy condition.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-29


QoS Commands

qos clear log


Clears messages in the current QoS log.
qos clear log

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command is useful for clearing messages from a large log file so that the file is easier to view. Logs
can get large if invalid rules are configured on the switch, or if a lot of QoS events have taken place. Clear-
ing the log makes the file easier to manage.

Examples
-> qos clear log

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos log lines Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.
debug qos Configures the type of QoS events that will be displayed in the QoS log.
show qos log Displays the log of QoS events.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigClearLog

page 17-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos apply
Applies configured global QoS and policy settings to the current configuration (changes will be active and
stored in flash).
qos apply

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is required to activate all QoS and policy commands. This is the only command that
causes current changes to be written to flash.
• Rules are configured through the policy rule command, but are not active on the switch until you enter
qos apply.

Examples
-> qos apply

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos revert Removes any policies configured through policy rule but not applied to
the current configuration through the qos apply command.
qos reset Resets the QoS configuration to its default values.
qos flush Deletes all pending policy information.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigApply

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-31


QoS Commands

qos revert
Deletes any QoS configuration that has not been applied to the configuration through the qos apply
command.
qos revert

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to remove currently configured policies that have not yet been activated through the
qos apply command.

Examples
-> qos revert

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule and saves it to the current configuration but
does not make it active on the switch.
qos apply Applies all QoS settings configured on the switch to the current configu-
ration.
qos reset Resets the QoS configuration to its defaults.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigRevert

page 17-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos flush
Deletes all pending policy information. This command is different from qos revert, which returns the
pending policy configuration to its last applied settings.
qos flush

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If you enter this command, the pending policy configuration is completely erased. If you then enter qos
apply, the erased configuration overwrites the applied policies and you will erase all of your policy
configuration.

Note. Do not use this command unless you want to erase all of your policy configuration and start config-
uring new policies.

• Use the qos revert command to return the pending policy configuration to its last applied value.

• Policy configuration includes the following commands:

base commands
policy rule policy mac group
policy network group policy port group
policy service policy condition
policy service group policy action

Examples
-> qos flush

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-33


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos revert Deletes any QoS configuration that has not been applied to the configu-
ration through the qos apply command.
qos apply Applies configured global QoS and policy settings to the current config-
uration (changes will be active and stored in flash).
policy server flush Removes all cached LDAP policy data from the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigFlush

page 17-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos reset
Resets the QoS configuration to its defaults.
qos reset

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to reset QoS configuration that has not yet been applied through the qos apply
command. The parameters are reset to their defaults.

Examples
-> qos reset

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies all QoS settings configured on the switch to the current configu-
ration.
qos revert Deletes any QoS configuration that has not been applied to the configu-
ration through the qos apply command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigReset

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-35


QoS Commands

qos stats reset


Resets QoS statistic counters to zero.
qos stats reset [egress]

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
All QoS statistic counters are reset to zero.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to reset global QoS statistics to zero. Statistics may be displayed with the show qos
statistics command.
• Use the egress parameter to reset only the egress CoS queue statistics to zero. Statistics may be
displayed with the show qos queue command.

Examples
-> qos stats reset
-> qos stats reset egress

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; egress parameter added.

Related Commands

show qos statistics Displays statistics about the QoS configuration.


show qos queue Displays QoS egress CoS queue statistics.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigStatsReset

page 17-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

qos port reset


Resets all QoS port configuration to the default values.
qos port slot/port reset

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The physical slot and port number. For example: 3/1.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The QoS port configuration parameters that are reset include:

parameter default
default queues 8
trusted not trusted

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 reset

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortSlot
alaQoSPortPort
alaQoSPortReset

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-37


QoS Commands

qos port
Configures QoS parameters for a physical port. This section describes the base command with a single
required option (slot/port).
In lieu of these options, the base command (qos port) may be used with other keywords to set up a QoS
configuration on a per port basis. These keywords are listed here and described as separate commands later
in this chapter. In addition, some keywords have a no form to remove the parameter or return it to its
default.
qos port slot/port
[trusted]
[servicing mode]
[maximum bandwidth]
[maximum egress-bandwidth]
[maximum ingress-bandwidth]
[default 802.1p value]
[default dscp value]
[default classification {802.1p | tos | dscp}]
[dei]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The physical slot and port number. For example: 4/1.

Defaults
• Mobile ports and ports enabled for 802.1Q are always trusted; by default, any other ports are not
trusted.
• By default, QoS ports do not preempt queues of lower priority.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the trusted option to change the trust mode for the port.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 trusted
-> qos port 4/2 no trusted

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; DEI field added.

page 17-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures whether the default mode for QoS ports is trusted or
untrusted.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortSlot
alaQoSPortPort
alaQoSPortTrusted
alaQoSPortDefault8021p
alaQoSPortDefaultDSCP
alaQoSPortMaximumDefaultBandwidth
alaQoSPortAppliedMaximumDefaultBandwidth
alaQoSPortDefaultClassification
alaQoSPortAppliedDefaultClassification
alaQoSPortLowPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortAppliedLowPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortMediumPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortAppliedMediumPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortHighPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortAppliedHighPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortUrgentPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortAppliedUrgentPriorityWeight
alaQoSPortDEIMarking

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-39


QoS Commands

qos port trusted


Configures whether an individual port is trusted or untrusted. Trusted ports can accept the 802.1p and ToS/
DSCP values in incoming packets; untrusted ports will set any 802.1p or ToS/DSCP values to zero in
incoming packets, unless a default 802.1p or ToS/DSCP value is configured.
qos port slot/port trusted
qos port slot/port no trusted

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.

Defaults
By default, QoS ports are not trusted.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the qos trust ports command to set the default trust mode for all QoS ports. The qos port trusted
command may be used to override the default.
• The setting applies only to ports with incoming traffic.

• Use the qos port default 802.1p or qos port default dscp commands to specify that a value other than
zero should be applied to the incoming packets. Note that this value is overidden if a policy exists that
specifies a different 802.1p or ToS/DSCP value for such packets.
• Mobile ports and ports configured for 802.1Q are always trusted.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 trusted
-> qos port 4/2 no trusted

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.
qos trust ports Configures the global trust mode for QoS ports.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortTrusted

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-41


QoS Commands

qos port servicing mode


Configures a queuing scheme for an individual destination (egress) port.
qos port slot/port servicing mode {strict-priority | wrr [w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7] | drr [w0 w1 w2 w3
w4 w5 w6 w7] | default}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number to which this servicing mode applies.
strict-priority Selects the strict priority queuing scheme as the servicing mode for the
specified port. All eight available queues on a port are serviced strictly
by priority.
wrr Selects the weighted round robin (WRR) queuing scheme as the default
servicing mode. Traffic is serviced based on the weight of each queue.
drr Selects the deficit round robin (DRR) queuing scheme as the default
servicing mode. Traffic is serviced based on the weight of each queue.
w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7 The value of the desired weight for each of the queues when WRR,
Priority WRR, or, DRR is the active queuing scheme. The range is 0 to
15.
default Selects the switch default servicing mode for the port. The default mode
is configured using the qos default servicing mode command.

Defaults

parameter default
strict-priority | priority-wrr | strict-priority
wrr | drr
w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7 1 (best effort)

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Each queue can have a different weight value and configuring these values in ascending or descending
order is not required. When a queue is given a weight of 0, it is configured as a Strict-Priority queue.
• Use the wrr parameter to configure a Priority-WRR queuing scheme, which consists of a combination
of Strict-Priority queues (zero weight) and WRR queues (non-zero weight).
• The qos port servicing mode command overrides the servicing mode configured with the qos default
servicing mode command.
• The servicing mode only applies to destination (egress) ports because this is where traffic shaping
occurs. Even though the qos port servicing mode and qos default servicing mode commands are
allowed on source (ingress) ports, they do not affect traffic on these ports.

page 17-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

• Once the qos port servicing mode command is used on a port, this same command is required to make
any additional mode changes for that port. If the port is changed back to the default servicing mode,
however, this restriction is removed and the qos default servicing mode command is also allowed on
the port.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 servicing mode strict-priority
-> qos port 3/3 servicing mode wrr 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-> qos default servicing mode priority-wrr 0 10 0 9 0 0 2 3
-> qos port 3/4 servicing mode drr 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
-> qos port 3/2 servicing mode default

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos default servicing mode Configures the default servicing mode for all switch ports.
show qos queue Displays information for all QoS queues.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortServicingMode
alaQosPortQ0PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ1PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ2PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ3PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ4PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ5PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ6PriorityWeight
alaQosPortQ7PriorityWeight

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-43


QoS Commands

qos port q maxbw


Configures a maximum bandwidth for each of the 8 COS egress queues on the specified port.
qos port slot/port qn maxbw kbps
qos port slot/port no qn maxbw kbps

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot/port on which the COS max bandwidth is configured.
n The number of the queue for the specified port. Range is 1 to 8.
kbps The maximum bandwidth value (in Kbits per second). The value may be
entered as an integer (for example, 10000) or with abbreviated units (for
example, 10k, 10m, 10g, or 10t). If the value is entered in bits per
second, the switch rounds the value up to the nearest thousand.

Defaults
By default the maximum bandwidth value for each queue is set to zero (port speed).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to return the maximum bandwidth value for the specified queue to
the default value (zero).
• Note that configuring the maximum bandwidth for the same queue is allowed on the same command
line (see the “Examples” section).
• Configuring the bandwidth values for different queues requires a separate command for each queue.

Examples
-> qos port 1/3 q1 maxbw 5g
-> qos port 1/3 q2 maxb2 4g
-> qos port 2/1 q7 maxbw 50k
-> qos port 1/3 no q1 maxbw

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos default servicing mode Configures the default servicing mode for all switch ports.
show qos queue Displays information for all QoS queues.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortSlot
alaQoSPortPort
alaQoSPortCOS0MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS1MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS2MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS3MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS4MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS5MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS6MaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortCOS7MaximumBandwidth

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-45


QoS Commands

qos port maximum egress-bandwidth


Configures the maximum rate at which to send traffic on the specified QoS port.
qos port slot/port maximum egress-bandwidth bps
qos port slot/port no maximum egress-bandwidth

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.
bps The maximum amount of bandwidth that may be used for all traffic
egressing on the QoS port.

Defaults
By default, the maximum bandwidth is the maximum allowed for the interface type on which the port
resides.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a configured maximum egress bandwidth value from a
port.
• When configuring the maximum egress bandwidth for a combo port, specify the bandwidth value in
multiples of 2Mbps.
• The maximum egress bandwidth value cannot exceed the maximum bandwidth of the interface type
associated with the port.
• Modifying the maximum egress bandwidth is most useful for low-bandwidth links.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 maximum egress-bandwidth 1000
-> qos port 3/1 no maximum egress-bandwidth

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos port maximum ingress- Configures the rate at which traffic is received on a QoS port.
bandwidth
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortSlot
alaQoSPortPort
alaQoSPortMaximumBandwidth
alaQoSPortMaximumBandwidthStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-47


QoS Commands

qos port maximum ingress-bandwidth


Configures the maximum rate at which traffic is received on a QoS port.
qos port slot/port maximum ingress-bandwidth bps
qos port slot/port no maximum ingress-bandwidth

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.
bps The maximum amount of bandwidth that may be used for all traffic
ingressing on the QoS port.

Defaults
By default, the maximum bandwidth is the maximum allowed for the interface type on which the port
resides.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a configured maximum ingress bandwidth value from a
port.
• The maximum ingress bandwidth value cannot exceed the maximum bandwidth of the interface type
associated with the port.
• Modifying the maximum ingress bandwidth is most useful for low-bandwidth links.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 maximum ingress-bandwidth 1000
-> qos port 3/1 no maximum ingress-bandwidth

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command introduced.

Related Commands

qos port maximum egress- Configures the rate at which traffic is sent on a QoS port.
bandwidth
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

page 17-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortSlot
alaQoSPortPort
alaQoSPortMaximumIngBandwidth
alaQoSPortMaximumIngBandwidthStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-49


QoS Commands

qos port default 802.1p


Configures the 802.1p value to be inserted in flows ingressing on an untrusted port.
qos port slot/port default 802.1p value

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.
value The priority value to be set. Values range from 0 (lowest priority) to 7
(highest priority).

Defaults

parameter default
value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• By default untrusted ports will set the 802.1p bit to zero on incoming flows. Use this command to spec-
ify that a different 802.1p value should be applied to the flow.
• The default 802.1p value is not used if there is a matching QoS policy rule that sets the priority.

• Note that on the 802.1p bit for tagged packets received on untrusted ports is set with the default 802.1p
value, which is configured using the qos port default 802.1p command. If the packet is untagged,
however, then the DSCP bit is set with the default DSCP value, which is configured using the qos port
default dscp command.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 default 802.1p 5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

page 17-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortDefault8021p
alaQoSAppliedPortDefault8021p

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-51


QoS Commands

qos port default dscp


Configures the ToS/DSCP value to be inserted in flows ingressing on an untrusted port.
qos port slot/port default dscp value

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.
value The ToS/DSCP value. The range is 0–63.

Defaults

parameter default
value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The value configured by this command sets the upper byte (precedence) and therefore configures the
ToS/DSCP value for the port.
• The default DSCP value is not used if there is a matching QoS policy rule that sets the priority.

• Note that on the 802.1p bit for tagged packets received on untrusted ports is set with the default 802.1p
value, which is configured using the qos port default 802.1p command. If the packet is untagged,
however, then the DSCP bit is set with the default DSCP value, which is configured using the qos port
default dscp command.

Examples
-> qos port 3/1 default dscp 63

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortDefaultDSCP
alaQoSAppliedPortDefaultDSCP

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-53


QoS Commands

qos port default classification


Specifies the default egress priority value to use for IP traffic ingressing on trusted ports.
qos port slot/port default classification {802.1p | dscp}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.
802.1p Specifies that the 802.1p value of the flow will be used to prioritize
flows coming in on the port.
dscp Specifies that DSCP value of the flow will be used to prioritize flows
coming in on the port.

Defaults

parameter default
802.1p | dscp dscp

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The egress priority assigned to an IP packet received on a trusted port is based on the DSCP value of
the packet unless 802.1p is specified using this command.
• The default classification priority is not used if there is a matching QoS policy rule that sets the egress
priority value.
• This command does not affect Layer 2 traffic, which is always classified with 802.1p.

• In some network situations, some IP traffic may be dropped before any QoS rules can take effect for
the traffic.

Examples
-> qos port 8/24 default classification dscp
-> qos port 7/1 default classification 802.1p

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortDefaultClassification

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-55


QoS Commands

qos port dei


Configures the Drop Eligible Indicator (DEI) bit marking setting for the specified QoS port. The DEI
setting applies to packets marked yellow (non-conforming) as the result of Tri-Color Marking (TCM) rate
limiting.
qos port slot/port dei [egress]
qos port slot/port no dei [egress]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number and port number of the physical port.
egress Sets the DEI/CFI bit for egress packets if TCM has marked the packets
as yellow.

Defaults
By default, no DEI/CFI bit marking is done.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable the DEI bit marking (egress) configuration for the speci-
fied port
• Use the qos dei command to set the global DEI bit marking configuration for all QoS switch ports.
Note that the port-level setting takes precedence over the global DEI setting.
• Packets marked yellow by TCM rate limiting are still transmitted when there is no congestion on the
egress port queues. Setting the DEI/CFI bit for yellow egress packets (qos port dei egress) ensures that
an upstream switch is made aware that the packet was marked yellow.
• DEI mapping of ingress traffic (qos port dei ingress) is not supported.

Examples
-> qos port 1/20 dei egress
-> qos port dei egress
-> qos port 1/20 no dei egress

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 17-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands

qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.


qos dei Configures the global Drop Eligible Indicator (DEI) bit marking setting
for all QoS ports.
policy action cir Configures a Tri-Color Marking policy action.
show qos config Displays global information about the QoS configuration.
show qos port Displays information about QoS ports.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSConfig
alaQoSConfigDEIMarking
alaQoSPortDEIMarking

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-57


QoS Commands

show qos port


Displays information about all QoS ports or a particular port.
show qos port [slot/port] [statistics]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The physical slot and port number. For example: 3/1.
statistics Displays statistics for high-density gigabit modules.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all ports is displayed unless a particular port is specified.

• Use the qos port command to configure port parameters.

• For ports that are trusted (Yes displays in the Trust field), the Trust field includes one of the following
characters:

character definition
+ Indicates that the port is manually configured as trusted through the qos
port trusted command; the port setting takes precedence over the global
trust setting configured through the qos trust ports command.
* Indicates that the port is automatically trusted regardless of the global set-
ting set through the qos trust ports command. (Applies to mobile ports and
ports configured for 802.1Q.)

Examples
-> show qos port
Slot/ Default Default Queues Bandwidth DEI
Port Active Trust P/DSCP Classification Deflt Total Physical Egress Mark Type
-----+-----+-----+------+--------------+-----+-----+--------+-------+----+------+-
1/1 Yes No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 100M - Yes ethernet
1/2 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/3 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/4 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/5 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/6 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/7 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/8 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/9 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet
1/10 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - Yes ethernet
1/11 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet

page 17-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

1/12 No No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 0K - No ethernet

-> show qos port 1/1


Slot/ Default Default Queues Bandwidth DEI
Port Active Trust P/DSCP Classification Deflt Total Physical Egress Mark Type
----+-----+-----+------+---------------+------+-----+---------+-----+-----+-------+
5/1 Yes No 0/ 0 DSCP 8 0 100M - Yes ethernet

output definitions
Slot/Port The slot and physical port number.
Active Whether or not the port is sending/receiving QoS traffic.
Trust Whether the port is trusted or not trusted.
Default P The default 802.1p setting for the port.
Default DSCP The default ToS/DSCP setting for the port.
Default Classification The default classification setting for the port (802.1p or DSCP).
Default Queues The number of default queues.
Total Queues The total number of queues.
Physical Bandwidth The amount of physical bandwidth available on the port.
Egress The amount of egress bandwidth for the port.
DEI Mark Whether or not the port sets the DEI bit for yellow (non-conforming)
egress packets.
Type The interface type, ethernet or wan.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; DEI Mark field added.

Related Commands

qos port Configures a physical port for QoS.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortTable
alaQoSPortSlot
alaQoSPortPort
alaQoSPortEnabled
alaQoSPortDefault8021p
alaQoSPortDefaultDSCP
alaQoSPortDefaultQueues
alaQoSPortMaximumReservedBandwidth
alaQoSPortMaximumDefaultBandwidth
alaQoSPortDefaultClassification
alaQoSPortDEIMarking
alaQoSClassify
alaQoSClassifySourceInterfaceType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-59


QoS Commands

show qos queue


Displays information and statistics for all QoS queues or only for those queues associated with a specific
port.
show qos queue [slot/port] [statistics slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
statistics Displays statistics for the specific slot and port.
slot/port The physical slot and port number. For example: 3/1.

Defaults
By default, statistics are displayed for all queues.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot/port parameter to display queue statistics for a specific port.

Examples
-> show qos queue 2/10
Slot/ Q Bandwidth Max Max Packets
Port VPN No Pri Wt Min Max Bufs Depth Xmit/Drop Type
-----+-----+----+----+-----+----+-----+------+------+--------+---+-------
2/10 102 0 0 - * * * * 1000/20 PRI
2/10 102 1 0 - * * * * 1000/20 PRI
2/10 102 2 0 - * * * * 1000/20 PRI
2/10 102 3 0 - * * * * 1000/20 PRI
2/10 102 4 0 - * * * * 1000/20 PRI
2/10 102 5 0 - * * * * 1000/20 PRI
Total Xmit Packets: 184368,
Total Drop Packets: 0

-> show qos queue statistics 2/10

Slot/ Q Transmit Dropped


Port No Pri Packets bytes Packets bytes
-----+---+-----+---------+-------------------+----------+--------------------
1/20 0 High 1758 135476 0 0
1/20 0 Low 0 0 0 0
1/20 1 High 0 0 0 0
1/20 1 Low 0 0 0 0
1/20 2 High 0 0 0 0
1/20 2 Low 0 0 0 0
1/20 3 High 0 0 0 0
1/20 3 Low 0 0 0 0
1/20 4 High 1651 125476 0 0
1/20 4 Low 0 0 0 0

page 17-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

1/20 5 High 0 0 0 0
1/20 5 Low 0 0 0 0
1/20 6 High 7066 589033 0 0
1/20 6 Low 0 0 0 0
1/20 7 High 3 216 0 0
1/20 7 Low 0 0 0 0

output definitions
Slot/Port The physical slot/port numbers associated with the queue.
VPN The virtual port number associated with the queue.
Q No The queue number (0 through 7).
Pri The priority associated with the queue (0 through 7), configured
through the policy action priority command.
Wt The weight value assigned to each queue. Configured through the qos
default servicing mode and qos port servicing mode commands.
Bandwidth Min The minimum bandwidth requirement for the queue.
Bandwidth Max The maximum bandwidth requirement for the queue (the bandwidth
allowed by the maximum configured for all actions associated with the
queue). Configured through the policy action maximum bandwidth
command.
Max Bufs The number of buffers associated with the queue.
Max Depth The maximum queue depth, in bytes. Configured through the policy
action maximum depth command.
Packets Xmit/Drop The number of packets transmitted/dropped from this queue.
Type The type of queuing performed on this queue (pri, wrr, drr).
Priority The number of high and low priority packets per queue.
Transmit/Dropped Packet/ The number of packets and bytes transmitted or dropped per queue.
Bytes

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; slot/port and statistics parameters added.

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch. A rule is made up of a condition
(for classifying incoming traffic) and an action (to be applied to outgo-
ing traffic).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-61


QoS Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSQueueTable
alaQoSQueueId
alaQoSQueueSlot
alaQoSQueuePort
alaQoSQueuePortId
alaQoSQueueType
alaQoSQueuePriority
alaQoSQueueMinimumBandwidth
alaQoSQueueMaximumBandwidth
alaQoSQueueAverageBandwidth
alaQoSQueueMaximumDepth
alaQoSQueueMaximumBuffers
alaQoSQueue8021p
alaQoSQueuePacketsSent
alaQoSQueuePacketsDropped
alaQoSQueueMaxLength
alaQoSQueueAverageLength
alaQoSQueueCurrentLength
alaQoSQueueStatsTable
alaQoSQueueStatsEntry
alaQoSStatsQueueId
alaQoSQueueStatsSlot
alaQoSQueueStatsPort
alaQoSQueueStatsPriority
alaQoSQueueStatsPacketsSent
alaQoSQueueStatsPacketsDropped
alaQoSQueueStatsBytesSent
alaQoSQueueStatsBytesDropped

page 17-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

show qos slice


Displays rule availability and usage information for QoS slices of QoS slots. A slice is a logical section of
hardware and corresponds to particular ports on the interface.
show qos slice [slot/slice]

Syntax Definitions
slot/slice The slot number and slice for which you want to view information. The
number of slices per module varies depending on the type of module.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all slots/slices is displayed unless a particular slot/slice is requested.

• This command is useful for monitoring switch resources required for policy rules.

Examples
-> show qos slice
Slot/ Ranges Rules Counters Meters
Slice Type Total/Free CAM Total/Free Total/Free Total/Free
3/0 Firebolt 16/16 0 128/101 128/101 64/64
1 128/125 128/125 64/64
2 128/0 128/0 64/64
3 128/0 128/0 64/64
4 128/0 128/0 64/64
5 128/0 128/0 64/64
6 128/0 128/0 64/64
7 128/0 128/0 64/64
8 128/0 128/0 64/64
9 128/0 128/0 64/64
10 128/0 128/0 64/64
11 128/0 128/0 64/64
12 128/0 128/0 64/64
13 128/0 128/24 64/64
14 128/0 128/62 64/64
15 128/124 128/123 64/63

output definitions
Slot/Slice The slot and slice number.
Type The type of slice.
Ranges Total The total number of TCP/UDP port ranges supported per slot/slice.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-63


QoS Commands

output definitions (continued)


Ranges Free The number of TCP/UDP port ranges that are still available for use.
CAM The CAM number.
Rules Total The total number of rules supported per CAM.
Rules Free The number of rules that are still available for use. On startup, the
switch uses 27 rules.
Counters Total The total number of counters supported per CAM.
Counter Free The number of counters that are still available for use.
Meters Total The total number of meters supported per CAM.
Meters Free The number of meters that are still available for use.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch. A rule is made up of a condition
(for classifying incoming traffic) and an action (to be applied to outgo-
ing traffic).

MIB Objects
N/A

page 17-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

show qos log


Displays the log of QoS events.
show qos log

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to display the current QoS log. To clear the log, use the qos clear log command.

Examples
-> show qos log
**QOS Log**
Insert rule 0
Rule index at 0
Insert rule 1
Rule index at 1
Insert rule 2
Rule index at 2
Enable rule r1 (1) 1,1
Enable rule r2 (0) 1,1
Enable rule yuba1 (2) 1,1
Verify rule r1(1)
Enable rule r1 (1) 1,1
Really enable r1
Update condition c1 for rule 1 (1)
Verify rule r2(1)
Enable rule r2 (0) 1,1
Really enable r2
Update condition c2 for rule 0 (1)
Verify rule yuba1(1)
Enable rule yuba1 (2) 1,1
Really enable yuba1
Update condition yubamac for rule 2 (1)
QoS Manager started TUE MAR 10 13:46:50 2002

Match rule 2 to 1
Match rule 2 to 2
Match rule 2 to 3

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-65


QoS Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos clear log Clears messages in the current QoS log.


qos log lines Configures the number of lines in the QoS log.

MIB Objects
N/A

page 17-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

show qos config


Displays global information about the QoS configuration.
show qos config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to view the current global configuration for QoS. Use the show qos statistics
command to view statistics about the QoS software in the switch.

Examples
-> show qos config
QoS Configuration:
Enabled : Yes,
Pending changes : port,
DEI:
Marking : Enabeled,
Classifier:
Default queues : 8,
Default queue service : strict-priority,
Trusted ports : No,
NMS Priority : Yes,
Phones : trusted,
Default bridged disposition : accept,
Default IGMP/MLD disposition: accept,
Logging:
Log lines : 256,
Log level : 6,
Log to console : No,
Forward log : No,
Stats interval : 60 seconds,
Userports:
Filter : spoof,
Shutdown: none,
Debug : info

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-67


QoS Commands

output definitions
QoS Configuration Whether or not QoS is enabled or disabled. Configured through the qos
command.
Marking Whether or not DEI marking for egress packets is enabled or disabled.
Configured through the qos dei command
Default queues The number of default queues for QoS ports. There are eight queues for
each QoS port; this value is not configurable.
Default queue service The default servicing mode for the switch (strict-priority, WRR, or
DRR). Configured through the qos default servicing mode command.
Trusted Ports The default trusted mode for switch ports. Configured through the qos
trust ports command.
NMS Priority Whether or not the automatic prioritization of NMS traffic is enabled or
disabled. Configured through the qos nms priority command.
Phones Whether or not IP Phone traffic is automatically trusted or assigned a
priority value. Configured through the qos phones command.
Default bridged disposition Whether or not bridged traffic that does not match any policy will be
accepted or denied on the switch Configured through the qos default
bridged disposition command.
Default IGMP/MLD disposi- Whether or not multicast flows that do not match any policy will be
tion accepted or denied on the switch. Configured through the qos default
multicast disposition command.
Log lines The number of lines included in the QoS log. Configured through the
qos log lines command.
Log level The level of log detail. Configured through the qos log level command.
Log to console Whether or not log messages are sent to the console. Configured
through the qos log console command.
Forward log Whether or not logged events are sent to the policy server software in
the switch in real time. Configured through the qos forward log com-
mand.
Stats interval How often the switch polls network interfaces for statistics about QoS
events. Configured through the qos stats interval command.
Filter The type of traffic that is filtered on ports that are members of the User-
Ports group. Configured through the qos user-port command.
Shutdown The type of traffic that will trigger an administrative shutdown of the
port if the port is a member of the UserPorts group. Configured through
the qos user-port command.
Debug The type of information that will be displayed in the QoS log. Config-
ured through the qos dei command. A value of info indicates the
default debugging type.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; DEI Marking field added.

page 17-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Related Commands
qos Enables or disables QoS. This base command may be used with key-
word options to configure QoS globally on the switch.
show qos statistics Displays statistics about the QoS configuration.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConfigTable
alaQoSConfigEnable
alaQoSConfigDEIMarking
alaQosConfigServicingMode
alaQosConfigTrustPorts
alaQoSConfigAutoNms
alaQoSConfigAutoPhones
alaQoSConfigDefaultBridgedDisposition
alaQoSConfigDefaultMulticastDisposition
alaQoSConfigLogLines
alaQoSConfigLogLevel
alaQoSConfigLogConsole
alaQoSConfigStatsInterval
alaQosConfigUserportFilter
alaQosConfigUserportShutdown
alaQoSConfigDebug

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-69


QoS Commands

show qos statistics


Displays statistics about the QoS configuration.
show qos statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays statistics about the global QoS configuration. Use the show qos config command
to display information about configurable global parameters.

Examples
-> show qos statistics
QoS stats
Events Matches Drops
L2 : 15 0 0
L3 Inbound : 0 0 0
L3 Outbound : 0 0 0
IGMP Join : 0 0 0
Fragments : 0
Bad Fragments : 0
Unknown Fragments : 0
Sent NI messages : 9
Received NI messages : 4322
Failed NI messages : 0
Load balanced flows : 0
Reflexive flows : 0
Reflexive correction : 0
Flow lookups : 0
Flow hits : 0
Max PTree nodes : 0
Max PTree depth : 0
Spoofed Events : 0
NonSpoofed Events : 0
DropServices : 0
L2TP : 0
L2TP Drop : 0
L2TP Match : 0

page 17-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Commands

Software resources
Applied Pending
Table CLI LDAP ACLM Blt Total CLI LDAP ACLM Blt Total Max
rules 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 2048
actions 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 2048
conditions 2 0 0 0 2 2 0 0 0 2 2048
services 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 256
service groups 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1024
network groups 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 1024
port groups 3 0 0 8 11 3 0 0 8 11 1024
mac groups 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1024
map groups 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1024
vlan groups 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1024

Hardware resources TCAM Ranges


Slot Slice Unit Used Free Max Used Free Max
1 0 0 13 1267 1280 0 0 0

output definitions
Events The number of Layer 2 or Layer 3 flows transmitted on the switch.
Matches The number of Layer 2 or Layer 3 flows that match policies.
Drops The number of Layer 2 or Layer 3 flows that were dropped.
L2 The number of Layer 2 events, matches, and drops.
L3 Ingress The number of Layer 3 ingress events, matches, and drops.
L3 Egress The number of Layer 3 egress events, matches, and drops
IGMP join The number of multicast events, matches, and drops.
Fragments The number of fragments dropped.
Bad Fragments The number of fragments received with an offset of 1.
Unknown Fragments The number of out-of-order fragments received.
Sent NI messages The number of messages sent to network interfaces.
Received NI messages The number of messages received by network interfaces.
Failed NI messages The number of failed message attempts to network interfaces.
Load balanced flows The number of Server Load Balance flow entries.
Reflexive flows The number of reflexive flows.
Reflexive correction The number of reflexive flow corrections.
Flow lookups The number of flow table lookups.
Flow hits The number of flow table lookup hits.
Max PTree nodes The highest number of nodes in the classifier tree.
Max Ptree depth The length of the longest path in the classifier tree.
Spoofed Events The number of spoofed events.
Nonspoofed Events The number of nonspoofed events.
DropServices The number of TCP/UDP flows dropped.
Software Resources The current usage and availability of software resources for the QoS
configuration.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 17-71


QoS Commands

output definitions (continued)


Hardware Resources The current usage and availability of hardware resources for the QoS
configuration.
L2TP The number of L2TP packets.
L2TP Drop The number of L2TP packets dropped.
L2TP Match The number L2TP packets that match policies.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; L2TP parameters added.

Related Commands

qos stats reset Resets QoS statistic counters to zero.

MIB Objects
alaQoSStats
alaQoSStatsL2Events
alaQoSStatsL2matches
alaQoSStatsL2Drops
alaQoSStatsL3IngressEvents
alaQoSStatsL3IngressMatches
alaQoSStatsL3IngressDrops
alaQoSStatsL3EgressEvents
alaQoSStatsL3EgressMatches
alaQoSStatsL3EgressDrops
alaQoSStatsFragments
alaQoSStatsBadFragments
alaQoSStatsUnknownFragments
alaQoSStatsSpoofedEvents
alaQoSStatsNonspoofedEvents
alaQoSStatsDropServicesEvents

page 17-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


18 QoS Policy Commands

This chapter describes CLI commands used for policy management in the switch. The Quality of Service
(QoS) software in the switch uses policy rules for classifying incoming flows and deciding how to treat
outgoing flows. A policy rule is made up of a policy condition and a policy action. Policy rules may be
created on the switch through CLI or SNMP commands, or they may be created through the PolicyView
GUI application on an attached LDAP server.

Note. Rules created through PolicyView cannot be modified through the CLI; however, you can create
policies in the CLI that take precedence over policies created through PolicyView.

Refer to Chapter 17, “QoS Commands,” for information about commands used to configure QoS software.
MIB information for the QoS policy commands is as follows:
Filename: alcatelIND1Qos.mib
Module ALCATEL-IND1-QoS-MIB

Important Note. Some of the commands listed here are not currently supported on one or more plat-
forms. See command descriptions in this chapter and check release notes for information about commands
that are not supported.

The QoS Policy commands are listed here:

Policy commands policy rule


policy validity period
policy condition
policy action
policy list
show policy action
show policy list
show active policy list
show policy condition
show active policy rule
show active policy rule meter-statistics
show policy rule
show policy validity period

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-1


QoS Policy Commands

Group commands policy network group


policy service
policy service protocol
policy service source tcp port
policy service destination tcp port
policy service source udp port
policy service destination udp port
policy service group
policy mac group
policy port group
policy vlan group
policy map group
show policy network group
show policy mac group
show policy port group
show policy vlan group
show policy map group
show policy service
show policy service group
Condition commands policy condition
policy condition source ip
policy condition source ipv6
policy condition destination ipv6
policy condition multicast ip
policy condition source network group
policy condition destination network group
policy condition multicast network group
policy condition source ip port
policy condition destination ip port
policy condition source tcp port
policy condition destination tcp port
policy condition source udp port
policy condition destination udp port
policy condition ethertype
policy condition established
policy condition tcpflags
policy condition service
policy condition service group
policy condition icmptype
policy condition icmpcode
policy condition ip protocol
policy condition ipv6
policy condition 802.1p
policy condition tos
policy condition dscp
policy condition source mac
policy condition destination mac
policy condition source mac group
policy condition destination mac group
policy condition source vlan
policy condition source vlan group
policy condition source port
policy condition destination port
policy condition source port group
policy condition destination port group
Command for testing show policy classify
conditions

page 18-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Action commands policy action


policy action disposition
policy action shared
policy action priority
policy action maximum bandwidth
policy action maximum depth
policy action cir
policy action tos
policy action 802.1p
policy action dscp
policy action map
policy action permanent gateway ip
policy action port-disable
policy action redirect port
policy action redirect linkagg
policy action no-cache
policy action mirror
policy action cir

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-3


QoS Policy Commands

Types of policies are generally determined by the kind of traffic they classify (policy conditions) and how
the policy is enforced (policy actions). Commands used for particular types of policies are listed here. See
the OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide for more information about creating these types of policies
and information about valid condition/action combinations.

Access Control Lists policy condition


policy list
policy rule
Traffic prioritization/shaping policy action shared
policy action priority
policy action maximum bandwidth
policy action maximum depth
policy action cir
policy rule
802.1p/ToS/DSCP tagging or policy condition tos
mapping policy condition dscp
policy condition 802.1p
policy action cir
policy action 802.1p
policy action dscp
policy rule
Network Address Translation policy condition source ip
(NAT) policy condition source ipv6
policy rule
Policy based port mirroring policy action mirror

page 18-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy rule
Configures a policy rule on the switch. A rule is made up of a condition (for classifying incoming traffic)
and an action (to be applied to outgoing traffic).
policy rule rule_name [enable | disable] [precedence precedence] [condition condition] [action action]
[validity period name | no validity period] [save] [log [interval seconds]] [count {packets | bytes}]
[trap | no trap]
no policy rule rule_name
policy rule rule_name [no reflexive] [no save] [no log]

Syntax Definitions
rule_name The name of the policy rule, any alphanumeric string.
enable Enables the policy rule.
disable Disables the policy rule.
precedence The precedence value in the range 0–65535. This value determines the
order in which rules are searched for a matching condition. A higher
number indicates higher precedence. Typically the range 30000–65535
is reserved for PolicyView.
condition The condition name that is associated with this rule. Conditions are
configured through the policy condition command.
action The name of the action that is associated with this rule. Actions are
configured through the policy action command.
name The name of a user-defined validity period that is associated with this
rule. Validity periods are configured through the policy validity period
command.
save Marks the policy rule so that it may be captured as part of the switch
configuration.
log Configures the switch to log messages about specific flows coming into
the switch that match this policy rule.
seconds Configures how often to look for packets that match this policy rule
when rule logging is applied (in the range from 0–3600 seconds). A
value of 0 specifies to log as often as possible.
packets Counts the number of packets that match the rule.
bytes Counts the number of bytes that match the rule.
trap Enables or disables traps for the rule.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-5


QoS Policy Commands

Defaults
By default, rules are not reflexive, but they are saved to the configuration.

parameter default
enable | disable enable
precedence 0
log no
log interval 30 seconds
packets | bytes packets
trap enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Any rule configured through this command is not active on the switch until the qos apply command is
issued.
• A policy rule configured through the PolicyView application may not be edited in the CLI. You may,
however, create a rule using the CLI with a higher precedence that will override a rule created through
PolicyView.
• Use the no form of the command to remove the rule from the configuration. The change will not take
effect, however, until the qos apply command is issued.
• When a flow comes into the switch, the switch examines Layer 2 source policies first; if no match is
found, it examines Layer 2 destination policies; if no match is found it then examines Layer 3 policies.
The precedence value only applies within the group of the same type of rules.
• If multiple rules (of the same type; that is, Layer 2 source, Layer 2 destination, or Layer 3) are config-
ured with the same precedence, the switch evaluates the rules in the order they were created.
• Only one validity period is associated with a policy rule. Each time this command is entered with a
validity period name specified, the existing period name is overwritten with the new one.
• Software and hardware resources are allocated for rules associated with a validity period even if the
validity period is not active. Pre-allocating the resources makes sure the rule can be enforced when the
validity period becomes active.
• The save option marks the policy rule so that the rule will be captured in an ASCII text file (using the
configuration snapshot command), saved to the working directory after the write memory command
or copy running-config working command is entered, or saved after a reboot. Rules are saved by
default. If no save is entered for the rule, the policy rule will not be written to the configuration. The
save option should be disabled only if you want to use a policy rule temporarily.

page 18-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

• If the configuration snapshot command is entered after the policy rule command is configured, the
resulting ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy rule command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the rule was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in rule, this setting is not configurable.
• The log option is useful for determining the source of attacks on the switch firewall.

• If traps are enabled for the rule, a trap is only sent when a port disable action or UserPort shutdown
operation is triggered.

Examples
-> policy rule rule2 precedence 65535
-> policy rule rule2 validity period vp01
-> no policy rule rule2
-> policy rule rule2 no precedence
-> policy rule no validity period

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy validity period Configures a validity period that specifies days, times, and/or months
during which an associated policy rule is in effect.
policy condition Configures condition parameters.
policy action Configures action parameters.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy rule Displays information for policy rules configured on the switch.
show active policy rule Displays only those policy rules that are currently being enforced on the
switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-7


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleTable
alaQoSRuleName
alaQoSRuleEnabled
alaQoSRuleSource
alaQoSRulePrecedence
alaQoSRuleCondition
alaQoSRuleAction
alaQoSRuleReflexive
alaQoSRuleSave
alaQoSRuleLog
alaQoSRuleLogInterval
alaQoSRuleCountType
alaQoSRulePacketCount
alaQoSRuleByteCount
alaQoSRuleExcessPacketCount
alaQoSRuleExcessByteCount
alaQoSAppliedRuleTable
alaQoSAppliedRuleName
alaQoSAppliedRuleEnabled
alaQoSAppliedRuleSource
alaQoSAppliedRulePrecedence
alaQoSAppliedRuleCondition
alaQoSAppliedRuleAction
alaQoSAppliedRuleReflexive
alaQoSAppliedRuleSave
alaQoSAppliedRuleLog
alaQoSAppliedRuleLogInterval
alaQoSAppliedCountType
alaQoSAppliedPacketCount
alaQoSAppliedByteCount
alaQoSAppliedExcessPacketCount
alaQoSAppliedExcessByteCount

page 18-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy validity period


Configures a validity period that specifies the days and times in which a policy rule is in effect.
policy validity period name [[no] days days] [[no] months months] [[no] hours hh:mm to hh:mm | no
hours] [interval mm:dd:yyyy hh:mm to mm:dd:yyyy hh:mm | no interval]
no policy validity period name

Syntax Definitions
name The name of the validity period (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
days The day(s) of the week this validity period is active. Enter the actual day
of the week (e.g., monday, tuesday, wednesday, etc.).
months The month(s) in which the validity period is active. Enter the actual
month (e.g., january, february, march, etc.).
hh:mm The time of day, specified in hours and minutes, the validity period
starts and the time of day the validity period ends (e.g., 10:30 to 11:30).
mm:dd:yyyy hh:mm An interval of time in which a rule is in effect. Specify a start and end to
the interval period by entering a beginning date and time followed by an
end date and time (e.g., 11:01:2005 12:01 to 11:02:2005 12:01).

Defaults
By default, no validity period is in effect for a policy rule.

parameter default
days no restriction
months no restriction
hh:mm no specific
time
mm:dd:yyyy hh:mm no interval

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a validity period from the configuration, or to remove
parameters from a particular validity period. Note that at least one parameter must be associated with a
validity period.
• Any combination of days, months, hours, and interval parameters is allowed. The validity period is
only in effect when all specified parameters are true.
• Use the policy rule command to associate a validity period with a rule.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-9


QoS Policy Commands

• Software and hardware resources are allocated for rules associated with a validity period even if the
validity period is not active. Pre-allocating the resources makes sure the rule can be enforced when the
validity period becomes active.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy validity period command is configured, the
resulting ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy validity period
command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indicates
a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy validity period vp01 days tuesday thursday months january february
-> policy validity period vp01 hours 13:00 to 19:00
-> policy validity period vp02 interval 01/01/05 12:01 to 02/01/05 11:59
-> policy validity period vp01 no days thursday
-> no policy validity period vp02

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch and optionally associates that rule
with a validity period.
show policy validity period Displays information about policy validity periods.

page 18-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSValidityPeriodTable
alaQoSValidityPeriodName
alaQoSValidityPeriodSource
alaQoSValidityPeriodDays
alaQoSValidityPeriodDaysStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodMonths
alaQoSValidityPeriodMonthsStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodHour
alaQoSValidityPeriodHourStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodEndHour
alaQoSValidityPeriodInterval
alaQoSValidityPeriodIntervalStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodEndInterval
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodTable
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodName
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodSource
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodDays
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodDaysStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodMonths
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodMonthsStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodHour
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodHourStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodEndHour
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodInterval
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodIntervalStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodEndInterval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-11


QoS Policy Commands

policy network group


Configures a network group name and its associated IP addresses. The group may be used as part of a
policy condition. The action associated with any policy using the condition will be applied to all members
of the network group.
policy network group net_group ip_address [mask net_mask] [ip_address2 [mask net_mask2]...]
no policy network group net_group
policy network group net_group no ip_address [mask netmask] [ip_address2 [mask net_mask2]...]

Syntax Definitions
net_group The name of the network group (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
ip_address An IPv4 address included in the network group. IPv6 addresses are not
supported with network groups.
net_mask The mask for the IPv4 address. If no mask is entered, the IPv4 address is
assumed to be a host address.
ip_address2 Optional. Another IPv4 address to be included in the network group.
Multiple IP addresses may be configured for a network group. Separate
each address/mask combination with a space.
net_mask2 Optional mask for the IPv4 address. If no mask is entered, the natural
mask for the address will be used.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to configure a group of IPv4 addresses to which you want to apply QoS rules.
Rather than create a condition for each IPv4 address, group the addresses together. Use the policy
condition command to associate a condition with the network group.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a network group from the configuration, or to remove an
IP address from a network group.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy network group command is configured, the
resulting ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy network group
command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the network group was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by
a user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option
indicates a built-in network group, this setting is not configurable.

page 18-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Examples
-> policy network group webgroup1 10.10.12.5 10.50.3.1
-> policy network group webgroup1 no 10.10.12.5
-> no policy network group webgroup1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Configures a policy condition. A network group may be configured as


part of a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy network group Displays information for policy network groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSNetworkGroupsTable
alaQoSNetworkGroupsName
alaQoSNetworkGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedNetworkGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedNetworkGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedNetworkGroupsSource
alaQoSNetworkGroupTable
alaQoSNetworkGroupIpAddr
alaQoSNetworkGroupsIpMask
alaQoSAppliedNetworkGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedNetworkGroupIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedNetworkGroupsIpMask

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-13


QoS Policy Commands

policy service group


Configures a service group and its associated services. The group may be used as part of a policy condi-
tion. The action associated with any policy using the condition will be applied to all members of the
service group.
policy service group service_group service_name1 [service_name2...]
no policy service group service_group
policy service group service_group no service_name1 [service_name2...]

Syntax Definitions
service_group The name of the service group (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
service_name1 The service name is configured through the policy service command
and includes information about protocol, source port, and destination
port.
service_name2... Optional. Additional service names may be configured for a service
group. Separate each service name with a space.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to configure a group of services to which you want to apply QoS rules. Rather than
create a condition for each service, group services together. Use the policy condition command to
associate a condition with the service group.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a service group from the configuration, or to remove a
service from a service group.
• To drop packets destined to specific TCP and UDP ports, create port services for the traffic that you
want dropped and add these services to a service group called DropServices. Then create a condition
for this service group and a source port group, which can then be used in a deny rule. Refer to the
OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide for more information about ACL security enhancements.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service group command is configured, the result-
ing ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service group command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service group was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a
user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in service group, this setting is not configurable.

page 18-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Examples
-> policy service group servgroup2 telnet ftp
-> policy service group servgroup2 no telnet
-> no policy service group servgroup2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy service Configures a service that may be used as part of a policy service group.
policy condition Configures a policy condition. A network group may be configured as
part of a policy condition.
show policy service group Displays information for policy service groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceGroupsTable
alaQoSServiceGroupsName
alaQoSServiceGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupsSource
alaQoSServiceGroupTable
alaQoSServiceGroupServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupServiceName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-15


QoS Policy Commands

policy mac group


Configures a MAC group and its associated MAC addresses. The group may be used as part of a policy
condition. The action associated with any policy using the condition will be applied to all members of the
MAC group.
policy mac group mac_group mac_address [mask mac_mask] [mac_address2 [mask mac_mask2]...]
no policy mac group mac_group
policy mac group mac_group no mac_address [mask mac_mask] [mac_address2 [mask mac_mask2]...]

Syntax Definitions
mac_group The name of the MAC group (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
mac_address The MAC address associated with the group (for example,
00:20:da:05:f6:23).
mac_mask The mask of the MAC address, used to identify which bytes in the MAC
address are significant when comparing the MAC address in the
received frame with the MAC address in the policy condition. If no
mask is specified, the switch automatically uses ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff.
mac_address2 Optional. Additional MAC addresses may be configured for a MAC
group. Separate each address with a space.
mac_mask2 The mask of an additional MAC address, used to identify which bytes in
the MAC address are significant when comparing the MAC address in
the received frame with the MAC address in the policy condition. If no
mask is specified, the switch automatically uses ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to configure a group of source or destination MAC addresses to which you want to
apply QoS rules. Rather than create a condition for each MAC address, group MAC addresses together.
Use the policy condition command to associate a condition with the MAC group.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a MAC group from the configuration, or to remove a MAC
address from a MAC group.
• The MAC group name “alaPhones” is a reserved group name used to identify the MAC addresses of IP
phones. See the qos phones command for more information.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy map group command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy map group command:

page 18-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

from {cli | ldap | blt}


This syntax indicates how the map group was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a
user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option
indicates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy mac group mac_group1 00:20:da:05:f6:23 00:20:da:05:f6:24
-> no policy mac group mac_group1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Configures a policy condition. A MAC group may be configured as part
of a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy mac group Displays information about policy MAC groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSMACGroupsTable
alaQoSMACGroupsName
alaQoSMACGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupsSource
alaQoSMACGroupTable
alaQoSMACGroupMacAddr
alaQoSMACGroupMacMask
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupMacAddr
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupMacMask

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-17


QoS Policy Commands

policy port group


Configures a port group and its associated slot and port numbers. A port group may be attached to a policy
condition. The action associated with that policy will be applied to all members of the port group.
policy port group group_name slot/port[-port] [slot/port[-port]...]
no policy port group group_name
policy port group group_name no slot/port[-port] [slot/port[-port]...]

Syntax Definitions
group_name The name of the port group (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
slot/port[-port] The slot and port (or port range) to be included in the group. At least
one slot/port combination must be specified. Additional combinations
may be included in the group; each combination should be separated by
a space.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to configure a group of ports to which you want to apply QoS rules. Rather than
create a condition for each port, group ports together. Use the policy condition command to associate a
condition with the port group.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a port group from the configuration, or to remove a slot/
port from a port group.
• If a range of ports is specified using the syntax slot/port-port (i.e., 2/1-8), a single port within that
range cannot be removed on its own. The entire range must be deleted as it was entered.
• When a port group is used as part of a policy rule and a policy action specifies a maximum bandwidth,
each interface in the port group will be allowed the maximum bandwidth.
• To prevent IP source address spoofing, add ports to the port group called UserPorts. This port group
does not need to be used in a condition or rule to be effected on flows and only applies to routed traf-
fic. Ports added to the UserPorts group will block spoofed traffic while still allowing normal traffic on
the port. Refer to the OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide for more information about ACL secu-
rity enhancements.
• Use the qos user-port command to configure the option to filter or administratively disable a port
when a specific type of traffic (Spoof, RIP and/or, BPDU) is received on a port that is a member of the
pre-defined UserPorts group.

page 18-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy port group command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy port group command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the port group was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a
user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option
indicates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy port group port_group4 3/1-2 4/3 5/4
-> policy port group port_group4 no 3/1-2
-> policy port group UserPorts 4/1-8 5/1-8

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Configures a policy condition. A port group may be configured as part
of a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action maximum Configures a maximum bandwidth value for a policy action.
bandwidth
show policy port group Displays information about policy port groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortGroupsTable
alaQoSPortGroupsName
alaQoSPortGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupsSource
alaPortGroupTable
alaQoSPortGroupSlot
alaQoSPortGroupPort
alaQoSPortGroupPortEnd
alaAppliedPortGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupSlot
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupPort
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupPortEnd

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-19


QoS Policy Commands

policy vlan group


Configures a VLAN group and its associated VLAN ID numbers. A VLAN group may be attached to a
policy condition. The action associated with that policy will be applied to all members of the VLAN
group.
policy vlan group group_name vlan_id[-vlan_id] [vlan_id[-vlan_id]...]
no policy vlan group group_name
policy vlan group group_name no vlan_id[-vlan_id] [vlan_id[-vlan_id]...]

Syntax Definitions
group_name The name of the VLAN group (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
vlan_id[-vlan_id] The VLAN ID to include in the group. At least one VLAN ID combina-
tion is required. To specify a contiguous range of VLAN IDs, use a
hyphen. To specify multiple ID entries, use a space (for example, 10-15
50 100 250-252).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to configure a group of VLAN IDs to which you want to apply QoS rules. Rather
than create a condition for each VLAN, group VLANs together. Use the policy condition command to
associate a condition with the VLAN group.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a VLAN group from the configuration, or to remove a
VLAN from a VLAN group.
• If a range of VLANs is specified using the syntax vlan_id-vlan_id (i.e., 1-8), a single VLAN within
that range cannot be removed on its own. The entire range must be deleted as it was entered.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy vlan group command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy port group command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the VLAN group was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a
user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy vlan group vlan_group1 100-200 205 240-245 1000
-> policy vlan group vlan_group2 1000-2000
-> policy vlan group vlan_group3 3000

page 18-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

-> policy vlan group vlan_group3 3000 3100-3105


-> no policy vlan group vlan_group2
-> policy vlan group vlan_group1 no 100-200

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition source vlan Configures a source VLAN policy condition. A VLAN group may be
configured as part of this type of policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy vlan group Displays information about policy VLAN groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSVlanGroupsTable
alaQoSVlanGroupsName
alaQoSVlanGroupsSource
alaQoSVlanGroupsStatus
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsStatus
alaQoSVlanGroupTable
alaQoSVlanGroupVlan
alaQoSVlanGroupVlanEnd
alaQoSVlanGroupStatus
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupVlan
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupVlanEnd
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-21


QoS Policy Commands

policy map group


Configures a map group and its associated mappings for 802.1p, Type of Service (ToS), or Differentiated
Services Code Point (DSCP) values. A map group may be referenced in a policy action with the map
keyword.
policy map group map_group {value1:value2...}
no policy map group map_group
policy map group no {value1:value2...}

Syntax Definitions
map_group The name of the map group (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
value1 The 802.1p, ToS, or DSCP value to be mapped to another value. May be
a value or a range of values (for example, 1-2).
value2... The 802.1p, ToS, or DSCP value to be used in place of value1. Addi-
tional mapping pairs may be included.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a mapping pair or to remove the map group entirely.

• The map group may contain more than one mapping pair.

• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy map group command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy map group command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the map group was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a
user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy map group tosGroup 1-4:3 5-6:5 7:6
-> policy map group tosGroup no 7:6
-> no policy map group tosGroup

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy action map Configures a mapping group for a policy action.

MIB Objects
alaQoSMapGroupsTable
alaQoSMapGroupsName
alaQoSMapGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupsSource
alaQoSMapGroupTable
alaQoSMapGroupKey
alaQoSMapGroupKeyEnd
alaQoSMapGroupValue
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupKey
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupKeyEnd
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupValue

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-23


QoS Policy Commands

policy service
Configures a service that may be used as part of a policy service group or included as part of a policy
condition. A service is a source and/or destination TCP or UDP port or port range.
This overview section describes the base command. At least one option must be configured with the base
command. Some options may be used in combination; some options are shortcuts for keyword combina-
tions (see the Usage Guidelines). Options are described as separate commands. See the command descrip-
tions and usage guidelines for valid combinations.
Use the no form for keywords to remove a parameter from a service.
policy service service_name
[protocol protocol]
[source ip port port[-port]]
[destination ip port port[-port]]
[source tcp port port[-port]]
[destination tcp port port[-port]]
[source udp port port[-port]]
[destination udp port port[-port]]
no policy service service_name

Syntax Definitions
service_name The name of the service (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
protocol The protocol associated with the service. The range of values is 0–255.
Currently a value of 6 (for TCP) or 17 (for UDP) is supported. This
value must be specified for source ip port or destination ip port; it
cannot be specified for source tcp port, destination tcp port, source
udp port, or destination udp port.
port The well-known port number (or port range) for the desired service. For
example, the port number for Telnet is 23. Specify a range of ports using
a hyphen (for example, 22-23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a service from the configuration, or to remove parameters
from a particular service. Note that at least one parameter must be associated with a service.

page 18-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

• The command options offer alternate ways of configuring TCP or UDP ports for a service. Note that
port types (TCP or UDP) cannot be mixed in the same service. The following table shows how the
keywords are used:

To configure: Use keywords: Notes


TCP or UDP ports for a service protocol The protocol must be specified with
source ip port at least one source or destination
destination ip port port.
TCP ports for a service source tcp port Keywords may be used in
destination tcp port combination.
UDP ports for a service source udp port Keywords may be used in
destination udp port combination.

• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
The following two commands show two different ways of configuring the same service:
-> policy service telnet2 protocol 6 destination ip port 23
-> policy service telnet3 destination tcp port 23

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a policy service group, which is made up of policy services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy service Displays information about policy services configured on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-25


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceIpProtocol
alaQoSServiceSourceIpPort
alaQoSServiceSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSServiceDestinationIpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationIpPortEnd
alaQoSServiceSourceTcpPort
alaQoSServiceSourceTcpPortEnd
alaQoSServiceDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSServiceSourceUdpPort
alaQoSServiceSourceUdpPortEnd
alaQoSServiceDestinationUdpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceIpProtocol
alaQoSAppliedSourceIpPort
alaQoSAppliedSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationIpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedSourceTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedSourceTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedSourceUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedSourceUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationUdpPortEnd

page 18-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy service protocol


Configures a service with a protocol and IP port or port range that may be used as part of a policy service
group or included as part of a policy condition.
policy service service_name protocol protocol {[source ip port port[-port]]
[destination ip port port[-port]]}
no policy service service_name
policy service service_name [no source ip port] [no destination ip port]

Syntax Definitions
service_name The name of the service (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
protocol The protocol associated with the service. The range of values is 0–255.
Currently a value of 6 (for TCP) or 17 (for UDP) is supported.
port The well-known port number (or port range) for the desired service. For
example, the port number for Telnet is 23. A port range should be sepa-
rated by a hyphen (for example, 22-23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a service from the configuration, or to remove parameters
from a particular service. (A protocol value cannot be removed from a service.)
• Shortcut commands for the policy service protocol command include the following: policy service
source tcp port, policy service destination tcp port, policy service source udp port, and policy
service destination udp port.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy service telnet2 protocol 6 destination ip port 23 source ip port 22
-> policy service telnet2 no source ip port

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-27


QoS Policy Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a policy service group, which is made up of policy services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy service Displays information about policy services configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceIpProtocol
alaQoSServiceSourceIpPort
alaQoSServiceSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSServiceDestinationIpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceIpProtocol
alaQoSAppliedSourceIpPort
alaQoSAppliedSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationIpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationIpPortEnd

page 18-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy service source tcp port


Configures a service with a source TCP port or port range that may be used as part of a policy service
group or included as part of a policy condition.
policy service service_name source tcp port port[-port]
no policy service service_name
policy service service_name no source tcp port

Syntax Definitions
service_name The name of the service (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
port The well-known port number (or port range) for the desired TCP
service. For example, the port number for Telnet is 23. A port range
should be separated by a hyphen (for example, 22-23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is a shortcut for the policy service protocol command.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a service from the configuration, or to remove parameters
from a particular service. Note that at least one parameter must be associated with a service.
• Ports associated with a particular service must all be of the same type. (The destination tcp port
keyword may be used with this command; other keywords for the command are not allowed.)
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy service serv_5 source tcp port 21-22

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-29


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a policy service group, which is made up of policy services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy service Displays information about policy services configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceSourceTcpPort
alaQoSServiceSourceTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedSourceTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedSourceTcpPortEnd

page 18-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy service destination tcp port


Configures a service with a destination TCP port or port range that may be used as part of a policy service
group or included as part of a policy condition.
policy service service_name destination tcp port port[-port]
no policy service service_name
policy service service_name no destination tcp port

Syntax Definitions
service_name The name of the service (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
port The well-known port number (or port range) for the desired TCP
service. For example, the port number for Telnet is 23. A port range
should be separated by a hyphen (for example, 22-23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a service from the configuration, or to remove parameters
from a particular service.
• This command is a shortcut for the policy service protocol command.

• A policy service may be grouped in a policy group using the policy service group command. A policy
condition may then be associated with the service group.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy service service4 destination tcp port 23

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-31


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a policy service group, which is made up of policy services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy service Displays information about policy services configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationTcpPortEnd

page 18-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy service source udp port


Configures a service with a source UDP port or port range that may be used as part of a policy service
group or included as part of a policy condition.
policy service service_name source udp port port[-port]
no policy service service_name
policy service service_name no source udp port

Syntax Definitions
service_name The name of the service (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
port The well-known port number (or port range) for the desired UDP
service. A port range should be separated by a hyphen (for example, 22-
23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is a shortcut for the policy service protocol command.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a service from the configuration, or to remove parameters
from a particular service. Note that at least one parameter must be associated with a service.
• Ports associated with a particular service must all be of the same type. (The destination tcp port
keyword may be used with this command; other keywords for the command are not allowed.)
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy service serv_a source udp port 1000
-> no policy service serv_a

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-33


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a policy service group, which is made up of policy services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy service Displays information about policy services configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceSourceUdpPort
alaQoSServiceSourceUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedSourceUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedSourceUdpPortEnd

page 18-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy service destination udp port


Configures a service with a destination UDP port or port range that may be used as part of a policy service
group or included as part of a policy condition.
policy service service_name destination udp port port[-port]
no policy service service_name
policy service service_name no destination udp port

Syntax Definitions
service_name The name of the service (up to 31 alphanumeric characters).
port The well-known port number (or port range) for the desired UDP
service. For example, a port number for NETBIOS is 137. A port range
should be separated by a hyphen (for example, 137-138).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is a shortcut for the policy service protocol command.

• A policy service may be grouped in a policy group using the policy service group command. A policy
condition may then be associated with the service group.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a service from the configuration, or to remove parameters
from a particular service.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy service command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy service command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the service was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy service service4 destination udp port 137

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-35


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a policy service group, which is made up of policy services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy service Displays information about policy services configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceDestinationUdpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationUdpPortEnd

page 18-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition
Creates a QoS policy condition. The condition determines what parameters the switch uses to classify
incoming flows. Condition parameters may be configured when the condition is created; or parameters
may be configured for an existing condition. At least one parameter must be configured for a condition.
This section describes the base command. Optional keywords are listed below and described as separate
commands later in this chapter. (Options may be used in combination but are described separately for ease
in explanation.) Use the no form for keywords to remove a parameter from the condition.
Some condition parameters may not be supported depending on the platform you are using. Also some
condition parameters may not be supported with some action parameters. See the condition/action tables
in the OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide.
policy condition condition_name
[source ip ip_address [mask netmask]]
[source ipv6 {any | ipv6_address [mask netmask]}
[destination ip ip_address [mask netmask]]
[destination ipv6 {any | ipv6_address [mask netmask]}
[multicast ip ip_address [mask netmask]]
[source network group network_group]
[destination network group network_group]
[multicast network group multicast_group]
[source ip port port[-port]]
[destination ip port port[-port]]
[source tcp port port[-port]]
[destination tcp port port[-port]]
[source udp port port[-port]]
[destination udp port port[-port]]
[ethertype etype]
[established]
[tcpflags {any | all} flag [mask flag]
[service service]
[service group service_group]
[icmptype type]
[icmpcode code]
[ip protocol protocol]
[ipv6]
[tos tos_value tos_mask]
[dscp {dscp_value[-value} [dscp_mask]]
[source mac mac_address [mask mac_mask]]
[destination mac mac_address [mask mac_mask]]
[source mac group group_name]
[destination mac group mac_group]
[source vlan vlan_id]
[source vlan group group_name]
[destination vlan vlan_id]
[802.1p 802.1p_value]
[source port slot/port[-port]]

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-37


QoS Policy Commands

[source port group group_name}


[destination port slot/port[-port]]
[destination port group group_name]

no policy condition condition_name

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. Any alphanumeric string.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A policy condition and a policy action are combined to make a policy rule. See the policy rule
command page for more information.
• Use the qos apply command to activate configuration changes.

• If multiple keywords are defined for a single condition, the traffic flow must match all of the parame-
ters in the condition before the rule is enforced.
• Use the no form of the command to remove a condition from a policy rule.

• At least one parameter must be associated with a condition.

• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy condition command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy condition command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the condition was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a
user modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in condition, this option is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 source port 3/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Configures a policy action.
policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch. A rule is made up of a condition
(for classifying incoming traffic) and an action (to be applied to outgo-
ing traffic).
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSource
alaQoSConditionSourceSlot
alaQoSConditionSourcePort
alaQoSConditionSourcePortEnd
alaQoSConditionSourcePortGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationSlot
alaQoSConditionDestinationPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationPortEnd
alaQoSConditionDestinationPortGroup
alaQoSConditionSourceInterfaceType
alaQoSConditionDestinationInterfaceType
alaQoSConditionSourceMacAddr
alaQoSConditionSourceMacMask
alaQoSConditionSourceMacGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacAddr
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacMask
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacGroup
alaQoSConditionSourceVlan
alaQoSConditionSourceVlanGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationVlan
alaQoSCondition8021p
alaQoSConditionSourceIpAddr
alaQoSConditionSourceIpMask
alaQoSConditionSourceNetworkGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpAddr
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpMask
alaQoSConditionDestinationNetworkGroup
alaQoSConditionMulticastIpAddr
alaQoSConditionMulticastIpMask
alaQoSConditionMulticastNetworkGroup
alaQoSConditionTos
alaQoSConditionDscp
alaQoSConditionTcpFlags
alaQoSConditionIpProtocol
alaQoSConditionSourceIpPort
alaQoSConditionSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpPortEnd
alaQoSConditionSourceTcpPort
alaQoSConditionSourceTcpPortEnd
alaQoSConditionDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSConditionSourceUdpPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-39


QoS Policy Commands

alaQoSConditionSourceUdpPortEnd
alaQoSConditionDestinationUdpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationUdpPortEnd
alaQoSConditionService
alaQoSConditionServiceStatus
alaQoSConditionServiceGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSource
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceSlot
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourcePort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourcePortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourcePortGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationSlot
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationPortGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceInterfaceType
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationInterfaceType
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceMacAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceMacMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceMacGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationMacAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationMacMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationMacGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceVlan
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceVlanGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationVlan
alaQoSAppliedCondition8021p
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceNetworkGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationNetworkGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionMulticastIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionMulticastIpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionMulticastNetworkGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTos
alaQoSAppliedConditionDscp
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlags
alaQoSAppliedConditionIpProtocol
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionService
alaQoSAppliedConditionServiceStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionServiceGroup

page 18-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source ip


Configures a source IP address for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source ip ip_address [mask netmask]
policy condition condition_name no source ip

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
ip_address The source IP address of the Layer 3 flow.
netmask The mask for the source IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a mask is not specified, the IP address is assumed to be a host address.

• A source IP address and a source IP network group cannot be specified in the same condition.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a source IP address from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 source ip 173.201.18.3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about a particular policy condition configured on the
switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-41


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceIpAddr
alaQoSConditionSourceIpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpMask

page 18-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source ipv6


Configures a source IPv6 address for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source ipv6 {any | ipv6_address [mask netmask]}
policy condition condition_name no source ipv6

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
any Any source IPv6 address.
ipv6_address A specific source IPv6 address.
netmask The mask for the source IPv6 address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source IPv6 address from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• If a mask is not specified, the IPv6 address is assumed to be a host address.

• This policy condition is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 source ipv6 ::1234:531F:BCD2:F34A

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about a particular policy condition configured on the
switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-43


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceIpv6Addr
alaQoSConditionSourceIpv6AddrStatus
alaQoSConditionSourceIpv6Mask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpv6Addr
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpv6AddrStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpMask

page 18-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination ip


Configures a destination IP address for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination ip ip_address [mask netmask]
policy condition condition_name no destination ip

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
ip_address The destination IP address of the Layer 3 flow.
netmask The mask for the destination IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a mask is not specified, the IP address is assumed to be a host address.

• A destination IP address and a destination IP network group cannot be specified in the same condition.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination IP address from a condition; however, at
least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 destination ip 208.192.21.0 mask 255.255.255.0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about a particular policy condition configured on the
switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-45


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpAddr
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpMask

page 18-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination ipv6


Configures a destination IPv6 address for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination ipv6 {any | ipv6_address [mask netmask]}
policy condition condition_name no destination ipv6

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
any Any destination IPv6 address.
ipv6_address A specific destination IPv6 address.
netmask The mask for the source IPv6 address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a destination IPv6 address from a condition; however, at
least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• If a mask is not specified, the IPv6 address is assumed to be a host address.

• This policy condition is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 destination ipv6 ::1234:531F:BCD2:F34A

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about a particular policy condition configured on the
switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-47


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpv6Addr
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpv6AddrStatus
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpv6Mask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpv6Addr
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpv6AddrStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpMask

page 18-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition multicast ip


Configures a multicast IP address for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name multicast ip ip_address [mask netmask]
policy condition condition_name no multicast ip

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
ip_address The multicast IP address.
netmask Optional. The mask for the multicast IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a mask is not specified, the IP address is assumed to be a host address.

• A multicast IP address and a multicast network group cannot be specified in the same condition.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a multicast IP address from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 multicast ip 224.1.1.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-49


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSMulticastIpAddr
alaQoSMulticastIpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedMulticastIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedMulticastIpMask

page 18-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source network group


Associates a source network group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source network group network_group
policy condition condition_name no source network group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
network_group The name of the source network group. Network groups are configured
through the policy network group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source network group from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A source IP address and a source IP network group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond5 source network group webgroup1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
policy network group Configures a network group name and its associated IP addresses.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.
show policy network group Displays information about policy network groups.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-51


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceNetworkGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceNetworkGroup

page 18-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination network group


Associates a destination network group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination network group network_group
policy condition condition_name no destination network group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
network_group The name of the destination network group. Network groups are config-
ured through the policy network group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination network group from a condition; however, at
least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A destination IP address and a destination IP network group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond6 destination network group webgroup1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


policy network group Configures a network group name and its associated IP addresses.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.
show policy network group Displays information about policy network groups.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-53


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationNetworkGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationNetworkGroup

page 18-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition multicast network group


Associates a multicast group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name multicast network group multicast_group
policy condition condition_name no multicast network group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
multicast_group The multicast group name. Multicast groups are configured through the
policy network group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a multicast group from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A multicast address and a multicast network group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 multicast group video2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
policy network group Configures a network group name and its associated IP addresses.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.
show policy network group Displays information about policy network groups.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-55


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionMulticastNetworkGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionMulticastNetworkGroup

page 18-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source ip port


Configures a source IP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source ip port port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no source ip port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
port The TCP or UDP port number of the source address of the Layer 3 flow,
in the range from 0–65535. A range of ports (separated by a hyphen)
may be specified instead of a single port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source IP port from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• The protocol (TCP or UDP) must be specified in the condition, either on the same command line or in
a previous command. Use the ip protocol keywords. See the policy condition ip protocol command.
• The same condition cannot specify a source IP port with a source TCP port, source UDP port, service,
or service group.

Examples
-> policy condition cond1 ip protocol 6 source ip port 137

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition ip protocol Configures an IP protocol for a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-57


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceIpPort
alaQoSConditionSourceIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceIpPortEnd

page 18-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination ip port


Configures a destination IP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination ip port port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no destination ip port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
port The TCP or UDP port number (or port range) of the destination address
of the Layer 3 flow, in the range from 0–65535. A range of ports (sepa-
rated by a hyphen) may be specified instead of a single port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination IP port from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• The protocol (TCP or UDP) must be specified in the same condition, either on the same command line
or in a previous command. Use the ip protocol keywords. See the policy condition ip protocol
command.
• The same condition cannot specify a destination IP port with a service or service group.

Examples
-> policy condition cond2 ip protocol 6 destination ip port 137-138

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition ip protocol Configures an IP protocol for a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-59


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationIpPortEnd

page 18-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source tcp port


Configures a source TCP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source tcp port port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no source tcp port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
port The TCP port number of the source address of the Layer 3 flow, in the
range from 0–65535. A range of ports (separated by a hyphen) may be
specified instead of a single port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source TCP port from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• This command is a shortcut for the policy condition source ip port command, which requires that the
protocol also be specified. Rather than specifying source ip port and ip protocol, use source tcp port.
• The same condition cannot specify a source TCP port with a service or service group.

• IP port protocol types cannot be mixed in the same condition; ports must be either TCP or UDP.

• Use this condition in combination with the IPv6 condition (policy condition ipv6) to configure IPv6
policies for Layer 4 information, services, and service groups.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 source tcp port 137
-> policy condition cond4 ipv6 source tcp port 21
-> policy condition cond3 no source tcp port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-61


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceTcpPort
alaQoSConditionSourceTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceTcpPortEnd

page 18-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination tcp port


Configures a destination TCP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination tcp port port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no destination tcp port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
port The TCP port number (or port range) of the destination address of the
Layer 3 flow, in the range from 0–65535. A range of ports (separated by
a hyphen) may be specified instead of a single port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination TCP port from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• This command is a shortcut for the policy condition destination ip port command, which requires
that the protocol also be specified. Rather than specifying destination ip port and ip protocol, use
destination tcp port.
• The same condition cannot specify a destination TCP port with a service or service group.

• IP port protocol types cannot be mixed in the same condition; ports must be either TCP or UDP.

• Use this condition in combination with the IPv6 condition (policy condition ipv6) to configure IPv6
policies for Layer 4 information, services, and service groups.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 destination tcp port 137-138
-> policy condition cond5 ipv6 destination tcp port 140
-> policy condition cond4 no destination tcp port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-63


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationTcpPortEnd

page 18-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source udp port


Configures a source UDP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source udp port port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no source udp port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
port The UDP port number of the source address of the Layer 3 flow, in the
range from 0–65535. A range of ports (separated by a hyphen) may be
specified instead of a single port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source UDP port from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• This command is a shortcut for the policy condition source ip port command, which requires that the
protocol also be specified. Rather than specifying source ip port and ip protocol, use source udp
port.
• The same condition cannot specify a source UDP port with a service or service group.

• IP port protocol types cannot be mixed in the same condition; ports must be either TCP or UDP.

• Use this condition in combination with the IPv6 condition (policy condition ipv6) to configure IPv6
policies for Layer 4 information, services, and service groups.

Examples
-> policy condition cond5 source udp port 1200-1400
-> policy condition cond6 ipv6 source udp port 1000
-> policy condition cond5 no source udp port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-65


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceUdpPort
alaQoSConditionSourceUdpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceUdpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceUdpPortEnd

page 18-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination udp port


Configures a destination UDP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination udp port port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no destination udp port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
port The UDP port number (or port range) of the destination address of the
Layer 3 flow, in the range from 0–65535. A range of ports (separated by
a hyphen) may be specified instead of a single port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination UDP port from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• This command is a shortcut for the policy condition destination ip port command, which requires
that the protocol also be specified. Rather than specifying destination ip port and ip protocol, use
destination tcp port.
• The same condition cannot specify a destination UDP port with a service or service group.

• IP port protocol types cannot be mixed in the same condition; ports must be either TCP or UDP.

• Use this condition in combination with the IPv6 condition (policy condition ipv6) to configure IPv6
policies for Layer 4 information, services, and service groups.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 destination udp port 137-138
-> policy condition cond5 ipv6 destination udp port 140
-> policy condition cond4 no destination udp port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-67


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationTcpPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationTcpPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationTcpPortEnd

page 18-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition ethertype


Configures an ethertype value to use for traffic classification.
policy condition condition_name ethertype etype
policy condition condition_name no ethertype

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
etype The ethertype value, in the range 1536–65535 or 0x600–0xffff hex.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove an ethertype value from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• Enter a numeric or equivalent hex value for the etype.

Examples
-> policy condition cond12 ethertype 8137

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-69


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionEthertype
alaQoSConditionEthertypeStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionEthertype
alaQoSAppliedConditionEthertypeStatus

page 18-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition established


Configures an established TCP connection as a policy condition. A connection is considered established if
the ack or rst flags in the TCP header of the packet are set.
policy condition condition_name established
policy condition condition_name no established

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove established from a condition; however, at least one classi-
fication parameter must be associated with a condition.
• When an initial TCP connection packet is received only the syn flag is set. As a result, TCP packets are
only examined if they are not the starting packet.
• Typically this condition is used in combination with source ip, destination ip, source port, source
TCP port, or destination TCP port conditions.
• The source mac, destination mac, and ethertype conditions cannot be combined with the estab-
lished condition parameter.
• Note that even though established can be used with most action parameters, it is mainly intended for
ACL use.

Examples
-> policy condition cond2 source ip 192.168.5.10 established
-> policy condition cond3 destination ip 10.255.11.40

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-71


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionTcpEstablished
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpEstablished

page 18-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition tcpflags


Configures a specific TCP flag value or combination of flag values as a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name tcpflags [any | all] {F | S | R | P | A | U | E | W} mask {F | S | R | P | A |
U | E | W}
policy condition condition_name no tcpflags

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
any Match on any of the specified TCP flags.
all Match all specified TCP flags.
F|S|R|P|A|U|E|W TCP flag value to match (F=fin, S=syn, R=rst, P=psh, A=ack, U=urg,
E=ecn, and W=cwr). The E and W flags are currently not supported.

Defaults

parameter default
any | all all

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove tcpflags from a condition; however, at least one classifica-
tion parameter must be associated with a condition.
• Use the any option to indicate that a match on any one of the specified TCP flags qualifies as a match
for the condition. Use the all option to indicate that a match on all specified TCP flags is required to
qualify as a match for the condition.
• Enter one or more TCP flags after the any or all keyword to indicate that the value of the flag bit must
be set to one to qualify as a match.
• Enter one or more TCP flags after the mask keyword to indicate which TCP flags to match.

• If a TCP flag is specified as part of the mask but does not have a corresponding match value specified
with the any or all options, then zero is assumed as the match value. For example, tcpflags all f s
mask f s a looks for the following bit values to determine a match: f=1, s=1, a=0.
• Typically this condition is used in combination with source ip, destination ip, source port, source
TCP port, or destination TCP port conditions.
• The source mac, destination mac, and ethertype conditions cannot be combined with the estab-
lished condition parameter.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-73


QoS Policy Commands

• Note that even though tcpflags can be used with most action parameters, it is mainly intended for ACL
use.

Examples
-> policy condition c1 tcpflags all f s mask f s a
-> policy condition c2 tcpflags any a r mask a r

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionTcpFlags,
alaQoSConditionTcpFlagsStatus,
alaQoSConditionTcpFlagsVal,
alaQoSConditionTcpFlagsValStatus,
alaQoSConditionTcpFlagsMask,
alaQoSConditionTcpFlagsMaskStatus,
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlags,
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlagsStatus,
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlagsVal,
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlagsValStatus,
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlagsMask,
alaQoSAppliedConditionTcpFlagsMaskStatus,

page 18-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition service


Configures a service for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name service service_name
policy condition condition_name no service

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
service_name The service name, configured through the policy service command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a service group from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A policy condition that specifies a service cannot also specify a service group, IP protocol, source IP
port, or destination IP port.

Examples
-> policy condition cond12 service serv2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy service Configures a service that may be used as part of a policy service group.
qos apply Applies configured global QoS and policy settings to the current config-
uration (changes will be active and stored in flash).
show policy service Displays information about all particular policy services or a particular
policy service configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionService
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionService

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-75


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition service group


Associates a policy service group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name service group service_group
policy condition condition_name no service group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
service_group The service group name. Service groups are configured through the
policy service group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a service group from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A policy condition that specifies a service group cannot also specify a service, IP protocol, source IP
port, or destination IP port.

Examples
-> policy condition cond12 service group servgroup2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a service group and its associated services.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionServiceGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionServiceGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-77


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition icmptype


Configures an ICMP type value to use for traffic classification.
policy condition condition_name icmptype type
policy condition condition_name no icmptype

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
type The ICMP type value, in the range 0–255.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of the command to remove an ICMP type value from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond12 icmptype 100

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


policy condition icmpcode Configures an ICMP code value for traffic classification.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionIcmpType
alaQoSConditionIcmpTypeStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionIcmpType
alaQoSAppliedConditionIcmpTypeStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-79


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition icmpcode


Configures an ICMP code value to use for traffic classification.
policy condition condition_name icmpcode code
policy condition condition_name no icmpcode

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
code The ICMP code value, in the range 0–255.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of the command to remove an ICMP code value from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond12 icmpcode 150

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


policy condition icmpcode Configures an ICMP type value for traffic classification.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionIcmpCode
alaQoSConditionIcmpCodeStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionIcmpCode
alaQoSAppliedConditionIcmpCodeStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-81


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition ip protocol


Configures an IP protocol for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name ip protocol protocol
policy condition condition_name no ip protocol

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.
protocol The protocol associated with the flow. The range is 0–255.

Defaults

parameter default
protocol 6

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a protocol from a condition; however, at least one classifi-
cation parameter must be associated with a condition.
• If a source or destination port is specified (through the policy condition source ip port or policy
condition destination ip port commands), the protocol must be specified.
• The same condition cannot specify an IP protocol with a service or service group.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 ip protocol 6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition source ip port Configures a source IP port number for a policy condition.
policy condition destination ip Configures a destination IP port number for a policy condition.
port
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionIpProtocol
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionIpProtocol

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-83


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition ipv6


Configures a policy condition to classify IPv6 traffic.
policy condition condition_name ipv6
policy condition condition_name no ipv6

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove IPv6 traffic as a condition; however, at least one classifica-
tion parameter must be associated with a condition.
• When the ipv6 keyword is used in a condition, a policy that uses the condition is considered an IPv6
policy. IPv6 policies are effected only on IPv6 traffic. All other IP policies are considered IPv4 poli-
cies and are effected only on IPv4 traffic.
• IPv6 Layer 4 policies are supported and are configured using the ipv6 keyword in a condition that
specifies Layer 4 information, services, or service groups. Note that IPv6 Layer 4 policies only work
with packets that contain a single header.
• The icmptype and icmpcode keywords in an IPv6 policy imply the ICMPv6 protocol, not the ICMPv4
protocol.
• This policy condition is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 ipv6
-> policy condition cond5 ipv6 tos 7
-> policy condition cond6 ipv6 source port 1/1
-> policy condition cond7 ipv6 source tcp port 21
-> policy condition cond8 ipv6 source tcp port 0-1024
-> policy condition cond6 no ipv6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionIpv6Traffic
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionIpv6Traffic

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-85


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition tos


Configures the precedence bits in the Type of Service (ToS) byte value for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name tos tos_value [mask tos_mask]
policy condition conditioning no tos

Syntax Definitions
conditioning The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
tos_value The Type of Service bits value included in the IP header. The three most
significant bits of the byte determine the precedence (i.e, priority) of the
frame (0 is the lowest, 7 is the highest).
tos_mask The mask for the ToS bits, in the range 0–7.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a ToS value from a condition; however, at least one classi-
fication parameter must be associated with a condition.
• If a ToS value is specified, a DSCP value may not be specified.

Examples
-> policy condition cond2 tos 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionTos
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionTos

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-87


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition dscp


Configures the Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) for a policy condition. The DSCP value defines
the six most significant bits of the DS byte in the IP header.
policy condition condition_name dscp {dscp_value[-value]} [mask dscp_mask]
policy condition condition_name no dscp

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
{dscp_value[-value]} The DiffServ Code Point value, in the range 0–63. Use a hyphen to
specify a range of DSCP values for the condition (for example, 10-20).
dscp_mask The mask for the DSCP bits, in the range 0–7.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a DSCP value from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• If a DSCP value is specified, a ToS value may not be specified.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 dscp 10
-> policy condition cond5 dscp 20-30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-88 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDscp
alaQoSConditionDscpMask
alaQoSConditionDscpEnd
alaQoSConditionDscpStatus
alaQosAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDscp
alaQoSAppliedConditionDscpMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionDscpEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionDscpStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-89


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source mac


Configures a source MAC address for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source mac mac_address [mask mac_mask]
policy condition condition_name no source mac

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
mac_address The source MAC address in the Layer 2 header of the frame (for exam-
ple, 00:20:da:05:f6:23)
mac_mask Optional. The mask for the source MAC address (for example,
ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source MAC address from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A source MAC address and a source MAC group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond2 source mac 00:20:da:05:f6:23

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-90 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceMacAddr
alaQoSConditionSourceMacMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceMacAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceMacMask

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-91


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination mac


Configures a destination MAC address for a policy condition.

Note. Specifying a destination MAC address and mask of all zeros (00:00:00:00:00:00) as a policy condi-
tion can result in the switch dropping all traffic. Only use this type of condition in combination with other
policies that will allow desired traffic and/or if a source or destination slot/port is also part of the destina-
tion MAC condition.

policy condition condition_name destination mac mac_address [mask mac_mask]


policy condition condition_name no destination mac

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
mac_address The destination MAC address in the Layer 2 header of the frame (for
example, 00:20:da:05:f6:23).
mac_mask Optional. The mask for the destination MAC address (for example,
ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination MAC address from a condition; however, at
least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A destination MAC address and a destination MAC group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 destination mac 00:20:da:05:f6:23

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-92 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSource
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacAddr
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacMask
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSource
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationMacAddr
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationMacMask

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-93


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source mac group


Associates a source MAC group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source mac group group_name
policy condition condition_name no source mac group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
group_name The name of the source MAC group, configured through the policy mac
group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source MAC group from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A source MAC address and a source MAC group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 source mac group mac_group1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy mac group Configures a MAC group and its associated MAC addresses.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-94 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceMacGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceMacGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-95


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination mac group


Associates a destination MAC group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name destination mac group mac_group
policy condition condition_name no destination

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
mac_group The name of the destination MAC group, configured through the policy
mac group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination MAC group from a policy condition;
however, at least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• A destination MAC address and a destination MAC group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond5 destination mac group mac_group1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy mac group Configures a MAC group and its associated MAC addresses.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-96 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationMacGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-97


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source vlan


Configures a source VLAN for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source vlan vlan_id
policy condition condition_name no source vlan

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
vlan_id The source VLAN ID for the flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source VLAN from a policy condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• The source vlan policy condition classifies double-tagged traffic (for example, VLAN Stacking pack-
ets) based on the value of the outer VLAN tag of the packet.
• A source VLAN ID and a source VLAN group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond5 source vlan 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceVlan

page 18-98 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceVlan

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-99


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source vlan group


Associates a source VLAN group with a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name source vlan group vlan_group
policy condition condition_name no source vlan group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
vlan_group The name of an existing VLAN group, configured through the policy
vlan group command. See page 18-20 for more information about this
command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source VLAN group from a policy condition; however,
at least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• The source vlan group condition classifies double-tagged traffic (for example, VLAN Stacking pack-
ets) based on the value of the outer VLAN tag of the packet.
• A source VLAN ID and a source VLAN group cannot be specified in the same condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond1 source vlan group vlan_group1
-> policy condition cond1 no source vlan group

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-100 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy vlan group Configures a VLAN group and its associated VLAN IDs.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceVlanGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceVlanGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-101


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination vlan


Configures a destination VLAN for a policy condition. Note that this condition is supported only in combi-
nation with a multicast condition (multicast ip, multicast ipv6, or multicast network group).
policy condition condition_name destination vlan vlan_id
policy condition condition_name no destination vlan

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
vlan_id The destination VLAN ID for the flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a destination VLAN from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• Note that this condition is supported for multicast only policies.

Examples
-> policy condition cond4 destination vlan 3 multicast ip any

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-102 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationVlan
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationVlan

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-103


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition 802.1p


Configures the 802.1p value for a policy condition.
policy condition condition_name 802.1p 802.1p_value[-802.1p_value]
policy condition condition_name no 802.1p

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. Specify an existing condition name or a new
condition.
802.1p_value[-802.1p_value] The 802.1p value, or a range of 802.1p values, in the 802.1Q VLAN tag
for the flow. Use a hyphen to specify a range of values (e.g., 2-5). Only
one entry is allowed per command line (a single 802.1p value or a range
of values, not both). Valid 802.1p values range from 0 (lowest priority)
to 7 (highest priority).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Rather than creating several policy conditions for contiguous 802.1p values, it is possible to specify a
range of values with this command to apply multiple 802.1p values with one condition.
• Use the no form of the command to remove an 802.1p value or range of values for a condition;
however, at least one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• When a range of values is configured for a single condition, removing a single value from within that
range is not allowed. All 802.1p values are removed from a condition when the no form of this
command is used.
• The 802.1p policy condition classifies double-tagged traffic (for example, VLAN Stacking packets)
based on the 802.1p value of the outer VLAN tag of the packet.

Examples
-> policy condition cond1 802.1p 0-7
-> policy condition cond2 802.1p 5
-> policy condition cond3 802.1p 2-5
-> policy condition cond3 no 802.1p

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; ability to specify a range of 802.1p values was added.

page 18-104 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSCondition8021p
alaQoSCondition8021pEnd
alaQoSCondition8021pStatus
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedCondition8021p
alaQoSAppliedCondition8021pEnd
alaQoSAppliedCondition8021pStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-105


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source port


Configures a source port number for a policy condition. Use the no form of the command to remove a
source port number from a condition.
policy condition condition_name source port slot/port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no source port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
slot/port The slot and port number (or range of ports) on which the frame is
received.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source port from a condition; however, at least one clas-
sification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• This policy condition is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy condition cond2 source port 3/1
-> policy condition cond3 source port 3/2-4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-106 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourceSlot
alaQoSConditionSourcePort
alaQoSConditionSourcePortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourceSlot
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourcePort
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourcePortEnd

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-107


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination port


Configures a destination port number for a policy condition. Note that this condition is supported only in
combination with a multicast condition (multicast ip, multicast ipv6, or multicast network group).
policy condition condition_name destination port slot/port[-port]
policy condition condition_name no destination port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
slot/port The slot and port number (or range of ports) on which the frame is
received.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a destination port from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• The destination port condition is only applied to bridged traffic, it is not applied to routed traffic.

Examples
-> policy condition cond3 destination port 4/2 multicast ip any
-> policy condition cond4 destination port 4/3-4 multicast ipv6 any

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-108 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationSlot
alaQoSConditionDestinationPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationPortEnd
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationSlot
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationPort
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationPortEnd

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-109


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition source port group


Associates a source port group with a policy condition. Use the no form of the command to remove a
source port group from a condition.
policy condition condition_name source port group group_name
policy condition condition_name no source port group

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
group_name The name of the source port group. Port groups are configured through
the policy port group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a source port group from a condition; however, at least one
classification parameter must be associated with a condition.
• This policy condition is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy condition cond6 source port group portgr4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy port group Configures a port group and its associated slot and port numbers.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-110 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSourcePortGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionSourcePortGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-111


QoS Policy Commands

policy condition destination port group


Associates a destination port group with a policy condition. Note that this condition is supported only in
combination with a multicast condition (multicast ip, multicast ipv6, or multicast network group).
policy condition condition_name destination port group group_name
policy condition condition_name no destination port

Syntax Definitions
condition_name The name of the condition. May be an existing condition name or a new
condition.
group_name The name of the destination port group. Port groups are configured
through the policy port group command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of the command to remove a destination port group from a condition; however, at least
one classification parameter must be associated with a condition.

Examples
-> policy condition cond6 destination port group portgr4 multicast ip any

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy port group Configures a port group and its associated slot and port numbers.
policy condition Creates a policy condition.
show policy condition Shows information about policy conditions configured on the switch.

page 18-112 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionDestinationPortGroup
alaQoSAppliedConditionTable
alaQoSAppliedConditionName
alaQoSAppliedConditionDestinationPortGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-113


QoS Policy Commands

policy action
Configures or deletes a QoS action. A QoS action describes how traffic that matches a particular QoS
condition should be treated. It may specify a particular set of bandwidth and queue parameters, or it may
simply specify whether the flow is allowed or denied on the switch.
This section describes the base command. Optional keywords are listed below and described as separate
commands later in this chapter. (Options may be used in combination but are described separately for ease
in explanation.) Use the no form for keywords to remove the parameter from the action.
Note that some action parameters may not be supported depending on the platform you are using. Also
some action parameters may not be supported with some conditions. See the condition table in the
OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide.
policy action action_name
[disposition {accept | drop | deny}]
[shared]
[priority priority_value]
[maximum bandwidth bps]
[maximum depth bytes]
[cir bps [cbs byte] [pir bps] [pbs byte]
[tos tos_value]
[802.1p 802.1p_value]
[dcsp dcsp_value]
[map {802.1p | tos | dscp} to {802.1p | tos| dscp} using map_group]
[permanent gateway ip ip_address]
[port-disable]
[redirect port slot/port]
[redirect linkagg link_agg]
[no-cache]
[{ingress | egress | ingress egress | no} mirror slot/port]
policy no action action_name

Syntax Definitions
action_name A name for the action, any alphanumeric string.

Defaults
By default, no drop algorithm is configured for the action, and any queues created by the action are not
shared.

parameter default
accept | drop | deny accept

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

page 18-114 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Usage Guidelines
• Any condition parameters that the hardware supports will be used to classify the traffic; any condition
parameters that are not supported by the hardware will not be used to classify traffic, and the event will
be logged in the QoS log.
• Bandwidth and queue parameters may be specified when the action is created or may be specified as
separate commands.
• Use the qos apply command to activate configuration changes.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a QoS action from the configuration.

• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy action command is configured, the resulting
ASCII file will include the following additional syntax for the policy action command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the action was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indi-
cates a built-in action, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy action action1 accept

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Configures a condition associated with the action.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about policy actions.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionSource
alaQoSActionDisposition
alaQoSActionMinimumBandwidth
alaQoSActionMaximumBandwidth
alaQoSActionPeakBandwidth
alaQoSActionPriority
alaQoSActionShared
alaQoSActionMaximumBuffers
alaQoSActionMaximumDepth
alaQoSActionCIR
alaQoSActionCIRStatus
alaQoSActionCBS
alaQoSActionCBSStatus
alaQoSActionPIR
alaQoSActionPIRStatus
alaQoSActionPBS

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-115


QoS Policy Commands

alaQoSActionPBSStatus
alaQoSAction8021p
alaQoSActionTos
alaQoSActionTosRewriteMask
alaQoSActionDscp
alaQoSActionMapFrom
alaQoSActionMapTo
alaQoSActionMapGroup
alaQoSActionSourceRewriteIpAddr
alaQoSActionSourceRewriteIpMask
alaQoSActionSourceRewriteIpGroup
alaQoSActionDestinationRewriteIpAddr
alaQoSActionDestinationRewriteIpMask
alaQoSActionDestinationRewriteIpGroup
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionSource
alaQoSAppliedActionDisposition
alaQoSAppliedActionMinimumBandwidth
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumBandwidth
alaQoSAppliedActionPeakBandwidth
alaQoSAppliedActionPriority
alaQoSAppliedActionShared
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumDepth
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumBuffers
alaQoSAppliedActionCIR
alaQoSAppliedActionCIRStatus
alaQoSAppliedActionCBS
alaQoSAppliedActionCBSStatus
alaQoSAppliedActionPIR
alaQoSAppliedActionPIRStatus
alaQoSAppliedActionPBS
alaQoSAppliedActionPBSStatus
alaQoSAppliedAction8021p
alaQoSAppliedActionTos
alaQoSAppliedActionTosRewriteMask
alaQoSAppliedActionDscp
alaQoSAppliedActionMapFrom
alaQoSAppliedActionMapTo
alaQoSAppliedActionMapGroup
alaQoSAppliedActionSourceRewriteIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedActionSourceRewriteIpMask
alaQoSAppliedActionSourceRewriteIpGroup
alaQoSAppliedActionDestinationRewriteIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedActionDestinationRewriteIpMask
alaQoSAppliedActionDestinationRewriteIpGroup

page 18-116 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy list
Configures a list of policy rules. There are two types of lists supported: User Network Profile (UNP) and
egress. Rules assigned to a UNP list are applied to traffic classified into a specific profile. Rules assigned
to an egress list are applied to traffic egressing on QoS ports.
policy list list_name type [unp | egress] rules rule_name [rule_name2...] [enable | disable]
no policy list list_name
policy list list_name no rules rule_name [rule_name2...]

Syntax Definitions
list_name The name to assign to the policy list. Note that the list name is case
sensitive.
unp Applies the list of policy rules to the User Network Profile to which the
list is assigned.
egress Applies the list of policy rules to traffic egressing on QoS ports.
rule_name The name of an existing QoS policy rule to include in the policy list.
rule_name2 Optional. The name of another QoS policy rule to include in the policy
list. Separate each rule name specified with a space.
enable Enables the policy list.
disable Disables the policy list.

Defaults
A default policy list is available when the switch boots up. This list has no name and is not configurable.
All QoS policy rules are assigned to this default list unless the no default-list option of the policy rule
command is used.

parameter default
unp | egress unp
enable | disable enabled

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450
N/A ; egress parameter supported.

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a policy list from the configuration or to remove a policy
rule from an existing list.
• The QoS policy rule name specified with this command must already exist in the switch configuration.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-117


QoS Policy Commands

• Only those rules that are assigned to an egress policy list are applied to egress traffic. However, certain
policy conditions and actions are not supported within an egress policy list. For example, IPv6 condi-
tions are not allowed. See the “Configuring QoS” chapter in the OmniSwitch Network Configuration
Guide for more information.
• QoS changes DSCP and 802.1p values for traffic ingressing on an untrusted port. As a result, the new
values may not match any egress policy list rules as expected. To avoid this scenario, trust the ingress
port or configure a default ToS/DSCP/802.1p value as required.
• If an egress policy list rule contains an 802.1p condition and the ingress port is trusted, set the default
classification of the ingress port to 802.1p. If the default classification of the ingress port is set to
DSCP, the 802.1p value of the traffic is changed per the DSCP classification and will not match the
egress 802.1p condition.
• An egress policy rule supports a maximum of two destination port groups.

• Egress rate limiting configured through an Ethernet Service SAP profile takes precedence over egress
rate limiting specified within a QoS egress policy list rule.
• A rule may belong to a UNP list, the default list, and an egress policy list at the same time. By default,
a rule is assigned to a default policy list when the rule is created. If the rule is subsequently assigned to
another policy list, it still remains associated with the default list.
• If a rule is a member of multiple policy lists but one or more of these lists are disabled, the rule is still
active in those lists that are enabled.
• If the QoS status of a rule is disabled, then the rule is disabled for all lists even if a list to which the
policy belongs is enabled.
• Any policy list configured through this command is not active on the switch until the qos apply
command is issued.
• If the snapshot command is entered after the policy list command is configured, the resulting ASCII
file will include the following additional syntax for the policy list command:
from {cli | ldap | blt}
This syntax indicates how the list was created. The cli and ldap options may be changed by a user
modifying the ASCII file; however, changing this setting is not recommended. The blt option indicates
a built-in object, this setting is not configurable.

Examples
-> policy list unp1 type rules r1 r2 r3
-> policy list unp1 disable
-> policy list unp1 no rules r2
-> policy list unp1 enable
-> no policy list unp1
-> policy list egr1 type egress rules r1 r2 r3
-> policy list egr1 disable
-> policy list egr1 no rules r3
-> policy list egr1 enable
-> no policy list egr1

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command was introduced.

page 18-118 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch and optionally associates that rule
with a validity period.
show policy rule Displays information for policy rules configured on the switch.
show active policy list Displays only those policy lists that are currently being enforced on the
switch.
show policy list Displays information for policy lists configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleGroupsTable
alaQoSRuleDefaultList
alaQoSRuleGroupsName
alaQosRuleGroupsSource
alaQosRuleGroupsType
alaQosRuleGroupsEnabled
alaQosRuleGroupsStatus
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsTable
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsName
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsSource
alaQosAppliedGroupsType
alaQosAppliedGroupsEnabled
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-119


QoS Policy Commands

policy action disposition


Configures a disposition for a policy action.
policy action action_name disposition {accept | drop | deny}
policy action action_name no disposition

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
accept Specifies that the switch should accept the flow.
drop Specifies that the switch should silently drop the flow.
deny Specifies that the switch should drop the flow and issue an ICMP
message indicating the flow was dropped for administrative reasons.
Currently this option will provide the same result as drop; that is, the
flow is silently dropped.

Defaults

parameter default
accept | drop | deny accept

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a disposition from an action.

• This command does not support Layer 2 conditions such as destination VLAN or destination MAC
address.

Examples
-> policy action a3 disposition deny
-> policy action a3 no disposition

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about policy actions.

page 18-120 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionDisposition
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionDisposition

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-121


QoS Policy Commands

policy action shared


Enables queues created by a particular action to be shared.
policy action action_name shared
policy action action_name no shared

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.

Defaults
By default, queues created by an action are not shared.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If multiple rules have the same action, more than one flow may be scheduled on the same queue if the
queue is defined as shared; otherwise, a separate queue is created for each flow.
• Note that flows must be sent over the same virtual port for the flows to share a queue. For example,
flows with the same 802.1Q tag may share the same queue.
• Use the no form of the command to disable sharing.

Example
-> policy action action5 shared
-> policy action action5 no shared

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy action Creates a policy action.


qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-122 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionShared
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionShared

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-123


QoS Policy Commands

policy action priority


Configures the priority for queuing a flow to which the QoS action applies.
policy action action_name priority priority_value
policy action action_name no priority

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
priority_value The priority given to scheduling traffic on the output port. Values range
from 0 (lowest) to 7 (highest).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a priority value from an action.

• This priority value is independent of 802.1Q, Type of Service (ToS), or Differentiated Services Code
Point (DSCP) values.
• Note that the value displayed on the show qos queue screen may be different from the value entered
here.

Examples
-> policy action action1 priority 1
-> policy action action1 no priority

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-124 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionPriority
alaQoSActionPriorityStatus
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionPriority
alaQoSAppliedActionPriorityStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-125


QoS Policy Commands

policy action maximum bandwidth


Configures a maximum bandwidth value for a policy action.
policy action action_name maximum bandwidth bps
policy action action_name no maximum bandwidth

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
bps The desired value for maximum bandwidth, in bits per second. The
value may be entered as an integer (for example, 10000) or with abbre-
viated units (for example, 10k). If the value is entered in bits per second,
the switch rounds the value up to the nearest thousand.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a maximum bandwidth value from an action.

• Note that the bandwidth may be entered in bits per second. Alternatively, the bandwidth may be
entered in abbreviated units (1k, 2k, etc). If the bandwidth value is entered in bytes, the switch rounds
the value to the nearest thousand bytes. For example, if you enter 1 to 1024, the result is 1K. If you
enter 1025 to 2048, the result is 2K.

Examples
-> policy action action4 maximum bandwidth 10000
-> policy action action4 maximum bandwidth 10k
-> policy action action4 no maximum bandwidth

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-126 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
policy action cir Creates a Tri-Color Marking (TCM) policy action.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionMaximumBandwidth
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumBandwidth

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-127


QoS Policy Commands

policy action maximum depth


Configures the maximum queue depth assigned to this action, in bytes. The queue depth determines the
amount of buffer allocated to each queue. When the queue depth is reached, the switch starts dropping
packets.
policy action action_name maximum depth bytes
policy action action_name no maximum depth

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
bytes The maximum queue depth, in bytes. The value may be entered as an
integer (for example, 10000) or with abbreviated units (for example,
10k). If the value is entered in bytes, the switch rounds the value up to
the nearest thousand.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a maximum depth value from a policy action.

• Note that the bandwidth may be entered in bytes. Alternatively, the bandwidth may be entered in
abbreviated units (1k, 2k, etc). If the bandwidth value is entered in bytes, the switch rounds the value
to the nearest thousand bytes. For example, if you enter 1 to 1024, the result is 1K. If you enter 1025 to
2048, the result is 2K.

Examples
-> policy action action2 maximum depth 100
-> policy action action2 no maximum depth

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-128 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionMaximumDepth
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumDepth

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-129


QoS Policy Commands

policy action cir


Configures a Tri-Color Marking (TCM) policy action. This type of action consists of parameters for
Committed Information Rate (CIR), Committed Burst Size (CBS), Peak Information Rate (PIR), and Peak
Burst Size (PBS).
policy action action_name cir bps [cbs byte] [pir bps] [pbs byte]
policy action action_name no cir bps

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
bps The burst size value, in bits per second.
byte The desired value for maximum bucket size, in bytes.

Defaults

parameter default
bps 0
byte 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the TCM parameter values.

• The cir and pir bits and the cbs and pbs bytes parameter values may be entered as an integer (for
example, 10000) or with abbreviated units (for example, 10m).
• The cbs and pbs parameters are optional. If not specified, the default value used by the switch for
maximum depth is used as the default cbs and pbs value.
• The optional pir parameter is used to invoke the Two-Rate TCM mode; otherwise, TCM operates in
the Single-Rate mode by default. Note that the pir value must be greater than the cir value when using
the Two-Rate TCM mode.

Examples
-> policy action A3 cir 10M
-> policy action A4 cir 10M cbs 4k
-> policy action A5 cir 10M cbs 4k pir 20M pbs 40M
-> policy action A3 no cir 10M

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-130 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy action Creates a policy action.


show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.
show active policy list Displays information about pending and applied policy rules that are
active (enabled) on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionCIR
alaQoSActionCBS
alaQoSActionPIR
alaQoSActionPBS
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSActionCIR
alaQoSActionCBS
alaQoSActionPIR
alaQoSActionPBS

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-131


QoS Policy Commands

policy action tos


Configures a Type of Service (ToS) bits value to be applied to packets in outgoing flows to which the
specified policy applies.
policy action action_name tos tos_value
policy action action_name no tos

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
tos_value The three-bit priority value in the IP header that should be set on outgo-
ing frames in flows that match the specified policy. Values range from 0
(lowest priority) to 7 (highest priority).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a ToS value from a policy action.

• Note that specifying both ToS and DSCP in the same action is not allowed.

• An 802.1p or ToS/DSCP action always sets the packet priority. For 802.1p marking, the priority is set
according to the marked 802.1p. For ToS marking, the priority is set according to the marked ToS. For
DSCP marking, the priority is set according to the marked DSCP.
• A ToS action alters the packet IP ToS fields. The DSCP bits 3,4,5 are reset to 0. For example, a ToS 2
action on a packet carrying DSCP 5 will set a DSCP value of 40.

Examples
-> policy action action3 tos 4
-> policy action action3 no tos

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-132 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionTos
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionTos

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-133


QoS Policy Commands

policy action 802.1p


Configures a value to be set in the 802.1p bits of the 802.1Q byte of an outgoing frame for traffic that
matches a policy with this action.
policy action action_name 802.1p 802.1p_value
policy action action_name no 802.1p

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
802.1p_value The priority value to be set in 802.1Q frames. Values range from 0
(lowest priority) to 7 (highest priority).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove an 802.1p value from a policy action.

• Note that specifying both ToS and DSCP in the same action is not allowed.

• An 802.1p or ToS/DSCP action always sets the packet priority. For 802.1p marking, the priority is set
according to the marked 802.1p. For ToS marking, the priority is set according to the marked ToS. For
DSCP marking, the priority is set according to the marked DSCP.

Examples
-> policy action action4 802.1p 7
-> policy action action4 no 802.1p

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-134 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSAction8021p
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedAction8021p

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-135


QoS Policy Commands

policy action dscp


Configures a Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) value to be set in an outgoing flow for traffic that
matches rules with this action.
policy action action_name dscp dscp_value
policy action action_name no dscp

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
dscp_value The DSCP value to be set, in the range 0–63.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a DSCP value from a policy action.

• Note that specifying both ToS and DSCP in the same action is not allowed.

• An 802.1p or ToS/DSCP action always sets the packet priority. For 802.1p marking, the priority is set
according to the marked 802.1p. For ToS marking, the priority is set according to the marked ToS. For
DSCP marking, the priority is set according to the marked DSCP.

Examples
-> policy action action2 dscp 61
-> policy action action2 no dscp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-136 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionDscp
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionDscp

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-137


QoS Policy Commands

policy action map


Configures a mapping group for a policy action.
policy action map {802.1p | tos | dscp} to {802.1p | tos| dscp} using map_group
policy action no map

Syntax Definitions
802.1p Indicates that an 802.1p value should be mapped.
tos Indicates that a ToS value should be mapped.
dscp Indicates that a DSCP value should be mapped.
map_group The name of the map group, configured through the policy map group
command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When remapping is configured with this command and a flow matches a policy with this remapping
action, and the 802.1p, ToS, or DSCP setting in the incoming flow is specified by the map group, the
value will be remapped in the outgoing flow according to the map group.
• If the 802.1p, ToS, or DSCP setting in the incoming flow is not a value specified in the map group, the
switch will do one of two things:
If the remap from and remap to types are the same (802.1p to 802.1p, ToS to ToS, or DSCP to DSCP),
the values in the outgoing flow will be unchanged. If the remap from and remap to types are not the
same (for example: 802.1p to ToS), the switch will set the remap to value to zero (in this case, the ToS
bit would be set to zero). The remap to value remains the same (in this case, the 802.1p bit would
remain unchanged).
• Use the no form of the command to delete the map group from the configuration.

Examples
-> policy action a1 map 802.1p to 802.1p using mapGroup2
-> policy action a2 map 802.1p to tos using mapGroup3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-138 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy map group Configures a map group and its associated mappings for 802.1p, Type of
Service (ToS), or Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) values.
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
policy action Creates a policy action.
show policy action Displays information about policy actions.
show policy map group Displays information about all pending and applied policy map groups
or a particular map group.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionMapFrom
alaQoSActionMapTo
alaQoSActionMapGroup
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionMapFrom
alaQoSAppliedActionMapTo
alaQoSAppliedActionMapGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-139


QoS Policy Commands

policy action permanent gateway ip


Used for Policy Based Routing (PBR). Routed flows to which this action is applied will be directed to the
IP address specified in the action regardless of whether or not a route already exists in the switch routing
table.
policy action action_name permanent gateway ip ip_address
policy action action_name no permanent gateway ip

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
ip_address The destination IP address to which packets will be routed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a gateway IP address from a policy action.

• If the gateway goes down, the traffic to be routed over the gateway will be dropped.

• This policy action is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy action pbr2 permanent gateway ip 10.10.2.1
-> policy action pbr2 no permanent gateway ip

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-140 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionPermanentGatewayIpAddr
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionPermanentGatewayIpAddr

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-141


QoS Policy Commands

policy action port-disable


Administratively disables the source port of the traffic to which this action is applied.
policy action action_name port-disable
policy action action_name no port-disable

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove port-disable from the policy action.

• An SNMP trap is sent when a port is administratively disabled through a port disable action or a User-
Ports shutdown function.
• To enable a port disabled by this action, use the interfaces admin command to administratively enable
the port or disconnect and reconnect the port cable.
• This policy action is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy action pd01 port-disable
-> policy action pb02 no port-disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-142 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionPortdisable
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionPortdisable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-143


QoS Policy Commands

policy action redirect port


Redirects bridged traffic matching a redirect policy to the specified port instead of the port to which the
traffic was destined.
policy action action_name redirect port slot/port
policy action action_name no redirect port

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
slot/port The slot and port number (or range of ports) that will receive the redi-
rected traffic.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove redirect port from the policy action.

• Redirection policies apply to bridged traffic. When redirecting traffic on VLAN A, the redirect port
must belong to VLAN A (tagged or default VLAN). In other words, the ingress port and redirect port
must both reside in the same VLAN.
• This policy action is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy action rp01 redirect port 1/12
-> policy action rp01 no redirect port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-144 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionRedirectSlot
alaQoSActionRedirectPort
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionRedirectSlot
alaQoSAppliedActionRedirectPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-145


QoS Policy Commands

policy action redirect linkagg


Redirects bridged traffic matching a redirect policy to the specified link aggregate ID instead of the link
aggregate to which the traffic was destined.
policy action action_name redirect linkagg link_agg
policy action action_name no redirect linkagg

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
link_agg The link aggregate ID number (0–32) to assign to the specified VLAN.
See Chapter 6, “Link Aggregation Commands.”

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove redirect linkagg from the policy action.

• Redirection policies apply to bridged traffic. When redirecting traffic on VLAN A, the redirect port
must belong to VLAN A (tagged or default VLAN). In other words, the ingress port and redirect port
must both reside in the same VLAN.
• This policy action is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy action rp01 redirect port 1/12
-> policy action rp01 no redirect port

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

page 18-146 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionRedirectAgg
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionRedirectAgg

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-147


QoS Policy Commands

policy action no-cache


Disables logging of rule entries to the hardware cache.
policy action action_name no-cache
policy action action_name no no-cache

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove no cache from the policy action.

• Recommended for use when applied to traffic going to the switch.

Examples
-> policy action nc01 no-cache
-> policy action nc01 no no-cache

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionNocache
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionNocache

page 18-148 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy action mirror


Mirrors ingress packets that match a mirroring policy to the specified port.
policy action action_name ingress mirror slot/port
policy action action_name no mirror slot/port

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
ingress Mirrors ingress packets.
slot/port The slot and port number that will receive the mirrored traffic.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove mirror from the policy action.

• Use this command to configure a mirror-to-port (MTP) action that is used for policy based mirroring.

• Only one MTP session is supported at any given time. As a result, all mirroring policies should specify
the same MTP port.
• Policy based mirroring and the port based mirroring feature can run simultaneously on the same
switch. If a packet qualifies for both types of sessions, the packet is copied to the destination for both
sessions.
• This policy action is not supported when applied to an egress policy list.

Examples
-> policy action a1 mirror 1/7 (default ingress)
-> policy action a1 ingress mirror 1/7
-> policy action a1 no mirror

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-149


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionMirrorSlot
alaQosActionMirrorPort
alaQosActionMirrorMode
alaQosActionMirrorModeStatus

page 18-150 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

policy action cir


Configures a Tri-Color Marking (TCM) policy action. This type of action consists of parameters for
Committed Information Rate (CIR), Committed Burst Size (CBS), Peak Information Rate (PIR), and Peak
Burst Size (PBS).
policy action action_name cir bps [cbs byte] [pir bps] [pbs byte]
policy action action_name no cir bps

Syntax Definitions
action_name The name of the action.
bps The burst size value, in bits per second.
byte The desired value for maximum bucket size, in bytes.

Defaults

parameter default
bps 0
byte 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the TCM parameter values.

• The cir and pir bits and the cbs and pbs bytes parameter values may be entered as an integer (for
example, 10000) or with abbreviated units (for example, 10m).
• The cbs and pbs parameters are optional. If not specified, the default value used by the switch for
maximum depth is used as the default cbs and pbs value.
• The optional pir parameter is used to invoke the Two-Rate TCM mode; otherwise, TCM operates in
the Single-Rate mode by default. Note that the pir value must be greater than the cir value when using
the Two-Rate TCM mode.

Examples
-> policy action A3 cir 10M
-> policy action A4 cir 10M cbs 4k
-> policy action A5 cir 10M cbs 4k pir 20M pbs 40M
-> policy action A3 no cir 10M

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-151


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

policy action Creates a policy action.


show policy action Displays information about actions configured on the switch.
show active policy rule Displays information about pending and applied policy rules that are
active (enabled) on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionCIR
alaQoSActionCBS
alaQoSActionPIR
alaQoSActionPBS
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSActionCIR
alaQoSActionCBS
alaQoSActionPIR
alaQoSActionPBS

page 18-152 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify


Sends hypothetical information to the Layer 2, Layer 3, or multicast classifier to see how the switch will
handle the packet. Used to verify that a policy rule works a particular way.
This section describes the base command. Optional keywords are listed below and described as separate
commands later in this chapter. (Note that options may be used in combination but are described sepa-
rately for ease in explanation.)
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied]
[source port slot/port]
[destination port slot/port]
[source mac mac_address]
[destination mac mac_address]
[source vlan vlan_id]
[destination vlan vlan_id]
[source interface type {ethernet | wan | ethernet-10 | ethernet-100 | ethernet-1G | ethernet-10G}]
[destination interface type {ethernet | wan | ethernet-10 | ethernet-100 | ethernet-1G | ethernet-
10G}]
[802.1p value]
[source ip ip_address]
[destination ip ip_address]
[multicast ip ip_address]
[tos tos_value]
[dscp dscp_value]
[ip protocol protocol]
[source ip port port]
[destination ip port port]

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet. Typically speci-
fied for port, MAC address, VLAN, interface type, or 802.1p.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet. Typically speci-
fied for interface type, IP address, ToS or DSCP, IP protocol, or TCP/
UDP port.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet. Typi-
cally specified for multicast IP address (which is the multicast stream)
and destination parameters (for the client issuing an IGMP request).
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.

Defaults
By default, only pending policies are examined.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-153


QoS Policy Commands

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• If you specify multicast traffic, any destination parameters specified indicate the client(s) attempting to
join a multicast group.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

• See command descriptions in the next sections for more information about the individual options.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 source ip 1.2.3.4 destination ip 198.60.22.2
destination ip port 80 ip protocol 6
Packet headers:
L3:
*Port : 0/0 -> 0/0
*MAC : 000000:000000 -> 000000:000000
*VLAN : 0 -> 0
*802.1p : 0
L3/L4:
*IP : 1.2.3.4 -> 198.60.22.2
TCP : 0 -> 80
*TOS/DSCP : 0/0
Using pending l3 policies
Classify L3:
*Matches rule ‘filter1’: action pri3 (accept)

• Source and destination are indicated to the left and right of the arrow (->) respectively. A zero displays
for values not requested in the hypothetical packet.
• Note that some fields only display for particular traffic types.

output definitions
L2/L3/L4 Indicates the type of traffic (Layer 2 or Layer 3/4).
Port The physical slot/port of the theoretical traffic.
IfType Displays for hypothetical Layer 2 packets only. The interface type of
the packet.
MAC The MAC address of the hypothetical packet.
VLAN The VLAN ID of the hypothetical packet.
802.1p The 802.1p value of the hypothetical packet.
Mcast Displays for hypothetical multicast packets only. The multicast address
of the hypothetical packet.
IP The IP address of the hypothetical packet.
TCP The TCP/UDP port of the hypothetical packet.
TOS/DSCP The ToS or DSCP value of the hypothetical packet.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-154 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceSlot
alaQoSClassifySourcePort
alaQoSClassifyDestinationSlot
alaQoSClassifyDestinationPort
alaQoSClassifySourceMac
alaQoSClassifyDestinationMac
alaQoSClassifySourceVlan
alaQoSClassifyDestinationVlan
alaQoSClassifySourceInterfaceType
alaQoSClassifyDestinationInterfaceType
alaQoSClassify8021p
alaQoSClassifySourceIp
alaQoSClassifyDestinationIp
alaQoSClassifyMulticastIp
alaQoSClassifyTos
alaQoSClassifyDscp
alaQoSClassifyIpProtocol
alaQoSClassifySourceIpPort
alaQoSClassifyDestinationIpPort
alaQoSClassifyExecute
alaQoSClassifyL2SourceResultRule
alaQoSClassifyL2SourceResultDisposition
alaQoSClassifyL2DestinationResultRule
alaQoSClassifyL2DestinationResultDisposition
alaQoSClassifyL3ResultRule
alaQoSClassifyL3ResultDisposition
alaQoSClassifyIGMPResultRule
alaQoSClassifyIGMPResultDisposition
alaQoSClassifyMulticastResultRule
alaQoSClassifyMulticastResultDisposition

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-155


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify source port


Specifies a source port for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will handle
the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
slot/port The slot and port number of the source address of the flow.

Defaults
By default, only pending policies are examined.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 source port 3/1

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-156 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceSlot
alaQoSClassifySourcePort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-157


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify destination port


Specifies a destination port for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
slot/port The slot and port number of the destination address of the flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 destination port 2/1

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

page 18-158 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyDestinationSlot
alaQoSClassifyDestinationPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-159


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify source mac


Specifies a source MAC address for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch
will handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source mac mac_address

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
mac_address The source MAC address of the Layer 2 flow (for example,
00:20:da:05:f6:23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 source mac 00:20:da:05:f6:23

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-160 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceMac

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-161


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify destination mac


Specifies a destination MAC address for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch
will handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 multicast} [applied] destination mac mac_address

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
mac_address The destination MAC address of the Layer 2 flow (for example,
00:20:da:05:f6:23).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 destination mac 00:20:da:05:f6:23

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-162 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyDestinationMac

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-163


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify source vlan


Specifies a source VLAN for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source vlan vlan_id

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
vlan_id The destination VLAN ID for the flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 source vlan 2

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-164 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceVlan

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-165


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify destination vlan


Specifies a destination VLAN for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination vlan vlan_id

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
vlan_id The destination VLAN ID for the flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 destination vlan 3

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-166 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceVlan

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-167


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify source interface type


Specifies a source interface type for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source interface type {ethernet | wan | ethernet-10 |
ethernet-100 | ethernet-1G | ethernet-10G}

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
ethernet Indicates that the flow’s source port is an Ethernet interface.
wan Indicates that the flow’s source port is a WAN interface. Not supported
currently.
ethernet-10 Indicates that the flow’s source port is 10 Mb Ethernet.
ethernet-100 Indicates that the flow’s source port is 100 Mb Ethernet.
ethernet-1G Indicates that the flow’s source port is 1 gigabit Ethernet.
ethernet-10G Indicates that the flow’s source port is 10 gigabit Ethernet.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> policy classify l2 source interface type ethernet

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-168 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceInterfaceType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-169


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify destination interface type


Specifies a destination interface type for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch
will handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination interface type {ethernet | wan | ethernet-
10 | ethernet-100 | ethernet-1G | ethernet-10G}

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
ethernet Indicates that the flow’s destination port is an Ethernet interface.
wan Indicates that the flow’s destination port is a WAN interface. Not
supported currently.
ethernet-10 Indicates that the flow’s destination port is 10 Mb Ethernet.
ethernet-100 Indicates that the flow’s destination port is 100 Mb Ethernet.
ethernet-1G Indicates that the flow’s destination port is 1 gigabit Ethernet.
ethernet-10G Indicates that the flow’s destination port is 10 gigabit Ethernet.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 destination interface type ethernet-10

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-170 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyDestinationInterfaceType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-171


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify 802.1p


Specifies a destination interface type for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch
will handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] 802.1p value

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
value The 802.1p value for the flow.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate saved policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l2 802.1p 4

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

page 18-172 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassify8021p

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-173


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify source ip


Specifies a source IP address for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source ip ip_address

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
ip_address The source IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 source ip 1.2.3.4

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-174 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceIp

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-175


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify destination ip


Specifies a destination IP address for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch
will handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination ip ip_address

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
ip_address The destination IP address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 destination ip 198.60.22.2

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-176 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyDestinationIpPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-177


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify multicast ip


Specifies a multicast address for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] multicast ip ip_address

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
ip_address The multicast IP address (the address of the multicast stream).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify multicast multicast ip 224.22.22.1
Packet headers:
L2:
*Port : 0/0 (any) -> 0/0 (any)
*MAC : 000000:000000 -> 080020:D1E51
*VLAN : 0 -> 0
*802.1p : 0
L3/L4:
*Mcast : 224.22.22.1
*IP : 0.0.0.0 -> 0.0.0.0
*TOS/DSCP : 0/0
Using pending multicast policies
Classify Multicast:
*No rule matched: (accept)
See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

page 18-178 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyMulticastIp

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-179


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify tos


Specifies a ToS value for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will handle
the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] tos tos_value

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
tos_value The Type of Service bits value included in the IP header. The three most
significant bits of the byte determine the precedence (i.e, priority) of the
frame (0 is the lowest, 7 is the highest).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

• If a ToS value is specified, a DSCP value may not be specified.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 tos 7

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-180 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyTos

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-181


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify dscp


Specifies a DiffServ Code Point (DSCP) value for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in
the switch will handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] dscp dscp_value

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
dscp_value The DiffServ Code Point value, in the range 0–63.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

• If a DSCP value is specified, a ToS value may not be specified.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 dscp 63

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-182 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyDscp

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-183


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify ip protocol


Specifies an IP protocol for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will handle
the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] ip protocol protocol

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
protocol The IP protocol number, for example, 6.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 ip protocol 6

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-184 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyIpProtocol

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-185


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify source ip port


Specifies a source IP port for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source ip port port

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
port The well-known port number for the desired service. For example, the
port number for Telnet is 23.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 source ip port 80

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-186 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifySourceIpPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-187


QoS Policy Commands

show policy classify destination ip port


Specifies a destination IP port for a hypothetical packet to show how the QoS software in the switch will
handle the packet.
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination ip port port

Syntax Definitions
l2 Uses the Layer 2 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
l3 Uses the Layer 3 classifier for the hypothetical packet.
multicast Uses the multicast IGMP classifier for the hypothetical packet.
applied Indicates that only applied policies should be examined.
port The well-known port number for the desired service. For example, the
port number for Telnet is 23.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to determine if the switch will classify the traffic condition specified and match it to
a policy. By default the classifier only tests pending policies (policies that have not yet been applied).
Use the applied keyword to test only those policies that have been applied.
• Use the qos apply command to activate policies.

Examples
-> show policy classify l3 destination ip port 80

See the output example given on page 18-153 for more information about the potential screen display.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 18-188 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Related Commands

qos apply Applies configured QoS and policy settings to the current configuration.
show policy classify Describes the base command.

MIB Objects
alaQoSClassifyTable
alaQoSClassifyDestinationIpPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-189


QoS Policy Commands

show policy network group


Displays information about pending and applied policy network groups.
show [applied] policy network group [network_group]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only network groups that have been applied should be
displayed.
network_group The name of the policy network group for which you want to display
information; or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying infor-
mation about network groups with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to
indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy network groups displays unless network_group is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy network group.
- Indicates the policy network group is pending
deletion.
# Indicates that the policy network group differs
between the pending/applied network groups.

Examples
-> show policy network group
Group Name: From Entries
Switch blt 4.0.1.166
10.0.1.166
143.209.92.166
192.85.3.1

+netgroup1 cli 143.209.92.0/255.255.255.0


172.28.5.0/255/255/255.0

page 18-190 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Group Name The name of the port group, configured through the policy network
group command.
From The way the group was configured: blt indicates a built-in entry; cli
indicates that the entry was configured on the switch; ldap indicates the
entry was configured through PolicyView
Entries The IP addresses associated with the network group.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy network group Configures policy network groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSNetworkGroupsTable
alaNetworkGroupsName
alaNetworkGroupsSource
alaNetworkGroupTable
alaNetworkGroupIpAddr
alaQoSNetworkGroupIpMask

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-191


QoS Policy Commands

show policy service


Displays information about pending and applied policy services.
show [applied] policy service [service_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only services that have been applied should be displayed.
service_name The name of the service for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about
services with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard
character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information about all policy services is displayed unless service_name is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy service.
- Indicates the policy service is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy service differs between
the pending/applied services.

Examples
-> show policy service
Service Name From IPProto ScrPort DstPort
telnet_service cli 6 (TCP) 23
+ftp_service cli 6 (TCP) 21
test_service cli 6 (TCP) 21

-> show policy service telnet_service


Service Name From IPProto ScrPort DstPort
telnet_service cli 6 (TCP) 23

-> show applied policy service


Service Name From IPProto ScrPort DstPort
telnet_service cli 6 (TCP) 23
test_service cli 6 (TCP) 21

page 18-192 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Service Name The name of the port group, configured through the policy service
command.
From The way the service was configured: blt indicates a built-in entry; cli
indicates that the entry was configured on the switch; ldap indicates the
entry was configured through PolicyView.
IPProto The IP protocol associated with the service.
ScrPort A source port associated with the service.
DstPort A destination port associated with the service.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy service Configures a service that may be used as part of a policy service group.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceTable
alaQoSServiceName
alaQoSServiceSource
alaQoSServiceIpProtocol
alaQoSServiceSourceIpPort
alaQoSServiceDestinationIpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceIpProtocol
alaQoSAppliedSourceIpPort
alaQoSAppliedServiceDestinationIpPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-193


QoS Policy Commands

show policy service group


Displays information about pending and applied policy service groups.
show [applied] policy service group [service_group]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only service groups that have been applied should be
displayed.
service_group The name of the service group for which you want to display informa-
tion; or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information
about service groups with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate
a wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy service groups displays unless service_group is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy service group.
- Indicates the policy service group is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy service group differs between
the pending/applied service groups.

Examples
-> show policy service group
Group Name: From Entries
serv_group1 cli telnet
ftp

serv_group2 cli telnet

page 18-194 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Group Name The name of the port group, configured through the policy service
group command.
From The origin of the service group: cli indicates that the entry was config-
ured on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through
PolicyView.
Entries The services associated with the group. Services are configured through
the policy service command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy service group Configures a service group and its associated services. A service group
may be attached to a policy condition.

MIB Objects
alaQoSServiceGroupsTable
alaQoSServiceGroupsName
alaQoSServiceGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupsSource
alaQoSServiceGroupTable
alaQoSServiceGroupServiceName
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedServiceGroupServiceName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-195


QoS Policy Commands

show policy mac group


Displays information about pending and applied MAC groups.
show [applied] policy mac group [mac_group]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only MAC groups that have been applied should be
displayed.
mac_group The name of the MAC group for which you want to display informa-
tion; or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information
about MAC groups with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a
wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy MAC groups displays unless mac_group is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy MAC group.
- Indicates the policy MAC group is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy MAC group differs between
the pending/applied MAC groups.

Examples
-> show policy mac group
Group Name: From Entries
pubs1 cli 0020da:05f623
0020da:05f624
143.209.92.166
192.85.3.1

+yuba cli 080020:D16E51


172.28.5.0/255/255/255.0

page 18-196 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Group Name The name of the port group, configured through the policy mac group
command.
From The origin of the MAC group: cli indicates that the entry was config-
ured on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through
PolicyView.
Entries The MAC addresses associated with the group.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy mac group Configures policy MAC groups.

MIB Objects
alaQoSMACGroupsTable
alaQoSMACGroupsName
alaQoSMACGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupsSource
alaQoSMACGroupTable
alaQoSMACGroupMacAddr
alaQoSMACGroupMacMask
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupMacAddr
alaQoSAppliedMACGroupMacMask

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-197


QoS Policy Commands

show policy port group


Displays information about pending and applied policy port groups.
show [applied] policy port group [group_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only policy port groups that have been applied should be
displayed.
group_name The name of the policy port group for which you want to display infor-
mation; or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information
about port groups with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a
wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy port groups displays unless group_name is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy port group.
- Indicates the policy port group is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy port group differs between
the pending/applied port groups.

Examples
-> show policy port group
Group Name: From Entries
Slot01 blt

Slot02 blt

Slot03 blt

Slot04 blt

Slot05 blt

Slot06 blt

Slot07 blt

page 18-198 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Slot08 blt

pgroup1 cli 2/1


3/1
3/2

pgroup2 cli 2/2


2/3

output definitions
Group Name The name of the port group, configured through the policy port group
command or built-in port groups automatically set up by the switch
(Slot01, Slot02, Slot03, etc.).
From The origin of the port group: cli indicates that the entry was configured
on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through Policy-
View; blt indicates the entry was set up automatically by the switch
based on the current hardware.
Entries The slot/port combinations associated with the port group.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy port group Configures a port group and its associated slot and port numbers.

MIB Objects
alaQoSPortGroupsTable
alaQoSPortGroupsName
alaQoSPortGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupsSource
alaPortGroupTable
alaQoSPortGroupSlot
alaQoSPortGroupPort
alaAppliedPortGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupSlot
alaQoSAppliedPortGroupPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-199


QoS Policy Commands

show policy vlan group


Displays information about pending and applied policy VLAN groups.
show [applied] policy vlan group [group_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Displays only those policy VLAN groups that have been applied.
group_name The name of the policy VLAN group for which you want to display
information; or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying infor-
mation about VLAN groups with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to
indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
By default, all VLAN groups are displayed with this command.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the group_name parameter to display information for a specific VLAN group.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy vlan group.
- Indicates the policy vlan group is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy vlan group differs between
the pending/applied port groups.

Examples
-> show policy vlan group
Group Name vlan From
----------+------------------------+---------------
Vlan_grp1 100 cli
Vlan_grp1 101 cli
Vlan_grp1 200 cli
Vlan_grp2 1234 cli
Vlan_grp3 2000 cli
Vlan_grp3 2001 cli
Vlan_grp3 2003-2005 cli
Vlan_grp3 2500 cli
Vlan_grp3 3000 cli

page 18-200 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

-> show policy vlan group


Group Name vlan From
----------+------------------------+---------------
Vlan_grp2 1234 cli

output definitions
Group Name The name of the VLAN group.
VLAN The VLAN IDs associated with the VLAN group.
From The origin of the VLAN group: cli indicates that the entry was config-
ured on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through
PolicyView; blt indicates the entry was set up automatically by the
switch based on the current hardware.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy vlan group Configures a VLAN group and its associated VLAN ID numbers.

MIB Objects
alaQoSVlanGroupsTable
alaQoSVlanGroupsName
alaQoSVlanGroupsSource
alaQoSVlanGroupsStatus
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupsStatus
alaQoSVlanGroupTable
alaQoSVlanGroupVlan
alaQoSVlanGroupVlanEnd
alaQoSVlanGroupStatus
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupVlan
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupVlanEnd
alaQoSAppliedVlanGroupStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-201


QoS Policy Commands

show policy map group


Displays information about pending and applied policy map groups.
show [applied] policy map group [group_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only map groups that have been applied should be
displayed.
group_name The name of the policy map group for which you want to display infor-
mation; or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information
about map groups with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a
wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy map groups displays unless group_name is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy port group.
- Indicates the policy port group is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy port group differs between
the pending/applied port groups.

Examples
-> show policy map group
Group Name From Entries
+tosGroup cli 1-2:4
4:5

output definitions
Group Name The name of the map group, configured through the policy map group
command.
From The origin of the port group: cli indicates that the entry was configured
on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through Policy-
View.
Entries The slot/port combinations associated with the port group.

page 18-202 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy mac group Configures a map group and its associated mappings for 802.1p, Type of
Service (ToS), or Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) values.

MIB Objects
alaQoSMapGroupsTable
alaQoSMapGroupsName
alaQoSMapGroupsSource
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupsTable
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupsName
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupsSource
alaQoSMapGroupTable
alaQoSMapGroupKey
alaQoSMapGroupKeyEnd
alaQoSMapGroupValue
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupTable
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupKey
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupKeyEnd
alaQoSAppliedMapGroupValue

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-203


QoS Policy Commands

show policy action


Displays information about pending and applied policy actions configured on the switch.
show [applied] policy action [action_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only actions that have been applied should be displayed.
action_name The name of the action for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about
actions with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard
character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy actions displays unless action_name is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy action.
- Indicates the policy action is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy action differs between the
pending/applied actions.

Examples
-> show policy action
Bandwidth Burst size
Action Name From Disp Pri Share Min Max CIR PIR Max-Depth Bufs CBS PBS To
-----------+----+------+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---------+----+---+---+---
A3 cli accept No 10M
+A4 cli accept No 10M 4K
A5 cli accept No 10M 10M 4K
A6 cli accept No
+A7 cli accept No
+A8 cli accept Yes
action1 cli accept No 10M 20M 4K
action2 cli accept No 10M 20M 4K 40M

page 18-204 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

-> show policy action a5


Bandwidth Burst size
Action Name From Disp Pri Share Min Max CIR PIR Max-Depth Bufs CBS PBS To
-----------+----+------+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---------+----+---+---+---
A5 cli accept No 10M 10M 4K

-> show applied policy action


Bandwidth Burst size
Action Name From Disp Pri Share Min Max CIR PIR Max-Depth Bufs CBS PBS To
-----------+----+------+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---------+----+---+---+---
A3 cli accept No 10M
A5 cli accept No 10M 10M 4K
A6 cli accept No
action1 cli accept No 10M 20M 4K
action2 cli accept No 10M 20M 4K 40M

-> show policy action action*


Bandwidth Burst size
Action Name From Disp Pri Share Min Max CIR PIR Max-Depth Bufs CBS PBS To
-----------+----+------+---+-----+---+---+---+---+---------+----+---+---+---
action1 cli accept No 10M 20M 4K
action2 cli accept No 10M 20M 4K 40M

output definitions
Action Name The name of the action, configured through the policy action com-
mand.
From Where the policy rule originated: cli indicates that the entry was config-
ured on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through
PolicyView.
Disp The disposition of the rule, either accept or deny.
Pri The priority configured for the rule.
Share Whether or not the rule specifies that the queue should be shared.
Min Bandwidth The minimum bandwidth required by the rule.
Max Bandwidth The maximum bandwidth required by the rule.
Max Depth Bufs Maximum depth (in Kbytes) of queues for traffic.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy action Creates a policy action. A QoS action is a particular set of bandwidth
and queue parameters that may be applied to a flow matching particular
QoS conditions.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-205


QoS Policy Commands

MIB Objects
alaQoSActionTable
alaQoSActionName
alaQoSActionSource
alaQoSActionDisposition
alaQoSActionShared
alaQoSActionMinimumBandwidth
alaQoSActionMaximumBandwidth
alaQosActionMaximumDepth
alaQoSAppliedActionTable
alaQoSAppliedActionName
alaQoSAppliedActionSource
alaQoSAppliedActionDisposition
alaQoSAppliedActionShared
alaQoSAppliedActionMinimumBandwidth
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumBandwidth
alaQoSAppliedActionMaximumDepth

page 18-206 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

show policy list


Displays information about pending and applied policy lists.
show [applied] policy list [list_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Displays only those policy lists that have been applied to the switch
configuration.
list_name The name of the list for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about lists
with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all rules is displayed unless a list_name is specified.

• Use the show active policy list command to display only active policy lists that are currently enforced
on the switch.
• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates that the policy list has been modified or has been
created since the last qos apply.
- Indicates the policy list is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy list differs between the pending/
applied lists.

Examples
-> show policy list
Group Name From Type Enabled Entries
list1 cli unp Yes r1
r2

+list2 cli unp Yes r3

egress_list1 cli egress No r1


r2
r3

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-207


QoS Policy Commands

-> show applied policy list


Group Name From Type Enabled Entries
list1 cli unp Yes r1
r2

egress_list1 cli egress No r1


r2
r3

output definitions
Group Name The name of the policy list. Configured through the policy list com-
mand. A plus sign (+) preceding a policy list name indicates that the list
was modified or created since the last qos apply.
From Where the list originated.
Type The type of rule (unp or egress). Configured through the policy list
command. Note that the default policy list is not shown. Use the show
active policy rule meter-statistics command to display rules that are
members of the default policy list.
Enabled Whether or not the rule is enabled. Configured through the policy list
command.
Entries The QoS policy rules that are grouped together in this policy list. Con-
figured through the policy list command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show active policy list Displays only those policy lists that are currently being enforced on the
switch.
show policy rule Displays information about pending and applied policy rules

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleGroupsTable
alaQoSRuleDefaultList
alaQoSRuleGroupsName
alaQosRuleGroupsSource
alaQosRuleGroupsType
alaQosRuleGroupsEnabled
alaQosRuleGroupsStatus
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsTable
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsName
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsSource
alaQosAppliedGroupsType
alaQosAppliedGroupsEnabled
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsStatus

page 18-208 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

show policy condition


Displays information about pending and applied policy conditions.
show [applied] policy condition [condition_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only conditions that have been applied should be
displayed.
condition_name The name of the condition for which you want to display information;
or a wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about
conditions with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wild-
card character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all policy conditions displays unless condition_name is specified.

• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates a new policy condition.
- Indicates the policy condition is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy condition differs between
the pending/applied conditions.

Examples
-> show policy condition
Condition Name: From Src -> Dest
pcond1 cli
*IP : Any -> 198.60.82.0/255.255.255.0

+c4 cli
*IP : 10.11.2.0/255/255/255.0 -> Any
*TCP : Any -> 600

-> show policy condition c*


Condition Name: From Src -> Dest
+c4 cli
*IP : 10.11.2.0/255/255/255.0 -> Any
*TCP : Any -> 600

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-209


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Condition Name The name of the condition, configured through the policy condition
command.
From The origin of the condition: cli indicates that the entry was configured
on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured through Policy-
View.
Scr The source address associated with the condition.
Dest The destination address associated with the condition.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy condition Creates a policy condition. The condition determines what parameters
the switch uses to classify incoming flows.

MIB Objects
alaQoSConditionTable
alaQoSConditionName
alaQoSConditionSource
alaQoSConditionSourceSlot
alaQoSConditionSourcePort
alaQoSConditionSourcePortGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationSlot
alaQoSConditionDestinationPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationPortGroup
alaQoSConditionSourceInterfaceType
alaQoSConditionDestinationInterfaceType
alaQoSConditionSourceMacAddr
alaQoSConditionSourceMacMask
alaQoSConditionSourceMacGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacAddr
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacMask
alaQoSConditionDestinationMacGroup
alaQoSConditionSourceVlan
alaQoSConditionSourceVlanGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationVlan
alaQoSCondition8021p
alaQoSConditionSourceIpAddr
alaQoSConditionSourceIpMask
alaQoSConditionSourceNetworkGroup
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpAddr
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpMask
alaQoSConditionDestinationNetworkGroup
alaQoSConditionMulticastIpAddr
alaQoSConditionMulticastIpMask
alaQoSConditionMulticastNetworkGroup
alaQoSConditionTos
alaQoSConditionDscp

page 18-210 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

alaQoSConditionTcpFlags
alaQoSConditionIpProtocol
alaQoSConditionSourceIpPort
alaQoSConditionDestinationIpPort
alaQoSConditionService
alaQoSConditionServiceGroup

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-211


QoS Policy Commands

show active policy list


Displays information about applied policy lists that are active (enabled) on the switch.
show active policy list [list_name]

Syntax Definitions
list_name The name of the list for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about lists
with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all active rules is displayed unless a list_name is specified.

• Use the show policy list command to display inactive as well as active policy lists.

• Applied lists may or may not be active on the switch. Applied lists are inactive if they have been
administratively disabled with the disable option in the policy list command.
• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates that the policy list has been modified or has been
created since the last qos apply.
- Indicates the policy list is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy list differs between the pending/
applied lists.

Examples
-> show active policy list
Group Name From Type Enabled Entries

list1 cli unp Yes r1


r2

+list2 cli unp Yes r3

egress_list1 cli egress Yes r1


r2
r3

page 18-212 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Group Name The name of the policy list. Configured through the policy list com-
mand. A plus sign (+) preceding a policy list name indicates that the list
was modified or created since the last qos apply.
From Where the list originated.
Type The type of rule (unp or egress). Configured through the policy list
command. Note that the default policy list is not shown. Use the show
policy rule command to display rules that are members of the default
policy list.
Enabled Whether or not the rule is enabled. Configured through the policy list
command.
Entries The QoS policy rules that are grouped together in this policy list. Con-
figured through the policy list command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show policy list Displays information about pending and applied policy lists.
show policy rule Displays information about pending and applied policy rules

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleGroupsTable
alaQoSRuleDefaultList
alaQoSRuleGroupsName
alaQosRuleGroupsSource
alaQosRuleGroupsType
alaQosRuleGroupsEnabled
alaQosRuleGroupsStatus
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsTable
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsName
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsSource
alaQosAppliedGroupsType
alaQosAppliedGroupsEnabled
alaQosAppliedRuleGroupsStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-213


QoS Policy Commands

show active policy rule


Displays information about pending and applied policy rules that are active (enabled) on the switch.
show active [bridged | routed | multicast] policy rule [rule_name]

Syntax Definitions
bridged Displays active rules that apply to bridged traffic.
routed Displays active rules that apply to routed traffic.
multicast Displays active rules that apply to multicast traffic.
rule_name The name of the rule for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about rules
with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the show policy rule command to display inactive as well as active policy rules.

• Information for all rules is displayed unless rule_name is specified.

• Information for all rule types is displayed unless a keyword (bridged, routed, multicast) is specified.

• Applied rules may or may not be active on the switch. Applied rules are inactive if they have been
administratively disabled with the disable option in the policy rule command.
• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates that the policy rule has been modified or has
been created since the last qos apply.
- Indicates the policy object is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy object differs between the pend-
ing/applied objects.

• A match may show for a rule that is not the highest precedence rule for a particular flow, but only the
rule with the highest precedence is actually applied.

page 18-214 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Examples
-> show active policy rule
Policy From Prec Enab Act Refl Log Trap Save Matches Green Yellow Red
R1 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes 6000 3000 2000 1000
(L2/3): c1 -> a1

R2 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes 0 0 0 0


(L2/3): C2 -> QoS_Action1

R3 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes 0 0 0 0


(L2/3): C3 -> QoS_Action1

output definitions
Policy The name of the policy rule, configured through the policy rule com-
mand. A plus sign (+) preceding a policy rule name indicates that the
policy rule has been modified or has been created since the last qos
apply.
From Where the rule originated.
Prec The precedence of the rule. Precedence determines the order in which
the switch will apply rules.
Enab Whether or not the rule is administratively enabled. (By default, rules
are enabled.)
Act Whether or not the rule is enforceable by the switch (e.g., qos is
enabled, rule is valid and enabled, validity period is active).
Refl Whether the rule is reflexive or not.
Log Whether or not the switch will log messages about specific flows com-
ing into the switch that match this policy rule. Configured through the
policy rule command.
Trap Whether or not traps are enabled for the rule. Configured through the
policy rule command. A trap is sent when a port is administratively
disabled through a port disable action or a UserPort shutdown function
Save Whether the rule will be captured in an ASCII text file (using the
configuration snapshot command), saved to the working directory
after the write memory command or copy running-config working
command is entered, or saved after a reboot. Configured through the
policy rule command.
Matches The number of flows matching this rule. Note that for ingress maxi-
mum bandwidth policies, the value in this field indicates the number of
packets that exceed the bandwidth limit, not the packets that match the
rule.
Green, Yellow, Red Tri-Color Marking (TCM) statistics; the number of packets/bytes that
are marked Green (low drop precedence), Yellow (high drop prece-
dence) , and Red (always drop). Configured through the policy action
cir command.
{L2/3} The condition and the action associated with the rule; configured
through the policy condition and policy action commands respec-
tively.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-215


QoS Policy Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch. A rule is made up of a condition
(for classifying incoming traffic) and an action (to be applied to outgo-
ing traffic).

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleTable
alaQoSRuleName
alaQoSRuleEnabled
alaQoSRuleSource
alaQoSRulePrecedence
alaQoSRuleActive
alaQoSRuleReflexive
alaQosRuleLog
alaQosRuleTrapEvents
alaQosRuleSave
alaQoSRuleCondition
alaQoSRuleAction

page 18-216 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

show active policy rule meter-statistics


Displays Tricolor Marking (TCM) packet color statistics for the policy rule. These statistics are kept for
those rules that consist of a TCM policy action (policy action cir).
show active policy rule [rule_name] meter-statistics

Syntax Definitions
rule_name The name of the rule for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about rules
with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
By default, statistics are displayed for all rules.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the optional rule_name parameter to display statistics for a specific policy rule.

• This command displays statistics for applied policy rules that are active (enabled) on the switch. Use
the show policy rule command to display inactive as well as active policy rules.
• Applied rules may or may not be active on the switch. Applied rules are inactive if they have been
administratively disabled with the disable option in the policy rule command.
• Statistics are displayed for all three colors: Green, Yellow, and Red.

• A TCM action specifies the rates and burst sizes used to determine drop precedence for packets to
which the action is applied. Packets are marked a certain color based on whether or not they conform to
the specified rates and burst sizes. The packet color indicates the drop precedence (Green = low drop
precedence, Yellow = high drop precedence, and Red = packet is always dropped).

Examples
The following command examples display statistics for the color counters. These are the two counters
specified by the TCM policy action that is assigned to the “R1” and “R2” policy rules.

-> show active policy rule meter-statistics


Policy: R1,
Count-type: packets,
Statistics:
Green: 75,
Red:50,
Yellow:0

Policy: R2,
Count-type: bytes,
Green: 75,
Red:50,
Yellow:0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-217


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Policy The name of the policy rule, configured through the policy rule com-
mand.
Green Packets marked green as a result of the TCM policy action; green pack-
ets have a low drop precedence.
Red Packets marked red as a result of the TCM policy action; red packets
are always dropped.
Yellow The number of packets marked yellow as a result of the TCM policy
action; yellow packets have a high drop precedence.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy action cir Configures a TCM policy action, including the color mode for the
action.
qos stats reset Resets QoS statistic counters to zero.
show policy action Displays information for policy actions configured on the switch.
show policy rule Displays information for policy rules configured on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleTable
alaQoSRuleName
alaQoSRuleGreenCount
alaQoSRuleRedCount
alaQoSRuleYellowCount
alaQoSAppliedRuleTable
alaQoSAppliedRuleName
alaQoSAppliedRuleGreenCount
alaQoSAppliedRuleRedCount
alaQoSAppliedRuleYellowCount

page 18-218 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

show policy rule


Displays information about pending and applied policy rules.
show [applied] [bridged | routed | multicast] policy rule [rule_name]

Syntax Definitions
applied Indicates that only policy rules that have been applied should be
displayed.
bridged Displays rules that apply to bridged traffic.
routed Displays rules that apply to routed traffic.
multicast Displays rules that apply to multicast traffic.
rule_name The name of the rule for which you want to display information; or a
wildcard sequence of characters for displaying information about rules
with similar names. Use an asterisk (*) to indicate a wildcard character.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all rules is displayed unless rule_name is specified.

• Information for all rule types is displayed unless a keyword (bridged, routed, multicast) is specified.

• Use the show active policy list command to display only active rules that are currently being enforced
on the switch.
• The display may include any of the following characters:

character definition
+ Indicates that the policy rule has been modified or has
been created since the last qos apply.
- Indicates the policy object is pending deletion.
# Indicates that the policy object differs between the pend-
ing/applied objects.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-219


QoS Policy Commands

Examples
-> show policy rule
Policy From Prec Enab Act Refl Log Trap Save
r1 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes
(L2/3): c1 -> a1

r2 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes


(L2/3): c2 -> a2

+r3 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes


(L2/3): c2 -> a3

+r4 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes


(L2/3): c1 -> a1

-> show applied policy rule


Policy From Prec Enab Act Refl Log Trap Save
r1 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes
(L2/3): c1 -> a1

r2 cli 0 Yes Yes No No Yes Yes


(L2/3): c2 -> a2

output definitions
Policy The name of the policy rule, configured through the policy rule com-
mand. A plus sign (+) preceding a policy rule name indicates that the
policy rule has been modified or has been created since the last qos
apply.
From Where the rule originated.
Prec The precedence of the rule. Precedence determines the order in which
the switch will apply rules. Configured through the
Enab Whether or not the rule is enabled.
Act Whether or not the rule is enforceable by the switch (e.g., qos is
enabled, rule is valid and enabled, validity period is active).
Refl Whether the rule is reflexive or not.
Log Whether or not the switch will log messages about specific flows com-
ing into the switch that match this policy rule. Configured through the
policy rule command.
Trap Whether or not traps are enabled for the rule. Configured through the
policy rule command. A trap is sent when a port is administratively
disabled through a port disable action or a UserPort shutdown function.
Save Whether the rule will be captured in an ASCII text file (using the
configuration snapshot command), saved to the working directory
after the write memory command or copy running-config working
command is entered, or saved after a reboot. Configured through the
policy rule command.
{L2/3} The condition and the action associated with the rule; configured
through the policy condition and policy action commands respec-
tively.

page 18-220 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy rule Configures a policy rule on the switch. A rule is made up of a condition
(for classifying incoming traffic) and an action (to be applied to outgo-
ing traffic).

MIB Objects
alaQoSRuleTable
alaQoSRuleName
alaQoSRuleEnabled
alaQoSRuleSource
alaQoSRulePrecedence
alaQoSRuleActive
alaQoSRuleReflexive
alaQosRuleLog
alaQosRuleTrapEvents
alaQosRuleSave
alaQoSRuleCondition
alaQoSRuleAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-221


QoS Policy Commands

show policy validity period


Displays information about policy validity periods.
show policy validity period [name]

Syntax Definitions
name The name of the validity period.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Information for all validity periods is displayed unless name is specified.

• Use the show policy rule command to display the validity period that is associated with a policy rule.

Examples
-> show policy validity period
ValidityPeriod From
vp01 cli
*Days : tuesday thursday
*Months: january february
*Hours : 13:00 - 14:00

vp02 cli
*Days : monday wednesday
*Hours : 9:00 - 10:00

-> show policy validity period vp01


ValidityPeriod From
vp01 cli
*Days : tuesday thursday
*Months: january february
*Hours : 13:00 - 14:00

output definitions
ValidityPeriod The name of the policy validity period, configured through the policy
validity period command. A plus sign (+) preceding a policy rule name
indicates that the policy rule has been modified or has been created
since the last qos apply.
From Where the validity period originated: cli indicates that the entry was
configured on the switch; ldap indicates the entry was configured
through PolicyView.

page 18-222 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


QoS Policy Commands

output definitions
Days The days of the week the validity period is active, configured through
the policy validity period command. If this field does not appear, then
the validity period is not restricted to specific days.
Months The months during which the validity period is active, configured
through the policy validity period command. If this field does not
appear, then the validity period is not restricted to specific months.
Hours The time of day the validity period begins and ends, configured through
the policy validity period command. If this field does not appear, then
the validity period is not restricted to a specific time.
Interval The date and time a validity period interval begins and ends, configured
through the policy validity period command. If this field does not
appear, then the validity period is not restricted to a specific date and
time interval.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy validity period Configures a validity period that specifies days, times, and/or months
during which an associated policy rule is in effect.

MIB Objects
alaQoSValidityPeriodTable
alaQoSValidityPeriodName
alaQoSValidityPeriodSource
alaQoSValidityPeriodDays
alaQoSValidityPeriodDaysStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodMonths
alaQoSValidityPeriodMonthsStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodHour
alaQoSValidityPeriodHourStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodEndHour
alaQoSValidityPeriodInterval
alaQoSValidityPeriodIntervalStatus
alaQoSValidityPeriodEndInterval
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodTable
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodName
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodSource
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodDays
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodDaysStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodMonths
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodMonthsStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodHour
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodHourStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodEndHour
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodInterval
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodIntervalStatus
alaQoSAppliedValidityPeriodEndInterval

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 18-223


QoS Policy Commands

page 18-224 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


19 Policy Server
Commands

This chapter describes CLI commands used for managing policies downloaded to the switch from an
attached LDAP server. Policy rules may be created on an attached server through the PolicyView GUI
application. Policy rules may also be created on the switch directly through CLI or SNMP commands.
This chapter describes commands related to managing LDAP policies only. See Chapter 17, “QoS
Commands,” for information about commands for creating and managing policies directly on the switch.
The policy commands are based on RFC 2251 and RFC 3060.
MIB information for policy server commands is as follows:
Filename: alcatelIND1policy.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-POLICY-MIB
The policy server commands are summarized here:

policy server load


policy server flush
policy server
show policy server
show policy server long
show policy server statistics
show policy server rules
show policy server events

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-1


Policy Server Commands

policy server load


Downloads policies from a LDAP server. These policies are created through the PolicyView management
application.
policy server load

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Policies are downloaded to the switch from the directory server with the highest preference setting; this
server must be enabled and operational (able to bind).

Examples
-> policy server load

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy server flush Removes all cached LDAP policy data from the switch.

MIB Objects
serverPolicyDecision

page 19-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

policy server flush


Removes all cached LDAP policy data from the switch.
policy server flush

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to remove LDAP policies. Policies configured through the CLI or SNMP are not
removed.

Examples
-> policy server flush

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy server load Downloads policies from a LDAP server. These policies are created
through the PolicyView management application.

MIB Objects
serverPolicyDecision

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-3


Policy Server Commands

policy server
Configures operational parameters for an LDAP-enabled directory server on which policies are stored.
policy server ip_address [port port_number] [admin {up | down}] [preference preference] [user
user_name password password] [searchbase search_string] [ssl | no ssl]
no policy server ip_address [port port_number]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address of the LDAP-enabled directory server.
port_number The TCP/IP port number used by the switch to connect to the directory
server.
up Enables the specified policy server to download rules to the switch
(servers are up by default.)
down Prevents the specified policy server from downloading rules to the
switch.
preference Determines which directory server is used for policy downloads when
multiple servers are configured. The range is 0–255. The server with the
highest value is used as the policy server. If that server becomes
unavailable, the server with the next highest preference value is used for
policy downloads.
user_name The user name for accessing the database entries on the directory server.
When spaces are used in the user name, quotation marks must be
included: “Directory Manager” is an example.
password The password associated with the user name. The password must match
the password defined on the directory server.
search_string The root of the directory on the search that will be searched for policy
information. Typically, the search_string includes o=organization and
c=country. For example, o=company and c=country.
ssl Enables a Secure Socket Layer between the switch and the policy
server.
no ssl Disables a Secure Socket Layer between the switch and the policy
server.

page 19-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

Defaults

parameter default
admin up
port_number 389 (SSL disabled)
636 (SSL enabled)
preference 0
ssl | no ssl no ssl

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you change the port number, another entry is added to the policy server table; an existing port number is
not changed. To remove a port number, use the no form of this command with the relevant policy server
IP address and the port number you want to remove.

Examples
-> policy server 222.22.22.2 port 345 user dirmgr password secret88 searchbase
ou=qos,o=company,c=country

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show policy server Displays information about policies downloaded from an LDAP server.

MIB Objects
DIRECTORYSERVERTABLE
directoryServerAddress
directoryServerPort
directoryServerAdminStatus
directoryServerPreference
directoryServerUserId
directoryServerAuthenticationType
directoryServerPassword
directoryServerSearchbase
directoryServerEnableSSL

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-5


Policy Server Commands

show policy server


Displays information about servers from which policies may be downloaded to the switch.
show policy server

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays basic information about policy servers. Use the show policy server long
command to display more details about the servers.

Examples
-> show policy server

Server IP Address port enabled status primary


------+--------------+-----+---------+--------+--------
1 208.19.33.112 389 Yes Up X
2 208.19.33.66 400 No Down -

output definitions
Server The index number corresponding to the LDAP server.
IP Address The IP address of the LDAP server.
port The TCP/IP port number used by the switch to connect to the policy
server.
enabled Whether or not the policy server is enabled.
status The state of the policy server, Unkn, Up or Down.
primary Indicates whether the server is the primary server; this server will be
used for the next download of policies; only one server is a primary
server.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 19-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

Related Commands

policy server Configures operational parameters for an LDAP-enabled directory


server on which policies are stored.

MIB Objects
directoryServerTable
directoryServerAddress
directoryServerPort
directoryServerAdminState

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-7


Policy Server Commands

show policy server long


Displays more detailed information about an LDAP policy server.
show policy server long

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays detailed information about policy servers. Use the show policy server command
to display basic information about policy servers.

Examples
-> show policy server long
LDAP server 0
IP address : 155.132.44.98,
TCP port : 16652,
Enabled : Yes,
Operational status : Unkn,
Preference : 99,
Authentication : password,
SSL : Disabled,
login DN : cn=Directory Manager,
searchbase : ou:4.1, cn=policyRoot, o=company.fr
Last load time : 09/13/01 16:38:18
LDAP server 1
IP address : 155.132.48.27,,
TCP port : 21890,
Enabled : Yes,
Operational status : Unkn,
Preference : 50,
Authentication : password,
SSL : Disabled,
login DN : cn=Directory Manager,
searchbase : o=company.fr
Last load time : 00/00/00 00:00:00

output definitions
IP address The IP address of the policy server.
TCP port The TCP/IP port number used by the switch to connect to the policy
server.

page 19-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

output definitions (continued)


Enabled Whether or not the policy server is enabled via the PolicyView applica-
tion.
Operational status The state of the policy server, Up or Down.
Preference Determines which directory server is used for policy downloads when
multiple servers are configured. The range is 0–255. The server with
the highest value is used as the policy server. If that server becomes
unavailable, the server with the next highest preference value is used
for policy downloads.
Authentication Displays password if a user name and password was specified for the
server through the policy server command. Displays anonymous if a
user name and password are not configured.
login DN The directory user name.
searchbase The searchbase name, which is the root of the directory that will be
searched for policy download information.
Last load time The date and time that policies were last downloaded. Values of zero
indicate that no policies have been downloaded.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

MIB Objects
directoryServerTable
directoryServerAddress
directoryServerPort
directoryServerPreference
directoryServerAuthenticationType
directoryServerSearchbase
directoryServerUserId
directoryServerPassword
directoryServerCacheChange
directoryServerLastChange
directoryServerAdminStatus
directoryServerOperStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-9


Policy Server Commands

show policy server statistics


Displays statistics about policy directory servers.
show policy server statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays statistics about server downloads. For information about server parameters, use
the show policy server command.

Examples
-> show policy server statistics
Server IP Address port accesses delta successes delta errors delta
------+--------------+-------+---------+-------+----------+-----+-------+------
1 155.132.44.98 16652 793 793 295 295 0 0
2 155.132.48.27 21890 0 0 0 0 0 0

output definitions
Server The index number corresponding to the server.
IP Address The IP address of the LDAP server.
port The TCP/IP port number used by the switch to connect to the policy
server.
accesses The number of times the server was polled by the switch to download
policies.
delta The change in the number of accesses since the last time the policy
server was accessed.
successes The number of times the server was polled by the switch to download
policies and the policies were successfully downloaded.
delta The change in the number of successful policy downloads since the last
time the policy server was accessed.
errors The number of errors returned by the server.
delta The change in the number of errors returned by the server since the last
time the policy server was accessed.

page 19-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy server Configures operational parameters for an LDAP-enabled directory


server on which policies are stored.

MIB Objects
policyStatsTable
policyStatsAddress
policyStatsServerPort
policyStatsAccessCount
policyStatsSuccessAccessCount
policyStatsNotFoundCount

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-11


Policy Server Commands

show policy server rules


Displays the names of policies originating on a directory server that have been downloaded to the switch.
show policy server rules

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays information about policies created on directory servers only. Chapter 17, “QoS
Commands,” for information about configuring and displaying policies directly on the switch.

Examples
-> show policy server rules
Num name prio scope status
---+-------------------+-------+-------------+------------
1 QoSRule1 0 Provisioned Active
2 QoSrule2 0 Provisioned Active
Fields are defined here:

output definitions
Num An index number corresponding to the policy rule.
name The name of the policy rule; only rules configured through PolicyView
are displayed in this table.
prio The priority or preference of the rule. Indicates the order in which rules
will be checked for matching to incoming traffic. If two or more rules
apply to the traffic, the rule with the highest preference is applied. Pref-
erence is determined when the rule is created.
scope The type of rule. Provisioned is the only type valid currently.
status The status of the rule: Active indicates that the rule has been pushed to
the QoS software in the switch and is available to apply to traffic;
notInService means the rule may be pushed to the QoS software in the
future but is not available yet (typically because of a variable validity
period); notReady indicates that the rule will never be pushed to the
QoS software because its validity period has expired or because it has
been disabled through SNMP.

page 19-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

policy server load Downloads policies from a LDAP server. These policies are created
through the PolicyView management application.

MIB Objects
policyRuleNamesTable
policyRuleNamesIndex
policyRuleNamesName
policyRuleOperStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-13


Policy Server Commands

show policy server events


Displays any events related to a directory server on which policies are stored.
show policy server events

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
The display is limited to 50 events.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The Policy Manager initialization event is always the first event logged.

Examples
-> show policy server events
Event Time event description
-----------------+-----------------------------------------------
09/13/01 16:38:15 Policy manager log init
09/13/01 16:38:17 LDAP server 155.132.44.98/16652 defined
09/13/01 16:38:17 LDAP server 155.132.44.98/21890 defined
09/13/01 16:38:18 PDP optimization: PVP day-of-week all 1
09/13/01 16:38:18 PDP optimization: PVP Month all 1
09/13/01 16:38:18 PDP optimization: PVP Month all 1
09/13/01 16:38:18 PDP optimization: PVP Month all 1
09/13/01 16:38:18 PDP optimization: PVP Month all 1
09/13/01 16:38:18 IP address and mask make bad address change on desination IP
address 155.132.44.98:155.132.44.101
:
output definitions
Event Time The date and time the policy event occurred.
event description A description of the event.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 19-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Policy Server Commands

Related Commands

policy server Configures operational parameters for an LDAP-enabled directory


server on which policies are stored.

MIB Objects
policyEventTable
policyEventCode
policyEventDetailString
policyEventIndex
policyEventTime

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 19-15


Policy Server Commands

page 19-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


20 802.1X Commands

This chapter includes information about commands used for configuring and viewing port-specific 802.1X
parameters. Included in this command set are specific commands used to configure Access Guardian poli-
cies (also referred to as device classification policies) for 802.1X ports.
MIB information for the 802.1X port commands is as follows:
Filename: IEEE_8021X.mib
Module: IEEE8021-PAE-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

802.1X port commands 802.1x


802.1x initialize
802.1x re-authenticate
802.1x supp-polling retry
802.1x captive-portal address
802.1x auth-server-down
802.1x auth-server-down policy
802.1x auth-server-down re-authperiod
show 802.1x users
show 802.1x statistics
show 802.1x non-supplicant
show 802.1x auth-server-down
Access Guardian commands 802.1x supplicant policy authentication
802.1x non-supplicant policy authentication
802.1x non-supplicant policy
802.1x policy default
802.1x captive-portal policy authentication
802.1x captive-portal session-limit
802.1x captive-portal retry-count
802.1x captive-portal address
802.1x captive-portal proxy-server-url
show 802.1x device classification policies
show 802.1x auth-server-down

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-1


802.1X Commands

802.1x
Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port. Typically used for port access control on a dedi-
cated 802.1X port.
802.1x slot/port [direction {both | in}] [port-control {force-authorized | force-unauthorized | auto}]
[quiet-period seconds] [tx-period seconds] [supp-timeout seconds] [server-timeout seconds] [max-req
max_req] [re-authperiod seconds] [reauthentication | no reauthentication]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
both Configures bidirectional control on the port.
in Configures control over incoming traffic only.
force-authorized Forces the port control to be authorized, which means that the port is
open without restrictions and behaves as any other non-802.1X port.
Devices do not need to authenticate to traffic through the port.
force-unauthorized Forces the port control to be unauthorized, which means the port cannot
accept any traffic.
auto Configures the switch to dynamically control the port control status
based on authentication exchanges between the 802.1X end station and
the switch. Initially the port is in an unauthorized state; it becomes
authorized if a device successfully completes an 802.1X authentication
exchange with the switch.
quiet-period seconds The time during which the port will not accept an 802.1X authentica-
tion attempt; the timer is activated after any authentication failure.
During the time period specified, the switch will ignore and discard all
Extensible Authentication Protocol over LAN (EAPOL) packets. The
range is 0 to 65535 seconds.
tx-period seconds The time before an EAP Request Identity will be re-transmitted. The
range is 1 to 65535 seconds.
supp-timeout seconds The number of seconds before the switch will time out an 802.1X user
who is attempting to authenticate. The value should be modified to be a
greater value if the authentication process will require additional steps
by the user (for example, entering a challenge).
server-timeout seconds The timeout for the authentication server for authentication attempts.
This value is always superseded by the value configured for the
RADIUS authentication server configured through the aaa radius-
server command.
max_req The maximum number of times the switch will retransmit a request for
authentication information (request identity, password, challenge, etc.)
to the 802.1X user before it times out the authentication session based
on the supp-timeout. The range is 1 to 10.

page 20-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

re-authperiod seconds The amount of time that must expire before the switch requires re-
authentication of the Supplicant on this port. Only applicable when re-
authentication is enabled.
reauthentication Specifies that the port will be reauthenticated after the re-authperiod
timer expires.
no reauthentication Specifies that the port will not be reauthenticated unless the
802.1x re-authenticate command is entered.

Defaults

parameter default
both | in both
force- authorized | force- auto
unauthorized | auto
quiet-period seconds 60
tx-period seconds 30
supp-timeout seconds 30
max_req 2
re-authperiod seconds 3600
reauthentication | no no reauthentication
reauthentication

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To set the port to accept any traffic without requiring 802.1X authentication, use the force-
authorized option.
• Use the vlan port 802.1x command with the disable option to disable 802.1X authentication on the
port.
• Before any device is authenticated through an 802.1X port, the port will only process 802.1X frames
(EAPoL frames) from an unknown source.
• Note that multiple devices can be authenticated on a given 802.1X port. Each device MAC address
received on the port is authenticated and learned separately. Only those that authenticate successfully
are allowed on the port, as described above. Those that fail authentication are blocked from accessing
the 802.1X port.

Examples
-> 802.1x port 3/1 quiet-period 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-3


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

aaa authentication 802.1x Enables/disables the switch for 802.1X authentication.


vlan port 802.1x Enables or disables 802.1X port-based access control on a mobile port.
aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated VLANs,
Authenticated Switch Access, or 802.1X port access control.
802.1x captive-portal address Displays information about ports configured for 802.1X.

MIB Objects
dot1xPaePortTable
dot1xPaePortNumber
dot1xPaePortInitialize
dot1xPaePortReauthenticate
dot1xAuthConfigTable
dot1xAuthAdminControlledDirections
dot1xAuthOperControlledDirections
dot1xAuthAuthControlledPortStatus
dot1xAuthAuthControlledPortControl
dot1xAuthQuitePeriod
dot1xAuthTxPeriod
dot1xAuthSuppTimeout
dot1xAuthServerTimeout
dot1xAuthMaxReq
dot1xAuthReAuthPeriod
dot1xAuthReAuthEnabled

page 20-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

802.1x initialize
Re-initializes a particular 802.1X port. Stops traffic on the port; then requires re-authentication of the port.
802.1x initialize slot/port

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is typically only used for troubleshooting, to reset the port access control mechanism in
the switch.
• When this command is entered, all traffic on the port is stopped; the port is then re-authenticated.
Connectivity is restored with successful re-authentication.

Examples
-> 802.1x initialize 3/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port.

MIB Objects
dot1xPaePortTable
dot1xPaePortInitialize

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-5


802.1X Commands

802.1x re-authenticate
Forces a particular 802.1X port to be re-authenticated.
802.1x reauthenticate slot/port

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.

Defaults
By default, 802.1X ports are not configured for periodic re-authentication. Use the 802.1x re-authenti-
cate command to force a re-authentication.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command forces a port to be re-authenticated, regardless of the re-authentication setting config-
ured for the 802.1x command.
• Re-authentication is transparent to the user. It does not affect traffic on the port unless there is a prob-
lem with the physical device connected to the port. The re-authentication mechanism verifies that there
is a device connected to the port, and that the authentication exchange is still valid.

Examples
-> 802.1x reauthenticate 3/1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port.

MIB Objects
dot1xPaePortTable
dot1xPaePortReauthenticate

page 20-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

802.1x supp-polling retry


Configures the number of times to poll a device for EAP frames to determine whether or not the device is
an 802.1x client.
802.1x slot/port supp-polling retry retries

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number of the 802.1x port.
port The 802.1x port number.
retries The number of times a device is polled for EAP frames (0–99).

Defaults
By default, the number of retries is set to 2.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guideline
• The polling interval is 0.5 seconds between each retry.

• If no EAP frames are received from a device connected to an 802.1x port, the device is considered a
non-802.1x client (non-supplicant).
• Specify 0 for the number of retries to bypass polling attempts and automatically classify the device
connected to the 802.1x port as a non-supplicant.
• Any devices previously authenticated on the port remain authenticated; however, re-authentication will
not occur.
• If a guest VLAN is configured on the 802.1x port, the non-802.1x client is assigned to the guest
VLAN. If a guest VLAN does not exist, the device is blocked from accessing the 802.1x port.

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 supp-polling retry 5
-> 802.1x 3/9 supp-polling retry 10
-> 802.1x 2/1 supp-polling retry 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-7


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal address Displays information about ports configured for 802.1X.
show 802.1x non-supplicant Displays a list of all non-802.1x supplicants learned on one or more
802.1x ports.Displays a list of all non-802.1x supplicants learned on one
or more 802.1x ports.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xSuppPollingCnt

page 20-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

802.1x supplicant policy authentication


Configures a supplicant device classification policy for an 802.1x port. This type of policy uses 802.1x
authentication via a remote RADIUS server. A supplicant is any device that uses the 802.1x protocol for
authentication.
802.1x slot/port supplicant policy authentication [[pass] {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan |
block | captive-portal}...] [[fail] {vlan vid | block | captive-portal}...]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
pass Indicates which policies to apply if 802.1x authentication is successful
but does not return a VLAN ID.
fail Indicates which policies to apply if 802.1x authentication fails or if
successful authentication returns a VLAN ID that does not exist.
group-mobility Use Group Mobility rules for device classification.
vlan vid Use this VLAN ID number for device classification.
default-vlan Assigns supplicant to the default VLAN for the 802.1x port.
block Blocks supplicant access on the 802.1x port.
captive-portal Use Captive Portal for web-based device classification.

Defaults
When 802.1x is enabled on the port, a default supplicant policy is defined for the port. This policy uses the
group-mobility and default-vlan parameters for the pass case and the block parameter for the fail case.
When the 802.1x supplicant policy authentication command is used without specifying any parameters,
the following values for the pass and fail case are configured by default:

parameter default
pass block
fail block

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Supplicant device classification policies are applied only when successful 802.1x authentication does
not return a VLAN ID, returns a VLAN ID that does not exist, or authentication fails.
• When authentication does return a VLAN ID that exists in the switch configuration, the supplicant is
assigned to that VLAN and no further classification is performed.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-9


802.1X Commands

• IF this command is used without specifying any of the optional policy keywords or a pass/fail parame-
ter (e.g. 802.1x 1/10 supplicant authentication), the resulting policy will block supplicants if success-
ful 802.1x authentication does not return a VLAN ID, returns a VLAN ID that does not exist, or
authentication fails.
• When multiple parameters are configured, the policy is referred to as a compound supplicant policy.
Such policies use the pass and fail parameters to specify which policies to use when 802.1x authentica-
tion is successful and which to use when it fails.
• The pass keyword is implied and therefore an optional keyword. If the fail keyword is not used, the
default action is to block the device when authentication fails.
• The order in which parameters are specified determines the order in which they are applied. However,
this type of policy must end with either the default-vlan or block, or captive-portal parameters,
referred to as terminal parameters (or policies). This applies to both pass and fail policies. If a terminal
parameter is not specified, the block parameter is used by default.
• If the captive-portal parameter is specified with this command, the Captive Portal authentication
policy is applied to supplicant traffic. See the 802.1x captive-portal policy authentication command
page for more information.
• Configuring supplicant classification policies is only supported on 802.1x enabled mobile ports.

• Each 802.1x port can have one supplicant policy and one non-supplicant policy for handling 802.1x
and non-802.1x devices, respectively. Configuring a new supplicant or non-supplicant policy over-
writes any policies that may already exist for the port.

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 supplicant policy authentication
-> 802.1x 4/1 supplicant policy authentication vlan 27 default-vlan
-> 802.1x 5/1 supplicant policy authentication group-mobility captive-portal
-> 802.1x 5/10 supplicant policy authentication pass group-mobility default-vlan
fail vlan 43 block
-> 802.1x 6/1 supplicant policy authentication pass group-mobility default-vlan
fail captive-portal

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 20-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures MAC authentication device classification policies for non-
authentication supplicants.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures device classification policies that do not perform 802.1x or
MAC authentication for non-supplicants.
802.1x policy default Resets the device classification policy to the default policy value for the
802.1x port.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for an 802.1x port.
classification policies
show 802.1x non-supplicant Displays a list of all non-supplicants learned on all 802.1x ports.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xSuppPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-11


802.1X Commands

802.1x non-supplicant policy authentication


Configures a non-supplicant device classification policy for an 802.1x port. This type of policy uses MAC
authentication via a remote RADIUS server. A non-supplicant is a device that does not support using the
802.1x protocol for authentication.
802.1x slot/port non-supplicant policy authentication [[pass] {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan |
block | captive-portal}] [[fail] {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan | block | captive-portal}]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
pass Indicates which policies to apply if MAC authentication is successful
but does not return a VLAN ID or the VLAN ID returned does not exist.
fail Indicates which policies to apply if MAC authentication fails.
group-mobility Use Group Mobility rules for device classification.
vlan vid Use this VLAN ID number for device classification.
default-vlan Assigns supplicant to the default VLAN for the 802.1x port.
block Blocks supplicant traffic on the 802.1x port.
captive-portal Use Captive Portal for web-based device classification.

Defaults
When 802.1x is enabled on the port, all non-supplicant traffic is blocked by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Non-supplicant device classification policies are applied only when successful MAC authentication
does not return a VLAN ID, returns a VLAN ID that does not exist, or MAC authentication fails.
• When MAC authentication does return a VLAN ID that exists in the switch configuration, the suppli-
cant is assigned to that VLAN and no further classification is performed.
• When multiple parameters are configured, the policy is referred to as a compound non-supplicant
policy. Such policies use the pass and fail parameters to specify which policies to use when MAC
authentication is successful and which to use when it fails.
• The pass keyword is implied and therefore an optional keyword. If the fail keyword is not used, the
default action is to block the device when authentication fails.
• The order in which the parameters are specified determines the order in which they are applied.
However, this type of policy must end with either the default-vlan or block, or captive-portal parame-
ters, referred to as terminal parameters (or policies). This applies to both pass and fail policies. If a
terminal parameter is not specified, the block parameter is used by default.

page 20-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

• If the captive-portal parameter is specified with this command, then the Captive Portal authentication
policy is applied to supplicant traffic. See the 802.1x captive-portal policy authentication command
page for more information.
• Configuring non-supplicant classification policies is only supported on 802.1x enabled mobile ports.

• Each 802.1x port can have one supplicant policy and one non-supplicant policy for handling 802.1x
and non-802.1x devices, respectively. Configuring a new supplicant or non-supplicant policy over-
writes any policies that may already exist for the port.

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 non-supplicant policy authentication
-> 802.1x 4/1 non-supplicant policy authentication pass group-mobility fail
default-vlan
-> 802.1x 5/1 non-supplicant policy authentication group-mobility captive-portal
-> 802.1x 5/10 non-supplicant policy authentication vlan 27 fail vlan 500 default-
vlan
-> 802.1x 2/1 non-supplicant policy authentication vlan 10 default-vlan
-> 802.1x 6/1 non-supplicant policy authentication pass group-mobility default-vlan
fail captive-portal

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.Release 6.3.1; capitive-portal parameter added.

Related Commands

802.1x supplicant policy Configures 802.1x authentication device classification policies for sup-
authentication plicants.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures device classification policies that do not perform 802.1x or
MAC authentication for non-supplicants.
802.1x policy default Resets the device classification policy to the default policy value for the
802.1x port.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for an 802.1x port.
classification policies
show 802.1x non-supplicant Displays a list of all non-supplicants learned on all 802.1x ports.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xNonSuppPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-13


802.1X Commands

802.1x non-supplicant policy


Configures a non-supplicant device classification policy for an 802.1x port. This type of policy does not
perform any authentication. A non-supplicant is a device that does not support using the 802.1x protocol
for authentication.
802.1x slot/port non-supplicant policy {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan | block | captive-
portal}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
group-mobility Use Group Mobility rules for device classification.
vlan vid Use this VLAN ID number for device classification.
default-vlan Assign supplicant to the default VLAN for the 802.1x port.
block Block supplicant traffic on the 802.1x port.
captive-portal Use Captive Portal for web-based device classification.

Defaults
By default no device classification policies are configured for an 802.1x port.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Because this policy does not use 802.1x or MAC authentication, non-supplicants are only classified for
assignment to non-authenticated VLANs.
• Note that if a non-supplicant policy is not configured for an 802.1x port, then non-supplicants are auto-
matically blocked from accessing the port.
• If the captive-portal parameter is specified with this command, then the Captive Portal authentication
policy is applied to non-supplicant traffic. See the 802.1x captive-portal policy authentication
command page for more information.
• Configuring non-supplicant classification policies is only supported on 802.1x enabled mobile ports.

• Each 802.1x port can have one supplicant policy and one non-supplicant policy for handling 802.1x
and non-802.1x devices, respectively. Configuring a new supplicant or non-supplicant policy over-
writes any policies that may already exist for the port.

Examples
-> 802.1x 4/1 non-supplicant policy group-mobility default-vlan
-> 802.1x 5/10 non-supplicant policy vlan 500 block
-> 8022.1x 6/1 non-supplicant policy group-mobility vlan 247 block
-> 802.1x 4/10 non-supplicant policy captive-portal

page 20-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x supplicant policy Configures 802.1x authentication device classification policies for sup-
authentication plicants.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures MAC authentication device classification policies for non-
authentication supplicants.
802.1x policy default Resets the device classification policy to the default policy value for the
802.1x port.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for an 802.1x port.
classification policies
show 802.1x non-supplicant Displays a list of all non-supplicants learned on all 802.1x ports.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xNonSuppPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-15


802.1X Commands

802.1x policy default


Resets the device classification policy to the default value for the 802.1x port.
802.1x slot/port {supplicant | non-supplicant} policy default

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
supplicant Reset the supplicant policy to the default policy value.
non-supplicant Reset the non-supplicant policy to the default policy value.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The default non-supplicant policy blocks all non-supplicants from accessing the 802.1x port.

• The default supplicant policy blocks supplicants that fail authentication. If authentication is successful
but does not return a VLAN ID, then Group Mobility rules are examined. If no rules exist or match
supplicant traffic, then the supplicant is assigned to the default VLAN for the 802.1x port.

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 supplicant policy default
-> 802.1x 4/1 non-supplicant policy default

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 20-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

802.1x supplicant policy Configures 802.1x authentication device classification policies for sup-
authentication plicants.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures MAC authentication device classification policies for non-
authentication supplicants.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures device classification policies that do not perform 802.1x or
MAC authentication for non-supplicants.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for an 802.1x port.
classification policies
show 802.1x non-supplicant Displays a list of all non-supplicants learned on all 802.1x ports.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xSuppPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-17


802.1X Commands

802.1x captive-portal policy authentication


Configures a Captive Portal device classification policy for an 802.1x port. This type of policy classifies
both supplicants and non-supplicants that have attempted network access using web-based authentication.
802.1x slot/port captive-portal policy authentication pass {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan |
block}] [fail] {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan | block}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
pass Indicates which policies to apply if authentication is successful but does
not return a VLAN ID or the VLAN ID returned does not exist.
fail Indicates which policies to apply if authentication fails.
group-mobility Use Group Mobility rules for device classification.
vlan vid Use this VLAN ID number for device classification.
default-vlan Assigns the device to the default VLAN for the 802.1x port.
block Blocks device traffic on the 802.1x port.

Defaults
A default Captive Portal policy is automatically configured when 802.1x is enabled on a port. This default
policy uses the default-vlan parameter for the pass case and the block parameter for the fail case.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Captive Portal device classification policies are applied only when successful web-based authentica-
tion does not return a VLAN ID, returns a VLAN ID that does not exist, or when web-based authenti-
cation fails.
• When web-based authentication does return a VLAN ID that exists in the switch configuration, the
device is assigned to that VLAN and no further classification is performed.
• When multiple parameters are configured, the policy is referred to as a compound non-supplicant
policy. Such policies use the pass and fail parameters to specify which policies to use when MAC
authentication is successful and which to use when it fails.
• If the fail keyword is not used, the default action is to block the device when authentication fails.

• The order in which the parameters are specified determines the order in which they are applied.
However, this type of policy must end with either the default-vlan or block parameters, referred to as
terminal parameters (or policies). This applies to both pass and fail policies.
• Captive Portal policies are applied only to 802.1x enabled mobile ports that are configured with an
802.1x supplicant or non-supplicant policy that specifies the use of Captive Portal web-based authenti-
cation.

page 20-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 captive-portal policy authentication pass vlan 100 block fail vlan 10
-> 802.1x 4/1 captive-portal policy authentication pass group-mobility

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x supplicant policy Configures 802.1x authentication device classification policies for sup-
authentication plicants.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures device classification policies that do not perform 802.1x or
MAC authentication for non-supplicants.
802.1x captive-portal session- Configures the length of a Captive Portal session and the number of
limit login attempts allowed before the device is classified as a failed login.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for an 802.1x port.
classification policies
show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the Captive Portal configuration information (session time
limit and the number of login retries) for the specified 802.1x port.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xCaptivePortalPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-19


802.1X Commands

802.1x captive-portal session-limit


Configures the length of an active Captive Portal session.
802.1x slot/port captive-portal session-limit time

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
time The amount of time the Captive Portal session remains active. Valid
range is from 1—999 hours.

Defaults

parameter default
time 12 hours

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The parameters configured with this command apply to the Captive Portal configuration for the speci-
fied 802.1x port.
• At the end of the Captive Portal session time limit, the user is automatically logged out of the session
and is no longer allowed to access the network.

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 captive-portal session-limit 8 retry-count 5
-> 802.1x 4/1 captive-portal session-limit 4 retry-count 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced..

page 20-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal retry- Configures the number of login attempts allowed before the Captive
count Portal fail policy is applied to the device.
802.1x captive-portal policy Configures a Captive Portal device classification policy for an 802.1x
authentication port.
show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the global Captive Portal configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xCaptivePortalSessionLimit

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-21


802.1X Commands

802.1x captive-portal retry-count


Configures the number of login attempts allowed before the Captive Portal fail policy is applied to the
device.
802.1x slot/port captive-portal retry-count retries

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port.
retries The number of login attempts allowed (1–99).

Defaults

parameter default
retries 3

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The parameters configured with this command apply to the Captive Portal configuration for the speci-
fied 802.1x port.
• When a device has failed the allowed number of login attempts, the fail case for the Captive Portal
policy configured for the 802.1x port is applied. To allow an unlimited number of login attempts, spec-
ify zero for the retry count value.

Examples
-> 802.1x 3/1 captive-portal session-limit 8 retry-count 5
-> 802.1x 4/1 captive-portal session-limit 4 retry-count 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced..

page 20-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal session- Configures the length of an active Captive Portal session.
limit
802.1x captive-portal policy Configures a Captive Portal device classification policy for an 802.1x
authentication port.
show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the global Captive Portal configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xCaptivePortalRetryCnt

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-23


802.1X Commands

802.1x captive-portal address


Configures a different subnet for the Captive Portal IP address (10.123.0.1).
802.1x captive-portal address ip_address

Syntax Definitions
address The IP address for the Captive Portal login page. This IP address must
use the following octet values: 10.x.0.1, where “x” is used to specify a
new subnet value.

Defaults
By default, the Captive Portal IP address is set to 10.123.0.1.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the 10.123.0.1 subnet is already in use on the network, use this command to change the second octet
of this IP address. Note that the second octet is the only configurable part of the Captive Portal IP
address that is allowed.
• This IP address is used exclusively by the Captive Portal feature to serve various pages and to assign a
temporary IP address for a client device that is attempting web-based authentication.

Examples
-> 802.1x captive-portal address 10.11.0.1
-> 802.1x captive-portal address 10.124.0.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the global Captive Portal configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xCportalConfig
alaDot1xCPortalIpAddress

page 20-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

802.1x captive-portal proxy-server-url


Configures Captive Portal to work with a specific proxy server URL used by the client.
802.1x captive-portal proxy-server-url proxy_url

Syntax Definitions
proxy_url The URL address for the users proxy server.

Defaults
By default, the proxy server URL value is set to proxy. Captive Portal will look for the word “proxy” to
identify the users web server URL.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Changing the Captive Portal proxy server URL value is only necessary if the proxy server URL does
not contain any of following in the address:
www
http
https
proxy
• When using a proxy server with Microsoft’s Internet Explorer browser, select the “bypass proxy for
local address” option.
• When using a proxy server with the Firefox or Netscape browsers, add the name “captive-portal” to the
proxy exception list.

Examples
-> 802.1x captive-portal proxy-server-url www.companyname.com

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the global Captive Portal configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xCportalConfig
alaDot1xCPortalProxyURL

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-25


802.1X Commands

802.1x auth-server-down
Enables or disables the authentication server down classification policy.
802.1x auth-server-down {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the auth-server-down policy.
disable Disables the auth-server-down policy.

Defaults
By default, authentication server down policy is disabled.

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to enable or disable the authentication server down policy.

• This command is global and applies to all ports on the switch.

Examples
-> 802.1x auth-server-down enable
-> 802.1x auth-server-down disable

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the configured authentication server down classification pol-
icy.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthSvrTimeoutStatus

page 20-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

802.1x auth-server-down policy


Configures the policy for classifying the device when the authentication server is not reachable.
802.1x auth-server-down policy {user-network-profile profile_name | block}

Syntax Definitions
profile_name The name of an existing User Network Profile (UNP) to use for device
classification.
block Blocks supplicant access on the 802.1x port.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to configure the authentication server down classification policy.

• Use the optional parameter block to restrict the device traffic on the 802.1x port.

• This command is global and applies to all ports on the switch.

Examples
-> 802.1x auth-server-down policy user-network-profile
-> 802.1x auth-server-down policy block

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the configured authentication server down classification pol-
icy.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthServerTimeoutPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-27


802.1X Commands

802.1x auth-server-down re-authperiod


Sets re-authentication time for the device to authenticate again with the RADIUS server when it is classi-
fied acoording to the Auth-server-down policy.
802.1x auth-server-down re-authperiod {value}

Syntax Definitions
value The value of re-authentication timer.The range is 1 to 9999 seconds.

Defaults

parameter default
re-authperiod value 3600

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to set the time for the device to re-authenticate.

Examples
-> 802.1x auth-server-down re-authperiod 30

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show 802.1x auth-server-down Displays the configured authentication server down classification pol-
icy.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthSvrTimeoutReAuthPeriod

page 20-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x
Displays information about ports configured for 802.1X.
show 802.1x [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot of the port for which you want to display information.
port The port for which you want to display 802.1X information.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify a particular slot/port, information for all 802.1X ports is displayed.

Examples
-> show 802.1x 1/13

802.1x configuration for slot 1 port 13:

direction = both,
operational directions = both,
port-control = auto,
quiet-period (seconds) = 60,
tx-period (seconds) = 30,
supp-timeout (seconds) = 30,
server-timeout (seconds) = 30,
max-req = 2,
re-authperiod (seconds) = 3600,
reauthentication = no
Supplicant polling retry count = 2

output definitions
direction Whether the port is configured for control on bidirectional traffic or
incoming traffic only. May be configured through the 802.1x com-
mand. Possible values are both or in.
operational directions The operational state of controlled direction on the port, which is set
automatically by the switch. If the value of direction is both, the value
of operational directions is both. If the value of direction is in, the
operational state is set to in on initialization and when the port’s MAC
address becomes operable. If the port’s MAC address becomes inopera-
ble, the operational direction is set to both.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-29


802.1X Commands

output definitions (continued)


port-control The value of the port control parameter for the port (auto, force-autho-
rized, or force-unauthorized), which is set through the 802.1x com-
mand.
quiet-period The time during which the port will not accept an 802.1X authentica-
tion attempt; the timer is activated after any authentication failure. The
range is 0 to 65535 seconds.
tx-period The time before an EAP Request Identity will be transmitted. The range
is 1 to 65535 seconds.
supp-timeout The number of seconds before the switch will time out an 802.1x user
who is attempting to authenticate.
server-timeout The timeout for the authentication server for authentication attempts.
This value is always superseded by the value configured for the
RADIUS authentication server configured through the aaa radius-
server command.
max-req The maximum number of times the switch will retransmit a request for
authentication information (request identity, password, challenge, etc.)
to the 802.1X user before it times out the authentication session based
on the supp-timeout. The range is 1 to 10.
re-authperiod The amount of time that must expire before the switch requires re-
authentication of the Supplicant on this port. Only applicable when re-
authentication is enabled.
reauthentication Whether or not the port will be re-authenticated after the re-authperiod
expires.
Supplicant polling retry count The number of times a device is polled for EAP frames to determine
whether or not the device is an 802.1x client. Configured through the
802.1x supp-polling retry command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port.


802.1x supp-polling retry Configures the number of times to poll a device for EAP frames to
determine whether or not the device is an 802.1x client.

page 20-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

MIB Objects
dot1xAuthConfigTable
dot1xAuthAdminControlledDirections
dot1xAuthOperControlledDirections
dot1xAuthAuthControlledPortControl
dot1xAuthQuietPeriod
dot1xAuthTxPeriod
dot1xAuthSuppTimeout
dot1xAuthServerTimeout
dot1xAuthMaxReq
dot1xAuthReAuthPeriod
dot1xAuthReAuthEnabled
alaDot1xSuppPollingCnt

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-31


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x users


Displays a list of all users for one or more 802.1X ports.
show 802.1x users [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot of the port for which you want to display information.
port The port for which you want to display 802.1X information.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify a particular slot/port, all users associated with 802.1X ports are displayed.

Examples
->show 802.1x users

Slot MAC Port User


Port Address State Policy Name
-----+-----------------+--------------------+---------+------------------
3/1 00:60:4f:11:22:33 Authenticated VLAN ID user50
3/1 00:60:4f:44:55:66 Authenticated VLAN ID user51
3/1 00:60:4f:77:88:99 Authenticated VLAN ID user52
3/3 00:60:22:15:22:33 Force-authenticated N/A
3/3 00:60:22:44:75:66 Force-authenticated N/A
3/3 00:60:22:37:98:09 Force-authenticated N/A

->show 802.1x users 3/1

Slot MAC Port User


Port Address State Policy Name
-----+-----------------+--------------------+---------+------------------
3/1 00:60:4f:11:22:33 Connecting VLAN ID user50
3/1 00:60:4f:44:55:66 Held VLAN ID user51
3/1 00:60:4f:77:88:99 Authenticated VLAN ID user52

output definitions
Slot/Port The 802.1X slot and port number that provides access to the user.
MAC Address The source MAC address of the 802.1X user.

page 20-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

output definitions (continued)


Port State The current state of the 802.1X port for a specific user:
• Initialize
• Disconnected
• Connecting
• Authenticating
• Authenticated
• Authenticated-L
• Authenticated-T - Supplicant learned according to the auth-server-
down policy
• Aborting
• Held
• Force-Authenticated
• Force-Unauthenticated
Policy The 802.1x device classification policy that was applied to the device.
User Name The user name that is used for authentication.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xPortTable
alaDot1xPortSlotNumber
alaDot1xPortPortNumber
alaDot1xPortMACAddress
alaDot1xPortUserName
alaDot1xPortState
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xSuppPolicy
alaDot1xNonSuppPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-33


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x statistics


Displays statistics about all 802.1X ports or for a particular 802.1X port.
show 802.1x statistics [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot of the port for which you want to display 802.1X statistics.
port The port for which you want to display 802.1X statistics.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify a particular slot/port, information for each 802.1X port is displayed.

Examples
-> show 802.1x statistic 1/13
802.1x slot/port = 1/13
Last EAPOL frame source = 00:0d:0c:00:00:02
Last EAPOL frame version = 1,
EAPOL frames received = 3,
EAPOL frames transmitted = 3,
EAPOL start frames received = 1,
EAPOL logoff frames received = 0,
EAP Resp/Id frames received = 1,
EAP Response frames received = 1,
EAP Req/Id frames transmitted = 1,
EAP Req frames transmitted = 1,
EAP length error frames received = 0,
Invalid EAPOL frames received = 0,

output definitions
Slot The slot number of the 802.1X port.
Port The 802.1X port number.
Last EAPOL frame version The protocol version number carried in the most recently received
EAPOL frame.
Last EAPOL frame source The source MAC address carried in the most recently received EAPOL
frame.
EAPOL frames received The number of valid EAPOL frames of any type that have been
received by the switch.

page 20-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

output definitions (continued)


EAPOL frames transmitted The number of EAPOL frames of any type that have been transmitted
by the switch.
EAPOL Start frames received The number of EAPOL Start frames that have been received by the
switch.
EAPOL Logoff frames The number of EAPOL Logoff frames that have been received by the
received switch.
EAP Resp/Id frames received The number of EAP Resp/Id frames that have been received by the
switch.
EAP Response frames The number of valid EAP Response frames (other than Resp/Id frames)
received that have been received by the switch.
EAP Req/Id frames The number of EAP Req/Id frames that have been transmitted by the
transmitted switch.
EAP Req frames The number of valid EAP Request frames (other than Req/Id frames)
transmitted that have been transmitted by the switch.
EAP length error frames The number of EAPOL frames that have been received by the switch
received for which the Packet Body Length field is invalid.
Invalid EAPOL frames The number of EAPOL frames that have been received by the switch
received for which the frame type is not recognized by the switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal address Displays information about ports configured for 802.1X.

MIB Objects
dot1xAuthStatsTable
dot1xAuthEapolFramesRx
dot1xAuthEapolFramesTx
dot1xAuthEapolStartFramesRx
dot1xAuthEapolLogoffFramesRx
dot1xAuthEapolRespIdFramesRx
dot1xAuthEapolRespFramesRx
dot1xAuthEapolReqIdFramesTx
dot1xAuthEapolReqFramesTx
dot1xAuthInvalidEapolFramesRx
dot1xAuthEapLengthErrorFramesRx
dot1xAuthLastEapolFrameVersion
dot1xAuthLastEapolFrameSource

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-35


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x device classification policies


Displays device classification policies configured for 802.1x ports.
show 802.1x device classification policies [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port for which you want to
display the policy configuration.

Defaults
All device classification policies for all 802.1x ports are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot/port parameter to display device classification policies for a specific 802.1X port.

Examples
-> show 802.1x device classification policies
Device classification policies on 802.1x port 2/26
Supplicant:
authentication, block
Non-Supplicant:
block
Device classification policies on 802.1x port 2/47
Supplicant:
authentication, block
Non-Supplicant:
block
Device classification policies on 802.1x port 2/48
Supplicant:
authentication, vlan 247, default-vlan
Non-Supplicant:
authentication:
pass: group-mobility, block
fail: strict-vlan 347, default-vlan

-> show 802.1x device classification policies 2/48


Device classification policies on 802.1x port 2/48
Supplicant:
authentication, vlan 247, default-vlan
Non-Supplicant:
authentication:
pass: group-mobility, block
fail: strict-vlan 347, default-vlan

page 20-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

output definitions
Supplicant: Displays the supplicant device classification policy configured for the
802.1x port.
Non-Supplicant: Displays the non-supplicant device classification policy configured for
the 802.1x port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal address Displays information about ports configured for 802.1X.
show 802.1x non-supplicant Displays a list of all non-supplicants learned on all 802.1x ports.

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xSuppPolicy
alaDot1xNonSuppPolicy

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-37


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x non-supplicant


Displays a list of all non-802.1x supplicants learned on one or more 802.1x ports.
show 802.1x non-supplicant [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot/port number of the 802.1x port for which you want to display
information.

Defaults
All non-supplicants associated with all 802.1X ports are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the slot/port parameter to display a list of non-supplicants learned on a specific 802.1x port.

Examples
->show 802.1x non-supplicant

Slot MAC Authentication Classification Vlan


Port Address Status Policy Learned
-----+-----------------+----------------+--------------+--------
03/3 00:61:22:15:22:33 Failed Vlan ID 1001
03/3 00:61:22:44:75:66 Authenticated MAC Authent 14
03/11 00:00:39:47:4f:0c Failed Vlan ID 1001
03/11 00:00:39:c9:5a:0c Authenticated Group Mobility 12
03/11 00:b0:d0:52:47:35 Authenticated Group Mobility 12
03/11 00:c0:4f:0e:70:68 Authenticated MAC Authent 14

->show 802.1x non-supp 3/3

Slot MAC Authentication Classification Vlan


Port Address Status Policy Learned
-----+-----------------+----------------+--------------+--------
03/3 00:61:22:15:22:33 Failed Vlan ID 1001
03/3 00:61:22:44:75:66 Authenticated MAC Authent 14

output definitions
Slot/Port The 802.1X slot and port number that provides access to the
non-802.1x device.
MAC Address The source MAC address of the non-802.1x device connected to the
802.1x port.

page 20-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

output definitions (continued)


Authentication Status Indicates whether or not MAC authentication failed.
• Success - Non-supplicant learned according to the Success policy.
• Failed - Non-supplicant learned according to the Failed policy
• Fail (timeout) - Non-Supplicant learned according to the auth-
server-down policy.
Classification Policy The 802.1x device classification policy that was applied to the device.
VLAN Learned The VLAN ID of the VLAN in which the source MAC address of the
non-802.1x device was learned.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal address Displays information about ports configured for 802.1X.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for an 802.1x port.
classification policies

MIB Objects
alaDot1xPortTable
alaDot1xNonSupplicantSlotNum
alaDot1xNonSupplicantPortNum
alaDot1xNonSupplicantMACAddress
alaDot1xNonSupplicantVlanID

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-39


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x auth-server-down


Displays the configured authentication server down classification policy.
show 802.1x auth-server-down

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show 802.1x auth-server-down

Status = Enabled
Re-authentication Interval = 30 seconds
Classification policy = block

-> show 802.1x auth-server-down

Status = Disabled
Re-authentication Interval = 30 seconds
Classification policy = block

output definitions
Status Authentication server down policy status: Enabled or Disabled
Re-authentication Interval The amount of time for the device to authenticate again with the
RADIUS server when it is classified according to the Auth-server-pol-
icy.
Classification Policy The 802.1x device classification policy that was applied to the device.

Release History
Release 6.6.2; command was introduced.

page 20-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Related Commands

802.1x auth-server-down Enables or disables the authentication server down policy.


802.1x auth-server-down policy Configures the policy for classifying the device when the authentication
server is not reachable
802.1x auth-server-down re- Configures the re-authentication time for the device to authenticate again
authperiod with the RADIUS server when it is classified acoording to the Auth-
server-down policy

MIB Objects

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-41


802.1X Commands

show 802.1x captive-portal configuration


Displays the Captive Portal configuration information (session time limit and the number of login retries)
for the specified 802.1x port.
show 802.1x captive-portal configuration [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot and port number of the 802.1x port for which you want to
display the configuration.

Defaults
By default, the Capitve Portal session limit and login retry count are displayed for all 802.1x ports if the
slot/port parameter is not specified..

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the slot/port parameter to display the Captive Portal configuration for a specific 802.1X port.

• This command only displays information for 802.1x ports that are configured with a Captive Portal
device classification policy.

Examples
-> show 802.1x captive-portal configuration

802.1x Captive Portal configuration for slot 7 port 11:

Session Limit (hours) = 4,


Login Retry Count = 5,

802.1x Captive Portal configuration for slot 8 port 1:

Session Limit (hours) = 8,


Login Retry Count = 2,

-> show 802.1x captive-portal configuration 8/1

802.1x Captive Portal configuration for slot 8 port 1:

Session Limit (hours) = 8,


Login Retry Count = 2,

output definitions
Session Limit (hours) The length of the Captive Portal session, in hours..
Login Retry Count The number of login retries allowed.

page 20-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


802.1X Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x captive-portal session- Configures the length of a Captive Portal session and the number of
limit login attempts allowed before the device is classified as a failed login.
show 802.1x device Displays device classification policies configured for 802.1x ports.
classification policies

MIB Objects
alaDot1xAuthPolicyTable
alaDot1xCaptivePortalSessionLimit
alaDot1xCaptivePortalRetryCnt

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 20-43


802.1X Commands

page 20-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


21 AAA Commands

This chapter includes descriptions for authentication, authorization, and accounting (AAA) commands.
The commands are used for configuring the type of authentication as well as the AAA servers and the
local user database on the switch.
• Authenticated Switch Access. Authenticates users into the switch to manage the switch. User informa-
tion is stored on a RADIUS, TACACS+, LDAP, or ACE/Server; or information may be stored locally
in the switch user database.
• Local user database. User information may be configured for Authenticated Switch Access. For
functional management access, users may be allowed to access specific command families or domains.
Alternately, users may be configured with a profile that specifies access to particular ports or VLANs.
MIB information for the AAA commands is as follows:
Filename: alcatelIND1AAA.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-AAA-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

Authentication servers aaa radius-server


aaa tacacs+-server
aaa ldap-server
aaa ace-server clear
show aaa server
Authenticated Switch Access aaa authentication
aaa authentication default
aaa accounting session
aaa accounting command
show aaa authentication
show aaa accounting
802.1X Port-Based Network aaa authentication 802.1x
Access Control aaa authentication mac
aaa accounting 802.1x
show aaa authentication mac
show aaa accounting 802.1x
Local User Database and user
Partitioned Management password
user password-size min
user password-expiration
show user
show aaa priv hexa

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-1


AAA Commands

Password Policy user password-size min


user password-expiration
user password-policy cannot-contain-username
user password-policy min-uppercase
user password-policy min-lowercase
user password-policy min-digit
user password-policy min-nonalpha
user password-history
user password-size min
user password-min-age
user password-expiration
show user
show user password-size
show user password-expiration
show user password-policy
User Lockout Settings user lockout-window
user lockout-threshold
user lockout-duration
user lockout unlock
show user
show user lockout-setting
End-user Profiles user
end-user profile
end-user profile port-list
end-user profile vlan-range
show end-user profile
User Network Profiles aaa user-network-profile
show aaa user-network-profile

page 21-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

aaa radius-server
Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch Access or 802.1X port access control.
aaa radius-server server [host {hostname | ip_address} [hostname2 | ip_address2]] [key secret]
[retransmit retries] [timeout seconds] [auth-port auth_port] [acct-port acct_port]
no aaa radius server server

Syntax Definitions
server The name of the RADIUS server.
hostname The host name (DNS name) of the primary RADIUS server. The host
name or IP address is required when creating a server.
ip_address The IP address of the primary RADIUS server. An IP address or host
name is required when creating a server.
hostname2 The host name (DNS name) of an optional backup RADIUS server.
ip_address2 The IP address of an optional backup RADIUS server.
secret The shared secret known to the switch and the server, but which is not
sent over the network. Can be any text or hexadecimal string but MUST
match the secret configured on the server. The secret is case-sensitive.
Required when creating a server.
retries The number of retries the switch makes to authenticate a user before
trying the backup server (hostname2 or ip_address2).
seconds The timeout for server replies to authentication requests.
auth_port The UDP destination port for authentication requests.
acct_port The UDP destination port for accounting requests.

Defaults

parameter default
retries 3
seconds 2
auth_port 1812
acct_port 1813

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-3


AAA Commands

Usage Guidelines
• A host name (or IP address) and a secret are required when configuring a server.

• The server and the backup server must both be RADIUS servers.

• Use the no form of the command to remove a RADIUS server from the configuration. Only one server
may be deleted at a time.

Examples
-> aaa radius-server pubs2 host 10.10.2.1 key wwwtoe timeout 5
-> no aaa radius-server pubs2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show aaa server Displays information about AAA servers.


aaa authentication Specifies the AAA servers to be used for Authenticated Switch
Access.
aaa accounting session Specifies the accounting servers to be used for Authenticated
Switch Access.

MIB Objects
aaaServerTable
aaasProtocol
aaasHostName
aaasIpAddress
aaasHostName2
aaasIpAddress2
aaasRadKey
aaasRetries
aaasTimout
aaasRadAuthPort
aaasRadAcctPort

page 21-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

aaa tacacs+-server
Configures or modifies a TACACS+ server for Authenticated Switch Access.
aaa tacacs+-server server [host {hostname | ip_address} {hostname2 | ip_address2}] [key secret]
[timeout seconds] [port port]
no aaa tacacs+-server server

Syntax Definitions
server The name of the TACACS+ server.
hostname The host name (DNS name) of the primary TACACS+ server. The host
name or IP address is required when creating a server.
ip_address The IP address of the primary TACACS+ server. An IP address or host
name is required when creating a server.
hostname2 The host name (DNS name) of an optional backup TACACS+ server.
ip_address2 The IP address of an optional backup TACACS+ server.
secret The shared secret known to the switch and the server, but which is not
sent over the network. Can be any text or hexadecimal string but MUST
match the secret configured on the server. The secret is case-sensitive.
required when creating a server.
seconds The timeout for server replies to authentication requests.
port The port number for the primary TACACS+ server.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 2
port 49

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove a TACACS+ server from the configuration. Only one
server may be deleted at a time.
• A host name (or IP address) and a secret are required when configuring a server.

• The server and the backup server must both be TACACS+ servers.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-5


AAA Commands

Examples
-> aaa tacacs+-server tpub host 10.10.2.2 key otna timeout 10
-> no aaa tacacs+-server tpub

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show aaa server Displays information about AAA servers.


aaa authentication Specifies the AAA servers to be used for Authenticated Switch
Access.
aaa accounting session Specifies the accounting servers to be used for Authenticated
Switch Access.

MIB Objects
aaaServerTable
aaasName
aaasProtocol
aaasHostName
aaasIpAddress
aaasHostName2
aaasIpAddress2
aaasTacacsKey
aaasTimout
aaasTacacsPort

page 21-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

aaa ldap-server
Configures or modifies an LDAP server for Authenticated Switch Access.
aaa ldap-server server_name [host {hostname | ip_address} [{hostname2 | ip_address2}]] [dn dn_name]
[password super_password] [base search_base] [retransmit retries] [timeout seconds] [ssl | no ssl]
[port port]
no aaa ldap-server server-name

Syntax Definitions
server_name The name of the LDAP server.
hostname The host name (DNS) of the primary LDAP server. The host name or IP
address is required when creating a new server.
ip_address The IP address of the primary LDAP server.
hostname2 The host name (DNS) of the backup LDAP server.
ip_address2 The IP address of a backup host for the LDAP server.
dn_name The super-user or administrative distinguished name in the format
recognized by the LDAP-enabled directory servers. For example:
cn=manager. Must be different from the search-base name and must be
in a format supported by the server. Required when creating a new
server.
super_password The super-user password recognized by the LDAP-enabled directory
servers. The password may be clear text or hexadecimal format.
Required when creating a new server.
search_base The search base recognized by the LDAP-enabled directory servers. For
example, o=company or c=country. Must be different from the
dn_name. Required when creating a new server.
retries The number of retries the switch makes to the LDAP server to authenti-
cate a user before trying the backup server.
seconds The timeout in seconds for server replies to authentication requests from
the switch.
ssl Enables a secure switch layer (SSL) between the switch and the LDAP
server.
no ssl Disables a secure switch layer (SSL) between the switch and the LDAP
server.
port The port number for the primary LDAP server and any backup server.
Must match the port number configured on the server.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-7


AAA Commands

Defaults
Defaults for optional parameters are as follows:

parameter default
port 389 (SSL disabled)
636 (SSL enabled)
retries 3
seconds 2
ssl | no ssl no ssl

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The dn_name must be different from the search_base name.

• Use the no form of the command to remove an LDAP server from the configuration. Only one server
may be removed at a time.
• The port number configured on the switch must match the port number configured for the server.

Examples
-> aaa ldap-server topanga5 host 10.10.3.4 dn cn=manager password tpub base c=us
retransmit 4
-> no aaa ldap-server topanga5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show aaa server Displays information about AAA servers.


aaa authentication Specifies the AAA servers to be used for authenticated switch
access.
aaa accounting session Specifies the accounting servers to be used for Authenticated
Switch Access.

page 21-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

MIB Objects
aaaServerTable
aaasProtocol
aaasHostName
aaasIpAddress
aaasHostName2
aaasIpAddress2
aaasLdapPort
aaasLdapDn
aaasLdapPasswd
aaasLdapSearchBase
aaasLdapServType
aaasRetries
aaasTimeout
aaasLdapEnableSsl

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-9


AAA Commands

aaa ace-server clear


Clears the ACE secret on the switch. An ACE/Server generates “secrets” that it sends to clients for authen-
tication. The secret cannot be configured on the switch but may be cleared on the switch.
aaa ace-server clear

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Clear the ACE secret on the switch if the server and the switch get out of synch. See RSA Security’s
ACE/Server documentation for more information.
• If you clear the secret on the switch, it must also be cleared on the server.

Examples
-> aaa ace-server clear

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa authentication Specifies servers for Authenticated Switch Access.


show aaa server Displays information about AAA servers configured for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaServerTable
aaasAceClear

page 21-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

aaa authentication
Configures the interface for Authenticated Switch Access and specifies the server(s) to be used. This type
of authentication gives users access to manage the switch.
aaa authentication {console | telnet | ftp | http | snmp | ssh | default} server1 [server2...] [local]
no aaa authentication [console | telnet | ftp | http | snmp | ssh | default]

Syntax Definitions
console Configures Authenticated Switch Access through the console port.
telnet Configures Authenticated Switch Access for any port used for Telnet.
ftp Configures Authenticated Switch Access for any port used for FTP.
http Configures Authenticated Switch Access for any port used for Web-
based management.
snmp Configures Authenticated Switch Access for any port used for SNMP.
ssh Configures Authenticated Switch Access for any port used for Secure
Shell.
default Configures Authenticated Switch Access for any port using any service
(telnet, ftp, etc.). Note that SNMP access is enabled only if an LDAP or
local server is specified with the command.
server1 The name of the authentication server used for Authenticated Switch
Access. At least one server is required. The server may be a RADIUS,
TACACS+, LDAP, ACE/Server, or the local user database. RADIUS,
TACACS+, and LDAP server names are set up through the aaa radius-
server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-server commands. If an
ACE/Server will be used, specify ace for the server name. (Only one
ACE/Server may be specified.)
server2... The names of backup servers for Authenticated Switch Access. Up to 3
backups may be specified (including local). These backups are only
used if server1 becomes unavailable. They are polled in the order they
are listed in this command. The first available server becomes the
authentication server.
local Specifies that the local user database will be a backup for the authenti-
cation servers. If you want to use the local user database as the only
authentication server, specify local for server1.

Defaults
• At switch startup, Authenticated Switch Access is available through console port via the local data-
base. Authentication for other management interfaces (Telnet, FTP, etc.) is disabled.
• The default user on the switch is admin, and switch is the password.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-11


AAA Commands

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The server type may be RADIUS, TACACS+, LDAP, ACE/Server, or the local user database. Up to 4
servers may be configured for an interface type; at least one is required. Each server name should be
separated by a space.
• The switch uses only the first available server in the list to check for user information. For example, if
server1 is not available, the switch will poll server2. If user information is not found on the first avail-
able server, the authentication request will fail.
• RADIUS, TACACS+, and LDAP servers may each have an additional backup specified through the
aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-server commands.
• If the local switch database will be used as the only authentication server, specify local for server1. If
local is specified as a backup server, it should be entered last in the list of servers. The local user data-
base is always available if the switch is up.
• Only LDAP or the local database may be used for authenticated SNMP management.

• An ACE/Server cannot be specified for SNMP access.

• If Secure Shell (ssh) is enabled, Telnet and FTP should be disabled.

Examples
-> aaa authentication telnet pubs1
-> no aaa authentication telnet
-> aaa authentication default pubs2 pubs3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch


Access.
aaa ldap-server Configures or modifies an LDAP server for Authenticated Switch
Access.
user Configures user information for the local database on the switch.
show aaa server Displays information about servers configured for Authenticated Switch
Access.

page 21-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

MIB Objects
aaaAuthSATable
aaatsInterface
aaasName
aaatsName1
aaatsName2
aaatsName3
aaatsName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-13


AAA Commands

aaa authentication default


Sets the authenticated switch access type to the default server setting.
aaa authentication {console | telnet | ftp | http | snmp | ssh} default

Syntax Definitions
console Configures the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting for
the console port.
telnet Configures the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting for
Telnet.
ftp Configures the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting for
FTP.
http Configures the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting for
Web-based management.
snmp Configures the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting for
any port used for SNMP.
ssh Configures the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting for
any port used for Secure Shell.

Defaults
By default, the default Authenticated Switch Access server setting does not include any servers.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the aaa authentication command to set the default servers.

Examples
-> aaa authentication telnet default
-> aaa authentication default default

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 21-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Related Commands

aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch


Access.
aaa tacacs+-server Configures or modifies an LDAP server for Authenticated Switch
Access.
user Configures user information for the local database on the switch.
show aaa server Displays information about servers configured for Authenticated Switch
Access.

MIB Objects
aaaAuthSATable
aaatsName1
aaatsName2
aaatsName3
aaatsName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-15


AAA Commands

aaa authentication 802.1x


Enables/disables the switch for 802.1X authentication.
aaa authentication 802.1x server1 [server2] [server3] [server4]
no aaa authentication 802.1x

Syntax Definitions
server1 The name of the RADIUS authentication server used for 802.1X authen-
tication. (Note that only RADIUS servers are supported for 802.1X
authentication.) At least one server is required. RADIUS server names
are set up through the aaa radius-server command.
server2...server4 The names of backup servers for authenticating 802.1X users. Up to 3
backups may be specified; include a space between each server name.
These backups are only used if server1 becomes unavailable. They are
polled in the order they are listed in this command. The first available
server becomes the authentication server.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable 802.1x authentication for the switch.

• Use the vlan port 802.1x command to enable or disable ports for 802.1X. Use the 802.1x command to
configure authentication parameters for a dedicated 802.1X port.
• Up to 4 RADIUS servers (total) may be specified. At least one server is required. Each server name
should be separated by a space.
• The switch uses only the first available server in the list to check for user information. For example, if
server1 is not available, the switch will poll server2. If user information is not found on the first avail-
able server, the authentication request will fail.
• RADIUS servers may each have an additional backup specified through the aaa radius-server
command.
• Before any device is authenticated through an 802.1X port, the port will only process 802.1X frames
(EAPoL frames) from an unknown source.
• Note that multiple supplicants can be authenticated on a given 802.1X port. Each supplicant MAC
address received on the port is authenticated and learned separately. Only those that authenticate
successfully are allowed on the port; those that fail authentication are blocked on the 802.1X port.

page 21-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Examples
-> aaa authentication 802.1x rad1 rad2
-> no aaa authentication 802.1x

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port. Typically used


for port access control on a dedicated 802.1X port.
aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch
Access or 802.1X port access control.
vlan port 802.1x Enables or disables 802.1X port-based access control on a mobile port.
show aaa authentication 802.1x Displays information about the global 802.1X configuration on the
switch.

MIB Objects
AaaAuth8021XTable
aaatxName1
aaatxName2
aaatxName3
aaatxName4
aaatxOpen

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-17


AAA Commands

aaa authentication mac


Enables/Disables the switch for MAC authentication. This type of authentication is available in addition to
802.1x authentication and is designed to handle devices that do not support an 802.1x authentication
method (non-supplicants).
aaa authentication MAC server1 [server2] [server3] [server4]
no aaa authentication MAC

Syntax Definitions
server1 The name of the RADIUS authentication server used for MAC authenti-
cation. (Note that only RADIUS servers are supported for MAC authen-
tication.) At least one server is required. RADIUS server names are set
up through the aaa radius-server command.
server2...server4 The names of backup servers used for MAC authentication. Up to 3
backups may be specified; include a space between each server name.
These backups are only used if server1 becomes unavailable. They are
polled in the order they are listed in this command. The first available
server becomes the authentication server.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Up to 4 RADIUS servers (total) may be specified. At least one server is required. Each server name
should be separated by a space.
• Use the no form of this command to disable MAC authentication for the switch.

• The switch uses only the first available server in the list to check for user information. For example, if
server1 is not available, the switch will poll server2. If user information is not found on the first avail-
able server, the authentication request will fail.
• RADIUS servers may each have an additional backup specified through the aaa radius-server
command.
• MAC authentication verifies the source MAC address of a non-supplicant device via a remote
RADIUS server. Similar to 802.1x authentication, this method sends RADIUS frames to the server
with the MAC address embedded in the username and password attributes.
• Note that the same RADIUS servers can be used for 802.1x (supplicant) and MAC (non-supplicant)
authentication. Using different servers for each type of authentication is allowed but not required.
• Use the vlan port 802.1x command to enable or disable ports for 802.1X. Use the 802.1x non-suppli-
cant policy authentication command to configure a MAC authentication policy for a dedicated
802.1X port.

page 21-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

• Multiple supplicants and non-supplicants can be authenticated on a given 802.1X port. Each device
MAC address received on the port is authenticated and learned separately. If no MAC authentication
policies exist on the port, non-supplicants are blocked.

Examples
-> aaa authentication mac rad1 rad2
-> no aaa authentication mac

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port. Typically used


for port access control on a dedicated 802.1X port.
802.1x non-supplicant policy Configures MAC authentication device classification policies for non-
authentication supplicants.
aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch
Access or 802.1X port access control.
vlan port 802.1x Enables or disables 802.1X port-based access control on a mobile port.
show aaa authentication mac Displays information about the global 802.1X configuration on the
switch.

MIB Objects
AaaAuthMACTable
aaaMacSrvrName1
aaaMacSrvrName2
aaaMacSrvrName3
aaaMacSrvrName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-19


AAA Commands

aaa accounting 802.1x


Enables/disables accounting for 802.1X authentication sessions. Accounting servers keep track of network
resources (time, packets, bytes, etc.) and user activity.
aaa accounting 802.1x server1 [server2...] [local]
no aaa accounting 802.1x

Syntax Definitions
server1 The name of the RADIUS, TACACS+, or LDAP server used for 802.1X
accounting. At least one server is required. RADIUS, TACACS+, and
LDAP server names are set up through the
aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-server
commands.
server2... The names of backup servers for 802.1X accounting. Up to 3 backups
may be specified (including local); include a space between each server
name. These backups are only used if server1 becomes unavailable.
They are polled in the order they are listed in this command. The first
available server becomes the accounting server.
local Local accounting is done through the Switch Logging feature in the
switch. See Chapter 28, “Switch Logging Commands,” for information
about Switch Logging commands.

Defaults
Accounting is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to disable accounting for 802.1X ports.

• Up to 4 accounting servers (total) may be specified. At least one server is required. Each server name
should be separated by a space.
• The servers may be RADIUS, TACACS+, or LDAP servers, and/or the local Switch Logging facility.

• If local is specified as server1, the switch will only use the local Switching Logging facility for
accounting.
• If local is specified as a backup, it should be entered last in the list of servers. The Switch Logging
facility is always available if the switch is up.
• The switch uses only the first available server in the list for accounting. For example, if server1 is not
available, the switch will use server2.
• RADIUS, TACACS+, and LDAP servers may each have an additional backup specified through the
aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-server commands.

page 21-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Examples
-> aaa accounting 802.1x rad1 local
-> no aaa accounting 802.1x

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

802.1x Configures 802.1X parameters on a particular slot/port. Typically used


for port access control on a dedicated 802.1X port.
aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch
Access or 802.1X port access control.
show aaa accounting 802.1x Displays information about accounting servers for 802.1X sessions.

MIB Objects
aaaAcct8021xTable
aaacxName1
aaacxName2
aaacxName3
aaacxName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-21


AAA Commands

aaa accounting session


Configures an accounting server or servers for authenticated switch sessions. Accounting servers keep
track of network resources (time, packets, bytes, etc.) and user activity.
aaa accounting session server1 [server2...] [local]
no accounting session

Syntax Definitions
server1 The name of the RADIUS, TACACS+, or LDAP server used for
accounting of authenticated switch sessions. At least one server is
required. RADIUS, TACACS+, and LDAP server names are set up
through the aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-
server commands.
server2... The names of backup servers. Up to 3 backups may be specified (includ-
ing local); each server name should be separated by a space. These
backups are only used if server1 becomes unavailable. They are polled
in the order they are listed in this command. The first available server
becomes the accounting server.
local Local accounting is done through the Switching Logging feature on the
switch. See Chapter 28, “Switch Logging Commands,” for information
about Switch Logging commands.

Defaults
Accounting is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to disable accounting for Authenticated Switch Access.

• Up to 4 accounting servers (total) may be specified. At least one server is required. Each server name
should be separated by a space.
• The servers may be RADIUS, TACACS+, LDAP servers, and/or the local Switch Logging facility.

• If local is specified as server1, the switch will only use the local Switching Logging facility for
accounting.
• If local is specified as a backup, it should be entered last in the list of servers. The Switch Logging
facility is always available if the switch is up.
• The switch uses only the first available server in the list for accounting. For example, if server1 is not
available, the switch will use server2.
• RADIUS, TACACS+, and LDAP servers may each have an additional backup specified through the
aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-server commands.

page 21-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Examples
-> aaa accounting session ldap1 radius2 local
-> no aaa accounting session

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show aaa accounting Displays information about accounting servers configured for Authenti-
cated Switch Access.

MIB Objects
aaaAcctsaTable
aaacsName1
aaacsName2
aaacsName3
aaacsName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-23


AAA Commands

aaa accounting command


Enables or disables the server for command accounting. Accounting servers keep track of network
resources (time, packets, bytes, etc.) and user activity.
aaa accounting command server1 [server2...] [local]
no accounting command

Syntax Definitions
server1 The name of the TACACS+ server used for command accounting. At
least one server is required. TACACS+ server names are set up through
the aaa tacacs+-server commands.
server2... The names of TACACS+ backup servers. Up to 3 backups may be spec-
ified; each server name should be separated by a space. These backups
are only used if server1 becomes unavailable. They are polled in the
order they are listed in this command. The first available server becomes
the accounting server.
local Local accounting is done through the Switching Logging feature on the
switch. See Chapter 28, “Switch Logging Commands,” for information
about Switch Logging commands.

Defaults
Accounting is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to disable command accounting.

• Up to 4 accounting servers (total) may be specified. At least one server is required. Each server name
should be separated by a space.
• The servers can be only TACACS+ servers.

• The switch uses only the first available server in the list for accounting. For example, if server1 is not
available, the switch will use server2.
• TACACS+ server may each have an additional backup specified through the aaa tacacs+-server
command.

Examples
-> aaa accounting command tacacs1 tacacs2 tacacs3
-> no aaa accounting command

page 21-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show aaa accounting Displays information about accounting servers configured for Authenti-
cated Switch Access.

MIB Objects
aaaAcctCmdTable
aaacmdSrvName1
aaacmdSrvName2
aaacmdSrvName3
aaacmdSrvName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-25


AAA Commands

user
Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database. Use the no form of the command to remove
the user from the local database.
user username [password password] [expiration {day | date}] [read-only | read-write [families... |
domains...| all | none]] [no snmp | no auth | sha | md5 | sha+des | md5+des] [end-user profile name]
no user username

Syntax Definitions
username The name of the user (maximum is 31 alphanumeric characters). Used
for logging into the switch. Required to create a new user entry or for
modifying a user.
password The user’s password in clear text or hexadecimal (corresponding to
encrypted form). Required to create a new user entry. The default mini-
mum length is 8 alphanumeric characters. The maximum is 47 charac-
ters.
day The number of days before this user’s current password expires. The
range is 1 to 150 days.
date The date (in the format mm/dd/yyyy hh:mm) that the user’s current pass-
word will expire.
read-only Specifies that the user will have read-only access to the switch.
read-write Specifies that the user will have read-write access to the switch.
families Determines the command families available to the user on the switch.
Each command family should be separated by a space. Command fami-
lies are subsets of domains. See Usage Guidelines for more details.
domains Determines the command domains available to the user on the switch.
Each domain should be separated by a space. See the Usage Guidelines
for more details.
all Specifies that all command families and domains are available to the
user.
none Specifies that no command families or domains are available to the user.
no snmp Denies the specified user SNMP access to the switch.
no auth Specifies that the user has SNMP access without any required SNMP
authentication and encryption protocol.
sha Specifies that the SHA authentication algorithm should be used for
authenticating SNMP PDU for the user.
md5 Specifies that the MD5 authentication algorithm should be used for
authenticating SNMP PDU for the user.

page 21-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

sha+des Specifies that the SHA authentication algorithm and DES encryption
standard should be used for authenticating and encrypting SNMP PDU
for the user.
md5+des Specifies that the MD5 authentication algorithm and the DES encryp-
tion standard should be used for authenticating and encrypting SNMP
PDU for the user.
name The name of an end-user profile associated with this user. Configured
through the end-user profile command. Cannot be associated with the
user if command families/domains are associated with the user.

Defaults
By default, if a user is created without indicating the read and write privileges and SNMP access, the user
will be given privileges based on the default user account. The default user account may be modified, but
by default it has the following privileges:

parameter default
read-only | read-write read-only
no snmp | no auth | sha | md5 | no snmp
sha+des | md5+des

For more information about the default user account, see the OmniSwitch Switch Management Guide.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• In addition to the syntax listed for the command, the syntax authkey key will display in an ASCII text
file produced via the snapshot command if the user is allowed SNMPv3 access to the switch.The
authentication key is in hexadecimal form, and is deducted from the user’s password with SHA or
MD5 hash and encrypted with DES encryption. The key parameter only appears in configuration files
that are resulting from a snapshot. The key is computed by the switch based on the user’s SNMP
access and will only appear in the ASCII text file; it is not displayed through the CLI. (This key is used
for both Auth Password and Priv Password in the OmniVista NMS application.)
• At least one user with SHA/MD5 authentication and/or DES encryption must be configured on the
switch for SNMPv3 communication with OmniVista.
• Use user username and password password to reset a user’s password configured through the pass-
word command.
• Typically the password should be a string of non-repeating characters. The CLI uses the first occur-
rence of the character series to uniquely identify the password. For example, the password tpubtpub is
the same as tpub. A better password might be tpub345.
• Note that the exclamation point (!) is not a valid password character. In addition, specifying an aster-
isk (*) as one or more characters in a password is allowed as long as every character is not an asterisk.
For example, password **123456** is allowed; password ******** is not allowed.
• The password expiration date will display in an ASCII text file produced via the snapshot command.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-27


AAA Commands

• A password expiration for the user’s current password may be configured with the expiration option.
However, if the password is changed, or the global password expiration setting is configured with the
user password-expiration command, the user’s password expiration will be configured with the
global expiration setting.
• When modifying a user’s SNMP access, the user password must be re-entered (or a new one config-
ured). This is required because the hash algorithm used to save the password in the switch depends on
the SNMP authentication level.
• At initial startup, the default user on the switch is admin with a password of switch. The switch will
not recreate this user at any successive startup as long as there exists at least one user defined with
write access to all commands. (Note that if password expiration is configured for the admin user, or
configured globally through the user password-expiration command, when the admin user’s pass-
word expires, the admin user will have access only through the console port.)
• Either privileges or an end-user profile may be associated with a user; both cannot be configured for
the same user.
• New users or updated user settings are saved automatically; that is, these settings do not require the
write memory, copy running-config working, or configuration snapshot command to save user
settings over a reboot.
Possible values for domains and families are listed in the table here:

Domain Corresponding Families


domain-admin file telnet dshell debug
domain-system system aip snmp rmon webmgt config
domain-physical chassis module interface pmm health
domain-network ip rip ip-routing ipmr ipms
domain-layer2 vlan bridge stp 802.1q linkagg ip-helper
domain-service dns
domain-security session aaa

Examples
-> user techpubs password writer read-only config
-> no user techpubs

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

password Configures the current user’s password.


show user Displays information about users configured in the local database on the
switch.

page 21-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

MIB Objects
aaaUserTable
aaauPassword
aaauReadRight
aaauWriteRight
aaauSnmpLevel
aaauSnmpAuthKey
aaauPasswordExpirationDate

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-29


AAA Commands

password
Configures the current user’s password.
password

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the snapshot command is used to capture the switch configuration, the text of the password is not
displayed in the file. Instead an authentication key is included in the file.
• The password command does not require a password in-line; instead, after the command is entered, the
system displays a prompt for the password. Enter any alphanumeric string. (The string displays on the
screen as asterisks.) The system displays a prompt to verify the new password.
• A new password cannot be identical to the current password; it cannot be identical to any of the three
passwords that preceded the current password.
• The password may be up to 47 characters. The default minimum password length is 8 characters.

• Note that the exclamation point (!) is not a valid password character. In addition, specifying an asterisk
(*) as one or more characters in a password is allowed as long as every character is not an asterisk. For
example, password **123456** is allowed; password ******** is not allowed.
• Password settings are saved automatically; that is, the write memory, copy running-config working,
or configuration snapshot command is not required to save password settings over a reboot.

Examples
-> password
enter old password: ********
enter new password: *********
reenter new password: *********
->

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 21-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user Configures entries in the local user database. May be used by a system
administrator to change any user’s password in addition to configuring
user privileges or profile.

MIB Objects
aaaUserTable
aaauPassword
aaauOldPassword

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-31


AAA Commands

user password-size min


Configures the minimum number of characters required when configuring a user password.
user password-size min size

Syntax Definitions
size The number of characters required when configuring a user password
through the password command or when setting up a user password
through the user command. The range is 1 to 14 characters.

Defaults

parameter default
size 8

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A.

Examples
-> user password-size min 9

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

user Configures entries in the local user database. May be used by a system
administrator to change any user’s password in addition to configuring
user privileges or profile.
show user password-size Displays the minimum number of characters that are required for a user
password.
show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordSizeMin

page 21-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

user password-expiration
Configures an expiration date for all user passwords stored locally on the switch or disables password
expiration.
user password-expiration {day | disable}

Syntax Definitions
day The number of days before locally configured user passwords will
expire. The range is 1 to 150 days.
disable Disables password expiration for users configured locally on the switch.

Defaults

parameter default
day | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The user password-expiration command sets a default password expiration for users configured
locally on the switch.
• Password expiration may be configured on a per-user basis through the user command; the user setting
overrides the user password-expiration setting until the user password is changed or the user
password-expiration command is entered again.

Examples
-> user password-expiration 2
-> user password-expiration disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

user Configures entries in the local user database. May be used by a system
administrator to change any user’s password in addition to configuring
user privileges or profile.
show user password-expiration Displays the expiration date for passwords configured for user accounts
stored on the switch.
show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-33


AAA Commands

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaDefaultPasswordExpirationInDays

page 21-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

user password-policy cannot-contain-username


Specifies whether or not a user can configure a password that contains the username for the account.
user password-policy cannot-contain-username {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Does not allow the password to contain the username.
disable Allows the password to contain the username.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The status of this function is specified as part of a global password policy that is applied to all pass-
words when they are created or modified.
• When this function is enabled, a check is done at the time the password is created or modified to ensure
that the username is not specified as part of the password text.

Examples
-> user password-policy cannot-contain-username enable
-> user password-policy cannot-contain-username disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordContainUserName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-35


AAA Commands

user password-policy min-uppercase


Configures the minimum number of uppercase English characters required for a valid password.
user password-policy min-uppercase number

Syntax Definitions
number The minimum number of uppercase characters. The range is 0 to 7.

Defaults

parameter default
number 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the minimum uppercase character requirement.

• The minimum number of uppercase characters is specified as part of a global password policy that is
applied to all passwords when they are created or modified.

Examples
-> user password-policy min-uppercase 2
-> user password-policy min-uppercase 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordMinUpperCase

page 21-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

user password-policy min-lowercase


Configures the minimum number of lowercase English characters required for a valid password.
user password-policy min-lowercase number

Syntax Definitions
number The minimum number of lowercase characters. The range is 0 to 7.

Defaults

parameter default
number 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the minimum lowercase character requirement.

• The minimum number of lowercase characters is specified as part of a global password policy that is
applied to all passwords when they are created or modified.

Examples
-> user password-policy min-lowercase 2
-> user password-policy min-lowercase 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordMinLowerCase

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-37


AAA Commands

user password-policy min-digit


Configures the minimum number of base-10 digits required for a valid password.
user password-policy min-digit number

Syntax Definitions
number The minimum number of digits. The range is 0 to 7.

Defaults

parameter default
number 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the minimum number of digits requirement.

• The minimum number of digits requirement is specified as part of a global password policy that is
applied to all passwords when they are created or modified.

Examples
-> user password-policy min-digit 2
-> user password-policy min-digit 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordMinDigit

page 21-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

user password-policy min-nonalpha


Configures the minimum number of non-alphanumeric characters (symbols) required for a valid password.
user password-policy min-nonalpha number

Syntax Definitions
number The minimum number of non-alphanumeric characters.
The range is 0 to 7.

Defaults

parameter default
number 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the minimum non-alphanumeric character requirement.

• The minimum number of non-alphanumeric characters is specified as part of a global password policy
that is applied to all passwords when they are created or modified.

Examples
-> user password-policy min-nonalpha 2
-> user password-policy min-nonalpha 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordMinNonAlpha

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-39


AAA Commands

user password-history
Configures the maximum number of old passwords to retain in the password history.
user password-history number

Syntax Definitions
number The maximum number of old passwords to retain.
The range is 0 to 24.

Defaults

parameter default
number 4

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the password history function.

• The user is prevented from specifying any passwords that are recorded in the password history and fall
within the range configured through this command.
• The password history value is specified as part of a global password policy that is applied to all pass-
words when they are created or modified.

Examples
-> user password-history 2
-> user password-history 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordHistory

page 21-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

user password-min-age
Configures the minimum number of days during which a user is prevented from changing a password.
user password-min-age days

Syntax Definitions
days The number of days to use as the minimum age of the password. The
range is 0 to 150.

Defaults

parameter default
days 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the minimum number of days requirement.

• Configure the minimum age of a password with a value that is less than the value configured for the
password expiration.
• The password minimum age value is specified as part of a global password policy that is applied to all
passwords when they are created or modified.

Examples
-> user password-min-age 7
-> user password-min-age 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordMinAge

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-41


AAA Commands

user lockout-window
Configures a moving period of time (observation window) during which failed login attempts are counted
to determine if the number of failed attempts has exceeded the number of allowed attempts. The number of
failed login attempts is decremented by the number of failed attempts that age beyond the observation
window time period.
user lockout-window minutes

Syntax Definitions
minutes The number of minutes the observation window remains active. The
range is 0 to 99999.

Defaults

parameter default
minutes 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is only available to the admin user because the admin user account is the only account
protected from any type of lockout attempt.
• Specify 0 with this command to disable the observation window function. This means that failed login
attempts will never age out; the number of failed attempts is never decremented.
• Do not configure an observation window time period that is greater than the lockout duration time
period.
• If the number of failed login attempts exceeds the number of failed attempts allowed before the obser-
vation window time expires, then the user account is locked out of the switch.
• The observation window time period is a global lockout setting that is applied to all passwords config-
ured on the switch.
• Lockout settings are saved automatically; that is, these settings do not require the write memory, copy
running-config working, or configuration snapshot command to save user settings over a reboot.

Examples
-> user lockout-window 500
-> user lockout-window 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 21-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user lockout-duration Configures the amount of time a user account remains locked out of the
switch.
user lockout-threshold Configures the number of failed password attempts allowed before the
user account is locked out of the switch.
user lockout unlock Manually locks or unlocks a user account on the switch.
show user lockout-setting Displays the global user lockout settings for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaLockoutWindow

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-43


AAA Commands

user lockout-threshold
Configures the number of failed password login attempts allowed during a certain period of time (observa-
tion window). If the number of failed attempts exceeds the lockout threshold number before the observa-
tion window period expires, the user account is locked out.
user lockout-threshold number

Syntax Definitions
number The number of failed login attempts allowed. The range is 0 to 999.

Defaults

parameter default
number 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is only available to the admin user because the admin user account is the only account
protected from any type of lockout attempt.
• If the lockout threshold is set to zero (the default), there is no limit to the number of failed login
attempts allowed.
• A user account remains locked out for the length of the lockout duration time period; at the end of this
time, the account is automatically unlocked.
• If the lockout duration time period is set to zero, only the admin user or a user with read/write AAA
privileges can unlock a locked user account. An account is unlocked by changing the user account
password or with the user lockout unlock command.
• The lockout threshold time period is a global lockout setting that is applied to all passwords configured
on the switch.
• Lockout settings are saved automatically; that is, these settings do not require the write memory, copy
running-config working, or configuration snapshot command to save user settings over a reboot.

Examples
-> user lockout-threshold 3
-> user lockout-threshold 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 21-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user lockout-window Configures a window of time during which failed login attempts are
counted to determine if the number of failed attempts has exceeded the
number of allowed attempts.
user lockout-duration Configures the length of time a user account remains locked out of the
switch.
user lockout unlock Manually locks or unlocks a user account on the switch.
show user lockout-setting Displays the global user lockout settings for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaLockoutThreshold

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-45


AAA Commands

user lockout-duration
Configures the length of time a user account remains locked out of the switch. At the end of this time
period, the user account is automatically unlocked.
user lockout-duration minutes

Syntax Definitions
minutes The number of minutes the user account remains locked out. The range
is 0 to 99999.

Defaults

parameter default
minutes 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is only available to the admin user because the admin user account is the only account
protected from any type of lockout attempt.
• Note that if the lockout duration time period is set to zero (the default), then locked user accounts are
never automatically unlocked.
• Only the admin user or a user with read/write AAA privileges can unlock a locked user account when
the lockout duration time is set to zero. An account is unlocked by changing the user password or with
the user lockout unlock command.
• Do not configure a lockout duration time period that is less than the amount of time configured for the
observation window.
• The lockout duration time period is a global lockout setting that is applied to all passwords configured
on the switch.
• Lockout settings are saved automatically; that is, these settings do not require the write memory, copy
running-config working, or configuration snapshot command to save user settings over a reboot.

Examples
-> user lockout-duration 60
-> user lockout-duration 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 21-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user lockout-window Configures a window of time during which failed login attempts are
counted to determine if the number of failed attempts has exceeded the
number of allowed attempts,
user lockout-threshold Configures the number of failed password attempts allowed before the
user account is locked out of the switch.
user lockout unlock Manually locks or unlocks a user account on the switch.
show user lockout-setting Displays the global user lockout settings for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaLockoutDuration

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-47


AAA Commands

user lockout unlock


Manually locks or unlocks a user account on the switch.
user {lockout | unlock}

Syntax Definitions
username The username of the account to lock or unlock.
lockout Locks the user account out of the switch.
unlock Unlocks a locked user account.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is only available to the admin user or a user with read/write AAA privileges.

• The admin user account is protected from any type of lockout attempt.

• User lockouts and unlocks are saved automatically; that is, these settings do not require the write
memory, copy running-config working, or configuration snapshot command to save user settings
over a reboot.

Examples
-> user j_smith lockout
-> user j_smith unlock

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user Displays information about all users or a particular user configured in
the local user database on the switch.
show user lockout-setting Displays the global user lockout settings for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaUserTable
aaauPasswordLockoutEnable

page 21-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

end-user profile
Configures or modifies an end user profile, which specifies access to command areas. The profile may be
attached to a customer login user account.
end-user profile name [read-only [area | all]] [read-write [area | all]] [disable [area | all]]
no end-user profile name

Syntax Definitions
name The name of the end-user profile, up to 32 alphanumeric characters.
area Command areas on the switch to which the user is allowed or denied
access. Areas include physical, vlan-table, basic-ip-routing, ip-
routes-table, mac-filtering-table, spantree.

Defaults
Areas are disabled for end-user profiles by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to delete an end-user profile.

• An end-user profile may not be attached to a user that is already configured with functional privileges.

• If a profile is deleted, but the profile name is still associated with a user, the user will not be able to log
into the switch.
• Use the end-user profile port-list and end-user profile vlan-range commands to configure ports and
VLANs to which this profile will have access. By default, new profiles do not allow access to any ports
or VLANs.

Examples
-> end-user profile bsmith read-only basic-ip-routing ip-routes-table
-> no end-user profile bsmith

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-49


AAA Commands

Related Commands

end-user profile port-list Configures a range of ports associated with an end-user profile.
end-user profile vlan-range Configures a range of VLANs associated with an end-user profile.
user Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database.
show end-user profile Displays information about end-user profiles.

MIB Objects
endUserProfileTable
endUserProfileName
endUserProfileAreaPhysical
endUserProfileAreaVlanTable
endUserProfileAreaBasicIPRouting
endUserProfileAreaIpRoutesTable
endUserProfileAreaMacFilteringTable
endUserProfileAreaSpantree
endUserProfileSlotPortTable
endUserProfileSlotNumber
endUserProfilePortList
endUserProfileVlanIdTable
endUserProfileVlanIdStart
endUserProfileVlandIdEnd

page 21-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

end-user profile port-list


Configures a range of ports associated with an end-user profile.
end-user profile name port-list slot1[/port_range1] [slot2[/port_range2] ...]
end-user profile name no port-list slot1 [slot2...]

Syntax Definitions
name The name of an existing or a new end-user profile.
slot1 The slot number associated with the profile.
port_range1 The port or port range associated with slot1. Ports are separated by a
hyphen, for example 2-4.
slot2 Additional slots may be associated with the profile.
port_range2 Additional ports may be associated with additional slot numbers associ-
ated with the profile.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of the command to remove a port list or lists from an end-user profile. Note that the no
form removes all the ports on a given slot or slots.

Examples
-> end user profile Prof1 port-list 2/1-3 3 4/1-5
-> end user profile Prof1 no port-list 4

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-51


AAA Commands

Related Commands

end-user profile Configures or modifies an end user profile, which specifies access to
command areas.
end-user profile vlan-range Configures a range of VLANs associated with an end-user profile.
show end-user profile Displays information about end-user profiles.

MIB Objects
endUserProfileTable
endUserProfileName
endUserProfileSlotPortTable
endUserProfileSlotNumber
endUserProfilePortList

page 21-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

end-user profile vlan-range


Configures a range of VLANs associated with an end-user profile.
end-user profile name vlan-range vlan_range [vlan_range2...]
end-user profile name no vlan-range vlan1 [vlan2..]

Syntax Definitions
name The name of an existing or a new end-user profile.
vlan_range The VLAN range associated with the end-user profile; values are sepa-
rated by a hyphen. For example: 3-6 indicates VLAN 3, VLAN 4,
VLAN 5, and VLAN 6.
vlan_range2... Optional additional VLAN ranges associated with the end-user profile.
Up to 16 ranges total may be configured.
vlan1 The VLAN range to be deleted from the profile. Only the start of the
range may be entered.
vlan2... Additional VLAN ranges to be deleted. Only the start of the range may
be entered.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of the command to remove a VLAN range or ranges from an end-user profile. Note that
only the start of the VLAN range must be entered to remove the range.

Examples
-> end-user profile Prof1 vlan-range 2-4 7-8
-> end-user profile Prof1 no vlan-range 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-53


AAA Commands

Related Commands

end-user profile Configures or modifies an end user profile, which specifies access to
command areas.
end-user profile port-list Configures a range of ports associated with an end-user profile.
show end-user profile Displays information about end-user profiles.

MIB Objects
endUserProfileTable
endUserProfileName
endUserProfileVlanIdTable
endUserProfileVlanIdStart
endUserProfileVlandIdEnd

page 21-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

aaa user-network-profile
Creates the user role in the user network profile table and maps the role to a VLAN ID.
aaa user-network-profile name name vlan vlan-id
no aaa user-network-profile name name

Syntax Definitions
name The name of an existing or a new user profile. The name specified here
must match with the Filter-ID attribute returned by the RADIUS server.
The user profile name can range from 1 to 32 characters in length.
vlan-id The VLAN identification number for a preconfigured VLAN that will
be assigned to a user. The valid range is 1-4094.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove a UNP from the switch configuration.

• This command is used only with RADIUS as the authentication server.

Examples
-> aaa user-network-profile name engineering vlan-id 10
-> aaa user-network-profile name accounting vlan-id 20
-> no aaa user-network-profile name engineering

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show aaa user-network-profile Displays the user network profile table.

MIB Objects
aaaUserNetProfileTable
aaaUserNetProfileName
aaaUserNetProfileVlanID

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-55


AAA Commands

show aaa server


Displays information about a particular AAA server or AAA servers.
show aaa server [server_name]

Syntax Definitions
server_name The server name, which is defined through the aaa radius-server or
aaa ldap-server commands or automatically set as ace for ACE servers.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If you do not include a server name in the syntax, information for all servers displays.

• To display information about an ACE server, use ace as the server_name. Information for ACE is only
available if ACE is specified for Authenticated Switch Access through the aaa authentication
command.

Examples
-> show aaa server
Server name = ldap2
Server type = LDAP,
Host name 1 = ors40535,
Retry number = 3,
Timeout (in sec) = 2,
Port = 389,
Domain name = manager,
Search base = c=us,
Server name = rad1
Server type = RADIUS,
IP Address 1 = 10.10.2.1,
IP Address 2 = 10.10.3.5,
Retry number = 3,
Timeout (in sec) = 2,
Authentication port = 1645,
Accounting port = 1646
Server name = Tpub1
Server type = TACACS+,
IP Address 1 = 10.10.5.1,
Port = 3,
Timeout (in sec) = 2,
Encryption enabled = no

page 21-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

-> show aaa server ldap2


Server name = ldap2
Server type = LDAP,
Host name 1 = ors40535,
Retry number = 3,
Timeout (in sec) = 2,
Port = 389,
Domain name = manager,
Search base = c=us,

RADIUS, TACACS+, and LDAP parameters are configured through the aaa radius-server,
aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-server commands. Parameters for the ACE server are automatically set
by the switch.
output definitions
Server name The name of the server. The switch automatically assigns “ace” to an
ACE server. A RADIUS, TACACS+ or LDAP server name is defined
through the aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-
server commands respectively.
Server type The type of server (ACE, LDAP, TACACS+, or RADIUS).
Host name The name of the primary LDAP, TACACS+, or RADIUS host.
IP address The IP address(es) of the server.
Retry number The number of retries the switch makes to authenticate a user before
trying the backup server.
Timeout The timeout for server replies to authentication requests.
Port The port number for the primary LDAP or TACACS+ server.
Encryption enabled The status of the encryption.
Domain name The super-user or administrative distinguished name in the format rec-
ognized by the LDAP-enabled directory servers.
Search base The search base recognized by the LDAP-enabled directory servers.
Authentication port The UDP destination port for authentication requests.
Accounting port The UDP destination port for accounting requests.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-57


AAA Commands

Related Commands

aaa radius-server Configures or modifies a RADIUS server for Authenticated Switch


Access.
aaa ldap-server Configures or modifies an LDAP server for Authenticated Switch
Access.
aaa tacacs+-server Configures or modifies an TACACS+ server for Authenticated Switch
Access.

MIB Objects
aaaServerTable
aaasName
aaasHostName
aaasIpAddress
aaasHostName2
aaasIpAddress2
aaasRadKey
aaasRetries
aaasTimout
aaasRadAuthPort
aaasRadAcctPort
aaasProtocol
aaasTacacsKey
aaasTacacsPort
aaasLdapPort
aaasLdapDn
aaasLdapPasswd
aaasLdapSearchBase
aaasLdapServType
aaasLdapEnableSsl

page 21-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show aaa authentication


Displays information about the current authenticated switch session.
show aaa authentication

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the show aaa authentication command to display authentication information about switch manage-
ment services (Telnet, FTP, console port, Secure Shell, etc.).

Examples
-> show aaa authentication
Service type = Default
1rst authentication server = RadiusServer
2nd authentication server = local
Service type = Console
1rst authentication server = local
Service type = Telnet
Authentication = Use Default,
1rst authentication server = RadiusServer
2nd authentication server = local
Service type = FTP
Authentication = Use Default,
1rst authentication server = RadiusServer
2nd authentication server = local
Service type = Http
Authentication = Use Default,
1rst authentication server = RadiusServer
2nd authentication server = local
Service type = Snmp
Authentication = Use Default,
1rst authentication server = RadiusServer
2nd authentication server = local
Service type = Ssh
Authentication = Use Default,
1rst authentication server = TacacsServer
2nd authentication server = local

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-59


AAA Commands

output definitions
Authentication Displays denied if the management interface is disabled. Displays Use
Default if the management interface is configured to use the default
configuration.
1st authentication server The first server to be polled for authentication information.
2nd authentication server The next server to be polled for authentication information.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa authentication Configures the interface for Authenticated Switch Access and specifies
the server(s) to be used.

MIB Objects
aaaAuthSATable
aaatsName1
aaatsName2
aaatsName3
aaatsName4

page 21-60 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show aaa authentication 802.1x


Displays information about the global 802.1X configuration on the switch.
show aaa authentication 802.1x

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays information about 802.1X settings configured through the aaa authentication
802.1x command.

Examples
-> show aaa authentication 802.1x
1rst authentication server = nms-vlan-30,
port usage = unique

output definitions
1st authentication server The first server to be polled for authentication information. Any backup
servers are also displayed on subsequent lines.
port usage Whether 802.1X ports on the switch will only accept frames from the
supplicant’s MAC address after successful authentication (unique); or
the switch will accept any frames on 802.1X ports after successful
authentication (global)

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa authentication 802.1x Enables/disables the switch for 802.1X authentication.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-61


AAA Commands

MIB Objects
AaaAuth8021XTable
aaatxName1
aaatxName2
aaatxName3
aaatxName4
aaatxOpen

page 21-62 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show aaa authentication mac


Displays a list of RADIUS servers configured for MAC based authentication.
show aaa authentication mac

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays MAC authentication servers configured through the aaa authentication mac
command.

Examples
-> show aaa authentication mac
1rst authentication server = rad1,

output definitions
1st authentication server The first server to be polled for authentication information. Any backup
servers are also displayed on subsequent lines.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa authentication mac Enables/disables the switch for MAC based authentication.

MIB Objects
AaaAuthMACTable
aaaMacSrvrName1
aaaMacSrvrName2
aaaMacSrvrName3
aaaMacSrvrName4

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-63


AAA Commands

show aaa accounting 802.1x


Displays information about accounting servers for 802.1X sessions.
show aaa authentication 802.1x

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Accounting servers are configured through the aaa radius-server, aaa tacacs+-server, and aaa ldap-
server commands.

Examples
-> show aaa accounting 802.1x
1rst authentication server = onyx,
2nd accounting server = odyssey
3rd accounting server = local

output definitions
1st authentication server The first server to be polled for accounting of 802.1X sessions. Any
backup servers are also displayed on subsequent lines.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa accounting 802.1x Enables/disables accounting for 802.1X authentication sessions.

MIB Objects
AaaAcct8021XTable
aaacxName1
aaacxName2
aaacxName3
aaacxName4

page 21-64 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show aaa accounting


Displays information about accounting servers configured for Authenticated Switch Access and 802.1X
port-based network access control. Accounting servers keep track of network resources (time, packets,
bytes, etc.) and user activity.
show aaa accounting

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the show aaa accounting command to display accounting servers configured for management session
types (Telnet, FTP, console port, HTTP, or SNMP) and 802.1X port-based network access control.

Examples
-> show aaa accounting
Authenticated vlan = 23,
1rst accounting server = RadiusServer
2nd accounting server = local
Authenticated vlan = 24,
1rst accounting server = RadiusServer,
2nd accounting server = local
Authenticated vlan = 25,
1rst accounting server = RadiusServer,
2nd accounting server = local
Session (telnet, ftp,...),
1rst accounting server = RadiusServer,
2nd accounting server = local

output definitions
Authenticated vlan Authenticated VLANs are not supported.
Session Indicates servers for Authenticated Switch Access session.
1st authentication server The first server to be polled for authentication information.
2nd authentication server The next server to be polled for authentication information.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-65


AAA Commands

Related Commands

aaa accounting session Configures accounting servers for Authenticated Switch Access ses-
sions.
aaa accounting 802.1x Enables/disables accounting for 802.1X authentication sessions.

MIB Objects
aaaAcctSATable
aaacsName1
aaacsName2
aaacsName3
aaacsName4

page 21-66 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show user
Displays information about all users or a particular user configured in the local user database on the
switch.
show user [username]

Syntax Definitions
username The name of the user. Used for logging into the switch.

Defaults
By default, all users are displayed if the username parameter is not specified with this command.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to display information about read/write access and partitioned management access
(domains and families) or end-user profiles associated with users.

Examples
-> show user
User name = Customer1,
Password expiration = 10/27/2007 11:01 (30 days from now),
Password allow to be modified date = 9/30/2007 10:59 (3 days from now),
Account lockout = Yes (Automatically unlocked after 19 minute(s)from now),
Password bad attempts = 3,
Read Only for domains = None,
Read/Write for domains = Admin System Physical Layer2 Services policy Security ,
Read/Write for families = ip rip ip-routing ipmr ipms ,
Snmp allowed = YES,
Snmp authentication = SHA,
Snmp encryption = DES
User name = admin,
Password expiration = 10/27/2007 11:01 (30 days from now),
Password allow to be modified date = 9/30/2007 10:59 (3 days from now),
Account lockout = None,
Password bad attempts = 0,
Read Only for domains = None,
Read/Write for domains = All ,
Snmp allowed = NO
User name = j_smith,
Password expiration = 10/27/2007 11:01 (30 days from now),
Password allow to be modified date = 9/30/2007 10:59 (3 days from now),
Account lockout = Yes (Automatically unlocked after 19 minute(s)from now),
Password bad attempts = 3,
END user profile = u_profile1,
Snmp allowed = YES,
Snmp authentication = SHA,
Snmp encryption = DES

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-67


AAA Commands

User name = public,


Password expiration = 10/27/2007 11:01 (30 days from now),
Password allow to be modified date = 9/30/2007 10:59 (3 days from now),
Account lockout = None,
Password bad attempts = 0,
Read Only for domains = None,
Read/Write for domains = All ,
Snmp allowed = NO,
User name = default (*),
Password expiration = 10/27/2007 11:01 (30 days from now),
Password allow to be modified date = 9/30/2007 10:59 (3 days from now),
Account lockout = None,
Password bad attempts = 0,
Read Only for domains = None,
Read/Write for domains = System Physical Layer2 Services policy Security ,
Read/Write for families = file telnet dshell debug ip rip ip-routing ipmr ipms ,
Snmp allowed = NO,
(*)Note:
The default user is not an active user account.
It contains the default user account settings,
for new user accounts.

-> show user j_smith


User name = j_smith,
Password expiration = 10/27/2007 11:01 (30 days from now),
Password allow to be modified date = 9/30/2007 10:59 (3 days from now),
Account lockout = Yes (Automatically unlocked after 19 minute(s)from now),
Password bad attempts = 3,
END user profile = u_profile1,
Snmp allowed = YES,
Snmp authentication = SHA,
Snmp encryption = DES

output definitions
User name The user name for this account.
Password expiration The date and time on which the password will expire. This field only
displays if the password expiration is configured specifically for a user,
or a default password expiration is configured globally on the switch
through the user password-expiration command. (Note that the date/
time are based on the switch’s default system date/time or the system
date/time configured through the system date and system time com-
mands.)
Password allow to be modified The earliest date and time on which the user may change the password.
date Configured through the user password-min-age command.
Account lockout Indicates if the user account is locked out (Yes or No) and how many
minutes remain until the user account is automatically unlocked. If no
remaining time is displayed, the admin user or a user with admin privi-
leges must manually unlock the account. Configured through the user
lockout-duration and user lockout unlock commands.
Password bad attempts The number of failed password login attempts for this user account.
Read Only for domains The command domains available with the user’s read-only access. See
the table on the next page for a listing of valid domains. This field does
not display if an end-user profile is associated with the user account.

page 21-68 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

output definitions (continued)


Read/Write for domains The command domains available with the user’s read-write access. See
the table on the next page for a listing of valid domains. This field does
not display if an end-user profile is associated with the user account.
Read Only for families The command families available with the user’s read-only access. See
the table on the next page for a listing of valid families. This field does
not display if an end-user profile is associated with the user account.
Read/Write for families The command families available with the user’s read-write access. See
the table on the next page for a listing of valid families. This field does
not display if an end-user profile is associated with the user account.
END user profile The name of an end-user profile associated with the user account. Con-
figured through the end-user profile command. This field only dis-
plays if an end-user profile is associated with the user account.
Snmp allowed Indicates whether or not the user is authorized to use SNMP (YES or
NO). SNMP is allowed for the user account when SNMP authentica-
tion is specified for the account.
Snmp authentication The level of SNMP authentication, if any, configured for the user. This
field only displays if the user is authorized to use SNMP.
Snmp encryption The level of SNMP encryption, if any, configured for the user. This
field only displays if the user is authorized to use SNMP.

Possible values for command domains and families are listed here:

Domain Corresponding Families


domain-admin file telnet dshell debug
domain-system system aip snmp rmon webmgt config
domain-physical chassis module interface pmm health
domain-network ip rip ip-routing ipmr ipms
domain-layer2 vlan bridge stp 802.1q linkagg ip-helper
domain-service dns
domain-security session aaa

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-69


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user Configures user entries in the local user database.


show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.
show user lockout-setting Displays the global user lockout settings for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaUserTable
aaauUserName
aaauPasswordExpirationDate
aaauPasswordExpirationInMinute
aaauPasswordAllowModifyDate
aaauPasswordLockoutEnable
aaauBadAttempts
aaauReadRight1
aaauReadRight2
aaauWriteRight1
aaauWriteRight2
aaauEndUserProfile
aaauSnmpLevel
aaauSnmpAuthkey

page 21-70 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show user password-size


Displays the minimum number of characters that are required for a user password.
show user password-size

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to display the current minimum number of characters required when configuring user
passwords.

Examples
-> show user password-size
password, minimum size 9

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

user password-size min Configures the minimum number of characters required when configur-
ing a user password.
user Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database.
password Configures the current user’s password.
show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordSizeMin

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-71


AAA Commands

show user password-expiration


Displays the expiration date for passwords configured for user accounts stored on the switch.
show user password-expiration

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays the default password expiration, which is configured through the user password-
expiration command.

Examples
-> show user password-expiration
User password expiration is set to 3 days.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

user password-expiration Configures an expiration date for user passwords stored locally on the
switch or disables password expiration.
user Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database.
password Configures the current user’s password.
show user password-policy Displays the global password policy configuration for the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaDefaultPasswordExpirationInDays

page 21-72 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show user password-policy


Displays the global password settings configured for the switch.
show user password-policy

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The password policy contains parameter values that define configuration requirements for all passwords
that are created on the switch. Use this command to display the current parameter values for the password
policy.

Examples
-> show user password-policy
Password Policy:
Contain username flag: Enable
Minimum number of English uppercase characters: 6
Minimum number of English lowercase characters: 4
Minimum number of base-10 digit: 2
Minimum number of non-alphanumeric: 3
Minimum size: 8
Password history: 4
Password minimum age: 20 (days)
Password expiration: 40 (days)

output definitions
Contain username flag Indicates if the username is included with the password check (Enable
or Disable). Configured through the user password-policy cannot-
contain-username command.
Minimum number of English The minimum number of uppercase characters required in a password.
uppercase characters Configured through the user password-policy min-uppercase com-
mand.
Minimum number of English The minimum number of lowercase characters required in a password.
lowercase characters Configured through the user password-policy min-lowercase.
Minimum number of base-10 The minimum number of digits required in a password. Configured
digit through the user password-policy min-digit command.
Minimum number of non- The minimum number of non-alphanumeric characters required in a
alphanumeric password. Configured through the user password-policy min-nonal-
pha command.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-73


AAA Commands

output definitions
Minimum size The minimum number of characters required for the password size.
Configured through the user password-size min command.
Password history The maximum number of old passwords retained in the password his-
tory. Configured through the user password-history command.
Password minimum age The number of days a password is protected from any modification.
Configured through the user password-min-age command.
Password expiration The default expiration date applied to all passwords. Configured
through the user password-expiration command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show user password-size Displays the minimum number of characters that are required for a user
password.

show user password-expiration Displays the expiration date for passwords configured for user accounts
stored on the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaPasswordContainUserName
aaaAsaPasswordMinUpperCase
aaaAsaPasswordMinLowerCase
aaaAsaPasswordMinDigit
aaaAsaPasswordMinNonAlpha
aaaAsaPasswordHistory
aaaAsaPasswordMinAge
aaaAsaPasswordSizeMin
aaaAsaDefaultPasswordExpirationInDays

page 21-74 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show user lockout-setting


Displays the global user lockout settings for the switch.
show user lockout-setting

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The global lockout settings include parameter values that determine the length of a user observation
window, the amount of time a locked user remains locked, and the number of failed password login
attempts allowed.

Examples
-> show user lockout-setting
Lockout Setting:
Observation window: 30 (minutes)
Duration: 200 (minutes)
Threshold: 20

output definitions
Observation window The amount of time, in minutes, during which the number of failed
password login attempts are counted. Configured through the user
lockout-window command.
Duration The amount of time, in minutes, that a locked user account remains
locked out of the switch. Configured through the user lockout-dura-
tion command.
Threshold The maximum number of failed password login attempts allowed
before the user is locked out of the switch. Configured through the user
lockout-threshold command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-75


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user lockout unlock Manually locks or unlocks a user account on the switch.
show user Displays information about all users or a particular user configured in
the local user database on the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAsaConfig
aaaAsaLockoutWindow
aaaAsaLockoutDuration
aaaAsaLockoutThreshold

page 21-76 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

debug command-info
Enables or disables the command information mode in the CLI. When this mode is enabled, any command
entered on the command line will display information about the command rather than executing the
command.
debug command-info {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the debugging command information mode.
disable Disables the debugging command information mode.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the mode is enabled, any command entered will result in output similar to the one shown in the
Examples section below. Any commands entered when the mode is enabled are not executed. To return
to normal operating mode, enter debug command-info disable.
• The command information mode is useful when setting privileges for users.

Examples
-> debug command-info enable
CLI command info mode on
-> vlan 2
PM family: VLAN
R/W mode: WRITE
-> ls
PM family: SYSTEM
R/W mode: READ

output definitions
PM family The partitioned management (PM) command family to which the com-
mand belongs.
R/W mode Whether the current command is a read-only or a write command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-77


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database.

page 21-78 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

debug end-user profile


Use this command to display detailed information about profiles or a particular profile.
debug end-user profile name

Syntax Definitions
name The name of the end-user profile, configured through the end-user
profile command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the show end-user profile command to display basic information about end-user profiles.

• If a particular profile is specified, information will be displayed for the profile and for all indexes
following that profile. (The index value is the way the switch internally tracks profiles and reflects the
order in which profiles are created.)

Examples
-> debug end-user profile
End user profile : jentest, length : 7 for index : 1
End user profile @0x5e781e8
Read area rights : 3f
Read and Write area rights : 0
Physical area rights : 2
vlan table area rights : 2
Basic Ip routing area rights : 2
Ip routes table area rights : 2
Mac filtering table area rights : 2
Spantree area rights : 2
Slot 1, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 2, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 3, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 4, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 5, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 6, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 7, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 8, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 9, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 10, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 11, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 12, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 13, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 14, ports : 0 0 0 0
Slot 15, ports : 0 0 0 0

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-79


AAA Commands

Slot 16, ports : 0 0 0 0


Vlan Id range number : 1
Vlan range 1, start : 1, end : 3
End user profile not created for index : 2
End user profile not created for index : 3
End user profile not created for index : 4
End user profile not created for index : 5
End user profile not created for index : 6
End user profile not created for index : 7
End user profile not created for index : 8
End user profile not created for index : 9
End user profile not created for index : 10
.
.
.
.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

end-user profile Configures or modifies an end user profile, which specifies access to
command areas on particular ports and VLANs.
show end-user profile Displays information about end-user profiles or a particular end-user
profile.

page 21-80 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show end-user profile


Displays basic information about end-user profiles or a particular end-user profile.
show end-user profile name

Syntax Definitions
name The name of the end-user profile (up to 32 alphanumeric characters).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The show end-user profile command displays information about profiles configured on the switch.
For information about users, use the show user command.
• If a particular profile is not specified, information about all profiles is displayed.

Examples
-> show end-user profile Prof1

End user profile : Prof1


Area accessible with read and write rights :
physical,
vlan table,
basic ip routing,
ip routes table,
mac filtering table,
spantree
Slot : 1, ports allowed : 1-2, 4-5, 7-8, 10-11, 13-14, 16-17, 19-20, 22-24
Slot : 2, ports allowed : 1-2, 4-5, 7-8, 10-11, 13-14, 16-17, 19-20, 22-24
Slot : 3, ports allowed : 1-2, 4-5, 7-8, 10-11, 13-14, 16-17, 19-20, 22-24
Slot : 4, ports allowed : 1-2, 4-5, 7-8, 10-11, 13-14, 16-17, 19-20, 22-24
Vlan Id :
1-18, 23, 27-1001, 4073-4092

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-81


AAA Commands

Related Commands

end-user profile Configures or modifies an end user profile, which specifies access to
command areas on particular ports and VLANs.
user Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database.

MIB Objects
endUserProfileTable
endUserProfileName
endUserProfileAreaPhysical
endUserProfileAreaVlanTable
endUserProfileAreaBasicIPRouting
endUserProfileAreaIpRoutesTable
endUserProfileAreaMacFilteringTable
endUserProfileAreaSpantree
endUserProfileSlotPortTable
endUserProfileSlotNumber
endUserProfilePortList
endUserProfileVlanIdTable
endUserProfileVlanIdStart
endUserProfileVlandIdEnd

page 21-82 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

show aaa user-network-profile


Displays the user network profile table.
show aaa user-network-profile

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show aaa user-network-profile
Role name: engineering vlan = 10
Role name: accounting vlan = 20

output definitions
Role name The user profile name.
vlan The VLAN number.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

aaa user-network-profile Creates the user role in the user network profile table and maps the role
to a VLAN ID.

MIB Objects
aaaUserNetProfileTable
aaaUserNetProfileName
aaaUserNetProfileVlanID

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-83


AAA Commands

show aaa priv hexa


Displays hexadecimal values for command domains/families. Useful for determining how to express
command families in hexadecimal; hexadecimal values are used in configuring user privileges in attributes
on an external LDAP or RADIUS authentication server.
show aaa priv hexa [domain or family]

Syntax Definitions
domain or family The CLI command domain or particular command family for which you
want to display hexadecimal values. See table in Usage Guidelines.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Valid values for the family parameter are listed in the Corresponding Families column of the following
table:

Domain Corresponding Families


domain-admin file telnet dshell debug
domain-system system aip snmp rmon webmgt config
domain-physical chassis module interface pmm health
domain-network ip rip ip-routing ipmr ipms
domain-layer2 vlan bridge stp 802.1q linkagg ip-helper
domain-service dns
domain-security session aaa

• Note that some command families may not be supported depending on the hardware platform you are
running.
• If you do not specify a command family, hexadecimal values for all commands sets will display.

page 21-84 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


AAA Commands

Examples
-> show aaa priv hexa
file = 0x00000001 0x00000000,
telnet = 0x00000008 0x00000000,
dshell = 0x00000020 0x00000000,
debug = 0x00000040 0x00000000,
domain-admin = 0x00000069 0x00000000,

system = 0x00000080 0x00000000,


aip = 0x00000100 0x00000000,
snmp = 0x00000200 0x00000000,
rmon = 0x00000400 0x00000000,
webmgt = 0x00000800 0x00000000,
config = 0x00001000 0x00000000,
domain-system = 0x00001F80 0x00000000,

chassis = 0x00002000 0x00000000,


module = 0x00004000 0x00000000,
interface = 0x00008000 0x00000000,
pmm = 0x00010000 0x00000000,
health = 0x00040000 0x00000000,
domain-physical = 0x0005E000 0x00000000,

ip = 0x00080000 0x00000000,
rip = 0x00100000 0x00000000,
ip-routing = 0x01000000 0x00000000,
ipmr = 0x04000000 0x00000000,
ipms = 0x08000000 0x00000000,
domain-network = 0x0FF80000 0x00000000,

vlan = 0x10000000 0x00000000,


bridge = 0x20000000 0x00000000,
stp = 0x40000000 0x00000000,
802.1q = 0x80000000 0x00000000,
linkagg = 0x00000000 0x00000001,
ip-helper = 0x00000000 0x00000002,
domain-layer2 = 0xF0000000 0x00000003,

dns = 0x00000000 0x00000010,


domain-service = 0x00000000 0x00000010,

qos = 0x00000000 0x00000020,


policy = 0x00000000 0x00000040,
domain-policy = 0x00000000 0x000000E0,

session = 0x00000000 0x00000100,


aaa = 0x00000000 0x00000800,
domain-security = 0x00000000 0x00000D00

-> show aaa priv hexa rip


0x00100000 0x00000000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 21-85


AAA Commands

Related Commands

user Configures or modifies user entries in the local user database.

page 21-86 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


22 Port Mobility Commands

Port mobility allows dynamic VLAN port assignment based on VLAN rules that are applied to port traf-
fic. By default, all switch ports are non-mobile ports that are manually assigned to a specific VLAN and
can only belong to one VLAN at a time. When a port is defined as a mobile port, switch software
compares traffic coming in on the port with configured VLAN rules. If any of the mobile port traffic
matches any of the VLAN rules, the port and the matching traffic become a member of that VLAN. It is
also possible for mobile ports to belong to more than one VLAN, when the port carries multiple traffic
types that match different rules on different VLANs.
VLANs do not have a mobile or non-mobile distinction and there is no overall switch setting to invoke the
mobile port feature. Instead, mobility is enabled on individual switch ports and rules are defined for indi-
vidual VLANs to capture mobile port traffic. This chapter includes descriptions of Command Line Inter-
face (CLI) commands used to define VLAN rules, enable or disable mobile port properties, and display
mobile port configuration information.
MIB information for port mobility commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1GroupMobility.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-GROUP-MOBILITY-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

vlan dhcp mac


vlan dhcp mac range
vlan dhcp port
vlan dhcp generic
vlan mac
vlan mac range
vlan ip
vlan protocol
vlan port
vlan port mobile
vlan port default vlan restore
vlan port default vlan
vlan port authenticate
vlan port 802.1x
show vlan rules
show vlan port mobile

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-1


Port Mobility Commands

vlan dhcp mac


Defines a DHCP MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. If a DHCP frame received on any mobile port
contains a source MAC address that matches the MAC address specified in the rule, the frame’s mobile
port is temporarily assigned to the rule’s VLAN.
vlan vid dhcp mac mac_address
vlan vid no dhcp mac mac_address

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
mac_address Source MAC address (e.g., 00:00:39:59:f1:0C).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a DHCP MAC address rule from the specified VLAN.

• Port mobility software checks for and processes DHCP traffic first on an active mobile port. When a
mobile port receives a DHCP frame that matches a DHCP rule, the port is temporarily assigned to the
VLAN long enough to forward the DHCP requests within the VLAN broadcast domain. The source
MAC address of the DHCP frame, however, is not learned for that VLAN port association.
• Once a DHCP device has obtained an IP address, its non-DHCP traffic must match other VLAN rules
within the same VLAN for the device to remain a member of that VLAN. If this match occurs, then the
frame source is learned in the matching rule VLAN.
• DHCP rules are most often used in combination with IP network address rules. A DHCP client has an
IP address of all zeros (0.0.0.0) until it receives an IP address from a DHCP server, so it would not
match any IP network address rules.
• Binding rules, MAC address rules, and protocol rules also capture DHCP client traffic. The exception
to this is binding rules that specify an IP address as part of the rule, similar to IP network address rule
definitions.
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 dhcp mac 00:00:39:59:0a:0c
-> vlan 20 dhcp mac 00:00:39:4f:f1:22
-> vlan 10 no dhcp mac 00:00:39:59:0a:0c

page 22-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan dhcp mac range Defines a DHCP MAC address range rule for an existing VLAN.
Mobile ports that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that
falls within the range specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to
the VLAN.
vlan dhcp port Defines a DHCP port rule for an existing VLAN. The mobile port spec-
ified by this rule is temporarily assigned to the VLAN when it receives
DHCP frames.
vlan dhcp generic Defines a generic DHCP rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports that
receive DHCP frames that do not match other DHCP rules are tempo-
rarily assigned to the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vDhcpMacRuleTable
vDhcpMacRuleAddr
vDhcpMacRuleVlanId
vDhcpMacRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-3


Port Mobility Commands

vlan dhcp mac range


Defines a DHCP MAC range rule for an existing VLAN. If a DHCP frame contains a source MAC address
that matches the low or high end MAC or falls within the range defined by the low and high end MAC, the
frame’s mobile port is temporarily assigned to the rule’s VLAN.
vlan vid dhcp mac range low_mac_address high_mac_address
vlan vid no dhcp mac range low_mac_address

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
low_mac_address MAC address that defines the low end of the range (e.g.,
00:00:39:59:f1:00).
high_mac_address MAC address that defines the high end of the range (e.g.,
00:00:39:59:f1:90).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a DHCP MAC range rule from the specified VLAN. It is
only necessary to specify the low end MAC to identify which rule to delete; the high end MAC is not
required.
• Only valid source MAC addresses are allowed for the low and high end boundary MACs. For exam-
ple, multicast addresses (e.g., 01:00:00:c5:09:1a) are ignored even if they fall within a specified MAC
range. To allow the use of a multicast address as either the low or high end boundary MAC would
cause misleading DHCP MAC range rule results.
• Port mobility software checks for and processes DHCP traffic first on an active mobile port. When a
mobile port receives a DHCP frame that matches a DHCP rule, the port is temporarily assigned to the
VLAN long enough to forward the DHCP requests within the VLAN broadcast domain. The source
MAC address of the DHCP frame, however, is not learned for that VLAN port association.
• Once a DHCP device has obtained an IP address, its non-DHCP traffic must match other VLAN rules
within the same VLAN for the device to remain a member of that VLAN. If this match occurs, then the
frame source is learned in the matching rule VLAN.
• DHCP rules are most often used in combination with IP network address rules. A DHCP client has an
IP address of all zeros (0.0.0.0) until it receives an IP address from a DHCP server, so it would not
match any IP network address rules.

page 22-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

• MAC address rules and protocol rules also capture DHCP client traffic.

• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 dhcp mac range 00:00:39:59:0a:0c 00:00:39:59:0a:0f
-> vlan 10 no dhcp mac range 00:00:39:59:0a:0c

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan dhcp mac Defines a DHCP MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports
that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that matches the
address specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to the VLAN.
vlan dhcp port Defines a DHCP port rule for an existing VLAN. The mobile port spec-
ified by this rule is temporarily assigned to the VLAN when it receives
DHCP frames.
vlan dhcp generic Defines a generic DHCP rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports that
receive DHCP frames that do not match other DHCP rules are tempo-
rarily assigned to the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-5


Port Mobility Commands

vlan dhcp port


Defines a DHCP port rule for an existing VLAN. If a DHCP frame is received on a mobile port that
matches the port specified in the rule, the mobile port is temporarily assigned to the rule’s VLAN.
vlan vid dhcp port slot/port
vlan vid no dhcp port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots
and ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a DHCP port rule from the specified VLAN.

• Port mobility software checks for and processes DHCP traffic first on an active mobile port. When a
mobile port receives a DHCP frame that matches a DHCP rule, the port is temporarily assigned to the
VLAN long enough to forward the DHCP requests within the VLAN broadcast domain. The source
MAC address of the DHCP frame, however, is not learned for that VLAN port association.
• Once a DHCP device has obtained an IP address, its non-DHCP traffic must match other VLAN rules
within the same VLAN for the device to remain a member of that VLAN. If this match occurs, then the
frame source is learned in the matching rule VLAN.
• DHCP rules are most often used in combination with IP network address rules. A DHCP client has an
IP address of all zeros (0.0.0.0) until it receives an IP address from a DHCP server, so it would not
match any IP network address rules.
• Binding rules, MAC address rules, and protocol rules also capture DHCP client traffic. The exception
to this is binding rules that specify an IP address as part of the rule, similar to IP network address rule
definitions.
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

page 22-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Examples
-> vlan 10 dhcp port 3/1
-> van 20 dhcp port 4/1-16
-> vlan 30 dhcp port 5/1-32 6/5-10 8/7-22
-> vlan 10 no dhcp port 3/1
-> vlan 20 no dhcp port 4/1-16

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan dhcp mac Defines a DHCP MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports
that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that matches the
address specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to the VLAN.
vlan dhcp mac range Defines a DHCP MAC address range rule for an existing VLAN.
Mobile ports that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that
falls within the range specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to
the VLAN.
vlan dhcp generic Defines a generic DHCP rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports that
receive DHCP frames that do not match other DHCP rules are tempo-
rarily assigned to the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vDhcpPortRuleTable
vDhcpPortRuleIfIndex
vDhcpPortRuleVlanId
vDhcpPortRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-7


Port Mobility Commands

vlan dhcp generic


Defines a DHCP rule for an existing VLAN. If a DHCP frame does not match any other DHCP rule crite-
ria, the frame’s mobile port is temporarily assigned to the DHCP generic rule VLAN.
vlan vid dhcp generic
vlan vid no dhcp generic

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Defaults
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a DHCP generic rule from the specified VLAN.

• Only one DHCP generic rule per switch is allowed.

• Port mobility software checks for and processes DHCP traffic first on an active mobile port. When a
mobile port receives a DHCP frame that matches a DHCP rule, the port is temporarily assigned to the
VLAN long enough to forward the DHCP requests within the VLAN broadcast domain. The source
MAC address of the DHCP frame, however, is not learned for that VLAN port association.
• Once a DHCP device has obtained an IP address, its non-DHCP traffic must match other VLAN rules
within the same VLAN for the device to remain a member of that VLAN. If this match occurs, then the
frame source is learned in the matching rule VLAN.
• DHCP rules are most often used in combination with IP network address rules. A DHCP client has an
IP address of all zeros (0.0.0.0) until it receives an IP address from a DHCP server, so it would not
match any IP network address rules.
• Binding rules, MAC address rules, and protocol rules also capture DHCP client traffic. The exception
to this is binding rules that specify an IP address as part of the rule, similar to IP network address rule
definitions.
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 dhcp generic
-> vlan 10 no dhcp generic

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 22-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Related Commands

vlan dhcp port Defines a DHCP port rule for an existing VLAN. The mobile port spec-
ified by this rule is temporarily assigned to the VLAN when it receives
DHCP frames.
vlan dhcp mac Defines a DHCP MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports
that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that matches the
address specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to the VLAN.
vlan dhcp mac range Defines a DHCP MAC address range rule for an existing VLAN.
Mobile ports that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that
falls within the range specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to
the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vDhcpGenericRuleTable
vDhcpGenericRuleVlanId
vDhcpGenericRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-9


Port Mobility Commands

vlan mac
Defines a MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. If the source MAC address of a device matches a
MAC address specified in this rule, the device and its mobile port will join the VLAN when the device
starts to send traffic.
vlan vid mac mac_address
vlan vid no mac mac_address

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
mac_address MAC address (e.g., 00:00:39:59:f1:0c).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a MAC address rule from the specified VLAN.

• Once a device joins a MAC address rule VLAN, then it is not eligible to join multiple VLANs even if
the device traffic matches other VLAN rules.
• Mac address rules take precedence behind DHCP and binding rules.

• MAC address rules also capture DHCP traffic, if no other DHCP rule exists that would classify the
DHCP traffic into another VLAN. Therefore, it is not necessary to combine DHCP rules with MAC
address rules for the same VLAN.
• If there are a large number of devices that must join a VLAN, try MAC range rules (see vlan mac
range command on page 22-12).
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 mac 00:00:39:59:0a:0c
-> vlan 20 mac 00:00:39:4f:f1:22
-> vlan 10 no mac 00:00:39:59:0a:0c

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 22-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Related Commands

vlan mac range Defines a MAC range rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports that
receive frames with a source MAC address that falls within the range
specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vMacRuleTable
vMacRuleAddr
vMacRuleVlanId
vMacRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-11


Port Mobility Commands

vlan mac range


Defines a MAC range rule for an existing VLAN. If the source MAC address of a device matches the low
or high end MAC or falls within the range defined by the low and high end MAC, the device and its
mobile port will join the VLAN when the device starts to send traffic.
vlan vid mac range low_mac_address high_mac_address
vlan vid no mac range low_mac_address

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
low_mac_address MAC address that defines the low end of the range (e.g.,
00:00:39:59:f1:00).
high_mac_address MAC address that defines the high end of the range (e.g.,
00:00:39:59:f1:90).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a MAC range rule from the specified VLAN. It is only
necessary to enter the low end MAC address to identify which rule to delete; the high end MAC is not
required.
• Only valid source MAC addresses are allowed for the low and high end boundary MACs. For exam-
ple, multicast addresses (e.g., 01:00:00:c5:09:1a) are ignored even if they fall within a specified MAC
range. To allow the use of a multicast address as either the low or high end boundary MAC would
cause misleading MAC range rule results.
• Once a device joins a MAC range rule VLAN, then it is not eligible to join multiple VLANs even if the
device traffic matches other VLAN rules.
• MAC range rules follow the same precedence as MAC address rules.

• MAC range rules also capture DHCP traffic, if no other DHCP rule exists that would classify the
DHCP traffic into another VLAN. Therefore, it is not necessary to combine DHCP rules with MAC
range rules for the same VLAN.
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 mac range 00:00:39:59:0a:0c 00:00:39:59:0a:0f
-> vlan 10 no mac range 00:00:39:59:0a:0c

page 22-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan mac Defines a MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports that
receive frames with a source MAC address that matches the address
specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vMacRangeRuleTable
vMacRangeRuleLoAddr
vMacRangeRuleHiAddr
vMacRangeRuleVlanId
vMacRangeRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-13


Port Mobility Commands

vlan ip
Defines an IP network address rule for an existing VLAN. If a device sends traffic that matches the IP
address specified in the rule, the device and its mobile port will join the rule’s VLAN.
vlan vid ip ip_address [subnet_mask]
vlan vid no ip ip_address [subnet_mask]

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
ip_address IP network address (e.g., 10.0.0.0, 171.15.0.0, 196.190.254.0)
subnet_mask Class A, B, or C subnet mask (e.g., 255.0.0.0, 255.255.0.0, or
255.255.255.0).

Defaults
By default, the subnet mask is set to the default subnet mask value for the IP address class.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete an IP network address rule from the specified VLAN.

• Network address rules take precedence behind DHCP, binding, and MAC address rules.

• Use DHCP rules in combination with IP network address rules to capture and forward DHCP traffic.

• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 ip 51.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
-> vlan 20 ip 21.0.0.0
-> vlan 10 no ip 21.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
-> vlan 10 no ip 51.0.0.0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 22-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Related Commands

vlan dhcp mac Defines a DHCP MAC address rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports
that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that matches the
address specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to the VLAN.
vlan dhcp mac range Defines a DHCP MAC address range rule for an existing VLAN.
Mobile ports that receive DHCP frames with a source MAC address that
falls within the range specified by this rule are temporarily assigned to
the VLAN.
vlan dhcp port Defines a DHCP port rule for an existing VLAN. The mobile port spec-
ified by this rule is temporarily assigned to the VLAN when it receives
DHCP frames.
vlan dhcp generic Defines a generic DHCP rule for an existing VLAN. Mobile ports that
receive DHCP frames that do not match other DHCP rules are tempo-
rarily assigned to the VLAN.
show vlan Displays existing VLANs.
show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vIpNetRuleTable
vIpNetRuleAddr
vIpNetRuleMask
vIpNetRuleVlanId
vIpNetRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-15


Port Mobility Commands

vlan protocol
Defines a protocol rule for an existing VLAN. If a device sends traffic that matches the protocol value
specified in the rule, the device and its mobile port will join the rule’s VLAN.
vlan vid protocol {ip-e2 | ip-snap | decnet | appletalk |
ethertype type | dsapssap dsap/ssap | snap snaptype}
vlan vid no protocol {ip-e2 | ip-snap | decnet | appletalk |
ethertype type | dsapssap dsap/ssap | snap snaptype}

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
ip-e2 IP Ethernet-II protocol. Also captures Address Resolution Protocol
(ARP).
ip-snap IP Sub-network Access Protocol (SNAP) protocol.
decnet DECNET Phase IV (6003) protocol.
appletalk AppleTalk protocol. Also captures Datagram Delivery Protocol (DDP)
and AppleTalk ARP (AARP).
type A two-byte hex value between 0x600 and 0xffff that defines an Ether-
net type (e.g., 0600, 0806, 6002).
dsap/ssap A one-byte hex value between 0x00 and 0xff that defines Destination
Service Access Protocol (DSAP) and Source Service Access Protocol
(SSAP) header values. Specify both a DSAP and an SSAP value for this
parameter variable (e.g., F0/F0, 04/04, BC/BC).
snaptype A two-byte hex value between 0x600 and 0xffff that defines a SNAP
protocol.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a protocol rule from the specified VLAN.

• Use the ethertype, dsapssap, or snap parameters if none of the generic protocol rule parameters (ip-
e2, ip-snap, decnet, appletalk) provide the necessary rule definition for a specific traffic protocol.
• If an attempt is made to define an Ethertype rule with a protocol type value that is equal to the value
already captured by one of the generic IP protocol rules, a message displays recommending the use of
the IP generic rule.
• Protocol rules take precedence behind DHCP, binding, MAC address, and network address rules.

page 22-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

• IP protocol rules (ipE2 and ipSnap) also capture DHCP traffic, if no other DHCP rule exists that would
classify the DHCP traffic into another VLAN. Therefore, it is not necessary to combine DHCP rules
with protocol rules for the same VLAN.
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

Examples
-> vlan 10 protocol ip-e2
-> vlan 30 protocol ethertype 0600
-> vlan 40 protocol dsapssap F0/F0
-> vlan 50 protocol snap 6004
-> vlan 10 no protocol ip-snap
-> vlan 30 no protocol ethertype 0806
-> vlan 40 no protocol dsapssap 04/04
-> vlan 50 no protocol snap 80FE

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan Displays existing VLANs.


show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vProtocolRuleTable
vProtoRuleProtoClass
vProtoRuleEthertype
vProtoRuleDsapSsap
vProtoRuleVlanId
vProtoRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-17


Port Mobility Commands

vlan port
Defines a port rule for an existing VLAN. An active mobile port that is specified in a port rule, dynami-
cally joins the VLAN even if traffic on that port does not get learned or matches any VLAN rules. The
specified port becomes a VLAN member only for the purpose of forwarding broadcast traffic for a VLAN
on that port. The advantage to this is that traffic from multiple VLANs can flood out on a single port.
vlan vid port slot/port
vlan vid no port slot/port

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots
and ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a port rule from the specified VLAN.

• Port rules are for silent devices, such as printers, that require VLAN membership to receive traffic
forwarded from the VLAN. These devices usually don’t send traffic, so they do not trigger dynamic
assignment of their mobile ports to a VLAN.
• Port rules do not classify incoming traffic on the specified mobile port. Incoming traffic is classified for
VLAN assignment in the same manner as all other mobile port traffic.
• VLAN assignments that are defined using port rules are exempt from the port’s default VLAN restore
status.
• An alternative to port rules is to manually assign a port to a VLAN by using the vlan port default
command. This applies to both mobile and non-mobile ports.
• Rules are only assigned to existing VLANs. Use the vlan command to create a new VLAN.

page 22-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Examples
-> vlan 10 port 3/10
-> vlan 20 port 6/1-32
-> vlan 500 port 2/1-12 4/10-16 8/4-17
-> vlan 30 no port 9/11
-> vlan 40 no port 4/1-16
-> vlan 600 no port 2/14-20 7/1-9

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan Displays existing VLANs.


show vlan rules Displays rules defined for VLANs.

MIB Objects
vPortRuleTable
vPortRuleIfIndes
vPortRuleVlanId
vPortRuleStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-19


Port Mobility Commands

vlan port mobile


Configures Ethernet ports as mobile ports and enables or disables BPDU ignore. Mobile ports are eligible
for dynamic VLAN assignment, which occurs when mobile port traffic matches a VLAN rule on one or
more VLANs. Typically, mobility is applied to ports that do not send or receive BPDUs. However,
enabling BPDU ignore allows BPDU ports to also participate in dynamic VLAN assignment.

Note. Enabling BPDU ignore is not recommended. In specific cases where it is required, such as connect-
ing legacy networks to port mobility networks, make sure that ignoring BPDUs on a mobile port will not
cause network loops to go undetected. Connectivity problems could also result if a mobile BPDU port
dynamically moves out of its configured default VLAN where it provides traffic flow to and from another
switch.

vlan port mobile slot/port [bpdu ignore {enable | disable}]


vlan no port mobile slot/port

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots and
ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).
enable Enables BPDU ignore on a mobile port.
disable Disables BPDU ignore on a mobile port.

Defaults
By default, all ports are non-mobile (fixed) ports.

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable mobility on the specified port.

• Only 10/100 and gigabit Ethernet ports are eligible for mobile port status.

• Mobile ports can join more than one VLAN. For example, if a device connected to a mobile port sends
IP and Appletalk traffic and VLAN 10 has an IP protocol rule and VLAN 20 has an appletalk protocol
rule, the mobile port and its device dynamically join both VLANs. However, certain rules, such as
MAC address rules, can limit port membership to one VLAN.

page 22-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

• When a VLAN is administratively disabled, manual port and dynamic mobile port assignments are
retained but traffic on these ports is not forwarded. However, VLAN rules remain active and continue
to classify mobile port traffic for VLAN membership.
• When a BPDU is received on a mobile port and BPDU ignore is disabled, the port is changed to a fixed
(non-mobile) port that is associated only with its configured default VLAN. Also, the BPDU port
participates in the Spanning Tree algorithm. When BPDU ignore is enabled, a mobile port that receives
a BPDU remains mobile and is not included in Spanning Tree topology calculations.
• Enabling mobility on an active port that sends or receives BPDU (e.g. ports that connect two switches
and Spanning Tree is enabled on both the ports and their assigned VLANs) is not allowed. If mobility
is required on this type of port, enable mobility and the BPDU ignore flag when the port is not active.

Examples
-> vlan port mobile 3/1
-> vlan port mobile 3/1-16
-> vlan port mobile 3/1-16 4/17-32 8/4-12
-> vlan port mobile 5/22 authenticate enable
-> vlan port mobile 6/12-16 authenticate disable
-> vlan no port mobile 2/1
-> vlan no port mobile 3/1-16
-> vlan no port mobile 4/17-32 8/4-12

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan port default vlan restore Enables default VLAN restore on a mobile port.
vlan port default vlan Enables default VLAN membership for mobile port traffic that does not
match any VLAN rules.
vlan port authenticate Enables or disables authentication on a mobile port.
show vlan port mobile Displays mobile port properties.

MIB Objects
vMobilePortTable
vMobilePortIIfIndex
vMobilePortMobility
vMobilePortIgnoreBPDU

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-21


Port Mobility Commands

vlan port default vlan restore


Enables or disables default VLAN restore for a mobile port. Use this command to specify if a mobile port
should retain or drop its dynamic VLAN assignments after all MAC addresses learned on that port have
aged out.
vlan port slot/port default vlan restore {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots
and ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).
enable Enable default VLAN restore for the specified mobile port. VLAN
assignments are dropped when port traffic ages out.
disable Disable default VLAN restore for the specified mobile port. VLAN
assignments are retained when port traffic ages out.

Defaults
By default, VLAN restore is enabled on mobile ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a hub is connected to a mobile port, enabling default VLAN restore on that port is recommended.

• If a VLAN port rule exists for a mobile port, it will remain a member of the port rule VLAN even if
default VLAN restore is enabled for that port.
• When a mobile port link is disabled and then enabled, the port is always returned to its configured
default VLAN. Switch ports are disabled when a device is disconnected from the port, a configuration
change is made to disable the port, or switch power is turned off.

Examples
-> vlan port 3/1 default vlan restore enable
-> vlan port 5/2 default vlan restore disable
-> vlan port 6/1-32 8/10-24 9/3-14 default vlan restore enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 22-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Related Commands

vlan port mobile Configures Ethernet ports as mobile ports.


vlan port default vlan Enables default VLAN membership for mobile port traffic that does not
match any VLAN rules.
vlan port authenticate Enables or disables authentication on a mobile port.
show vlan port mobile Displays mobile port properties.

MIB Objects
vMobilePortTable
vMobilePortIIfIndex
vMobilePortDefVlanRestore

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-23


Port Mobility Commands

vlan port default vlan


Enables or disables the forwarding of mobile port traffic on the configured default VLAN for the mobile
port when the traffic does not match any VLAN rules.
vlan port slot/port default vlan {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots
and ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).
enable Enable the configured default VLAN for the specified mobile port.
disable Disable the configured default VLAN for the specified mobile port.

Defaults
Default VLAN is enabled on mobile ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• It is recommended that mobile ports with their default VLAN disabled should not share a VLAN with
any other types of ports (e.g., mobile ports with default VLAN enabled or non-mobile, fixed ports).
• If the default VLAN is enabled for a mobile port, traffic that does not match any VLAN rules is
forwarded on the default VLAN.
• If the default VLAN is disabled for the mobile port, traffic that does not match any VLAN rules is
dropped.
• When a port (mobile or fixed) is manually assigned to a default VLAN or is still a member of default
VLAN 1, then that association is referred to as the configured default VLAN for the port. If a mobile
port is dynamically assigned to additional VLANs, these subsequent associations are referred to as
secondary VLANs.

Examples
-> vlan port 3/1 default vlan enable
-> vlan port 5/2 default vlan disable
-> vlan port 6/1-32 8/10-24 9/3-14 default vlan enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 22-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Related Commands

vlan port mobile Configures Ethernet ports as mobile ports.


vlan port default vlan restore Enables default VLAN restore on a mobile port.
vlan port authenticate Enables or disables authentication on a mobile port.
show vlan port mobile Displays mobile port properties.

MIB Objects
vMobilePortTable
vMobilePortIIfIndex
vMobilePortDefVlanEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-25


Port Mobility Commands

vlan port authenticate


Enables or disables authentication on a mobile port.
vlan port slot/port authenticate {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots
and ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).
enable Enable authentication on the specified mobile port.
disable Disable authentication on the specified mobile port.

Defaults
By default, authentication is disabled on mobile ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
At this time, authentication is only supported on mobile ports.

Examples
-> vlan port 3/1 authenticate enable
-> vlan port 5/2 authenticate disable
-> vlan port 6/1-32 8/10-24 9/3-14 authenticate enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; command was deprecated.

page 22-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

Related Commands

vlan port mobile Configures Ethernet ports as mobile ports.


vlan port 802.1x Enables or disables 802.1X port-based access control on a mobile port.
show vlan port mobile Displays mobile port properties.

MIB Objects
vMobilePortTable
vMobilePortIIfIndex
vMobilePortAuthenticate

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-27


Port Mobility Commands

vlan port 802.1x


Enables or disables 802.1X port-based access control on a mobile port.
vlan port slot/port 802.1x {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots
and ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).
enable Enable 802.1x on the specified mobile port.
disable Disable 802.1x on the specified mobile port.

Defaults
By default, 802.1x is disabled on mobile ports.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• At this time, 802.1X is only supported on mobile ports.

• Authentication and 802.1X are mutually exclusive on a given mobile port.

Examples
-> vlan port 3/1 802.1x enable
-> vlan port 5/2 802.1x disable
-> vlan port 6/1-32 8/10-24 9/3-14 802.1x enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vlan port mobile Configures Ethernet ports as mobile ports.


vlan port authenticate Enables or disables authentication on a mobile port.
show vlan port mobile Displays mobile port properties.

page 22-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

MIB Objects
vMobilePortTable
vMobilePortIIfIndex
vMobilePortAuthenticate

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-29


Port Mobility Commands

show vlan rules


Displays VLAN rules for the specified VLAN.
show vlan [vid] rules

Syntax Definitions
vid VLAN ID number (1–4094).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If a vid is not specified, rules defined for all VLANs are displayed.

Examples
-> show vlan rules
Legend: * indicates a binding rule

type vlan rule


+--------------------+------+----------------------------------------------------+
ip-net 7 143.113.0.0, 255.255.0.0
mac-addr 4000 00:00:00:00:10:10
mac-range 4001 00:00:00:10:00:00, 00:00:00:20:00:00
mac-port-proto* 4094 00:00:0e:00:12:34, 15/4, appletalk

-> show vlan 55 rules


Legend: * indicates a binding rule

type vlan rule


+--------------------+------+----------------------------------------------------+
ip-net 55 143.113.0.0, 255.255.0.0
mac-addr 55 00:00:00:00:10:10
mac-range 55 00:00:00:10:00:00, 00:00:00:20:00:00
mac-port-proto* 55 00:00:0e:00:12:34, 15/4, appletalk

output definitions
Type The type of rule defined. There are several types of VLAN rules:
binding rules, MAC address rules, IP network address rules, protocol
rules, port rules, custom rules, and DHCP rules.
* Identifies a binding rule. The asterisk appears next to the rule type.

page 22-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

output definitions (continued)


VLAN The VLAN ID number for the rule’s VLAN.
Rule The value for the type of rule defined. Switch software uses these rule
values to determine mobile port VLAN assignment. If traffic coming in
on a mobile port matches the value of a VLAN rule, then the mobile
port is dynamically assigned to that VLAN.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan Displays a list of existing VLANs.


show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments for all VLANs, a specific VLAN,
or for a specific port (mobile and fixed).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-31


Port Mobility Commands

show vlan port mobile


Displays current status of mobile properties for a switch port.
show vlan port mobile [slot/port]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). To enter multiple slots and
ports in a single command, use a hyphen to specify a range of ports
(e.g., 3/1-16) and a space to specify multiple slots (e.g., 3/1-16 5/10-20
8/2-9).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a slot/port is not specified, then mobile properties for all ports are displayed.

• Note that the show vlan port mobile command only displays ports that are mobile or are eligible to
become mobile ports. For example, ports that are part of a link aggregate or are configured for 802.1Q
VLAN tagging are not included in the output of this command.

Examples
-> show vlan port mobile
cfg ignore
port mobile def authent enabled restore bpdu
+-----+------+----+--------+--------+--------+-----+
12/12 on 1 off on off off
12/13 off
12/14 off
12/15 on 10 on-8021x off on off
12/16 on 10 on-8021x on off on

output definitions
port The slot number for the module and the physical mobile port number
on that module.
mobile The mobile status for the port (on or off). If set to on, the port is mobile
and eligible for dynamic VLAN assignment. If set to off, the port is
non-mobile and remains only a member of its configured default
VLAN. Use the vlan port mobile to enable or disable mobility on a
port.
cfg def The configured default VLAN for the port, which is assigned using the
vlan port default command.

page 22-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mobility Commands

output definitions (continued)


authent The authentication status for the port (on-8021x, or off). Use the vlan
port authenticate and vlan port 802.1x commands to change this sta-
tus.
enabled The default VLAN status for the port: on enables the forwarding of
traffic that doesn’t match any rules on the port’s configured default
VLAN; off disables the forwarding of such traffic and packets are dis-
carded. Use the vlan port default vlan to change this status.
restore The default VLAN restore status for the port: on indicates that the
mobile port will not retain its VLAN assignments when qualifying traf-
fic ages out on that port; off indicates that the mobile port will retain its
dynamic VLAN assignments after qualifying traffic has aged out. Use
the vlan port default vlan restore command to change this status.
ignore BPDU The ignore BPDU status for the port: on indicates that if the mobile
port receives BPDUs, they’re ignored and the port remains eligible for
dynamic VLAN assignment; off indicates that if a BPDU is seen on the
port, mobility is disabled and the port is not eligible for dynamic
assignment. The status of ignore BPDU is set when the vlan port
mobile command is used to enable or disable mobility on a port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show vlan port Displays VLAN port assignments for all VLANs, a specific VLAN,
or for a specific port.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 22-33


Port Mobility Commands

page 22-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


23 Port Mapping Commands

Port Mapping is a security feature, which controls the peer users from communicating with each other.
Each session comprises a session ID and a set of user ports and/or a set of network ports. The user ports
within a session cannot communicate with each other and can only communicate via network ports. In a
Port Mapping session with user port set A and network port set B, ports in set A can communicate with
ports in set B only. If set B is empty, the ports in set A can communicate with the rest of the ports in the
system.
A port mapping session can be configured in a unidirectional or bidirectional mode. In the unidirectional
mode, the network ports can communicate with each other within the same session. In the bidirectional
mode, the network ports cannot communicate with each other. Network ports of a unidirectional port
mapping session can be shared with other unidirectional sessions, but cannot be shared with any session
configured in bidirectional mode. Network ports of different sessions can communicate with each other.
MIB information for the Port Mapping commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1PortMapping.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-PORT-MAPPING
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

port mapping user-port network-port


port mapping (configures port mapping status)
port mapping (configures port mapping direction)
show port mapping status
show port mapping

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 23-1


Port Mapping Commands

port mapping user-port network-port


Creates a port mapping session either with or without the user ports, network ports, or both. Use the no
form of the command to delete ports or an aggregate from a session.
port mapping port_mapping_sessionid [no] [user-port {slot slot | slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num}]
[network-port {slot slot | slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num}]

Syntax Definitions
port_mapping_sessionid The port mapping session ID. Valid range is 1 to 8.
user-port Specifies a user port of the mapping session.
network-port Specifies a network port of the mapping session.
slot Specifies a slot to be assigned to the mapping session.
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
linkagg Specifies a link aggregation group to be assigned to the mapping
session.
agg_num Link aggregation number.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• User ports that are part of one session cannot communicate with each other and can communicate only
via network ports of the session to the rest of the system.
• User ports can be part of one Port Mapping session only.

• An aggregable port of a link aggregation group cannot be a mapped port and a mapped port cannot be
an aggregable port of a link aggregation group.
• A mirrored port cannot be a mapped port and a mapped port cannot be a mirrored port.

• A mobile port cannot be configured as a network port of a mapping session.

page 23-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mapping Commands

Examples
-> port mapping 3 user-port 2/3 network-port 6/4
-> port mapping 4 user-port 2/5-8
-> port mapping 5 user-port 2/3 network-port slot 3
-> port mapping 5 no user-port 2/3
-> port mapping 6 no network-port linkagg 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port mapping Enables, disables, or deletes a port mapping session.


port mapping Configures the direction of a port mapping session.
show port mapping Displays the configuration of one or more port mapping sessions.

MIB Objects
PortMappingSessionTable
pmapSessionNumber
portMappingTable
pmapPortIfindex
pmapPortType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 23-3


Port Mapping Commands

port mapping
Enables, disables, or deletes a port mapping session.
port mapping port_mapping_sessionid {enable | disable}
no port mapping port_mapping_sessionid

Syntax Definitions
port_mapping_sessionid The port mapping session ID. Valid range is 1 to 8.
enable Enables a port mapping session.
disable Disables a port mapping session.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
To be enabled, a session should have a minimum of two ports.

Examples
-> port mapping 3 enable
-> port mapping 4 disable
-> no port mapping 5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 23-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mapping Commands

Related Commands

port mapping user-port Creates a port mapping session with or without the user ports, network
network-port ports, or both.
port mapping Configures the direction of a port mapping session.
show port mapping status Displays the status of one or more port mapping sessions.
show port mapping Displays the configuration of one or more port mapping sessions.

MIB Objects
PortMappingSessionTable
pmapSessionNumber
pmapSessionStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 23-5


Port Mapping Commands

port mapping
Configures the direction of a port mapping session.
port mapping port_mapping_sessionid {unidirectional | bidirectional}

Syntax Definitions
port_mapping_sessionid The port mapping session ID. Valid range is 1 to 8.
unidirectional Specifies unidirectional port mapping.
bidirectional Specifies bidirectional port mapping.

Defaults

parameter default
unidirectional | bidirectional bidirectional

Platform Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• In the bidirectional mode, the network ports of a session cannot communicate with each other. Also,
the network ports of that session cannot be a part of a network port set of another session.
• In the unidirectional mode, the network ports of a session can communicate with each other. Also, the
network ports of that session can be part of a network port set of another session, which is also in the
unidirectional mode.
• To change the direction of an active session with network ports, delete the network ports of the session,
change the direction, and recreate the network ports.

Examples
-> port mapping 5 unidirectional
-> port mapping 6 bidirectional

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 23-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mapping Commands

Related Commands

port mapping user-port Creates a port mapping session with or without the user ports, network
network-port ports or both.
port mapping Enables, disables, or deletes a port mapping session.
show port mapping Displays the configuration of one or more port mapping sessions.

MIB Objects
PortMappingSessionTable
PmapSessionNumber
PmapSessionDirection

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 23-7


Port Mapping Commands

show port mapping status


Displays the status of one or more port mapping sessions.
show port mapping [port_mapping_sessionid] status

Syntax definitions
port_mapping_sessionid The port mapping session ID. Valid range is 1 to 8.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify the port mapping session ID, then the status of all the port mapping sessions will be
displayed.

Examples
-> show port mapping status

SessionID Direction Status


-------------+----------------+---------------
8 bi disable

output definitions
SessionID Displays the port mapping session ID.
Direction Displays the direction of a port mapping session.
Status Displays status of a port mapping session.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 23-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mapping Commands

Related Commands

port mapping user-port Creates a port mapping session with or without the user ports, network
network-port ports, or both.
port mapping Enables, disables, or deletes a port mapping session.

MIB Objects
PortMappingSessionTable
PmapSessionNumber
PmapSessionDirection
pmapSessionStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 23-9


Port Mapping Commands

show port mapping


Displays the configuration of one or more port mapping sessions.
show port mapping [port_mapping_sessionid]

Syntax Definitions
port_mapping_sessionid The port mapping session ID. Valid range is 1 to 8.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify the port mapping session ID, then the configuration for all the port mapping sessions
will be displayed.

Examples
-> show port mapping 3

SessionID USR-PORT NETWORK-PORT


-----------+----------------+------------------
8 1/2 1/3
8 1/6
8 1/7

output definitions
SessionID Displays the port mapping session ID.
USR-PORT Displays the set of user ports of a port mapping session.
NETWORK-PORT Displays the set of network ports of a port mapping session.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 23-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mapping Commands

Related Commands

port mapping user-port Creates a port mapping session with or without the user ports, network
network-port ports, or both.
port mapping Enables, disables, or deletes a port mapping session.

MIB Objects
PortMappingSessionTable
PmapSessionNumber
portMappingTable
pmapPortIfindex
pmapPortType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 23-11


Port Mapping Commands

page 23-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


24 Learned Port Security
Commands

Learned Port Security (LPS) provides a mechanism for controlling network device communication on one
or more switch ports. Configurable LPS parameters allow the user to restrict source learning on a port to:
• A maximum number of learned source MAC addresses.

• A specific amount of time in which source MAC addresses are learned.

• An individual learned source MAC address.

• A range of learned source MAC addresses.

This chapter includes descriptions of the CLI commands used to define LPS parameters and display infor-
mation about the current LPS configuration.

MIB information for Learned Port Security commands is as follows:


Filename: AlcatelInd1LearnedPortSecurity.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-LPS-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

port-security
port-security shutdown
port-security maximum
port-security max-filtering
port-security convert-to-static
port-security mac
port-security mac-range
port-security violation
port-security release
port-security learn-trap-threshold
show port-security
show port-security shutdown

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-1


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security
Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s). When LPS is enabled, only devices
that have a source MAC address that complies with LPS restrictions are learned on the port(s).
port-security slot/port[-port2] [enable | disable]
port-security chassis disable
no port security slot/port[-port2]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
enable Enables LPS on the specified port(s).
disable Disables LPS on the specified port(s).
chassis disable Disables all LPS-eligible ports on the chassis.

Defaults
By default, LPS is disabled on all switch ports.

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

page 24-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove LPS and clear all entries from the table. This command
enables learning of new MAC addresses.
• The port-security chassis disable command disables all the LPS-eligible ports on the chassis.
Disabling port security restricts a port from learning new MAC addresses.
• LPS is supported on 10/100 and Gigabit Ethernet fixed, mobile, authenticated, 802.1Q tagged ports,
and 802.1x ports.
• LPS is not supported on 10 Gigabit Ethernet, link aggregate, or 802.1Q tagged link aggregate (trunked)
ports.
• Note that when LPS is enabled on an active port, all MAC addresses learned on that port prior to the
time LPS was enabled are cleared from the source learning MAC address table.
• Configurable MAC learning restrictions consist of setting a source learning time limit window, speci-
fying a maximum number of MACs allowed on a specific port, configuring a list of MAC addresses
(individual or range of addresses) allowed on the port, and determining how a port handles traffic that
is unauthorized.

Examples
-> port-security 4/8 enable
-> port-security 2/1-10 enable
-> port-security 2/11-15 disable
-> no port-security 1/1-12

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port-security mac Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that
belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security mac-range Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of
addresses allowed on the port.
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security shutdown Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all
LPS ports.
port-security violation Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS
restrictions for the specified port(s).

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsAdminStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-3


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security shutdown
Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all LPS ports. This LPS parameter
applies to the entire switch, so when the time limit expires, source learning of new MAC addresses is
stopped on all LPS ports. Only configured authorized MAC addresses are still allowed on LPS ports after
this timer expires. This command also enables or disables the conversion of dynamic MAC addresses to
static MAC addresses on LPS ports.
port-security shutdown minutes [convert-to-static {enable | disable}]

Syntax Definitions
minutes The number of minutes that defines the amount of time in which LPS
allows source learning across all LPS ports.
enable Enables the conversion of dynamic MAC addresses to static MAC
addresses on the LPS port.
disable Disables the conversion of dynamic MAC addresses to static MAC
addresses on the LPS port.

Defaults
By default, the LPS source learning time limit is not set for the switch.

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The LPS source learning time window is started and/or reset each time the port-security shutdown
command is issued.
• To automatically start the timer on switch reboot, save this command to the boot.cfg file for the switch.
Each time the switch reboots, the timer is restarted. It is still possible at any time, however, to reset the
timer by issuing the command again.
• Note that the LPS source learning time window has a higher priority over the maximum number of
MAC addresses allowed. For example, if the maximum number of MAC addresses allowed is set at 30
and the learning interval expires when the port has only learned 15, then the port will not learn
anymore MAC addresses.
• If the convert-to-static parameter is enabled and the LPS source learning time window expires, then
all dynamic MAC addresses are converted to static MAC addresses. This stops the MAC addresses
from aging out.
• The conversion of dynamic MAC addresses to static ones does not apply to LPS mobile and authenti-
cated ports.

page 24-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

Examples
-> port-security shutdown 25
-> port-security shutdown 60
-> port-security shutdown 2 convert-to-static enable
-> port-security shutdown 2 convert-to-static disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security mac Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that
belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security mac-range Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of
addresses allowed on the port.
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security violation Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS
restrictions for the specified port.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityGlobalGroup
lpsLearningWindowTime
lpsLearningWindowTimeWithStaticConversion

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-5


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security maximum
Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security slot/port[-port2] maximum number

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
number The number of source MAC addresses (1–100) that are allowed on this
port.

Defaults
By default, the number of MAC addresses allowed is set to 1.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the port attempts to learn a MAC address that will exceed the maximum number allowed, the port
will block the unauthorized address or will shutdown. Use the port-security violation command to
specify how an LPS port will handle violating traffic.
• Note that source learning of configured authorized MAC addresses is still allowed after the LPS time
limit has expired; however, all learning is stopped if the number of MAC addresses learned meets or
exceeds the maximum number of addresses allowed, even if the LPS time limit has not expired.

Examples
-> port-security 2/14 maximum 25
-> port-security 4/10-15 maximum 100

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 24-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security mac Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that
belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security mac-range Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of
addresses allowed on the port.
port-security shutdown Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all
LPS ports. Also, enables or disables the conversion of dynamic MAC
addresses to static MAC addresses on LPS ports.
port-security violation Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS
restrictions for the specified port.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsMaxMacNum

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-7


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security max-filtering
Configures the maximum number of MAC addresses that can be filtered on the LPS port(s).
port-security slot/port[-port2] max-filtering number

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
number The maximum number of filtered MAC addresses (1–100) that are
allowed on this port.

Defaults
By default, the maximum number of filtered MAC addresses that can be learned on an LPS port is set to 5.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When the number of filtered MAC addresses learned on the port reaches the maximum, either the port is
disabled (Shutdown Violation mode) or MAC address learning is disabled (Restrict Violation mode). By
default, MAC address learning is disabled.

Examples
-> port-security 1/10 max-filtering 6
-> port-security 1/10-13 max-filtering 18

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security violation Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS
restrictions for the specified port.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsMaxFilteredMacNum

page 24-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security convert-to-static
Converts the dynamically learned MAC addresses on the LPS port(s) to static MAC addresses.
port-security {slot/port[-port2] | chassis} convert-to-static

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
chassis Specifies all the LPS-eligible ports on the chassis.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can stop the aging out of dynamic MAC addresses on the LPS port(s) by converting them to static
MAC addresses.
• The conversion of dynamic MAC addresses to static ones does not apply to LPS mobile and authenti-
cated ports.
• The number of converted static MAC addresses cannot exceed the maximum number of MAC
addresses allowed on the port(s).

Examples
-> port-security 4/8 convert-to-static

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-9


Learned Port Security Commands

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityGlobalGroup
lpsConvertToStatic

page 24-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security mac
Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security slot/port mac mac_address [vlan vlan_id]
port-security slot/port no mac {all | mac_address} [vlan vlan_id]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
mac_address The source MAC address (e.g., 00:da:39:59:f1:0c) of the port.
vlan_id The VLAN or the tagged VLAN to which the LPS port belongs. The
range is 1–4094.

Defaults
By default, the default VLAN for the port is used.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove statically configured or dynamically learned source MAC
address entries from the LPS table. When a MAC address is removed from the LPS table, it is automat-
ically cleared from the source learning table at the same time.
• LPS should be enabled on the port before configuring a MAC address. If an attempt is made to config-
ure a MAC address on a non-LPS port, an error message is displayed.
• Any additional source MAC addresses received that do not match configured authorized addresses are
allowed on the port based on the LPS time limit (if active) and maximum number of MAC addresses
allowed.
• Each configured authorized MAC address counts towards the number of addresses allowed on the port
even if the port has not learned the configured address. For example, if a port has 3 configured autho-
rized MAC addresses and the maximum number of addresses allowed is set to 10, then only 7 addi-
tional MAC addresses are allowed on that port.

Examples
-> port-security 4/20 mac 00:20:95:00:fa:5c vlan 2
-> port-security 2/11 no mac 00:20:95:00:fa:5c

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-11


Learned Port Security Commands

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security mac-range Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of
addresses allowed on the port.
port-security shutdown Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all
LPS ports. Also, enables or disables the conversion of dynamic MAC
addresses to static MAC addresses on LPS ports.
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security violation Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS
restrictions for the specified port.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityL2MacAddressTable
lpsL2MacAddress
lpsL2VlanId
lpsL2MacAddressRowStatus

page 24-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security mac-range
Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of addresses allowed on the port. This
command also enables LPS on the specified port, if LPS is not already active on the port.
port-security slot/port[-port2] mac-range [low mac_address | high mac_address | low mac_address
high mac_address]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
low mac_address MAC address that defines the low end of a range of MACs
(e.g., 00:20:95:00:10:2A).
high mac_address MAC address that defines the high end of a range of MACs
(e.g., 00:20:95:00:10:2F).

Defaults

parameter default
high mac_address ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff
low mac_address 00:00:00:00:00:00

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If low and high end MAC addresses are not specified with this command, then the range is set back to
the default range value (00:00:00:00:00:00– ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff).
• Source MAC addresses received on an LPS port that fall within the authorized range are allowed on
the port. An additional entry is made in the LPS table for each of these learned addresses.
• Any additional source MAC addresses received that do not match configured authorized addresses are
allowed on the port based on the LPS time limit (if active) and the maximum number of MAC
addresses allowed.
• Each configured authorized MAC address counts towards the number of addresses allowed on the port
even if the port has not learned the configured address. For example, if a port has 3 configured autho-
rized MAC addresses and the maximum number of addresses allowed is set to 10, then only 7 addi-
tional MAC addresses are allowed on that port.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-13


Learned Port Security Commands

Examples
-> port-security 4/20 mac-range low 00:20:95:00:fa:5c
-> port-security 5/11-15 mac-range low 00:da:95:00:00:10 high 00:da:95:00:00:1f
-> port-security 5/16-20 mac-range high 00:da:95:00:00:1f
-> port-security 5/11-15 mac-range

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security mac Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that
belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security shutdown Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all
LPS ports. Also, enables or disables the conversion of dynamic MAC
addresses to static MAC addresses on LPS ports.
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security violation Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS
restrictions for the specified port.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsLoMacRange
lpsHiMacRange
lpsRowStatus

page 24-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security violation
Selects the method for handling traffic that does not comply with LPS restrictions for the specified port(s).
port-security slot/port[-port2] violation {restrict | shutdown}

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
restrict Filters (blocks) unauthorized traffic but allows traffic that complies with
LPS restrictions to forward on the port.
shutdown The port is disabled when the port receives unauthorized traffic; no traf-
fic is allowed on the port.

Defaults
By default, the security violation mode is set to restrict when LPS is enabled on the port.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When a traffic violation occurs on an LPS port, notice is sent to the Switch Logging task.

• If the violation mode is set to restrict, unauthorized source MAC addresses are not learned in the LPS
table but are still recorded in the source learning MAC address table with a filtered operational status.
This allows the user to view MAC addresses that were attempting unauthorized access to the LPS port.
• When an LPS port is disabled (shutdown) or unauthorized traffic received on the port is filtered
(restrict) due to a security violation, use the port-security release command to restore the port to
normal operation.

Examples
-> port-security 2/14 violation restrict
-> port-security 4/10-15 violation shutdown

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-15


Learned Port Security Commands

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security release Releases a port that was shut down due to an LPS violation
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.
port-security mac Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that
belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security mac-range Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of
addresses allowed on the port.
port-security shutdown Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all
LPS ports. Also, enables or disables the conversion of dynamic MAC
addresses to static MAC addresses on LPS ports.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsViolationOption

page 24-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security release
Releases a port that was shut down due to a Learned Port Security (LPS) violation. The specified port
resumes normal operation without having to manually reset the port and/or the entire module.
port-security slot/port release

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3). Use a hyphen to specify a
range of ports on the same module (e.g. 3/1-16).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command restores the port to the same operational state it was in before the shutdown. This
includes the activation of any existing LPS configuration for the port.
• Note that when this command is used, all MAC addresses known to the specified port are flushed from
the switch MAC address table.

Examples
-> port-security 2/14 release
-> port-security 4/10-15 release

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port-security Enables or disables Learned Port Security (LPS) on the switch port(s).
port-security mac Configures a single authorized source MAC address for a port that
belongs to a specified VLAN.
port-security mac-range Configures a list of authorized MAC addresses by defining a range of
addresses allowed on the port.
port-security shutdown Configures the amount of time in minutes to allow source learning on all
LPS ports. Also, enables or disables the conversion of dynamic MAC
addresses to static MAC addresses on LPS ports.
port-security maximum Specifies the maximum number of source MAC addresses that an LPS
port(s) is allowed to learn.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-17


Learned Port Security Commands

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsRelease

page 24-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

port-security learn-trap-threshold
Configures the number of bridged MAC addresses to learn before sending a trap.
port-security slot/port[-port2] learn-trap-threshold number

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
number The number of bridged MAC addresses (1–100) to learn before sending
a trap.

Defaults
By default, the number of bridged MAC addresses learned is set to 5.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the number of bridged MAC addresses learned on the port matches the specified threshold
amount, a trap is sent for every bridged MAC address learned thereafter.
• Sending a trap when this threshold is reached provides notification of newly learned bridged MAC
addresses. Trap contents includes identifying information about the MAC, such as the address itself,
the corresponding IP address, switch identification, and the slot and port number on which the MAC
was learned.

Examples
-> port-security 1/10 learn-trap-threshold 6
-> port-security 1/10-13 learn-trap-threshold 18

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show port-security Displays Learned Port Security (LPS) configuration and table entries.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsLearnTrapThreshold

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-19


Learned Port Security Commands

show port-security
Displays Learned Port Security (LPS) configuration and table entries.
show port-security [slot/port[-port2] | slot]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port The slot number for the module and the physical port number on that
module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
-port2 The last port number in a range of ports you want to configure on the
same slot (e.g, 3/1-4 specifies ports 1-4 on slot 3).
slot Enter the slot number for a module to specify that the command should
include all ports on that module (e.g., 6 specifies all ports on the module
found in slot 6 of the switch chassis).

Defaults
By default, all ports with an LPS configuration are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Displays ports that have an LPS configuration, even if LPS is disabled on the port.

• Use the slot/port[-port2] parameter with this command to display the LPS configuration for a specific
port or a range of ports.
• Use the slot parameter with this command to display the LPS configuration for all the ports on a
specific slot.
• In addition, MAC addresses that were learned on the LPS port because they fell within the specified
MAC address range, appear as a separate entry in the LPS table with a dynamic MAC type.
• Dynamic MAC addresses become configured MAC addresses in the LPS table when the switch config-
uration is saved and the switch is rebooted. If the configuration is not saved before the next reboot, all
dynamic MAC addresses are cleared from the LPS table.
• The MAC Type field is blank if an authorized MAC address range is configured for the LPS port.

page 24-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

Examples
-> show port-security

Port: 7/10
Operation Mode : ENABLED,
Max MAC bridged : 1,
Trap Threshold : DISABLED,
Max MAC filtered : 5,
Low MAC Range : 00:00:00:00:00:00,
High MAC Range : ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff,
Violation : RESTRICT

MAC Address VLAN TYPE


-------------------+------+-------------------
00:20:95:00:fa:5c 1 STATIC

output definitions
Port The module slot number and the physical port number on that module.
Operation Mode The Learned Port Security operation status for the port (enabled or dis-
abled). Configured through the port-security command.
Max MAC bridged The maximum number of bridged MAC addresses that are allowed on
this port. Configured through the port-security maximum command.
Trap Threshold The number of bridged MACs to learn before sending a trap. After this
number is reached, a trap is sent out for every MAC learned thereafter.
If disabled is displayed in this field, the trap threshold is not in force.
Configured through the port-security learn-trap-threshold command.
Max MAC filtered The maximum number of filtered MAC addresses that the LPS port can
learn. Configured through the port-security max-filtering command.
Low MAC Range MAC address that defines the lower end of a MAC address range. Con-
figured through the port-security mac-range command.
High MAC Range MAC address that defines the higher end of a MAC address range.
Configured through the port-security mac-range command.
Violation The security violation mode for the port (restrict or shutdown). Con-
figured through the port-security violation command.
MAC Address An individual authorized MAC address. Configured through the
port-security mac command.
VLAN The VLAN to which the LPS port belongs.
TYPE Indicates if the MAC address was dynamically learned or statically
configured as an authorized MAC address for the port. Dynamic MAC
addresses become configured MAC address entries after a configura-
tion save and switch reboot.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-21


Learned Port Security Commands

Related Commands

show port-security shutdown Displays the amount of time during which source learning can occur
on all LPS ports.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityTable
lpsMaxMacNum
lpsMaxFilteredMacNum
lpsLoMacRange
lpsHiMacRange
lpsViolationOption
lpsOperStatus
lpsRelease

page 24-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Learned Port Security Commands

show port-security shutdown


Displays the amount of time during which source learning can occur on all LPS ports.
show port-security shutdown

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The source learning time limit is a switch-wide parameter that applies to all ports that have LPS
enabled.
• If the shutdown time is set to zero, then a source learning time limit is not active on LPS ports.

• Note that source learning of configured authorized MAC addresses is still allowed after the LPS time
limit has expired; however, all learning is stopped if the number of MAC addresses learned meets or
exceeds the maximum number of addresses allowed, even if the LPS time limit has not expired.

Examples
-> show port-security shutdown
LPS Shutdown Config = 2 min
Convert-to-static = DISABLE
Remaining Learning Window = 110 sec

output definitions
LPS Shutdown Config The configured amount of time during which the LPS port can learn
new MAC addresses.
Convert-to-static Indicates whether or not dynamic MACs are converted to static MACs
(enabled or disabled). Configured through the
port-security shutdown command.
Remaining Learning Window The remaining amount of time during which the LPS port can learn
MAC addresses.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 24-23


Learned Port Security Commands

Related Commands

port-security learn-trap- Displays Learned Port Security (LPS) configuration and table
threshold entries.

MIB Objects
learnedPortSecurityGlobalGroup
lpsConvertToStatic
lpsLearningWindowTime
lpsLearningWindowTimeWithStaticConversion

page 24-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


25 Port Mirroring and
Monitoring Commands

The Port Mirroring and Port Monitoring features are primarily used as diagnostic tools.
The Port Mirroring feature allows you to have all the traffic (inbound and outbound) of an Ethernet port
sent to another port on the switch. When you enable port mirroring, the active, or “mirrored,” port trans-
mits and receives network traffic normally and the “mirroring” port receives a copy of all transmit and
receive traffic to the active port. You can connect an RMON probe or network analysis device to the
mirroring port to see an exact duplication of traffic on the mirrored port without disrupting network traffic
to and from the mirrored port.
The Port Monitoring feature allows you to examine packets to and from a specific Ethernet port.
MIB information for the Port Mirroring commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1portMirMon.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-PORT-MIRRORING-MONITORING-MIB
The following table summarizes the available commands:

Port Mirroring Commands port mirroring source destination


port mirroring
show port mirroring status
Port Monitoring Commands port monitoring source
port monitoring
show port monitoring status
show port monitoring file

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-1


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

port mirroring source destination


Defines a port to mirror and the port that is to receive data from the mirrored port, and enables or disables
port mirroring status. Also, enables or diables remote port mirroring.
port mirroring port_mirror_sessionid [no] source slot/port[-port2] [slot/port[-port2]...]
destination slot/port [rpmir-vlan vlan_id] [bidirectional |inport |outport] [unblocked vlan_id]
[enable | disable]

Syntax Definitions
port_mirror_sessionid Mirroring session identifier.
source Adds the alphabet “a” to a port mirroring session.
no source Removes a port or range of ports from a port mirroring session.
slot Slot number you want to configure.
port Port number of the interface you want to configure.
port2 Last port number in a range of ports you want to configure.
[slot/port[-port2]...] Configures multiple source ports.
rpmir-vlan vlan_id Reserved VLAN (1–4094) to carry the mirroring traffic.
bidirectional Specifies bidirectional port mirroring.
inport Specifies incoming unidirectional port mirroring.
outport Specifies outgoing unidirectional port mirroring.
vlan_id VLAN ID is the number (1–4094) that specifies the VLAN to protect
from Spanning Tree changes while port mirroring/monitoring is active.
Ports in this VLAN will remain unblocked.
enable Enables port mirroring status.
disable Disables port mirroring status.

Defaults

parameter default
bidirectional | inport | outport bidirectional
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The maximum number of mirroring sessions is limited to two.

page 25-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

• You cannot configure port mirroring and monitoring on the same switching ASIC. Each switching
ASIC controls 24 ports (e.g., ports 1–24, 25–48, etc.). For example, if a port mirroring session is
configured for ports 1/12 and 1/22, then configuring a port monitoring session for any of the ports
between 1 and 24 is not allowed.
• If a port mirroring session is configured across two switching ASICs, then configuring a monitoring
session is not allowed on any of the ports controlled by each of the ASICs involved. For example, if a
port mirroring session is configured for ports 1/8 and 1/30 on a 48-port switch, then configuring a port
monitoring session involving any of the ports between 1 and 48 is not allowed.
• Port mirroring is not supported on logical link aggregate ports however, it is supported on individual
ports that are members of a link aggregate.
• An “N-to-1” port mirroring session is configurable, where “N” can be a number from 1 to 24. In other
words, you can configure up to 24 source ports for a single destination port in a session.
• Once you execute the port mirroring source destination command to define the mirrored port and
enable port mirroring status, the port mirroring command must be used to enable the port mirroring
session.
• By default, the mirroring port is subject to Spanning Tree changes that could cause it to go into a
blocked state. To prevent this, specify the vlan_id number of the mirroring port that is to remain
unblocked when executing the command.

Usage Guidelines - Remote Port Mirroring


• Use the rpmir-vlan parameter with this command to configure remote port mirroring.

• There must not be any physical loop present in the remote port mirroring VLAN.

• Spanning Tree must be disabled for the remote port mirroring VLAN.

• Source learning must be disabled or overridden on the ports belonging to the remote port mirroring
VLAN on intermediate and destination switches.
• The QoS redirect feature can be used to override source learning.

Examples
-> port mirroring 6 destination 6/4
-> port mirroring 6 source 2/3
-> port mirroring 6 destination 6/4
-> port mirroring 6 source 2/3-5 2/7 2/10
-> port mirroring 8 destination 1/12 rpmir-vlan 7
-> port mirroring 8 source 1/7 bidirectional
-> port mirroring 7 destination 6/4 unblocked 750
-> port mirroring 7 source 2/3
-> port mirroring 9 destination 1/24
-> port mirroring 9 source 1/23 inport
-> port mirroring 9 disable
-> port mirroring 8 no source 1/7
-> port mirroring 6 no source 2/10-12 2/14

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-3


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

port mirroring Enables, disables, or deletes a port mirroring session.


show port mirroring status Displays the status of mirrored ports. This value may be enabled or
disabled.

MIB Objects
mirrorTable
mirrorMirroringIfindex
mirrorDirection
mirrorStatus
mirrorUnblockedVLAN
mirrorTaggedVLAN

page 25-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

port mirroring
Enables, disables, or deletes a port mirroring session.
port mirroring port_mirror_sessionid {enable | disable}
no port mirroring port_mirror_sessionid {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
port_mirror_sessionid Mirroring session identifier.
enable Enables port mirroring.
disable Disables port mirroring.
no Optional syntax. Deletes a previously-configured port mirroring session.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a port mirroring session.

• You must first enter the port mirroring source destination command to specify the mirrored and
destination ports. Then use this command to enable or disable port mirroring activity on these ports.

Examples
-> port mirroring 6 enable
-> port mirroring 6 disable
-> no port mirroring 6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-5


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

port mirroring source Defines a port to mirror and the port that is to receive data from the
destination mirrored port, and enables or disables port mirroring status.
show port mirroring status Displays the status of mirrored ports. This value may be enabled or
disabled.

MIB Objects
mirrorTable
mirrorMirroringIfindex
mirrorStatus

page 25-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

port monitoring source


Configures a port monitoring session.
port monitoring port_monitor_sessionid source slot/port
[{no file | file filename [size filesize] | [overwrite {on | off}]}]
[inport | outport | bidirectional] [timeout seconds] [enable | disable]

Syntax Definitions
port_monitor_sessionid Monitoring session identifier.
slot/port Enter the slot number for the module and the physical port number on
that module (e.g., 3/1 specifies port 1 on slot 3).
file filename Specifies a file name for the monitoring session (e.g., /flash/port2).
filesize Specifies the size of the file in 16K (16384) byte increments. For exam-
ple, a value of 3 would specify a size of 49152 bytes. The file size can
be up to 160 K (163840 bytes).
no file Specifies that no file will be created for the monitoring session.
on Specifies that any existing port monitoring file in flash memory will be
overwritten if the total data exceeds the specified file size.
off Specifies that any existing port monitoring file in flash memory will not
be overwritten if the total data exceeds the specified file size.
inport Specifies incoming unidirectional port monitoring.
outport Specifies outgoing unidirectional port monitoring.
seconds Specifies the number of seconds after which the session is disabled. The
range is 0–2147483647 where 0 is forever.
enable Enables the port monitoring status.
disable Disables the port monitoring status.

Defaults

parameter default
filesize 1
on | off on
bidirectional | inport | outport bidirectional
seconds 0
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-7


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

Usage Guidelines
• The maximum number of monitoring sessions is limited to one per chassis and/or stack.

• You cannot configure port mirroring and monitoring on the same switching ASIC. Each switching
ASIC controls 24 ports (e.g., ports 1–24, 25–48, etc.). For example, if a port mirroring session is
configured for ports 1/12 and 1/22, then configuring a port monitoring session for any of the ports
between 1 and 24 is not allowed.
• If a port mirroring session is configured across two switching ASICs, then configuring a monitoring
session is not allowed on any of the ports controlled by each of the ASICs involved. For example, if a
port mirroring session is configured for ports 1/8 and 1/30 on a 48-port switch, then configuring a port
monitoring session involving any of the ports between 1 and 48 is not allowed.
• By default, a file called pmonitor.enc is created in the /flash directory when you configure and enable
a port monitoring session. Use the file option to create a user-specified file.
• By default, more-recent frames will overwrite older frames in a port monitoring file if the total data
exceeds the specified file size. Use the overwrite off option to prevent this from occurring.
• Only the first 64 bytes of the traffic will be captured.

• The format of the file created is compliant with the ENC file format (Network General Sniffer Network
Analyzer Format).

Examples
-> port monitoring 6 source 2/3
-> port monitoring 6 source 2/3 file port3 size 2 enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port monitoring Disables, pauses, resumes, or deletes a port monitoring session.


show port monitoring status Displays the port monitoring status.
show port monitoring file Displays the port monitoring data.

MIB Objects
monitorTable
monitorSessionNumber
monitorIfindex
monitorFileStatus
monitorFileName
monitorFileSize
monitorScreenStatus
monitorScreenLine
monitorTrafficType
monitorStatus
monitorFileOverWrite
monitorDirection
monitorTimeout

page 25-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

port monitoring
Disables, pauses, resume, or deletes an existing port monitoring session.
port monitoring port_monitor_sessionid {disable | pause | resume}
no port monitoring port_monitor_sessionid

Syntax Definitions
port_monitor_sessionid Monitoring session identifier.
disable Disables the port monitoring session.
pause Pauses the port monitoring session.
resumes Resumes the port monitoring session.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to delete a port monitoring session.

Examples
-> port monitoring 6 pause
-> port monitoring 6 disable
-> port monitoring 6 resume
-> no port monitoring 6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port monitoring Configures a port monitoring session.


show port monitoring status Displays the port monitoring status.

MIB Objects
monitorTable
monitorSessionNumber
monitorScreenStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-9


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

show port mirroring status


Displays the status of mirrored ports.
show port mirroring status [port_mirror_sessionid]

Syntax Definitions
port_mirror_sessionid Mirroring session identifier.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If a port mirroring session identifier is not specified with this command, then all port mirroring sessions
are displayed.

Examples
-> show port mirroring status

Session Mirror Mirror Unblocked Config Oper


Destination Direction Vlan Status Status
----------+----------+--------------+----------+----------+---------
6. 1/41 - NONE Enable Off
----------+----------+--------------+----------+----------+---------
Mirror
Source
----------+----------+--------------+----------+----------+---------
6. 1/20 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/21 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/22 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/23 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/24 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/25 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/26 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/27 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/28 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/29 bidirectional - Enable Off
6. 1/30 bidirectional - Enable Off

output definitions
Session The port mirroring session identifier.
Mirror Destination The location of the mirrored port.
Mirror Direction The direction of the mirroring or mirrored port, which can be
bidirectional (the default), inport, or outport.
Unblocked VLAN The mirroring VLAN ID number.

page 25-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


Config Status The configuration status of the session.
Oper Status The current status of the mirroring or mirrored port.
Mirror Source The location of the mirroring port.

output definitions
Session The port mirroring session identifier.
Mirror Destination The location of the mirrored port.
Mirror Direction The direction of the mirroring or mirrored port, which can be
bidirectional (the default), inport, or outport.
Unblocked VLAN The mirroring VLAN ID number.
Config Status The configuration status of the session.
Oper Status The current status of the mirroring or mirrored port.
Mirror Source The location of the mirroring port.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

port mirroring Enables, disables, or deletes a port mirroring session.


port mirroring source Defines a port to mirror and a port that will receive data from the
destination mirrored port, and enables or disables port mirroring status.

MIB Objects
mirrorTable
mirrorMirroringIfindex
mirrorDirection
mirrorStatus
mirrorUnblockedVLAN

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-11


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

show port monitoring status


Displays port monitoring status.
show port monitoring status [port_monitor_sessionid]

Syntax Definitions
port_monitor_sessionid Monitoring session identifier.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If a port monitoring session identifier is not specified with this command, then all port monitoring sessions
are displayed.

Examples
-> show port monitoring status

Session Monitor Monitor Overwrite Operating Admin


slot/port Direction Status Status
----------+----------+----------+--------------+----------+--------------------
1. 1/ 9 Bidirectional ON ON ON

output definitions
Session The port monitoring session identifier.
Monitor slot/port The location of the monitored port.
Monitor Direction The direction of the monitoring session, which can be bidirectional
(the default), inport, or outport.
Overwrite Whether files created by a port monitoring session can be overwritten.
The default is ON.
Operating Status The current operating status of the port monitoring session (on/off).
Admin Status The current administrative status of the port monitoring session (on/
off).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 25-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

port monitoring source Configures a port monitoring session.


port monitoring Disables, pauses, resumes, or deletes a port monitoring session.
show port monitoring file Displays port monitoring data.

MIB Objects
monitorTable
monitorSessionNumber
monitorIfindex
monitorStatus
monitorFileOverWrite
monitorDirection

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-13


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

show port monitoring file


Displays port monitoring data.
show port monitoring file [port_monitor_sessionid]

Syntax Definitions
port_monitor_sessionid Monitoring session identifier.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show port monitoring file

Destination | Source | Type | Data


-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
01:80:C2:00:00:00 | 00:20:DA:8F:92:C6 | BPDU | 00:26:42:42:03:00:00:00:00:00
00:20:DA:C7:2D:D6 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:FE:4A:40:00
00:20:DA:A3:89:F6 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:CF:89:40:00
00:20:DA:BF:5B:76 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:CF:85:40:00
00:20:DA:A3:89:F6 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:CF:8A:40:00
00:20:DA:BF:5B:76 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:CF:86:40:00
00:20:DA:A3:89:F6 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:CF:8B:40:00
01:80:C2:00:00:00 | 00:20:DA:8F:92:C6 | BPDU | 00:26:42:42:03:00:00:00:00:00
00:20:DA:BF:5B:76 | 08:00:20:95:F3:89 | UDP | 08:00:45:00:00:6B:CF:87:40:00

output definitions
Destination The destination MAC address of the packet.
Source The source MAC address of the packet.
Type The type of packet.
Data The packet displayed in hexadecimal format.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 25-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

port monitoring source Configures a port monitoring session.


port monitoring Disables, pauses, resumes, or deletes a port monitoring session.
show port monitoring status Displays the port monitoring status.

MIB Objects
monitorTable
monitorSessionNumber
monitorIfindex
monitorTrafficType

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 25-15


Port Mirroring and Monitoring Commands

page 25-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


26 sFlow Commands

sFlow is a network monitoring technology that gives visibility in to the activity of the network, by provid-
ing network usage information. It provides the data required to effectively control and manage the network
usage. sFlow is a sampling technology that meets the requirements for a network traffic monitoring solu-
tion.
sFlow provides a network-wide view of usage and active routes. It is used for measuring network traffic,
collecting, storing, and analyzing the traffic data. As it is scalable, that doesn’t add significant network
load. sFlow is an industry standard with many vendors delivering products with this support. Some of the
applications of the sFlow data include:
• Detecting, diagnosing, and fixing network problems

• Real-time congestion management

• Detecting unauthorized network activity

• Usage accounting and billing

• Understanding application mix

• Route profiling and peer optimization

• Capacity planning

sFlow is a sampling technology embedded within switches/routers. It provides the ability to monitor the
traffic flows. It requires an sFlow agent software process running as part of the switch software and a
sFlow collector which receives and analyses the monitored data. The sFlow collector makes use of SNMP
to communicate with an sFlow agent in order to configure sFlow monitoring on the device (switch).
An sFlow agent running on the switch/router combines interface counters and traffic flow (packet)
samples, preferably, on all the interfaces into sFlow datagrams that are sent across the network to an sFlow
collector.
Packet sampling on the switch/router is typically performed by the switching/routing ASICs, providing
wire-speed performance. In this case, an sFlow agent does very little processing, by packaging data into
sFlow datagrams that are immediately sent on network. This minimizes the memory and CPU utilization
by the sFlow agent.
MIB information for the sFlow commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1PortMirMon.MIB
Module: Alcatel-IND1-PORT-MIRRORING-MONITORING-MIB
Filename: SFLOW_RFC3176.MIB
Module: SFLOW-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-1


sFlow Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here:

sflow receiver
sflow sampler
sflow poller
show sflow agent
show sflow receiver
show sflow sampler
show sflow poller

page 26-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

sflow receiver
Sets the destination hosts where the sFlow datagrams are sent out. If there are multiple destinations, then
each destination is associated with the receiver instance. All these destinations are attached to the sFlow
manager instance and to an associated sampler/poller.
sflow receiver num name string timeout {seconds | forever} address {ip_address | ipv6address} udp-
port port packet-size size Version num
sflow receiver receiver_index release

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the receiver index.
string Specifies the name.
seconds | forever Specifies the timeout value.
ip_address| ipv6address Specifies the 32/128-bit ip address.
port Specifies the UDP (destination) port.
size Specifies the maximum number of data bytes (size) that can be sent.
num Specifies the version number.

Defaults

parameter default
string empty
seconds 0
ip_address 0.0.0.0(ipv4)
port 6343
size 1400
version num 5

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the release form at the end of the command to delete a receiver.

Examples
-> sflow receiver 1 name Golden address 198.206.181.3
-> sflow receiver 1 release

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-3


sFlow Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show sflow receiver Displays the receiver table.

MIB Objects
sFlowRcvrTable
sFlowRcvrIndex
sFlowRcvrOwner
sFlowRcvrTimeout
sFlowRcvrMaximumDatagramSize
sFlowRcvrAddressType
sFlowRcvrAddress
sFlowRcvrPort
sFlowRcvrDatagramVersion

page 26-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

sflow sampler
Gets the hardware sampled from Q-dispatcher and fills up the sampler part of the UDP datagram.
sflow sampler num portlist receiver receiver_index rate value sample-hdr-size size
no sflow sampler num portlist

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the instance id.
portlist Specifies the interface index range.
receiver_index Specifies the receiver index.
value Specifies the rate value for packet sampling.
size Specifies the maximum number of bytes (size) that can be copied from a
sampled packet.

Defaults

parameter default
receiver_index 0
value 0
size 128

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete a sampler.

• A sampling rate of 1 counts all packets. A sampling rate of 0 disables sampling.

Examples
-> sflow sampler 1 2/1-5 receiver 1 rate 1024
-> no sflow sampler 1 2/1-5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-5


sFlow Commands

Related Commands

show sflow sampler Displays the sampler table.

MIB Objects
sFlowFsTable
sFlowFsDataSource
sFlowFsInstance
sFlowFsReceiver
sFlowFsPacketSamplingRate
sFlowFsMaximumHeaderSize

page 26-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

sflow poller
Gets counter samples from ethernet driver and fills up the counter part of the UDP datagram.
sflow poller num portlist receiver receiver_index interval value
no sflow poller num portlist

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the instance id.
portlist Specifies the interface index range.
receiver_index Specifies the receiver index.
value Specifies the maximum number of seconds between successive samples
(interval value).

Defaults

parameter default
receiver_index 0
value 0

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to delete a poller.

Examples
-> sflow poller 1 2/6-10 receiver 1 interval 30
-> no sflow poller 1 2/6-10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show sflow poller Displays the poller table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-7


sFlow Commands

MIB Objects
sFlowCpTable
sFlowCpDataSource
sFlowCpInstance
sFlowCpReceiver
sFlowCpInterval

page 26-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

show sflow agent


Displays the sflow agent table.
show sflow agent

Syntax Definitions
agent Collects sample datagrams and send it to the collector across the
network.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• It is necessary to execute the ip interface command to make a loopback0 IP address as the fixed
primary address of the switch, in order to avoid interface changes, which might need the collector soft-
ware to be restarted for it to communicate using the new agent IP address. Normally, the primary IP
address could change depending on the IP interface going up/down. Therefore, the sFlow agent always
needs to send a fixed IP address in the datagram.
• The loopback address should be an IP interface configured on the switch.

Examples
-> ip interface loopback0 address 198.206.181.100
-> show sflow agent
Agent Version = 1.3; Alcatel-Lucent; 6.1.1
Agent IP = 198.206.181.100

output definitions
Agent Version Identifies the version which includes the MIB version, organization
name, and the specific software build of the agent.
Agent address IP address associated with the agent.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show sflow receiver Displays the receiver table.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-9


sFlow Commands

MIB Objects
sFlowAgent
sFlowVersion
sFlowAgentAddressType
sFlowAgentAddress

page 26-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

show sflow receiver


Displays the sflow receiver table.
show sflow receiver [num]

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the receiver index.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show sflow receiver
Receiver 1
Name = Golden
Address = IP_V4 198.206.181.3
UDP Port = 6343
Timeout = 65535
Packet Size= 1400
DatagramVer= 5

output definitions
Name Name of the entry to claim.
Address IP address of the sFlow collector.
UDP Port Destination port for sFlow datagrams.
Timeout Time remaining before the sampler is released and stops sampling.
Packet size Maximum number of data bytes that can be sent in a single sample dat-
agram.
Datagram ver Version of sFlow datagrams that should be sent.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-11


sFlow Commands

Related Commands

sflow receiver Sets the destination hosts where the sFlow datagrams are sent out.

MIB Objects
sFlowRcvrTable
sFlowRcvrIndex

page 26-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

show sflow sampler


Displays the sflow sampler table.
show sflow sampler[num]

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the instance id.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A.

Examples
-> show sflow sampler
Instance Interface Receiver Sample-rate Sample-hdr-size
-----------------------------------------------------------------
1 2/ 1 1 2048 128
1 2/ 2 1 2048 128
1 2/ 3 1 2048 128
1 2/ 4 1 2048 128
1 2/ 5 1 2048 128

output definitions
Instance Instance for the flow sampler.
Interface Interface used for the flow sampler.
Receiver Receiver associated with the flow sampler.
Sample-rate Statistical sampling rate for packet sampling from the source.
Sample-hdr-size Maximum number of bytes that should be copied from a sampled
packet.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-13


sFlow Commands

Related Commands

sflow sampler Gets hardware sampled from Q-dispatcher.

MIB Objects
sFlowFsTable
sFlowFsInstance

page 26-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


sFlow Commands

show sflow poller


Displays the sflow poller table.
show sflow poller [num]

Syntax Definitions
num Specifies the instance id.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show sflow poller
Instance Interface Receiver Interval
-------------------------------------------
1 2/ 6 1 30
1 2/ 7 1 30
1 2/ 8 1 30
1 2/ 9 1 30
1 2/10 1 30

output definitions
Instance Instance for the counter poller.
Interface Interface used for the counter poller.
Receiver Receiver associated with the counter poller.
Interval The maximum number of seconds between successive samples of the
counters associated with the data source.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 26-15


sFlow Commands

Related Commands

sflow poller Gets counter samples.

MIB Objects
sFlowCpTable
sFlowCpInstance

page 26-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


27 RMON Commands

Remote Network Monitoring (RMON) probes can be used to monitor, manage, and compile statistical data
about network traffic from designated active ports in a LAN segment without negatively impacting
network performance. This feature supports basic RMON 4 group implementation compliant with
RFC 2819 (Remote Network Monitoring Management Information Base), but does not support RMON 10
group or RMON 2. This chapter includes descriptions of RMON commands used to enable or disable indi-
vidual (or a group of a certain flavor type) RMON probes, show a list of (or individual) RMON probes and
show a list of (or individual) RMON logged events.
MIB information for the RMON commands is as follows:
Filename: IETF_RMON.mib
Module: RMON-MIB
The following table summarizes the available commands:

rmon probes
show rmon probes
show rmon events

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 27-1


RMON Commands

rmon probes
This command enables or disables types of RMON probes.
rmon probes {stats | history | alarm} [entry-number] {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
stats Ethernet Statistics Table probe entries.
history History Control Table probe entries.
alarm Alarm Table probe entries.
entry-number The entry number in the list of probes (optional).
enable Enables the RMON probe.
disable Disables the RMON probe.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Network activity on subnetworks attached to the RMON probe can be monitored by NMS applications.

• RMON will not monitor activities on the CMM onboard Ethernet Management port.

Examples
-> rmon probes stats 4012 enable
-> rmon probes history 10240 disable
-> rmon probes alarm 11235 enable
-> rmon probes stats enable
-> rmon probes history disable
-> rmon probes alarm enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 27-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RMON Commands

Related Commands

show rmon probes Displays a list of RMON probes or a single RMON probe.
show rmon events Displays a list of RMON logged events or a single RMON event.

MIB Objects
ETHERSTATSTABLE
etherStatsStatus
HISTORYCONTROLTABLE
historyControlStatus
ALARMTABLE
alarmStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 27-3


RMON Commands

show rmon probes


Displays a list of RMON probes or a single RMON probe.
show rmon probes [stats | history | alarm] [entry-number]

Syntax Definitions
stats Ethernet Statistics Table probe entries.
history History Control Table probe entries.
alarm Alarm Table probe entries.
entry-number The entry number in the list of probes (optional).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To display a list of current probes, omit the entry-number from the command line.

• To display statistics for a particular probe, include the probe’s entry-number in the command line.

• The show rmon probes command displays the following information: Entry number, Slot/Port, Flavor
(whether the probe type is Ethernet, History or Alarm), Status (Active or Inactive), Duration (time
since the last change in status, in hours/minutes) and System Resources (the amount of memory allo-
cated to this probe).
• The show rmon probes entry-number command displays the following information: Probe’s Owner
(probe type and location), Slot/Port, Entry number, Flavor (whether the probe type is Ethernet, History
or Alarm), Status (Active or Inactive), Time since the last change in status (hours/minutes), and System
Resources (the amount of memory allocated to this probe). Displayed statistics may vary, depending on
whether the probe type is Ethernet, History or Alarm.

Examples
-> show rmon probes stats

Entry Slot/Port Flavor Status Duration System Resources


-------+-----------+-----------+----------+---------------+---------------------
4001 4/1 Ethernet Active 00:25:00 275 bytes
4008 4/8 Ethernet Active 00:25:00 275 bytes
4005 4/5 Ethernet Active 00:25:00 275 bytes

page 27-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RMON Commands

-> show rmon probes history

Entry Slot/Port Flavor Status Duration System Resources


-------+-----------+-----------+----------+---------------+---------------------
1 4/1 History Active 00:25:00 9063 bytes
10240 4/5 History Active 00:14:00 601 bytes
10325 4/8 History Active 00:14:00 601 bytes

-> show rmon probes alarm

Entry Slot/Port Flavor Status Duration System Resources


-------+-----------+-----------+----------+---------------+---------------------
11235 4/8 Alarm Active 00:07:00 835 bytes

-> show rmon probes stats 4005

Probe’s Owner: Falcon Switch Auto Probe on Slot 4, Port 5


Entry 4005
Flavor = History, Status = Active
Time = 48 hrs 54 mins,
System Resources (bytes) = 275

-> show rmon probes history 10325

Probe’s Owner: Analyzer-p:128.251.18.166 on Slot 4, Port 5


History Control Buckets Requested = 2
History Control Buckets Granted = 2
History Control Interval = 30 seconds
History Sample Index = 5859
Entry 10325
Flavor = History, Status = Active
Time = 48 hrs 53 mins,
System Resources (bytes) = 601

-> show rmon probes alarm 11235

Probe’s Owner: Analyzer-t:128.251.18.166 on Slot 4, Port 8


Alarm Rising Threshold = 5
Alarm Falling Threshold = 0
Alarm Rising Event Index = 26020
Alarm Falling Event Index = 0
Alarm Interval = 10 seconds
Alarm Sample Type = delta value
Alarm Startup Alarm = rising alarm
Alarm Variable = 1.3.6.1.2.1.16.1.1.1.5.4008
Entry 11235
Flavor = Alarm, Status = Active
Time = 48 hrs 48 mins,
System Resources (bytes) = 1677

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 27-5


RMON Commands

output definitions
Probe’s Owner Description and interface (location) of the probe.
Slot/Port The Slot/Port number (interface) that this probe is monitoring.
Entry The Entry number in the list of probes.
Flavor Whether the probe type is Ethernet, History, or Alarm.
Status The status of the probe–Creating (the probe is under creation), Active
(the probe is Active), or Inactive (the probe is inactive).
Duration Elapsed time (hours/minutes/seconds) since the last change in status.
System Resources Amount of memory that has been allocated to this probe.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rmon probes Enables or disables types of RMON probes.


show rmon events Displays RMON logged events.

MIB Objects
ETHERSTATSTABLE
etherStatsIndex
HISTORYCONTROLTABLE
historyControlIndex
ALARMTABLE
alarmIndex

page 27-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


RMON Commands

show rmon events


Displays RMON events (actions that take place based on alarm conditions detected by the RMON probe).
show rmon events [event-number]

Syntax Definitions
event-number The event number (optional) in the list of probes.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To display a list of logged events, omit the event-number from the command line.

• To display statistics for a particular event, include the event-number in the command line.

• The show rmon events command displays the following information for all RMON Logged Events:
Entry number, Time (hours/minutes/seconds) since the last change in status and Description (nature of
the event).
• The show rmon events event-number command displays the following information for a particular
RMON Logged Event: Entry number, Time (hours/minutes/seconds) since the last change in status and
Description (nature of the event).

Examples
-> show rmon events

Entry Time Description


---------+-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------
1 00:08:00 etherStatsPkts.4008: [Falling trap] “Falling Event”
2 00:26:00 etherStatsCollisions.2008: “Rising Event”

-> show rmon events 2

Entry Time Description


---------+-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------
2 00:26:00 etherStatsCollisions.2008: “Rising Event”

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 27-7


RMON Commands

output definitions
Entry The entry number in the list of probes.
Time Time (hours, minutes, and seconds) since the last change in status.
Description Description of the Alarm condition detected by the probe.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rmon probes Enables or disables types of RMON probes.


show rmon probes Displays RMON probes or a single RMON probe.

MIB Objects
EVENTTABLE
eventIndex

page 27-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


28 Switch Logging
Commands

This chapter includes descriptions for Switch Logging commands. These commands are used to configure
parameters for the Switch Logging utility.
MIB information for the system commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1System.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SYSTEM-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here.

swlog
swlog appid level
swlog output
swlog output flash file-size
swlog clear
show log swlog
show swlog

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-1


Switch Logging Commands

swlog
Enables or disables switch logging. Switch logging allows you to view a history of various switch
activities in a text format.
swlog
no swlog

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, switch logging is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> swlog
-> no swlog

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

swlog appid level Defines the level at which switch logging information will be filtered for
the specified application.
swlog output Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data
socket.
show log swlog Displays stored switch logging information from flash.
show swlog Displays switch logging information.

MIB Objects
systemSwitchLoggingGroup
systemSwitchLoggingEnable

page 28-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Switch Logging Commands

swlog appid level


Defines the level at which switch logging information will be filtered for the specified application. All
application events of the defined level and lower are captured. Applications can be specified by their
application ID (i.e., subsystem) or by their numeric equivalent.
swlog appid {app_id | integer} level {level | integer}
no swlog appid app_id

Syntax Definitions
app_id An application identification keyword. Current application IDs are
listed in the table below.
integer A numerical equivalent value for the application ID. Current numeric
equivalent values are listed in the table below.

Supported Application IDs and their Numeric Equivalents


802.1q - 7 interface - 6ip - 15 psm - 81
aaa - 20 ipc-diag - 1 qdispatcher - 3
amap - 18 ip-helper - 22 qdriver - 2
bridge - 10 ipc-link - 4 qos - 13
chassis - 64 ipc-mon - 21 rmon - 79
cli - 67 ipms - 17 rsvp - 14
config - 66 lanpower - 108 session - 71
dbggw - 89 ldap - 86 smni - 83
diag - 0 linkagg - 12 snmp - 68
distrib - 84 mipgw - 70 ssl - 88
drc - 74 module - 24 stp - 11
eipc - 26 nan-driver - 78 system - 75
epilogue - 85 ni-supervision - 5 telnet - 80
ftp - 82 nosnmp - 87 trap - 72
gmap - 19 pmm - 23 vlan - 8
health - 76 policy - 73 web - 69
idle - 255 port-mgr - 64

level The severity level filter keyword value for the application ID (see table
on the following page). All switch logging messages of the specified
level and lower will be captured. The severity level is a value assigned
to the relative severity of the switch logging message. A lower value
indicates messages that are more severe, a higher value indicates
messages that are less severe.
integer A numerical equivalent value for the severity level (see table on the
following page). All switch logging messages of the specified level and
lower will be captured. The severity level is a value assigned to the rela-
tive severity of the switch logging message. A lower value indicates
messages that are more severe, a higher value indicates messages that
are less severe. Values range from 2–9.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-3


Switch Logging Commands

Supported Levels Numeric Equivalents Description


alarm 2 Highest severity. The system is about to crash and reboot.
error 3 System functionality is reduced.
alert 4 A violation has occurred.
warning 5 A unexpected, non-critical event has occurred.
info 6 Any other non-debug message (default).
debug1 7 A normal event debug message.
debug2 8 A debug-specific message.
debug3 9 Lowest severity. A maximum verbosity debug message.

Defaults
Default severity level is info. The numeric equivalent for info is 6.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You may enter multiple application IDs in the command line. Separate each application ID with a
space and no comma.
• Application IDs may be entered in any order.

• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> swlog appid 254 level alarm
-> swlog appid policy level info
-> swlog appid policy snmp web aaa vlan level alert
-> no swlog appid debug2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 28-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Switch Logging Commands

Related Commands

swlog Enables or disables switch logging.


swlog output Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data
socket.
show log swlog Displays stored switch logging information from flash.
show swlog Displays switch logging information.

MIB Objects
systemSwitchLoggingGroup
systemSwitchLoggingLevelAppId
systemSwitchLoggingLevel

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-5


Switch Logging Commands

swlog output
Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data socket (remote session).
swlog output {console | flash | socket [ip_address]}
no swlog output {console | flash | socket [ip_address]}

Syntax Definitions
console Specifies console output. When enabled, switch logging output is
printed to the user console.
flash Specifies /flash file output. When enabled, switch logging output is
printed to a file in the switch’s /flash file system.
socket Specifies data socket output. When enabled, switch logging output is
printed to a remote session.
ip_address The IPv4 or IPv6 address for the remote session host.

Defaults

parameter default
console | flash | socket flash and console

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable one or more configured output IP addresses.

• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

• You can send files to multiple hosts (maximum of four) using the socket keyword, followed by the IP
address of the remote host.

Examples
-> swlog output console
-> no swlog output flash
-> swlog output socket 14.1.1.1
-> swlog output socket 15.1.1.1
-> swlog output socket 16.1.1.1
-> swlog output socket 17.1.1.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 28-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Switch Logging Commands

Related Commands

swlog Enables or disables switch logging.


swlog appid level Defines the level at which switch logging information will be filtered for
the specified application.
show log swlog Displays stored switch logging information from flash.
show swlog Displays switch logging information.

MIB Objects
systemSwitchLoggingGroup
systemSwitchLoggingFlash
systemSwitchLoggingSocket
systemSwitchLoggingSocketIpAddr
systemSwitchLoggingConsole
systemSwitchLoggingHostTable
systemSwitchLoggingHostIpAddr
systemSwitchLoggingHostPort
systemSwitchLoggingHostStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-7


Switch Logging Commands

swlog output flash file-size


Configures the size of the switch logging file.
swlog output flash file-size bytes

Syntax Definitions
bytes The size of the switch logging file. The minimum value is 32000 while
the maximum value is the total amount of free space in flash memory.

Defaults

parameter default
bytes 128000

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the ls command to determine the amount of available flash memory.

• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> swlog output flash file size 400000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

swlog clear Clears the files that store switch logging data.
show log swlog Displays stored switch logging information from flash.
show swlog Displays switch logging information.

MIB Objects
systemSwitchLoggingGroup
systemSwitchLoggingFileSize

page 28-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Switch Logging Commands

swlog clear
Clears the files that store switch logging data.
swlog clear

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command when the switch logging display is too long due to some of the data being old or out
of date.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> swlog clear

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

swlog output Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data
socket.
show log swlog Displays stored switch logging information from flash.
show swlog Displays switch logging information.

MIB Objects
systemSwitchLoggingGroup
systemSwitchLoggingClear

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-9


Switch Logging Commands

show log swlog


Displays stored switch logging information.
show log swlog
show log swlog [session session_id] [timestamp start_time [end_time]] [appid appid] [level level]

Syntax Definitions
session_id Identification number of the session for which switch logging
information is displayed.
start_time Specify the starting time for the switch logging information to be
displayed. Use the format mm/dd/yyyy hh:mm where mm represents the
month, dd is the day, yyyy is the year, hh is the hour, and mm is the
minutes. Use four digits to specify the year.
end_time Specify the ending time for the switch logging information to be
displayed. Use the format mm/dd/yyyy hh:mm where mm represents the
month, dd is the day, yyyy is the year, hh is the hour, mm is the minutes.
Use four digits to specify the year.
appid A digit that represents the application ID for the switch logging
information to be displayed. Values are listed in the following table.

Supported Application IDs and their Numeric Equivalents


802.1q - 7 interface - 6 psm - 81
aaa - 20 ip - 15 qdispatcher - 3
amap - 18 ipc-diag - 1 qdriver - 2
bridge - 10 ip-helper - 22 qos - 13
chassis - 64 ipc-link - 4 rmon - 79
cli - 67 ipc-mon - 21 rsvp - 14
config - 66 ipms - 17 session - 71
dbggw - 89 ldap - 86 smni - 83
diag - 0 linkagg - 12 snmp - 68
distrib - 84 mipgw - 70 ssl - 88
drc - 74 module - 24 stp - 11
eipc - 26 nan-driver - 78 system - 75
epilogue - 85 ni-supervision - 5 telnet - 80
ftp - 82 nosnmp - 87 trap - 72
gmap - 19 pmm - 23 vlan - 8
health - 76 policy - 73 web - 69
idle - 255 port-mgr - 64

page 28-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Switch Logging Commands

level A numerical equivalent value for the severity level (see table below).
All switch logging messages of the specified level and lower will be
shown. The severity level is a value assigned to the relative severity of
the switch logging message. A lower value indicates messages that are
more severe, a higher value indicates messages that are less severe.
Values range from 2–9.

Supported Levels Numeric Equivalents Description


alarm 2 Highest severity. The system is about to crash and reboot.
error 3 System functionality is reduced.
alert 4 A violation has occurred.
warning 5 A unexpected, non-critical event has occurred.
info 6 Any other non-debug message (default).
debug1 7 A normal event debug message.
debug2 8 A debug-specific message.
debug3 9 Lowest severity. A maximum verbosity debug message.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the switch logging display is too long, you may use the show log swlog command to clear all of
the switch logging information.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show log swlog
Displaying file contents for 'swlog2.log'
FILEID: fileName[swlog2.log], endPtr[32]
configSize[64000], currentSize[64000], mode[2]
Displaying file contents for 'swlog1.log'
FILEID: fileName[swlog1.log], endPtr[395]
configSize[64000], currentSize[64000], mode[1]

Time Stamp Application Level Log Message

------------------------+--------------+-------+--------------------------------

MON NOV 11 12:42:11 2002 SYSTEM info Switch Logging files cleared by
command
MON NOV 11 13:07:26 2002 WEB info The HTTP session login successfu
l!
MON NOV 11 13:18:24 2002 WEB info The HTTP session login successfu
l!
MON NOV 11 13:24:03 2002 TELNET info New telnet connection, Address ,

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-11


Switch Logging Commands

128.251.30.88
MON NOV 11 13:24:03 2002 TELNET info Session 4, Created
MON NOV 11 13:59:04 2002 WEB info The HTTP session user logout suc
cessful!

output definitions
Time Stamp The day, date and time for which Switch Logging log information is
displayed.
Application The Application ID (Subsystem) for which Switch Logging log infor-
mation is displayed.
Level The corresponding Severity Level for which Switch Logging informa-
tion was stored. Levels include alarm, error, alert, warning, info,
debug1, debug2, and debug3.
Log Message The condition that resulted in the logging information being stored.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

swlog Enables or disables switch logging.


swlog appid level Adds or removes a filter level for a specified subsystem.
swlog output Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data
socket.
swlog clear Clears the files that store switch logging data.
show swlog Displays switch logging information.

page 28-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Switch Logging Commands

show swlog
Displays switch logging information (e.g., switch logging status, log devices, application IDs with non-
default severity level settings).
show swlog

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show swlog
Switch Logging is :
- INITIALIZED.
- RUNNING.

Log Device(s)
-------------
flash
console
socket ipaddr 11.1.1.1
socket ipaddr 12.1.1.1
socket ipaddr 13.1.1.1
socket ipaddr 14.1.1.1

All Applications have their trace level set to the level 'info' (6)

output definitions
Application ID The Application ID (subsystem) for which the Severity Level is not set
to the info (6) default setting.
Level The Severity Level of the above-referenced Application ID. Levels
include (2), error (3), alert (4), warning (5), info (6), debug1 (7),
debug2 (8), and debug3 (9).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 28-13


Switch Logging Commands

Related Commands

swlog Enables or disables switch logging.


swlog appid level Defines the level at which switch logging information will be filtered for
the specified application.
swlog output Enables or disables switch logging output to the console, file, or data
socket.
show log swlog Displays stored switch logging information from flash.

page 28-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


29 Health Monitoring
Commands

The Health Monitoring function monitors the consumable resources of the switch (e.g., bandwidth usage,
CPU usage) and provides a single integrated resource for a Network Management System (NMS). This
function monitors the switch, and at fixed intervals, collects the current values for each resource being
monitored. Users specify resource threshold limits and traps are sent to an NMS if a value falls above or
below a user-specified threshold.
The Health Monitoring commands comply with RFC1212.
MIB information for the Health Monitoring commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Health.mib
Module: healthMIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

health threshold
health interval
health statistics reset
show health threshold
show health interval
show health
show health all
show health slice
show health fabric

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-1


Health Monitoring Commands

health threshold
Configures thresholds for input traffic (RX), output/input traffic (TX/RX), memory usage, CPU usage, and
chassis temperature.
Input traffic, output/input traffic, memory usage, and CPU usage thresholds specify the maximum percent-
age for each resource that may be consumed before a trap is sent to the user. The temperature threshold
specifies the maximum operating temperature, in Celsius, allowed within the chassis before a trap is sent.
health threshold {rx percent | txrx percent | memory percent | cpu percent | temperature degrees}

Syntax Definitions
rx Specifies the maximum input (RX) traffic threshold.
txrx Specifies the maximum output/input (TX/RX) traffic threshold.
memory Specifies the maximum RAM memory usage threshold.
cpu Specifies the maximum CPU usage threshold.
percent The new threshold value, in percent, for the corresponding resource—
i.e., rx, txrx, memory, cpu—(0–100).
temperature Specifies the temperature threshold for the chassis.
degrees The new threshold value, in Celsius, for the chassis temperature
threshold (0–100).

Defaults

parameter default
percentage 80
degrees 50

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When a resource falls back below the configured threshold, an additional trap is sent to the user. This
indicates that the resource is no longer operating beyond its configured threshold limit.
• Changing a threshold value sets the value for all levels of the switch (i.e., switch, module, and port).
You cannot set different threshold values for each level.
• For detailed information on each threshold type, refer to page 29-6, or refer to the “Diagnosing Switch
Problems” chapter in the OmniSwitch Network Configuration Guide.
• To view the current health threshold values, use the show health threshold command. Do not use the
show temperature command as it does not display health threshold statistics. These two show
commands are unrelated.

page 29-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

Examples
-> health threshold rx 85
-> health threshold txrx 55
-> health threshold memory 95
-> health threshold cpu 85
-> health threshold temperature 40

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show health threshold Displays the current health threshold settings.

MIB Objects
HealthThreshInfo
healthThreshDeviceRxLimit
healthThreshDeviceTxRxLimit
healthThreshDeviceTempLimit
healthThreshDeviceMemoryLimit
healthThreshDeviceCpuLimit

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-3


Health Monitoring Commands

health interval
Configures the sampling interval between health statistics checks. The sampling interval is the time inter-
val between polls of the switch’s consumable resources to see if it is performing within set thresholds.
health interval seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds Sampling interval (in seconds). Valid entries are 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 10, 12,
15, 20, 30.

Defaults

parameter default
seconds 5

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Decreasing the polling interval may impact switch performance.

Examples
-> health interval 6

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show health interval Displays the current health sampling interval.

MIB Objects
HealthThreshInfo
healthSamplingInterval

page 29-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

health statistics reset


Resets health statistics for the switch.
health statistics reset

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command clears statistics for the entire switch. You cannot clear statistics for a module or port only.

Examples
-> health statistics reset

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show health Displays health statistics for the switch.

MIB Objects
HealthThreshInfo
healthSamplingReset

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-5


Health Monitoring Commands

show health threshold


Displays current health threshold settings.
show health threshold [rx | txrx | memory | cpu | temperature]

Syntax Definitions
rx Displays the current input (RX) traffic threshold.
txrx Displays the current output/input (TX/RX) traffic threshold.
memory Displays the current RAM memory usage threshold.
cpu Displays the current CPU usage threshold.
temperature Displays the current chassis temperature threshold.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Unless a specific resource type (i.e., rx, txrx, memory, cpu, or temperature) is specified, threshold
information for all resources displays.
• To display only a specific threshold, enter the command, followed by the specific resource type
(rx, txrx, memory, cpu, or temperature). For example, to display only the memory threshold, enter
the following syntax: show health threshold memory.

Examples
-> show health threshold
Rx Threshold = 80
TxRx Threshold = 80
Memory Threshold = 80
CPU Threshold = 80
Temperature Threshold = 50

page 29-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Rx Threshold The current device input (RX) threshold. This value displays the maxi-
mum percentage of total bandwidth allowed for incoming traffic on the
switch. The total bandwidth is defined as the Ethernet port capacity for
all NI modules currently operating in the switch, in Mbps. For example,
a chassis with 48 100Base-T Ethernet ports installed has a total band-
width of 4800 Mbps. The default value is 80 percent and can be
changed via the health threshold command.
TxRx Threshold The current device output/input (TX/RX) threshold. This value dis-
plays the maximum percentage of total bandwidth allowed for all
incoming and outgoing traffic. As with the RX threshold described
above, the total bandwidth is defined as the Ethernet port capacity for
all the NI modules currently operating in the switch, in Mbps. The
default value is 80 percent and can be changed via the
health threshold command.
Memory Threshold Displays the current memory usage threshold. Memory usage refers to
the total amount of RAM memory currently used by switch applica-
tions. The default value is 80 percent and can be changed via the
health threshold command.
CPU Threshold Displays the current CPU usage threshold. CPU usage refers to the total
amount of CPU processor capacity currently used by switch applica-
tions. The default value is 80 percent and can be changed via the
health threshold command.
Temperature Threshold Displays the current chassis temperature threshold, in Celsius. The
default value is 50 degrees Celsius and can be changed via the
health threshold command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

health threshold Configures thresholds for input traffic (RX), output/input traffic
(TX/RX), memory usage, CPU usage, and chassis temperature.

MIB Objects
HealthThreshInfo
healthThreshDeviceRxLimit
healthThreshDeviceTxRxLimit
healthThreshDeviceTempLimit
healthThreshDeviceMemoryLimit
healthThreshDeviceCpuLimit

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-7


Health Monitoring Commands

show health interval


Displays the current health sampling interval.
show health interval

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the health interval command to set the sampling interval.

Examples
-> show health interval
Sampling Interval = 5

output definitions
Sampling Interval Currently configured interval between health statistics checks (in sec-
onds).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

health interval Configures the interval between health statistics checks.

MIB Objects
HealthThreshInfo
healthSamplingInterval

page 29-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

show health
Displays the health statistics for the switch. Statistics are displayed as percentages of total resource capac-
ity and represent data taken from the last sampling interval.
show health [slot/port] [statistics]

Syntax Definitions
slot/port To view a specific slot, enter the slot number (e.g., 3). To view a
specific port, enter the slot and port number (e.g., 3/1).
statistics Optional command syntax. It displays the same information as the show
health command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no slot/port information is specified, the aggregate health statistics for all ports is displayed.

• Use the health statistics reset command to reset health statistics for the switch.

Examples
-> show health
* - current value exceeds threshold

Device 1 Min 1 Hr 1 Hr
Resources Limit Curr Avg Avg Max
----------------+-------+-----+------+-----+-----+-------
Receive 80 01 01 01 01
Transmit/Receive 80 01 01 01 01
Memory 80 66 66 66 66
CPU 80 41 40 32 30
Temperature Cmm 50 33 33 33 33
Temperature Cmm Cpu 50 32 32 32 32

-> show health 4/3


* - current value exceeds threshold

Port 04/03 1 Min 1 Hr 1 Hr


Resources Limit Curr Avg Avg Max
----------------+-------+-----+-------+-----+-------
Receive 80 01 01 01 01
Transmit/Receive 80 01 01 01 01

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-9


Health Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Receive Traffic received by the switch.
Transmit/Receive Traffic transmitted and received by the switch.
Memory Switch memory.
CPU Switch CPU.
Temperature Cmm CMM Chassis Temperature.
Temperature Cmm Cpu CMM CPU Temperature.
Limit Currently configured device threshold levels (percentage of total avail-
able bandwidth or temperature measured in degrees Celsius).
Curr Current device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in degrees
Celsius).
1 Min Avg Average device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in degrees
Celsius) over a 1-minute period.
1 Hr Avg Average device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in degrees
Celsius) over a 1-hour period.
1 Hr Max Maximum device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in
degrees Celsius) over a 1-hour period (i.e., the maximum of the 1
minute averages).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

health statistics reset Resets health statistics for the switch.


show health all Displays health statistics for a specified resource on all NIs cur-
rently operating in the chassis.

MIB Objects
healthModuleTable
healthModuleSlot
healthModuleRxLatest
healthModuleRx1MinAvg
healthModuleRx1HrAvg
healthModuleRx1HrMax
healthModuleRxTxLatest
healthModuleRxTx1MinAvg
healthModuleRxTx1HrAvg
healthModuleRxTx1HrMax
healthModuleMemoryLatest
healthModuleMemory1MinAvg
healthModuleMemory1HrAvg
healthModuleMemory1HrMax
healthModuleCpuLatest
healthModuleCpu1MinAvg
healthModuleCpu1HrAvg
healthModuleCpu1HrMax

page 29-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

show health all


Displays health statistics for a specified resource on all active NI modules installed in the chassis.
show health all {memory | cpu | rx | txrx}

Syntax Definitions
memory Displays the RAM memory health statistics for all active NI modules in
the switch.
cpu Displays the CPU health statistics for all active NI modules.
rx Displays the health statistics for traffic received on all active NI
modules.
txrx Displays the health statistics for traffic both transmitted and received on
all active NI modules.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show health all memory
* - current value exceeds threshold

1 Min 1 Hr 1 Hr
Memory Limit Curr Avg Avg Max
-----------------+-------+------+------+-----+----
01 80 40 40 40 40
02 80 40 40 40 40
03 80 40 40 40 40
04 80 40 40 40 40
05 80 40 40 40 40
06 80 40 40 40 40
07 80 40 40 40 40
13 80 40 40 40 40

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-11


Health Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Memory (Cpu, TXRX, RX) A list of all currently-active NI modules (i.e., active slots) on the
switch. The column header corresponds with the resource keyword
entered. For example, if show health all cpu is entered, Cpu is used as
the column header.
Limit Current usage threshold for the specified resource type, on the corre-
sponding slot (in percent). The usage threshold refers to the maximum
amount of the resource’s total bandwidth that can be used by switch
applications before a notification is sent to the user. The default value
for all resource types is 80 percent. This threshold can be changed via
the health threshold command.
Curr Current usage of the resource on the corresponding slot, in percent (i.e.,
the amount of the resource’s total bandwidth actually being used by
switch applications).
1 Min Avg Average usage of the resource on the corresponding slot over a one
minute period.
1 Hr Avg Average usage of the resource on the corresponding slot over a one
hour period.
1 Hr Max The highest average hourly usage for the resource on the corresponding
slot.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show health Displays the health statistics for the switch.


health threshold Configures thresholds for input traffic (RX), output/input traffic
(TX/RX), memory usage, CPU usage, and chassis temperature.

MIB Objects
healthModuleTable
healthModuleSlot
healthModuleRxLatest
healthModuleRx1MinAvg
healthModuleRx1HrAvg
healthModuleRx1HrMax
healthModuleRxTxLatest
healthModuleRxTx1MinAvg
healthModuleRxTx1HrAvg
healthModuleRxTx1HrMax
healthModuleMemoryLatest
healthModuleMemory1MinAvg
healthModuleMemory1HrAvg
healthModuleMemory1HrMax
healthModuleCpuLatest
healthModuleCpu1MinAvg
healthModuleCpu1HrAvg
healthModuleCpu1HrMax

page 29-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

show health slice


Displays the health statistics for a particular slice. The term slice refers to an amount of CPU time and
RAM memory allotted for switch applications. By monitoring slice statistics on the switch, users can
determine whether there are any potential usage issues with CPU and RAM memory that may affect
switch multi-tasking.
show health slice slot

Syntax Definitions
slot A specific physical slot number for which slice statistics are to be
displayed (e.g., 3).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show health slice 13
Slot 13 slice
Resources 1
----------+-------
Memory 40
Cpu 21

output definitions
Slot The physical slot number for the corresponding slice.
slice The on-board slice number (1–64).
Memory The slice-level RAM memory utilization over the latest sample period,
in percent (0–100).
Cpu The slice-level CPU utilization over the latest sample period, in
percent (0–100).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-13


Health Monitoring Commands

MIB Objects
healthSliceTable
healthSliceSlot
healthSliceSlice
healthSliceMemoryLatest
healthSliceCpuLatest

page 29-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Health Monitoring Commands

show health fabric


Displays the health statistics of a fabric for a particular slot or a range of slots.
show health fabric slot 1[-slot2]

Syntax Definitions
slot A specific physical slot number for which fabric statistics are to be
displayed (e.g., 3).
slot2 Last fabric slot number in a range of slots you want to display.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show health fabric 3
* - current value exceeds threshold

Slot 03 1 Min 1 Hr 1 Hr
Fabric Limit Curr Avg Avg Max
-----------------+-------+------+------+-----+----
Receive
Primary 80 00 00 00 00
Secondary 80 00 00 00 00
Transmit/Receive
Primary 80 00 00 00 00
Secondary 80 00 00 00 00

output definitions
Slot The physical slot number for the corresponding fabric.
Limit Currently configured device threshold levels (percentage of total avail-
able bandwidth or temperature measured in degrees Celsius).
Curr Current device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in degrees
Celsius).
1 Min Avg Average device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in degrees
Celsius) over a 1-minute period.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 29-15


Health Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


1 Hr Avg Average device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in degrees
Celsius) over a 1-hour period.
1 Hr Max Maximum device bandwidth usage or temperature (measured in
degrees Celsius) over a 1-hour period (i.e., the maximum of the 1
minute averages).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
healthFabricTable
healthFabricSlot
healthFabricPrimaryRxLatest
healthFabricPrimaryRx1MinAvg
healthFabricPrimaryRx1HrAvg
healthFabricPrimaryRx1HrMax
healthFabricPrimaryRxTxLatest
healthFabricPrimaryRxTx1MinAvg
healthFabricPrimaryRxTx1HrAvg
healthFabricPrimaryRxTx1HrMax
healthFabricSecondaryRxLatest
healthFabricSecondaryRx1MinAvg
healthFabricSecondaryRx1HrAvg
healthFabricSecondaryRx1HrMax
healthFabricSecondaryRxTxLatest
healthFabricSecondaryRxTx1MinAvg
healthFabricSecondaryRxTx1HrAvg
healthFabricSecondaryRxTx1HrMax

page 29-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


30 CMM Commands

The Chassis Management Module (CMM) CLI commands allow you to manage switch software files in
the working directory, the certified directory, and the running configuration.
MIB information for the CMM commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Chassis.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-CHASSIS-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1ConfigMgr.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-CONFIG-MGR-MIB DEFINITIONS
A summary of available commands is listed here:
reload
reload working
copy running-config working
write memory
copy working certified
copy working certified
copy flash-synchro
takeover
show running-directory
show reload
show microcode
show microcode history

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-1


CMM Commands

reload
Reboots the CMM to its startup software configuration.
reload [primary | secondary] [with-fabric] [in [hours:] minutes | at hour:minute [month day | day
month]]
reload [primary | secondary] [with-fabric] cancel

Syntax Definitions
primary | secondary Reboot the primary or secondary CMM to its startup software configu-
ration. If the primary CMM is already running the startup version, a
primary reboot will result in a secondary takover.
in [hours:] minutes Optional syntax. Schedules a reload of the software to take effect in the
specified minutes or hours and minutes within the next 24 hours.
at hour:minute Optional syntax. Schedules a reload of the software to take place at the
specified time using a 24-hour clock. If you do not specify the month
and day, the reload takes place at the specified time on the current day
provided the specified time is later than the time when the CLI
command is issued. If the specified time is earlier than the current time,
the reload will take place on the following day.
month day | day month The name of the month and the number of the day for the scheduled
reload. Specify a month name and the day number. It is unimportant if
the month or day is first. See examples below for further explanation.
cancel Cancels a pending time delayed reboot.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command causes the specified CMM to reboot. If no CMM is specified, the primary CMM
reboots.
• If a reload command is issued, and another reload is currently scheduled, a message appears informing
the user of the next reload time and asks for confirmation to change to the new reload time.
• If the switch has a redundant CMM and the primary CMM is rebooted, the switch will fail over to the
secondary CMM. For more information on CMM failover, see “Managing CMM Directories” in the
OmniSwitch Switch Management Guide.
• If the switch is part of a stacked configuration consisting of three or more switches, the next switch in
“idle” mode becomes the secondary CMM, and the original primary CMM becomes “idle.” For more
information on stacks, see “Managing Stacks” in the appropriate Hardware Users Guide.The cancel
keyword stops a pending reboot.

page 30-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> reload
-> reload primary
-> reload primary in 15:25
-> reload primary at 15:25 august 10
-> reload primary at 15:25 10 august

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload working Immediate primary CMM reboot to the working software configuration
without secondary CMM takeover.

MIB Objects
chasEntPhysicalTable
csEntPhysicalIndex
chasEntPhysAdminStatus
chasControlRedundantTable
chasControlDelayedRebootTimer

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-3


CMM Commands

reload working
Immediately reboots the primary CMM from the working directory. There is no CMM fail over during this
reboot, causing a loss of switch functionality during the reboot. All NIs reboot as well, including the
secondary CMM.
reload working {rollback-timeout minutes | no rollback-timeout} [in [hours:] minutes | at hour:minute]

Syntax Definitions
rollback-timeout minutes Sets a timeout period, in minutes. The switch immediately reboots from
the working directory and then at the end of this time period, automati-
cally reboots again from the certified directory. The range is 1–15.
no rollback-timeout Specifies no timeout to rollback. If the command is issued with this
keyword, then the switch will continue to run from the working direc-
tory until manually rebooted.
in [hours:] minutes Optional syntax. Schedules a reload of the working directory to take
effect in the specified minutes or hours and minutes within the next 24
hours.
at hour:minute Optional syntax. Schedules a reload of the working directory to take
place at the specified time using a 24-hour clock. If you do not specify
the month and day, the reload takes place at the specified time on the
current day provided the specified time is later than the time when the
CLI command is issued. If the specified time is earlier than the current
time, the reload will take place on the following day.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is used to reload the primary CMM from the working directory as opposed to the certi-
fied CMM. The working directory reload takes place immediately unless a time frame is set using the
in or at keywords.
• The in or at keywords allow you to schedule a working reload sometime in the future. A schedule
working reboot is called an activate.
• If a reload or an immediate working reload is initiated before a scheduled activate is enacted, a
message appears displaying the number of seconds until the scheduled activate and if it should be over-
ridden.
• If a timeout is set, the switch reboots again after the set number of minutes, from the certified direc-
tory. The reboot can be halted by issuing a cancel order as described in the reload command.

page 30-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

• If the switch is a part of a stacked configuration, using this command synchronizes the working direc-
tories of all the switches in the stack to the working directory of the primary CMM switch.

Examples
-> reload working rollback-timeout 5
-> reload working no rollback-timeout
-> reload working no rollback-timeout in 50
-> reload working rollback-timeout 10 at 12:50

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload Reboots the CMM to its startup software configuration.

MIB Objects
chasControlModuleTable
csEntPhysicalIndex
chasControlActivateTimeout

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-5


CMM Commands

copy running-config working


Copies the running configuration (RAM) to the working directory.
[configure] copy running-config working

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is used to copy the changes made using the CLI commands from the running configura-
tion (RAM) to the working directory.
• This command is only valid if the switch is running from the working directory. Use the show
running-directory command to check from where the switch is running.
• This command performs the same function as the write memory command.

Note. The saved boot.cfg file will be overwritten if the takeover command is executed after the copy
running-config working or write memory commands, in an OmniSwitch set up with redundant CMMs.

Examples
-> configure copy running-config working

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 30-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

Related Commands
write memory Copies the running primary RAM version of the CMM software to the
working primary flash.
copy flash-synchro Copies the startup primary flash version of the CMM software to the
startup secondary flash version of the CMM software.

MIB Objects
chasControlModuleTable
csEntPhysicalIndex
chasControlVersionMngt

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-7


CMM Commands

write memory
Copies the running configuration (RAM) to the working directory.
[configure] write memory

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is used to copy the changes made using the CLI commands from the running configura-
tion (RAM) to the working directory.
• This command is only valid if the switch is running from the working directory. Use the show
running-directory command to check from where the switch is running.
• This command performs the same function as the copy running-config working command.

Note. The saved boot.cfg file will be overwritten if the takeover command is executed after the copy
running-config working or write memory commands, in an OmniSwitch set up with redundant CMMs.

Examples
-> configure write memory
-> write memory

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
copy running-config working Copies the running primary RAM version of the CMM software to the
working primary flash. Or copy the startup primary flash version of the
CMM software to the working primary flash.
copy flash-synchro Copies the startup primary flash version of the CMM software to the
startup secondary flash version of the CMM software.

page 30-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

MIB Objects
configManager
configWriteMemory

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-9


CMM Commands

copy working certified


Copies the working directory version of the CMM software to the certified directory, on the primary
CMM. This command also allows you to synchronize the primary and secondary CMMs.
[configure] copy working certified [flash-synchro]

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is used to overwrite the contents of the certified directory with the contents of the work-
ing directory. This should only be done if the contents of the working directory have been verified as
the best version of the CMM files.
• The flash-synchro keyword, when used with the copy certified working command, synchronizes the
files between the primary and secondary CMMs by overwriting the contents of the secondary CMM
certified directory with the contents of the primary CMM certified directory. If the switch is part of a
stacked configuration, all switches in the stack are updated with the primary CMM files.
• In order for this command to work, the amount of free space in flash must equal the size of the files
being copied. If there isn’t enough free space, the copy attempt will fail and an error message is gener-
ated. Only image files, the boot.cfg file, and the certs.pem file should be kept in the working directory.
• This command will not work if the switch is running from the certified directory. To view where the
switch is running from, see the show running-directory command.

Examples
-> copy working certified
-> copy working certified flash-synchro

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 30-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

Related Commands

copy working certified Copies the running primary RAM version of the CMM software to the
working primary flash. Or copy the startup primary flash version of the
CMM software to the working primary flash.
copy flash-synchro Copies the startup primary flash version of the CMM software to the star-
tup secondary flash version of the CMM software.

MIB Objects
chasControlModuleTable
csEntPhysicalIndex
chasControlVersionMngt

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-11


CMM Commands

copy flash-synchro
Copies the certified directory version of the primary CMM software to the certified directory of the
secondary CMM.
[configure] copy flash-synchro

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command is used to synchronize the certified directories of the primary and secondary CMMs.
The two CMMs must be in synchronization if a fail over occurs, otherwise switch performance is lost.
• If the switch is part of stackable configuration, all switches in the stack are updated with the primary
CMM files.

Examples
-> copy flash-synchro
-> configure copy flash-synchro

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

copy working certified Copies the running primary RAM version of the CMM software to the
working primary flash. Or copies the startup primary flash version of
the CMM software to the working primary flash.
copy working certified Copies the working primary flash version of the CMM software to cer-
tified primary flash. Or copies the working primary flash version of the
CMM software to startup secondary flash.

MIB Objects
chasControlModuleTable
csEntPhysicalIndex
chasControlVersionMngt

page 30-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

takeover
The current secondary CMM assumes the role of primary CMM.
takeover

Syntax Definitions
with-fabric Performs a complete CMM reload.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command causes the secondary CMM to take over the functions of the primary CMM. After this
command, the old primary CMM is the new secondary CMM.
• Before issuing the takeover command, be sure that the secondary CMM has all software (i.e., image
and configuration files) required to continue CMM operations.
• For information on synchronizing the primary and secondary CMM software before issuing the
takeover command, see the copy flash-synchro command.
• When the CMM modules switch primary and secondary roles, the console session to the new primary
CMM is disconnected. To continue managing the switch, be sure that you have physical connections to
both CMMs or local access to the switch in order to move your Ethernet or serial cable from one CMM
to the other.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

• If the switch is part of an a stackable configuration consisting of three or more switches, the next
switch in “idle” mode becomes the secondary CMM, and the original primary CMM becomes “idle.”
For more information on stacks, see “Managing Stacks” in the Hardware Users Guide.

Note. The saved boot.cfg file will be overwritten if the takeover command is executed after the copy
running-config working or write memory commands, in an OmniSwitch set up with redundant CMMs.
Refer to the “NIs Reload On Takeover” description on page 30-16 for more information on the takeover
command and redundant management modules.

Examples
-> takeover
-> takeover with-fabric

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-13


CMM Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Command

reload Reboots the CMM to its startup software configuration.

MIB Objects
chasEntPhysicalTable
csEntPhysicalIndex
chasEntPhysAdminStatus

page 30-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

show running-directory
Shows the directory from where the switch was booted.
show running-directory

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Once a switch has booted and is running, it will run either from the working or certified directory. If
running from the certified, changes made to the running configuration using CLI commands cannot be
saved. A switch must be running from the working directory in order to save the current running
configuration.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show running-directory

CONFIGURATION STATUS
Running CMM : PRIMARY,
CMM Mode : DUAL CMMs,
Current CMM Slot : 1,
Running configuration : WORKING,
Certify/Restore Status : CERTIFY NEEDED
SYNCHRONIZATION STATUS
Flash Between CMMs : SYNCHRONIZED,
Running Configuration : NOT AVAILABLE,
Stacks Reload on Takeover: ALL STACKs (SW Activation)

output definitions
Running CMM The CMM currently controlling the switch, either PRIMARY or
SECONDARY.
CMM Mode Displays whether the primary and secondary CMMs are synchronized.
In the case that there is no secondary CMM, MONO-CMM-CHASSIS
is shown.
Current CMM Slot The slot number of the primary CMM.
Running Configuration Where the switch is running from, either WORKING or CERTIFIED.
A switch running from the certified directory will not be able to manip-
ulate files in the directory structure.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-15


CMM Commands

output definitions (continued)


Certify/Restore Status Indicates if the CM has been certified (i.e., the Working directory
matches the Certified directory).
Flash Between CMMs Displays whether the Working and Certified directories are the same.
NIs Reload On Takeover Displays how many Network Interface (NI) modules or switches in a
Stacks Reload on Takeover stack will be reloaded in the event of a management module takeover.
Options include NONE, ALL, or a list of specific NIs.
If there are no unsaved configuration changes and the flash directories
on both the primary and secondary management modules have been
synchronized via the copy flash-synchro command, no NIs will be
reloaded if a management module takeover occurs. As a result, data
flow is not interrupted on the NIs during the takeover.
If a configuration change is made to one or more NI modules (e.g., a
VLAN is configured on several different interfaces), and the changes
are not saved via the write memory command, the corresponding NIs
will automatically reload if a management module takeover occurs.
Data flow on the affected NIs will be interrupted until the reload is
complete. Note that the NIs will reload whether or not the flash syn-
chronization status shows SYNCHRONIZED. This is because the
unsaved changes have occurred in the running configuration
(i.e., RAM), and have not been written to the flash directory’s configu-
ration file. In this case, a list of only the affected NIs displays in the
table output (e.g., 1 6 9 12).
If the flash directories on the primary and secondary management mod-
ules are not synchronized (e.g., a copy flash-synchro command has not
been issued recently), all NIs will be reloaded automatically if a man-
agement module takeover occurs. Data flow will be interrupted on all
NIs until the reload is complete.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload Reboots the CMM to its startup software configuration.


write memory Copies the running configuration (RAM) to the working directory.
copy flash-synchro Copies the certified directory version of the primary CMM software to
the certified directory of the secondary CMM.

MIB Objects
chasControlModuleTable
chasControlRunningVersion
chasControlActivateTimeout
chasControlVersionMngt
chasControlDelayedActivateTimer
chasControlCertifyStatus
chasControlSynchronizationStatus

page 30-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

show reload
Shows the status of any time delayed reboot(s) that are pending on the switch.
show reload [status]

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• It is possible to preset a reboot on a CMM by using the reload command. If this is done, use the show
reload command to see when the next scheduled reboot will occur.
• If the reload working command was used, and a rollback timeout was set, the time the rollback will
occur is shown using the show reload command.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show reload status
Primary Control Module Reload Status: No Reboot Scheduled,
Secondary Control Module Reload Status: No Reboot Scheduled

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload Reboots the primary or secondary CMM to its startup software configura-
tion.
reload working Immediate primary CMM reboot to the working software configuration
without secondary CMM takeover.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-17


CMM Commands

show microcode
Displays microcode versions installed on the switch.
show microcode [working | certified | loaded]

Syntax Definitions
working Specifies the switch’s working directory; only microcode information
from the working directory will be displayed.
certified Specifies the switch’s certified directory; only microcode information
from the certified directory will be displayed.
loaded Specifies that only loaded (i.e., currently-active) microcode versions
will be displayed. Idle microcode versions will not be displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If no additional parameters are entered (i.e., working, certified, or loaded), microcode information for
the running configuration will be displayed.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show microcode
Package Release Size Description
-----------------+---------------+--------+-----------------------------------
Jbase.img 6.1.1.403.R01 10520989 Alcatel-Lucent Base Software
Jos.img 6.1.1.403.R01 1828255 Alcatel-Lucent OS
Jadvrout.img 6.1.1.403.R01 1359435 Alcatel-Lucent Advanced Routing

page 30-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CMM Commands

output definitions
Package File name.
Release Version number.
Size File size.
Description File description.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show microcode history Displays the archive history for microcode versions installed on the
switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 30-19


CMM Commands

show microcode history


Displays the archive history for microcode versions installed on the switch.
show microcode history [working | certified]

Syntax Definitions
working The history for the working directory’s microcode will be displayed.
certified The history for the certified directory’s microcode will be displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If no additional parameters are entered (i.e., working or certified), the microcode history for the running
directory will be displayed.

Examples
-> show microcode history
Archive Created 8/27/05 23:45:00

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show microcode Displays microcode versions installed on the switch.

page 30-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


31 Chassis Management and
Monitoring Commands

Chassis Management and Monitoring commands allow you to configure and view hardware-related opera-
tions on the switch. Topics include basic system information, as well as Network Interface (NI) module
and chassis management.

Additional Information. Refer to your separate Hardware Users Guide for detailed information on
chassis components, as well as managing and monitoring hardware-related functions.

MIB information for the Chassis Management and Monitoring commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Chassis.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-CHASSIS-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1System.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SYSTEM-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1StackManager.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-STACK-MANAGER-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-1


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

A summary of available commands is listed here:


Management Commands system contact
system name
system location
system date
system time
system time-and-date synchro
system timezone
system daylight savings time
update
update lanpower
reload ni
reload all
reload pass-through
power ni
temp-threshold
stack set slot
stack set slot mode
stack clear slot
Monitoring Commands show system
show hardware info
show chassis
show cmm
show ni
show module
show module long
show module status
show power
show fan
show temperature
show stack topology
show stack status
show stack mode

page 31-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system contact
Specifies the switch’s administrative contact. An administrative contact is the person or department in
charge of the switch. If a contact is specified, users can easily find the appropriate network administrator if
they have questions or comments about the switch.
system contact text_string

Syntax Definitions
text_string The administrative contact being specified for the switch. The system
contact can range from 1 to 254 characters in length. Text strings that
include spaces must be enclosed in quotation marks. For example,
“Jean Smith Ext. 477 [email protected]”.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> system contact "Jean Smith Ext. 477 [email protected]"
-> system contact [email protected]

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system name Modifies the switch’s current system name.


system location Specifies the switch’s current physical location.
show system Displays the basic system information for the switch.

MIB Objects
system
systemContact

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-3


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system name
Modifies the switch’s current system name. The system name can be any simple, user-defined text descrip-
tion for the switch.
system name text_string

Syntax Definitions
text_string The new system name. The system name can range from 1 to 19
characters in length. Text strings that include spaces must be enclosed in
quotation marks. For example, “OmniSwitch 6450”.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> system name "OmniSwitch 6450"
-> system name OS-6450

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system contact Specifies the switch’s administrative contact (e.g., an individual or a


department).
system location Specifies the switch’s current physical location.
show system Displays the basic system information for the switch.

MIB Objects
system
systemName

page 31-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system location
Specifies the switch’s current physical location. If you need to determine the switch’s location from a
remote site, entering a system location can be very useful.
system location text_string

Syntax Definitions
text_string The switch’s physical location. For example, TestLab. The system
location can range from 1 to 254 characters in length. Text strings that
include spaces must be enclosed in quotation marks. For example,
“NMS Test Lab”.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> system location "NMS Test Lab"
-> system location TestLab

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system contact Specifies the switch’s administrative contact (e.g., an individual or a


department).
system name Modifies the switch’s current system name.
show system Displays the basic system information for the switch.

MIB Objects
system
systemLocation

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-5


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system date
Displays or modifies the switch’s current system date.
system date [mm/dd/yyyy]

Syntax Definitions
mm/dd/yyyy The new date being specified for the system. Enter the date in the
following format: mm/dd/yyyy, where mm is the month, dd is the day,
and yyyy is the year. For example, 08/08/2005.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If you do not specify a new system date in the command line, the current system date will be displayed.

• For more information on setting time zone parameters (e.g., Daylight Savings Time), refer to the
system timezone command on page 31-9.

Examples
-> system date 08/08/2005
-> system date
08/08/2005

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system time Displays or modifies the switch’s current system time.


system timezone Displays or modifies the time zone for the switch.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesDate

page 31-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system time
Displays or modifies the switch’s current system time.
system time [hh:mm:ss]

Syntax Definitions
hh:mm:ss The new time being specified for the system. To set this value, enter the
current time in 24-hour format, where hh is the hour, mm is the minutes,
and ss is the seconds. For example, 14:30:00.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you do not specify a new system time in the command line, the current system time will be displayed.

Examples
-> system time 14:30:00
-> system time
15:48:08

Release History
Release 6.6.16.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system date Displays or modifies the switch’s current system date.


system timezone Displays or modifies the time zone for the switch.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesTime

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-7


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system time-and-date synchro


Synchronizes the time and date settings between primary and secondary CMMs.
system time-and-date synchro

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The system time-and-date synchro command applies only to switches with redundant CMM
configurations.
• Synchronizing date and time settings is an important step in providing effective CMM failover for
switches in redundant configurations. Be sure to periodically synchronize the primary and secondary
CMMs using this command.
• For detailed redundancy information refer to “Managing Stacks” in addition to “Managing CMM
Directory Content” in the OmniSwitch Switch Management Guide.

Examples
-> system time-and-date synchro

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

copy flash-synchro Copies the certified directory version of the primary CMM software to
the certified directory of the secondary CMM.

MIB Objects
systemServices

page 31-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system timezone
Displays or modifies the time zone for the switch.
system timezone [timezone_abbrev | offset_value | time_notation]

Syntax Definitions
timezone_abbrev Specifies a time zone for the switch and sets the system clock to run on
UTC. Refer to the table below for a list of supported time zone abbrevi-
ations. If you specify a time zone abbreviation, the hours offset from
UTC will be automatically calculated by the switch.
offset_value Specifies the number of hours offset from UTC. Values may range from
-13 through +12. The switch automatically enables UTC. However, if
you do not want your system clock to run on UTC, simply enter the
offset +0 for the system time zone. This sets UTC to run on local time.
time_notation Specifies a non-integer time-notation offset for areas that are offset from
UTC by increments of 15, 30, or 45 minutes (e.g., 05:30).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To display the current time zone for the switch, enter the syntax system timezone.

• When Daylight Saving Time (DST)—also referred to as summertime—is enabled, the clock automati-
cally sets up default DST parameters for the local time zone.
• Refer to the table below for a list of supported time zone abbreviations.

Abbreviation Name Hours from DST Start DST End DST Change
UTC
nzst New Zealand +12:00 1st Sunday in Oct. at 3rd Sunday in Mar. 1:00
2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
zp11 No standard name +11:00 No default No default No default
aest Australia East +10:00 Last Sunday in Oct. Last Sunday in Mar. 1:00
at 2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
gst Guam +10:00 No default No default No default
acst Australia Central +09:30 Last Sunday in Oct. Last Sunday in Mar. 1:00
Time at 2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
jst Japan +09:00 No default No default No default
kst Korea +09:00 No default No default No default
awst Australia West +08:00 No default No default No default

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-9


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Abbreviation Name Hours from DST Start DST End DST Change
UTC
zp8 China; +08:00 No default No default No default
Manila, Philippines
zp7 Bangkok +07:00 No default No default No default
zp6 No standard name +06:00 No default No default No default
zp5 No standard name +05:00 No default No default No default
zp4 No standard name +04:00 No default No default No default
msk Moscow +03:00 Last Sunday in Mar. Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
at 2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
eet Eastern Europe +02:00 Last Sunday in Mar. Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
at 2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
cet Central Europe +01:00 Last Sunday in Mar. Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
at 2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
met Middle Europe +01:00 Last Sunday in Mar. Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
at 2:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
bst British Standard +00:00 Last Sunday in Mar. Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
Time at 1:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
wet Western Europe +00:00 Last Sunday in Mar. Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
at 1:00 a.m. at 3:00 a.m.
gmt Greenwich Mean +00:00 No default No default No default
Time
wat West Africa -01:00 No default No default No default
zm2 No standard name -02:00 No default No default No default
zm3 No standard name -03:00 No default No default No default
nst Newfoundland -03:30 1st Sunday in Apr. at Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
2:00 a.m. at 2:00 a.m.
ast Atlantic Standard -04:00 1st Sunday in Apr. at Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
Time 2:00 a.m. at 2:00 a.m.
est Eastern Standard -05:00 1st Sunday in Apr. at Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
Time 2:00 a.m. at 2:00 a.m.
cst Central Standard -06:00 1st Sunday in Apr. at Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
Time 2:00 a.m. at 2:00 a.m.
mst Mountain Standard -07:00 1st Sunday in Apr. at Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
Time 2:00 a.m. at 2:00 a.m.
pst Pacific Standard -08:00 2nd Sunday in Mar. 1st Sunday in Nov. at 1:00
Time at 2:00 a.m. 2:00 a.m.
akst Alaska -09:00 1st Sunday in Apr. at Last Sunday in Oct. 1:00
2:00 a.m. at 2:00 a.m.
hst Hawaii -10:00 No default No default No default
zm11 No standard name -11:00 No default No default No default

page 31-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Examples
-> system timezone mst
-> system timezone -7
-> system timezone +0
-> system timezone +12
-> system timezone 12
-> system timezone 05:30
-> system timezone 00:00 hour from UTC

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system date Displays or modifies the switch’s current system date.


system time Displays or modifies the switch’s current system time.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesTimezone
systemServicesTimezoneStartWeek
systemServicesTimezoneStartDay
systemServicesTimezoneStartMonth
systemServicesTimezoneStartTime
systemServicesTimezoneOffset
systemServicesTimezoneEndWeek
systemServicesTimezoneEndDay
systemServicesTimezoneEndMonth
systemServicesTimezoneEndTime
systemServicesEnableDST

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-11


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

system daylight savings time


Enables or disabled Daylight Savings Time (DST) on the switch.
system daylight savings time [{enable | disable} | start {week} {day} in {month} at {hh:mm} end {week}
{day} in {month} at {hh:mm} [by min]]

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables DST. The switch clock will automatically adjust for DST as
specified by one of the default time zone or by the specifications set
with the system daylight savings time start command.
disable Disables DST. The switch clock will not change for DST.
start For non-default time zone, you can specify the week, day, month, and
hour for DST to start. (You must also specify the week, day, month, and
hour for DST to end.)
end For non-default time zone, if you specify the week, day, month, and
hour for DST to end, you must also specify the week, day, month, and
hour for DST to end.
week Indicate whether first, second, third, fourth, or last.
day Indicate whether Sunday, Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday,
Friday, or Saturday.
month Indicate whether January, February, March, April, May, June, July,
August, September, October, November, or December.
hh:mm Use two digits between 00 and 23 to indicate hour. Use two digits
between 00 and 59 to indicate minutes. Use as for a 24 hour clock.
by min Use two digits to indicate the number of minutes your switch clock will
be offset for DST. The range is from 00 to 50.

Defaults
• By default, DST is disabled.

• Unless a different value is set with the by syntax, the system clock will offset one hour for DST.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If your timezone shows a default value in the DST Start and DST End columns of the “Time Zone and
DST Information Table” found in Chapter 2, “Managing System Files,” of the OmniSwitch Switch
Management Guide, you do not need to set a start and end time. Your switch clock will automatically
adjust for DST as shown in the table.

page 31-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

• You must enable DST whether you use a default DST timezone or if you specify your offset using the
daylight savings time start syntax.

Examples
-> system daylight savings time enable
-> system daylight savings time disable
-> system daylight savings time start first Sunday in May at 23:00 end last Sunday
in November at 10:00
-> system daylight savings time start first Sunday in May at 23:00 end last Sunday
in November at 10:00 by 45

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system time Displays or modifies the switch’s current system time.


system timezone Displays or modifies the timezone for the switch.
system date Displays or modifies the switch’s current system date.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesTimezone
systemServicesEnableDST

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-13


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

update
Updates the versions of Uboot, FPGA, BootROM, or Miniboot. Refer to the Release Notes and/or any
available Upgrade Instructions for the new release before performing this type of update on the switch.
update {uboot {cmm | ni {all | slot}} uboot-miniboot | fpga cmm | bootrom {all | slot} | [default |
backup] miniboot [all | slot] }

Syntax Definitions
uboot Updates the uboot version.
ni Specifies that the update is performed for the Network Interface (NI)
Module.
all Specifies that the update is performed for all slots within a chassis or all
switches within a stack.
slot Specifies the number of the NI module within a chassis or the switch
number within a stack for which the update is performed.
uboot-miniboot Updates the uboot and the miniboot version on all available slots on all
available switches within a stack.
miniboot Updates the miniboot version.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

page 31-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Usage Guidelines
• Note that when performing an update, it is important that the correct update file is used and that the file
is located in the /flash directory on the switch. Specifying the wrong file may impact the operation of
the switch.
• A different update file is required depending on the type of switch and the type of update. The follow-
ing table provides a list of the required update files:

OmniSwitch Update Type Update File


6450 N/A N/A

Examples
OS6450-> update uboot 2
OS6450-> update uboot-miniboot
OS6450-> update fpga cmm
OS6450-> update miniboot 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload all Reloads all the NIs and CMMs in a chassis.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-15


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

update lanpower
Uploads new firmware to the POE controller. Please contact your Alcatel-Lucent support representative
before using this command.
update lanpower {lanpower_num | all}

Syntax Definitions
lanpower_num The POE unit number to update.
all Updates all POE units in the switch.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> update lanpower 3
-> update lanpower all

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

update Updates the versions of Uboot, FPGA, BootROM, or Miniboot.

page 31-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

reload ni
Reloads (i.e., reboots) a specified Network Interface (NI) module.
reload ni [slot] number

Syntax Definitions
slot Optional command syntax.
number Slot (i.e., switch) number within a stack that represents the NI module
to be reloaded.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The reload ni command reboots only the specified switch. However, if you use this command on a
switch that has a primary CMM role in a stack, it will no longer be primary. Instead, it will be second-
ary in a two-switch stack and idle in a stack consisting of three or more switches.

Examples
-> reload ni slot 2
-> reload ni 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload all Reloads all the NIs and CMMs in a chassis.


power ni Turns the power on or off for a specified Network Interface (NI)
module.
show ni Shows the hardware information and the current status for Network
Interface (NI) modules currently running in the chassis.

MIB Objects
chasEntPhysicalTable
chasEntPhysAdminStatus
reset

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-17


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

reload all
Reloads (i.e., reboots) all Network Interfaces (NIs) and Chassis Management Module (CMMs).
reload all [in [hours:] minutes | at hour:minute [month day | day month]]
reload all cancel

Syntax Definitions
in [hours:] minutes Optional syntax. Schedules a reload of all modules to take effect in the
specified minutes or hours and minutes within the next 24 hours.
at hour:minute Optional syntax. Schedules a reload of all modules to take place at the
specified time using a 24-hour clock. If you do not specify the month
and day, the reload takes place at the specified time on the current day
provided the specified time is later than the time when the CLI
command is issues. If the specified time is earlier than the current time,
the reload will take place on the following day.
month day | day month The name of the month and the number of the day for the scheduled
reload. Specify a month name and the day number. It is unimportant if
the month or day is first. See examples below for further explanation.
cancel Cancels a pending time delayed reload.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> reload all

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 31-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

reload ni Reloads a specific NI module.


power ni Turns the power on or off for a specified Network Interface (NI)
module.
show ni Shows the hardware information and current status for Network Inter-
face (NI) modules currently running in the chassis.

MIB Objects
chasEntPhysicalTable
chasEntPhysAdminStatus
reset

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-19


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

reload pass-through
Reloads (i.e., reboots) a switch in a stacked configuration that has been forced into the pass-through mode.
The pass-through mode is a state in which a switch has been assigned a slot number that is not available in
the current stacked configuration. When a switch is in the pass-through mode, its Ethernet ports are
brought down (i.e, they cannot pass traffic). However, its stacking ports are fully functional and can pass
traffic through to other switches in the stack; in this way, pass-through mode provides a mechanism to
prevent the stack ring from being broken.

Note. If a switch is forced into the pass-through mode, the rest of the virtual chassis (i.e., stack) will not be
disrupted. Any elements in the stack not operating in pass-through mode continue to operate normally.

reload pass-through slot-number

Syntax Definitions
slot-number The virtual chassis slot number of the switch currently in the pass-
through mode (1001–1008). For more information on pass-through slot
numbering, refer to the “Usage Guidelines” section below.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Switches in the pass-through mode are given distinct slot numbers. These slot numbers are not related
to their position in the stack. Instead, they are assigned the prefix “100,” followed by the numerical
order in which they were forced into pass-through. In other words, if only one switch in a stack is
forced into the pass-through mode, it is given the slot number 1001. If multiple switches in a stack are
forced into pass-through, the first switch in pass-through is given the slot number 1001, the second
switch is given the slot number 1002, the third switch is given the slot number 1003, etc.
• Before issuing the reload pass-through command, be sure that the corresponding switch has been
given a unique saved slot number. The saved slot number is the slot number the switch will assume
after it has been rebooted. If the saved slot number is not unique, the switch will simply return to pass-
through mode. To view the current and saved slot numbers for all switches in a stack, use the show
stack topology command. To assign a unique saved slot number to a switch before rebooting, use the
stack set slot command.

Examples
-> reload pass-through 1001

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 31-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

show stack topology Displays the current operating topology of switches within a stack.
stack set slot Assigns a new saved slot number to a switch in a stacked configuration.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrChassisTable
alaStackMgrSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrCommandAction
reloadPassThru

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-21


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

power ni
Turns the power on or off for a specified Network Interface (NI) module.
power ni [slot] slot-number
no power ni [slot] slot-number

Syntax Definitions
slot Optional command syntax.
slot-number The chassis slot number containing the NI module being powered
on or off.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to power off the corresponding switch in a stacked configuration.

Examples
-> power ni slot 1
-> power ni 7

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

reload ni Reloads (i.e., reboots) a specified Network Interface (NI) module.


show ni Shows the hardware information and current status for Network Inter-
face (NI) modules currently running in the chassis.

MIB Objects
chasEntPhysicalTable
chasEntPhysAdminStatus
powerOn
powerOff

page 31-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

temp-threshold
Sets the CPU warning temperature threshold for the switch.
temp-threshold temp slot slot-number

Syntax Definitions
temp The new temperature threshold value, in Celsius.
slot-number The chassis slot number for which the CPU warning temperature thresh-
old is set.

Defaults

parameter default
temp 76

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the show temperature command to display the current value for the temerpature warning threshold.
Do not use the show health threshold command as it does not display temperature threshold information.

Examples
-> temp-threshold 45
-> temp-threshold 55 slot 2

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show temperature Displays the current operating chassis ambient temperature, as well as cur-
rent temperature threshold settings.

MIB Objects
chasChassisTable
chasTempThreshold

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-23


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

stack set slot


Sets the saved slot number for a switch in a stacked configuration. The saved slot number is the slot posi-
tion the switch will assume following a reboot. The stack set slot command also provides syntax for
immediately rebooting the corresponding switch.
stack set slot slot-number saved-slot saved-slot-number [reload]

Syntax Definitions
slot-number The current slot position used by the switch (1–8; 1001–1008). Note that
the valid slot number range also includes slot positions 1001 through
1008, reserved for switches in pass-through mode.
saved-slot-number The new (i.e., saved) slot number (1–8). The saved slot number is the
slot position the switch will assume following a reboot.
reload Optional command syntax. When reload is entered in the command
line, a confirmation prompt is issued. If the user approves the reload, the
corresponding switch will be rebooted immediately and the new
(i.e., saved) slot number will take effect when the switch comes back
up—barring any pass-though mode conditions, such as duplicate slot
numbers.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the stack set slot command is issued, the new saved slot value is written to the boot.slot.cfg file.
This file is located in the switch’s /flash directory and is used when assigning a slot number for the
switch during the boot process.
• In order to avoid duplicate slot numbers within the virtual chassis—which can force one or more
switches into pass-though mode—be sure that the saved slot number being configured is not already
being used by another switch in the stack. To view the saved slot numbers currently assigned, use the
show stack topology command. For detailed information on assigning saved slot numbers, as well as
information on pass-through mode, refer to the Hardware Users Guide.

Examples
-> stack set slot 2 saved-slot 3
-> stack set slot 1001 saved-slot 4 reload

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 31-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

stack clear slot Clears the current saved slot information for a switch within a stacked
configuration.
show stack topology Displays the current operating topology of switches within a stack.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrChassisTable
alaStackMgrSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrSavedSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrCommandAction
alaStackMgrCommandStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-25


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

stack set slot mode


Sets the switch to either stackable or standalone mode. The stack set slot mode command also provides
syntax for immediately rebooting the corresponding switch.
stack set slot slot-number mode {stackable | standalone} [reload]

Syntax Definitions
slot-number The current slot position used by the switch (1–8; 1001–1008). Note that
the valid slot number range also includes slot positions 1001 through
1008, reserved for switches in pass-through mode.
stackable Sets the switch to stackable mode allowing the switch to be stacked into
a virtual chassis using the fixed fiber ports.
standalone Sets the switch to standalone mode allowing the fixed fiber ports to be
used as uplink ports.
reload Optional command syntax. When reload is entered in the command
line, a confirmation prompt is issued. If the user approves the reload, the
corresponding switch will be rebooted immediately and the new
mode will take effect when the switch comes back up.

Defaults

parameter default
mode Standalone

Platforms Supported
N/A

Usage Guidelines
• The switch must be rebooted for the new mode to take affect.

Examples
-> stack set slot 2 mode stackable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 31-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

show stack mode Displays the current mode of the switches.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrChassisTable
alaStackMgrSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrCommandAction
alaStackMgrCommandStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-27


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

stack clear slot


Clears the current saved slot information for a switch within a stacked configuration. When the saved slot
information has been cleared via the stack clear slot command, the corresponding switch will automati-
cally be assigned a unique slot number following a reboot. The command also provides optional syntax for
immediately forcing the corresponding switch into pass-though mode.
stack clear slot slot-number [immediate]

Syntax Definitions
slot-number The current slot position used by the switch (1–8; 1001–1008). Note that
the valid slot number range also includes slot positions 1001 through
1008, reserved for switches in pass-through mode.
immediate Optional command syntax. When immediate is entered in the command
line, the corresponding switch is essentially manually forced into pass-
through mode at the time the command is entered. All traffic on the
switch’s Ethernet ports is stopped. Unprocessed traffic (if applicable)
will continue to be passed through the stacking cables to other switches
in the stack. A limited number of management commands on the switch
are also supported.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the stack clear slot command is issued, the boot.slot.cfg file is immediately removed from the
switch’s /flash directory. As a result, no slot assignment information will be found the next time the
switch is booted. Because the switch’s slot will be considered undefined during the boot process, the
switch is automatically assigned a unique slot number.
• Primary and secondary management modules cannot be forced into pass-through mode using the
stack clear slot command. If the user attempts to force the secondary management module into pass-
through, the secondary switch will reboot and assume idle status when it comes back up. Meanwhile,
an idle switch within the stack is selected and rebooted; when it comes up it assumes the secondary
role.

Examples
-> stack clear slot 1002
-> stack clear slot 3 immediate

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 31-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

stack set slot Sets the saved slot number for a switch in a stacked configuration.
show stack topology Displays the current operating topology of switches within a stack.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrChassisTable
alaStackMgrSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrSavedSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrCommandAction
alaStackMgrCommandStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-29


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show system
Displays basic system information for the switch. Information includes a user-defined system description,
name, administrative contact, and location, as well as object ID, up time, and system services.
show system

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show system
System:
Description: Alcatel-Lucent OS6450-24 6.6.2.63.R02 February 21, 2010.,
Object ID: 1.3.6.1.4.1.6486.800.1.1.2.1.6.1.2,
Up Time: 0 days 5 hours 20 minutes and 49 seconds,
Contact: Alcatel-Lucent, www.alcatel-lucent.com/enterprise/en,
Name: OmniSwitch 6450,
Location: NMS_LABORATORY,
Services: 72,
Date & Time: FRI FEB 24 2010 16:21:30 (PST)

Flash Space:
Primary CMM:
Available (bytes): 31266816,
Comments : None

output definitions
System Description The description for the current system. This description shows the
current software version and the system date.
System Object ID The SNMP object identifier for the switch.
System Up Time The amount of time the switch has been running since the last system
reboot.
System Contact An user-defined administrative contact for the switch. This field is
modified using the system contact command.
System Name A user-defined text description for the switch. This field is modified
using the system name command.

page 31-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


System Location The user-defined physical location of the switch. This field is modified
using the system location command.
System Services The number of current system services.
System Date & Time The current system date and time. This field is modified using the
system date and system time commands.
Flash Space: Primary CMM: The available flash memory space available on the switch’s primary
Available (bytes) management module.
Flash Space: Primary CMM: Comments regarding the available flash memory space available on the
Comments switch’s primary management module, if applicable.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

system contact Specifies the switch’s administrative contact (e.g., an individual or a


department).
system name Modifies the switch’s current system name.
system location Specifies the switch’s current physical location.

MIB Objects
system
systemContact
systemName
systemLocation

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-31


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show hardware info


Displays the current system hardware information. Includes CPU, flash, RAM, NVRAM battery, jumper
positions, BootROM, and miniboot and FPGA information.
show hardware info

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines

This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either as the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show hardware info
CPU Type : PowerPC 8245,
Flash Manufacturer : TOSHIBA,
Flash size : 67108864 bytes (64 MB),
RAM Manufacturer : (null),
RAM size : 268435456 bytes (256 MB),
NVRAM Battery OK ? : YES,
BootROM Version : 6.1.2.20.R02 ,
Backup Miniboot Version : 6.1.2.20.R02,
Default Miniboot Version : 6.1.2.20.R02,
Product ID Register : 54
Hardware Revision Register : 00
CPLD Revision Register : 06
XFP Module ID : 02

output definitions
CPU Type The manufacturer and model number of the CPU used on the CMM.
Flash Manufacturer The manufacturer of the flash memory used on the CMM.
Flash size The total amount of flash memory (i.e., file space) on the CMM. This
field specifies the total flash memory size only and does not indicate
the amount of memory free or memory used.
RAM Manufacturer The manufacturer of the RAM memory used on the CMM.
RAM size The total amount of RAM memory on the CMM. This field specifies
the total RAM memory only and does not indicate the amount of mem-
ory free or memory used.

page 31-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


NVRAM Battery OK The current status of the NVRAM battery. If the battery is OK, YES is
displayed in this field. If the battery charge becomes low, NO is dis-
played in this field.
BootROM Version The current BootROM version.
Backup Miniboot Version The current backup miniboot version.
Default Miniboot Version The current default miniboot version.
Product ID Register The register number of the product ID.
Hardware Revision Register The register number of the hardware revision.
CPLD Revision Register The register number of the CPLD revision.
XFP Module ID The ID number of the XFP module.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show chassis Displays the basic configuration and status information for the switch
chassis.
show cmm Displays the basic hardware and status information for CMM modules
running in the chassis.

MIB Objects
systemHardware
systemHardwareBootCpuType
systemHardwareFlashMfg
systemHardwareFlashSize
systemHardwareMemoryMfg
systemHardwareMemorySize
systemHardwareNVRAMBatteryLow
systemHardwareJumperInterruptBoot
systemHardwareJumperForceUartDefaults
systemHardwareJumperRunExtendedMemoryDiagnostics
systemHardwareJumperSpare
systemHardwareBootRomVersion
systemHardwareBackupMiniBootVersion
systemHardwareDefaultMiniBootVersion
systemHardwareFpgaVersionTable
systemHardwareFpgaVersionEntry
systemHardwareFpgaVersionIndex

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-33


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show chassis
Displays the basic configuration and status information for the switch chassis.
show chassis [number]

Syntax Definitions
number Specifies the slot (i.e., switch) number within a stack of switches. The
valid range of slot numbers is 1–8, depending on the size of the stack.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command may be used when logged into either the primary or secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show chassis

Chassis 1
Model Name: OS6450-10,
Description: 10/100/1000,
Part Number: 902274-10,
Hardware Revision: 002,
Serial Number: E23L9052,
Manufacture Date: JUN 09 2004,
Admin Status: POWER ON,
Operational Status: UP,
Number Of Resets: 115
MAC Address e8:e7:32:01:01:01

Chassis 2
Model Name: OS6450-10,
Description: 10/100/1000,
Part Number: 902274-10,
Hardware Revision: 004,
Serial Number: 432L0008,
Manufacture Date: SEP 08 2004,
Admin Status: POWER ON,
Operational Status: UP,
Number Of Resets: 115
MAC Address e8:e7:32:01:0b:0a

page 31-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Model Name The factory-set model name for the switch. This field cannot be modi-
fied.
Description The factory-set description for the switch. This field cannot be modi-
fied.
Part Number The Alcatel-Lucent part number for the chassis.
Hardware Revision The hardware revision level for the chassis.
Serial Number The Alcatel-Lucent serial number for the chassis.
Manufacture Date The date the chassis was manufactured.
Admin Status The current power status of the chassis. Because chassis information is
obtained from a running CMM, the value will always be POWER ON.
Operational Status The current operational status of the chassis.
Number of Resets The number of times the CMM has been reset (i.e., reloaded or reboo-
ted) since the last cold boot of the switch.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show hardware info Displays the current system hardware information.


show power Displays the hardware information and current status for chassis power
supplies.
show fan Displays the current operating status of chassis fans.

MIB Objects
chasChassisTable
chasFreeSlots
chasPowerLeft

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-35


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show cmm
Displays basic hardware and status information for the CMM modules in a standalone switch or the
switches that perform the CMM role running in a stack.
show cmm [number]

Syntax Definitions
number Specifies the CMM slot number within a standalone switch or the CMM
switch number within a stack switches.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a switch, which performs a secondary CMM role in a stack, the hardware and status information for
both the switches that perform the primary and secondary CMM role will be displayed.
• This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show cmm
CMM in slot 1
Model Name: OS6450-10,
Description: 10/100/1000,
Part Number: 902271-10,
Hardware Revision: 002,
Serial Number: E23L9059,
Manufacture Date: JUN 08 2004,
Firmware Version: N/A,
Admin Status: POWER ON,
Operational Status: UP,
Power Consumption: 0,
Power Control Checksum: 0x0,
MAC Address: 00:d0:95:a3:e5:09,

output definitions
Model Name The model name of the switch.
Description A factory-defined description of the associated board (e.g., BBUS
Bridge or PROCESSOR).
Part Number The Alcatel-Lucent part number for the board.
Hardware Revision The hardware revision level for the board.
Serial Number The Alcatel-Lucent serial number for the board.

page 31-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


Manufacture Date The date the board was manufactured.
Firmware Version The firmware version for the board’s ASICs.
Admin Status The current power status of the CMM. Because information is obtained
from a running CMM, the value will always be POWER ON.
Operational Status The current operational status of the CMM.
Power Consumption The current power consumption for the CMM.
Power Control Checksum The current power control checksum for the corresponding CMM.
MAC Address The MAC address assigned to the chassis. This base chassis MAC
address is a unique identifier for the switch and is stored on an
EEPROM card in the chassis. It is not tied to the CMM. Therefore, it
will not change if the CMM is replaced or becomes secondary. The
MAC address is used by the Chassis MAC Server (CMS) for allocation
to various applications. Refer to the “Managing MAC Addresses and
Ranges” chapter of the OmniSwitch Switch Management Guide for
more information.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show chassis Displays the basic configuration and status information for the switch
chassis.
show ni Displays the basic hardware and status information for Network Inter-
face (NI) modules currently installed in the switch.
show module Displays the basic information for either a specified module or all the
modules installed in the chassis.
show module long Displays the detailed information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.
show module status Displays the basic status information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.
show system Displays basic system information for the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-37


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show ni
Displays the basic hardware and status information for Network Interface (NI) modules currently installed
in a standalone switch or in a stack.
show ni [number]

Syntax Definitions
number The slot number for a specific NI module installed in a standalone chas-
sis or the switch number within a stack. If no slot number is specified,
information for all the NI modules is displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines

This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show ni 1
Module in slot 1
Model Name: 6450 10 PORT COPPER FE,
Description: 6450 10 PORT COPPER FE,
Part Number: 902734-90,
Hardware Revision: 03,
Serial Number: K2182393,
Manufacture Date: JUN 27 2009,
Firmware Version: ,
Admin Status: POWER ON,
Operational Status: UP,
Power Consumption: 43,
Power Control Checksum: 0x6b36,
CPU Model Type : ARM926 (Rev 1),
MAC Address: 00:e0:b1:c2:ee:89,
ASIC - Physical 1: MV88F6281 Rev 2,
FPGA - Physical 1: 0010/00,
UBOOT Version : n/a,
UBOOT-miniboot Version : 6.6.1.602.R01,
POE SW Version : n/a

page 31-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Model Name The NI’s module name. For example, OS9-GNI-C24 indicates a twenty
four-port 10/100/1000BaseT Ethernet module.
Description A general description of the NI. For example, 24pt 10/100/1000BaseT
Mod indicates a twenty four-port 10/100/1000BaseT Ethernet module.
Part Number The Alcatel-Lucent part number for the NI.
Hardware Revision The hardware revision level for the NI.
Serial Number The Alcatel-Lucent serial number for the NI’s printed circuit board
(PCB).
Manufacture Date The date the NI was manufactured.
Firmware Version The firmware version for the NI’s ASICs.
Admin Status The current power status of the NI. Options include POWER ON or
POWER OFF.
Operational Status The operational status of the NI. Options include UP or DOWN. The
operational status can be DOWN while the power status is on, indicat-
ing a possible software issue.
Power Consumption The current power consumption for the CMM.
Power Control Checksum The current power control checksum for the corresponding NI.
MAC Address The MAC address assigned to the NI.
ASIC - Physical General information regarding the NI module’s ASICs.
CPLD - Physical General information regarding the CPLD.
UBOOT Version UBOOT version of the NI.
UBOOT-miniboot Version UBOOT-miniboot version of the NI.
POE SW Version POE software version of the NI (POE modules only).
C20L Upgd FailCount The number of failed upgrade attempts (C20L modules that have
attempted to be upgraded only).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-39


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

reload ni Reloads (i.e., reboots) a specified Network Interface (NI) module.


power ni Turns the power on or off for a specified Network Interface (NI)
module.
show module Displays the basic information for either a specified module or all mod-
ules installed in the chassis.
show module long Displays the detailed information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.
show module status Displays the basic status information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.

MIB Objects
chasEntPhysOperStatus

page 31-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show module
Displays the basic information for either a specified module or all modules installed in a standalone switch
chassis or a stack. Modules include switches performing the primary and secondary CMM roles and
Network Interface (NI) in a stack.
show module [number]

Syntax Definitions
number The slot number for a specific module installed in a standalone switch
chassis or the switch number within a stack. If no slot number is speci-
fied, information for all modules is displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines

This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show module
HW Mfg
Slot Part-Number Serial # Rev Date Model Name
-------+--------------+------------+---+-----------+----------------------------
CMM-1 902271-10 E23L9059 002 JUN 08 2004 OS6450-10
NI-1 902271-10 E23L9059 002 JUN 08 2004 OS6450-10

output definitions
Slot The chassis slot position of the module. For detailed slot numbering
information, refer to the “Chassis and Power Supplies” chapter of the
Hardware User Manual. Refer to page 31-36 for additional information
on CMM location callouts.
Part-Number The Alcatel-Lucent part number for the module.
Serial # The Alcatel-Lucent serial number for the module.
Rev The hardware revision level for the module.
Date The date the module was manufactured.
Model Name The descriptive name for the module. For example, OS9-GNI-U24
indicates a twenty four-port Gigabit Ethernet module.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-41


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show module long Displays the detailed information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.
show module status Displays the basic status information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.

page 31-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show module long


Displays the detailed information for either a specified module or all the modules installed in a standalone
switch chassis or a stack. Modules include switches performing the primary and secondary CMM roles
and Network Interface (NI) in a stack.
show module long [number]

Syntax Definitions
number The slot number for a specific module installed in a standalone switch
chassis or the switch number within a stack. If no slot number is speci-
fied, detailed information for all the modules is displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When a particular NI module is specified in the command line, output is the same as that of the
show ni command.
• This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show module long
CMM in slot 1
Model Name: OS6450-10,
Description: 10/100/1000,
Part Number: 902271-10,
Hardware Revision: 002,
Serial Number: E23L9059,
Manufacture Date: JUN 08 2004,
Firmware Version: N/A,
Admin Status: POWER ON,
Operational Status: UP,
Power Consumption: 0,
Power Control Checksum: 0x0,
MAC Address: 00:d0:95:a3:e5:09,

Module in slot 1
Model Name: OS6450-10,
Description: 10/100/1000,
Part Number: 902271-10,
Hardware Revision: 002,
Serial Number: E23L9059,
Manufacture Date: JUN 08 2004,
Firmware Version: N/A,

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-43


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Admin Status: POWER ON,


Operational Status: UP,
Power Consumption: 200,
Power Control Checksum: 0x0,
MAC Address: 00:d0:95:a3:e5:0b,
ASIC - Physical 1 (hex): BCM5695_A1,
ASIC - Physical 2 (hex): BCM5695_A1,
ASIC - Physical 3 (hex): BCM5670_A1
CPLD - Physical 1 (hex): 0006/00

output definitions
Model Name The NI’s module name. For example, OS9-GNI-C24 indicates a twenty
four-port 10/100/1000BaseT Ethernet module.
Description A general description of the NI. For example, 24pt 10/100/1000BaseT
Mod indicates a twenty four-port 10/100/1000BaseT Ethernet module.
Part Number The Alcatel-Lucent part number for the NI.
Hardware Revision The hardware revision level for the NI.
Serial Number The Alcatel-Lucent serial number for the NI’s printed circuit board
(PCB).
Manufacture Date The date the NI was manufactured.
Firmware Version The firmware version for NI’s ASICs.
Admin Status The current power status of the NI. Options include POWER ON or
POWER OFF.
Operational Status The operational status of the NI. Options include UP or DOWN. The
operational status can be DOWN while the power status is on, indicat-
ing a possible software issue.
Power Control Checksum The current power control checksum for the corresponding NI.
MAC Address The MAC address assigned to the NI.
ASIC - Physical General information regarding the NI’s ASICs.
CPLD - Physical General information regarding the CPLD.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show module Displays the basic information for either a specified module or all mod-
ules installed in the chassis.
show module status Displays the basic status information for either a specified module or all
modules installed in the chassis.

page 31-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show module status


Displays the basic status information for either a specified module or all modules installed in a standalone
switch chassis or a stack. Modules include switches performing the primary and secondary CMM roles
and Network Interface (NI) in a stack.
show module status [number]

Syntax Definitions
number The slot number for a specific module installed in a standalone switch
chassis or the switch number within a stack. If no slot number is speci-
fied, status information for all modules is displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines

This command may be used when logged into the switch that performs either as the primary or secondary
CMM role in a stack.

Examples
-> show module status
Operational Firmware
Slot Status Admin-Status Rev MAC
------+-------------+------------+---------+-----------------
CMM-1 UP POWER ON N/A 00:d0:95:a3:e5:09
NI-1 UP POWER ON N/A 00:d0:95:a3:e5:0b

output definitions
Slot The chassis slot position of the module. For detailed slot numbering
information, refer to the “Chassis and Power Supplies” chapter of the
Hardware User Guide. Refer to page 31-36 for additional information
on CMM callouts.
Operational Status The operational status of the module. Options include UP or DOWN.
For NI and secondary CMM modules, the operational status can be
DOWN while the power status is on, indicating a possible software
issue.
Admin-Status The current power status of the module. Options include POWER ON
or POWER OFF.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-45


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


Firmware Rev The firmware version for module’s ASICs.
MAC For the CMM, the base chassis MAC address is displayed. For detailed
information on this base chassis MAC address, refer to the “Managing
MAC Addresses and Ranges” chapter of the OmniSwitch Switch Man-
agement Guide. For NI modules, the MAC address for the correspond-
ing NI is displayed.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show module Displays the basic information for either a specified module or all the
modules installed in the chassis.
show module long Displays the detailed information for either a specified module or all the
modules installed in the chassis.

page 31-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show power
Displays the hardware information and current status for chassis power supplies.
show power [supply] [number]

Syntax Definitions
supply Optional command syntax.
number The single-digit number for a specific power supply installed in the
chassis. If no power supply number is specified, information for all
power supplies is displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When the show power command is entered on stackable switches, information is displayed only for
power supplies that are installed in the chassis and powered on. If a power supply is present in a power
supply bay, but the power supply is unplugged or its on/off switch is in the off position, the power supply
is not listed in the command output.

Examples
-> show power
Slot PS Wattage Type Status Location
----+----+---------+------+-----------+----------
1 600 AC UP Internal
2 600 AC UP Internal
3 -- -- -- --
4 600 IP UP External
5 600 IP UP External
6 600 IP UP External
7 600 IP UP External

-> show power 5


Module in slot PS-5
(Power Shelf slot 5)
Model Name: OS-IPS-600A,
Description: ILPS AC,
Part Number: 902252-10,
Hardware Revision: A01,
Serial Number: E51P4078,
Manufacture Date: JAN 07 2005,
Operational Status: UP,
Power Provision: 600

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-47


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Model Name The power supply’s model number.
Description A description of the associated power supply. This field will reflect the
model name in most cases.
Part Number The Alcatel-Lucent part number for the power supply.
Hardware Revision The hardware revision level for the power supply.
Serial Number The Alcatel-Lucent serial number for the power supply.
Manufacture Date The date the power supply was manufactured.
Type The type of power supply. Options include AC or IP.
Location The location of the power supply. Options include Internal or External.
Operational Status The operational status of the power supply. Options include UP or
DOWN.
Power Provision The number of Watts used by this power supply.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show chassis Displays the basic configuration and status information for the switch
chassis.

page 31-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show fan
Displays the current operating status of chassis fans.
show fan [number]

Syntax Definitions
number Specifies the switch (slot) number of the chassis.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This parameter specifies the switch (slot) number of the chassis. If no switch number is specified, then all
the switches in a stack will be displayed.

Examples
-> show fan
Chassis Fan Status
-------+---+-----------
1 1 Running
1 2 Running
1 3 Running
1 4 Not Running
1 5 Not Running
1 6 Not Running
2 1 Running
2 2 Running
2 3 Running
2 4 Not Running
2 5 Not Running
2 6 Not Running
3 1 Running
3 2 Running
3 3 Running
3 4 Not Running
3 5 Not Running
3 6 Not Running

output definitions
Chassis The number of the switch in a stack.
Fan The fan number describing the fan position.
Status The current operational status of the corresponding fan.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-49


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show temperature Displays the current operating chassis ambient temperature, as well as
current temperature threshold settings.

page 31-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show temperature
Displays the current operating chassis ambient temperature, as well as current temperature threshold
settings.
show temperature [number]

Syntax Definitions
number Specifies the slot (i.e., switch) number within the stack. The valid range
of slot numbers is 1–8, depending on the size of the stack.

Defaults
If a slot number is not specified with this command, temperature information for all switches operating in
the stack is displayed by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The number parameter is not an option when using this command on a standalone switch.

Examples
-> show temperature

Temperature for chassis 1


Hardware Board Temperature (deg C) = 41,
Hardware Cpu Temperature (deg C) = N/A,
Temperature Upper Threshold Range (deg C) = 15 to 80,
Temperature Upper Threshold (deg C) = 57,
Temperature Status = UNDER THRESHOLD,
Temperature Danger Threshold (deg C) = 80

Temperature for chassis 2


Hardware Board Temperature (deg C) = 40,
Hardware Cpu Temperature (deg C) = N/A,
Temperature Upper Threshold Range (deg C) = 15 to 80,
Temperature Upper Threshold (deg C) = 57,
Temperature Status = UNDER THRESHOLD,
Temperature Danger Threshold (deg C) = 80

Temperature for chassis 3


Hardware Board Temperature (deg C) = 40,
Hardware Cpu Temperature (deg C) = N/A,
Temperature Upper Threshold Range (deg C) = 15 to 80,
Temperature Upper Threshold (deg C) = 57,
Temperature Status = UNDER THRESHOLD,
Temperature Danger Threshold (deg C) = 80

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-51


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions
Hardware Board The current chassis temperature as determined by the built-in tempera-
Temperature ture sensor. The temperature is displayed in degrees Centigrade (i.e.,
Celsius). This temperature is checked against the upper threshold value.
If the threshold is exceeded, a warning is sent to the user.
Hardware Cpu Temperature The current CPU temperature. The temperature is displayed in degrees
Centigrade (i.e., Celsius).
Temperature Upper The supported threshold range. When you specify a threshold for the
Threshold Range switch via the temp-threshold command, values may range from
31–94.
Temperature Upper The warning temperature threshold, in degrees Celsius. If the switch
Threshold reaches or exceeds this temperature, the primary switch or CMM’s
TEMP LED displays amber and a warning is sent to the user. Values
may range from 15–94. The default value is 60. For information on
changing the upper threshold value, refer to the temp-threshold com-
mand on page 31-23.
Temperature Range The current threshold status of the switch. Displays whether the switch
is UNDER THRESHOLD or OVER THRESHOLD. If the status is
OVER THRESHOLD, the primary CMM’s TEMP LED displays
amber and a warning is sent to the user.
Temperature Danger The factory-defined danger threshold. This field is not configurable. If
Threshold the chassis temperature rises above 80 degrees Centigrade, the switch
will power off all Network Interface (NI) modules until the temperature
conditions (e.g., chassis air flow obstruction or ambient room tempera-
ture) have been addressed and the switch is manually booted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

temp-threshold Sets the chassis warning temperature threshold.


show fan Shows the hardware information and current status for the chassis fans.

MIB Objects
chasChassisTable
chasHardwareBoardTemp
chasHardwareCpuTemp
chasTempRange
chasTempThreshold
chasDangerTempThreshold

page 31-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show stack topology


Displays the current operating topology of switches within a stack.
show stack topology [slot-number]

Syntax Definitions
slot-number Optional syntax specifying a single slot number within the stack (1–8).
When a slot number is specified, topology information for only the
corresponding slot displays.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show stack topology
Link A Link A Link B Link B
NI Role State
Saved Link A Remote Remote Link B Remote Remote
Slot State NI Port State NI Port
----+-----------+--------+------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------
1 PRIMARY RUNNING 1 UP 3 StackB UP 2 StackA
2 IDLE RUNNING 2 UP 1 StackB UP 3 StackA
3 SECONDARY RUNNING 3 UP 2 StackB UP 1 StackA

output definitions
NI The current slot position for each switch in the virtual chassis (i.e.,
stacked configuration). Note that the order of the slot numbers does not
necessarily correspond with the physical positions of switches within
the stack. In other words, slot position 1 may not be the uppermost (top)
switch in the stack. To manually assign these slot numbers via the CLI,
use the stack set slot command.
Role The current management role of the corresponding switch within the
stack. Options include PRIMARY (the switch is the primary manage-
ment module in the stack; standalone switches also display this role),
SECONDARY (the switch is the secondary—or backup—management
module in the stack), IDLE (the switch does not have a management
role but is operating normally as a network interface module within the
stack), PASS-THRU (the switch is operating in pass-through mode),
UNDEFINED (the switch’s current role is not known).

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-53


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


State The current operational state of the corresponding switch. Options
include RUNNING (the switch is up and operating normally),
DUP-SLOT (the switch has a duplicate saved slot number and has auto-
matically entered pass-through mode), CLR-SLOT (the switch has
been manually “cleared” via the stack clear slot command and is now
in pass-through mode), OUT-SLOT (the current stacked configuration
already has eight switches and therefore cannot accommodate this
switch), OUT-TOK (there are not enough unused tokens remaining in
the current stacked configuration to accommodate this switch),
UNKNOWN (the switch’s current state is not known).
Saved Slot The designated saved slot number for the corresponding switch. The
saved slot number is the slot position the switch will assume following
a reboot. A value of zero (0) indicates that the switch has been
“cleared” and, as a result, is designated for pass-through mode. To
assign saved slot numbers, use the stack set slot command. To clear a
switch and designate it for pass-though mode, use the stack clear slot
command.
Link A State The current status of the stacking cable link at the switch’s stacking
port A. Options include UP, DOWN, or UNKNOWN.
Link A Remote NI The slot number of the switch to which stacking cable A’s remote end is
connected. In other words, if a switch in slot position 1 displays a
Link A Remote NI value of 3, this indicates that the stacking cable
plugged into slot 1 stacking port A is connected to the slot 3 switch. If
no stacking cable link exists, the value 0 displays.
Link A Remote Port The specific stacking port to which stacking cable A’s remote end is
connected. Options include StackA, StackB, and 0. If stacking cable A’s
remote end is connected to stacking port B on the other switch, the
value displays StackB. If no stacking cable link exists, the value 0
displays.
Link B State The current status of the stacking cable link at the switch’s stacking
port B. Options include UP, DOWN, or UNKNOWN.
Link B Remote NI The slot number of the switch to which stacking cable B’s remote end is
connected. In other words, if a switch in slot position 6 displays a
Link A Remote NI value of 7, this indicates that the stacking cable
plugged into slot 6 stacking port B is connected to the slot 7 switch.
Link B Remote Port The specific stacking port to which stacking cable B’s remote end is
connected. Options include StackA, StackB, and 0. If stacking cable
B’s remote end is connected to stacking port B on the other switch, the
value displays StackB. If no stacking cable link exists, the value 0
displays.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 31-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

Related Commands

show stack status Displays the current redundant stacking cable status and token availabil-
ity for a stacked configuration.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrChassisTable
alaStackMgrSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrSlotCMMNumber
alaStackMgrChasRole
alaStackMgrLocalLinkStateA
alaStackMgrRemoteNISlotA
alaStackMgrRemoteLinkA
alaStackMgrLocalLinkStateB
alaStackMgrRemoteNISlotB
alaStackMgrRemoteLinkB
alaStackMgrChasState
alaStackMgrSavedSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrCommandAction
alaStackMgrCommandStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-55


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show stack status


Displays the current redundant stacking cable status and token availability for a stacked configuration.
show stack status

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show stack status

Redundant cable status : present

output definitions
Redundant cable status Indicates whether a redundant stacking cable is currently installed.
Options include present and not present. To provide added resiliency
and redundancy, it is strongly recommended that a redundant stacking
cable is connected from the top switch in the stack to the bottom switch
in the stack at all times. For more information on stack redundancy,
refer to the “Managing OmniSwitch Series Stacks” chapter in the
Hardware Users Guide.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show stack topology Displays the current operating topology of switches within a stack.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrStackStatus
alaStackMgrTokensUsed
alaStackMgrTokensAvailable

page 31-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

show stack mode


Displays the current stacking or standalone mode of the switch.
show stack mode

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show stack mode
NI Role State Running Saved
Mode Mode
----+-----------+--------+----------+---------------
1 PRIMARY RUNNING stackable stackable
2 SECONDARY RUNNING stackable stackable

output definitions
NI The current slot position for each switch in the virtual chassis (i.e.,
stacked configuration). Note that the order of the slot numbers does not
necessarily correspond with the physical positions of switches within
the stack. In other words, slot position 1 may not be the uppermost (top)
switch in the stack. To manually assign these slot numbers via the CLI,
use the stack set slot command.
Role The current management role of the corresponding switch:
PRIMARY (the switch is the primary management module in the stack;
standalone switches also display this role)
SECONDARY (the switch is the secondary—or backup—management
module in the stack)

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 31-57


Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands

output definitions (continued)


State The current operational state of the switch:
UNKNOWN: the state of the element cannot be determined
RUNNING: element is up and running
DUP SLOT: this element has a duplicate slot number
CLR SLOT: the slot number of the element has been cleared via man-
agement command after the last reboot
OUT SLOT: the element cannot initialize because there are no slot Ids
left to be assigned
Running Mode The current mode of the switch.
Saved Mode The mode the switch will be in after a reboot. The output is based on
contents of "boot.slot.cfg" file.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

stack set slot mode Changes the stacking/standalone mode of the switch.

MIB Objects
alaStackMgrChassisTable
alaStackMgrSlotNINumber
alaStackMgrSlotCMMNumber
alaStackMgrChasRole
alaStackMgrChasState
alaStackMgrCommandAction
alaStackMgrCommandStatus

page 31-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


32 Chassis MAC Server (CMS)
Commands

The Chassis MAC Server (CMS) manages MAC addresses on the switch. The MAC addresses managed
via the CMS are used as identifiers for the following functions:
• Base chassis MAC address

• Ethernet Management Port (EMP)

• VLAN router ports

Similar to IP addresses, MAC addresses are assigned by the Internet Assigned Numbers Authority (IANA)
and distributed to users in sequential blocks. A sequential block of MAC addresses is referred to as a MAC
address range.
The MAC address range is stored on the switch’s EEPROM. The switch supports one MAC address range
only. By default, this MAC address range contains thirty-two (32) factory-installed, contiguous MAC
addresses. Users may add additional MAC addresses; the maximum capacity for the switch’s default range
is 256 MAC addresses.
In stackable switches, CMS is responsible for sharing the base MAC address of the primary switch with all
the other switches in the stack. This helps the secondary switch to retain the same MAC address during
takeover.This is called MAC Address Retention.
MIB information for the Chassis MAC Server commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1MacServer.MIB
Module: Alcatel-IND1-MAC-SERVER-MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

mac-range eeprom
mac-retention status
mac-retention dup-mac-trap
mac release
show mac-range
show mac-range alloc
show mac-retention status

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 32-1


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

mac-range eeprom
Modifies the default MAC range on the switch’s EEPROM.

Note. Use caution when modifying the default MAC range. Improper use of this command can disable
your system and adversely affect your network. Contact Alcatel-Lucent Customer Support for further
assistance.

mac-range eeprom start_mac_address count

Syntax Definitions
start_mac_address The first MAC address in the modified range. Enter the MAC address in
the following format: xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx, where x is a hex value (0–f).
count Specifies the number of MAC addresses in the range (1–256).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Because the factory-installed 32 MAC addresses are sufficient for most network configurations, this
command should only be used by qualified network administrators for special network requirements.
• After modifying a MAC address range by using the mac-range eeprom command, you must reboot
the switch. Otherwise, MAC addresses for existing VLAN router ports will not be allocated properly.
• All MAC addresses in a range must be contiguous (i.e., there cannot be any gaps in the sequence of
MAC addresses).

Examples
-> mac-range eeprom 00:20:da:23:45:35 32

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 32-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

Related Commands

show mac-range Displays the MAC range table.

MIB Objects
chasMacAddressRangeTable
chasMacRangeIndex
chasGlobalLocal
chasMacAddressStart
chasMacAddressCount

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 32-3


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

mac-retention status
Enables or disables the MAC retention status.
mac-retention status {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the administrative status of MAC retention.
disable Disables the administrative status of MAC retention.

Defaults

Parameter Status
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When MAC retention is enabled, the stack uses the MAC address of the primary switch even after it
has failed.
• When the administrative status of MAC retention is enabled, the stack performance is enhanced.

Examples
-> mac-retention status enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show mac-retention status Displays the MAC retention status.

MIB Objects
chasMacAddrRetentionObjects
chasMacAddrRetentionStatus

page 32-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

mac-retention dup-mac-trap
Enables or disables the duplicate MAC address trap status.
mac-retention dup-mac-trap {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the duplicate MAC address trap status.
disable Disables the duplicate MAC address trap status.

Defaults

Parameter Status
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If the old primary switch is not detected and included in the stack within a pre-defined time period, an
SNMP trap will be generated.

Examples
-> mac-retention dup-mac-trap enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show mac-retention status Displays the MAC retention status.

MIB Objects
chasMacAddrRetentionObjects
chasPossibleDuplicateMacTrapStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 32-5


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

mac release
Releases the MAC address currently being used as the primary base MAC address.
mac release

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The MAC address is released only if the address has not been derived from the EEPROM (i.e., it should be
a retained MAC address of the old primary switch).

Examples
-> mac release

Release History
Release 6.2.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.3.1; mac-retention keyword was replaced with the mac keyword.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
chasMacAddrRetentionObjects
chasMacAddrRetentionStatus

page 32-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

show mac-range
Displays the MAC range table.
show mac-range [index]

Syntax Definitions
index Identifies the MAC range by referring to its position in the MAC range
table.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Because the switch currently supports one MAC address range only, index position 1 displays.

Examples
-> show mac range

Mac Local/
Range Row Status Global Start Mac Addr End Mac Addr
-----+----------------+--------+------------------+------------------

01 ACTIVE GLOBAL 00:d0:95:6a:79:6e 00:d0:95:6a:79:8d

output definitions
Mac Range The MAC range index number (1). Because the switch currently sup-
ports one MAC address range only, index position 1 displays.
Row Status The current status of the MAC range. The status ACTIVE refers to
MAC addresses that are available for allocation to VLAN router ports
and other applications.
Local/Global The Local/Global status for MAC addresses in the range. Local MAC
addresses have the local bit set in the first byte of the address. Global
MAC addresses (also referred to as EEPROM MAC addresses) have
the global bit set in the first byte of the address and are stored on the
switch’s EEPROM. Because the switch’s default MAC range is stored
on EEPROM, the status GLOBAL displays.
Start Mac Addr The first MAC address in the MAC address range.
End Mac Addr The last MAC address in the MAC address range.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 32-7


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

Related Commands

mac-range eeprom Modifies the default MAC range on the switch’s EEPROM.

MIB Objects
chasMacAddressRangeTable
chasMacRangeIndex
chasGlobalLocal
chasMacAddressStart
chasMacAddressCount
chasMacRowStatus

page 32-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

show mac-range alloc


Displays all allocated addresses from the MAC range table.
show mac-range [index] alloc

Syntax Definitions
index Identifies the MAC range by referring to its position in the MAC range
table. Currently, index position 1 only is supported.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If you are assigning VLAN router ports while the switch is in single MAC router mode, all VLAN router
ports will use the base chassis MAC address (ID value 0).

Examples
-> show mac-range alloc
Range Mac Address Application Id
-----+-----------------+--------------------+---
01 00:d0:95:6b:09:40 CHASSIS 0
01 00:d0:95:6b:09:41 802.1X 0
01 00:d0:95:6b:09:5f CHASSIS 1

output definitions
Range The MAC range’s index number. The index number refers to the posi-
tion of the range in the MAC range table. Values may range from
1–20. MAC ranges are divided by index number into four distinct cate-
gories. Refer to page 32-7 for more information.
Mac Address Current MAC address allocated for a specific application.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 32-9


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

output definitions (continued)


Application The application for which the allocated MAC address is being used.
Current options include VLAN, 802.1X, and CHASSIS. VLAN refers
to MAC addresses allocated to VLAN router ports in multiple MAC
router mode. CHASSIS refers to MAC addresses used for the base
chassis MAC address and the Ethernet Management Port (EMP).
Id An ID number used to identify an allocated MAC address. ID numbers
are used for the base chassis MAC address and Ethernet Management
Port (EMP), as well as VLAN router ports. The ID value 0 is reserved
for the switch's base chassis MAC address. The ID value 1 is reserved
for the EMP MAC address. Router ports assigned to VLANs 2 through
4094 are given corresponding MAC IDs. For example, a router port
configured on VLAN 44 receives an allocated MAC ID of 44. Because
default VLAN 1 router ports use the base chassis MAC address by
default, any router port configured on VLAN 1 is assigned the ID
value 0.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

mac-range eeprom Modifies the default MAC range on the switch’s EEPROM.

MIB Objects
ChasMacAddressAllocTable
chasAppId
chasObjectId
chasAllocMacRangeIndex
chasAllocMacAddress

page 32-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

show mac-retention status


Displays the MAC retention status.
show mac-retention status

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the administrative status of MAC retention is not configured, it will be displayed as disabled by
default.
• If the administrative status of the duplicate MAC address trap is not configured, it will be displayed as
disabled by default.
• If the source of the currently used MAC address is not configured, it will be displayed as EEPROM by
default.

Examples
-> show mac-retention status
MAC RETENTION STATUS
==============================================================================
Admin State : Enabled
Trap admin state : Enabled
Current MAC address : 00:0a:0b:0c:0d:0e
MAC address source : Retained
Topology Status : Ring present

output definitions
Admin State Displays the administrative status of MAC retention (Enabled or Dis-
abled).
Trap admin state Displays the administrative status of the duplicate MAC address trap
(Enabled or Disabled).
Current MAC address Displays the MAC address currently used by the switch.
MAC address source Displays the source of the currently used MAC address. Options
include EEPROM and Retained.
Topology Status Displays the topology status of the stack. Options include Ring present
and Ring Not Present.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 32-11


Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands

Release History
Release 6.2.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.3.1; EEPROM MAC Address field was deleted.

Related Commands

mac-retention status Enables or disables the MAC retention status.


mac-retention dup-mac-trap Enables or disables the duplicate MAC address trap status.

MIB Objects
chasMacAddrRetentionObjects
chasMacAddrRetentionStatus
chasPossibleDuplicateMacTrapStatus
chasRingStatus
chasBaseMacAddrSource
chasBaseMacAddr

page 32-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


33 Network Time Protocol
Commands

The Network Time Protocol (NTP) is used to synchronize the time of a computer client or server to
another server or reference time source, such as a radio or satellite receiver. It provides client time accura-
cies within a millisecond on LANs, and up to a few tens of millisecond on WANs. Typical NTP configura-
tions utilize multiple redundant servers and diverse network paths in order to achieve high accuracy and
reliability.
It is important for networks to maintain accurate time synchronization between network nodes. The stan-
dard timescale used by most nations of the world is based on a combination of Universal Coordinated
Time (UTC) (representing the Earth’s rotation about its axis) and the Gregorian Calendar (representing the
Earth’s rotation about the Sun). UTC time is disseminated by various means, including radio and satellite
navigation systems, telephone modems, and portable clocks.
The MIB information for NTP is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1Ntp.mib
Module: alcatelIND1NTPMIB
A summary of available commands is listed here:
ntp server
ntp server synchronized
ntp server unsynchronized
ntp client
ntp broadcast
ntp broadcast-delay
ntp key
ntp key load
show ntp client
show ntp server status
show ntp client server-list
show ntp keys

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-1


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp server
Specifies an NTP server from which the switch will receive updates.
ntp server {ip_address | domain_name} [key key | version version | minpoll exponent | prefer]
no ntp server {ip_address | domain_name}

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address of the NTP server to be added or deleted to the client’s
server list.
domain_name The domain name of the NTP server to be added or deleted to the
client’s server list. This is usually a text string.
key The key identification number that corresponds to the specified NTP
server.
version The version of NTP being used. This will be 1, 2, 3, or 4.
exponent The number of seconds between polls to this server. This number is
determined by raising 2 to the power of the number entered. Therefore,
if 4 were entered, the minimum poll time would be 16 seconds (24 =
16).
prefer Marks this server as the preferred server. A preferred server’s times-
tamp will be used before another server.

Defaults

Parameter Default
version 4
exponent 6
prefer not preferred

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the specified server.

• To configure NTP in the client mode you must first define the NTP servers. Up to 3 NTP servers may
be defined.
• Either an IP address or domain name for the specified server can be entered.

• The NTP key identification is an integer. It corresponds to an MD5 authentication key contained in an
authentication file (.txt) located on the server. This file must be on both the server and the local switch,
and match, for authentication to work. Enter the key identification using the key keyword if the server
is set to MD5 authentication.

page 33-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

• Use the version keyword to set the correct version of NTP.

• Use the minpoll keyword to set the minimum poll time for the server. This number is determined by
raising 2 to the power of the number entered. Therefore, if 4 were entered, the minimum poll time
would be 16 seconds (24 = 16). The client will poll the server for a time update when the minpoll time
is exceeded.

Examples
-> ntp server 1.1.1.1
-> ntp server spartacus
-> ntp server 1.1.1.1 key 1
-> ntp server 1.1.1.1 version 4
-> ntp server spartacus minpoll 5
-> no ntp server 1.1.1.1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ntp client Enables or disables NTP operation on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaNtpConfig
alaNtpPeerAddressType
alaNtpPeerType
alaNtpPeerAuth
alaNtpPeerVersion
alaNtpPeerMinpoll
alaNtpPeerPrefer
alaNtpPeerAddress

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-3


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp server synchronized


Enables an NTP client to invoke tests for NTP server synchronization as specified by the NTP protocol.
ntp server synchronized

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, NTP synchronization is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The NTP protocol discards the NTP servers that are unsynchronized. However, the unsynchronized NTP
servers are used as network time sources.

Examples
-> ntp server synchronized

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ntp server unsynchronized Disables an NTP client from invoking tests for NTP server synchroniza-
tion. This allows the NTP client to synchronize with unsynchronized
NTP servers in the network.

MIB Objects
alaNtpConfig
alaNtpPeerTests

page 33-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp server unsynchronized


Disables an NTP client from invoking tests for NTP server synchronization. This allows the NTP client to
synchronize with unsynchronized NTP servers in the network.
ntp server unsynchronized

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When NTP peer synchronization tests are disabled, the NTP client is able to synchronize with either an
NTP peer that is not synchronized with an atomic clock or a network of NTP servers that will finally
synchronize with an atomic clock.

Examples
-> ntp server unsynchronized

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ntp server synchronized Enables an NTP client to invoke tests for NTP server synchronization as
specified by the NTP protocol.

MIB Objects
alaNtpConfig
alaNtpPeerTests

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-5


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp client
Enables or disables NTP operation on the switch.
ntp client {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables NTP.
disable Disables NTP.

Defaults
NTP protocol is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use this command to enable or disable NTP. Before NTP can be enabled, an NTP server must be speci-
fied using the ntp server command.

Examples
-> ntp client enable
-> ntp client disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ntp server Specifies an NTP server from which the switch will receive updates.

MIB Objects
alaNtpEnable

page 33-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp broadcast
Enables or disables the client’s broadcast mode.
ntp broadcast {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables the client broadcast mode.
disable Disables the client broadcast mode.

Defaults
Broadcast mode is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines

Broadcast mode is intended for operation on networks with numerous workstations and where the highest
accuracy is not required. In a typical scenario, one or more time servers on the network broadcast NTP
messages that are received by NTP hosts. Correct time is determined from this NTP message based on a
pre-configured latency or broadcast delay in the order of a few milliseconds.

Examples
-> ntp broadcast enable
-> ntp broadcast disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ntp broadcast-delay Sets the broadcast delay time in microseconds.

MIB Objects
alaNtpBroadcastEnable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-7


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp broadcast-delay
Sets the broadcast delay time in microseconds.
ntp broadcast delay microseconds

Syntax Definitions
microseconds The number of microseconds for the broadcast delay.

Defaults

parameter default
microseconds 4000

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
When running in the NTP client broadcast mode, a broadcast delay must be set. The broadcast delay is the
number of microseconds added to the timestamp.

Examples
-> ntp broadcast delay 1000
-> ntp broadcast delay 10000

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
ntp broadcast Enables or disables the client’s broadcast mode.

MIB Objects
alaNtpBroadcastDelay

page 33-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp key
Labels the specified authentication key identification as trusted or untrusted.
ntp key key [trusted | untrusted]

Syntax Definitions
key The key number matching an NTP server.
trusted Signifies that the specified key is trusted and can be used for authentica-
tion.
untrusted Signifies that the specified key is not trusted and cannot be used for
authentication. Synchronization will not occur with an untrusted authen-
tication key.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Authentication keys are stored in a key file and loaded into memory when the switch boots. The keys
loaded into memory are not trusted until this command is used.
• Once the keys are loaded into software (on boot up of the switch), they must be activated by being
labeled as trusted. A trusted key will authenticate with a server that requires authentication as long as
the key matches the server key.
• New keys must be added manually to the key file. A newly added key will not be loaded into the
switch software until the ntp key load command is issued, or the switch is rebooted.

Examples
-> ntp key 5 trusted
-> ntp key 2 untrusted

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-9


Network Time Protocol Commands

Related Commands

ntp key Sets the public key the switch uses when authenticating with the specified
NTP server.
ntp client Enables or disables authentication on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaNtpAccessKeyIdTable
alaNtpAccessKeyIdKeyId
alaNtpAccessKeyIdTrust

page 33-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

ntp key load


Loads the current key file into memory.
ntp key load

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command reloads the key file into the switch memory. This allows for new keys in the key file to
be added to the list of keys the switch can use for authentication.
• Newly added keys must be labeled as trusted with the ntp key command before being used for
authentication.

Examples
-> ntp key load

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ntp key Labels the specified authentication key identification as trusted or


untrusted.
ntp server Specifies an NTP server from which this switch will receive updates.

MIB Objects
alaNtpAccessRereadkeyFile

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-11


Network Time Protocol Commands

show ntp client


Displays information about the current client NTP configuration.
show ntp client

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays the current configuration parameters for the NTP client. The display is slightly
different depending on what has been configured on the client. See the Examples section for more infor-
mation.

Examples
-> show ntp client
Current time: SAT APR 16 2005 00:19:02 (UTC)
Last NTP update: SAT APR 16 2005 00:06:45 (UTC)
Client mode: enabled
Broadcast client mode: disabled
Broadcast delay (microseconds): 4000

output definitions
Current time The current time for the NTP client.
Last NTP update The time of the last synchronization with an NTP server.
Client mode Whether the NTP client software is enabled or disabled.
Broadcast client mode What NTP mode the client is running in, either client or broadcast.
Broadcast delay The number of microseconds in the advertised broadcast delay time.
This field is absent if the client broadcast mode is disabled.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 33-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

Related Command

ntp client Enables or disables NTP operation on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaNtpLocalInfo

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-13


Network Time Protocol Commands

show ntp client server-list


Displays a list of the servers with which the NTP client synchronizes.
show ntp client server-list

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ntp client server-list
IP Address Ver Key St Delay Offset Disp
================+===+=======+====+==========+=================+==========
198.206.181.70 4 0 2 0.167 0.323 0.016

output definitions
IP Address The server IP address.
Ver The version of NTP the server is using. Versions 3 and 4 are valid.
Key The NTP server’s public key. This must be accurate and the same as the
NTP server, or the client switch will not be able to synchronize with the
NTP server. A zero (0) means there is no key entered.
St The stratum of the server.
Delay The delay received from the server in its timestamp.
Offset The offset received from the server in its timestamp.
Disp The dispersion value received from the server in its timestamp.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 33-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

Related Command

ntp client Enables or disables authentication on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaNtpPeerListTable

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-15


Network Time Protocol Commands

show ntp server status


Displays the basic server information for a specific NTP server or a list of NTP servers.
show ntp server status [ip_address | domain_name]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address of the NTP server to be displayed.
domain_name The domain name of the server to be displayed. This is usually a text
string.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command displays a selected server or a list of servers with which the NTP client synchronizes.

• To display a specific server, enter the command with the server’s IP address or domain name. To
display all servers, enter the command with no server IP address.

Examples
-> show ntp server status
-> show ntp server status 198.206.181.139
IP address = 198.206.181.139,
Host mode = client,
Peer mode = server,
Prefer = no,
Version = 4,
Key = 0,
Stratum = 2,
Minpoll = 6 (64 seconds),
Maxpoll = 10 (1024 seconds),
Delay = 0.016 seconds,
Offset = -180.232 seconds,
Dispersion = 7.945 seconds
Root distance = 0.026,
Precision = -14,
Reference IP = 209.81.9.7,
Status = configured : reachable : rejected,
Uptime count = 1742 seconds,
Reachability = 1,
Unreachable count = 0,
Stats reset count = 1680 seconds,
Packets sent = 1,
Packets received = 1,
Duplicate packets = 0,

page 33-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

Bogus origin = 0,
Bad authentication = 0,
Bad dispersion = 0,
Last Event = peer changed to reachable,

output definitions
IP address The server IP address.
Host mode The host mode of this remote association.
Peer mode The peer mode of this remote association.
Prefer Whether this server is a preferred server or not. A preferred server is
used to synchronize the client before a non-preferred server.
Version The version of NTP the server is using. Versions 3 and 4 are valid.
Key The NTP server’s public key. This must be accurate and the same as the
NTP server, or the client switch will not be able to synchronize with the
NTP server. A zero (0) means there is no key entered.
Stratum The stratum of the server. The stratum number is the number of hops
from a UTC time source.
Minpoll The minimum poll time. The client will poll the server for a time update
every time this limit has been exceeded.
Maxpoll The maximum poll time.
Delay The delay received from the server in its timestamp.
Offset The offset received from the server in its timestamp.
Dispersion The dispersion value received from the server in its timestamp.
Root distance The total round trip delay (in seconds) to the primary reference source.
Precision The advertised precision of this association.
Reference IP The IP address identifying the peer’s primary reference source.
Status The peer selection and association status.
Uptime count The time period (in seconds) during which the local NTP server was
associated with the switch.
Reachability The reachability status of the peer.
Unreachable count Number of times the NTP entity was unreachable.
Stats reset count The time delay (in seconds) since the last time the local NTP server was
restarted.
Packets sent Number of packets sent.
Packets received Number of packets received.
Duplicate packets Number of duplicated packets received.
Bogus origin Number of bogus packets.
Bad authentication Number of NTP packets rejected for not meeting the authentication
standards.
Bad dispersion Number of bad dispersions.
Last Event The last event.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-17


Network Time Protocol Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Command

ntp client Enables or disables authentication on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaNtpPeerListTable
alaNtpPeerShowStatus

page 33-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Network Time Protocol Commands

show ntp keys


Displays information about all authentication keys.
show ntp keys

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays information about the authentication keys loaded into the memory.

Examples
-> show ntp keys
Key Status
=======+============
1 untrusted
2 untrusted
3 trusted
4 trusted
5 untrusted
6 untrusted
7 trusted
8 trusted

output definitions
Key The key number corresponding to a key in the key file.
Status Whether the key is trusted or untrusted.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 33-19


Network Time Protocol Commands

Related Command

ntp key Labels the specified authentication key identification as trusted or


untrusted.
ntp key load Loads the current key file into memory.

MIB Objects
alaNtpAccessKeyIdTable

page 33-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


34 Session Management
Commands

Session Management commands are used to monitor and configure operator sessions including FTP,
Telnet, HTTP (WebView), console, Secure Shell, and Secure Shell FTP on the switch. (See the SNMP
Commands chapter for SNMP session commands.) Maximum number of concurrent sessions allowed:

Session OS-6450
Telnet(v4 or v6) 4
FTP(v4 or v6) 4
SSH + SFTP(v4 or v6 secure 8
sessions)
HTTP 4
Total Sessions 20
SNMP 50

MIB information for commands in this chapter are as follows:


Filename: AlcatelInd1SessionMgr.mib
Module: AlcatelIND1SessionMgrMIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1AAA.mib
Module: Alcatel-IND1-AAA-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1System.mib
Module: Alcatel-IND1ConfigMgr.mib
Filename: AlcatelIND1Ssh.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SSH-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-1


Session Management Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here:

session login-attempt
session login-timeout
session banner
session timeout
session prompt
session xon-xoff
prompt
show prefix
alias
show alias
user profile save
user profile reset
history size
show history
!
command-log
kill
exit
who
whoami
show session config
show session xon-xoff
more size
more
show more
telnet
telnet6
ssh
ssh6
ssh enforce pubkey-auth
show ssh config
show command-log status

page 34-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

session login-attempt
Sets or resets the number of times a user can attempt unsuccessfully to log into the switch before the TCP
connection is closed.
session login-attempt integer

Syntax Definitions
integer The number of times the user can attempt to log in to the switch before
the TCP connection is closed. Valid range is 1 to 10.

Defaults
Default is 3 login attempts.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> session login-attempt 5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show session config Displays Session Manager information such as banner file name,
session timeout value, and default prompt value.
session login-timeout Sets or resets the amount of time the user can take to accomplish a
successful login to the switch.
session timeout Configures the inactivity timer for a CLI, HTTP (including Web-
View), or FTP interface. When the switch detects no user activity
for this period of time, the user is logged off the switch.

MIB Objects
sessionMgr
sessionLoginAttempt

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-3


Session Management Commands

session login-timeout
Sets or resets the amount of time the user can take to accomplish a successful login to the switch. If the
timeout period is exceeded, the TCP connection is closed by the switch.
session login-timeout seconds

Syntax Definitions
seconds The number of seconds the switch allows for the user to accomplish a
successful login. Valid range is from 5 to 600 seconds.

Defaults
Login timeout default is 55 seconds.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> session login-timeout 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show session config Displays Session Manager information such as banner file name,
session timeout value, default prompt value, login timer, and login
attempt number.
session login-attempt Sets or resets the number of times a user can attempt unsuccessfully
to log into the switch before the TCP connection is closed.
session timeout Configures the inactivity timer for a CLI, HTTP (including Web-
View), or FTP interface. When the switch detects no user activity
for this period of time, the user is logged off the switch.

MIB Objects
sessionMgr
sessionLoginTimeout

page 34-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

session banner
Sets or resets the file name of the user–defined banner. The banner is a welcome banner that appears after
the user sucessfully logs onto the switch.
session banner {cli | ftp | http} file_name
session banner no {cli | ftp | http}

Syntax Definitions
cli Creates/modifies the CLI banner file name.
ftp Creates/modifies the FTP banner file name.
http Creates/modifies the HTTP banner file name.
file_name Banner file name including the path from the switch’s /flash directory.
The maximum length of the filename and path is 255 characters.

Defaults
• A default banner is included in one of the switch’s image files. It is automatically displayed at login so
no configuration is needed.
• The user has the option of defining a custom supplementary banner or of using the default banner.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The session banner no command is used to disable a user defined session banner file from displaying
when you log onto the switch. The text file containing the custom banner will remain on the switch
until you remove it with the rm command.
• The session banner command is used to configure or modify the banner file name. You must use a
text editor to edit the file containing the banner text.

Examples
-> session banner cli/switch/banner.txt

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-5


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

show session config Displays Session Manager information such as banner file name,
session timeout value, and default prompt value.

MIB Objects
SessionConfigTable
SessionType
SessionBannerFileName

page 34-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

session timeout
Configures the inactivity timer for a CLI, HTTP (including WebView), or FTP interface. When the switch
detects no user activity for this period of time, the user is logged off the switch.
session timeout {cli | http | ftp} minutes

Syntax Definitions
cli Sets the inactivity timeout for CLI sessions.
http Sets the inactivity timeout for HTTP sessions.
ftp Sets the inactivity timeout for FTP sessions.
minutes Inactivity timeout value (in minutes). Valid range 1 to 596523.

Defaults

parameter default
minutes 4

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The inactivity timer value may be different for each type of interface, such as CLI (Console, Telnet),
HTTP (including WebView), and FTP.
• If you change the timer, the new value does not affect current sessions; the new timer is applied to new
sessions only.

Examples
-> session timeout cli 5

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-7


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

show session config Displays Session Manager information, such as banner file name,
session timeout value, and default prompt value.

MIB Objects
SessionConfigTable
SessionType
SessionInactivityTimerValue

page 34-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

session prompt
Configures the default CLI prompt for console and Telnet sessions. The prompt is the symbol and/or text
that appears on the screen in front of the cursor.
session prompt default [string]

Syntax Definitions
string Prompt string.

Defaults

parameter default
string ->

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The maximum prompt string length is 31 characters.

• The new prompt will not take effect until you log off and back onto the switch.

Examples
-> session prompt default -->

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show session config Displays Session Manager information such as banner file name,
session timeout value, and default prompt value.

MIB Objects
SessionConfigTable
SessionType
sessionDefaultPromptString

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-9


Session Management Commands

session xon-xoff
Enables/disables the XON-XOFF protocol on the console port.
session xon-xoff {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables XON-XOFF on the console port.
disable Disables XON-XOFF on the console port.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The switch may interpret noise from an RS232 line as Control-S (XOFF). If the session console xon-xoff
command is enabled, traffic to the console port may be stopped.

Examples
-> session xon-xoff enable
-> session xon-xoff disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show session xon-xoff Displays whether the console port is enabled or disabled for XON-
XOFF.

MIB Objects
sessionXonXoffEnable

page 34-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

prompt
This command defines the CLI prompt.
prompt [user] [time] [date] [string string] [prefix]
no prompt

Syntax Definitions
user The name of the current user is displayed as part of the CLI prompt.
time The current system time is displayed as part of the CLI prompt.
date The current system date is displayed as part of the CLI prompt.
string You can specify a text string as the prompt. Prompts specified with this
parameter are limited to four characters.
prefix The current prefix (if any) is displayed as part of the CLI prompt.
Prefixes are stored for command families that support the prefix recog-
nition feature. See Usage Guidelines.

Defaults
The default prompt is the arrow (->, or dash greater-than).

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to remove the CLI prompt.

• Prefixes are stored for command families that support the prefix recognition feature. These command
families include AAA, Interface, Link Aggregation, QoS, Spanning Tree, and VLAN Management.
Other command families do not store a prefix.
• To set the CLI prompt back to the arrow (->), enter the prompt string -> (prompt string dash greater-
than) syntax.

Examples
-> prompt user
-> prompt user time date
-> prompt prefix
-> prompt string 12->
-> prompt prefix ->

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-11


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

show prefix Shows the command prefix (if any) currently stored by the CLI.
Prefixes are stored for command families that support the prefix
recognition feature.

MIB Objects
N/A

page 34-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

show prefix
Shows the command prefix (if any) currently stored by the CLI. Prefixes are stored for command families
that support the prefix recognition feature.
show prefix

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Prefixes are stored for command families that support the prefix recognition feature. These command
families include AAA, Interface, Link Aggregation, QoS, Spanning Tree, and VLAN Management. Other
command families do not store a prefix.

Examples
-> show prefix

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

prompt This command defines the format of the CLI prompt. The prompt
can be defined to include the command prefix.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-13


Session Management Commands

alias
Defines substitute command text for the switch’s CLI command keywords.
alias alias command_name

Syntax Definitions
alias Text string that defines the new CLI command name (alias) that you
will use to replace an old CLI command name.
command_name The old CLI command name being replaced by your alias.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Alias commands are stored until the user session ends. To save alias settings, you must execute the
user profile save command. Otherwise, once you log off the switch, substitute commands configured
with the alias command are destroyed.
• You can eliminate excess typing by reducing the number of characters required for a command. For
instance, the group syntax can be defined as gp.
• You can change unfamiliar command words into familiar words or patterns. For instance, if you prefer
the term “privilege” to the term “attribute” with reference to a login account’s read/write capabilities,
you can change the CLI command from attrib to privileges.
• To reset commands set with alias back to their factory default, use the user profile reset command.

Examples
-> alias gp group
-> alias privilege attrib

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

show alias Lists all current commands defined by the use of the alias CLI
command.
user profile reset Resets the alias, prompt, and more values to their factory defaults.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-15


Session Management Commands

show alias
Displays all current commands defined by the use of the alias CLI command.
show alias

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
The following will display where the alias gp was defined to replace the group command, and the alias
privilege was defined to replace the attrib command.
-> show alias
gp: group
privilege: attrib

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

alias Defines substitute command text for the switch’s CLI command
keywords.

MIB Objects
N/A

page 34-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

user profile save


Saves the user account settings for aliases, prompts, and the more mode screen setting. These settings will
be automatically loaded when the user account logs on.
user profile save

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to save alias definitions, prompt definitions, and more mode screen settings for use
in future login sessions for the current user account.
• If you do not use the user profile save, alias, prompt, and more size commands, settings are lost
when the user account logs off.
• Use the user profile reset command to set the alias, prompt, and more size values to their factory
defaults.

Examples
-> user profile save

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

alias Defines substitute command text for the switch’s CLI command
keywords.
prompt Defines substitute command text for the switch’s CLI command
keywords.
more size Specifies the number of lines that your console screen will display.
user profile reset Resets the alias, prompt and more values to their factory defaults.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-17


Session Management Commands

user profile reset


Resets the alias, prompt, and more values to their factory defaults.
user profile reset

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> user profile reset

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

alias Defines substitute command text for the switch’s CLI command
keywords.
prompt Defines substitute command text for the switch’s CLI command
keywords.
more size Specifies the number of lines that your console screen will display.
user profile save Saves the user account settings for aliases, prompts and the more
screen.

MIB Objects
N/A

page 34-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

history size
Sets the number of commands that will be stored in the CLI’s history buffer.
history size number

Syntax Definitions
number Enter an integer between 1 and 500. The history buffer can store up to
500 commands.

Defaults
By default, the history buffer size is set to 100 commands.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> history size 10

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show history Displays commands that you have recently issued to the switch. The
commands are displayed in a numbered list.
! Recalls commands listed in the history buffer and displays them at
the CLI prompt.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-19


Session Management Commands

show history
Displays commands that you have recently issued to the switch. The commands are displayed in a
numbered list.
show history [parameters]

Syntax Definitions
parameters When this syntax is used, the CLI displays the history buffer size, the
current number of commands in the history buffer, and the index range
of the commands.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show history
1 show cmm
2 show fan
3 show sensor
4 show temp
5 show time
6 show arp
7 clear arp
8 show prefix

-> show history parameters


History size: 10
Current Size: 7
Index Range: 1-7

output definitions
History Size The size of the history buffer.
Current Size The number of commands currently stored in the history buffer for this
session.
Index Range The index range of the commands for this CLI session currently stored
in the history buffer.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

history size Sets the number of commands that will be stored in the CLI’s
history buffer.
! Recalls commands listed in the history buffer and displays them at
the CLI prompt.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-21


Session Management Commands

!
Recalls commands listed in the history buffer and displays them at the CLI prompt.
!{! | n}

Syntax Definitions
! Recalls the last command listed in the history buffer and displays that
command at the CLI prompt.
n Identifies a single command in the history buffer by number and
displays that command at the CLI prompt.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You can use the show history command to list all commands in the history buffer, then use the !n
syntax to issue a single command from the list.
• When you use !n or !! to recall a command in the history buffer list, you must press the Enter key to
execute the command.

Examples
-> show history
1* show cmm
2 show fan
3 show sensor
4 show temp
5 show time
6 show arp
7 clear arp

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

history size Sets the number of commands that will be stored in the CLI’s history
buffer.
show history Displays commands you have recently issued to the switch. The com-
mands are displayed in a numbered list.

MIB Objects
N/A

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-23


Session Management Commands

command-log
Enables or disables command logging on the switch. When command logging is enabled, a command.log
is automatically created; this file stores a comprehensive CLI command history for all active sessions since
the function was first enabled.
command-log {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Creates a file called command.log in the switch’s /flash directory. Any
configuration commands entered on the command line will be recorded
to this file until command logging is disabled.
disable Disables logging of current session commands to the command.log file.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The maximum log file size is 66,402 bytes; the file may hold up to 100 commands.

Examples
-> command-log enable
-> command-log disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show ssh config Displays the contents of the command.log file.


show command-log status Shows the current status of the command logging function
(i.e., enabled or disabled).

MIB Objects
sessionCliCommandLogEnable

page 34-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

kill
Kills an active session. The command takes effect immediately.
kill session_number

Syntax Definitions
session_number Number of the session you want to kill.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the who command to obtain the session number variable.

• You cannot kill your own session.

• You cannot kill a connected session where the user has not yet completed the login process. These
sessions appear with username “(at login)” when displayed with the who command.

Examples
-> kill 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

who Displays all active login sessions (e.g., Console, Telnet, FTP,
HTTP, Secure Shell, and Secure Shell FTP).

MIB Objects
SessionMgr
sessionIndex
sessionRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-25


Session Management Commands

exit
Ends the current CLI session. If the CLI session to the switch was via Telnet, the connection is closed.
exit

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
If changes were made using the CLI and have not been saved with the copy running-config working
command, a warning message appears asking to confirm the user exit. To save changes, enter N at the
warning prompt and use the copy running-config working command.

Examples
-> exit

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

kill Kills an active session. The command takes effect immediately.

MIB Objects
SessionMgr
sessionIndex
sessionRowStatus

page 34-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

whoami
Displays the current user session.
whoami

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the who command to display all sessions on the switch.

Examples
-> whoami
Session number = 5
User name = admin,
Access type = telnet,
Access port = NI,
IP address = 121.251.17.76,
Read-only domains = None,
Read-only families = ,
Read-Write domains = All ,
Read-Write families = ,
End-User profile =

output definitions
Session Number The session number assigned to the user.
User name User name.
Access type Type of access protocol used to connect to the switch.
Access port Switch port used for access during this session.
Ip Address User IP address.
Read-only domains The command domains available with the user’s read-only access. See
the table beginning on page 34-28 for a listing of valid domains.
Read-only families The command families available with the user’s read-only access. See
the table beginning on page 34-28 for a listing of valid families.
Read-Write domains The command domains available with the user’s read-write access. See
the table beginning on page 34-28 for a listing of valid domains.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-27


Session Management Commands

output definitions
Read-Write families The command families available with the user’s read-write access. See
the table beginning on page 34-28 for a listing of valid families.
End-User Profile The name of an end-user profile associated with the user.

Possible values for command domains and families are listed here:

domain families
domain-admin file image bootrom telnet reset dshell debug
domain-system system aip snmp rmon webmgt config
domain-physical chassis module interface pmm flood health
domain-network ip iprm ipmr ipms
domain-layer2 vlan bridge stp 802.1q linkagg ip-helper
domain-service ldap dhcp dns
domain-security session binding aaa

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

who Displays all active login sessions (e.g., Console, Telnet, FTP,
HTTP, Secure Shell, and Secure Shell FTP).
kill Kills another user’s session.

page 34-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

MIB Objects
SessionActive
sessionIndex
sessionAccessType
sessionPhysicalPort
sessionUserName
sessionUserReadPrivileges
sessionUserWritePrivileges
sessionUserProfileNumber
sessionUserIpAddress
sessionRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-29


Session Management Commands

who
Displays all active login sessions (e.g., Console, Telnet, FTP, HTTP, Secure Shell, and Secure Shell FTP).
who

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
You can identify your current login session by using IP address.

Examples
-> who
Session number = 0
User name = (at login),
Access type = console,
Access port = Local,
IP address = 0.0.0.0,
Read-only domains = None,
Read-only families = ,
Read-Write domains = None,
Read-Write families = ,
End-User profile =
Session number = 5
User name = admin,
Access type = telnet,
Access port = NI,
IP address = 128.251.17.176,
Read-only domains = None,
Read-only families = ,
Read-Write domains = All ,
Read-Write families = ,
End-User profile =

output definitions
Session Number The session number assigned to the user.
User name User name.
Access type Type of access protocol used to connect to the switch.
Access port Switch port used for access during this session.

page 34-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

output definitions (continued)


Ip Address User IP address.
Read-only domains The command domains available with the user’s read-only access. See
the table beginning on page 34-31 for a listing of valid domains.
Read-only families The command families available with the user’s read-only access. See
the table beginning on page 34-31 for a listing of valid families.
Read-Write domains The command domains available with the user’s read-write access. See
the table beginning on page 34-31 for a listing of valid domains.
Read-Write families The command families available with the user’s read-write access. See
the table beginning on page 34-31 for a listing of valid families.
End-User Profile The name of an end-user profile associated with the user.

Possible values for command domains and families are listed here:

domain families
domain-admin file image bootrom telnet reset dshell debug
domain-system system aip snmp rmon webmgt config
domain-physical chassis module interface pmm flood health
domain-network ip rip iprm ipmr ipms
domain-layer2 vlan bridge stp 802.1q linkagg ip-helper
domain-service ldap dhcp dns
domain-security session binding avlan aaa

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

whoami Displays current user session.


kill Kills another user’s session.

MIB Objects
SessionActive
sessionIndex
sessionAccessType
sessionPhysicalPort
sessionUserName
sessionUserReadPrivileges
sessionUserWritePrivileges
sessionUserProfileNumber
sessionUserIpAddress
sessionRowStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-31


Session Management Commands

show session config


Displays session manager configuration information (e.g., default prompt, banner file name, inactivity
timer, login timer, and login attempts).
show session config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the configuration commands detailed in this section to modify any of the values displayed.

Examples
-> show session config

Cli Default Prompt = ->


Cli Banner File Name = ,
Cli Inactivity Timer in minutes = 60
Ftp Banner File Name = ,
Ftp Inactivity Timer in minutes = 60
Http Inactivity Timer in minutes = 60
Login Timer in seconds = 60
Maximum number of Login Attempts = 2

output definitions
Cli Default Prompt Default prompt displayed for CLI sessions.
Cli Banner File Name Name of the file that contains the banner information that will appear
during a CLI session.
Cli Inactivity Timer in Inactivity timer value (in minutes) for CLI sessions. The user is logged
minutes off when this value is exceeded.
Ftp Banner File Name Name of the file that contains the banner information that will appear
during an FTP session.
Ftp Inactivity Timer in Inactivity timer value (in minutes) for FTP sessions. The user is logged
minutes off when this value is exceeded.
Http Inactivity Timer in Inactivity timer value (in minutes) for HTTP (including WebView)
minutes sessions. The user is logged off when this value is exceeded.

page 34-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

output definitions (continued)


Login Timer in seconds The amount of time the user can take to accomplish a successful login
to the switch. If the timeout period is exceeded, the TCP connection is
closed by the switch.
Maximum number of Login The number of times a user can attempt unsuccessfully to log into the
Attempts switch before the TCP connection is closed.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

session prompt Configures the default CLI prompt for console and Telnet sessions.
session banner Sets the file name of the user–defined banner.
session timeout Configures the inactivity timer for a CLI, HTTP (including Web-
View), or FTP interface.
session login-attempt Sets the number of times a user can attempt to log into the switch
unsuccessfully before the TCP connection is closed.
session login-timeout Sets the amount of time the user can take to accomplish a successful
login to the switch.

MIB Objects
SessionConfigTable
sessionType
sessionBannerFileName
sessionInactivityTimerValue
sessionDefaultPromptString

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-33


Session Management Commands

show session xon-xoff


Displays whether the console port is enabled or disabled for XON-XOFF.
show session xon-xoff

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
The switch may interpret noise from an RS232 line as Control-S (XOFF). If the console port is enabled for
XON-XOFF (through the session xon-xoff command), traffic to the console port may be stopped.

Examples
-> show session xon-xoff
XON-XOFF Enabled

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

session xon-xoff Enables/disables the XON-XOFF protocol on the console port.

MIB Objects
sessionXonXoffEnable

page 34-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

more size
Specifies the number of lines that your console screen will display.
more size lines

Syntax Definitions
lines Specify the number of lines for your console to display.

Defaults

parameter default
lines 128

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If the display from the switch contains more lines than specified with this command, the switch will
display only the number of lines specified. The last line on your console will display as follows:
More? [next screen <sp>, next line <cr>, filter pattern </>, quit </>]

• To display more lines, press the spacebar to show another full screen, press Enter to show the next line,
or press q to quit the display and return to the system prompt.

Examples
-> more size 12
-> more size 30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

more Enables the more mode for your console screen display.
show more Shows the enable status of the more mode along with the number of
lines specified for the screen display.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-35


Session Management Commands

more
Enables the more mode for your console screen display.
more
no more

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
Disabled

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command enables the more mode where your console screen display is determined by the value set
with the more size command.

Examples
-> more
-> no more

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show more Shows the number of TTY lines and columns to be displayed.
more size Specifies the number of lines that your console screen will display.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 34-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

show more
Shows the enable status of the more mode along with the number of lines specified for the screen display.
show more

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command shows the enable status of the more mode.

• The number of lines displayed is the value set with the more size command.

Examples
-> show more
The more feature is enabled and the number of line is set to 12

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

more Enables the more mode for your console screen display.
more size Specifies the number of lines that your console screen will display.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-37


Session Management Commands

telnet
Invokes a Telnet session. A Telnet session is used to connect to a remote system or device.
telnet {host_name | ip_address}

Syntax Definitions
host_name Specifies the host name for the Telnet session.
ip_address Specifies the IP address for the Telnet session.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To abort a Telnet session, enter CTRL + ] and then CTRL + D. Refer to your switch’s User Manual
for more information on using Telnet.
• You can establish up to 5 concurrent IPv4 or IPv6 telnet client sessions.

• You can establish up to 4 concurrent IPv4 or IPv6 telnet sessions to an OmniSwitch (i.e. when the
switch acts as a telnet server).

Examples
-> telnet 172.17.6.228
Trying 172.17.6.228...
Connected to 172.17.6.228.
Escape character is '^]'.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

telnet6 Invokes a Telnetv6 session. A Telnetv6 session is used to connect to a


remote system or device over an IPv6 network
ssh Invokes the Secure Shell on the switch. A Secure Shell is used to make a
secured connection to a remote system or device.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-39


Session Management Commands

telnet6
Invokes a Telnetv6 session. A Telnetv6 session is used to connect to a remote system or device over an
IPv6 network.
telnet6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address Specifies the IPv6 address for the Telnetv6 server.
hostname Specifies the hostname for the Telnetv6 server.
if_name The name of the interface used to reach the Telnetv6 server, if the target
has been specified using the link-local address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To abort a Telnet session, enter CTRL + ] and then CTRL + D. Refer to your switch’s User Manual
for more information on using Telnet.
• If the session is invoked using the server’s link-local address, the source interface name must be
provided.
• You can establish up to 5 concurrent IPv4 or IPv6 telnet client sessions.

• You can establish up to 4 concurrent IPv4 or IPv6 telnet sessions to an OmniSwitch (i.e. when the
switch acts as a telnet server).

Examples
-> telnet6 fe80::a00:20ff:fea8:8961 intf1
-> telnet6 ::1
-> telnet6 Sun.com

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

telnet Invokes a Telnet session. A Telnet session is used to connect to a remote


system or device.
ssh6 Invokes Secure Shellv6 on the switch. Secure Shellv6 is used to make a
secured connection to an SSHv6 server.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-41


Session Management Commands

ssh
Invokes Secure Shell on the switch. Secure Shell is used to make a secured connection to a remote system
or device.
ssh {host_name | ip_address | enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
host_name Specifies the host name for Secure Shell.
ip_address Specifies the IP address for Secure Shell.
enable Administratively enables Secure Shell on the switch.
disable Administratively disables Secure Shell on the switch.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must have a valid username and password for the specified host.

• You can establish up to 1 SSH sessions from an OmniSwitch (when it acts as Client) and up to 8 SSH
sessions to an OmniSwitch (when it acts as Server).

Examples
-> ssh enable
-> ssh 172.155.11.211
login as:

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

telnet Invokes a Telnet session. A Telnet session is used to connect to a remote


system or device.
sftp Starts an SFTP session. An SFTP session provides a secure file transfer
method.
ssh6 Invokes Secure Shellv6 on the switch. Secure Shellv6 is used to make a
secured connection to an SSHv6 server.
show ssh config Displays the status of Secure Shell, SCP/SFTP on the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAcctSATable
aaacsInterface
alaSshConfigGroup
alaSshAdminStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-43


Session Management Commands

ssh6
Invokes Secure Shellv6 on the switch. Secure Shellv6 is used to make a secured connection to an SSHv6
server.
ssh6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address Specifies the IPv6 address for Secure Shell.
hostname Specifies the host name for Secure Shell.
if_name The name of the interface used to reach the sshv6 server, if the target
has been specified using the link-local address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must have a valid username and password for the specified host.

• If the session is invoked using the server’s link-local address, the source interface name must be
provided.
• You can establish up to 1 SSH6 sessions from an OmniSwitch (when it acts as Client) and up to 8
SSH6 sessions to an OmniSwitch (when it acts as Server).
• A console or a telnet session can handle only one SSHv6 client session

• At anytime, there can be only a single SSH client session (either SSHv4 or SSHv6) to any SSH server.

Examples
-> ssh6 fe80::a00:20ff:fea8:8961 int1
-> ssh6 ::1
-> ssh6 Sun.com

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 34-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

telnet6 Invokes a Telnetv6 session. A Telnetv6 session is used to connect to a


remote system or device over an IPv6 network
sftp6 Starts an SFTPv6 session. An SFTPv6 session provides a secure file
transfer method.
ssh Invokes Secure Shell on the switch. Secure Shell is used to make a
secured connection to a remote system or device.
show ssh config Displays the status of Secure Shell, SCP/SFTP on the switch.

MIB Objects
aaaAcctSATable
aaacsInterface
alaSshConfigGroup
alaSshAdminStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-45


Session Management Commands

ssh enforce pubkey-auth


Enables or disables Secure Shell public key and password authentication. When enabled, password authen-
tication is not allowed.
ssh enforce pubkey-auth {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enforces only SSH public key authentication.
disable Enforces both SSH public key and password authentication.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable disable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Note that if a public key file (i.e., thomas_dsa.pub) exists in the flash/network/pub directory on the
switch, public key authentication is used even if this method of authentication is disabled using this
command. Rename, move, or delete the public key file to ensure that public key authentication is disabled.

Examples
-> ssh enforce pubkey-auth enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

telnet Invokes a Telnet session. A Telnet session is used to connect to a remote


system or device.
sftp Starts an SFTP session. An SFTP session provides a secure file transfer
method.

MIB Objects
alaSshConfigGroup
alaSshPubKeyEnforceAdminStatus

page 34-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

show ssh config


Displays the status of Secure Shell, SCP/SFTP on the switch.
show ssh config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ssh config
SSH = Enabled
SCP/SFTP = Enabled
Public Key Authentication Enforced = False

output definitions
SSH Displays the SSH status (enabled or disabled).
SCP/SFTP Displays the SCP/SFTP status (enabled or disabled).
Public Key Authentication Displays whether the Public Key Authentication is enforced. Options
Enforced include true or false.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-47


Session Management Commands

Related Commands

ssh Invokes Secure Shell on the switch. Secure Shell is used to make a
secured connection to a remote system or device.
ftp6 Enables or disables secure copy (SCP) and secure FTP (SFTP) at the
same time on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaSshConfigGroup
alaSshAdminStatus
alaScpSftpAdminStatus
alaSshPubKeyEnforceAdminStatus

page 34-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

show command-log
Displays the contents of the command.log file. This file contains a record of all CLI commands executed
on the switch since the command logging function was enabled. For more information on enabling and
disabling command logging, refer to page 34-24.
show command-log

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The show command-log command lists CLI commands in the descending order. In other words, the
most recent commands are listed first. In the example below, the command-log enable syntax is the
least recent command logged; the ip interface Marketing address 17.11.5.2 vlan 255 syntax is the
most recent.
• By default, command logging is disabled. To enable command logging on the switch, use the
command-log command.
• As mentioned above, command history is archived to the command.log file. If this file is removed, the
command history will no longer be available. In addition, the command.log file has a 66,402 byte
capacity. This capacity allows up to 100 commands; if the maximum capacity is reached, only the 100
most recent commands display.

Examples
-> show command-log
Command : ip interface Marketing address 17.11.5.2 vlan 255
UserName : admin
Date : FRI JAN 09 00:20:01
Ip Addr : 128.251.19.240
Result : SUCCESS

Command : ip interface "Distribution" 11.255.14.102 vlan 500 local-proxy-arp


UserName : admin
Date : FRI JAN 09 00:19:44
Ip Addr : 128.251.19.240
Result : ERROR: Ip Address must not belong to IP VLAN 44 subnet

Command : command-log enable


UserName : admin
Date : FRI JAN 09 00:18:49
Ip Addr : 128.251.19.240
Result : SUCCESS

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-49


Session Management Commands

output definitions
Command The exact syntax of the command, as entered by the user.
UserName The name of the user session that entered the command. For more
information on different user session names, refer to the user command
page, or the “Managing Switch User Accounts” chapter in the
OmniSwitch Switch Management Guide.
Date The date and time, down to the second, when the command was
entered.
IpAddr The IP address of the terminal from which the command was entered.
Result The outcome of the command entry. Options include SUCCESS and
ERROR. For erroneous command entries, the same error details pre-
sented by the switch at the time the command was entered are also dis-
played in the log file.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

command-log Enables or disables command logging on the switch.


show command-log status Shows the current status of the command logging function
(i.e., enabled or disabled).

MIB Objects
sessionCliCommandLogEnable

page 34-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Session Management Commands

show command-log status


Shows the current status of the command logging function (i.e., enabled or disabled). For more informa-
tion on enabling and disabling command logging, refer to the command-log command on page 34-24.
show command-log status

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
Command logging is disabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show command-log status
CLI command logging : Enable

output definitions
CLI command logging The current status of command logging on the switch. Options include
Disable and Enable. Disable indicates that the command logging func-
tion is currently disabled (default). Enable indicates that the command
logging function has been enabled via the command-log command.
For more information, refer to page 34-24.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

command-log Enables or disables command logging on the switch.


show ssh config Displays the contents of the command.log file.

MIB Objects
sessionCliCommandLogStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 34-51


Session Management Commands

page 34-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


35 File Management
Commands

This chapter includes descriptions for CLI commands used to manage files on the switch. Several of these
commands are used to create, move, and delete both files and directories in the OmniSwitch flash direc-
tory. Other commands allow you to change command privileges and to monitor the switch’s memory.
MIB information for the system commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1System.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SYSTEM-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1Chassis.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-CHASSIS-MIB
Filename: AlcatelIND1Ssh.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SSH-MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-1


File Management Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here:

File System cd
pwd
mkdir
rmdir
ls
dir
rename
rm
delete
cp
scp
mv
move
chmod
attrib
freespace
fsck
newfs
rcp
rrm
rls
System Services vi
view
tty
show tty
more
ftp
ftp6
show ssh config
sftp
sftp6
tftp
rz

page 35-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

cd
Changes the switch’s current working directory.
cd [path]

Syntax Definitions
path Specifies a particular working directory. If no path is specified, the
switch’s working directory is changed to the top level.

Defaults
The switch’s default working directory is /flash.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories, including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> cd
-> cd test_path

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-3


File Management Commands

Related Commands

pwd Displays the switch’s current working directory.


mkdir Creates a new directory.
rmdir Deletes an existing directory.
ls Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.
dir Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesWorkingDirectory

page 35-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

pwd
Displays the switch’s current working directory.
pwd

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> pwd
/flash

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

cd Changes the switch’s current working directory.


mkdir Creates a new directory.
rmdir Deletes an existing directory.
ls Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.
dir Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesWorkingDirectory

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-5


File Management Commands

mkdir
Creates a new directory.
mkdir [path/]dir

Syntax Definitions
path The path in which the new directory is being created. If no path is speci-
fied, the new directory is created in the current path.
dir A user-defined name for the new directory. Up to thirty-two (32) char-
acters may be used (e.g., test_directory).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate path directories with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> mkdir test_directory
-> mkdir flash/test_directory

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 35-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

Related Commands

cd Changes the switch’s current working directory.


pwd Displays the switch’s current working directory.
rmdir Deletes an existing directory.
ls Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.
dir Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-7


File Management Commands

rmdir
Deletes an existing directory.
rmdir [path/]dir

Syntax Definitions
path The path containing the directory to be removed. If no path is specified,
the command assumes the current path.
dir The name of the existing directory being removed. Up to thirty-two (32)
characters may be used (e.g., test_directory).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate path directories with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for the specified path.

• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> rmdir ../working
-> rmdir flash/working

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 35-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

Related Commands

cd Changes the switch’s current working directory.


pwd Displays the switch’s current working directory.
mkdir Creates a new directory.
ls Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.
dir Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-9


File Management Commands

ls
Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working directory.
ls [-r] [[path/]dir]

Syntax Definitions
-r Optional syntax that displays the contents of the current directory in
addition to recursively displaying all subdirectories. Be sure to include a
space between the syntax ls and -r (i.e., ls -r).
path/ Specifies the path (i.e., location) of a particular directory to be
displayed. If no path is specified, the command assumes the current
location.
dir Specifies a particular directory to be displayed. If no directory name is
specified, the contents of the current working directory are displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate multiple path directories with a slash (/).

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

page 35-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

Examples
-> ls

Listing Directory /flash:

-rw 268 Oct 2 09:54 boot.params


drw 2048 Sep 29 15:36 certified/
drw 2048 Oct 2 05:32 working/
drw 2048 Sep 27 12:26 switch/
-rw 115837 Sep 27 15:30 debug.lnk
-rw 185 Sep 29 14:19 phwi
-rw 706 Sep 29 14:52 incrsrc2
-rw 127640 Sep 29 14:52 pktgen.o
-rw 354 Sep 29 15:48 incrsrc

3143680 bytes free

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

cd Changes the switch’s current working directory.


pwd Displays the switch’s current working directory.
mkdir Creates a new directory.
rmdir Deletes an existing directory.
dir Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-11


File Management Commands

dir
Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working directory.
dir [[path/]dir]

Syntax Definitions
path/ Specifies the path (i.e., location) of a particular directory to be
displayed. If no path is specified, the command assumes the current
location.
dir Specifies a particular directory to be displayed. If no directory name is
specified, the contents of the current working directory are displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate multiple path directories with a slash (/).

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

page 35-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

Examples
-> dir /certified

Listing Directory /certified:

drw 2048 Jul 8 11:05 ./


drw 2048 Aug 21 13:54 ../
-rw 3555538 Jul 5 09:37 Jeni.img
-rw 1824898 Jul 5 09:37 Jos.img
-rw 2929 Jul 5 09:37 Jrelease.img
-rw 10526922 Jul 5 09:37 Jbase.img
-rw 9393680 Jun 10 10:35 Jeni2.img
-rw 1452 Jun 28 18:23 boot.cfg
-rw 1348241 Jul 5 09:36 Jadvrout.img
-rw 2478362 Jul 5 09:37 Jdiag.img
-rw 349555 Jul 5 09:37 Jsecu.img
-rw 256 Jul 8 11:05 random-seed

2390016 bytes free

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

cd Changes the switch’s current working directory.


pwd Displays the switch’s current working directory.
mkdir Creates a new directory.
rmdir Deletes an existing directory.
ls Displays the contents of a specified directory or the current working
directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg22
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-13


File Management Commands

rename
Renames an existing file or directory.
rename [path/]old_name [path/]new_name

Syntax Definitions
path/ Specifies the particular path (i.e., location) containing the file or direc-
tory to be renamed. If no path is specified, the command assumes the
current directory.
old_name The name of the existing file or directory to be renamed.
new_name The new user-defined file or directory name. Up to thirty-two (32) char-
acters may be used.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> rename flash/working/asc.1.snap new_file

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 35-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

Related Commands

cp Copies an existing file or directory.


mv Moves an existing file or directory to a new location.
move Moves an existing file or directory to a new location.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesArg2
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-15


File Management Commands

rm
Permanently deletes an existing file. This command can also delete a directory if the -r keyword is used.
rm [-r] [path/]filename

Syntax Definitions
-r Syntax that recursively removes directories, as well as any associated
subdirectories and files. Be sure to include a space between the syntax
rm and -r (i.e., rm -r).
path The path (i.e., location) containing the file being removed. If no path is
specified, the command assumes the current directory.
filename The name of the existing file being deleted. Up to thirty-two (32) char-
acters may be used (e.g., test_config_file).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Use care when deleting files. Depending on your switch and network configurations, specific configu-
ration and image files must be present for your system to work properly.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> rm test_config_file
-> rm flash/test_config_file

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

delete Deletes an existing file.

page 35-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-17


File Management Commands

delete
Deletes an existing file.
delete [path/]filename

Syntax Definitions
path/ The path (i.e., location) containing the file being removed. If no path is
specified, the command assumes the current directory.
filename The name of the existing file being removed. Up to thirty-two (32) char-
acters may be used (e.g., test_config_file).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Use care when deleting files. Depending on your switch and network configurations, specific configu-
ration and image files must be present for your system to work properly.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> delete test_config_file
-> delete flash/test_config_file

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rm Deletes an existing file or directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 35-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

cp
Copies an existing file. This command can also copy a directory if the -r keyword is used.
cp [-r] [path/]orig_filename [dest_path/]dupl_filename

Syntax Definitions
-r Syntax that recursively copies directories, as well as any associated
subdirectories and files. Be sure to include a space between the syntax
cp and -r (i.e., cp -r).
path/ Specifies the path containing the original file to be copied. If no path
name is specified, the command assumes the current path.
orig_filename The name of the existing file to be copied.
dest_path/ Specifies the destination path for the resulting file copy. If no destina-
tion path is specified, the file copy will be placed in the current path.
dupl_filename The new user-defined file name for the resulting file copy. If you are
copying a file to the same directory as the original, the file name for the
copy must be different from the original. Up to thirty-two (32) charac-
ters may be used.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You should verify that your switch’s /flash directory has enough available memory to hold the new
files and directories that will result from using the cp -r command.
• A file may be copied to a new location; you are not required to copy a file to the same directory that
contains the original.
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-19


File Management Commands

Examples
-> cp flash/snapshots/asc.1.snap flash/snapshot/snapshot_copy
-> cp flash/snapshots/asc.1.snap snapshot_copy
-> cp asc.1.snap flash/snapshot/snapshot_copy
-> cp asc.1.snap snapshot_copy

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

mv Moves an existing file or directory to a new location.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesArg2
systemServicesAction

page 35-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

scp
Copies an existing file in a secure manner.
scp user_name@remote_ip_addr:[path/]source [path/]target
scp [path/]source user_name@remote_ip_addr:[path/]target

Syntax Definitions
user_name@remote_ip_addr: The username along with the IP address of the remote switch.
path/ Specifies the path containing the file to be copied and the path where
the file will be copied.
source The name of the file(s) to be copied.
target The new user-defined file name for the resulting file copy. Up to thirty-
two (32) characters may be used.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command will prompt you to enter the admin password, and the names and the path of the files
being copied will be displayed.
• A file may be copied to a new location; you are not required to copy a file to the same directory that
contains the original.
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• If SCP is not enabled, use the ftp6 command to enable it.

• SCP is not supported between OmniSwitch and Windows currently.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-21


File Management Commands

Examples
-> scp [email protected]:/flash/working/Kos.img /flash/working/Kos.img
admin's password for keyboard-interactive method:

Fetching /flash/working/Kos.img to /flash/working/Kos.img


Connection to 172.17.11.13 closed.

-> scp /flash/working/Kos.img [email protected]:/flash/working/Kos.img


admin's password for keyboard-interactive method:

Uploading /flash/working/Kos.img to /flash/working/Kos.img


Connection to 172.17.11.13 closed.

-> scp [email protected]:/flash/working/*.img /flash/working


admin's password for keyboard-interactive method:

Fetching /flash/working/K2os.img to /flash/working/K2os.img


Fetching /flash/working/Kadvrout.img to /flash/working/Kadvrout.img
Fetching /flash/working/Kbase.img to /flash/working/Kbase.img
Fetching /flash/working/Keni.img to /flash/working/Keni.img
Fetching /flash/working/Kos.img to /flash/working/Kos.img
Fetching /flash/working/Krelease.img to /flash/working/Krelease.img
Fetching /flash/working/Ksecu.img to /flash/working/Ksecu.img
Connection to 172.17.11.13 closed.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

mv Moves an existing file or directory to a new location.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesArg2
systemServicesAction

page 35-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

mv
Moves an existing file or directory to a new location.
mv {[path/]filename dest_path[/new_filename] | [path/]dir dest_path[/new_dir]}

Syntax Definitions
path/ Specifies the path (i.e., location) containing the file or directory being
moved. If no path name is specified, the command assumes the current
path.
filename Specifies the name of the existing file to be moved.
dest_path/ Specifies the destination path (i.e., new location) for the file or direc-
tory that is being moved.
new_filename Specifies a new file name for the file being moved. If a new name is not
specified, the existing name will be used.
dir Specifies the name of the existing directory to be moved.
new_dir Specifies a new directory name for the directory being moved. If a new
name is not specified, the existing name will be used.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The mv command does not make a copy of the file or directory being moved. To copy a file or direc-
tory to the current path or to a new location, use the cp command on page 35-19.
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> mv flash/asc.1.snap flash/backup_files/asc.1.snap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-23


File Management Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rename Renames an existing file or directory.


cp Copies an existing file or directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesArg2
systemServicesAction

page 35-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

move
Moves an existing file or directory to a new location.
move {[path/]filename dest_path[/new_filename] | [path/]dir dest_path[/new_dir]}

Syntax Definitions
path/ Specifies the path (i.e., location) containing the file or directory being
moved. If no path name is specified, the command assumes the current
path.
filename Specifies the name of the existing file to be moved.
dest_path/ Specifies the destination path (i.e., new location) for the file or direc-
tory that is being moved.
new_filename Specifies a new file name for the file being moved. If a new name is not
specified, the existing name will be used.
dir Specifies the name of the existing directory to be moved.
new_dir Specifies a new directory name for the directory being moved. If a new
name is not specified, the existing name will be used.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The move command does not make a copy of the file or directory being moved. To copy a file or direc-
tory to the current path or to a new location, use the cp command.
• Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Refer to the examples below.

• Up to 255 characters may be used for a fully qualified path.

• A path can contain up to a maximum of seven (7) directories including /flash.

• As with files names, up to thirty-two (32) characters may be used for a directory name.

• File and directory names can include only the following character types: a-z, A-Z, 0-9, dashes (-),
dots (.), and underscores (_).
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> move flash/asc.1.snap flash/backup_files/asc.1.snap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-25


File Management Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rename Renames an existing file or directory.


cp Copies an existing file or directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesArg2
systemServicesAction

page 35-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

chmod
Changes the write privileges for a specified file.
chmod {+w | -w} [path/]file

Syntax Definitions
+w Enables read-write privileges for the file.
-w Disables write privileges for the file—i.e., the file becomes read-only.
path/ The path containing the file for which privileges are being changed. Be
sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash (/). Up to
255 characters may be used for the specified path. Also, a path may
contain a maximum of thirty-two (32) directories.
file The name of the file for which read-write privileges are being changed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> chmod +w vlan.config
-> chmod -w flash/backup_configs/vlan.config

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

attrib Changes the write privileges for a specified file.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-27


File Management Commands

attrib
Changes the write privileges for a specified file.
attrib {+w | -w} [path/]file

Syntax Definitions
+w Enables read-write privileges for the file.
-w Disables write privileges for the file—i.e., the file becomes read-only.
path/ The path containing the file for which write privileges are being
changed. Be sure to separate path directories and file names with a slash
(/). Up to 255 characters may be used for the specified path. Also, a path
may contain a maximum of thirty-two (32) directories.
file The name of the file for which write privileges are being changed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> attrib +w vlan.config
-> attrib -w flash/backup_configs/vlan.config

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

chmod Changes the write privileges for a specified file.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 35-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

freespace
Displays the amount of free space available in the /flash directory.
freespace [/flash]

Syntax Definitions
/flash Optional syntax. The amount of free space is shown for the /flash direc-
tory.

Defaults
N/A

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Examples
-> freespace /flash
/flash 3143680 bytes free

-> freespace
/flash 3143680 bytes free

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

fsck Performs a file system check, including diagnostic information in the


event of file corruption. If the fsck command detects a problem with the
/flash file system, a message is displayed indicating the problem, along
with any steps needed to resolve it.

MIB Objects
SystemFileSystemTable
systemFileSystemFreespace

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-29


File Management Commands

fsck
Performs a file system check, including diagnostic information in the event of file corruption.
fsck /flash [no-repair | repair]

Syntax Definitions
/flash Indicates that the file system check will be performed on the /flash
directory.
no-repair Performs only the file system check on the /flash directory.
repair Performs file system check on the /flash directory and also repairs any
errors found on the file system.

Defaults

parameter default
no-repair | repair no-repair

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The file system check is performed on the /flash directory by default.

• Specifying the parameter repair along with the command performs the file system check and also
repairs any errors found.The switch will display the errors found and specify those errors that have
been repaired. If there are no errors found, then just the file system information is displayed.
• This command only applies to the primary and secondary CMM in an OmniSwitch chassis-based
switch or the primary and secondary switch in an OmniSwitch stack.

Examples
-> fsck /flash no-repair
/flash/ - disk check in progress ...
/flash/ - Volume is OK

total # of clusters: 29,758


# of free clusters: 18,886
# of bad clusters: 0
total free space: 77,357,056
max contiguous free space: 55,451,648 bytes
# of files: 59
# of folders: 5
total bytes in files: 44,357,695
# of lost chains: 0
total bytes in lost chains: 0

page 35-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

(Example Continued on Next Page)


-> fsck /flash repair
/flash/ - disk check in progress ...
/flash/ - Volume is OK
Change volume Id from 0x0 to 0xef2e3c

total # of clusters: 29,758


# of free clusters: 18,886
# of bad clusters: 0
total free space: 77,357,056
max contiguous free space: 55,451,648 bytes
# of files: 59
# of folders: 5
total bytes in files: 44,357,695
# of lost chains: 0
total bytes in lost chains: 0

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

freespace Displays the amount of free space available in the /flash directory.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-31


File Management Commands

newfs
Deletes a complete /flash file system and all files within it, replacing it with a new, empty /flash file
system. Use this command when you want to reload all files in the file system or in the unlikely event that
the /flash file system becomes corrupt.
newfs /flash

Syntax Definitions
/flash Required syntax. This indicates that the complete flash file system will
be replaced.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• It is recommended that you preserve all required image and configuration files by saving them to a
remote host before executing the newfs command.
• Do not power-down the switch after running the newfs command until you reload all required image
and configuration files.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> newfs /flash

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 35-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

rcp
Copies a file from a primary to a non-primary switch in a stack and vice versa.
rcp [slot:] source_filepath [slot:] destination_filepath

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number of the non-primary switch in a stack.
source_filepath The name and path of the source file.
destination_filepath The name and path of the destination file.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
On switches in a stack configuration, this command copies a file from any non-primary switch to the
primary switch in a stack. You must specify the slot number on these switches.

Examples
-> rcp 3:/flash/file.txt file.txt
-> rcp /flash/working/file.txt 3:/flash/working/file.txt

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rrm Removes a file from a secondary CMM or from a non-primary switch in


a stack.
rls Displays the content of a non primary CMM in a switch or a non-pri-
mary switch in a stack.

MIB Objects
chasSupervisionRfsLsTable
alcatelIND1ChassisSupervisionRfsCommands
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsSlot
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsCommand
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsSrcFileName
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsDestFileName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-33


File Management Commands

rrm
Removes a file from a non-primary switch in a stack.
rrm slot filepath

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number of the non-primary switch in a stack.
filepath The name and path of the file to be deleted.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
On switches in a stacked configuration, this command deletes a file from any non-primary switch. You
must specify the slot number on these switches.

Examples
-> rrm 5 /flash/boot.params

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

rcp Copies a file from a non-primary switch to a primary switch in a stack.


rls Displays the content of a non primary CMM in a switch or anon-pri-
mary switch in a stack.

MIB Objects
chasSupervisionRfsLsTable
alcatelIND1ChassisSupervisionRfsCommands
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsSlot
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsCommand
chasSupervisionRfsCommandsSrcFileName

page 35-34 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

rls
Displays the content of a non-primary switch in a stack.
rls slot directory [file_name]

Syntax Definitions
slot The slot number of the non-primary switch in a stack.
directory The name of the directory on the non-primary switch.
file_name The file to be displayed on the non-primary switch.

Defaults
By default, all files in the specified directory are displayed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command displays directory content on any non-primary switch in a stack. You must specify the slot
number on these switches.

Examples
-> rls 5 /flash
-rw 324 Mar 3 11:32 boot.params
drw 2048 Mar 3 11:32 certified/
drw 2048 Mar 3 11:32 working/
-rw 64000 Mar 7 09:54 swlog1.log
-rw 29 Feb 5 2023 policy.cfg
-rw 3369019 Mar 3 11:20 cs_system.pmd
-rw 394632 Jan 1 1980 bootrom.bin
-rw 511096 Jan 1 1980 miniboot.backup
-rw 511096 Jan 1 1980 miniboot.default
drw 2048 Feb 25 06:34 network/
drw 2048 Mar 3 11:29 switch/
-rw 256 Mar 3 11:29 random-seed

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-35


File Management Commands

Related Commands

rcp Copies a file from a secondary CMM to a primary CMM or from a non-
primary switch to a primary switch in a stack.
rrm Removes a file from a secondary CMM or from a non-primary switch in
a stack.

MIB Objects
chasSupervisionRfsLsTable
chasSupervisionRfsLsFileIndex
chasSupervisionRfsLsSlot
chasSupervisionRfsLsDirName
chasSupervisionRfsLsFileName
chasSupervisionRfsLsFileType
chasSupervisionRfsLsFileSize
chasSupervisionRfsLsFileAttr
chasSupervisionRfsLsFileDateTime

page 35-36 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

vi
Launches the switch’s UNIX-like Vi text editor. The Vi file editor allows you to view or edit the contents
of a specified text file.
vi [path/]filename

Syntax Definitions
path The path (i.e., location) containing the file being viewed or edited. If no
path is specified, the command assumes the current directory.
filename The name of the existing file being viewed or edited. Up to thirty-two
(32) characters may be used (e.g., test_config_file).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Until you exit the switch’s file editor, all keystrokes will be passed to the text editor rather than the
switch’s command line.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> vi test_config_file

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

view Allows you to view the contents of a specified file by invoking the Vi
text editor in read-only mode.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-37


File Management Commands

view
Allows you to view the contents of a specified file by invoking the Vi text editor in read-only mode.
view [path/]filename

Syntax Definitions
path The path directory leading to the file being viewed. If no path is speci-
fied, the command assumes the current directory.
filename The name of the existing file being viewed. Up to thirty-two (32) char-
acters may be used (e.g., test_config_file).

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> view flash/text_file.txt

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

vi Launches the switch’s Vi text editor.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 35-38 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

tty
Specifies the number of lines and columns to be displayed on the terminal screen while the switch is in the
edit file mode.
tty lines columns

Syntax Definitions
lines The number of lines to be displayed on the terminal emulation screen
for the current session. Values may range from 10 to 150.
columns The number of columns to be displayed for each line. One column is the
same width as a single text character. Values may range from 20 to 150.

Defaults

parameter default
lines 24
columns 80

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The number of lines and columns set with this command control the screen size when the switch is
editing or viewing a text file with the vi or more commands.
• The values set with this command do not control the CLI screen when the switch is operating in normal
mode.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> tty 10 60

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-39


File Management Commands

Related Commands

show tty Displays current TTY settings.


more Displays a switch text file onto the console screen.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesTtyLines
systemServicesTtyColumns

page 35-40 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

show tty
Displays current TTY settings.
show tty

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Shows the settings made with the tty command.

• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> show tty
lines = 24, columns = 80

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

tty Specifies the number of TTY lines and columns to be displayed.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesTtyLines
systemServicesTtyColumns

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-41


File Management Commands

more
Displays a switch text file onto the console screen.
more [path/]file

Syntax Definitions
path The directory path leading to the file to be displayed. If no path is speci-
fied, the command assumes the current path.
file The name of the text file to be displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• This command displays the specified text file within the line and column parameters set with the tty
command.
• If the specified text file contains more columns than set with the tty command, the text will wrap to the
next line displayed.
• If the text file contains more lines than set with the tty command, the switch will display only the
number of lines specified. To display more lines, press the spacebar to show another full screen, press
Enter to show the next line, or press q to quit the display and return to the system prompt.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> more config_file1
-> more flash/config_file1
-> more flash/working/config_file1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

tty Specifies the number of TTY lines and columns to be displayed.

page 35-42 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-43


File Management Commands

ftp
Starts an FTP session.
ftp {host_name | ip_address}

Syntax Definitions
host_name Specifies the host name for the FTP session.
ip_address Specifies the IP address for the FTP session.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must have a valid username and password for the specified host.

• You can establish up to 9 FTP sessions from an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Client) and up to 4
FTP sessions to an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Server).
• After logging in, FTP commands are supported. They are defined in the following table:

ascii Set transfer type to ASCII (7-bit).


binary Set transfer type to binary (8-bit).
bye Close session gracefully.
cd Change to a new directory on the remote machine.
delete Delete a file on the remote machine.
dir Obtain a long listing on the remote machine.
get Retrieve a file from the remote machine.
hash Print the hash symbol (#) for every block of data transferred. (This com-
mand toggles hash enabling and disabling.)
ls Display summary listing of the current directory on the remote host.
put Send a file to the remote machine.
pwd Display the current working directory on the remote host.
quit Close session gracefully.
remotehelp List the commands that the remote FTP server supports.
user Send new user information.
lpwd Display the current working directory on the local host.
? Display list of available FTP commands.

page 35-44 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

Examples
-> ftp 172.17.6.228
Connecting to 172.17.6.228 [172.17.6.228]...connected.
220 Annex FTP server (Version RA4000 R14.1.15) ready.
Name :

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

sftp Starts an SFTP session.


ftp6 Starts an FTPv6 session.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-45


File Management Commands

ftp6
Starts an FTPv6 session.
ftp6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
ipv6_address Specifies the IPv6 address of the FTPv6 server.
hostname Specifies the hostname of the FTPv6 server.
if_name The name of the interface used to reach the FTPv6 server, if the target
has been specified using the link-local address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must have a valid username and password for the specified host.

• A console, a telnet or an SSH session can handle only one FTPv6 client session.

• You can establish upto 9 FTP or FTPv6 sessions from an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Client) and
upto 4 FTP or FTPv6 sessions to an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Server).
• If the session is invoked using the server’s link-local address, the source interface name must be
provided.
• After logging in, FTPv6 commands are supported. They are defined in the following table:

ascii Set transfer type to ASCII (7-bit).


binary Set transfer type to binary (8-bit).
bye Close session gracefully.
cd Change to a new directory on the remote machine.
close Terminate the ftp session.
delete Delete a file on the remote machine.
dir Obtain a long listing on the remote machine.
get Retrieve a file from the remote machine.
hash Print the hash symbol (#) for every block of data transferred. (This com-
mand toggles hash enabling and disabling.)
help Display list of available FTP commands.
lcd Change to a new directory on the local machine.

page 35-46 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

ls Display summary listing of the current directory on the remote host.


? Display list of available FTP commands.
mgets Receive multiple files.
mputs Receive multiple files.
prompt Enable/disable interactive prompting.
put Send a file to the remote machine.
pwd Print current working directory.
quit Close session gracefully.
remotehelp List the commands that the remote FTP server supports.
user Send new user information.
ls Display list content of local directory.

Examples
-> ftp6 fe80::a00:20ff:fea8:8961 int3
-> ftp6 ::5
-> ftp6 Sun.com

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

sftp6 Starts an SFTPv6 session.


ftp Starts an FTP session.

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-47


File Management Commands

scp-sftp
Enables or disables secure copy (SCP) and Secure FTP (SFTP) at the same time on the switch.
scp-sftp {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Administratively enables SCP/SFTP on the switch.
disable Administratively disables SCP/SFTP on the switch.

Defaults

parameter default
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> scp-sftp enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ssh Invokes Secure Shell on the switch. Secure Shell is used to make a
secured connection to a remote system or device.
show ssh config Displays the status of Secure Shell, SCP/SFTP on the switch.

MIB Objects
alaSshConfigGroup
alaScpSftpAdminStatus

page 35-48 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

show ssh config


Displays the status of Secure Shell, SCP/SFTP on the switch.
show ssh config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show ssh config
SSH = Enabled
SCP/SFTP = Enabled
Public Key Authentication Enforced = False

output definitions
SSH Displays the SSH status (enabled or disabled).
SCP/SFTP Displays the SCP/SFTP status (enabled or disabled).
Public Key Authentication Displays whether the Public Key Authentication is enforced. Options
Enforced include true or false.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ssh Invokes Secure Shell on the switch. Secure Shell is used to make a
secured connection to a remote system or device.
ftp6 Enables or disables secure copy (SCP) and secure FTP (SFTP) at the
same time on the switch.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-49


File Management Commands

MIB Objects
alaSshConfigGroup
alaSshAdminStatus
alaScpSftpAdminStatus
alaSshPubKeyEnforceAdminStatus

page 35-50 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

sftp
Starts an SFTP session. An SFTP session provides a secure file transfer method.
sftp {host_name | ip_address}

Syntax Definitions
host_name Specifies the host name for the SFTP session.
ip_address Specifies the IP address for the SFTP session.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must have a valid username and a password for the specified host.

• If SFTP is not enabled, use the ftp6 command to enable it.

• You can establish up to 4 SFTP sessions from an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Client) and up to 8
SFTP sessions to an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Server).
• After logging in, SFTP commands are supported. They are defined in the following table:

cd path Change remote path to ‘path’.


lcd path Change local directory to ‘path’.
chmod mode path Change permissions of file ‘path’ to ‘mode’.
help Display command help information.
get remote-path [local path] Download a file from the remote path to the local path.
lls [path] Display local directory listing.
ln oldpath newpath Creates a symbolic link (symlink) to the remote file.
symlink oldpath newpath Creates a symbolic link (symlink) to the remote file.
lmkdir path Create local directory.
lpwd Print local working directory.
ls [path] Display remote directory listing.
mkdir path Create remote directory.
put local-path [remote- Upload file.
path]
pwd Display remote working directory.
exit Quit the sftp mode.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-51


File Management Commands

quit Exit the sftp mode.


rename oldpath newpath Rename a remote file.
rmdir path Remove remote directory.
rm path Delete remote file.
version Show the current SFTP version.
? Synonym for help. Displays command help information.

Examples
-> sftp 12.251.11.122
login as:

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ftp Starts an FTP session.


ssh Invokes Secure Shell on the switch. Secure Shell is used to make a
secured connection to a remote system or device.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 35-52 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

sftp6
Starts an SFTPv6 session. An SFTPv6 session provides a secure file transfer method.
sftp6 {host_name | ipv6_address} [if_name]

Syntax Definitions
host_name Specifies the host name for the SFTPv6 session.
ipv6_address Specifies the IPv6 address for the SFTPv6 session.
if_name The name of the interface used to reach the SFTPv6 server, if the target
has been specified using the link-local address.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• You must have a valid username and a password for the specified host.

• A console or a telnet session can handle only one SSHv6 client session.

• If the session is invoked using the server’s link-local address, the source interface name must be
provided.
• You can establish up to 4 SFTP6 sessions from an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Client) and up to
8 SFTP6 sessions to an OmniSwitch (when it acts as FTP Server).
• At anytime, there can be only 4 SFTP sessions (including SFTPv4 or SFTPv6) to any SSH servers.

• After logging in, SFTPv6 commands are supported. They are defined in the following table:

cd path Change remote path to ‘path’.


lcd path Change local directory to ‘path’.
chmod mode path Change permissions of file ‘path’ to ‘mode’.
help Display command help information.
get remote-path [local path] Download a file from the remote path to the local path.
lls [path] Display local directory listing.
ln oldpath newpath Creates a symbolic link (symlink) to the remote file.
symlink oldpath newpath Creates a symbolic link (symlink) to the remote file.
lmkdir path Create local directory.
lpwd Print local working directory.
ls [path] Display remote directory listing.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-53


File Management Commands

mkdir path Create remote directory.


put local-path [remote-path] Upload file.
pwd Display remote working directory.
exit Quit the sftp mode.
quit Exit the sftp mode.
rename oldpath newpath Rename a remote file.
rmdir path Remove remote directory.
rm path Delete remote file.
version Show the current SFTP version.
? Synonym for help. Displays command help information.

Examples
-> sftp6 fe80::a00:20ff:fea8:8961 int1
-> sftp6 ::1
-> sftp6 Sun.com

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ftp6 Starts an FTP6 session.


ssh6 Invokes Secure Shellv6 on the switch. Secure Shellv6 is used to make a
secured connection to an SSHv6 server.

MIB Objects
SystemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesAction

page 35-54 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

tftp
Starts a TFTP client session that enables a file transfer to an TFTP server.
tftp {host_name | ip_address} {get | put} source-file [src_path/]src_file [destination-file [dest_path/]
dest_file] [ascii]

Syntax Definitions
host_name Specifies the hostname of the TFTP server.
ip_address Specifies the IP address of the TFTP server.
get Specifies to download the file from the TFTP server.
put Specifies to upload the file to the TFTP server.
src_path Specifies the path containing the source file to be transferred.
src_file Specifies the file name of the source file to be transferred.
dest_path Specifies the destination path of the file to be transferred.
dest_file Specifies the destination file name of the file to be transferred.
ascii Sets the transfer type to ASCII (7-bit).

Defaults
• If a path is not specified with the filename, the current path is used by default (for example, /flash).

• If a destination filename is not specified, the source filename is used by default.

• The default file transfer mode for a TFTP client session is Binary mode.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The OmniSwitch supports TFTP client functionality only.

• A TFTP server has no provisions for user authentication.

• Only one active TFTP client session is allowed at a time.

• When downloading a file to the switch, the file size must not exceed the available flash space.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-55


File Management Commands

Examples
-> tftp tftp.server.com get source-file abc.img destination-file xyz.img
-> tftp tftp.server.com put source-file abc.txt destination-file xyz.txt ascii
-> tftp 10.211.17.1 get source-file boot.cfg destination-file /flash/working/
boot.cfg ascii
-> tftp 10.211.17.1 get source-file boot.cfg ascii

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesArg1
systemServicesArg2
systemServicesArg3
systemServicesArg4
systemServicesArg5
systemServicesAction

page 35-56 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


File Management Commands

rz
Starts a Zmodem session.
rz

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To use Zmodem, you must have a terminal emulator that supports the Zmodem protocol.

• Activate the Zmodem transfer according to the instructions that came with your terminal emulation
software.
• When the transfer is complete, you can use the ls command to verify that the files were loaded
successfully.
• To abort a Zmodem session, enter CTRL + X five times in succession. Refer to your switch’s User
Manual for more information on uploading files via Zmodem.
• This command can also be used on the secondary CMM.

Examples
-> rz
Upload directory: /flash
rz ready to receive file, please start upload (or send 5 CTRL-X's to abort).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
systemServices
systemServicesAction

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 35-57


File Management Commands

page 35-58 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


36 Web Management
Commands

The switch can be configured and monitored using WebView, which is a web-based device management
tool. Web Management CLI commands allow you to enable/disable web-based management and config-
ure certain WebView parameters, such as Secure Socket Layer (SSL).
MIB information for the Web Management commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelInd1WebMgt.mib
Module: alcatelIND1WebMgtMIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

http server
http ssl
http port
https port
debug http sessiondb
show http

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 36-1


Web Management Commands

http server
Enables/disables web management on the switch. When enabled, a user is able to configure the switch
using the WebView application.
{[ip] http | https} server
no {[ip] http | https} server

Syntax Definitions
ip Optional syntax. Using this optional syntax is the same as using the http
server command.

Defaults
Web management is enabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to disable web management. If web management is disabled, you will
not be able to access the switch using WebView.

Examples
-> http server
-> no http server
-> https server
-> no https server

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

http ssl Enables/disables SSL on the switch.


debug http sessiondb Displays web management session information.
show http Displays web management configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaIND1WebMgtConfigMIBGroup
alaInd1WebMgtAdminStatus

page 36-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Web Management Commands

http ssl
Enables/disables Force SSL on the switch. SSL is a protocol that establishes and maintains secure commu-
nication between SSL-enabled servers and clients across the Internet.
{[ip] http | https} ssl
no {[ip] http | https} ssl

Syntax Definitions
ip Optional syntax. Using this optional syntax is the same as using the http
ssl command.

Defaults
SSL is enabled by default.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Use the no form of this command to disable SSL.

Examples
-> http ssl
-> no http ssl
-> https ssl
-> no https ssl

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

http server Enables/disables web management on the switch.


show http Displays web management configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaIND1WebMgtConfigMIBGroup
alaInd1WebMgtSsl

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 36-3


Web Management Commands

http port
Changes the port number for the embedded Web server in the switch.
[ip] http port {default | port}

Syntax Definitions
ip Optional syntax.
default Restores the port to its default (80) value.
port The desired port number for the embedded Web server. The number
must be in the range 0 to 65535; well-known port numbers cannot be
configured.

Defaults

parameter default
port 80

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
All WebView sessions must be terminated before entering this command.

Examples
-> http port 1025
-> http port default

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

http server Enables/disables web management on the switch.


show http Displays web management configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaIND1WebMgtConfigMIBGroup
alaIND1WebMgtHttpPort

page 36-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Web Management Commands

https port
Changes the default secure HTTP (HTTPS) port for the embedded Web server.
https port {default | port}

Syntax Definitions
default Restores the port to its default (443) value.
port The desired HTTPS port number. The number must be in the range 0 to
65535; well-known port numbers cannot be configured.

Defaults

parameter default
port 443

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
All WebView sessions must be terminated before entering this command.

Examples
-> https port 1026
-> https port default

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

http server Enables/disables web management on the switch.


show http Displays web management configuration information.

MIB Objects
alaIND1WebMgtConfigMIBGroup
alaIND1WebMgtHttpsPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 36-5


Web Management Commands

debug http sessiondb


Displays web management session information.
debug http sessiondb

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> debug http sessiondb

Sess SessName Name TimeOut Status URL Name--&--StatMsg


-----+-----------+------+-------+--------------+----------------------------------
0 6 sess_21606 admin 5848035 AUTHENTICATED /web/content/index.html
1 -2 sess_28257 5999940 IN_PROGRESS /ip/content/index.html
Current Active WebView Session: 1

output definitions
Sess The first number is the session number.
SessName Unique ID assigned by the browser.
Name User name.
TimeOut User-configured inactivity timer, in minutes.
Status Session status. If the user has successfully logged in, the status is
“Authenticated.”
URL Name&StatMsg Current page being viewed by the user.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 36-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Web Management Commands

Related Commands

http server Enables/disables web management on the switch.


http ssl Enables/disables SSL on the switch.
show http Displays web management configuration information.

MIB Objects

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 36-7


Web Management Commands

show http
Displays web management configuration information.
show [ip] http

Syntax Definitions
ip Optional syntax. Using this optional syntax is the same as using the
show http command.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show http

Web Management = on
Force SSL = on
Web Management Http Port = 80
Web Management Https Port = 443

output definitions
Web Management Indicates whether web management is enabled (on) or disabled (off) on
the switch.
Force SSL Indicates whether Force SSL is enabled (on) or disabled (off) on the
switch. If this is set to on this means that SSL is forced on an HTTP
session and hence HTTPS protocol is negotiated between the client and
server. For example, an “http://switchname.com” URL will be redi-
rected to an “https://switchname.com” URL.
Web Management Http Port The port configured for the HTTP connection.
Web Management Https Port The port configured for a secure HTTP connection (SSL enabled).

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 36-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Web Management Commands

Related Commands

http server Enables/disables web management on the switch.


http ssl Enables/disables SSL on the switch.
http port
https port

MIB Objects
alaIND1WebMgtConfigMIBGroup
alaInd1WebMgtAdminStatus
alaInd1WebMgtSsl
alaInd1WebMgtHttpPort
alaInd1WebMgtHttpsPort

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 36-9


Web Management Commands

page 36-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


37 Configuration File
Manager Commands

The Configuration Manager feature allows you to configure your switch using an ASCII-based text file.
CLI commands may be typed into a text document—referred to as a configuration file—and then uploaded
and applied to the switch.
MIB information for the Configuration Manager commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1System.mib
Module: Alcatel-IND1ConfigMgr.mib
A summary of the available commands is listed here:

configuration apply
configuration error-file limit
show configuration status
configuration cancel
configuration syntax check
configuration snapshot
show configuration snapshot
write terminal

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-1


Configuration File Manager Commands

configuration apply
Applies a configuration file to the switch. Files may be applied immediately or after a designated timer
session. With the timer session option, files are applied either at a scheduled date and time or after a
specified period of time (i.e., a countdown) has passed.
configuration apply filename [at hh:mm month dd [year]] | [in hh[:mm]] [verbose]

Syntax Definitions
filename The name of the configuration text file to be applied to the switch
(e.g., newfile1).

at hh:mm Designates a timer session in which a configuration file is applied at a


{dd month | month dd} [year] specified date and time in the future. Values for hh range from 00
through 23. Values for mm range from 00 through 59. Values for dd
range from 01 through 31. Values for month range from january through
december. The switch assumes either the current year or the next calen-
dar year for month and day pairs that precede the current date.

in hh[:mm] Designates a timer session in which the configuration file is applied


after a specific amount of time (i.e., a countdown) has passed. Values
for hh range from 00 through 23. Values for mm range from 00 through
59.
verbose When verbose is entered, information is displayed on your workstation’s
console as each command in the configuration file is applied.

Defaults
By default, verbose error checking is not performed.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• The configuration apply command only applies settings to the running configuration. The boot.cfg
file does not get overwritten.
• It is recommended that you check all configuration files for syntax errors before applying them to your
switch.
• To schedule a timer session in which a file is applied at a specific date and time, enter at followed by
the hour, minute, month, day, and year. The switch assumes either the current calendar year or the next
calendar year for dates beginning January 1.
• To schedule a timer session in which a file is applied after a specific amount of time (i.e., a countdown)
has passed, enter in followed by the number of hours and minutes.
• Verbose mode is not supported for timer sessions.

page 37-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

• The keyword, authkey, along with a related alpha-numeric text string, are automatically included in
many snapshot files (e.g., configuration snapshot all). The text string following the authkey keyword
represents a login password that has been encrypted twice. (The first encryption occurs when a pass-
word is first created by a user; the second encryption occurs when a configuration snapshot is taken.)
This dual encryption further enhances switch security. However, it is important to note that any config-
uration file (including a generated snapshot) that includes this dual-encrypted password information
will result in an error whenever it is applied to the switch via the configuration apply command. This
is a valid switch function and does not represent a significant problem. If an authkey-related error is
the only error detected, simply remove all authkey-related syntax using a text editor. If a new pass-
word is required for the switch, include valid password syntax in the configuration file or immediately
issue a new password by using the password command at the command prompt. For more informa-
tion on passwords, refer to page 21-30.

Examples
-> configuration apply new_configuration at 12:00 15 november
-> configuration apply new_configuration at 12:00 november 15
-> configuration apply newfile1 in 01:30
-> configuration apply my_switch_config in 00:05
-> configuration apply asc.1.snap in 23:00
-> configuration apply aaa_config in 12
-> configuration apply vlan_config verbose
-> configuration apply vlan_config
...

Note. When the configuration apply command is entered without at or in syntax information, one or
more dots “.” is displayed in the next line, immediately following the command line. This indicates
command progress; each dot represents 256 text lines in the configuration file processed by the
configuration apply mechanism.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

configuration syntax check Performs a syntax and authorization check of all CLI commands contained
in a configuration file.

MIB Objects
alcatelIND1ConfigMgrMIBObjects
configFileName
configFileMode
configFileAction
configTimerFileName
configTimerFileTime

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-3


Configuration File Manager Commands

configuration error-file limit


Specifies the maximum number of configuration error files allowed in the switch’s /flash directory. Error
files are normally generated when a configuration file is applied to the switch. Error files are identified by
their .err extension.When the maximum number of .err files is exceeded, any new error file will over-
write the .err file with the oldest timestamp.
configuration error-file limit number

Syntax Definitions
number Indicate the number of error files allowed in the /flash directory. The
valid range is from 1 to 25 files.

Defaults

parameter default
number 1

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When the error file limit is set to 1 (the default value), the next error file generated by the switch will
replace the existing one.
• When the error file limit is set to a value greater than 1, when a new error file that exceeds the
maximum limit is created, the switch will automatically remove the error file with the smallest times-
tamp.
• The error files generated by the switch have the .err extension.

• If you want to save an error file, you may change the file name so that it does not have the .err
extension, or you can move it from the /flash directory.

Examples
-> configuration error-file limit 2
-> configuration error-file limit 1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 37-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

Related Commands

configuration apply Applies a configuration file to the switch. Also used for scheduling a timer
session for a configuration file.
configuration cancel Cancels a pending timer session for a configuration file.

MIB Objects
alcatelIND1ConfigMgrMIBObjects
configErrorFileMaximum

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-5


Configuration File Manager Commands

show configuration status


Displays whether there is a pending timer session scheduled for a configuration file and indicates whether
the running configuration and the saved configuration files are identical or different. This command also
displays the number of error files that will be held in the flash directory.
show configuration status

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• A timer session can be scheduled using the configuration apply command. For more information,
refer to page 37-2.
• The screen output File configuration </path/filename>: scheduled at dd/mm hh:mm indicates that a
timer session has been scheduled for a later time.
• The output No file configuration has been scheduled indicates an idle timer session (i.e., no timer
session has been scheduled for a configuration file).
• The output File configuration is in progress indicates that a file is currently being applied to the
switch.
• The output File configuration </path/filename>: completed with 2 errors indicates that the named
file was applied to the switch with two recorded errors.
• When the running and saved configurations are the same, the output Running configuration and
saved configuration are identical will be displayed.
• When the running and saved configurations are the different, the output Running configuration and
saved configuration are different will be displayed.
• To synchronize the running and saved configuration, use the write memory command.

Examples
-> show configuration status

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 37-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

Related Commands

configuration apply Applies a configuration file to the switch. Also used for scheduling a timer
session for a configuration file.
configuration cancel Cancels a pending timer session for a configuration file.
configuration error-file limit Specifies the maximum number of configuration error files allowed in the
switch’s /flash directory.
write memory Copies the running configuration (RAM) to the working directory.

MIB Objects
configTimerFileGroup
configTimerFileStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-7


Configuration File Manager Commands

configuration cancel
Cancels a pending timer session for a configuration file.
configuration cancel

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> configuration cancel

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

configuration apply Applies a configuration file to the switch. Also used for scheduling a timer
session for a configuration file.
show configuration status Displays whether there is a pending timer session scheduled for a configu-
ration file.

MIB Objects
configTimerFileGroup
configTimerClear

page 37-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

configuration syntax check


Performs a syntax and authorization check of all CLI commands contained in a configuration file.
configuration syntax check path/filename [verbose]

Syntax Definitions
path/filename The configuration file being checked for syntax and authorization
errors. If a configuration file is located in another directory, be sure to
specify the full path. For example, /flash/working/asc.1.snap.
verbose When verbose is specified in the command line, all syntax contained in
the configuration file is printed to the console, even if no error is
detected. When verbose is not specified in the command line, cursory
information (number of errors and error log file name) will be printed to
the console only if a syntax or configuration error is detected.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When an error is detected, an error file (.err) is automatically generated by the switch. By default, this
file is placed in the root /flash directory. To view the contents of a generated error file, use the view
command. For example, view asc.1.snap.1.err.
• The syntax, mac alloc, is automatically included in many snapshot files (e.g., configuration snapshot
all). All mac alloc-related syntax is valid during switch boot up only (i.e., it cannot be applied while
the switch is in run-time operation). Because snapshot files are commonly used as configuration files,
syntax checks may detect mac alloc syntax and issue an error (along with a generated .err file). This is
a valid switch function and does not represent a significant problem. If a mac alloc-related error is the
only error detected, simply remove the syntax using a text editor, then re-check the file using the
configuration syntax check command.
• It is recommended that you check all configuration files for syntax errors before applying them to your
switch.

Examples
-> configuration syntax check vlan_file1
..

Note. When the configuration syntax check command is entered, one or more dots “.” is displayed in the
command output. This indicates command progress; each dot represents 256 text lines in the configura-
tion file processed by the syntax check mechanism.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-9


Configuration File Manager Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

configuration apply Applies a configuration file to the switch. Also used for scheduling a
timer session for a configuration file.
show configuration status Displays whether there is a pending timer session scheduled for a
configuration file.

MIB Objects
configFileGroup
configErrorFileName
configErrorFileMaximum
configFileMode
configFileStatus

page 37-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

configuration snapshot
Generates a snapshot file of the switch’s non-default current running configuration. A snapshot can be
generated for all current network features or for one or more specific network features. A snapshot is a
single text file that can be viewed, edited, and reused as a configuration file.
configuration snapshot feature_list [path/filename]

Syntax Definitions
feature_list The description for the network feature(s) to be included in the
snapshot. You may enter more than one network feature in the
command line. Current snapshot-supported network features are listed
below.

snapshot-supported features
802.1q ip-routing rip
aaa ipmr ripng
aip ipms saa
all ipv6 session
bridge linkagg snmp
chassis loopback-detection stack-manager
efm-oam module stp
erp ntp system
ethernet-oam policy test-oam
health pmm udld
interface port-mapping vlan
ip qos webmgt
ip-helper rdp

path/filename A user-defined name for the resulting snapshot file. For example,
test_snmp_snap. You may also enter a specific path for the resulting
file. For example, the syntax /flash/working/test_snmp_snap places
the test_snmp_snap file in the switch’s /flash/working directory.

Defaults
If a file name is not specified, the default file name asc.#.snap is used. Here, # indicates the order in
which the default file is generated. For example, the first default file name to be generated is asc.1.snap,
the second default file name to be generated is named asc.2.snap, etc. By default, all snapshot files are
placed in the root /flash directory.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-11


Configuration File Manager Commands

Usage Guidelines
• Only current, non-default configuration settings are written to the snapshot file.

• You may enter more than one network feature in the command line. Separate each network feature with
a space and no comma. Network features may be entered in any order.
• The snapshot file is automatically placed in the root /flash directory unless otherwise specified.

Examples
-> configuration snapshot all
-> configuration snapshot new_file1 qos health aggregation
-> configuration snapshot snmp_snapshot snmp
-> configuration snapshot 802.1q

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; erp, saa, and test-oam parameters added.

Related Commands
N/A

MIB Objects
configManager
configSnapshotFileName
configSnapshotAction
configSnapshotAllSelect
configSnapshotVlanSelect
configSnapshotSpanningTreeSelect
configSnapshotErpSelect
configSnapshotQOSSelect
configSnapshotIPSelect
configSnapshotIPMSSelect
configSnapshotAAASelect
configSnapshotSNMPSelect
configSnapshot802.1QSelect
configSnapshotLinkAggregateSelect
configSnapshotPortMirrorSelect
configSnapshotXIPSelect
configSnapshotHealthMonitorSelect
configSnapshotBootPSelect
configSnapshotBridgeSelect
configSnapshotChassisSelect
configSnapshotInterfaceSelect
configSnapshotPolicySelect
configSnapshotSAASelect
configSnapshotSessionSelect
configSnapshotSystemServiceSelect
configSnapshotTESTOAMSelect
configSnapshotWebSelect
configSnapshotRIPSelect
configSnapshotIPRMSelect
configSnapshotIPMRSelect

page 37-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

configSnapshotModuleSelect
configSnapshotRDPSelect
configSnapshotIPv6Select

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-13


Configuration File Manager Commands

show configuration snapshot


Displays the switch’s current running configuration for all features or for the specified feature(s).
show configuration snapshot [feature_list]

Syntax Definitions
feature_list Specify the feature(s) for which you want to display the running config-
uration. List the features separated by a space with no comma.

snapshot-supported features
802.1q ip-routing rip
aaa ipmr ripng
aip ipms saa
all ipv6 session
bridge linkagg snmp
chassis loopback-detection stack-manager
efm-oam module stp
erp ntp system
ethernet-oam policy test-oam
health pmm udld
interface port-mapping vlan
ip qos webmgt
ip-helper rdp

Defaults
By default, this command shows configuration information for all features.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use this command to view the current configuration for any feature shown in the table.

• To show a list of features on the switch, use the show configuration snapshot ? syntax.

• Configurations are listed below the name of each feature.

• Features with no current configuration show only the name of the feature.

page 37-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

Examples
-> show configuration snapshot
-> show configuration snapshot aaa bridge
! Bridging :

! AAA :
aaa authentication default "local"
aaa authentication console "local"
user "public" read All write All no auth authkey 391b0e74dbd13973d703cceaa4a8e30

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.
Release 6.6.2; erp, saa, and test-oam parameters added.

Related Commands

write terminal Displays the switch’s current running configuration for all features.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-15


Configuration File Manager Commands

MIB Objects
configManager
configSnapshotFileName
configSnapshotAction
configSnapshotAllSelect
configSnapshotVlanSelect
configSnapshotSpanningTreeSelect
configSnapshotErpSelect
configSnapshotQOSSelect
configSnapshotIPSelect
configSnapshotIPMSSelect
configSnapshotAAASelect
configSnapshotSNMPSelect
configSnapshot802.1QSelect
configSnapshotLinkAggregateSelect
configSnapshotPortMirrorSelect
configSnapshotXIPSelect
configSnapshotHealthMonitorSelect
configSnapshotBootPSelect
configSnapshotBridgeSelect
configSnapshotChassisSelect
configSnapshotInterfaceSelect
configSnapshotPolicySelect
configSnapshotSAASelect
configSnapshotSessionSelect
configSnapshotSystemServiceSelect
configSnapshotTESTOAMSelect
configSnapshotWebSelect
configSnapshotRIPSelect
configSnapshotIPRMSelect
configSnapshotIPMRSelect
configSnapshotModuleSelect
configSnapshotRDPSelect
configSnapshotIPv6Select

page 37-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Configuration File Manager Commands

write terminal
Displays the switch’s current running configuration for all features.
write terminal

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Configurations are listed below the name of each feature.

• Features with no current configuration show only the name of the feature.

Examples
-> write terminal

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show configuration snapshot Displays the switch’s current running configuration for all features or for
the specified feature(s).

MIB Objects
configManager
mib_configSnapshotAllSelect

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 37-17


Configuration File Manager Commands

page 37-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


38 SNMP Commands

This chapter includes descriptions for Trap Manager and SNMP Agent commands. The commands are
used for configuring SNMP settings on the switch.
• SNMP station commands can create, modify, or delete an SNMP station. Also included is a show
command for monitoring current SNMP station status.
• SNMP trap commands configure SNMP trap settings. Traps can be replayed and filtered. Also, test
traps can be generated to verify that individual traps are being correctly handled by the Network
Management Station (NMS). The SNMP trap commands set includes show commands for monitoring
SNMP trap information.
• SNMP agent commands configure SNMP security levels on the switch. Also includes show commands
for monitoring the current SNMP security status.
MIB information for SNMP Community commands is as follows:
Filename: IETFsnmpCommunity.MIB
Module: IETF SNMP-COMMUNITY.MIB
MIB information for Trap Manager commands is a follows:
Filename AlcatelIND1TrapMgr.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-TRAP-MGR.MIB
MIB information for SNMP Agent commands is a follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1SNMPAgent.MIB
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SNMP-AGENT.MIB

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-1


SNMP Commands

A summary of the available commands is listed here:

SNMP station commands snmp station


show snmp station
SNMP community map snmp community map
commands snmp community map mode
show snmp community map
SNMP security commands snmp security
show snmp security
show snmp statistics
show snmp mib family
SNMP trap commands snmp trap absorption
snmp trap to webview
snmp trap replay
snmp trap filter
snmp authentication trap
show snmp trap replay
show snmp trap filter
snmp authentication trap
show snmp trap config

page 38-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

snmp station
Adds a new SNMP station; modifies or deletes an existing SNMP station.
snmp station {ip_address | ipv6_address} {[udp_port] [username] [v1 | v2 | v3] [enable | disable]}
no snmp station {ip_address | ipv6_address}

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address to which SNMP unicast traps will be sent.
ipv6_address The IPv6 address to which SNMP unicast traps will be sent.
udp_port A UDP destination port.
username The user name on the switch or external server used to send traps to the
SNMP station(s). The username specified here must match an
existing user account name.
v1 Specifies that traps are sent using SNMP version 1.
v2 Specifies that traps are sent using SNMP version 2.
v3 Specifies that traps are sent using SNMP version 3.
enable Enables the specified SNMP station.
disable Disables the specified SNMP station.

Defaults

parameter default
udp_port 162
v1 | v2 | v3 v3
enable | disable enable

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of the command to remove an existing SNMP station.

• When adding an SNMP station, you must specify an IP address plus username parameters. For exam-
ple, the syntax snmp station 1.2.3.4 is not a valid command entry; however, snmp station 1.2.3.4
username1 is a valid command entry.
• You can establish up to 50 SNMP sessions to an OmniSwitch.

• When modifying an SNMP station, you must specify an IP address plus at least one additional
parameter. For example, the syntax snmp station 1.2.3.4 is not a valid command entry; however,
snmp station 1.2.3.4 v2 is a valid command entry.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-3


SNMP Commands

• The default UDP port 162 is commonly used for traps; however, the destination port can be redefined
to accommodate an SNMP station using a nonstandard port. The destination port specified in the
command line must correspond with the UDP destination port configured at the receiving SNMP
station(s).
• When the SNMP station is enabled, the switch transmits traps to the specified IP or IPv6 address.

Examples
-> snmp station 168.22.2.2 111 username2 v1 disable
-> snmp station 168.151.2.101 "test lab"
-> snmp station 170.1.2.3 username1 enable
-> snmp station 1.1.2.2 v2
-> no snmp station 2.2.2.2
-> snmp station 300::1 enable
-> no snmp station 300::1

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp station Displays the current SNMP station information.

MIB Objects
trapStationTable
trapStationIP
trapStationPort
trapStationUser
trapStationProtocol
trapStationRowStatus
alaTrapInetStationTable
alaTrapInetStationIPType
alaTrapInetStationIP
alaTrapInetStationPort
alaTrapInetStationRowStatus
alaTrapInetStationProtocol
alaTrapInetStationUser

page 38-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp station


Displays the current SNMP station status.
show snmp station

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show snmp station
ipAddress/udpPort status protocol user
---------------------------------------------------+---------+--------+------
172.21.160.32/4000 enable v3 abc
172.21.160.12/5000 enable v3 user1
0300:0000:0000:0000:0211:d8ff:fe47:470b/4001 enable v3 user2
0300:0000:0000:0000:0211:d8ff:fe47:470c/5001 enable v2 abc

output definitions
IPAddress IP Address of the SNMP management station that replayed the trap.
UDP Port UDP port number.
Status The Enabled/Disabled status of the SNMP management station.
Protocol The version of SNMP set for this management station.
User The user account name.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-5


SNMP Commands

Related Commands

snmp station Adds a new SNMP station; modifies or deletes an existing SNMP
station.

MIB Objects
trapStationTable
trapStationIP
trapStationPort
trapStationUser
trapStationProtocol
trapStationRowStatus
alaTrapInetStationTable
alaTrapInetStationIPType
alaTrapInetStationIP
alaTrapInetStationPort
alaTrapInetStationRowStatus
alaTrapInetStationProtocol
alaTrapInetStationUser

page 38-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

snmp community map


Configures and enables a community string on the switch and maps it to an existing user account name.
snmp community map community_string {[user useraccount_name] | {enable | disable}}
no snmp community map community_string

Syntax Definitions
community_string A community string in the form of a text string. This string must be
between 1 and 32 characters.
useraccount_name A user name in the form of a text string. This name must match a user
login account name already configured on the switch or configured
remotely on an external AAA server. This user name must be between 1
and 32 characters.
enable Enables SNMP community string mapping.
disable Disables SNMP community string mapping.

Defaults
By default, SNMP community map authentication is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Community strings configured on the switch are used for v1 and v2c SNMP managers only.

• The user account name must be a current user account recognized by the switch. For a list of current
user names use the show user command. To create a new user account, use the user command.
• There is one to one mapping between each community string and a user account name.

• Privileges attached to the community string are the ones inherited from the user account name that
created it.

Examples
-> snmp community map community1 user testname1
-> snmp community map community1 enable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-7


SNMP Commands

Related Commands

snmp community map mode Enables the local community strings database.

MIB Objects
SNMPCommunityTable
snmpCommunityIndex
snmpCommunitySecurityName
snmpCommunityStatus

page 38-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

snmp community map mode


Enables the local community strings database.
snmp community map mode {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables SNMP community map database.
disable Disables SNMP community map database.

Defaults
By default, SNMP community strings database is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• When enabled, the community string carried over each incoming v1 or v2c SNMP request must be
mapped to a user account name in order to be processed by the SNMP agent.
• When enabled, mapping is contained in the local community strings database populated by using the
snmp community map command.
• When disabled, the community strings carried over each incoming v1 or v2c request must be equal to a
user account name in order to be processed by the SNMP agent.

Examples
-> snmp community map mode enable
-> snmp community map mode disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

snmp community map Configures and enables a community string on the switch and maps it to
an existing user account name.

MIB Objects
SNMPCommunityTable
snmpCommunityIndex
snmpCommunitySecurityName
snmpCommunityStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-9


SNMP Commands

show snmp community map


Shows the local community strings database.
show snmp community map

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guideline
N/A

Examples
-> show snmp community map
Community mode : enabled

status community string user name


--------+-------------------------------+--------------------------------
enabled test_string1 bb_usename
enabled test_string2 rr_usename
disabled test_string3 cc_usename
disabled test_string4 jj_usename

output definitions
Status The Enabled/Disabled status of the community string.
Community String The text that defines the community string.
User Name The user account name.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

snmp community map Configures and enables a community string on the switch and maps it to
an existing user account name.

page 38-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

snmp security
Configures SNMP security settings.
snmp security {no security | authentication set | authentication all | privacy set | privacy all | trap
only}

Syntax Definitions
no security The switch will accept all SNMP v1, v2, and v3 requests.
authentication set The switch will accept all requests except v1, v2, and non-authenticated
v3 set requests. SNMP v1, v2, and non-authenticated v3 set requests
will be rejected.
authentication all The switch will accept all requests except v1, v2, and non-authenticated
v3 get, get-next, and set requests. SNMP v1, v2, and non-authenticated
v3 get, get-next, and set requests will be rejected.
privacy set The switch will accept only authenticated SNMP v3 get, get-next and
encrypted v3 set requests. All other requests will be rejected.
privacy all The switch will accept only encrypted v3 get, get-next, and set requests.
All other requests will be rejected.
trap only All SNMP get, get-next, and set requests will be rejected.

Defaults
By default, the SNMP security default is set to privacy all, which is the highest level of security.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Refer to the table below for a quick-reference list of security parameter and the SNMP request allowances
for each parameter.

v1 set v1 get v3 auth set v3 auth get/ v3 encryp set v3 encryp get/
v2 set v2 get get-next get-next
v3 non-auth v3 non-auth get/
set get-next
no security accepted accepted accepted accepted accepted accepted
authentication set rejected accepted accepted accepted accepted accepted
authentication all rejected rejected accepted accepted accepted accepted
privacy set rejected rejected rejected accepted accepted accepted
privacy all rejected rejected rejected rejected accepted accepted
trap only rejected rejected rejected rejected rejected rejected

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-11


SNMP Commands

Examples
-> snmp security no security
-> snmp security authentication set
-> snmp security authentication all
-> snmp security privacy set
-> snmp security trap only

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp security Displays the current SNMP security status.

MIB Objects
SNMPAgtConfig
SnmpAgtSecurityLevel

page 38-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp security


Displays the current SNMP security status.
show snmp security

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
Refer to the command on page 38-11 for descriptions of the five SNMP security states: no security,
authentication set, authentication all, privacy set, privacy all, and trap only.

Examples
-> show snmp security
snmp security = no security

-> show snmp security


snmp security = authentication set

-> show snmp security


snmp security = authentication all

-> show snmp security


snmp security = privacy set

-> show snmp security


snmp security = privacy all

-> show snmp security


snmp security = trap only

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-13


SNMP Commands

Related Commands

snmp security Configures the SNMP security settings.

page 38-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp statistics


Displays the current SNMP statistics.
show snmp statistics

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show snmp statistics
From RFC1907
snmpInPkts = 801
snmpOutPkts = 800
snmpInBadVersions = 0
snmpInBadCommunityNames = 0
snmpInBadCommunityUses = 0
snmpInASNParseErrs = 0
snmpEnableAuthenTraps = disabled(2)
snmpSilentDrops = 0
snmpProxyDrops = 0
snmpInTooBigs = 0
snmpOutTooBigs = 0
snmpInNoSuchNames = 0
snmpOutNoSuchNames = 0
snmpInBadValues = 0
snmpOutBadValues = 0
snmpInReadOnlys = 0
snmpOutReadOnlys = 0
snmpInGenErrs = 0
snmpOutGenErrs = 0
snmpInTotalReqVars = 839
snmpInTotalSetVars = 7
snmpInGetRequests = 3
snmpOutGetRequests = 0
snmpInGetNexts = 787
snmpOutGetNexts = 0
snmpInSetRequests = 7
snmpOutSetRequests = 0
snmpInGetResponses = 0
snmpOutGetResponses = 798

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-15


SNMP Commands

snmpInTraps = 0
snmpOutTraps = 0
From RFC2572
snmpUnknownSecurityModels = 0
snmpInvalidMsgs = 0
snmpUnknownPDUHandlers = 0
From RFC2573
snmpUnavailableContexts = 0
snmpUnknownContexts = 1
From RFC2574
usmStatsUnsupportedSecLevels = 0
usmStatsNotInTimeWindows = 1
usmStatsUnknownUserNames = 1
usmStatsUnknownEngineIDs = 0
usmStatsWrongDigests = 0
usmStatsDecryptionErrors = 0

output definitions
From RFCxxxx Displays the RFC number that defines the SNMP MIB objects listed.
MIB Objects Name of the MIB object listed as an SNMP statistic.
= (integer) The number of times the MIB object has been reported to the SNMP
management station since the last reset.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands
N/A

page 38-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp mib family


Displays SNMP MIB information. Information includes MIP ID number, MIB table name, and command
family.
show snmp mib family [table_name]

Syntax Definitions
table_name The name of the MIB table to be displayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• If a table name is not specified in the command syntax, all MIB table names will be displayed.

• If the command family is not valid for the entire MIB table, the command family will be displayed on a
per-object basis.
• Table names are case-sensitive. Therefore, use the exact table names from the MIB database.

Examples
-> show snmp mib family trapStationTable
MIP ID MIB TABLE NAME FAMILY
-------+----------------------------------------+---------------------
73733 trapStationTable snmp

output definitions
MIP ID Identification number for the MIP associated with this MIB Table.
MIB Table Name Name of the MIB table.
Family Command family to which this MIB table belongs.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp trap filter Displays the SNMP trap filter information.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-17


SNMP Commands

snmp trap absorption


Enables or disables the trap absorption function.
snmp trap absorption {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables SNMP trap absorption. When trap absorption is enabled,
identical, repetitive traps sent by applications during a pre-configured
time period will be absorbed, and therefore not sent to SNMP Manager
stations configured on the switch.
disable Disables SNMP trap absorption.

Defaults
By default, trap absorption is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
To view the current trap absorption status, use the show snmp trap config command.

Examples
-> snmp trap absorption enable
-> snmp trap absorption disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp trap config Displays the SNMP trap information. Information includes trap ID num-
bers and corresponding trap names and families.

MIB Objects
trapFilterTable
trapAbsorption

page 38-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

snmp trap to webview


Enables the forwarding of traps to WebView.
snmp trap to webview {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables WebView forwarding. When WebView forwarding is enabled,
all traps sent by switch applications are also forwarded to WebView.
This allows a WebView session to retrieve the trap history log.
disable Disables WebView forwarding.

Defaults
By default, WebView forwarding is enabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
To view the current WebView forwarding status, use the show snmp trap config command.

Examples
-> snmp trap to webview enable
-> snmp trap to webview disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp trap config Displays the SNMP trap information, including the current status for
trap absorption and WebView forwarding.

MIB Objects
trapFilterTable
trapToWebView

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-19


SNMP Commands

snmp trap replay


Replays stored traps from the switch to a specified SNMP station. This command is used to replay (to
resend) traps on demand. This is useful in the event when traps are lost in the network.
snmp trap replay {ip_address | ipv6_address} [seq_id]

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address for the SNMP station to which traps will be replayed
from the switch.
ipv6_address The IPv6 address for the SNMP station to which traps will be replayed
from the switch.
seq_id The sequence number from which trap replay will begin. Each trap sent
by the switch to an SNMP station has a sequence number. The sequence
number reflects the order in which the trap was sent to the SNMP
station. For example, the first trap sent to an SNMP station has a
sequence number of 1; the second trap has a sequence number of 2, etc.
If no sequence number is entered, all stored traps are replayed.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the show snmp station command on page page 38-5 to display the latest stored sequence number
for each SNMP station.
• The switch replays traps in the same order that they were previously sent, beginning from the specified
sequence number.
• When traps are replayed, the original dates on which the trap was issued, rather than the current dates
are used.
• If the specified sequence number is lower than the oldest trap sequence number stored in the switch,
the switch replays all stored traps.
• If the specified sequence number is equal to or greater than the oldest trap sequence number stored, the
switch replays all stored traps from the specified sequence number up to the latest sequence number.
• If the specified sequence number is greater than the latest sequence number, no traps are replayed..

Examples
-> snmp trap replay 172.12.2.100
-> snmp trap replay 300::1

page 38-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp station Displays the current SNMP station status.


show snmp trap replay Displays the SNMP trap replay information.

MIB Objects
trapStationTable
trapStation Replay
AlaTrapInetStationEntry
alaTrapInetStationReplay
alaTrapInetStationNextSeq

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-21


SNMP Commands

snmp trap filter


Enables or disables SNMP trap filtering. Trap filtering is used to determine whether a trap or group of
traps will be sent from the switch to a specified SNMP station.
snmp trap filter {ip_address | ipv6_address} trap_id_list
no snmp trap filter {ip_address | ipv6_address} trap_id_list

Syntax Definitions
ip_address The IP address for the SNMP station for which trap filtering is being
enabled or disabled.
ipv6_address The IPv6 address for the SNMP station for which trap filtering is being
enabled or disabled.
trap_id_list Specifies the trap(s) for which filtering is being enabled or disabled.
Traps must be specified using the numeric trap ID. You can specify
more than one trap in the command line; separate each trap ID with a
space and no comma.

Defaults
By default, SNMP trap filtering is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• To enable trap filtering, use the syntax snmp trap filter ip_address trap_id_list.

• To disable trap filtering, use the syntax no snmp trap filter ip_address trap_id_list.

• When filtering is enabled, the specified trap(s) will not be sent to the SNMP station. When filtering is
disabled, the specified traps will be sent to the SNMP station.
• To display a list of traps and their ID numbers, use the show snmp trap config command.

Examples
-> snmp trap filter 172.1.2.3 1
-> snmp trap filter 172.1.2.3 0 1 3 5
-> snmp trap filter 300::1 1 3 4
-> no snmp trap filter 172.1.2.3 1
-> no snmp trap filter 172.1.2.3 0 1 3 5
-> no snmp trap filter 300::1 1 3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 38-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

Related Commands

show snmp trap filter Displays the current SNMP trap filter status.
show snmp trap config Displays the SNMP trap information, including trap ID numbers, trap
names, command families, and absorption rate.

MIB Objects
trapFilterTable
trapFilterStatus
alaTrapInetFilterTable
alaTrapInetFilterStatus

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-23


SNMP Commands

snmp authentication trap


Enables or disables SNMP authentication failure trap forwarding.
snmp authentication trap {enable | disable}

Syntax Definitions
enable Enables authentication failure trap forwarding. When enabled, the
standard authentication failure trap is sent each time an SNMP
authentication failure is detected.
disable Disables authentication failure trap forwarding.

Defaults
By default, authentication failure trap forwarding is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> snmp authentication trap enable
-> snmp authentication trap disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

show snmp authentication trap Displays the current authentication failure trap forwarding status.

MIB Objects
snmpGroup
snmpEnableAuthenTraps

page 38-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp trap replay


Displays SNMP trap replay information.
show snmp trap replay

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
A maximum of 60 traps will be replayed.

Examples
-> show snmp trap replay
ipAddress oldest replay number
-----------------------------------------+--------------------
172.21.160.32 12
172.21.160.12 57
0300:0000:0000:0000:0211:d8ff:fe47:470b 12
0300:0000:0000:0000:0211:d8ff:fe47:470c 42

output definitions
IPAddress IP address of the SNMP station manager that replayed the trap.
Oldest Replay Number Number of the oldest replayed trap.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-25


SNMP Commands

Related Commands

snmp trap replay Replays stored traps from the switch to a specified SNMP station.

MIB Objects
trapStationTable
snmpStation Replay
AlaTrapInetStationEntry
alaTrapInetStationReplay
alaTrapInetStationNextSeq

page 38-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp trap filter


Displays the current SNMP trap filter status.
show snmp trap filter

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
To display a list of traps and their ID numbers, use the show snmp trap config command.

Examples
-> show snmp trap filter
ipAddress trapId list
-----------------------------------------+-----------------------------------
172.21.160.32 1 3 4
172.21.160.12 no filter
0300:0000:0000:0000:0211:d8ff:fe47:470b 4 5 6
0300:0000:0000:0000:0211:d8ff:fe47:470c no filter

output definitions
IPAddress IP address of the SNMP management station that recorded the traps.
TrapId List Identification number for the traps being filtered.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

snmp trap filter Enables or disables SNMP trap filtering.


show snmp trap config Displays the SNMP trap information, including trap ID numbers, trap
names, command families, and absorption rate.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-27


SNMP Commands

MIB Objects
trapFilterTable
trapFilterEntry
alaTrapInetFilterTable
alaTrapInetFilterStatus

page 38-28 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

show snmp authentication trap


Displays the current authentication failure trap forwarding status (i.e., enable or disable).
show snmp authentication trap

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show snmp authentication trap
snmp authentication trap = disable

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

snmp authentication trap Enables or disables SNMP authentication failure trap forwarding.

MIB Objects
sessionAuthenticationTrap

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-29


SNMP Commands

show snmp trap config


Displays SNMP trap information. Information includes trap ID numbers, trap names, command families,
and absorption rate. This command also displays the Enabled/Disabled status of SNMP absorption and the
Traps to WebView service.
show snmp trap config

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show snmp trap config
Absorption service : enabled
Traps to WebView : enabled
Id trapName family absorption
--+------------------------------------+---------------+------------
0 coldStart chassis 15 seconds
1 warmStart chassis 15 seconds
2 linkDown interface 15 seconds
3 linkUp interface 15 seconds
4 authenticationFailure snmp 15 seconds
5 entConfigChange module 15 seconds
30 slPesudoCAMStatusTrap bridge 15 seconds
34 ifMauJabberTrap interface 15 seconds
35 sessionAuthenticationTrap session 15 seconds
---------------------------------------------------------------------

output definitions
Id Identification number for the trap.
Trap Name Name of the trap.
Family Family to which the trap belongs.
Absorption Time needed for the trap to process.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 38-30 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


SNMP Commands

Related Commands

show snmp mib family Displays SNMP MIB information.


snmp trap absorption Enables or disables the trap absorption function.
snmp trap to webview Enables or disables the forwarding of SNMP traps to WebView.

MIB Objects
trapConfigTable
trapConfigEntry

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 38-31


SNMP Commands

page 38-32 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


39 DNS Commands

A Domain Name System resolver is an internet service that translates host names into IP addresses. Every
time you use a host name, a DNS service must resolve the name to an IP address. You can configure up to
three domain name servers. If the primary DNS server does not know how to translate a particular host
name, it asks the secondary DNS server (if specified). If this fails, it asks the third DNS server (if speci-
fied), until the correct IP address is returned (resolved). If all DNS servers have been queried and the name
is still not resolved to an IP address, the DNS resolver will fail and issue an error message.
MIB information for the DNS commands is as follows:
Filename: AlcatelIND1System.mib
Module: ALCATEL-IND1-SYSTEM.MIB
A summary of the available commands is listed here.

ip domain-lookup
ip name-server
ipv6 name-server
ip domain-name
show dns

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 39-1


DNS Commands

ip domain-lookup
Enables or disables the DNS resolver.
ip domain-lookup
no ip domain-lookup

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
By default, the DNS resolver is disabled.

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to disable the DNS resolver.

• You must use the ip domain-name command to set a default domain name for your DNS resolver(s)
and the ip name-server command to specify up to three DNS servers to query on host lookups.
• The ip domain-lookup command enables the DNS resolver.

Examples
-> ip domain-lookup
-> no ip domain-lookup

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip name-server Specifies the IP addresses of up to three servers to query on a host


lookup.
ipv6 name-server Specifies the IPv6 addresses of up to three IPv6 DNS servers to query
on a host lookup.
ip domain-name Sets or deletes the default domain name for DNS lookups.
show dns Displays the current DNS resolver configuration and status.

MIB Objects
systemDNS
systemDNSEnableDnsResolver

page 39-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DNS Commands

ip name-server
Specify the IP addresses of up to three servers to query on a host lookup.
ip name-server server-address1 [server-address2 [server-address3]]

Syntax Definitions
server-address1 The IP address of the primary DNS server to query for host lookup. This
is the only address that is required.
server-address2 The IP address of the secondary DNS server to query for host lookup.
This server will be queried only if the desired host name or host IP
address is not located by the primary DNS server. A second IP address
is optional.
server-address3 The IP address of the DNS server with the lower priority. This server
will be queried only if the desired host name or IP address is not located
by the primary and secondary DNS servers. A third IP address is
optional.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Configuration of the DNS resolver to resolve any host query requires that you first set the default
domain name with the ip domain-name command and enable the DNS resolver function with the ip
domain-lookup command before you specify the IP addresses of the DNS servers by using the ip
name-server command.
• You can configure up to three IPv4 DNS servers and three IPv6 DNS servers in a switch.

Examples
-> ip name-server 189.202.191.14 189.202.191.15 188.255.19.1
-> ip name-server 10.255.11.66

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 39-3


DNS Commands

Related Commands

ip domain-lookup Enables or disables the DNS resolver.


ip domain-name Sets or deletes the default domain name for DNS lookups.
show dns Displays the current DNS resolver configuration and status.

MIB Objects
systemDNS
systemDNSNsAddr1
systemDNSNsAddr2
systemDNSNsAddr3

page 39-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DNS Commands

ipv6 name-server
Specifies the IPv6 addresses of up to three IPv6 DNS servers to query on a host lookup.
ipv6 name-server server-ipv6_address1 [server-ipv6_address2 [server-ipv6_address3]]

Syntax Definitions
server-ipv6_address1 The IPv6 address of the primary IPv6 DNS server to query for host
lookup. Specifying the primary IPv6 DNS address is mandatory.
server-ipv6_address2 The IPv6 address of the secondary IPv6 DNS server to query for host
lookup. This server will be queried only if the desired host name is not
able to be resolved by the primary IPv6 DNS server. A second IPv6
address is optional.
server-ipv6_address3 The IPv6 address of the IPv6 DNS server with the lower priority. This
server will be queried only if the desired host name is not able to be
resolved by both the primary and secondary IPv6 DNS servers. A third
IPv6 address is optional.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Configuration of the DNS resolver to resolve any host query requires that you first set the default
domain name with the ip domain-name command and enable the DNS resolver function with the ip
domain-lookup command before you specify the IPv6 addresses of the IPv6 DNS servers by using the
ipv6 name-server command.
• You cannot use multicast, loopback, link-local and unspecified IPv6 addresses for specifying IPv6
DNS servers.
• You can configure up to three IPv6 DNS servers and three IPv4 DNS servers in a switch.

Examples
-> ipv6 name-server fec0::2d0:d3:f3fc
-> ipv6 name-server fe2d::2c f302::3de1:1 f1bc::202:fd40:f3

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 39-5


DNS Commands

Related Commands

ip domain-lookup Enables or disables the DNS resolver.


ip domain-name Sets or deletes the default domain name for DNS lookups.
show dns Displays the current DNS resolver configuration and status.

MIB Objects
systemDNS
systemDNSNsIPv6Addr1
systemDNSNsIPv6Addr2
systemDNSNsIPv6Addr3

page 39-6 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DNS Commands

ip domain-name
Sets or deletes the default domain name for DNS lookups.
ip domain-name name
no ip domain-name

Syntax Definitions
name The default domain name for host lookups.

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
• Use the no form of this command to delete the default domain name.

• Use this command to set the default domain name for DNS lookups.

Examples
-> ip domain-name company.com
-> no ip domain-name

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

Related Commands

ip domain-lookup Enables or disables the DNS resolver.


ip name-server Specifies the IP addresses of up to three servers to query on a host
lookup.
ipv6 name-server Specifies the IPv6 addresses of up to three IPv6 DNS servers to query
on a host lookup.
show dns Displays the current DNS resolver configuration and status.

MIB Objects
systemDNS
systemDNSDomainName

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 39-7


DNS Commands

show dns
Displays the current DNS resolver configuration and status.
show dns

Syntax Definitions
N/A

Defaults
N/A

Platforms Supported
OmniSwitch 6450

Usage Guidelines
N/A

Examples
-> show dns
Resolver is : enabled
domainName : company.com
IPv4 nameServer(s): 189.202.191.14
: 189.202.191.15
: 188.255.19.1
IPv6 nameServer(s): fe2d::2c
: f302::3de1:1
: f1bc::202:fd40:f3

output definitions
Resolver is Indicates whether the DNS resolver is enabled or disabled.
domainName Indicates the default domain name assigned to the DNS lookups. This
value is set using the ip domain-name command.
IPv4 nameServer(s) Indicates the IP address(es) of the IPv4 DNS server(s). These addresses
are set using the ip name-server command.
IPv6 nameServer(s) Indicates the IPv6 address(es) of the IPv6 DNS server(s). These
addresses are set using the ipv6 name-server command.

Release History
Release 6.6.1; command was introduced.

page 39-8 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


DNS Commands

Related Commands

ip domain-lookup Enables or disables the DNS resolver.


ip name-server Specifies the IP addresses of up to three servers to query on a host
lookup.
ipv6 name-server Specify the IPv6 addresses of up to three IPv6 DNS servers to query on
a host lookup.
ip domain-name Sets or deletes the default domain name for DNS lookups.

MIB Objects
systemDNS
systemDNSEnableDnsResolver
systemDNSDomainName
systemDNSNsAddr1
systemDNSNsAddr2
systemDNSNsAddr3
systemDNSNsIPv6Addr1
systemDNSNsIPv6Addr2
systemDNSNsIPv6Addr3

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 39-9


DNS Commands

page 39-10 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


A Software License
and Copyright Statements

This appendix contains Alcatel-Lucent and third-party software vendor license and copyright statements.

Alcatel-Lucent License Agreement


ALCATEL-LUCENT SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT

IMPORTANT. Please read the terms and conditions of this license agreement carefully before opening
this package.

By opening this package, you accept and agree to the terms of this license agreement. If you are not
willing to be bound by the terms of this license agreement, do not open this package. Please
promptly return the product and any materials in unopened form to the place where you obtained it
for a full refund.
1. License Grant. This is a license, not a sales agreement, between you (the “Licensee”) and Alcatel-
Lucent. Alcatel-Lucent hereby grants to Licensee, and Licensee accepts, a non-exclusive license to use
program media and computer software contained therein (the “Licensed Files”) and the accompanying
user documentation (collectively the “Licensed Materials”), only as authorized in this License Agreement.
Licensee, subject to the terms of this License Agreement, may use one copy of the Licensed Files on the
Licensee’s system. Licensee agrees not to assign, sublicense, transfer, pledge, lease, rent, or share their
rights under this License Agreement. Licensee may retain the program media for backup purposes with
retention of the copyright and other proprietary notices. Except as authorized under this paragraph, no
copies of the Licensed Materials or any portions thereof may be made by Licensee and Licensee shall not
modify, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, or otherwise attempt to derive the Source Code.
Licensee is also advised that Alcatel-Lucent products contain embedded software known as firmware
which resides in silicon. Licensee may not copy the firmware or transfer the firmware to another medium.
2. Alcatel-Lucent’s Rights. Licensee acknowledges and agrees that the Licensed Materials are the sole
property of Alcatel-Lucent and its licensors (herein “its licensors”), protected by U.S. copyright law, trade-
mark law, and are licensed on a right to use basis. Licensee further acknowledges and agrees that all rights,
title, and interest in and to the Licensed Materials are and shall remain with Alcatel-Lucent and its licen-
sors and that no such right, license, or interest shall be asserted with respect to such copyrights and trade-
marks. This License Agreement does not convey to Licensee an interest in or to the Licensed Materials,
but only a limited right to use revocable in accordance with the terms of this License Agreement.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-11


Alcatel-Lucent License Agreement Software License and Copyright Statements

3. Confidentiality. Alcatel-Lucent considers the Licensed Files to contain valuable trade secrets of Alca-
tel-Lucent, the unauthorized disclosure of which could cause irreparable harm to Alcatel-Lucent. Except as
expressly set forth herein, Licensee agrees to use reasonable efforts not to disclose the Licensed Files to
any third party and not to use the Licensed Files other than for the purpose authorized by this License
Agreement. This confidentiality obligation shall continue after any termination of this License Agreement.
4. Indemnity. Licensee agrees to indemnify, defend and hold Alcatel-Lucent harmless from any claim,
lawsuit, legal proceeding, settlement or judgment (including without limitation Alcatel-Lucent’s reason-
able United States and local attorneys’ and expert witnesses’ fees and costs) arising out of or in connec-
tion with the unauthorized copying, marketing, performance or distribution of the Licensed Files.
5. Limited Warranty. Alcatel-Lucent warrants, for Licensee’s benefit alone, that the program media
shall, for a period of ninety (90) days from the date of commencement of this License Agreement (referred
to as the Warranty Period), be free from defects in material and workmanship. Alcatel-Lucent further
warrants, for Licensee benefit alone, that during the Warranty Period the Licensed Files shall operate
substantially in accordance with the functional specifications in the User Guide. If during the Warranty
Period, a defect in the Licensed Files appears, Licensee may return the Licensed Files to Alcatel-Lucent
for either replacement or, if so elected by Alcatel-Lucent, refund of amounts paid by Licensee under this
License Agreement. EXCEPT FOR THE WARRANTIES SET FORTH ABOVE, THE LICENSED
MATERIALS ARE LICENSED “AS IS” AND ALCATEL-LUCENT AND ITS LICENSORS
DISCLAIM ANY AND ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUD-
ING (WITHOUT LIMITATION) ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. SOME STATES DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION
OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES SO THE ABOVE EXCLUSIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO LICENSEE.
THIS WARRANTY GIVES THE LICENSEE SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS. LICENSEE MAY ALSO
HAVE OTHER RIGHTS WHICH VARY FROM STATE TO STATE.
6. Limitation of Liability. Alcatel-Lucent’s cumulative liability to Licensee or any other party for any
loss or damages resulting from any claims, demands, or actions arising out of or relating to this License
Agreement shall not exceed the license fee paid to Alcatel-Lucent for the Licensed Materials. IN NO
EVENT SHALL ALCATEL-LUCENT BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, CONSE-
QUENTIAL, SPECIAL, OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES OR LOST PROFITS, EVEN IF ALCATEL-
LUCENT HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. SOME STATES DO
NOT ALLOW THE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION OF LIABILITY FOR INCIDENTAL OR CONSE-
QUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION TO INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES MAY NOT APPLY TO LICENSEE.
7. Export Control. This product is subject to the jurisdiction of the United States. Licensee may not
export or reexport the Licensed Files, without complying with all United States export laws and regula-
tions, including but not limited to (i) obtaining prior authorization from the U.S. Department of Commerce
if a validated export license is required, and (ii) obtaining “written assurances” from licensees, if required.
8. Support and Maintenance. Except as may be provided in a separate agreement between Alcatel-
Lucent and Licensee, if any, Alcatel-Lucent is under no obligation to maintain or support the copies of the
Licensed Files made and distributed hereunder and Alcatel-Lucent has no obligation to furnish Licensee
with any further assistance, documentation or information of any nature or kind.
9. Term. This License Agreement is effective upon Licensee opening this package and shall continue until
terminated. Licensee may terminate this License Agreement at any time by returning the Licensed Materi-
als and all copies thereof and extracts therefrom to Alcatel-Lucent and certifying to Alcatel-Lucent in writ-
ing that all Licensed Materials and all copies thereof and extracts therefrom have been returned or erased
by the memory of Licensee’s computer or made non-readable. Alcatel-Lucent may terminate this License
Agreement upon the breach by Licensee of any term hereof. Upon such termination by Alcatel-Lucent,
Licensee agrees to return to Alcatel-Lucent or destroy the Licensed Materials and all copies and portions
thereof.

page A-12 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Alcatel-Lucent License Agreement

10. Governing Law. This License Agreement shall be construed and governed in accordance with the
laws of the State of California.
11. Severability. Should any term of this License Agreement be declared void or unenforceable by any
court of competent jurisdiction, such declaration shall have no effect on the remaining terms herein.
12. No Waiver. The failure of either party to enforce any rights granted hereunder or to take action against
the other party in the event of any breach hereunder shall not be deemed a waiver by that party as to
subsequent enforcement of rights or subsequent actions in the event of future breaches.
13. Notes to United States Government Users. Software and documentation are provided with restricted
rights. Use, duplication or disclosure by the government is subject to (i) restrictions set forth in GSA ADP
Schedule Contract with Alcatel-Lucent’s reseller(s), or (ii) restrictions set forth in subparagraph (c) (1)
and (2) of 48 CFR 52.227-19, as applicable.
14.Third Party Materials. Licensee is notified that the Licensed Files contain third party software and
materials licensed to Alcatel-Lucent by certain third party licensors. Some third party licensors (e.g., Wind
River and their licensors with respect to the Run-Time Module) are third part beneficiaries to this License
Agreement with full rights of enforcement. Please refer to the section entitled “Third Party Licenses and
Notices” on page A-14 for the third party license and notice terms.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-13


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

Third Party Licenses and Notices


The licenses and notices related only to such third party software are set forth below:

A. Booting and Debugging Non-Proprietary Software


A small, separate software portion aggregated with the core software in this product and primarily used for
initial booting and debugging constitutes non-proprietary software, some of which may be obtained in
source code format from Alcatel-Lucent for a limited period of time. Alcatel-Lucent will provide a
machine-readable copy of the applicable non-proprietary software to any requester for a cost of copying,
shipping and handling. This offer will expire 3 years from the date of the first shipment of this product.

B. The OpenLDAP Public License: Version 2.8, 17 August 2003


Redistribution and use of this software and associated documentation (“Software”), with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1 Redistributions of source code must retain copyright statements and notices.

2 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce applicable copyright statements and notices, this list of
conditions, and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
distribution.
3 Redistributions must contain a verbatim copy of this document.

4 The names and trademarks of the authors and copyright holders must not be used in advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealing in this Software without specific, written prior permis-
sion.
5 Due credit should be given to the OpenLDAP Project.

6 The OpenLDAP Foundation may revise this license from time to time. Each revision is distinguished
by a version number. You may use the Software under terms of this license revision or under the terms of
any subsequent revision of the license.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OPENLDAP FOUNDATION AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS
IS” AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OPENLDAP FOUNDATION OR ITS
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEM-
PLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCURE-
MENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
OpenLDAP is a trademark of the OpenLDAP Foundation.
Copyright 1999-2000 The OpenLDAP Foundation, Redwood City,
California, USA. All Rights Reserved. Permission to copy and
distributed verbatim copies of this document is granted.

page A-14 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Third Party Licenses and Notices

C. Linux
Linux is written and distributed under the GNU General Public License which means that its source code
is freely-distributed and available to the general public.

D. GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE: Version 2, June 1991


Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is
not allowed.

Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By
contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This General Public License applies to most of
the Free Software Foundation’s software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it.
(Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public License
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this
service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the soft-
ware or use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask
you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute
copies of the software, or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the
recipients all the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source
code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and (2) offer you this license which
gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software.
Also, for each author’s protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone understands that there
is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we want
its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so that any problems introduced by others
will not reflect on the original authors’ reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that
redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the program
proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone’s free use
or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.

GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING,


DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0 This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed by the copyright
holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this General Public License. The “Program”, below,
refers to any such program or work, and a “work based on the Program” means either the Program or any
derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it, either

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-15


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is
included without limitation in the term “modification”.) Each licensee is addressed as “you”.
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are
outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program is
covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the Program (independent of having been made by
running the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
1 You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program’s source code as you receive it, in any
medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copy-
right notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the
absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License along with
the Program.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer
warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2 You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on
the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above,
provided that you also meet all of these conditions:

a You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and
the date of any change.

b You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in whole or in part contains or is
derived from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third parties
under the terms of this License.

c If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run, you must cause it, when
started running for such interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an announcement
including an appropriate copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you
provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these conditions, and telling the
user how to view a copy of this License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but does not
normally print such an announcement, your work based on the Program is not required to print an
announcement.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in them-
selves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as sepa-
rate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the
Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other
licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. Thus, it is
not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather,
the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the
Program.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the Program (or with a work
based on the Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work
under the scope of this License.

3 You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, under Section 2) in object code or
executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:

a Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must be
distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software inter-
change; or,

page A-16 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Third Party Licenses and Notices

b Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give any third party, for a charge
no more than your cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete machine-readable
copy of the corresponding source code, to be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a
medium customarily used for software interchange; or,

c Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute corresponding source
code. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you received the
program in object code or executable form with such an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For an
executable work, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the
executable. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so
on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the
executable.
If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place,
then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place counts as distribution of the
source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
4 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as expressly provided under
this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will
automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or
rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain
in full compliance.
5 You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants
you permission to modify or distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited
by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Program (or any
work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms and
conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or works based on it.
6 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the Program), the recipient automati-
cally receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the
rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this License.
7 If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason
(not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or other-
wise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this
License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and
any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Program at all. For
example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by all those who
receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this
License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circum-
stances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or
to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the
free software distribution system, which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have
made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-17


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distrib-
ute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this
License.
8 If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Program under this License may add
an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted
only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if
written in the body of this License.
9 The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the General Public License
from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in
detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies a version number of this
License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the option of following the terms and condi-
tions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the
Program does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published by
the Free Software Foundation.
10 If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose distribution conditions
are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Soft-
ware Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our
decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free soft-
ware and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
11 BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR
THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
PROVIDE THE PROGRAM “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO
THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
12 IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARIS-
ING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES
SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE
WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS

page A-18 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Third Party Licenses and Notices

Appendix: How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs


If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, the best way
to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source
file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the “copy-
right” line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
<one line to give the program’s name and a brief idea of what it does.> Copyright (C)
19yy <name of author>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of
the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this
program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge,
MA 02139, USA.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode:
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) 19yy name of author Gnomovision comes with
ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type ‘show w’. This is free software,
and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type ‘show c’ for details.
The hypothetical commands ‘show w’ and ‘show c’ should show the appropriate parts of the General
Public License. Of course, the commands you use may be called something other than ‘show w’ and
‘show c’; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your program.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a “copy-
right disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program ‘Gnomovision’
(which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
Ty Coon, President of Vice
This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into proprietary programs. If
your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary appli-
cations with the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General Public License
instead of this License.
URLWatch:
For notice when this page changes, fill in your email address.
Maintained by: Webmaster, Linux Online Inc.
Last modified: 09-Aug-2000 02:03AM.
Views since 16-Aug-2000: 177203.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-19


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

Material copyright Linux Online Inc.


Design and compilation copyright (c)1994-2002 Linux Online Inc.
Linux is a registered trademark of Linus Torvalds
Tux the Penguin, featured in our logo, was created by Larry Ewing
Consult our privacy statement
URLWatch provided by URLWatch Services.
All rights reserved.

E. University of California
Provided with this product is certain TCP input and Telnet client software developed by the University of
California, Berkeley.
Copyright (C) 1987. The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms are permitted provided that the above copyright notice
and this paragraph are duplicated in all such forms and that any documentation, advertising materials, and
other materials related to such distribution and use acknowledge that the software was developed by the
University of California, Berkeley. The name of the University may not be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTIBILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

F. Carnegie-Mellon University
Provided with this product is certain BOOTP Relay software developed by Carnegie-Mellon University.

G. Random.c
PR 30872 B Kesner created May 5 2000
PR 30872 B Kesner June 16 2000 moved batch_entropy_process to own task iWhirlpool to make code
more efficient
random.c -- A strong random number generator
Version 1.89, last modified 19-Sep-99
Copyright Theodore Ts’o, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, and the entire permission notice
in its entirety, including the disclaimer of warranties.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
without specific prior written permission. ALTERNATIVELY, this product may be distributed under the
terms of the GNU Public License, in which case the provisions of the GPL are required INSTEAD OF the

page A-20 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Third Party Licenses and Notices

above restrictions. (This clause is necessary due to a potential bad interaction between the GPL and the
restrictions contained in a BSD-style copyright.)
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ALL OF WHICH ARE HEREBY DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROF-
ITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABIL-
ITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF NOT
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

H. Apptitude, Inc.
Provided with this product is certain network monitoring software (“MeterWorks/RMON”) licensed from
Apptitude, Inc., whose copyright notice is as follows: Copyright (C) 1997-1999 by Apptitude, Inc. All
Rights Reserved. Licensee is notified that Apptitude, Inc. (formerly, Technically Elite, Inc.), a California
corporation with principal offices at 6330 San Ignacio Avenue, San Jose, California, is a third party bene-
ficiary to the Software License Agreement. The provisions of the Software License Agreement as applied
to MeterWorks/RMON are made expressly for the benefit of Apptitude, Inc., and are enforceable by
Apptitude, Inc. in addition to Alcatel-Lucent. IN NO EVENT SHALL APPTITUDE, INC. OR ITS
SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES, INCLUDING COSTS OF PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE PRODUCTS OR SERVICES, LOST PROFITS, OR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT,
CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY
OF LIABILITY, ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THIS AGREEMENT.

I. Agranat
Provided with this product is certain web server software (“EMWEB PRODUCT”) licensed from Agranat
Systems, Inc. (“Agranat”). Agranat has granted to Alcatel-Lucent certain warranties of performance,
which warranties [or portion thereof] Alcatel-Lucent now extends to Licensee. IN NO EVENT,
HOWEVER, SHALL AGRANAT BE LIABLE TO LICENSEE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF LICENSEE OR A THIRD PARTY AGAINST LICENSEE ARIS-
ING OUT OF, OR IN CONNECTION WITH, THIS DISTRIBUTION OF EMWEB PRODUCT TO
LICENSEE. In case of any termination of the Software License Agreement between Alcatel-Lucent and
Licensee, Licensee shall immediately return the EMWEB Product and any back-up copy to Alcatel-
Lucent, and will certify to Alcatel-Lucent in writing that all EMWEB Product components and any copies
of the software have been returned or erased by the memory of Licensee’s computer or made non-read-
able.

J. RSA Security Inc.


Provided with this product is certain security software (“RSA Software”) licensed from RSA Security Inc.
RSA SECURITY INC. PROVIDES RSA SOFTWARE “AS IS” WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY WHAT-
SOEVER. RSA SECURITY INC. DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STAT-
UTORY, AS TO ANY MATTER WHATSOEVER INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF
THIRD PARTY RIGHTS.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-21


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

K. Sun Microsystems, Inc.


This product contains Coronado ASIC, which includes a component derived from designs licensed from
Sun Microsystems, Inc.

L. Wind River Systems, Inc.


Provided with this product is certain software (“Run-Time Module”) licensed from Wind River Systems,
Inc. Licensee is prohibited from: (i) copying the Run-Time Module, except for archive purposes consis-
tent with Licensee’s archive procedures; (ii) transferring the Run-Time Module to a third party apart from
the product; (iii) modifying, decompiling, disassembling, reverse engineering or otherwise attempting to
derive the source code of the Run-Time Module; (iv) exporting the Run-Time Module or underlying tech-
nology in contravention of applicable U.S. and foreign export laws and regulations; and (v) using the Run-
Time Module other than in connection with operation of the product. In addition, please be advised that:
(i) the Run-Time Module is licensed, not sold and that Alcatel-Lucent and its licensors retain ownership of
all copies of the Run-Time Module; (ii) WIND RIVER DISCLAIMS ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, (iii) The SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT
EXCLUDES LIABILITY FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT, PUNITIVE, INCIDENTAL AND CONSE-
QUENTIAL DAMAGES; and (iv) any further distribution of the Run-Time Module shall be subject to the
same restrictions set forth herein. With respect to the Run-Time Module, Wind River and its licensors are
third party beneficiaries of the License Agreement and the provisions related to the Run-Time Module are
made expressly for the benefit of, and are enforceable by, Wind River and its licensors.

M.Network Time Protocol Version 4


The following copyright notice applies to all files collectively called the Network Time Protocol Version 4
Distribution. Unless specifically declared otherwise in an individual file, this notice applies as if the text
was explicitly included in the file.
***********************************************************************
* *
* Copyright (c) David L. Mills 1992-2003 *
* *
* Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and *
* its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby *
* granted, provided that the above copyright notice appears in all *
* copies and that both the copyright notice and this permission *
* notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name *
* University of Delaware not be used in advertising or publicity *
* pertaining to distribution of the software without specific, *
* written prior permission. The University of Delaware makes no *
* representations about the suitability this software for any *
* purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied *
* warranty. *
* *
*************************************************************************

page A-22 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Third Party Licenses and Notices

N.Remote-ni
Provided with this product is a file (part of GDB), the GNU debugger and is licensed from Free Software
Foundation, Inc., whose copyright notice is as follows: Copyright (C) 1989, 1991, 1992 by Free Software
Foundation, Inc. Licensee can redistribute this software and modify it under the terms of General Public
License as published by Free Software Foundation Inc.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without
even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
See the GNU General Public License for more details.

O.GNU Zip
GNU Zip -- A compression utility which compresses the files with zip algorithm.
Copyright (C) 1992-1993 Jean-loup Gailly.
BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR
THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO
THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
REPAIR OR CORRECTION.

P. FREESCALE SEMICONDUCTOR SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT


Provided with this product is a software also known as DINK32 (Dynamic Interactive Nano Kernel for
32-bit processors) solely in conjunction with the development and marketing of your products which use
and incorporate microprocessors which implement the PowerPC (TM) architecture manufactured by
Motorola. The licensee comply with all of the following restrictions:
1. This entire notice is retained without alteration in any modified and/or redistributed versions.
2. The modified versions are clearly identified as such. No licenses are granted by implication, estoppel or
otherwise under any patents or trademarks of Motorola, Inc.
The SOFTWARE is provided on an "AS IS" basis and without warranty. To the maximum extent permit-
ted by applicable law, MOTOROLA DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WHETHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND ANY WARRANTY AGAINST INFRINGEMENT WITH REGARD
TO THE SOFTWARE (INCLUDING ANY MODIFIED VERSIONS THEREOF) AND ANY ACCOM-
PANYING WRITTEN MATERIALS.To the maximum extent permitted by applicable law, IN NO
EVENT SHALL MOTOROLA BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER.
Copyright (C) Motorola, Inc. 1989-2001 All rights reserved.
Version 13.1

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-23


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

Q.Boost C++ Libraries


Provided with this product is free peer-reviewed portable C++ source libraries.
Version 1.33.1

Copyright (C) by Beman Dawes, David Abrahams, 1998-2003. All rights reserved.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE AND NON-
INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE
DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.

R. U-Boot
Provided with this product is a software licensed from Free Software Foundation Inc. This is used as OS
Bootloader; and located in on-board flash. This product is standalone and not linked (statically or dynami-
cally) to any other software.
Version 1.1.0
Copyright (C) 2000-2004. All rights reserved.

S. Solaris
Provided with this product is free software; Licensee can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of
the GNU General Public License.
Copyright (C) 1992-1993 Jean-loup Gailly. All rights reserved.

T. Internet Protocol Version 6


Copyright (C) 1982, 1986, 1990, 1991, 1993. The Regents of the University of California.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permit-
ted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of condi-
tions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the
following acknowledgement: This product includes software developed by the University of
California, Berkeley and its contributors.

page A-24 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Software License and Copyright Statements Third Party Licenses and Notices

4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be used to
endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written
permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS'' AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE. FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL.
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS.
OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION). HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT. LIABIL-
ITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF
THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The copyright of the products such as crypto, dhcp, net, netinet, netinet6, netley, netwrs, libinet6 are same
as that of the internet protocol version 6.

U. CURSES
Copyright (C) 1987. The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms are permitted provided that the above copyright notice
and this paragraph are duplicated in all such forms and that any documentation, advertising materials, and
other materials related to such distribution and use acknowledge that the software was developed by the
University of California, Berkeley. The name of the University may not be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

V. ZModem
Provided with this product is a program or code that can be used without any restriction.
Copyright (C) 1986 Gary S. Brown. All rights reserved.

W.Boost Software License


Provided with this product is reference implementation, so that the Boost libraries are suit-
able for eventual standardization. Boost works on any modern operating system, including UNIX and
Windows variants.
Version 1.0
Copyright (C) Gennadiy Rozental 2005. All rights reserved.

X. OpenLDAP
Provided with this software is an open source implementation of the Lightweight Directory Access Proto-
col (LDAP).
Version 3
Copyright (C) 1990, 1998, 1999, Regents of the University of Michigan, A. Hartgers, Juan C. Gomez. All
rights reserved.

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page A-25


Third Party Licenses and Notices Software License and Copyright Statements

This software is not subject to any license of Eindhoven University of Technology.Redistribution and use
in source and binary forms are permitted only as authorized by the OpenLDAP Public License.
This software is not subject to any license of Silicon Graphics Inc.or Purdue University. Redistribution and
use in source and binary forms are permitted without restriction or fee of any kind as long as this notice is
preserved.

Y. BITMAP.C
Provided with this product is a program for personal and non-profit use.
Copyright (C) Allen I. Holub, All rights reserved.

Z. University of Toronto
Provided with this product is a code that is modified specifically for use with the STEVIE editor. Permis-
sion is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose on any computer system, and to redistribute
it freely, subject to the following restrictions:
1. The author is not responsible for the consequences of use of this software, no matter how awful, even if
they arise from defects in it.
2.The origin of this software must not be misrepresented, either by explicit claim or by omission.
3. Altered versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be misrepresented as being the original
software.
Version 1.5
Copyright (C) 1986 by University of Toronto and written by Henry Spencer.

AA.Free/OpenBSD
Copyright (c) 1982, 1986, 1990, 1991, 1993 The Regents of University of California. All Rights Reserved.

page A-26 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


CLI Quick Reference show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} accounting
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} counters
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} counters errors
Ethernet Port Commands show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} collisions
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} traffic
trap slot[/port[-port2]] port link {enable | disable | on | off} show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} port
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] speed {auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | 10000 | max {100 | 1000}} show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} flood rate
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} ifg
autoneg {enable | disable | on | off}
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] crossover {auto | mdix | mdi} Source Learning
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] pause {rx | tx-and-rx | disable}
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] duplex {full | half | auto}
Commands
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] admin {up | down} mac-address-table [permanent] mac_address {slot/port | linkagg link_agg} vid [bridging |
interfaces slot/port alias description filtering]
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] ifg bytes no mac-address-table [permanent | learned] [mac_address {slot/port | linkagg link_agg}
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] no l2 statistics vid]
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] max frame bytes mac-address-table static-multicast multicast_address {slot1/port1[-port1a] [slot2/port2[-
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] flood multicast {enable | disable} port2a]...] | linkagg link_agg} vid
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] flood rate Mbps no mac-address-table static-multicast [multicast_address {slot1/port1[-port1a] [slot2/port2[-
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] clear-violation-all port2a]...] | linkagg link_agg} vid]
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid {fiber | copper} autoneg {enable | disable | on | off} mac-address-table aging-time seconds
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid copper crossover {auto | mdix | mdi} no mac-address-table aging-time
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid {fiber | copper} duplex {full | half | auto} source-learning {port slot/port1[-port2] | linkagg linkagg_num} {enable | disable}
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] speed hybrid {fiber | copper} {auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | 10000 | max show mac-address-table [permanent | learned] [mac_address] [slot slot | slot/port] [linkagg
{100 | 1000}} link_agg] [vid | vid1-vid2]
interfaces slot[/port[-port2]] hybrid {fiber | copper} pause {rx | tx-and-rx | disable} show mac-address-table static-multicast [multicast_address] [slot slot | slot/port] [linkagg
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] link_agg] [vid | vid1-vid2]
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] capability show mac-address-table count [mac_address] [slot slot | slot/port] [linkagg link_agg] [vid |
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] flow [control] vid1-vid2]
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] pause show mac-address-table aging-time
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] accounting show source-learning [port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg linkagg_num]
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] counters
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] counters errors VLAN Management Commands
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] collisions
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] status vlan vid [enable | disable] [name description]
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] port no vlan vid
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] ifg vlan vid [1x1 | flat] stp {enable | disable}
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] flood rate vlan vid mobile-tag {enable | disable}
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] traffic vlan vid port default {slot/port | link_agg}
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} vlan vid no port default {slot/port | link_agg}
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} status show vlan [vid]
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} flow control show vlan [vid] port [slot/port | link_agg]
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} pause show vlan router mac status
show interfaces [slot[/port[-port2]]] hybrid {fiber |copper} capability show vlan gvrp [vlan-id | vlan-range]

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 1 Ethernet Port Commands
show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id | ipmvlan-id1-ipmvlan-id2] bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority
802.1Q Commands bridge msti msti_id {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} priority priority
vlan vid 802.1q {slot/port | aggregate_id} [description] bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost
vlan vid no 802.1q {slot/port | aggregate_id} bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost
vlan 802.1q slot/port frame type {all | tagged} bridge mist msti_id {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost
show 802.1q {slot/port | aggregate_id} bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} path cost path_cost
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} mode {forwarding | blocking | dynamic}
Distributed Spanning bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} mode {dynamic | blocking | forwarding}
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} mode {dynamic | blocking | forwarding}
Tree Commands bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} connection {noptp | ptp | autoptp | edgeport}
bridge mode {flat | 1x1} bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} connection {noptp | ptp | autoptp | edgeport}
bridge [instance] protocol {stp | rstp | mstp} bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} connection {noptp | ptp | autoptp | edgeport}
bridge cist protocol {stp | rstp | mstp} bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} admin-edge {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge 1x1 vid protocol {stp | rstp} bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} admin-edge {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge mst region name name bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} auto-edge {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge mst region no name bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} auto-edge {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge mst region revision level rev_level bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} {restricted-role | root-guard} {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge mst region max hops max_hops bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} {restricted-role | root-guard} {on | off | enable |
bridge msti msti_id [name name] disable}
bridge no msti msti_id bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} restricted-tcn {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge msti msti_id no name bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} restricted-tcn {on | off | enable | disable}
bridge msti msti_id vlan vid_range bridge cist txholdcount value
bridge msti msti_id no vlan vid_range bridge 1x1 vid txholdcount {value}
bridge [instance] priority priority bridge rrstp
bridge cist priority priority no bridge rrstp
bridge msti msti_id priority priority bridge rrstp ring ring_id port1 {slot/port | linkagg agg_num} port2
bridge 1x1 vid priority priority {slot/port | linkagg agg_num} vlan-tag vlan_id [status {enable | disable}]
bridge [instance] hello time seconds no bridge rrstp ring [ring_id]
bridge cist hello time seconds bridge rrstp ring ring_id vlan-tag vid
bridge 1x1 vid hello time seconds bridge rrstp ring ring_id status {enable | disable}
bridge [instance] max age seconds show spantree [instance]
bridge cist max age seconds show spantree cist
bridge 1x1 vid max age seconds show spantree msti [msti_id]
bridge [instance] forward delay seconds show spantree 1x1 [vid]
bridge cist forward delay seconds show spantree [instance] ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]
bridge 1x1 vid forward delay seconds show spantree cist ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]
bridge [instance] bpdu-switching {enable | disable} show spantree msti [msti_id] ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]
bridge path cost mode {auto | 32bit} show spantree 1x1 [vid] ports [forwarding | blocking | active | configured]
bridge [msti msti_id] auto-vlan-containment {enable | disable} show spantree mst region
bridge instance {slot/port | logical_port} {enable | disable} show spantree mst [msti_id] vlan-map
bridge cist {slot/port | logical_port} {enable | disable} show spantree cist vlan-map
bridge 1x1 vid {slot/port | logical_port} {enable | disable} show spantree mst vid vlan-map

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 2 802.1Q Commands
show spantree mst port {slot/port | logical_port} lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
show bridge rrstp configuration no actor system priority
show bridge rrstp ring [ring_id] lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin state
bridge mode 1x1 pvst+ {enable | disable} {[active] [timeout] [aggregate] [synchronize] [collect] [distribute] [default] [expire] |
bridge port {slot/port | agg_num} pvst+ {auto | enable | disable} none}
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin state
{[[no] active] [[no] timeout] [[no] aggregate] [[no] synchronize] [[no] collect] [[no]
Link Aggregation Commands distribute]
[[no] default] [[no] expire] | none}
static linkagg agg_num size size [name name] [admin state {enable | disable}] lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin system id
no static linkagg agg_num partner_admin_system_id
static linkagg agg_num name name lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
static linkagg agg_num no name no partner admin system id
static linkagg agg_num admin state {enable | disable} lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin key
static agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port agg num agg_num partner_admin_key
static agg no [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port no partner admin key
lacp linkagg agg_num size size lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin system priority
no lacp linkagg agg_num partner_admin_system_priority
lacp linkagg agg_num name name lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
lacp linkagg agg_num no name no partner admin system priority
lacp linkagg agg_num admin state {enable | disable} lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor port priority actor_port_priority
lacp linkagg agg_num actor admin key actor_admin_key lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port no actor port priority
lacp linkagg agg_num no actor admin key lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin port
lacp linkagg agg_num actor system priority actor_system_priority partner_admin_port
lacp linkagg agg_num no actor system priority lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
lacp linkagg agg_num actor system id actor_system_id no partner admin port
lacp linkagg agg_num no actor system id lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port partner admin port priority
lacp linkagg agg_num partner system id partner_system_id partner_admin_port_priority
lacp linkagg agg_num no partner system id lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
lacp linkagg agg_num partner system priority partner_system_priority no partner admin port priority
lacp linkagg agg_num no partner system priority show linkagg [agg_num]
lacp linkagg agg_num partner admin key partner_admin_key show linkagg port [slot/port]
lacp linkagg agg_num no partner admin key
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor admin key actor_admin_key GVRP Commands
lacp agg no [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor admin state {[active] [timeout] gvrp
[aggregate] [synchronize] [collect] [distribute] [default] [expire] | none} no gvrp
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port gvrp {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
actor admin state {[[no] active] [[no] timeout] [[no] aggregate] [[no] synchronize] no gvrp {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
[[no] collect] [[no] distribute] [[no] default] [[no] expire] | none} gvrp transparent switching
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor system id actor_system_id no gvrp transparent switching
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port no actor system id gvrp maximum vlan vlanlimit
lacp agg [ethernet | fastethernet | gigaethernet] slot/port actor system priority no gvrp registration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
actor_system_priority gvrp applicant {participant | non-participant | active} {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 3 Link Aggregation Commands
no gvrp applicant {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} show lldp local-system
gvrp timer {join | leave | leaveall} timer-value {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} show lldp [slot/port | slot] local-port
no gvrp timer {join | leave | leaveall} {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} show lldp local-management-address
no gvrp restrict-vlan-registration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list show lldp [slot/port | slot] remote-system
no gvrp restrict-vlan-advertisement {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list show lldp [slot/port | slot] remote-system [med {network-policy | inventory}]
gvrp static-vlan restrict {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list
no gvrp static-vlan restrict {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} vlan-list Interswitch Protocol Commands
clear gvrp statistics [linkagg agg_num | port slot/port]
show gvrp statistics [linkagg agg_num | port slot/port] amap {enable | disable}
show gvrp last-pdu-origin {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port} amap discovery [time] seconds
show gvrp configuration amap common [time] seconds
show gvrp configuration port show amap
show gvrp configuration {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}
show gvrp timer [[join | leave | leaveall] {linkagg agg_num | port slot/port}] IP Commands
802.1AB Commands ip interface name [address ip_address] [mask subnet_mask] [admin [enable | disable]] [vlan
vid] [forward | no forward] [local-proxy-arp | no local-proxy-arp] [eth2 | snap] [primary
lldp destination mac-address {nearest-bridge | nearest-edge} | no primary]
lldp transmit fast-start-count num no ip interface name
lldp transmit interval seconds ip interface dhcp-client [vlan vid] [release | renew] [option-60 opt60_string] [admin {enable |
lldp transmit hold-multiplier num disable}]
lldp transmit delay seconds no ip interface dhcp-client
lldp reinit delay seconds ip router primary-address ip_address
lldp notification interval seconds ip router router-id ip_address
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} lldpdu {tx | rx | tx-and-rx | disable} ip static-route ip_address [mask mask] gateway gateway [metric metric]
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} notification {enable | disable} no ip static-route ip_address [mask mask] gateway ip_address [metric metric]
lldp network-policy policy_id - [ policy_id2] application { voice | voice-signaling | guest- ip route-pref {static | rip | ebgp | ibgp} value
voice | ip default-ttl hops
guest-voice-signaling | softphone-voice | video-conferencing | streaming-video | video- ping {ip_address | hostname} [count count] [size packet_size] [interval seconds] [timeout
signaling } seconds]
vlan { untagged | priority-tag | vlan-id } [ l2-priority 802.1p_value ] [ dscp dscp_value ] traceroute {ip_address | hostname} [max-hop max_hop_count]
no lldp network-policy policy_id - [ policy_id2] ip directed-broadcast {on | off}
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} med network-policy policy_id - [policy_id2] ip service {all | service_name | port service_port}
no lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} med network-policy policy_id - [policy_id2] no ip service {all | service_name | port service_port}
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv management {port-description | system-name | system- ip redist {local | static | rip} into {rip} route-map route-map-name [status {enable | disable}]
description | system-capabilities | management-address} {enable | disable} no ip redist {local | static | rip} into {rip} [route-map route-map-name]
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv dot1 {port-vlan | vlan-name} {enable | disable} ip access-list access-list-name
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv dot3 mac-phy {enable | disable} no ip access-list access-list-name
lldp {slot/port | slot | chassis} tlv med {power | capability | network policy} {enable | disable} ip access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen [action {permit | deny}]
show lldp {slot | slot/port} config [redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}]
show lldp network-policy [policy_id] no ip access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen
show lldp [slot | slot/port] med network-policy ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ip-nexthop
show lldp system-statistics {access-list-name | ip_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]}
show lldp [slot|slot/port] statistics

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 4 802.1AB Commands
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ip-nexthop ip dos scan tcp open-port-penalty penalty_value
{access-list-name | ip_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]} ip dos scan udp open-port-penalty penalty_value
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-nexthop ip dos scan threshold threshold_value
{access-list-name | ipv6_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]} ip dos trap {enable | disable}
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-nexthop ip dos scan decay decay_value
{access-list-name | ipv6_address/prefixLen [permit | deny]} show ip traffic
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv4-interface interface- show ip interface [name | vlan vlan id | dhcp-client]
name show ip route [summary]
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv4-interface interface- show ip route-pref
name show ipv6 redist [rip]
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-interface interface- show ip access-list [access-list-name]
name show ip route-map [route-map-name]
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match ipv6-interface interface- show ip router database [protocol type | gateway ip_address | dest {ip_address/prefixLen |
name ip_address}]
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match metric metric [deviation show ip config
deviation] show ip protocols
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] match metric metric show ip service
[deviation deviation] show arp [ip_address | hardware_address]
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set metric metric show arp filter [ip_address]
[effect {add | subtract | replace | none}] show icmp control
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set metric metric show icmp [statistics]
[effect {add | subtract | replace | none}] show tcp statistics
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set tag tag-number show tcp ports
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set tag tag-number show udp statistics
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ip-nexthop ip_address show udp ports
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ip-nexthop ip_address show ip dos config
ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ipv6-nexthop ipv6_address show ip dos statistics
no ip route-map route-map-name [sequence-number number] set ipv6-nexthop ipv6_address show ip dos arp-poison
arp ip_address hardware_address [alias]
no arp ip_address [alias] IPv6 Commands
clear arp-cache
ip dos arp-poison restricted-address ip_address ipv6 interface if_name vlan vid [enable | disable]
no ip dos arp-poison restricted-address ip_address [base-reachable-time time]
arp filter ip_address [mask ip_mask] [vid] [sender | target] [allow | block] [ra-send {yes | no}]
no arp filter ip_address [ra-max-interval interval]
clear arp-cache [ra-managed-config-flag {true | false}]
icmp type type code code {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap} [ra-other-config-flag {true | false}]
icmp unreachable [net-unreachable | host-unreachable | protocol-unreachable | [ra-reachable-time time]
port-unreachable] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap} [ra-retrans-timer time]
icmp echo [request | reply] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap} [ra-default-lifetime time | no ra-default-lifetime]
icmp timestamp [request | reply] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap} [ra-send-mtu] {yes | no}
icmp add-mask [request | reply] {{enable | disable} | min-pkt-gap gap} no ipv6 interface if_name
icmp messages {enable | disable} ipv6 address ipv6_address /prefix_length [anycast] {if_name | loopback}
ip dos scan close-port-penalty penalty_value no ipv6 address ipv6_address [anycast] {if_name | loopback}

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 5 IPv6 Commands
ipv6 address ipv6_prefix eui-64 {if_name | loopback} ipv6 access-list access-list-name
no ipv6 address ipv6_prefix eui-64 {if_name | loopback} no ipv6 access-list access-list-name
ipv6 dad-check ipv6_address if_name ipv6 access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen [action {permit | deny}]
ipv6 hop-limit value [redist-control {all-subnets | no-subnets | aggregate}]
no ipv6 hop-limit no ipv6 access-list access-list-name address address/prefixLen
ipv6 pmtu-lifetime time show ipv6 redist [rip]
ipv6 host name ipv6_address show ip access-list [access-list-name]
no ipv6 host name ipv6_address ipv6 load rip
ipv6 neighbor stale-lifetime stale-lifetime ipv6 rip status {enable | disable}
ipv6 neighbor ipv6_address hardware_address {if_name} slot/port ipv6 rip invalid-timer seconds
no ipv6 neighbor ipv6_address {if_name} ipv6 rip garbage-timer seconds
ipv6 prefix ipv6_address /prefix_length if_name ipv6 rip holddown-timer seconds
[valid-lifetime time] ipv6 rip jitter value
[preferred-lifetime time] ipv6 rip route-tag value
[on-link-flag {true | false} ipv6 rip update-interval seconds
[autonomous-flag {true | false}] if_name ipv6 rip triggered-sends {all | updated-only | none}
no ipv6 prefix ipv6_address /prefix_length if_name ipv6 rip interface if_name
ipv6 route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length ipv6_address [if_name] [no] ipv6 rip interface if_name
no ipv6 route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length ipv6_address [if_name] ipv6 rip interface if_name metric value
ipv6 static-route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length gateway ipv6_address [if_name] [metric metric] ipv6 rip interface if_name recv-status {enable | disable}
no ipv6 static-route ipv6_prefix/prefix_length gateway ipv6_address [if_name] ipv6 rip interface if_name send-status {enable | disable}
ipv6 route-pref {static | rip} value ipv6 rip interface if_name horizon {none | split-only | poison}
ping6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name] [count count] [size data_size] [interval seconds] show ipv6 rip
traceroute6 {ipv6_address | hostname} [if_name] [max-hop hop_count] [wait-time time] show ipv6 rip interface [if_name]
[port port_number] [probe-count probe] show ipv6 rip peer [ipv6_addresss]
show ipv6 hosts [substring] show ipv6 rip routes [dest <ipv6_prefix/prefix_length>] | [gateway <ipv6_addr>] | [detail
show ipv6 icmp statistics [if_name] <ipv6 prefix/prefix_length>]
show ipv6 interface [if_name | loopback]
show ipv6 pmtu table RIP Commands
clear ipv6 pmtu table
show ipv6 neighbors [ipv6_prefix/prefix_length | if_name | hw hardware_address | static] ip load rip
clear ipv6 neighbors ip rip status {enable | disable}
show ipv6 prefixes ip rip interface {interface_name}
show ipv6 routes [ipv6_prefix/prefix_length | static] no ip rip interface {interface_name}
show ipv6 route-pref ip rip interface {interface_name} status {enable | disable}
show iv6p router database [protocol type | gateway ipv6_address | dest ipv6_prefix/ ip rip interface {interface_name} metric value
prefix_length] ip rip interface {interface_name} send-version {none | v1 | v1compatible | v2}
show ipv6 tcp ports ip rip interface {interface_name} recv-version {v1 | v2 | both | none}
show ipv6 traffic [if_name] ip rip force-holddowntimer seconds
clear ipv6 traffic ip rip host-route
show ipv6 udp ports no ip rip host-route
show ipv6 information ip rip route-tag value
ipv6 redist {local | static | rip} into {rip} route-map route-map-name ip rip interface {interface_name} auth-type {none | simple | md5}
[status {enable | disable}] ip rip interface {interface_name} auth-key string

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 6 RIP Commands
ip rip update-interval seconds no ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan vlan_id
ip rip invalid-timer seconds ip helper dhcp-snooping port slot1/port1[-port1a] {block | client-only | trust}
ip rip garbage-timer seconds ip helper dhcp-snooping port slot1/port1[-port1a] traffic-suppression {enable | disable}
ip rip holddown-timer seconds ip helper dhcp-snooping port slot1/port1[-port1a] ip-source-filtering {enable | disable}
show ip rip ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding {[enable | disable] | [mac_address port slot/port
show ip rip routes [ip_address ip_mask] address ip_address lease-time time vlan vlan_id]}
show ip rip interface [interface_name] no ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding mac_address port slot/port address ip_address
show ip rip peer [ip_address] lease-time time vlan vlan_id
ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding timeout seconds
RDP Commands ip helper dhcp-snooping port binding action {purge | renew}
ip helper dhcp-snooping binding persistency {enable | disable}
ip router-discovery {enable | disable} ip helper boot-up {enable | disable}
ip router-discovery interface name [enable | disable] ip helper boot-up enable {BOOTP | DHCP}
no router-discovery interface name ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port [name]}
ip router-discovery interface name advertisement-address {all-systems-multicast | broadcast} no ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port}
ip router-discovery interface name max-advertisement-interval seconds ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port} vlan
ip router-discovery interface name min-advertisement-interval seconds vlan_id
ip router-discovery interface name advertisement-lifetime seconds no ip udp relay {BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port} vlan
ip router-discovery interface name preference-level level vlan_id
show ip router-discovery show ip helper
show ip router-discovery interface [name] show ip helper stats
ip helper no stats
DHCP Relay Commands show ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan
show ip helper dhcp-snooping port
ip helper address ip_address show ip helper dhcp-snooping binding
ip helper no address [ip_address] show ip udp relay service [BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP |
ip helper address ip_address vlan vlan_id port]
ip helper no address ip_address vlan vlan_id show ip udp relay [BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP | NTP | port]
ip helper standard show ip udp relay destination [BOOTP | NBDD | NBNSNBDD | DNS | TACACS | TFTP |
ip helper per-vlan only NTP | port]
ip helper forward delay seconds
ip helper maximum hops hops IP Multicast Switching Commands
ip helper agent-information {enable | disable}
ip helper agent-information policy {drop | keep | replace} ip multicast [vlan vid] status [{enable | disable}]
ip helper pxe-support {enable | disable} ip multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding [{enable | disable}]
ip helper traffic-suppression {enable | disable} no ip multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding
ip helper dhcp-snooping {enable | disable} ip multicast [vlan vid] version [version]
ip helper dhcp-snooping mac-address verification {enable | disable} ip multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion {enable | disable} no ip multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port
ip helper dhcp-snooping option-82 data-insertion format [base-mac | system-name | user- ip multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port
string string] no ip multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port
ip helper dhcp-snooping bypass option-82-check {enable | disable} ip multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port
ip helper dhcp-snooping vlan vlan_id [mac-address verification {enable | disable}] [option-82 no ip multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port
data-insertion {enable | disable}] ip multicast [vlan vid] query-interval [seconds]

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 7 RDP Commands
ip multicast [vlan vid] last-member-query-interval [tenths-of-seconds] show ipv6 multicast querier
ip multicast [vlan vid] query-response-interval [tenths-of-seconds] show ipv6 multicast group [ip_address]
ip multicast [vlan vid] unsolicited-report-interval [seconds] show ipv6 multicast source [ip_address]
ip multicast [vlan vid] router-timeout [seconds]
ip multicast [vlan vid] source-timeout [seconds] IP Multicast VLAN
ip multicast [vlan vid] querying [{enable | disable}]
no ip multicast [vlan vid] querying
Commands
ip multicast [vlan vid] robustness [robustness] vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id [{enable | disable} | [{1x1 | flat} stp {enable | disable}]] [name name-
ip multicast [vlan vid] spoofing [{enable | disable}] string] [svlan]
no ip multicast [vlan vid] spoofing no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id [-ipmvlan-id2]
ip multicast [vlan vid] zapping [{enable | disable}] vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id ctag {ctag | ctag1-ctag2}
ip multicast [vlan vid] proxying [enable | disable] no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id ctag {ctag | ctag1-ctag2}
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] status [{enable | disable}] vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id address {ip_address | ipv6_address | ipaddress1-ipaddress2 |
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding [{enable | disable}] ipv6address1-ipv6address2}
no ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querier-forwarding no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id address {ip_address | ipv6_address | ipaddress1-ipaddress2 |
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] version [version] ipv6address1-ipv6address2}
ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id sender-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-agg_num2]}
no ipv6 multicast static-neighbor vlan vid port slot/port no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id sender-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-
ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port agg_num2]}
no ipv6 multicast static-querier vlan vid port slot/port vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id receiver-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-
ipv6 multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port agg_num2]}
no ipv6 multicast static-group ip_address vlan vid port slot/port no vlan ipmvlan ipmvlan-id receiver-port {port slot/port[-port2] | linkagg agg_num [-
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] query-interval [seconds] agg_num2]}
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] last-member-query-interval [milliseconds] vlan svlan port {slot/port | agg_num} translate cvlan customer-vlan-id {ipmvlan ipmvlan-id |
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] query-response-interval [milliseconds] svlan svlan-id}
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] unsolicited-report-interval [seconds] vlan svlan port {slot/port | agg_num} cvlan customer-vlan-id no ipmvlan ipmvlan-id
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] router-timeout [seconds] show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id] c-tag
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] source-timeout [seconds] show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id] address
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querying [{enable | disable}] show vlan ipmvlan [ipmvlan-id] port-config
no ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] querying show vlan ipmvlan port-config [slot/port | agg_num]
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] robustness [robustness] show vlan ipmvlan port-binding [slot/port | agg_num]
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] spoofing [{enable | disable}]
no ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] spoofing QoS Commands
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] zapping [{enable | disable}]
ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] proxying [enable | disable] qos {enable | disable}
show ip multicast [vlan vid] qos trust ports
show ip multicast forward [ip_address] qos no trust ports
show ip multicast neighbor qos default servicing mode {strict-priority | wrr [w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7] | drr] [w0 w1 w2
show ip multicast querier w3 w4 w5 w6 w7]}
show ip multicast group [ip_address] qos forward log
show ip multicast source [ip_address] qos no forward log
show ipv6 multicast [vlan vid] qos log console
show ipv6 multicast forward [ipv6_ddress] qos no log console
show ipv6 multicast neighbor qos log lines lines

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 8 IP Multicast VLAN Commands
qos log level level qos port slot/port no dei [egress]
qos no log level show qos port [slot/port] [statistics]
qos default bridged disposition {accept | deny | drop} show qos queue [slot/port] [statistics slot/port]
qos default multicast disposition {accept | deny | drop} show qos slice [slot/slice]
qos stats interval seconds show qos log
qos nms priority show qos config
qos no nms priority show qos statistics
qos phones priority priority_value
qos no phones QoS Policy Commands
qos user-port {filter | shutdown} {spoof | bpdu | rip | dhcp-server | dns-reply}
qos no user-port {filter | shutdown} policy rule rule_name [enable | disable] [precedence precedence] [condition condition]
qos dei egress [action action] [validity period name | no validity period] [save] [log [interval seconds]]
qos no dei egress [count {packets | bytes}] [trap | no trap]
debug qos [info] [config] [rule] [main] [route] [hre] [port] [msg] [sl] [ioctl] [mem] [cam] no policy rule rule_name
[mapper] [flows] [queue] [slot] [l2] [l3] [classifier] [nat] [sem] [pm] [ingress] [egress] policy rule rule_name [no reflexive] [no save] [no log]
[rsvp] [balance] [nimsg] policy validity period name [[no] days days] [[no] months months] [[no] hours hh:mm to
debug no qos hh:mm | no hours] [interval mm:dd:yyyy hh:mm to mm:dd:yyyy hh:mm | no interval]
debug no qos [info] [config] [rule] [main] [route] [hre] [port] [msg] [sl] [ioctl] [mem] [cam] no policy validity period name
[mapper] [flows] [queue] [slot] [l2] [l3] [classifier] [nat] [sem] [pm] [ingress] [egress] policy network group net_group ip_address [mask net_mask] [ip_address2 [mask
[rsvp] [balance] [nimsg] net_mask2]...]
debug qos internal [slice slot/slice] [flow] [queue] [port] [l2tree] [l3tree] [vector] [pending] no policy network group net_group
[verbose] [mapper] [pool] [log] [pingonly | nopingonly] policy network group net_group no ip_address [mask netmask] [ip_address2 [mask
qos clear log net_mask2]...]
qos apply policy service group service_group service_name1 [service_name2...]
qos revert no policy service group service_group
qos flush policy service group service_group no service_name1 [service_name2...]
qos reset policy mac group mac_group mac_address [mask mac_mask] [mac_address2 [mask
qos stats reset [egress] mac_mask2]...]
qos port slot/port reset no policy mac group mac_group
qos port slot/port policy mac group mac_group no mac_address [mask mac_mask] [mac_address2 [mask
qos port slot/port trusted mac_mask2]...]
qos port slot/port no trusted policy port group group_name slot/port[-port] [slot/port[-port]...]
qos port slot/port servicing mode {strict-priority | wrr [w0 w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7] | drr [w0 no policy port group group_name
w1 w2 w3 w4 w5 w6 w7] | default} policy port group group_name no slot/port[-port] [slot/port[-port]...]
qos port slot/port qn maxbw kbps policy vlan group group_name vlan_id[-vlan_id] [vlan_id[-vlan_id]...]
qos port slot/port no qn maxbw kbps no policy vlan group group_name
qos port slot/port maximum egress-bandwidth bps policy vlan group group_name no vlan_id[-vlan_id] [vlan_id[-vlan_id]...]
qos port slot/port no maximum egress-bandwidth policy map group map_group {value1:value2...}
qos port slot/port maximum ingress-bandwidth bps no policy map group map_group
qos port slot/port no maximum ingress-bandwidth policy map group no {value1:value2...}
qos port slot/port default 802.1p value policy service service_name
qos port slot/port default dscp value no policy service service_name
qos port slot/port default classification {802.1p | dscp} policy service service_name protocol protocol {[source ip port port[-port]]
qos port slot/port dei [egress] [destination ip port port[-port]]}

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 9 QoS Policy Commands
no policy service service_name policy condition condition_name ethertype etype
policy service service_name [no source ip port] [no destination ip port] policy condition condition_name no ethertype
policy service service_name source tcp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name established
no policy service service_name policy condition condition_name no established
policy service service_name no source tcp port policy condition condition_name tcpflags [any | all] {F | S | R | P | A | U | E | W} mask {F | S
policy service service_name destination tcp port port[-port] | R | P | A | U | E | W}
no policy service service_name policy condition condition_name no tcpflags
policy service service_name no destination tcp port policy condition condition_name service service_name
policy service service_name source udp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no service
no policy service service_name policy condition condition_name service group service_group
policy service service_name no source udp port policy condition condition_name no service group
policy service service_name destination udp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name icmptype type
no policy service service_name policy condition condition_name no icmptype
policy service service_name no destination udp port policy condition condition_name icmpcode code
policy condition condition_name policy condition condition_name no icmpcode
no policy condition condition_name policy condition condition_name ip protocol protocol
policy condition condition_name source ip ip_address [mask netmask] policy condition condition_name no ip protocol
policy condition condition_name no source ip policy condition condition_name ipv6
policy condition condition_name source ipv6 {any | ipv6_address [mask netmask]} policy condition condition_name no ipv6
policy condition condition_name no source ipv6 policy condition condition_name tos tos_value [mask tos_mask]
policy condition condition_name destination ip ip_address [mask netmask] policy condition conditioning no tos
policy condition condition_name no destination ip policy condition condition_name dscp {dscp_value[-value]} [mask dscp_mask]
policy condition condition_name destination ipv6 {any | ipv6_address [mask netmask]} policy condition condition_name no dscp
policy condition condition_name no destination ipv6 policy condition condition_name source mac mac_address [mask mac_mask]
policy condition condition_name multicast ip ip_address [mask netmask] policy condition condition_name no source mac
policy condition condition_name no multicast ip policy condition condition_name destination mac mac_address [mask mac_mask]
policy condition condition_name source network group network_group policy condition condition_name no destination mac
policy condition condition_name no source network group policy condition condition_name source mac group group_name
policy condition condition_name destination network group network_group policy condition condition_name no source mac group
policy condition condition_name no destination network group policy condition condition_name destination mac group mac_group
policy condition condition_name multicast network group multicast_group policy condition condition_name no destination
policy condition condition_name no multicast network group policy condition condition_name source vlan vlan_id
policy condition condition_name source ip port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no source vlan
policy condition condition_name no source ip port policy condition condition_name source vlan group vlan_group
policy condition condition_name destination ip port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no source vlan group
policy condition condition_name no destination ip port policy condition condition_name destination vlan vlan_id
policy condition condition_name source tcp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no destination vlan
policy condition condition_name no source tcp port policy condition condition_name 802.1p 802.1p_value[-802.1p_value]
policy condition condition_name destination tcp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no 802.1p
policy condition condition_name no destination tcp port policy condition condition_name source port slot/port[-port]
policy condition condition_name source udp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no source port
policy condition condition_name no source udp port policy condition condition_name destination port slot/port[-port]
policy condition condition_name destination udp port port[-port] policy condition condition_name no destination port
policy condition condition_name no destination udp port policy condition condition_name source port group group_name

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 10 QoS Policy Commands
policy condition condition_name no source port group show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source mac mac_address
policy condition condition_name destination port group group_name show policy classify {l2 | l3 multicast} [applied] destination mac mac_address
policy condition condition_name no destination port show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source vlan vlan_id
policy action action_name show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination vlan vlan_id
policy no action action_name show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source interface type {ethernet | wan |
policy list list_name type [unp | egress] rules rule_name [rule_name2...] [enable | disable] ethernet-10 | ethernet-100 | ethernet-1G | ethernet-10G}
no policy list list_name show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source ip ip_address
policy list list_name no rules rule_name [rule_name2...] show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination ip ip_address
policy action action_name disposition {accept | drop | deny} show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] multicast ip ip_address
policy action action_name no disposition show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] tos tos_value
policy action action_name shared show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] dscp dscp_value
policy action action_name no shared show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] ip protocol protocol
policy action action_name priority priority_value show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source ip port port
policy action action_name no priority show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] destination ip port port
policy action action_name maximum bandwidth bps show [applied] policy network group [network_group]
policy action action_name no maximum bandwidth show [applied] policy service [service_name]
policy action action_name maximum depth bytes show [applied] policy service group [service_group]
policy action action_name no maximum depth show [applied] policy mac group [mac_group]
policy action action_name cir bps [cbs byte] [pir bps] [pbs byte] show [applied] policy port group [group_name]
policy action action_name no cir bps show [applied] policy vlan group [group_name]
policy action action_name tos tos_value show [applied] policy map group [group_name]
policy action action_name no tos show [applied] policy action [action_name]
policy action action_name 802.1p 802.1p_value show [applied] policy list [list_name]
policy action action_name no 802.1p show [applied] policy condition [condition_name]
policy action action_name dscp dscp_value show active policy list [list_name]
policy action action_name no dscp show active [bridged | routed | multicast] policy rule [rule_name]
policy action map {802.1p | tos | dscp} to {802.1p | tos| dscp} using map_group show active policy rule [rule_name] meter-statistics
policy action no map show [applied] [bridged | routed | multicast] policy rule [rule_name]
policy action action_name permanent gateway ip ip_address show policy validity period [name]
policy action action_name no permanent gateway ip
policy action action_name port-disable Policy Server
policy action action_name no port-disable
policy action action_name redirect port slot/port
Commands
policy action action_name no redirect port policy server load
policy action action_name redirect linkagg link_agg policy server flush
policy action action_name no redirect linkagg policy server ip_address [port port_number] [admin {up | down}] [preference preference]
policy action action_name no-cache [user user_name password password] [searchbase search_string] [ssl | no ssl]
policy action action_name no no-cache no policy server ip_address [port port_number]
policy action action_name ingress mirror slot/port show policy server
policy action action_name no mirror slot/port show policy server long
policy action action_name cir bps [cbs byte] [pir bps] [pbs byte] show policy server statistics
policy action action_name no cir bps show policy server rules
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] show policy server events
show policy classify {l2 | l3 | multicast} [applied] source port slot/port

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 11 Policy Server Commands
802.1X Commands aaa ldap-server server_name [host {hostname | ip_address} [{hostname2 | ip_address2}]] [dn
dn_name] [password super_password] [base search_base] [retransmit retries] [timeout
802.1x slot/port [direction {both | in}] [port-control {force-authorized | force-unauthorized | seconds] [ssl | no ssl] [port port]
auto}] [quiet-period seconds] [tx-period seconds] [supp-timeout seconds] [server- no aaa ldap-server server-name
timeout seconds] [max-req max_req] [re-authperiod seconds] [reauthentication | no aaa ace-server clear
reauthentication] aaa authentication {console | telnet | ftp | http | snmp | ssh | default} server1 [server2...] [local]
802.1x initialize slot/port no aaa authentication [console | telnet | ftp | http | snmp | ssh | default]
802.1x reauthenticate slot/port aaa authentication {console | telnet | ftp | http | snmp | ssh} default
802.1x slot/port supp-polling retry retries aaa authentication 802.1x server1 [server2] [server3] [server4]
802.1x slot/port supplicant policy authentication [[pass] {group-mobility | vlan no aaa authentication 802.1x
vid | default-vlan | block | captive-portal}...] [[fail] {vlan vid | block | captive-portal}...] aaa authentication MAC server1 [server2] [server3] [server4]
802.1x slot/port non-supplicant policy authentication [[pass] {group-mobility | no aaa authentication MAC
vlan vid | default-vlan | block | captive-portal}] [[fail] {group-mobility | vlan vid | aaa accounting 802.1x server1 [server2...] [local]
default-vlan | block | captive-portal}] no aaa accounting 802.1x
802.1x slot/port non-supplicant policy {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan | block | aaa accounting session server1 [server2...] [local]
captive-portal} no accounting session
802.1x slot/port {supplicant | non-supplicant} policy default aaa accounting command server1 [server2...] [local]
802.1x slot/port captive-portal policy authentication pass {group-mobility | no accounting command
vlan vid | default-vlan | block}] [fail] {group-mobility | vlan vid | default-vlan | block} user username [password password] [expiration {day | date}] [read-only | read-write
802.1x slot/port captive-portal session-limit time [families... | domains...| all | none]] [no snmp | no auth | sha | md5 | sha+des | md5+des]
802.1x slot/port captive-portal retry-count retries [end-user profile name]
802.1x captive-portal address ip_address no user username
802.1x captive-portal proxy-server-url proxy_url password
802.1x auth-server-down {enable | disable} user password-size min size
802.1x auth-server-down policy {user-network-profile profile_name | block} user password-expiration {day | disable}
802.1x auth-server-down re-authperiod {value} user password-policy cannot-contain-username {enable | disable}
show 802.1x [slot/port] user password-policy min-uppercase number
show 802.1x users [slot/port] user password-policy min-lowercase number
show 802.1x statistics [slot/port] user password-policy min-digit number
show 802.1x device classification policies [slot/port] user password-policy min-nonalpha number
show 802.1x non-supplicant [slot/port] user password-history number
show 802.1x auth-server-down user password-min-age days
show 802.1x captive-portal configuration [slot/port] user lockout-window minutes
user lockout-threshold number
AAA Commands user lockout-duration minutes
user {lockout | unlock}
aaa radius-server server [host {hostname | ip_address} [hostname2 | ip_address2]] [key end-user profile name [read-only [area | all]] [read-write [area | all]] [disable [area | all]]
secret] [retransmit retries] [timeout seconds] [auth-port auth_port] [acct-port acct_port] no end-user profile name
no aaa radius server server end-user profile name vlan-range vlan_range [vlan_range2...]
aaa tacacs+-server server [host {hostname | ip_address} {hostname2 | ip_address2}] [key end-user profile name no vlan-range vlan1 [vlan2..]
secret] aaa user-network-profile name name vlan vlan-id
[timeout seconds] [port port] no aaa user-network-profile name name
no aaa tacacs+-server server show aaa server [server_name]
show aaa authentication

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 12 802.1X Commands
show aaa authentication 802.1x Port Mapping Commands
show aaa authentication mac
show aaa authentication 802.1x port mapping port_mapping_sessionid {enable | disable}
show aaa accounting no port mapping port_mapping_sessionid
show user [username] show port mapping [port_mapping_sessionid]
show user password-size
show user password-expiration Learned Port Security
show user password-policy
show user lockout-setting
Commands
debug command-info {enable | disable} port-security slot/port[-port2] [enable | disable]
debug end-user profile name port-security chassis disable
show end-user profile name no port security slot/port[-port2]
show aaa priv hexa [domain or family] port-security shutdown minutes [convert-to-static {enable | disable}]
port-security slot/port[-port2] maximum number
Port Mobility Commands port-security slot/port[-port2] max-filtering number
port-security {slot/port[-port2] | chassis} convert-to-static
vlan vid dhcp mac mac_address port-security slot/port mac mac_address [vlan vlan_id]
vlan vid no dhcp mac mac_address port-security slot/port no mac {all | mac_address} [vlan vlan_id]
vlan vid dhcp mac range low_mac_address high_mac_address port-security slot/port[-port2] mac-range [low mac_address | high mac_address | low
vlan vid no dhcp mac range low_mac_address mac_address high mac_address]
vlan vid dhcp port slot/port port-security slot/port[-port2] violation {restrict | shutdown}
vlan vid no dhcp port slot/port port-security slot/port release
vlan vid dhcp generic port-security slot/port[-port2] learn-trap-threshold number
vlan vid no dhcp generic show port-security [slot/port[-port2] | slot]
vlan vid mac mac_address show port-security shutdown
vlan vid no mac mac_address
vlan vid mac range low_mac_address high_mac_address Port Mirroring and
vlan vid no mac range low_mac_address
vlan vid ip ip_address [subnet_mask]
Monitoring Commands
vlan vid no ip ip_address [subnet_mask] port mirroring port_mirror_sessionid [no] source slot/port[-port2] [slot/port[-port2]...]
vlan vid protocol {ip-e2 | ip-snap | decnet | appletalk | destination slot/port [rpmir-vlan vlan_id] [bidirectional |inport |outport] [unblocked
ethertype type | dsapssap dsap/ssap | snap snaptype} vlan_id]
vlan vid no protocol {ip-e2 | ip-snap | decnet | appletalk | [enable | disable]
ethertype type | dsapssap dsap/ssap | snap snaptype} port mirroring port_mirror_sessionid {enable | disable}
vlan vid port slot/port no port mirroring port_mirror_sessionid {enable | disable}
vlan vid no port slot/port port monitoring port_monitor_sessionid source slot/port
vlan port mobile slot/port [bpdu ignore {enable | disable}] [{no file | file filename [size filesize] | [overwrite {on | off}]}]
vlan no port mobile slot/port [inport | outport | bidirectional] [timeout seconds] [enable | disable]
vlan port slot/port default vlan restore {enable | disable} port monitoring port_monitor_sessionid {disable | pause | resume}
vlan port slot/port default vlan {enable | disable} no port monitoring port_monitor_sessionid
vlan port slot/port authenticate {enable | disable} show port mirroring status [port_mirror_sessionid]
vlan port slot/port 802.1x {enable | disable} show port monitoring status [port_monitor_sessionid]
show vlan [vid] rules show port monitoring file [port_monitor_sessionid]
show vlan port mobile [slot/port]

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 13 Port Mobility Commands
sFlow Commands show health all {memory | cpu | rx | txrx}
show health slice slot
sflow receiver num name string timeout {seconds | forever} address {ip_address | show health fabric slot 1[-slot2]
ipv6address} udp-port port packet-size size Version num
sflow receiver receiver_index release CMM Commands
sflow sampler num portlist receiver receiver_index rate value sample-hdr-size size
no sflow sampler num portlist reload [primary | secondary] [with-fabric] [in [hours:] minutes | at hour:minute [month day |
sflow poller num portlist receiver receiver_index interval value day month]]
no sflow poller num portlist reload [primary | secondary] [with-fabric] cancel
show sflow agent reload working {rollback-timeout minutes | no rollback-timeout} [in [hours:] minutes | at
show sflow receiver [num] hour:minute]
show sflow sampler[num] [configure] copy running-config working
show sflow poller [num] [configure] write memory
[configure] copy working certified [flash-synchro]
RMON Commands [configure] copy flash-synchro
takeover
rmon probes {stats | history | alarm} [entry-number] {enable | disable} show running-directory
show rmon probes [stats | history | alarm] [entry-number] show reload [status]
show rmon events [event-number] show microcode [working | certified | loaded]
show microcode history [working | certified]
Switch Logging Commands
Chassis Management and Monitoring Commands
swlog
no swlog system contact text_string
swlog appid {app_id | integer} level {level | integer} system name text_string
no swlog appid app_id system location text_string
swlog output {console | flash | socket [ip_address]} system date [mm/dd/yyyy]
no swlog output {console | flash | socket [ip_address]} system time [hh:mm:ss]
swlog output flash file-size bytes system time-and-date synchro
swlog clear system timezone [timezone_abbrev | offset_value | time_notation]
show log swlog system daylight savings time [{enable | disable} | start {week} {day} in {month} at {hh:mm}
show log swlog [session session_id] [timestamp start_time [end_time]] [appid appid] [level end {week} {day} in {month} at {hh:mm} [by min]]
level] reload ni [slot] number
show swlog reload all [in [hours:] minutes | at hour:minute [month day | day month]]
reload all cancel
Health Monitoring Commands reload pass-through slot-number
power ni [slot] slot-number
health threshold {rx percent | txrx percent | memory percent | cpu percent | temperature no power ni [slot] slot-number
degrees} temp-threshold temp slot slot-number
health interval seconds stack set slot slot-number saved-slot saved-slot-number [reload]
health statistics reset stack set slot slot-number mode {stackable | standalone} [reload]
show health threshold [rx | txrx | memory | cpu | temperature] stack clear slot slot-number [immediate]
show health interval show system
show health [slot/port] [statistics] show hardware info

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 14 sFlow Commands
show chassis [number] session banner no {cli | ftp | http}
show cmm [number] session timeout {cli | http | ftp} minutes
show ni [number] session prompt default [string]
show module [number] session xon-xoff {enable | disable}
show module long [number] prompt [user] [time] [date] [string string] [prefix]
show module status [number] no prompt
show power [supply] [number] show prefix
show fan [number] alias alias command_name
show temperature [number] show alias
show stack topology [slot-number] user profile save
show stack status user profile reset
show stack mode history size number
show history [parameters]
Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands !{! | n}
command-log {enable | disable}
mac-range eeprom start_mac_address count kill session_number
mac-retention status {enable | disable} exit
mac-retention dup-mac-trap {enable | disable} whoami
mac release who
show mac-range [index] show session config
show mac-range [index] alloc show session xon-xoff
show mac-retention status more size lines
more
Network Time Protocol Commands no more
show more
ntp server {ip_address | domain_name} [key key | version version | minpoll exponent | prefer] telnet {host_name | ip_address}
no ntp server {ip_address | domain_name} ssh {host_name | ip_address | enable | disable}
ntp server synchronized ssh enforce pubkey-auth {enable | disable}
ntp server unsynchronized show ssh config
ntp client {enable | disable} show command-log
ntp broadcast {enable | disable} show command-log status
ntp broadcast delay microseconds
ntp key key [trusted | untrusted] File Management
ntp key load
show ntp client
Commands
show ntp client server-list cd [path]
show ntp server status [ip_address | domain_name] pwd
show ntp keys mkdir [path/]dir
rmdir [path/]dir
Session Management Commands ls [-r] [[path/]dir]
dir [[path/]dir]
session login-attempt integer rename [path/]old_name [path/]new_name
session login-timeout seconds rm [-r] [path/]filename
session banner {cli | ftp | http} file_name delete [path/]filename

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 15 Chassis MAC Server (CMS) Commands
cp [-r] [path/]orig_filename [dest_path/]dupl_filename show configuration snapshot [feature_list]
scp user_name@remote_ip_addr:[path/]source [path/]target write terminal
scp [path/]source user_name@remote_ip_addr:[path/]target
mv {[path/]filename dest_path[/new_filename] | [path/]dir dest_path[/new_dir]} SNMP Commands
move {[path/]filename dest_path[/new_filename] | [path/]dir dest_path[/new_dir]}
chmod {+w | -w} [path/]file snmp station {ip_address | ipv6_address} {[udp_port] [username] [v1 | v2 | v3] [enable |
attrib {+w | -w} [path/]file disable]}
freespace [/flash] no snmp station {ip_address | ipv6_address}
fsck /flash [no-repair | repair] show snmp station
newfs /flash snmp community map community_string {[user useraccount_name] | {enable | disable}}
rcp [slot:] source_filepath [slot:] destination_filepath no snmp community map community_string
rrm slot filepath snmp community map mode {enable | disable}
rls slot directory [file_name] show snmp community map
vi [path/]filename snmp security {no security | authentication set | authentication all | privacy set | privacy all |
view [path/]filename trap only}
tty lines columns show snmp security
show tty show snmp statistics
more [path/]file show snmp mib family [table_name]
ftp {host_name | ip_address} snmp trap absorption {enable | disable}
scp-sftp {enable | disable} snmp trap to webview {enable | disable}
show ssh config snmp trap replay {ip_address | ipv6_address} [seq_id]
tftp {host_name | ip_address} {get | put} source-file [src_path/]src_file snmp trap filter {ip_address | ipv6_address} trap_id_list
[destination-file [dest_path/] dest_file] [ascii] no snmp trap filter {ip_address | ipv6_address} trap_id_list
rz snmp authentication trap {enable | disable}
show snmp trap replay
Web Management Commands show snmp trap filter
show snmp authentication trap
{[ip] http | https} server show snmp trap config
no {[ip] http | https} server
{[ip] http | https} ssl DNS Commands
no {[ip] http | https} ssl
[ip] http port {default | port} ip domain-lookup
https port {default | port} no ip domain-lookup
debug http sessiondb ip name-server server-address1 [server-address2 [server-address3]]
show [ip] http ipv6 name-server server-ipv6_address1 [server-ipv6_address2 [server-ipv6_address3]]
ip domain-name name
Configuration File Manager Commands no ip domain-name
show dns
configuration apply filename [at hh:mm month dd [year]] | [in hh[:mm]] [verbose]
configuration error-file limit number
show configuration status
configuration cancel
configuration syntax check path/filename [verbose]
configuration snapshot feature_list [path/filename]

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 page 16 Web Management Commands
Index reload 31-2
running configuration 31-6
show running-directory 31-6
takeover 31-13
CMS 33-1
allocated addresses 33-9
display status 33-11
MAC address release 33-6
Numerics mac retention status 33-4
mac-range 33-2
802.1ab 9-1
range table 33-7
notification of local system MIB changes 9-12
commands
reinit delay 9-8
domains and families 22-28
show port statistics 9-34
conditions
tlv management 9-18
multiple conditions defined 19-38
transmit time interval 9-5
counters 2-82
802.1p
current user session 35-27
mapped to ToS or DSCP 19-138
QoS port default 18-50
802.1Q 5-1 D
show 5-6 Daylight Savings Time (DST)
untrusted ports 18-5 enabling or disabling 32-12
802.1X 21-1 debug messages 29-4, 29-11
device classification policy 21-16 default route
supplicant policy authentication 21-9 IP 11-11
supp-polling retry 21-7 DHCP Relay 15-1
DHCP server IP address 15-3
A dhcp snooping option-82 format 15-24
elapsed boot time 15-10
AAA 22-1
forward delay time 15-10
password-size min 22-32
Global DHCP 15-3
show user network profile 22-83
ip helper pre-support 15-18
show user password-expiration 22-72
maximum number of hops 15-12
accounting 2-47, 2-79
per-VLAN forwarding option 15-8
actions
show ip helper 15-47
supported by hardware 19-115
standard forwarding option 15-7
active login sessions 35-30
statistics 15-51, 15-53
Alcatel Mapping Adjacency Protocol 10-1
DHCP VLAN rules 23-2, 23-4, 23-6, 23-8
adjacent switches 10-2
directory
common transmission state 10-5
change 36-3
discovery transmission state 10-3
create 36-6
alerts 29-4, 29-11
delete 36-8
alias 35-14
display 36-5, 36-10, 36-29, 36-31, 36-35
AMAP
rename 36-14
see Alcatel Mapping Adjacency Protocol
DNS
assigning ports to VLANs 4-8
domain name 40-2
authenticated mobile ports 23-21, 23-23, 23-25, 23-26, 23-28
enables resolver 40-2
name servers 40-2, 40-3, 40-7, 40-9
B resolver 40-1
boot.cfg file DSCP
QoS log lines 18-11 mapped to 802.1p or ToS 19-138
BPDU QoS port default 18-52
see Bridge Protocol Data Units duplex data transfer 2-30
Bridge Protocol Data Units 6-4, 6-94, 6-96, 6-97, 6-99 dynamic link aggregation
adding ports 7-21
C creating 7-9
deleting 7-9
CLI
deleting ports 7-21
logging commands 35-24, 35-49–35-51
LACPDU frames 7-24, 7-30
CMM

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 Index-1


Index

local port MAC address 7-26 query interval 16-15, 16-74


remote group MAC address 7-17 query response interval 16-19, 16-21, 16-74
remote port MAC address 7-32 querying 16-5, 16-27, 16-74
dynamic VLAN assignment robustness variable 16-29, 16-74
mobile ports 23-20 router timeout 16-23, 16-74
dynamic VLAN port assignment source timeout 16-25, 16-74
secondary VLANs 23-24 spoofing 16-31, 16-74
VLAN rules 23-1 zapping 16-33, 16-35, 16-74
inter-frame gap 2-17, 2-90, 2-94
E IP Multicast Switching
see IPMS 16-1
editor
IP network address VLAN rule 23-14
vi 36-37
IP routing
error file 38-4
default route 11-11
error frame 2-52, 2-84
IPMS 16-1
errors 29-4, 29-11
ipv6 multicast querier-forwarding 16-39
Ethernet 2-1
IPMV 17-1
clear port violation 2-25
assign ipv4, ipv6 address 17-6
interfaces 2-5
association 17-12
trap port 2-3
create 17-2
exit 35-26
customer VLAN ID 17-4
delete 17-2
F ipv4, ipv6 address 17-15
file receiver port 17-10
copy 36-19, 36-21, 36-33 sender port 17-8
delete 36-16, 36-32, 36-34 show ipmvlan port-config 17-19
move 36-23 ipv6
privileges 36-27 address 12-6
starting ftpv6 session 36-46 dad-check 12-8
starting sftpv6 session 36-53 hop-limit 12-9
system check 36-29, 36-30 host 12-11
transfer 36-44, 36-46, 36-55 interface 12-3
neighbor 12-12, 12-13
ping6 12-21
G pmtu-lifetime 12-9, 12-10
GARP 8-1 prefix 12-15
GVRP 8-1 rip 12-65
applicant 8-9 route 12-17, 12-18
disable 8-2 traceroute 12-23
disable on specified port 8-3
display configuration on specified port 8-4, 8-8, 8-10,
8-12, 8-14, 8-16, 8-18, 8-26, 8-27, 8-28, 8-30 L
enable 8-2 LACP
enable on specified port 8-3, 8-27, 8-30 see dynamic link aggregation
registration 8-7 line speed 2-32
timer 8-11 LPS 25-1
learn-trap-threshold 25-19
max-filtering 25-8
H maximum 25-6
health 30-2 shutdown 25-4

I M
IGMP MAC address table
default 16-7, 16-74 duplicate MAC addresses 3-3
group entry 16-13, 16-77, 16-83, 16-85 MAC address VLAN rule 23-10, 23-12
ip multicast querier-forwarding 16-5 MAC addresses
last member query interval 16-17, 16-74 aging time 3-6, 6-41, 6-43, 6-45
neighbor entry 16-9, 16-78 dynamic link aggregation 7-17, 7-26, 7-32
querier entry 16-11, 16-80 learned 3-2

Index-2 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011


Index

statically assigned 3-2, 3-3, 3-5 port status 2-90


MLD port VLAN rule 23-18
default 16-41, 16-89 prompt 35-11
group entry 16-47, 16-92, 16-98, 16-100 protocol VLAN rules 23-16
last member query interval 16-51, 16-89
neighbor entry 16-43, 16-93
Q
querier entry 16-45, 16-95
QOS
query interval 16-49, 16-89
ip phone traffic 18-20
query response interval 16-53, 16-55, 16-89
nms priority 18-18
querying 16-61, 16-89
robustness variable 16-63, 16-89
router timeout 16-57, 16-89 R
source timeout 16-59, 16-89 RDP
spoofing 16-65, 16-89 advertisement packets 14-5
zapping 16-67, 16-69, 16-89 maximum time 14-7, 14-11
mobile port properties minimum time 14-9
authentication 23-21, 23-23, 23-25, 23-26, 23-28 preference level 14-13
BPDU ignore 23-20, 23-21 resolver
default VLAN membership 23-24 see DNS resolver
restore default VLAN 23-22 Ring Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol
status 23-32 create 6-111, 6-112, 6-116
mobile ports 23-20 disable 6-111
trusted ports 18-5 enable 6-111
VLAN rules 23-1 remove 6-112
modules RIP
power 32-22 active peer 13-30
reloading 32-18, 32-20 forced hold-down timer 13-13
temperature 32-23 garbage timer 13-21
global 13-2
N hold-down timer 13-22
host-route 13-15
Network Interface (NI) modules
IGP 13-1
reloading 32-14, 32-16, 32-17
interface 13-4
NTP 34-1
invalid timer 13-20
broadcast delay 34-8
route-tag 13-16
key 34-9
security 13-17
operation 34-6
status 13-3
server 34-2
RMON
server unsynchronization 34-5
probes 28-2
synchronization 34-4
router discovery protocol
see RDP 14-1
P
pending configuration
commands associated with 18-33
S
secure shell session 35-41, 35-42, 35-43, 35-44, 36-52, 36-54
erasing policy configuration 18-33
secure socket layer
PMM
see SSL
port mirroring 26-2
session management
port monitoring source 26-7
banner 35-5
policies
history buffer 35-19
save option 19-6
kills 35-25
policy condition
login attempt 35-3
dscp 19-88
more 35-36
source vlan 19-98, 19-100
more size 35-35
policy servers
prompt 35-9
displaying information about 20-6
timeout 35-7
SSL 20-4
user profile 35-17
port mapping 24-2
xon-xoff 35-10
port mobility
sflow 27-5
see mobile ports

OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011 Index-3


Index

poller 27-7 U
receiver 27-3 user accounts
sampler 27-5 SNMP access 22-28
smurf attack 11-20 UTC 34-1
snapshot 38-11
SNMP
community map 39-7 V
community strings 39-7 VLAN rules 23-1
security 39-11 DHCP 23-2, 23-4, 23-6, 23-8
station 39-3 IP network address 23-14
statistics 39-15 MAC address 23-10, 23-12
trap 39-18 port 23-18
source learning 3-1 protocol 23-16
MAC address table 3-1, 3-2, 3-5 VLANs 4-1, 4-2
Spanning Tree Algorithm and Protocol 6-1 administrative status 4-2
1x1 operating mode 6-4, 6-12, 6-14, 6-17, 6-19, 6-26, default VLAN 4-8
6-28 description 4-2
bridge ID 6-21, 6-23, 6-25, 6-27 operational status 4-2
flat operating mode 6-4, 6-12, 6-14, 6-17, 6-19, 6-26, 6-28 port assignments 4-8
path cost 6-68, 6-72, 6-75, 6-79 rules 23-1
port ID 6-59, 6-61, 6-63, 6-65 secondary VLAN 4-8
port states 6-81, 6-83, 6-85 Spanning Tree status 4-4
pvst+ mode 6-173
rrstp ring vlan-tag 6-114 W
Spanning Tree bridge parameters warnings 29-4, 29-11
maximum aging time 6-35 WebView
Spanning Tree port parameters enabling/disabling 37-2
connection type 6-87, 6-88, 6-89, 6-90, 6-91, 6-92, 6-94,
6-96, 6-97, 6-100, 6-101, 6-102, 6-103, 6-104,
6-105, 6-106, 6-107, 6-108 Z
link aggregate ports 6-53, 6-55, 6-57 Zmodem 36-57
mode 6-81, 6-83, 6-85
path cost 6-83, 6-85
priority 6-59
Spanning Tree status 6-53, 6-55, 6-57
ssh6 35-44
SSL 37-3
policy servers 20-4
static link aggregation
creating 7-3
deleting 7-3
static MAC addresses 3-2, 3-3, 3-5
syntax check 38-9
system information
administrative contact 32-3
date 32-6
location 32-5
name 32-4
time 32-6, 32-7
time zone 32-9

T
telnet 35-38, 35-40
timer session 38-6
ToS
mapped to 802.1p or DSCP 19-138
QoS port default 18-52

Index-4 OmniSwitch 6450 CLI Reference Guide November 2011

You might also like